Skip to main content

Full text of "Zoology : being a sketch of the classification, structure, distribution, and habits, of animals"

See other formats


UC-NRLF 


(rf 


NO.  i..;:.:x 

Division :.. 


Range BIOLOGY 

LIBRARY 

Shelf.... 


Received  (Jt  .187^ 


i£ 


1 


>> 

JS> 

J»t>          -> 


>)>   oe> 


|||JAiJBANCROr-. 


POPULAR    CYCLOPAEDIA 


NATURAL   SCIENCE. 


ZOOLOGY, 


A  SKETCH  OF  THK  CLASSIFICATION,   STRUCTURE,  DISTRIBUTION, 
AND  HABITS,  OF  ANIMALS. 


WILLIAM  B.  CARPENTER,  M.D.,  F.R.S., 

* 


I.Ki-i<  HKR  ON  NATURAL  HISTORY  AND  COMF'ARATIVK  ANATOMY  AT 
ST.  THOMAS'S  HOSPITAL. 


VOL.  I. 

COMPRISING  MAMMALS,   BIRDS,  AND  REPTILES. 


LONDON : 
WM.  S.  ORR  AND  Co.,  PATERNOSTER  ROW. 

W.  AND  R.  CHAMBERS,  EDINBURGH ;  AND  W.  CURRY  AND  CO.,  DUBLIN. 
MDCCCXLIV. 


ru 


6 


LONDON : 
BRADBURY  AND  EVANS,  PRINTERS,  \VHITEFRfARS. 


TO   THE  RIGHT   HONOURABLE 

AUGUSTA    ADA,   COUNTESS   OF   LOVELACE, 

Cflese  Volumes 

ARK 

MOST    RESPECTFULLY    DKDICATED, 

BY 
HKH    OBLIGED    AND    FAITHFUL    SERVANT, 

THE   AUTHOR. 


PREFACE. 


IN  the  preparation  of  this  Treatise,  the  Author  has  kept 
-steadily  in  view  the  objects  at  which  he  has  aimed  in  the 
preceding  volumes,  and  in  the  attainment  of  which  he 
trusts  that  he  has  been  in  some  degree  successful ; — namely, 
the  exposition  of  the  principles  of  Science  in  their  simplest 
form,  and  the  illustration  of  these  by  the  most  useful  and 
interesting  examples.  He  has  so  fully  explained  his  views 
on  the  utility  of  the  study  of  Zoology,  and  on  the  mode  in 
which  it  may  be  most  advantageously  pursued,  in  the  Intro- 
duction and  First  Chapter  of  the  present  volume,  that 
he  considers  any  further  remarks  on  these  subjects  here 
uncalled  for. 

The  general  account  of  the  Classes  is  translated,  with  some 
additions  and  modifications,  from  the  "  Cours  Elernentaire 
de  Zoologie  "of  M.  Milne-Edwards ;  a  work  adopted  by 
the  French  Government  as  the  Text-Book  of  instruction, 
in  the  Colleges  connected  with  the  University  of  Paris ; 
and  the  whole  of  the  beautiful  illustrations  prepared  for 
that  Treatise,  will  be  found  in  the  present  volumes.  For 
the  more  detailed  accounts  of  the  Orders,  Families,  &c., — 
as  well  as  for  the  first  Two  Chapters,  the  Author  is  solely 
responsible.  In  the  preparation  of  these  portions  of  the 
work,  he  has  availed  himself  of  the  best  and  most  recent 


VI  PREFACE. 

sources  of  information  ;  and  has  endeavoured  to  adopt  the 
most  approved  systems  of  Classification.  As  scarcely  any 
two  Naturalists  agree,  however,  on  this  head,  the  choice 
has  been  frequently  a  matter  of  difficulty  ;  and  he  cannot 
suppose  that  he  has  been  always  equally  successful.  He  has 
adopted  as  his  chief  guides,  the  last  Edition  of  the  Synopsis 
of  the  British  Museum ;  and  the  Pictorial  Museum  of 
Natural  History,  at  present  in  course  of  publication  :  and 
to  the  latter  of  these  works  he  is  also  under  great  obliga- 
tion, for  numerous  details,  obtained  from  sources  to  which 
he  might  not  otherwise  have  gained  access. 

A  little  reflection  will  show,  that  any  general  Zoological 
Treatise  must  necessarily  be  in  great  part  a  Compilation 
from  the  works  of  other  Naturalists  ;  and  the  merit  of  an 
Elementary  work  like  the  present,  must  consist  rather  in 
the  judgment  shown  in  the  selection  and  arrangement  of 
the  materials,  than  in  the  originality  of  its  contents.  How 
far  the  Author  has  succeeded  in  his  present  attempt,  it  will 
be  for  his  readers  to  decide. 

LONDON,  June  30,  1844. 


CONTENTS. 


INTRODUCTION. 

PAOK 

OBJECTS     AND     NATURE     OF     ZOOLOGICAL     SCIENCE  ;     PLEASURES     AND 

ADVANTAGES    OF    THE    STUDY                .....  1 

CHAPTER  I. 

UN    ZOOLOGICAL    CLASSIFICATION             ......  25 

CHAPTER  II. 

GENERAL    CHARACTERS    OF    VERTEBRATED    ANIMALS    .  .  .  .83 

CHAPTER  III. 

OF    THE  CLASS    MAMMALIA 92 

SUB-CLASS  I. — VIVIPAROUS  MAMMALIA. 

ORDER          I. — BIMANA         .......  137 

ORDFR        II. — QUADRUMANA     .          .         .         .         .         .  153 

ORDER      III.— CHEIROPTERA 181 

ORDER      IV. — INSRCTIVORA      .......  194 

ORDER        V.— CARNIVORA 202 

ORDER       VI.— CETACEA              237 

ORDER     VII.— RODENTU 246 

ORDER  VIII.— EDENTATA 271 

ORDER      IX.— RUMINANTIA 283 

ORDER       X. — PACHYDERMATA  .                            ....  317 


Vlll  CONTENTS. 

SUB-CLASS  11. — OVO-VIVIPAROUS  MAMMALIA. 

PAGE 

ORDER      XI. — MARSUPULIA 342 

ORDFR    XII. — MONOTREMXTA            354 

RELATIONS    OF    THE    SEVERAL    ORDERS    OF    THE    CLASS    MAMMALIA  360 

CHAPTER  IV. 

OF    THE    CLASS    OF    BIRDS 361 

ORDER         I. — RAFTORES 396 

ORDER        II.— INSESSOKES 423 

TRIBE     I. — CONIROSTRES 427 

TRIBE    II. — DENTIROSTRES 440 

TRIBE  III.— FISSIROSTRES               .....  450 

TRIBE  IV.— TENUIROSTRES 459 

ORDFR     III. — SCANSORES 467 

ORDER     IV.— RASORES 473 

ORDER       V,— CURSORES 484 

ORDER     VI. — GRALLATORES 492 

ORDER  VII.— NATATORES 506 

CHAPTER  V. 

CLASS    OF    REPTILES .            .      .  523 

ORDER         I. — CHELONIA 548 

ORDER        II. — SAURIA 553 

ORDER      III. — OPHIDIA 569 

ORDER      IV — BATRACHIA 574 


INTRODUCTION. 


OBJECTS    AND    NATURE    OP    ZOOLOGICAL    SCIENCE;    PLEASURES 
AND    ADVANTAGES    OP    THE    STUDY. 

THE  objects  of  Natural  History  are  perhaps  in  general  less 
clearly  understood  than  those  of  most  other  sciences,  even 
among  those  who  pursue  it  as  their  professed  employment.  And 
it  is  partly  in  consequence  of  this  misconception,  that  its  advan- 
tages as  a  means  of  intellectual  and  moral  cultivation,  and  the 
pleasures  which  arise  from  the  pursuit  have  been,  in  the  opinion 
of  the  Author,  very  commonly  underrated.  It  is  usually  sup- 
posed to  be  a  Science  of  names  and  of  intricate  classification;  but 
it  will  be  shown,  in  the  course  of  this  Introduction,  that  these 
are  not  the  objects  of  the  Science,  but  merely  furnish  the  me- 
chanism (so  to  speak),  by  which  its  true  ends  are  to  be  attained. 

In  Natural  History,  as  in  all  departments  of  Philosophy,  the 
first  step  is  made  by  collecting  and  registering  facts, — just  as  the 
Astronomer  collects  his  facts,  from  observation  of  the  movements 
of  the  heavenly  bodies, — or  the  Chemist,  from  experiments  upon 
the  properties  of  the  different  substances  found  on  the  earth. 
In  these  last  sciences,  it  is  as  requisite,  as  in  Natural  History,  to 
give  names  to  the  objects  whose  movements  or  properties  are 
being  described ;  simply  in  order  that  various  Astronomers  or 
Chemists  may  be  enabled  to  compare  their  observations,  which 
they  could  not  readily  do,  if  there  were  no  name  or  title  to 
designate  them.  This  may  be  easily  understood,  from  such  a 
case  as  the  following.  Let  the  reader  suppose  himself  to  be  often 


2  INTRODUCTION. 

in  company,  in  public  meetings,  and  private  society,  with  a  gentle- 
man of  whose  name  he  was  ignorant,  but  who  might  take  so 
active  a  part  in  the  proceedings  c*  conversation,  as  strongly  to 
attract  his  attention.  He  would  himself  have  no  difficulty  in 
recognising  this  individual,  on  one  occasion  after  another ;  and 
he  might  form  an  opinion  of  his  character,  from  the  actions  he 
witnessed,  or  the  opinions  he  heard  expressed  by  him.  Now  a 
knowledge  of  his  name  would  add  nothing  to  his  information 
respecting  such  an  individual ;  unless  an  acquaintance  with  his 
name  led  to  some  further  knowledge — as  of  his  family,  or  of  his 
proceedings  elsewhere, — which  might  throw  additional  light  on 
his  character.  But  suppose  the  reader  to  wish  to  make  the  cha- 
racter of  this  individual  a  subject  of  discussion  with  a  friend,  who 
might  have  had  the  same  or  other  opportunities  of  observing  it ; 
he  could  not  do  so,  without  making  his  friend  know  to  what 
individual,  among  the  many  into  whose  society  they  might  have 
been  thrown  together,  he  was  referring.  Now  he  might  make 
this  known  to  him  by  describing  his  countenance,  person,  dress, 
manner,  voice,  &c. ;  but  to  do  this  with  sufficient  certainty  would 
often  require  some  time  and  trouble,  all  of  which  might  be  saved 
by  a  knowledge  of  the  name  by  which  he  is  at  once  distinguished. 
Now  the  real  use  of  names  in  Natural  History  may  be  easily 
understood,  from  the  similar  case  just  given.  Every  living  being, 
whether  plant  or  animal,  furnishes  the  Naturalist  with  a  group 
or  collection  of  facts,  to  be  examined  and  compared.  He  has 
first  to  observe  the  form  and  arrangement  of  the  external  parts 
of  each;  then  its  internal  structure,  which  ought  to  be  very 
minutely  investigated;  then  its  physiological  actions,  or  the 
changes  which  it  undergoes  in  the  progress  of  growth  and  de- 
cline ;  then  the  habits  connected  with  these ;  and  lastly,  the 
alterations  which  these  may  undergo,  from  a  difference  in  mode 
of  life,  or  from  diseased  actions.  Now  when  it  is  considered  that, 
in  order  to  make  even  the  foundations  of  the  science  complete,  all 
this  knowledge  ought  to  be  gained  respecting  each  of  the  many 


INTRODUCTION. 


hundred  thousand  species  of  Plants  and  Animals  existing  on  our 
globe,  it  is  evident  that  this  labour  must  be  greatly  subdivided, 
that  it  may  be  undertaken  with  any  chance  of  success.  Each 
Naturalist  chooses  a  department  most  conformable  to  his  own 
taste,  or  to  his  opportunities  for  pursuing  it ;  one  confining  him- 
self, for  example,  to  the  study  of  the  external  forms  of  some 
particular  group;  another  to  the  examination  of  its  internal 
structure ;  a  third  devotes  himself  to  physiological  inquiries ;  and 
a  fourth  to  the  observation  of  the  habits  and  instincts  of  the 
respective  beings,  in  a  state  of  nature.  Now  it  would  be  quite 
possible  to  pursue  any  of  these  inquiries  without  a  knowledge  of 
the  names,  which  had  been  imposed  upon  the  objects  that  fall 
under  our  observation ;  and  the  pleasure  derived  from  such  pur- 
suits is  but  little  impaired  by  this  ignorance.  What  does  it 
matter,  for  example,  to  the  Microscopic  observer,  whether  he  is 
or  is  not  acquainted  with  the  name  given  to  some  Animalcule, 
whose  movements  he  might  be  watching  with  the  greatest  inte- 
rest, by  some  former  observer,  who  very  probably  knew  much 
less  of  its  structure  and  actions  than  himself  ?  But  if  we  wish 
to  unite  or  compare  our  observations  with  those  of  others,  a 
knowledge  of  names  becomes  highly  desirable,  in  order  to  save 
the  time,  trouble,  and  uncertainty  which  will  otherwise  be  in- 
volved. The  Author  may  mention  a  recent  example  of  this 
kind,  from  his  own  experience.  He  recently  observed  a  very 
active  movement  of  the  reproductive  granules  (VEGET.  PHYSIOL. 
§  424)  in  a  species  of  Sea-weed,  in  which,  to  the  best  of  his 
belief,  it  had  not  been  previously  seen.  Now,  in  order  to  place 
this  observation  upon  record,  it  might  certainly  answer  to  give 
such  a  general  description  of  the  plant  as  would  probably  serve 
to  point  it  out  to  other  observers ;  but  such  a  description,  not 
drawn  up  by  a  Botanist  who  had  paid  especial  attention  to  the 
study  of  the  Algas,  would  be  very  probably  erroneous  or  defective, 
and  might  consequently  leave  it  uncertain  which  species  of  Sea- 
weed was  really  meant.  But  by  ascertaining  the  name  of  this 


4  INTRODUCTION. 

specimen  to  be  Ulva  Linza,  he  becomes  able  to  publish  his 
observation,  in  a  form  which  at  once  enables  any  other  observer 
to  seek  for  the  plant,  and  to  repeat  or  extend  his  inquiry. 

This  is,  however,  the  only  utility  of  names  in  Natural  History, 
or  in  any  other  science.  They  serve,  like  money,  as  the 
medium  of  exchange.  And  for  those  who  pursue  science  for 
their  amusement  only,  it  cannot  be  desirable  to  burden  the 
memory  with  a  large  number  of  names,  which  can  only  now  and 
then  be  useful,  and  which  can  easily  be  ascertained  when  wanted. 
— Juliet's  question — "What's  in  a  name?" — has  a  more  extensive 
applicability  than  she  probably  dreamt  of  at  the  moment  she 
littered  it ;  yet  her  own  reply  shows  her  to  have  had  a  clear 
notion  in  her  mind,  that,  in  other  objects,  as  well  as  in  her 
lover,  names  and  properties  have  no  essential  connexion  ; — 
*'  that  which  we  call  a  rose,  by  any  other  name  would  smell  as 
sweet." 

Let  us  now  examine,  in  a  somewhat  similar  manner,  the 
value  of  Classification,  in  the  scientific  pursuit  of  Natural 
History.  A  very  cursory  inspection  of  the  forms  and  structures 
of  the  different  tribes  of  living  beings,  which  are  constantly  pre- 
senting themselves  to  our  notice,  may  satisfy  the  observer,  that 
amongst  all  there  are  resemblances  and  differences; — between 
some,  the  similarity  being  a  prevailing  feature,  whilst  between 
others  the  differences  are  most  obvious.  Amidst  all  the  variety, 
he  perceives  on  closer  examination  such  a  prevailing  uniformity, 
that  he  is  led  to  believe  that  they  are  all  formed  on  some  general 
plan  or  system,  analogous  to  that  which  is  seen  to  prevail  in 
other  portions  of  the  Creator's  works.  And  just  as  the  Astro- 
nomer is  enabled  to  show,  that  the  great  principle  of  mutual 
attraction  between  all  the  masses  of  matter  in  the  Universe,  not 
only  governs  the  regular  movements  of  the  heavenly  bodies,  but 
is  constantly  producing  slight  modifications  or  perturbations  in 
their  course  (see  ASTRONOMY), — so  does  the  Naturalist  hope  that, 
in  the  living  Kingdoms  of  Nature,  some  principle  may  be  dis- 


INTRODUCTION.  5 

coverable,  which  not  only  governs  the  uniformity  that  exists  in 
the  structure  and  actions  of  all  the  creatures  belonging  to  them, 
but  produces  those  numerous  deviations  from  it,  which  are  at 
first  sight  so  perplexing. 

To  discover  this  plan,  therefore,  is  the  highest  object  of  the 
scientific  Naturalist ;  and  all  his  endeavours  should  be  directed 
towards  it.  There  is  no  fact  or  class  of  facts  relating  to  the 
structure,  actions,  or  habits  of  living  beings,  which  can  be 
useless  to  him.  That  which  seems,  when  regarded  alone,  to  be  of 
trivial  importance,  is  often  found,  when  united  with  others,  or 
placed  in  a  different  light,  to  possess  an  unexpected  value.  Every 
one,  therefore,  who  carefully  observes  any  occurrences  that  may 
fall  beneath  his  notice,  and  scrupulously  records,  not  his  infer- 
ences from  them,  but  the  facts  themselves,  may  be  regarded  as 
contributing  towards  the  advancement  of  the  science.  And 
when  we  consider  how  little  is  known,  compared  with  that 
which  remains  to  be  discovered,  it  is  obvious  that  there  are  few 
who  cannot  do  something.  The  man  of  active  and  observant 
mind,  whatever  be  his  regular  object  of  pursuit,  may  find  many 
opportunities  of  rendering  important  services  to  Science,  by 
simply  watching  that  which  passes  before  him,  and  committing  to 
writing  what  he  notices.  A  fund  of  interesting  and  valuable 
anecdotes  regarding  our  native  animals,  may  thus  be  collected 
by  an  attentive  observer,  who  is  nevertheless  ignorant  of  their 
scientific  names,  their  internal  structure,  or  their  place  in  a  clas- 
sification :  and  these  may  be  of  the  greatest  service  in  completing 
the  histories  which  have  been  already  ascertained,  in  regard  to 
their  structure  and  physiological  actions ;  and  in  explaining  the 
uses  of  parts,  which  were  previously  unknown. 

But  the  inability  to  go  abroad  and  observe  Nature  in  the  field, 
need  be  no  obstacle  to  those,  who  are  inclined  to  pursue  a  course 
of  investigation  into  her  phenomena;  for  such  persons  may 
advantageously  employ  themselves  in  inquiring  into  the  minute 
structure,  and  vital  actions,  of  even  our  commonest  Plants,  and 


6  INTRODUCTION. 

Animals;  which  are  very  far  from  having  been  completely 
studied ;  and  to  these  the  Microscope  will  be  found  a  never- 
ending  source  of  amusement  and  instruction.  The  most  curious 
facts  we  possess  in  regard  to  the  influence  of  light  on  the  deve- 
lopment of  the  Vegetable  structure,  were  ascertained  by  the 
observation  of  one  of  its  commonest  and  simplest  forms  (VEGET. 
PHYSIOL.  §.95)  ;  and  the  progress  of  discovery  is  almost  daily 
revealing  to  us  something  new  in  the  structure  of  animals  with 
which  we  imagine  ourselves  to  be  well  acquainted.  A  very 
limited  knowledge  of  names  and  classification  is  required  for  the 
successful  pursuit  of  such  inquiries ;  although  there  is  doubtless 
a  great  advantage  in  a  previous  acquaintance  with  the  general 
principles  of  Natural  History,  both  in  preserving  the  inquirer 
from  erroneous  conclusions,  in  directing  him  to  new  subjects  for 
observation,  and  in  heightening  the  pleasure  which  he  derives 
from  his  pursuit.  But  such  a  view  need  not  involve  details 
which  are  burdensome  to  the  memory ;  nor  diminish  the  feeling 
of  freshness,  which  we  derive  so  much  more  strongly  from 
surveying  the  wonders  of  Nature  for  ourselves,  than  from 
becoming  acquainted  with  them  through  the  writings  of  others. 

Thus,  although  no  one  can  go  far  in  the  scientific  pursuit  of 
Natural  History,  without  some  knowledge  of  names  and  of  clas- 
sification, yet  this  is  but  little  required  by  those  who  pursue 
certain  departments  of  it  for  their  own  pleasure  and  improvement. 
For  it  cannot  be  too  constantly  borne  in  mind,  that  in  its  present 
state  (which  is  much  less  perfect  and  complete  than  that  of  almost 
any  other  science),  there  is  ample  room  for  the  labours  of  all  who 
devote  themselves  to  it  as  their  regular  object  of  pursuit,  and  with 
the  intention  of  raising  it  in  the  scale  of  the  scienGes, — much  more, 
therefore,  for  the  less  constant  inquiries  of  those,  who  seek  but 
for  refreshment  and  novelty  by  occasionally  turning  to  the  study 
of  Nature,  from  the  harassing  cares  of  business,  or  the  wearying 
monotony  of  a  handicraft  occupation,  and  who  are  content 
with  the  humbler  but  not  less  honourable  task  of  collecting  and 


INTRODUCTION.  7 

supplying  the  materials  with  which  the  skilful  builder  may  erect 
his  edifice.  There  cannot  be  a  more  beautiful  example  of  that 
adaptation  which  exists  between  the  faculties  of  the  human  mind 
and  the  objects  of  human  knowledge,  than  the  variety  of  modes  in 
which  the  study  of  Natural  History  may  be  pursued,  and  the  cor- 
responding variety  of  tastes  which  we  meet  with  in  those  who  devote 
themselves  to  it.  For  whilst  some  busy  themselves  in  simply 
collecting  the  birds,  the  insects,  the  zoophytes,  or  the  plants 
which  they  meet  with  in  their  neighbourhood,  and  delight  in 
ascertaining  those  characters  by  which  their  place  in  a  classifi- 
cation may  be  determined ;  others  avail  themselves  of  the  mate- 
rials thus  brought  together,  and  (perhaps  without  ever  themselves 
going  abroad  into  the  fields,  or  even  confined,  it  may  be,  to  a 
narrow  apartment  in  the  middle  of  a  crowded  city),  delight  in 
examining  their  internal  structure,  toilsomely  unravelling  the 
details  of  their  organisation,  and  scrutinising,  with  the  aid  of  the 
Microscope,  their  minutest  parts  ; — others,  again,  prefer  to  leave 
the  birds,  the  insects,  the  zoophytes,  or  the  plants,  unmolested 
in  their  native  haunts,  but  devote  themselves  to  the  observation 
of  their  habits,  the  examination  of  their  economy,  the  recording 
of  their  actions  ; — whilst  the  scientific  Naturalist,  whose  talent 
lies  rather  in  generalising  than  in  observing,  and  who  is  versed  in 
the  principles  which  have  been  already  ascertained  in  regard  to 
the  structure,  physiology,  habits,  and  classification  of  the  objects 
of  his  study,  seeks  to  combine  the  observations  of  others,  in  such 
a  manner,  as  to  correct  what  has  been  erroneous  in  his  previous 
system,  to  extend  it  to  new  and  previously  unknown  forms  of 
animated  being,  and  to  develope  those  beautiful  analogies  and 
connections,  which  show  the  whole  to  be  parts  of  one  vast  plan, 
the  work  of  one  Almighty  and  Omniscient  Creator. 

As  the  labours  of  all  these  are  necessary  to  the  building-up  of 
the  Science  of  Natural  History,  it  is  well  that  such  diversity  of 
tastes  and  of  mental  faculties  should  exist ;  since  all  the  subjects 
receive  their  due  share  of  attention,  which  could  not  be  if  there 


8  INTRODUCTION. 

were  a  greater  uniformity  in  the  constitution  of  the  human  mind. 
And,  for  the  same  reason,  neither  of  the  labourers  should  despise 
or  undervalue  the  labours  of  the  re^t ;  since  each  department  has 
its  peculiar  value,  and  the  pursuit  of  it  cannot  be  rendered  use- 
less by  any  advance  in  the  rest.  Thus,  the  mere  collection  of 
specimens,  and  the  arrangement  of  them  according  to  their  external 
characters,  is,  in  fact,  laying  the  foundation  for  the  operations  of 
the  scientific  Naturalist.  Even  in  districts  which  have  been 
most  completely  explored,  it  will  be  rare  for  the  diligent  collector 
to  find  himself  unrewarded  by  the  discovery  of  some  species  new 
to  that  locality,  if  not  previously  altogether  unknown.  But  in 
those  which  have  been  as  yet  comparatively  little  examined,  it 
cannot  be  doubted  that  a  rich  harvest  of  discovery  awaits  every 
one  who  will  devote  himself  to  the  search  for  it.  We  need  not 
leave  our  own  island  for  this  purpose.  To  the  number  of  the 
larger  animals  which  tenant  the  land  we  cannot  expect  any  con- 
siderable addition ;  but  not  a  year  passes  without  many  new 
species  of  insects  being  discovered  ;  and  there  are  several  parts  of 
our  coasts  that  are  rich  in  marine  tribes,  of  which  very  little  is 
yet  known,  and  which,  consequently,  hold  out  the  most  tempting 
prospect  to  the  collector.  In  all  such  researches,  the  locality, 
and  the  other  circumstances  in  which  the  specimen  is  found 
should  be  carefully  noted ;  for  the  collection  then  has  a  double 
value,  —  not  only  on  its  own  account,  but  as  affording  information 
on  a  most  interesting  and  important  department  of  zoology — the 
geographical  distribution  of  animals. 

As  to  the  importance  of  the  study  of  the  Anatomy  and  of  the 
Habits  of  the  animals  brought  together  by  the  collector,  it 
would  seem  unnecessary, to  say  anything  here.  It  will  be  shown 
in  the  course  of  the  present  Treatise,  that  the  classification  of 
Animals  must  be  founded  upon  their  general  structure,  not  upon 
a  few  external  characters ;  and  that  the  value  of  these  last  in 
Zoology  is,  chiefly  that  they  serve  as  a  ready  key  or  index  to  the 
internal  organisation,  when  the  connexion  between  them  lias  been 


INTRODUCTION.  9 

once  established  (§  55).  Hence,  the  Comparative  Anatomist 
may  be  said  to  prepare  the  cement  by  which  the  materials  fur- 
nished by  the  Collector  are  to  be  united  together.  But  the 
arrangement  and  combination  of  the  whole  is  the  work  of  the 
Philosophic  Zoologist ;  whose  department  requires  the  exercise 
of  all  the  highest  faculties  of  the  mind,  and  whose  work  cannot 
be  perfect,  unless  he  has  obtained  and  mastered  all  the  inform- 
ation which  has  been  accumulated  by  the  labours  of  his  associates. 
Now  it  is  possible  to  pursue  each  of  these  departments  to  a 
certain  degree  independently  of  the  rest ;  and  many  have  done 
so  with  considerable  success.  But,  on  the  other  hand,  the 
success  will  be  probably  greater,  in  proportion  to  the  amount  of 
the  general  knowledge  of  the  whole  subject,  which  is  already 
possessed  ;  and  the  interest  of  the  pursuit,  whichever  department 
of  it  may  be  undertaken,  is  also  greatly  enhanced. 

We  have  dwelt  upon  the  opportunity  which  the  study  of 
Natural  History  offers  to  almost  every  one  for  the  promotion  of 
its  purposes  as  a  Science,  because  it  differs  from  most  other 
branches  of  knowledge  in  these  respects, — that  the  objects  it 
embraces  are  almost  illimitable  in  their  extent, — that  our  inform- 
ation respecting  almost  every  one  of  them  is  still  very  scanty, — 
and  that  there  is,  consequently,  the  most  abundant  opportunity 
for  every  one  to  benefit  mankind,  by  assisting  in  the  collection  of 
materials  for  the  extension  of  the  Science,  whilst  obtaining 
recreation  and  healthful  employment  for  his  own  mind.  And  if 
we  consider  the  ultimate  objects  of  Science,  it  must  be  acknow- 
ledged that  no  more  worthy  motive  for  such  pursuits  can  be  set 
before  the  mind,  than  that  which  is  directly  connected  with  it. 
For  its  purpose  is  the  discovery  of  those  simple  laws  which  are 
the  highest  truths  to  which  Reason  (unaided  by  Revelation)  can 
conduct  us,  in  regard  to  the  character  and  dealings  of  the  Creator. 
Hence,  in  the  pursuit  of  Science,  if  conducted  in  a  right  spirit, 
we  are  guided  by  that  simple  love  of  Truth,  which  is,  as 
Sir  H.  Davy  has  beautifully  observed,  "  in  its  ultimate  and  most 


10  INTRODUCTION. 

perfect  development,  the  love  of  Infinite  Wisdom  and  unbounded 
Power,  or  the  love  of  God."  But  it  is  not  every  mind  which  is 
conscious  of  this  high  and  noble  aspiration.  In  many  it  exists 
without  the  knowledge  of  its  possessors,  and  needs  to  be 
awakened  from  its  dormant  condition.  In  some  it  seems  almost 
or  altogether  deficient.  It  cannot  be  amiss,  then,  to  hold  out 
some  of  the  more  direct  advantages  which  attend  the  cultivation 
of  Natural  History.  These  are  twofold  : — the  first  bearing  upon 
Man's  corporeal  wants ;  the  second  upon  his  mental  and  moral 
state.  A  single  illustration,  having  reference  to  each  of  these 
points,  must  here  suffice. 

There  are  many  species  of  Insects,  whose  voracity  (especially 
in  the  larva  state)  is  so  great  that,  when  they  are  present  in 
large  numbers,  they  become  a  source  of  the  most  terrible  devas- 
tation. "We  have  examples  of  this  kind,  on  a  small  scale,  in  our 
own  country.  Thus  the  caterpillars  of  the  Beetle  kind,  and  especi- 
ally of  the  Cockchafer,  would  speedily  destroy  the  roots  of  all  our 
corn  and  grasses,  were  they  not  themselves  eagerly  sought  after  as 
food  by  the  Rook  and  other  birds.  It  is  true  that,  when  the 
supply  of  these  is  exhausted,  the  Rook  will  support  itself  upon 
new-sown  wheat.  But  the  injury  which  it  thus  does  to  the 
farmer  is  as  nothing  compared  with  that  from  which  it  saves 
him ;  and  if  this  tribe  of  birds  were  to  be  extirpated,  a  famine 
would  speedily  follow.  In  many  parts  of  this  country,  however, 
popular  ignorance  has  prevailed  so  far  as  to  cause  the  destruction 
of  rookeries,  under  the  idea  that  the  birds  devour  a  large  quan- 
tity of  grain ;  but  so  speedy  has  been  the  multiplication  of  the 
real  enemies  of  the  agriculturist,  when  no  longer  kept  within 
limits,  that  the  restoration  of  the  birds  has  been,  in  every 
instance,  petitioned  for  within  a  few  years.  The  larvae  of  the 
Turnip  Fly  committed  the  most  serious  ravages  in  some  of  the 
eastern  counties  of  England,  a  few  years  since ;  and  no  method 
was  found  so  effectual  as  the  turning  a  large  number  of  Ducks 
into  the  turnip-fields  ;  for  these  birds,  being  the  natural  enemies 


INTRODUCTION.  1 1 

of  the  grubs,  stripped  the  plants  of  them  much  more  rapidly  than 
human  hands  could  have  done,  and  were,  besides,  themselves 
rendered  very  fat  and  fit  for  the  table. — But  the  destruction  of 
vegetation  which  occasionally  results  from  such  causes  in  this 
country,  is  as  nothing  to  that  which  frequently  takes  place  in 
warmer  climates.  No  insect  is  so  largely  concerned  in  this  as 
the  Locust,  of  which  immense  swarms  occasionally  make  their 
appearance,  traversing  a  great  extent  of  country,  and  clearing  it 
so  completely  of  its  vegetation,  as  to  leave  scarcely  a  trace  behind, 
save  the  leafless  skeletons  of  the  trees  and  shrubs,  whose  softer 
parts  they  have  destroyed.  Numerous  attempts  have  been  made 
to  keep  down  the  multiplication  of  these  insects  by  rewards 
offered  for  the  destruction  of  their  eggs  and  larvas  ;  but  none  of 
these  have  been  effectual.  The  sagacious  Naturalist,  however, 
who  duly  considers  the  relations  between  different  tribes  of 
organised  beings,  who  bears  in  mind  that  there  is  not  one  species 
of  plant  or  animal  which  is  not  the  destined  food  of  another,  and 
who  calls  to  his  aid  the  power  which  the  Creator  has  given  to 
Man  over  the  animated  world — not  for  its  destruction,  but  for  its 
protection  and  regulation — will  not  have  much  difficulty  in 
devising  a  means  far  better  adapted  than  those  just  mentioned, 
for  the  object  in  view.  He  will  ascertain  what  species  is  most 
opposed  to  the  one  he  is  desirous  of  eradicating  ;  and,  by 
encouraging  its  multiplication,  he  will  put  a  far  more  complete 
check  upon  the  ravages  of  his  enemy,  than  by  any  scheme  that 
may  appear  more  direct  in  its  operation.  There  is  a  T>ird  in 
India,  termed  the  Grakle,  which  performs  the  same  office  in 
regard  to  the  eggs  and  larvae  of  the  Locusts,  that  the  Rook 
and  similar  birds  fulfil  in  colder  countries.  Nevertheless,  the 
inhabitants,  being  ignorant  of  the  benefits  they  derive  from 
it.  have  sometimes  sought  to  exterminate  it ;  and  when  they 
have  done  this,  the  same  consequences  result  as  when  a  Rookery 
has  been  destroyed  in  this  country  ; — viz.,  a  great  multiplication 
of  the  destructive  insects  formerly  kept  in  check.  The  following 
history  affords  a  curious  example  of  this  occurrence  : 


1 2  INTRODUCTION. 

We  are  informed  by  Buffon  that  there  was  once  a  danger  of 
the  island  of  Bourbon  being  entirely  devastated  by  locusts ;  the 
eggs  of  which  were  introduced  witn  some  plants  from  Madagas- 
car. They  were  rapidly  multiplying,  and  the  produce  of  the 
fields  was  in  progress  of  being  destroyed.  But  the  Governor, 
who  was  a  man  of  superior  intelligence,  learning  the  great 
services  which  the  Grakle  performed  in  India,  had  a  number  of 
pairs  introduced  and  distributed  over  the  islands.  They  bred 
very  fast,  were  diligent  in  their  labours  ;  and  in  a  few  years  the 
locusts  seemed  extirpated.  When  this  took  place,  the  Grakles 
began  to  dig  and  examine  the  newly-sown  fields ;  and  the 
colonists,  concluding  that  they  did  so  for  the  purpose  of  eating 
the  seeds,  (when  they  were  in  reality  only  searching  for  the  eggs 
of  the  locusts),  took  the  alarm,  got  them  proscribed  by  govern- 
ment, and  speedily  exterminated  them.  In  a  few  years,  how- 
ever, they  perceived  their  error ;  for  the  ravages  of  the  locusts 
recommenced.  Upon  this  the  governor  procured  a  second  supply 
of  birds  from  India ;  and  the  state  took  charge  of  their  preser- 
vation. Special  laws  were  framed  for  their  protection ;  and, 
lest  the  people  should  have  a  hankering  for  grakle  pie,  the 
physicians  were  instructed  to  proclaim  their  flesh  very  unwhole- 
some food.  But  this  extraordinary  care  was  injurious.  The 
birds  soon  again  cleared  the  island  of  the  locusts,  and  destroyed 
the  grubs  which  injure  the  coffee  plantations.  But  when  this 
supply  failed  them,  they  proceeded  to  attack  the  corn-fields  and 
orchards  ;  and  even  killed  the  young  of  pigeons,  and  other  domes- 
tic birds.  In  order  to  restore  the  balance,  a  sort  of  Malthusian 
law  was  enacted,  to  prevent  their  numbers  from  exceeding 
the  quantity  of  their  legitimate  food ;  and,  when  thus  kept  in 
check,  they  continued  to  do  good  without  any  admixture  of  evil. 

Many  similar  examples  might  be  adduced,  to  illustrate  the 
advantages,  which  a  very  moderate  acquaintance  with  Natural 
History  confers  upon  its  possessor,  and  the  injurious  results 
which  proceed  from  ignorance  of  its  simplest  principles.  But  it 
is  a  very  partial  view  of  the  objects  of  Science,  which  looks  for 


INTRODUCTION.  lo 

its  benefits  in  the  improvement  of  the  corporeal,  temporal,  and 
earthly  condition  of  Man, — which  regards  as  its  direct  advantages 
the  contributions  it  makes  towards  his  comfort,  his  luxury,  his 
refinement, — and  which  considers  as  a  mere  collateral  result,  or  as 
an  accident  by  the  way,  its  influence  on  his  spiritual,  immortal, 
celestial  being.  Surely  it  is  here  that  we  are  to  look  for  its  most 
permanent,  most  direct,  most  important  advantages.  The  works 
of  the  Creator,  when  they  afford  neither  sustenance  nor  physic 
for  the  body,  yield  both  food  and  medicine  for  the  mind.  It  is 
surely  a  more  worthy  occupation,  to  study  the  works  of  Infinite 
Wisdom  and  boundless  Power,  than  to  bestow  the  labour  of  a 
life  upon  the  critical  examination  of  a  Greek  Drama  or  a  Latin 
Satire.  And  it  is  surely  a  more  likely  means  of  advantageously 
developing  the  intellectual  and  moral  faculties  of  the  young,  to 
exercise  them  upon  the  objects  which  are  everywhere  around 
them,  and  a  knowledge  of  which  will  be  useful  to  them  in  almost 
every  possible  scene  of  their  future  lives,  than  to  confine  them  to 
subjects  which  leave  many  of  their  powers  unemployed,  and 
numerous  sources  of  the  purest  pleasure  undeveloped.  "Strange 
indeed,"  it  has  been  well  remarked,  "  must  be  the  perversion  of 
that  mind,  which  is  made  neither  wiser  nor  better,  by  studying 
the  works  of  Him,  whose  own  wisdom  is  infinite,  and  all  whose 
operations  tend  to  good  and  happiness." 

The  observing  powers  are  especially  cultivated  by  the  study  of 
Natural  History.  The  organs  of  the  senses  are  the  portals, 
through  which  all  our  knowledge  of  the  world  around  us  makes 
its  entry  into  our  minds.  In  the  infant  and  the  young  child, 
they  are  set  wide  open ;  and  we  see  how  rapid  is  the  develop- 
ment of  the  faculties  by  the  information  they  communicate.  Yet, 
in  ordinary  systems  of  education,  this  process  is  almost  entirely 
checked,  during  the  period  when  it  might  be  continued  with  the 
greatest  advantage  ;  and  the  learning  of  the  schools  is  substituted 
for  the  teachings  of  the  great  Book  of  Nature.  It  is  not  enough 
that  the  senses  should  be  used ; — they  must  be  used  aright. 


14  INTRODUCTION. 

To  observe  well  is  not  so  easy  a  thing  as  some  persons  imagine. 
Some  are  too  hasty,  imagining  that  they  can  take  in  everything 
at  a  glance,  and  often  forming  very  erroneous  or  imperfect 
notions.  Others  are  too  slow,  fixing  their  attention  too  exclu- 
sively on  the  details,  so  as  to  lose  sight  of  the  general  plan. 
Both  these  faults  should  be  carefully  avoided  ;  and  the  habit  of 
guarding  against  them,  once  acquired,  will  be  of  invaluable 
service  in  future  life.  There  is  also  a  danger  in  allowing  our 
observations  to  be  influenced  by  previously  formed  ideas;  so 
that  we  often  think  we  see  what  exists  only  in  our  own  imagina- 
tions. This  habit  cannot  be  too  early  checked ;  and  there  is 
probably  no  better  mode  of  preventing  its  formation,  than  the 
accustoming  the  young  to  exercise  their  organs  of  sense  upon  the 
numberless  objects  which  the  study  of  Nature  brings  under  their 
notice,  and  to  give  careful  and  accurate  descriptions  of  what  they 
observe.  It  has  been  sometimes  said  that  there  are  more  false 
facts,  than  false  theories,  in  science ;  and  if  this  is  true  of  any 
department,  it  is  of  Natural  History.  It  is  wonderful  how  the 
most  acute  and  profound  reasoners  have  erred,  when  they  have 
trusted  too  much  to  their  own  observations,  and  too  little  to  the 
statements  of  others,  who  may  have  been  much  more  competent 
than  themselves  as  observers,  though  far  inferior  as  reasoners. 
This  was  not  unfrequently  the  case  with  the  great  Bacon  ;  who, 
so  far  from  contributing  anything  to  our  knowledge  of  facts  in 
Natural  History,  often  gave  additional  force  to  errors  by  the 
weight  of  his  authority.  Many  examples  of  this  will  be  found 
in  his  treatise  entitled  "Sylva  Sylvarum;"  the  following  will 
here  suffice. 

The  Misseltoe  is  included  by  Bacon  among  the  excrescences, 
which  sometimes  grow  from  trees  as  a  consequence  of  disease. 
"  They  have  an  idle  tradition,"  he  says,  "  that  there  is  a  bird 
called  a  missel-bird,  that  feedeth  upon  a  seed,  which  many  times 
she  cannot  digest,  and  so  expelleth  it  whole ;  which,  falling  upon 
the  bough  of  a  tree  that  hath  some  rift,  putteth  forth  the  Missel- 


INTRODUCTION.  1 5 

toe.  But  this  is  a  fable  ;  for  it  is  not  probable  that  birds  should 
feed  upon  what  they  cannot  digest.  But  allow  that,  yet  it  can- 
not be,  for  other  reasons  ;  for,  first,  it  is  found  but  upon  certain 
trees,  and  those  trees  bear  no  such  fruit  as  may  allure  that  bird 
to  sit  and  feed  upon  them.  It  may  be,  that  bird  feedeth  upon 
the  misseltoe  berries,  and  so  is  often  found  there ;  which  may 
have  given  occasion  to  the  tale.  But  that  which  maketh  an  end 
of  the  question  is,  that  misseltoe  hath  been  found  to  put  forth 
under  the  boughs,  and  not  only  above  the  boughs ;  so  it  cannot 
be  anything  that  falleth  upon  the  bough."  He  then  goes  on  to 
argue  that  this  plant,  which  he  considers  as  a  superior  kind  of 
fungus,  is  produced  by  "  abundance  of  sap  in  the  bough  that 
putteth  it  forth,"  which,  he  says,  may  be  certainly  set  down  ;  as 
also  that  "this  sap  must  be  such  as  the  tree  doth  excern  and 
cannot  assimilate,  for  else  it  would  go  into  a  bough ;  and,  besides, 
it  seemeth  more  fat  and  unctuous  than  the  ordinary  sap  of  the 
tree ;  both  by  the  berry,  which  is  clammy  ;  and  by  that  it  con- 
tinueth  green  winter  and  summer,  which  the  tree  doth  not."  The 
vegetable  Physiologist,  however,  is  now  well  assured,  that  the 
Misseltoe  is  a  distinct  and  independent  plant,  springing,  like 
others,  from  seed,  and  drawing  its  nourishment  from  the  juices  of 
the  tree  on  which  it  has  germinated  (VEGET.  PHYSIOL.  §  319) ; 
and  a  little  careful  observation  of  the  habits  of  the  Missel-Thrush 
and  other  birds  would  have  shown  to  the  great  philosopher, 
that  they  really  perform  the  office  which  is  commonly  attributed 
to  them — that  of  diffusing  the  plant,  by  dropping  its  seeds  in 
situations  where  they  may  fall  into  the  chinks  and  hollows  of 
trees, — but  which  he  denied  on  very  insufficient  grounds. 

There  are  two  other  tendencies  which  exist,  more  or  less,  in 
almost  every  mind  ;  and  which  must  be  especially  guarded 
against  by  those  who  desire  to  render  that  study  of  Nature 
alike  beneficial  to  their  own  minds,  whilst  promoting  the  im- 
provement of  science.  These  are,  the  love  of  the  marvellous  ; 
and  the  inclination  to  rest  satisfied  with  superficial  resemblances. 


16  INTRODUCTION. 

An  amusing  illustration  of  the  effects  of  these  may  be  drawn 
from  a  large  volume,  entitled  "  Gerarde's  Herbal,"  first  pub- 
lished near  the  end  of  the  16th  century,  but  looked  up  to  by 
many  of  a  generation,  not  long  since  passed,  as  their  chief 
botanical  authority.  "  Having  travelled,"  he  says  at  the  con- 
clusion of  his  volume,  "  from  the  grasses  growing  in  the  bottom 
of  the  fenny  waters,  the  woods,  and  mountains,  even  unto 
Lebanus  itself — and  also  the  sea  and  bowels  of  the  same — we 
are  arrived  at  the  end  of  our  history  ;  thinking  it  not  impertinent 
to  the  conclusion  of  the  same  to  end  with  one  of  the  marvels  of 
this  land,  we  may  say  of  the  world — the  history  whereof,  to  set 
forth  according  to  the  worthiness  and  variety  thereof,  would  not 
only  require  a  large  and  peculiar  volume,  but  also  a  deeper 
search  into  the  bowels  of  Nature  than  my  intended  purpose  will 
suffer  me  to  wade  into,  my  sufficiency  also  considered.  There 
are  found  in  the  north  parts  of  Scotland,  and  the  islands 
adjacent,  called  Orchades,  certain  trees  whereon  do  grow  certain 
shells  of  a  white  colour,  tending  to  russet,  wherein  are  contained 
little  living  creatures;  which  shells,  in  time  of  maturity,  do 
open,  and  out  of  them  grow  those  little  living  things,  which, 
falling  into  the  water,  do  become  fowls,  which  we  call  Barnacles, 
in  the  north  of  England  Brant-geese,  and  in  Lancashire  Tree- 
geese  ;  and  the  other  that  do  fall  upon  the  land,  perish  and  come 
to  nothing.  Thus  much  by  the  writings  of  others,  and  also 
from  the  mouths  of  people  of  those  parts,  which  may  very  well 
accord  with  truth." 

" But  what  our  eyes  have  seen  and  our  hands  have  touched" 
continues  the  Author,  doubtless  with  full  sincerity,  "  we  shall 
declare.  There  is  a  small  island  in  Lancashire  called  the  Pile  of 
Foulders,  wherein  are  found  the  broken  pieces  of  old  and  bruised 
ships,  some  whereof  have  been  cast  thither  by  shipwreck,  and 
also  the  trunks  and  bodies,  with  the  branches  of  old  and  rotten 
trees,  cast  up  there  likewise,  whereon  is  found  a  certain  spume 
or  froth,  that  in  time  breedeth  unto  certain  shells,  in  shape  like 


INTRODUCTION.  17 

those  of  a  mussel,  but  sharper  pointed,  and  of  a  whitish  colour ; 
wherein  is  contained  a  thing  in  form  like  a  lace  of  silk  finely 
woven  as  it  were  together,  of  a  whitish  colour,  one  end  whereof 
is  fastened  unto  the  inside  of  the  shell,  even  as  the  fish  of  oysters 
and  mussels  are  ;  the  other  end  is  made  fast  unto  the  belly  of  a 
rude  mass  or  lump,  which  in  time  cometh  to  the  shape  and  form 
of  a  bird  ;  when  it  is  perfectly  formed,  the  shell  gapeth  open, 
and  the  first  thing  that  appeareth  is  the  foresaid  lace  or  string  ; 
next  come  the  legs  of  the  bird  hanging  out,  and  as  it  groweth 
greater,  it  openeth  the  shell  by  degrees,  till  at  length  it  is  all 
come  forth,  and  hangeth  only  by  the  bill.  In  short  space  it 
cometh  to  full  maturity,  and  falleth  into  the  sea,  where  it 
gathereth  feathers,  and  groweth  to  a  fowl,  bigger  than  a  Mallard, 
and  lesser  than  a  Goose,  having  black  legs  and  a  bill  or  beak,  and 
feathers  black  and  white,  spotted  in  such  manner  as  our  Magpie, 
called  in  some  places  a  Pie  Annet,  which  the  people  of  Lancashire 
call  by  no  other  name  than  a  Tree  Goose  ;  which  place  aforesaid, 
and  all  those  parts  adjacent,  do  so  much  abound  therewith,  that 
one  of  the  best  may  be  bought  for  threepence.  For  the  truth 
hereof,  if  any  doubt,  may  it  please  them  to  repair  unto  me,  and  I 
shall  satisfy  them  by  the  testimony  of  credible  witnesses." 

It  is  scarcely  conceivable  how  any  one  could  have  been  so  led 
away  by  the  love  of  the  marvellous,  as  to  rest  upon  the  most 
superficial  resemblance,  in  proof  of  the  extraordinary  supposition, 
that  from  a  Barnacle  is  produced  a  Bird  ;  especially  when  the 
Author  tells  us  that  so  far  he  is  satisfied  by  his  own  observation, 
of  "  what  his  eyes  have  seen  and  his  hands  have  touched."  The 
other  part  of  his  story,  setting  forth  that  these  Barnacles  grow 
upon  trees,  which  he  learned  "  from  the  writings  of  others,  and 
also  from  the  mouths  of  people  of  those  parts,"  is  by  no  means 
so  discordant  with  truth,  as  they  certainly  do  grow  on  trees, 
though  not  produced  by  them.  Those  who  have  seen  the 
Mangrove  trees  ( BOTANY,  §  598)  surrounding  the  lagoons  in  the 
islands  of  the  tropical  ocean,  their  pendent  branches  loaded  with 


18  INTRODUCTION. 

shell-fish  of  various  kinds,  may  easily  excuse  a  popular  error  of 
this  nature ;  but  for  the  Scientific  Naturalist  of  the  present  day 
to  give  credence  to  it,  would  be  unpardonable. 

The  study  of  Natural  History,  then,  has  an  obvious  tendency, 
not  only  to  encourage  the  habit  of  correct  and  unprejudiced 
observation  in  its  votaries,  but  to  call  into  exercise  the  discri- 
minating powers,  which  shall  teach  them  to  attach  their  due 
value  to  the  statements  of  others.  Upon  the  advantage  of  such 
a  kind  of  mental  cultivation,  it  is  unnecessary  here  to  dwell.  It 
is  useful  in  every  situation,  in  every  relation  of  life.  It  enables 
us  to  suspend  our  judgment,  when  we  are  not  satisfied  of  the 
stability  of  the  grounds  upon  which  we  are  to  decide ;  and  leads 
us  to  draw  the  line  between  suspicious  incredulity  on  the  one 
hand,  and  too  ready  assent  to  improbable  and  unconfirmed  state- 
ments on  the  other.  In  the  cultivation  of  this  habit,  the  study 
of  Natural  History  has  an  obvious  advantage  over  that  of  the 
more  exact  Sciences.  We  have  not  yet  the  same  guidance 
afforded  by  general  laws,  as  that  which  they  possess,  and  which 
enables  the  physical  philosopher  to  decide  at  once  on  the  truth 
of  statements  submitted  to  him.  Tell  a  man  acquainted  with 
the  simple  laws  of  Matter,  that  a  perpetual  motion  had  been 
invented,  depending  upon  strictly  mechanical  principles;  and  he 
will  not  believe  it,  because  he  knows  it  to  be  a  physical  impos- 
sibility. In  Natural  History  we  are  to  a  certain  extent  equally 
safe  in  forming  a  positive  decision.  The  differences  between  the 
skeleton  of  Man,  and  that  of  an  Elephant  or  Lizard,  are  now 
sufficiently  well  known,  to  prevent  our  giving  credence  to  the 
marvellous  accounts  of  such  prodigies,  as  a  Man  25  feet  long  ; 
these  cease  to  astonish  us  (except  as  regards  the  ignorance  that 
propagated  them),  now  that  we  are  acquainted  with  their  true 
explanation.  Nor  are  we  in  danger  of  allowing  ourselves  to  be 
led  away  by  an  English  writer  of  much  learning,  who,  so  late  as 
the  middle  of  the  17th  century,  attributed  the  origin  of  fossil 
shells  and  fishes  to  "  a  plastic  virtue  latent  in  the  earth."  But 


INTRODUCTION.  19 

when  we  place  side  by  side  the  apparently  contradictory  state- 
ments of  credible  observers  at  the  present  time  (take,  for  instance, 
those  of  Audubon  and  Waterton  on  the  powers  of  scent  pos- 
sessed by  the  Vulture),  we  are  compelled  to  suspend  our  judg- 
ment, until  we  have  examined  into  the  possible  fallacies  of  each, 
and  sought  for  more  unexceptionable  testimony  from  other 
sources.  Now  it  is  the  very  necessity  of  this  process,  which  is 
seldom  needed  in  other  sciences,  that  renders  the  study  of  Natural 
History  peculiarly  advantageous  as  a  means  of  intellectual 
culture  and  discipline.  "  If  a  man,"  says  Bacon,  "  begin  with 
certainties,  he  shall  end  in  doubts  ;  but  if  he  be  content  to  begin 
with  doubts,  he  shall  end  in  certainties." 

But  Natural  History  employs  higher  faculties  of  the  mind, 
than  those  simply  connected  with  the  observation  of  facts.  There 
is  no  Science  which,  with  so  extensive  a  basis  of  observed  phe- 
nomena, has  its  materials  so  little  connected  by  general  laws. 
The  slow  progress  of  this  is  partly  due  to  the  prevalent  miscon- 
ception of  their  nature,  and  of  the  mode  in  which  they  are  to 
be  attained.  It  has  been  already  pointed  out,  that  Classi- 
fication, which  is  so  often  considered  as  the  highest  object  of 
Natural  History,  is  but  a  means  towards  the  pursuit  of  more 
elevated  inquiries, — a  means  which  is  employed  in  all  Sciences, 
but  which  takes  a  more  prominent  station  in  Natural  History, 
in  consequence  of  the  difficulties  attending  it,  and  the  diversity 
of  the  objects  which  come  within  its  scope.  But  even  though 
not  the  highest  object  of  Natural  History,  it  exercises  mental 
faculties  of  a  superior  order.  The  mere  collection  of  specimens, 
and  the  arrangement  of  them  under  their  respective  divisions,  is 
a  useful  exercise  to  the  growing  mind ;  teaching,  as  it  does,  the 
habits  of  patient  discrimination  and  careful  comparison.  But 
this  may  be  carried  too  far.  It  is  not  uncommon  to  meet  with 
persons,  in  whom  the  amor  habendi  (love  of  possessing),  engrosses 
every  other  feeling,  to  which  the  pursuit  of  science  ought  to  give 
rise.  These  are,  indeed,  mere  collectors ;  estimating  their 

c  2 


20  INTRODUCTION. 

acquirements  more  by  the  number  of  species  they  possess,  than 
by  their  knowledge  of  those  general  principles,  which  constitute 
the  Science  of  Natural  History.  It  is  quite  possible  for  one 
of  these  pseudo-naturalists  to  attain  a  correct  acquaintance  with 
the  external  characters  of  every  individual  composing  an  exten- 
sive group  ;  and  even  to  contribute  towards  improving  their 
classification.  But  he  would  not  thereby  have  more  claim  to 
the  character  of  a  man  of  Science,  nor  would  he  have  more 
exercised  the  higher  faculties  of  his  mind,  than  one  who  should 
learn  the  forms,  colours,  and  specific  gravities  of  all  the  sub- 
stances with  which  Chemistry  brings  us  acquainted,  without 
making  himself  acquainted  with  the  laws  of  chemical  com- 
bination. 

It  is  in  the  search  after  those  general  principles,  which  regu- 
late the  structure  and  actions  of  the  animated  as  well  as  the 
inanimate  creation,  that  the  noblest  powers  of  the  human  intellect 
are  exercised  ;  and  exercised,  too,  in  their  most  legitimate  sphere. 
"  Wherefore,"  it  may  be  asked,  "  has  the  Creator  given  to  Man 
faculties  so  far  exalted  above  those  of  the  brute  creation  ?  Where- 
fore has  He  formed  him  with  a  mind  capable  of  seeing  into  the 
depths  of  space — of  grasping  ages  in  one  mighty  thought — of 
seeing  with  the  eye  of  reason  into  things  not  obvious  to  mortal 
sense — of  discovering  and  in  some  measure  comprehending,  his 
own  sublime  and  ever-acting  laws  ?"  Was  it  merely  to  compen- 
sate for  the  partial  inferiority  of  his  bodily  constitution, — was  it 
only  to  give  him  the  power  of  subduing  the  lion  without  his 
strength,  of  providing  himself  with  subsistence  from  the  antelope 
without  his  fleetness,  of  parrying  the  venomous  attacks  of  the 
serpent  without  his  cunning,  of  resisting  the  inclemency  of  the 
elements,  without  those  natural  defences  with  which  almost  every 
other  animal  is  provided  ?  Surely  not.  We  should  be  much 
nearer  the  truth  in  considering,  that  the  Creator  has  provided 
Man  with  a  corporeal  structure  inferior  in  many  respects  to 
that  of  brutes,  and  has  left  him  with  instinctive  powers  far  less 


INTRODUCTION.  21 

developed  than  their?,  for  the  very  purpose  of  arousing  the  latent 
energies  of  his  mind.  The  greater  the  difficulties  presented  by 
circumstances  to  the  supply  of  his  wants,  the  more  are  his  intel- 
lectual faculties  called  into  exercise  for  their  gratification.  And 
when  once  excited  to  action,  who  shall  set  the  limit  to  their 
development?  The  mind  requires  occupation  as  much  as  tlio 
body  requires  food.  And  as  we  select  those  substances  for  the 
nutriment  of  the  corporeal  structure,  which  are  best  adapted  to 
support  its  strength  and  to  complete  its  growth,  so  should  we 
prefer  those  materials  for  the  development  and  invigoration  of 
the  mental  powers,  which  are  by  their  nature  and  tendency 
most  fit  to  expand  and  elevate  them.  If  there  be  no  assignable 
limit  to  the  powers  of  the  human  mind,  it  is  obvious  that  they 
should  be  employed  on  objects  equally  extensive.  Nothing  can 
be  more  prejudicial  to  its  healthy  action,  than  to  confine  it  to 
some  exclusive  and  monotonous  occupation ;  and  nothing,  on  the 
other  hand,  can  be  more  favourable  to  the  development  of  its 
higher  faculties  and  nobler  aspirations,  than  to  turn  it.  if  only 
for  the  brief  periods  of  relaxation  which  the  necessary  labours 
and  cares  of  the  world  may  leave  unoccupied,  to  the  contempla- 
tion of  the  works  of  the  Great  Author  of  the  iTniverse.  It  is 
here  alone  that  its  powers  can  find  their  full  scope ;  for  here 
alone  can  it  be  felt,  that  however  great  the  amount  of  knowledge 
attained,  it  is  as  nothing  compared  with  that  which  is  yet  to  be 
unfolded  by  Infinite  Wisdom ;  and  that,  however  great  the 
triumphs  of  human  skill,  they  are  as  nothing  to  the  wonders  of 
Almighty  Power.  All  other  departments  of  knowledge  have 
their  limit ;  and  much  of  what  is  brought  together  by  the  labours 
of  a  protracted  life,  dies  with  the  scholar  by  whose  toil  it  has 
been  collected.  But  in  the  study  of  Natural  Science,  no  step 
once  gained  is  ever  lost ;  for  it  serves  to  plant  the  succeeding 
footsteps,  by  which  other  minds  may  rise  into  yet  nearer  com- 
munion with  the  Creator,  and  gain  a  wider  survey  of  his  works. 
But  as  all  his  attributes  are  Infinite,  not  even  Eternity  can  be 
sufficient  to  unfold  them  to  the  beings  He  has  created. 


22  INTRODUCTION. 

The  effects  which  the  pursuit  of  Natural  History  should  pro- 
duce upon  the  moral  faculties,  are  not  less  valuable  than  those 
which  have  been  adverted  to  in  regard  to  the  intellectual  powers. 
And  these  may  be  recognised  at  the  very  outset  of  the  study,  if 
it  be  commenced  in  a  right  spirit.  Well  has  the  great  Bacon 
remarked  upon  the  "  felicity  wherewith  God  hath  blessed  a 
humility  of  mind,  such  as  rather  laboureth  to  spell,  and  so  by 
degrees  to  read,  in  the  volumes  of  his  creation,  than  to  solicit  and 
urge/'1  "  It  is  no  less  true,"  he  elsewhere  says,  "  in  this  human 
kingdom  of  knowledge,  than  in  God's  kingdom  of  heaven,  that 
no  man  shall  enter  into  it,  *  except  he  become  first  as  a  little 
child.1  r  And  this  humility  of  spirit  is  encouraged,  rather  than 
repressed,  by  the  subsequent  progress  of  the  inquirer  ;  since  his 
prospect  becomes  wider,  every  step  that  he  takes ;  and  his  feel- 
ing of  his  own  insignificance,  in  comparison  with  the  vastness  of 
Creation,  should  be  continually  increasing.  No  frame  of  mind 
can  be  more  advantageous  than  this,  for  the  reception  of  those 
other  influences  which  the  study  of  Nature  is  calculated  to  exert. 
The  Naturalist  who  has  cherished  it,  and  who  possesses  also  that 
openness  to  conviction  which  is  its  almost  necessary  result,  can 
scarcely  fail  to  perceive  that  Infinite  Love  is  displayed  in  the 
works  of  the  Creator,  as  well  as  boundless  Wisdom  and  Almighty 
Power.  In  everything  which  he  can  trace  to  its  causes — in 
which  he  can  detect  the  mode  of  their  operation — of  which  he 
can  discover  the  design,  he  sees  the  evidence  of  the  same  attri- 
butes ;  and  hard  indeed  must  be  the  heart,  and  proud  the  spirit, 
and  blind  the  understanding,  that  does  not  pass  from  the  known 
to  the  unknown ;  and,  trusting  where  it  cannot  trace,  feel  an 
assured  conviction,  that  the  same  Almighty  Power,  the  same 
boundless  Wisdom,  and  the  same  Infinite  Love,  are  as  fully 
exercised  in  those  instances  in  which  they  are  to  him  least  evident, 
as  in  those  where  they  are  most  clearly  manifested. 

And  thus  is  laid  a  good  foundation  for  the  reception  of  those 
truths,  regarding  the  peculiar  concern  of  the  Creator  in  the  welfare 
of  his  human  offspring,  which  Revelation  discloses  to  us.  The 


INTRODUCTION.  23 

mind  that  has  been  led  by  the  philosophic  study  of  Nature 
(which  is  nothing  else  than  the  application  of  that  reason  with 
which  man  has  been  endowed,  to  the  discerning  contemplation 
of  those  glorious  works  with  which  he  is  surrounded),  to  recog- 
nise in  it  a  Power  which  can  never  fail,  a  Wisdom  which  can  no- 
wise err,  and  a  Goodness  which  cannot  be  unkind, — and  which, 
by  continually  dwelling  on  such  thoughts,  has  interwoven  them 
(as  it  were)  with  itself,  and  made  them  a  part  of  its  own  consti- 
tution,— is  well  prepared  to  view  the  Great  Creator  of  all  in  that 
peculiarly  parental  character,  in  which  He  has  been  so  frequently 
and  touchingly  represented  to  us  by  His  inspired  messengers  ; 
and  to  submit  without  a  murmur  to  the  severest  inflictions  of  His 
Almighty  hand,  as  the  discipline  of  a  Father  who  alone  knoweth 
what  is  good  for  his  children,  and  who  loveth  even  while  he 
chasteneth.  In  the  events  of  life,  as  in  the  phenomena  of  Nature, 
he  will  be  prepared  to  trust  where  he  cannot  trace;  and,  by  the 
contemplation  of  those  mercies  by  which  every  afflictive  dispen- 
sation is  tempered,  to  rise  to  the  assured  conviction, — a  conviction 
pervading  the  heart,  as  well  as  satisfactory  to  the  understanding, 
— that  the  stroke  itself  is  not  only  designed  by  Wisdom,  and 
given  by  Power,  but  is  aimed  and  directed  by  Love.  And, 
when  this  conviction  has  been  attained,  it  finds  itself  reflected  by 
every  object  around ;  and,  in  the  contemplation  of  the  visible 
works  of  Creation,  a  degree  of  realisation  is  given  to  it,  which 
can  scarcely  be  attained  in  any  other  way,  by  those  who  have 
not  passed  through  a  long  course  of  religious  experience.  It 
should  operate,  too,  not  merely  in  severe  trials  or  seasons  of  the 
deepest  gloom,  but  in  lightening  the  daily  cares,  and  giving 
cheerfulness  to  the  daily  scenes  of  life ;  and  if  such  be  the  fruits 
of  the  study,  on  the  recommendation  of  which  we  have  dwelt 
so  long,  it  is  indeed  one  not  to  be  neglected. 


CHAPTER   I. 

ON   ZOOLOGICAL    CLASSIFICATION. 

1.  THE  principles  of  a  Natural  arrangement  of  Plants  or 
Animals    having    been     elsewhere    fully   explained    (BOTANY, 
Chap.  I.),  it  will  not  be  necessary  to  do  more  in  this  place  than 
recapitulate  them,  with  some  additional  illustrations  of  a  Zoo- 
Wical  character. 

O 

2.  The  object  of  all  Classification  has  been  shown  to  be, — 
to  bring  together  those  beings  which  most  resemble  each  other, 
and  to  separate  those  that  differ.     In  this  manner  we  greatly 
shorten  the  labour  which  would  be  otherwise  required  from  the 
Naturalist ;  since,  instead  of  spending  his  time  and  attention  in 
the  study  of  all  the  characters  which  each  specimen  presents,  he 
is  at  once  able,  by  knowing  its  general  position  in  the  Animal 
scale,  to  see  (as  it  were)  into  its  interior,  and  a  single  character 
often  becomes  the  key  to  a  great  number,     Thus,  for  instance, 
if  we  meet  with  an  animal  covered  with  feathers,  we  know  that  it 
must  belong  to  the  class  of  Birds  ;  because  no  other  animal  than 
a  Bird  is  endowed  with  this  covering.     And  when  we  know  it 
to  be  a  Bird,   we  can  at  once  attribute  to  it  all  those  characters 
by  which  the  members  of  this  group  are  distinguished.     Thus, 
we  feel  a  certainty  that  it  has  a  bony  skeleton  covered   with 
flesh  ;  that  of  this  skeleton,  a  jointed  back-bone  forms  the  essen- 
tial part ;  that  this  back-bone  contains  a  spinal  marrow,  swelling 
at  its  upper  end  into  a  brain,  which  is  inclosed   within  a  bony 
casing  or  skull  ;    that  it  is  oviparous,   or  propagates  by  eggs  ; 
that  it  breathes  air  by  means  of  lungs ;  that  its  heart  has  four 
cavities ;  that  the  blood  is  red,  and  its  circulation  rapid,  and  ar- 
ranged on  the  same  plan  with  that  of  Man  ;  that  the  temperature 


26  PRINCIPLES    OF    CLASSIFICATION. 

of  the  body  is  always  high  during  life  ;  that  the  mouth  is  desti- 
tute of  teetli,  but  that  its  jaws  are  furnished  with  a  horny 
bill ;  that  the  body  is  supported  on  the  ground  upon  two  legs 
only  ;  and  that,  if  its  wings  are  sufficiently  developed,  the  animal 
can  raise  itself  into  the  air  by  their  movement.  All  these  facts, 
and  many  more,  are  included  in  the  general  idea  of  the  structure 
of  the  Bird  which  the  Zoologist  possesses ;  but  only  a  few  of 
them  are  included  in  the  common  idea.  For  a  person  ignorant 
of  Zoology  thinks  of  little  but  the  external  characters ;  and 
attaches  little  else  to  the  name  of  Bird,  than  the  idea  of  an 
animal  covered  with  feathers,  possessing  one  pair  of  wings  and 
one  pair  of  legs,  and  having  a  horny  bill.  Or,  if  he  thought  of 
the  internal  structure  at  all,  the  distinction  upon  which  his  mind 
would  naturally  fix,  would  be  the  gizzard,  or  strong  muscular 
stomach  possessed  by  most  of  the  birds  used  as  food  ;  but  this 
would  not  be  a  proper  zoological  character  of  the  class,  because  it 
is  confined  to  a  certain  part  of  it  only,  and  is,  moreover,  possessed 
by  animals  of  other  tribes. 

3.  Thus  we  see  how  much  our  labour  is  simplified,  by 
the  union  into  one  group,  of  all  the  animals  which  agree  in  the 
most  important  or  essential  characters ;  since,  by  the  knowledge 
of  these  characters,  we  are  at  once  put  in  possession  of  a  great 
amount  of  important  information  respecting  every  one  of  the  ani- 
mals included  in  the  group.  Thus,  among  the  many  thousand 
species  which  belong  to  the  class  of  Birds,  there  is  not  a  single 
one  that  does  not  agree  in  all  the  characters  just  named ;  and, 
if  we  should  find  a  new  species, — which  no  Naturalist  had  ever 
met  with,  no  Anatomist  had  ever  examined, — we  might  antici- 
pate with  certainty  (so  far,  at  least,  as  we  have  a  right  to  feel 
certain  of  anything  of  this  kind),  that  its  internal  structure  would 
correspond  with  the  description  already  given.  For  not  only  do 
the  animals  included  in  the  class  of  Birds  agree  amongst  them- 
selves in  all  these  characters  ;  but  they  also  differ  from  all  others 
in  having  them  thus  combined.  Thus,  if  we  compare  Birds  with 
Insects,  to  which,  in  their  mode  of  life  and  possession  of  the 
powers  of  flight,  they  bear  the  greatest  external  resemblance  ;  we 
shall  find  the  points  of  agreement  really  much  fewer  than  the 


PRINCIPLES    OP    CLASSIFICATION.  27 

points  of  difference.  For  the  resemblance  does  not  extend  much 
beyond  the  presence  of  wings,  the  breathing  of  air,  the  repro- 
duction by  eggs,  and  the  covering  of  the  wings  and  body  (in 
some  Insects)  with  a  kind  of  down.  The  points  of  difference 
are  much  more  striking.  For  the  body  of  an  Insect  has  no 
internal  skeleton,  but  is  included  within  a  jointed  envelope,  of 
greater  or  less  firmness ;  the  nervous  centres,  instead  of  being 
united  into  one  continuous  mass — the  brain  and  spinal  marrow, 
are  scattered  through  the  body  in  distinct  ganglia;  the  air  which 
enters  the  body,  instead  of  being  confined  to  certain  bags  or 
chambers,  is  carried  through  the  whole,  by  means  of  a  widely- 
distributed  system  of  air-tubes ;  instead  of  a  heart,  there  is  a  long 
tube,  situated  in  the  back,  and  divided  into  chambers  that  cor- 
respond with  the  segments  or  divisions  of  the  body  ;  the  blood  is 
white,  and  its  circulation  slow  and  feeble ;  the  temperature  of 
the  body  is  usually  not  much  above  that  of  the  air  around  it ;  the 
body  is  supported,  when  on  the  ground,  upon  six  legs ;  and 
the  eyes  are  compound  in  their  structure,  each  of  the  dark  hemi- 
spherical protuberances  on  the  head  being,  in  fact,  an  assemblage 
or  cluster  of  distinct  eyes.  All  these  are  characters,  of  which  the 
union  is  peculiar  to  the  Insect,  distinguishing  it  from  other 
classes  ;  and  we  see  how  very  little  real  conformity  there  can  be 
between  Insects  and  Birds ;  since  the  points  of  difference  are  so 
much  greater  than  those  of  agreement. 

4.  The  fact  is,  that  these  two  classes  belong  to  different  pri- 
mary subdivisions  of  the  Animal  kingdom  ; — the  Birds  to  the 
group  of  VERTEBRATA,  which  is  especially  distinguished  by  the 
possession  of  an  internal  skeleton,  protecting  the  nervous  centres, 
and  clothed  by  the  muscles  which  communicate  motion  to  it ; — 
whilst  the  Insects  form  part  of  the  group  of  ARTICULATA,  in 
which  the  skeleton  is  external,  having  the  muscles  that  move  it 
attached  to  its  interior,  and  not  giving  more  protection  to  the 
nervous  centres  than  it  does  to  the  rest  of  the  body.  But  the 
class  of  Birds  may  be  regarded  as  holding  the  same  position  in 
the  Vertebrated  series,  which  that  of  Insects  does  in  the  Arti- 
culated. They  are  adapted  for  the  same  mode  of  life;  and 
notwithstanding  the  different  plans  on  which  their  bodies  are 


28  PRINCIPLES    OF    CLASSIFICATION. 

constructed,  there  is  a  remarkable  correspondence  between  several 
parts  of  their  respective  fabrics.  Hence,  they  are  termed  analo- 
gous groups ;  and  may  be  said  to  represent  one  another  in  the 
series  to  which  they  respectively  belong.  Thus,  Birds  may  be 
termed  the  Insects  of  the  Vertebrated  series ;  and  Insects  may 
be  regarded  as  the  Birds  of  the  Articulated.  We  shall  have 
several  occasions  for  noticing  similar  analogies,  in  the  course  of 
this  Treatise. 

5.  But  we  shall  next  inquire,  how  the  characters  which  have 
been  mentioned  as  distinguishing  the  class  of  Birds,  serve  to  sepa- 
rate it  from  others,  which  have  more  in  common  with  it.  The 
classes  of  Reptiles  and  Mammals  *  all  agree  with  Birds  in  a 
larger  number  of  characters, — and  these,  too,  of  the  highest 
importance, —  than  do  Insects  ;  notwithstanding  that  the  differ- 
ence in  external  form,  and  in  habit  of  life,  may  be  much  greater. 
For  they  are  all  Yertebrated  animals,  possessing  a  jointed  internal 
skeleton,  which  envelopes  and  protects  the  nervous  centres,  a 
distinct  brain  and  spinal  marrow,  four  members  or  extremities, 
five  senses,  red  blood,  simple  eyes,  &c.,  &c.  With  Mammalia 
and  Reptiles,  Birds  further  agree,  in  breathing  air  by  means  of 
lungs ;  whilst  they  agree  with  Reptiles  and  Fishes  in  being 
oviparous.  With  Mammals,  again,  they  agree  in  having  a  heart 
with  four  cavities,  and  a  complete  double  circulation  (which  is  so 
arranged,  as  to  expose  all  the  blood  to  the  air  in  the  lungs,  before 
it  is  again  transmitted  to  the  system) ;  and  also  in  constantly 
maintaining  a  high  temperature.  But  they  differ  from  Mammals 
in  being  oviparous  instead  of  viviparous  ;  that  is,  in  depositing 
eggs,  instead  of  producing  their  young  alive,  and  nourishing  them 
afterwards  by  suckling  ;  and  in  having  their  bodies  covered  with 
feathers,  instead  of  with  hair  or  scales.  They  differ,  too,  in  the 
mode  of  life  for  which  they  are  adapted ;  the  Mammals  (as  a 
class)  being  destined  to  live  on  the  ground,  whilst  the  Birds 
inhabit  the  air  :  but  there  are  exceptions  in  both  instances,  some 

*  This  modification  of  the  scientific  term  Mammalia,  having  been  sanctioned 
by  high  authority,  will  be  used  in  this  work  ;  when  it  is  requisite  to  speak  of  the 
class  in  connection  with  others,  which  are  ordinarily  and  most  conveniently 
designated  by  English  names. 


1'KINCIPLES    OF    CLASSIFICATION.  29 

Mammals  (as  the  Bats)  being  able  to  fly  like  Birds,  whilst  some 
Birds  are  confined  to  the  ground,   like  Mammals. 

6.  From  Reptiles,  again,  Birds  differ  in  possessing  a  heart 
with  four  cavities  and  a  complete  double  circulation  ;  the  heart 
of  Reptiles  being  furnished  with   only  three  cavities,  and  the 
circulation  being  so  arranged,  that  only  a  part  of  the  blood  sent 
to  the  system  has  been  exposed  to  the  influence  of  air  in  the  lungs: 
and  whilst  the  temperature  of  the  bodies  of  Birds  is  kept  up  to 
a  certain  high  standard,  that  of  the  Reptiles  varies  with  that  of 
the  surrounding  air,  and  is  usually  but  little  above  it.     There  is 
the  same  difference,  too,  in  their  mode  of  life,  between  Birds  and 
Reptiles,  as  between  Birds  and  Mammals ;  with  this  addition, — 
that  Birds  are  the  most  active  and  energetic  in  their  movements, 
of  all  the  vertebrated  classes  ;  whilst  Reptiles  are  the  most  inert 
and  sluggish.     Between   Birds  and  Fishes,  the  differences  are 
still  greater ;  for  though  they  agree  in  being  oviparous,  they  are 
adapted  for  an  opposite  mode  of  respiration,  the  latter  breathing 
by  water,  whilst  the  former  breathe  by  air ;  the  circulation  of 
Fishes,  too,  is  much  simpler  in  its  plan,  the  heart  having  but  two 
cavities ;    and  the   construction  of  their  skeleton  is  such,  as  to 
adapt  these  animals  to  rapid  movement  through  a  dense  element, 
water,  in   which  they  float  without  effort,  instead  of  enabling 
them  to  raise  and  sustain  themselves  in  the  comparatively  unre- 
sisting air. 

7.  It  appears,  then,  that  a  close  affinity  exists,  between  Birds 
and  Mammals  on  the  one  hand,  and  Birds  and  Reptiles  on  the 
other.     And  we  shall  hereafter  see,  that  this  affinity  is  rendered 
still  more  close,  by  the  existence  of  certain  species,  in  which  the 
characters  of  the  respective  classes  to  which  they  belong,  are  so 
shaded  off  (as  it  were),  and  so  blended  with  those  of  the  neigh- 
bouring classes,  that  we  pass  without  any  very  abrupt  break, 
from  one  to  the  other. 

8.  But  it  is  not  only  in  marking  out  these  principal  groups, 
and  in  enabling  us  at  once  to  know  their  points  of  general  agree- 
ment, as  well  as  their  most  important  differences,  that  classifica- 
tion is  useful.     For  the  principal  groups,  or  classes,  are  subdivided 
into  others,   termed  orders  ;    every  one  of  which  contains  an 


30  PRINCIPLES    OP    CLASSIFICATION. 

assemblage  of  species,  that  possesses  certain  points  of  agreement, 
less  striking  than  those  which  characterise  the  class,  but  enough 
to  distinguish  each  group  from  others  having  the  same  general 
structure.  Thus  among  Birds,  we  have  the  Birds  of  Prey,  the 
Perching  Birds,  the  Climbing  Birds,  the  Running  Birds,  the 
Scratching  Birds,  the  Wading  Birds,  and  the  Aquatic  Birds ; 
each  of  these  orders  being  known  by  some  peculiar  form  of 
the  bill  and  legs,  which  distinguishes  it  from  the  rest,  and  which 
is  common  (though  often  with  great  modifications)  to  all  the 
Birds  contained  in  it. — With  the  peculiar  forms  of  the  bill  and 
legs,  which  especially  distinguish  the  order,  and  which  show  its 
adaptation  to  some  particular  kind  of  life,  we  have  certain  other 
characters  combined.  Thus  the  Rasores,  or  Scratching  Birds, 
which  feed  upon  grains  or  seeds,  live  for  the  most  part  upon  the 
ground,  whence  their  food  is  obtained  ;  their  bodies  are  heavy 
and  their  wings  short,  so  that  they  cannot  rise  in  the  air  without 
difficulty ;  and  they  are  all  furnished  with  a  gizzard,  or  stout 
muscular  stomach  for  grinding  down  their  food.  On  the  other 
hand,  among  the  Birds  of  Prey,  which  obtain  their  food  by 
pursuing  other  birds  in  the  air,  we  find  the  body  and  wings 
adapted  to  active  flight ;  and  the  stomach  destitute  of  thick 
muscular  walls,  as  the  nature  of  the  food  introduced  into  it 
renders  it  much  less  difficult  of  digestion,  than  that  on  which  the 
Fowl  tribe  is  supported. 

9.  In  like  manner,  Orders  are  subdivided  into  Families,  upon 
characters  of  still  less  importance, — such  as  minute  differences  in 
the  form  of  the  feet  and  bill,  or  in  the  arrangement  of  the  wing- 
feathers  ;  but  these  differences  are  always  connected  with  some- 
thing in  the  internal  structure,  and  in  the  habits  of  the  tribe, 
that  shows  it  to  be  really  distinct  from  others,  which  it  may 
strongly  resemble  in  general  appearance.  Families,  again,  are 
divided  into  Genera  ;  each  of  which  includes  a  number  of  Species, 
whose  points  of  difference  are  very  slight,  whilst  their  points  of 
agreement  include  all  the  characters  which  are  of  any  importance. 
Thus  we  find  that  each  Genus  commonly  includes  a  number  of 
Species,  differing  from  each  other  (it  may  be)  in  little  else  than 
size  and  colour,  and  agreeing  in  every  other  respect ;  thus  of  the 


PRINCIPLES    OF    CLASSIFICATION.  31 

genus  Linaria  or  Linnet,  there  are  in  this  country  alone,  five 
species,  the  green  linnet  or  greenfinch,  the  brown  linnet,  the 
mountain  linnet  or  twite,  the  smaller  redpoll,  and  the  mealy 
redpoll, — the  habits,  food,  and  general  conformation  of  all  being 
very  nearly  the  same, — whilst  there  are  differences  between  them 
sufficiently  constant  to  prevent  their  ever  being  confounded.  But 
the  genus  Linaria  is  united  with  many  other  genera,  which  are 
chiefly  distinguished  from  it  by  some  slight  variations  in  the 
form  of  the  bill,  into  the  family  of  Fringillidce  or  Finches  ;  which 
includes  the  well-known  Goldfinch,  Hawfinch,  Bullfinch,  Gros- 
beak, Sparrow,  Chaffinch,  Brambling,  and  many  other  birds,  all 
having  a  stout  conical  bill,  slightly  bent  down  near  its  point. 
This  family, — with  others  in  which  the  shape  of  the  bill,  and 
the  general  formation  of  the  body,  are  more  or  less  unlike  what 
is  seen  in  it, — constitutes  the  section  Conirostres  (or  conical-billed 
birds)  of  the  order  Insessores,  or  Perchers. 

10.  Thus  it  is  seen  that,  as  we  pass  up  from  species  to  genera, 
from  genera  to  families,  from  families  to  orders,  and  from  orders 
to  classes,  the  characters  of  agreement  become  fewer  and  fewer ; 
whilst  those  of  difference  manifest  themselves  more  and  more 
strongly.     And  when  we  arrive  at  classes,  we  may  generally  say 
that  the  points  of  difference  are  stronger  than  those  of  agreement , 
so  that,   if  two  animals  belong  to  distinct  classes,  they  may  be 
considered  more  unlike  than  they  are  like  ;  whilst,  if  they  belong 
to  the  same  class,  they  may  be  regarded  as  more  like  than  they 
are  unlike. 

1 1 .  One  other  example  may  be  introduced,  to  show  the  utility 
of  even  a  very  moderate  knowledge  of  the  principles  of  classifi- 
cation, in  enabling  us  to  retain  and  apply  a  large  amount  of 
information  ;  which,  if  we  had  to  derive  it  from  the  study  of 
each  individual  animal,  could  scarcely  be  embraced  by  a  single 
mind.      The  Common  Dog  is  a  species    of  the  genus    Canis, 
belonging  to  the  family  Canida,  of  the  order  Carnivora,  of  the 
class  Mammalia,  of  the  sub-kingdom  Vertebrata.     The  informa- 
tion conveyed  to  us  by  these  last  terms  has  already  been  noticed. 
From  the  simple  name  vertebrated  animal,  we  learn  that  it  has  an 
internal  skeleton,  with  a  jointed  backbone  and  skull,  containing 


32  PRINCIPLES    OF    CLASSIFICATION. 

the  spinal  marrow  and  brain,  the  centres  of  the  nervous  sys- 
tem ;  and  that  it  has  five  senses,  four  extremities,  red  blood, 
£c.  &c.  Whilst  the  knowledge  that  it  is  one  of  the  class  Mam- 
malia further  implies,  that  it  is  a  warm-blooded  animal,  breathing 
air,  possessing  a  heart  with  four  cavities,  a  complete  double 
circulation,  producing  its  young  alive,  nourishing  them  after- 
wards by  suckling,  and  having  the  body  more  or  less  completely 
covered  with  hair.  By  being  able  to  refer  it  to  the  order  Car- 
nivora,  we  know  that  it  is  a  beast  of  prey  (in  its  natural  state), 
adapted  by  the  formation  of  its  teeth  .and  digestive  apparatus  to 
feed  upon  animal  flesh,  and  by  the  structure  of  its  extremities  to 
pursue  and  attack  the  animals  which  serve  as  its  prey.  As  one 
of  the  family  Canidae,  we  know  that  it  agrees  with  the  Wolves, 
Foxes,  Jackals,  and  Hyaenas,  as  well  as  with  the  Cats,  in  being 
digitigrade,  that  is,  in  walking  upon  the  ends  of  the  toes,  instead 
of  upon  the  sole  of  the  foot,  as  does  the  Bear  :  but  it  agrees  with 
the  former  animals,  and  differs  from  the  Cats,  in  not  being  so 
much  adapted  to  pursue  and  attack  living  prey,  as  to  feed  upon 
the  flesh  of  animals  already  killed  ; — the  teeth  not  being  formed 
so  exclusively  for  cutting  and  tearing,  as  are  those  of  the  Feline 
or  Cat  tribe ;  and  the  claws  not  being  either  so  long  and  sharp 
as  theirs,  or  capable  of  being  pushed  forth  and  withdrawn,  as  in 
the  Cats.  The  dog  differs  from  the  Fox  and  Hyasna,  in  certain 
peculiarities  in  the  form  of  his  teeth ;  but  his  relationship  to  the 
Wolf  is  so  close,  that  many  naturalists  have  regarded  them  as 
having  sprung  from  the  same  stock.  Hence  while  the  Dog  be- 
longs to  a  genus  distinct  from  the  Hyaena  and  Fox,  it  is  included 
with  the  Wolf  and  Jackal  in  the  same  generic  character ;  and  it 
may  be,  that  it  does  not  even  constitute  a  species  distinct  from 
the  Wolf. 

12.  There  is  frequently  great  difficulty,  in  Zoology  as  well 
as  in  Botany,  in  distinguishing  species  from  varieties.  Any  two 
races  of  animals  are  considered  to  be  of  distinct  species,  which 
are  marked  by  characters  of  difference  that  are  constantly 
exhibited ;  so  that  neither  shows  any  tendency  to  lose  its  own 
peculiarity,  or  to  acquire  that  of  the  other.  Thus,  notwith- 
standing the  variety  of  forms  exhibited  by  the  several  races 


DISTINCTION    BETWEEN    SPECIES    AND    VARIETIES.  33 

of  Dog,  we  never  see  any  which  present  so  strong  a  resemblance 
to  a  Fox,  as  to  be  at  all  in  danger  of  being  mistaken  for  that 
animal ;  and  they  may  always  be  distinguished  by  this  obvious 
character, — that  the  pupil  of  the  eye  of  the  Dog  is  always  round, 
whilst  that  of  the  Fox  is  oval  when  contracted  (ANIM.  PHYSIOL. 
§  533).  When  such  constant  distinctions  are  found  to  exist,  the 
Zoologist  has  a  right  to  assume  that  they  always  have  existed  ; 
and  consequently  that  the  original  parents,  or  the  stocks  whence 
the  races  originated,  were  also  distinct. 

13.  But  whilst  some  characters  are  constant  in  each  race, 
others  may  undergo  great  variation ;  so  that,  within  the  limits 
of  one  species,  we  may  have  a  large  number  of  varieties  or  breeds, 
marked  by  differences  much  greater  than  those  which,  in  other 
cases,  are  held  sufficient  to  distinguish  species.  This  is  especially 


FIG.  1. — THE  HIGHLAND  GREYHOUND. 


the  case  with  our  various  domesticated  animals ;  and  indeed  it  is 
in  great  part  from  the  power  which  their  constitutions  possess, 


34  DISTINCTION    BETWEEN     SPECIES    AND    VARIETIES. 

of  adapting  themselves  to  changes  in  the  circumstances  of  their 
residence,  mode  of  life,  &c.,  that  their  utility  to  Man  arises. 
There  is  none  which  shows  this  more  strongly  than  the  Dog, 
which  is  the  companion  of  Man  in  every  part  of  the  globe,  and 
which  presents  more  striking  varieties  of  form  than  any  other 
species.  Not  only  do  the  different  races  of  Dogs  vary  in  the 
colour  and  quantity  of  their  hair,  but  also  in  the  proportions  of 
the  different  parts  of  their  body  (which  is  shown  as  much  in 
their  skeletons  as  in  the  living  animals),  and  even  in  their  instincts, 
which  in  most  animals  are  invariable.  How  different,  for  ex- 


FIG.  2.— CUBAN  MASTIFF. 

ample,  are  the  Greyhound  and  the  Mastiff,  the  Bloodhound  and 
the  Spaniel !  We  should  scarcely  imagine  that  any  period  of 
time,  or  external  influences,  could  ever  convert  one  into  the  other. 
Yet  the  Zoologist  has  no  hesitation  in  affirming,  that  they  had  a 
common  origin ;  since  it  is  found  that  their  distinct  forms  are 
preserved,  only  so  long  as  they  are  matched  in  breeding  with 
forms  of  the  same  kind.  For  if  the  different  races  of  Dogs  are 
allowed  to  breed  promiscuously  together,  and  escape  from  the 
influence  of  Man,  returning  to  their  original  savage  mode  of  life, 
the  varieties  gradually  disappear,  and  the  races  all  blend  toge- 
ther, after  a  few  generations,  into  one  common  type,  which 


DISTINCTION    BETWEEN    SPECIES    AND    VARIETIES.  35 

probably  resembles  that  from  which  the  various  breeds  at  first 
originated.     This  change  has  taken  place  in  various  parts  of  the 


FJO.  3.—  THE  BLOODHOUND. 


world,  in  the  case  of  Dogs  which  were  introduced  from  Europe, 
and  which  have  since  become  wild  ;  but  it  has  been  particularly 


FIG.  4 — THK  SPANIEL. 


noticed  in  Cuba,  where  the  exact  period  at  which  the  Dog  was 
first  introduced, — that  of  the  invasion  by  the  Spaniards  at  the 

D2 


36  DISTINCTION    BETWEEN    SPECIES    AND    VARIETIES. 

end  of  the  fifteenth  century, — is  known.  There  is  good  reason 
to  believe,  that  the  Dingo  or  native  Dog  of  Australia  (Fig.  5)  is 
the  descendant  of  a  race  once  domesticated,  which  has  returned  to 
its  wild  state ;  since  there  are  many  considerations  which  induce 
the  Zoologist  to  believe,  that  it  was  not  a  native  of  New  Holland. 
Hence  there  is  no  difficulty  in  reconciling  the  diversities  actually 
existing  among  the  various  races  of  Dog,  with  the  idea  of  one 
common  form,  of  which  they  are  modifications.  When  and  how 
the  several  breeds  first  arose,  is  less  easily  determined, 

14.  The  question,  whether  the  Wolf  and  the  Dog  had  a  com- 
mon origin  ?  or,  rather,  whether  the  Wolf  was  the  original  form 
of  the  Dog  ?  is  one  of  great  interest,  and  affords  another  valuable 
illustration  of  the  topic  under  discussion.  It  is  maintained  by 
many  Naturalists,  and  with  much  probability,  that  they  are  the 
same ;  and  chiefly  for  the  reason,  that  the  peculiarities  of  form 
and  character,  usually  regarded  as  distinguishing  the  Dog  from 
the  Wolf,  show  a  tendency  to  disappear  in  those  races,  which 
have  long  been  accustomed  to  a  savage  mode  of  life.  This  is 
especially  the  case  in  the  Australian  Dingo,  which  has  probably 


FlG.   5. — AUSTKALIAN    DlNGO. 


lived  in  this  unreclaimed  state  longer  than  any  other  known  race 
of  wild  Dogs ;  but  it  is  also  true  of  the  Dhole  of  India,  and  of 
two  partially  tamed  races,  which  are  known  in  North  and  South 
America.  "  These  races,  in  different  degrees,  and  in  a  greater 


SPECIFIC    IDENTITY    OP    DOG    ANT)    WOLF.  37 

degree  as  they  are  more  wild,  exhibit  the  lank  ami  gaunt  form, 
the  lengthened  limbs,  the  long  and  slender  muzzle,  and  the  great 
comparative  strength,  which  characterise  the  Wolf;  and  the  tail 
of  the  Australian  Dog,  which  may  be  considered  as  the  most 
remote  from  the  state  of  domestication,  assumes  the  slightly  bushy 
form  of  that  animal*."  All  these  wild  races,  too,  have  more  or 
less  completely  lost  that  common  character  of  domestication — 
variety  of  colour  and  marking,  and  have  assumed  a  uniform  dull- 
brown  hue,  much  resembling  that  of  the  common  Wolf.  It  has 
been  objected,  that  the  Wolf  does  not  exhibit  that  character, 
which  is  so  remarkable  in  all  the  races  of  the  Dog — attachment 
to  Man.  Even  the  wild  breeds  of  Dogs  are  easily  brought  under 
subjection,  and  are  made  useful  to  him  in  various  ways ;  which 
could  not  be  the  case,  if  they  had  the  same  savage  disposition  as 
the  common  Wolf.  But  it  has  been  shown,  that  the  Wolf  is 
much  more  capable  of  domestication  than  is  commonly  supposed, 
if  taken  young  from  its  wild  state,  and  brought  up  under  the 
influence  of  Man  ;  and  that  it  then  displays  as  much  attachment 
to  its  master,  and  remembrance  of  kindness  shown  to  it,  as  any 
Dog  could  do.  So  that  there  is  no  difficulty  in  understanding 
how,  by  a  continuance  of  this  influence  through  successive  gene- 
rations, the  character  of  the  race  may  become  so  permanently 
changed,  that  the  traces  of  former  domestication  may  not  .be 
altogether  lost,  even  in  breeds  which  have  returned  to  their  wild 
state  for  centuries  f. 

*  Bell's  British  Quadrupeds,  p.  197. 

f  The  question  as  to  the  identity  of  species  between  the  Dog  and  the  Wolf  can- 
not be  regarded  as  yet  settled  one  way  or  the  other.  It  will  probably  be  determined 
by  more  positive  information  upon  some  points,  respecting  the  propagation  of  the  two 
races,  which  have  not  been  satisfactorily  ascertained.  Thus,  if  the  'period  during 
which  the  female  goes  with  young  is  the  same  in  the  Wolf  as  in  the  Dog  (63  days), 
it  will  be  a  powerful  argument  for  the  identity  of  the  species;  but,  if  it  is  different, 
it  will  almost  certainly  prove  the  difference  of  the  species,  or,  in  other  words,  of  the 
original  stocks ;  since  this  is  a  character  in  which  there  is  no  variation  beyond  very 
narrow  limits.  Again,  it  is  well  known  that  the  Dog  will  breed  with  the  Wolf,  and 
that  the  offspring  will  breed  again  with  either  of  the  parent  races  ;  but  it  will  require 
to  be  ascertained,  whether  the  offspring  of  the  Dog  and  the  Wolf  will  breed  with 
another  hybrid  of  the  same  kind.  If  it  does,  the  identity  of  the  species  of  its  parents 
is  almost  certain  ;  if  it  cannot,  a  powerful  argument  is  afforded  for  the  separation  of 
the  two  races  as  distinct  species. — (See  VFGF.T.  PHYSIOL.  §  454.) 


38  DISTINCTION    BETWEEN    SPECIES    AND    VARIETIES. 

15.  Now,  if  we  turn  to  other  tribes  of  animals,  we  shall  find 
that  races  exist,  in  which  the  tendency  to  variation  is  so  slight, 
that  differences  between  two  anhrals,  far  less  in  degree  than 
those  which  exist  between  the  Ireeds  of  Dogs,  are  quite  sufficient 
to  serve  as  distinctions  of  species.      Thus,  among  the  Feline  or 
Cat  tribe,  the  resemblance  between  most  of  the  species  is  so  great, 
that,  excepting  in  regard  to  their  size,  it  is  not  easy  to  detect  any 
differences  between  their  skeletons  ;  that  of  the  common  Cat,  for 
instance,  being  almost  precisely  a  miniature  representation  of  that 
of  the  Tiger.    Even  in  species  so  different  in  external  appearance 
as  the  Lion  and  Tiger,  the  form  of  the  skull  is  so  nearly  the  same, 
that  there  is  no  constant  mark  by  which  they  can  be  distin- 
guished.    Yet  these  several  species,  nearly  allied  as  they  seem, 
never  exhibit  any  tendency  to  assume  each  other's  characters,  or 
to  lose  their  own  ;  but  preserve  their  respective  forms,  and  even 
the  markings  on  the  skin,  unchanged,  from  generation  to  gene- 
ration.    The  only  species  in  which  there  is  any  decided  tendency 
to  variation,  is  the  domestic  Cat;  of  which,  as  is  well  known,  there 
are  several  breeds.     But  these  races  differ  much  less  from  each 
other,  than  do  the  different  breeds  of  the  Dog ;  and  the  variations 
chiefly  consist  in  the  length  and  colour  of  the  hair.     But  in  the 
other  Felines,  even  these  characters  remain  so  constant,  that  cer- 
tain stripes  and  patches  are  repeated,  generation  after  generation, 
upon  each  individual ;  and  thus  afford  grounds  for  regarding  as 
distinct  species,  any  races    between  which  marked  differences 
exist,  even  of  so  trifling  a  character.     These  have  not  been  sub- 
jected to  the  influence  of  domestication,  for  the  simple  reason, 
that  they  do  not  seem  capable  of  it ;  their  ferocity  not  being 
subdued  by  confinement,  nor  softened  by  kindness;  and  their 
constitutions   not   being   endowed  with  the  power  of  adapting 
themselves  to  those  variations  of  temperature,  food,  habits,  &c. 
which  animals  that  are  brought  into  subjection  to  Man   must 
undergo. 

1 6.  Upon  grounds  as  trifling  (in  appearance  at  least)  as  these, 
the  Zoologist  feels  himself  justified  in  marking  out  as  distinct 
species,  in  other  groups  of  Animals,  those  which  present  con- 
stant differences,   however  insignificant,  whilst  in  similar  cir- 


DISTINCTION    BETWEEN    SPECIES    AND    VARIETIES.  39 

cnmstances.  Thus  there  are  many  species  of  Moths  and 
Butterflies,  which  are  only  known  apart  by  certain  spots  of 
colour  upon  their  wings ;  hut  these,  being  always  found  in  the 
same  situation,  and  of  the  same  hue,  are  justly  regarded  as  suf- 
ficient characters  for  the  distinction  of  species.  But  on  the 
other  hand,  if  there  be  any  difference  in  the  circumstances  under 
which  the  two  animals  are  found,  it  is  necessary  to  ascertain 
how  far  the  variation  may  be  due  to  this  cause.  Thus,  most 
Birds  undergo  a  change  of  plumage  according  to  the  season  of 
the  year  ;  and  until  these  changes  are  thoroughly  known,  we 
are  in  danger  of  considering  as  distinct  species  what  are  really 
identical.  For  if  we  were  to  compare  one  bird  in  its  winter 
dress,  with  another  of  the  same  species  in  its  summer  plumage, 
we  should  often  find  the  variations  sufficiently  great  to  induce 
us  to  regard  them  as  distinct  species,  if  we  did  not  trace  their 
respective  histories.  In  regard  to  the  birds  which  constantly 
inhabit  our  own  country,  this  has  been  accurately  done ;  but 
there  are  many  species  that  migrate  to  distant  countries,  either 
to  spend  the  winter  in  a  warmer  region,  or  the  summer  in  a 
cooler  one  ;  and  in  regard  to  some  of  these,  there  is  still  much 
doubt, — certain  birds  being  known  in  one  country  by  one  plum- 
age, and  again  in  the  other  by  a  different  one, — and  sufficient 
evidence,  whether  they  are  of  the  same  or  of  different  races,  not 
being  always  obtainable.  Even  between  the  northern  and 
southern  parts  of  one  extensive  district, — such  as  India, — there 
will  be  occasionally  found  such  differences  in  the  plumage  of 
their  feathered  inhabitants,  as  would  lead  to  their  being  regarded 
as  distinct  species,  if  there  were  not  evidence  to  the  contrary, 
derived  from  the  intermediate  forms  presented  by  the  birds  of 
the  intervening  country. 

17.  Thus  it  is  seen,  that  the  discrimination  of  species  is 
often  a  matter  of  the  greatest  difficulty  to  the  Zoologist ;  and 
the  sources  of  error  which  have  been  mentioned,  are  by  no 
means  the  only  ones.  "We  have  hitherto  noticed  only  those 
variations,  which  may  be  produced  by  the  influence  of  external 
conditions,  or  of  a  natural  tendency  to  variation,  such  as  is  par- 
ticularly evident  in  the  domesticated  races.  But  there  are  most 


40 


DISTINCTION    BETWEEN    SPECIES    AND    VARIETIES. 


striking  variations  in  many  animals,  not  only  in  the  size  of  the 
body,  but  in  its  form  and  structure,  at  different  periods  of  life  ; 
and  also,  not  unfrequently,  a  great  want  of  resemblance  between 
the  two  sexes.  In  some  instances,  there  is  a  positive  metamor- 
phosis or  change  of  form,  between  the  early  age  of  the  animal, 
and  its  adult  or  complete  state ;  this  is  the  case  in  the  Frog 
tribe,  in  Insects,  and  in  many  of  the  lower  classes.  No  one, 
who  might  be  unacquainted  with  the  history  of  these  changes, 
would  hesitate  in  regarding  the  Caterpillar  as  belonging,  not 
only  to  a  species,  but  even  to  a  class,  distinct  from  the  Insect ;  or 
in  separating  the  Tadpole  from  the  Frog;  and  yet,  by  due 
attention  to  the  history  of  these  animals,  we  come  to  know  that 
one  is  transformed  into  another  widely  different. 

18.     Now,  although  Zoologists  are  tolerably  well  acquainted 
with  such  changes  of  this  description,  as  take  place  among  the 
higher  classes,   yet  their  knowledge  is  still  extremely  imperfect 
of  the  metamorphoses  of  the  lower.     Thus  it  has   been   only 
within  a  few  years  that  proof  has  been  gained,  that  the  Zoea,  a 
little  crustaceous'  animal,  long  regarded  as  forming  a  genus  by 
itself,  is  nothing  else  than  the  young  of 
the  common  Crab;  and  that  an  animal 
very  closely  resembling  it  undergoes  a 
still  more  extraordinary  metamorphosis, 
in  order  to  assume  its  ultimate  form  of 
the  Barnacle.    But  even  where  no  such 
well-marked  changes  occur  during  the 
period  of  growth,  there  are  often  varia- 
tions  which  would  be  held  to   distin- 
guish species,  if  we  were  not  aware  that 
the  two  forms  are  really  the  same,  in 
different  states.     Thus,    in   almost   all 
Birds,  the  plumage  of  the  young  male  is 
different  from  that  of  the  adult ;  some- 
FIO.  6.— EARLY  FORM  OF  THE    times    resembling    that   of    the   adult 
female  ;  but  often  being  different  from 

that  of  either  parent.  Even  here,  then,  we  should  be  in  danger 
of  falling  into  error,  by  separating  as  distinct  species  what  are 


INFLUENCE    OP    AGE    AND    SEX.  41 

really  the  young  and  adult  states  of  the  same,  were  we  not  to 
study  the  animal  through  its  whole  period  of  life.  The  same  is 
the  case,  too,  in  regard  to  Fishes  ;  the  markings  on  which  un- 
dergo a  similar  variation  ;  so  that  it  has  been  only  lately  ascer- 
tained with  certainty  (the  difficulty  of  observation  being  here 
greater)  that  the  Salmon-Parr  is  the  young  of  the  Salmon,  and 
not  a  distinct  species,  as  it  was  long  considered.  Among  Shells, 
similar  difficulties  exist, — the  young  being  often  very  different 
in  form  from  the  adult  (as  will  be  shown  hereafter),  so  as  only 
to  be  identified  with  it  as  the  same  species,  by  comparing  toge- 
ther a  number  of  specimens  in  different  stages  of  growth.  Such 
a  series  is,  of  course,  more  difficult  to  obtain  among  fossils,  than 
among  shells  of  existing  races ;  and  it  is  consequently  very  often 
difficult  to  speak  with  certainty,  as  to  whether  two  fossil  shells 
are  of  the  same,  or  of  different  species.  In  some  groups,  on  the 
other  hand,  there  is  such  a  similarity  among  the  different  shells, 
and  such  a  gradual  passage  from  one  form  to  another,  that  it  is 
very  difficult  to  say,  from  the  shells  alone,  whether  any  distinc- 
tion of  species  exists  at  all.  It  is  to  be  remembered  that  the 
shells  are  only  the  external  skeletons,  thrown  off  from  the 
surface  of  the  animals  which  form  them ;  and  that  it  is  conse- 
quently not  at  all  safe  to  judge  from  them  alone;  since  differences 
may  exist  in  the  animals,  where  the  shells  do  not  manifest  any. 
19.  The  difference  of  sex,  too,  is  often  marked  by  such  dif- 
ferences in  the  form  and  colouring  of  the  body,  and  even  in  the 
shape  of  parts  which  might  have  been  expected  to  be  alike  in  the 
male  and  female  of  the  same  species  (the  antennas,  of  insects  for 
example),  as  may  often  perplex  the  Naturalist.  Thus,  it  is  well 
known,  that,  among  Birds,  the  male  is  usually  larger  and  more 
vigorous  than  the  female,  his  plumage  gayer,  and  his  song  more 
powerful  and  varied ;  and  where  the  head  has  any  distinctive 
crest  of  feathers,  this  is  often  wanting  in  the  female.  Among 
Mammals,  too,  there  are  several  species  in  which  horns  are  con- 
fined to  the  male-sex ;  and  in  the  Lion  we  have  a  familiar  in- 
stance of  the  difference  of  aspect  between  the  male  and  female, 
caused  by  the  greater  quantity  and  length  of  the  hair  on  the 
head  and  neck  of  the  former.  Among  Insects,  again,  there  are 


42  DISTINCTION    BETWEEN    SPECIES    AND    VARIETIES. 

many  differences  of  this  kind,  in  the  markings  of  the  surface  ;  but 
others  of  a  still  more  important  character  are  often  met  with. 
Thus,  there  are  some  species,  in  vvhich  the  females  are  destitute 
of  wings, — as  is  the  case  with  the  common  Glow-worm  ;  and 
others,  in  which  her  form  is  quite  different  from  that  of  the 
adult  male  (although  the  young  of  the  two  sexes  correspond), — 
of  which  we  have  an  example  in  the  Cochineal  insect.  But  even 
these  differences  are  surpassed  by  those  which  are  met  with  in 
other  classes.  Thus  among  the  lower  Crustacea,  there  are  seve- 
ral species,  of  which  only  females  have  been  hitherto  discovered  ; 
whence,  it  is  probable,  that  the  males  possess  an  entirely  different 
form,  and  have  not  improbably  been  described  as  members  of 
some  other  group.  In  the  curious  Lerncea  (Fig.  7-)»  the  male  is 
much  smaller  than  the  female,  and  differs  so  much  in  form,  that 
its  true  character  was  long  unknown. 

20.  From  these  facts  we  are  led  to  perceive,  how  much 
knowledge  is  required  by  the  Naturalist,  before  he  determines 
upon  the  arrangement  of  the  different  forms  of  animal-life,  which 
he  has  collected,  into  distinct  species, — the  first  step  in  classifica- 
tion. It  is  not  sufficient  that,  on  comparing  together  two 
animals  which  bear  a  strong  general  resemblance  to  one  another, 
he  finds  some  obvious  point  of  difference.  He  must  ascertain 
whether  this  difference  invariably  manifests  itself,  in  the  races  to 
which  these  animals  respectively  belong  ;  or  whether  it  is  a  mere 
individual  peculiarity.  Thus,  Men  with  six  fingers  and  six  toes 
are  occasionally  to  be  met  with  ;  but  we  should  not  on  this 
account  rank  them  as  constituting  a  species  distinct  from  ordi- 
nary men,  since  both  the  parents  and  offspring,  the  brothers  and 
sisters,  of  such  persons,  are  very  commonly  found  to  have  only 
the  usual  number.  Yet,  a  variation  of  no  greater  amount  among 
many  of  the  lower  tribes, — especially  Insects, — would  be  a  suffi- 
cient distinction,  not  only  between  different  species,  but  between 
different  genera,  or  even  families.*  But,  even  supposing  that 
such  variations  do  appear  constant,  it  is  further  necessary  to 
ascertain,  whether  they  have  always  been  so,  or  whether  they 

*  Thus  the  great  order,  Coleoptera,  or  Beetles,  is  divided  into  sub-orders, 
according  to  the  number  of  joints  in  the  foot. 


KNOWLEDGE    OF    ANIMAL'S    WHOLE    HISTORY    REQUIRED.      43 

have  arisen  from  some  unknown  cause  at  a  former  period ;  from 
which  sprang  different  breeds  or  varieties,  such  as  those  of  our 
domesticated  animals ;  and  of  which  the  cessation  permits  the 
race  to  return  to  its  original  form,  as  takes  place  to  a  certain 
degree  when  domesticated  animals  resume  the  original  habits  of 
their  kind. 

21.  It  will  be  further  necessary,  that  the  Naturalist  should 
know  the  changes  of  form,  which  the  animals  he  is  considering 
may  undergo,  in  the  progress  of  their  growth  and  development ; 
so  as  not  to  separate  as  distinct  species,  those  which  are  but  dif- 
ferent stages  of  the  same.     And  he  ought,  further,  to  be  ac- 
quainted with  the  forms  of  both  sexes  ;  and  with  the  changes  in 
aspect  which  they  may  undergo,  from  the  influence  of  season, 
climate,  &c.  In  fact,  the  ichole  history  of  everv  species  of  animal 
ought  to   be   known   to   the  Naturalist,  before  he   begins   his 
arrangement ;  and  as  this  is  very  far  from  being  the  case  at  pre- 
sent, it  is  obvious  that  there  is  the  widest  scope  for  the  labours 
of  any  amount  of  observers,  and  that  many  corrections  will  have 
to  be  introduced  into  the  arrangements  which  Naturalists  have 
formed.     In  fact,  these  arrangements  must  be  regarded,  in  many 
instances,  as  provisional  or  temporary ;  to  be  confirmed,  or  set 
aside  in  favour  of  some  other  more  perfect,  by  increased  know- 
ledge. 

22.  Hence,  the  greatest  encouragement  may  be  offered  to 
those  who  are  commencing  the  pursuit  of  Natural  History,  on 
however  limited  a  scale  ;  for  every  one,  who  observes  accurately, 
and   (still  more)  who  collects  and  arranges  facts  with  the  guid- 
ance of  sufficient  previous  knowledge,  is  rendering  a  service  to 
Science.     Even  those  who  are  entirely  ignorant  of  Zoology  may 
do  much  in  this  way ;  but  their  chances  of  error  are  great ;  and 
they  should  be  careful  to  record  what  they  actually  see,  carefully 
separating  from  this  the  inferences  or  reasonings  which  they  have 
founded  upon  it.     But  those  who  have  some  previous  knowledge 
of  the  Science  may  do  much  more  ;  for  they  are  guided  by  it  how 
to  observe,  and  what  to  observe.     The  pleasure  which  is  derived 
from  a  country  walk,  or  from  a  visit  to  the  sea-coast,  is  thus 
enhanced  beyond  all  conception.     A  very  moderate  amount  of 


44        ADVANTAGES    OF    GENERAL    KNOWLEDGE    OF    ZOOLOGY. 

acquaintance  with  Botany  and  Entomology  will  direct  the 
rambler  among  the  fields  and  lanes,  to  many  objects  of  great 
interest,  which  the  ordinary  observer  would  pass  unnoticed  ;  and 
the  inspection  of  the  haunts  of  the  marine  tribes,  will  frequently 
lead  the  Naturalist,  who  may  have  previously  paid  them  but  a 
very  superficial  attention,  to  spectacles  of  the  rarest  and  most 
unexpected  beauty. 

23.  There  are  many  reasons  why  it  is  desirable  to  gain  a 
general  acquaintance  with  Zoology,  before  taking  up  any  single 
branch  as  a  regular  object  of  pursuit.  In  the  first  place,  the 
interest  which  is  derived  from  the  cultivation  of  the  science, 
is  very  much  increased,  by  the  wideness  of  the  field  which  is 
thus  embraced.  To  the  mere  Entomologist,  the  Birds,  the  Rep- 
tiles, the  land  and  fresh- water  Shells,  which  he  meets  with  in  the 
course  of  his  insect-hunting  rambles,  are  but  as  inanimate  objects, 
instead  of  furnishing  him  with  a  number  of  new  subjects  of 
interest.  The  mere  Ornithologist,  in  like  manner,  by  confining 
himself  exclusively  to  Birds,  misses  various  sources  of  gratifica- 
tion, which  a  small  amount  of  knowledge  of  other  branches  of 
Natural  History  would  enable  him  to  derive,  from  the  observa- 
tions to  which  he  would  be  led,  during  his  pursuit  of  the  fea- 
thered tribes;  and  the  mere  collector  of  Shells,  who  thinks  of 
nothing  but  the  completeness  of  his  cabinet,  not  only  misses  the 
opportunities  of  adding  to  our  very  limited  knowledge  of  the 
structure  and  habits  of  the  animals  which  form  them,  but  also 
loses  a  large  amount  of  pleasure,  which  he  might  derive  from  the 
observation  of  the  structure  and  habits  of  the  animals,  that  he 
would  meet  with  in  the  same  haunts.  Of  the  advantage  of  a 
general  interest  of  this  kind,  to  those  who  pursue  Natural  His- 
tory for  the  sake  of  the  healthful  and  agreeable  occupation  which 
it  affords  to  the  mind,  and  the  store  of  interesting  information 
which  it  opens  to  its  grasp,  we  cannot  have  a  better  proof  than 
the  pleasure  which  is  derived  from  the  perusal  of  the  simple 
record  of  such  observations,  in  such  works  as  White's  Natural 
History  of  Selborne,  Knapp's  Journal  of  a  Naturalist,  Gosse's 
Canadian  Naturalist,  and  Jesse's  Gleanings  in  Natural  History. 
And  to  those  who  make  some  particular  branch  of  Natural  His- 


NATURAL    SYSTEM    OF    CLASSIFICATION.  45 

tory  their  professed  object  of  pursuit,  it  is  equally  advantageous 
to  gain  a  previous  knowledge  of  the  general  plan  of  the  Animal 
Creation ;  since  the  characters  of  any  particular  division  of  it 
are  thereby  much  more  completely  understood, — relations  and 
analogies  of  the  greatest  interest  are  discerned,  which  would  have 
been  otherwise  overlooked, — and  the  labour  bestowed,  whether 
on  the  examination  of  the  structure,  or  on  the  systematic 
arrangement,  of  the  animals  particularly  sought  for,  is  rendered 
much  more  successful,  by  the  guidance  received  from  even 
a  very  moderate  general  acquaintance  with  Zoology. 

24.  The  principles  upon  which  Classification  should  be  founded 
in  Zoology,  are  now  generally  admitted.     It  is  not,  however, 
always  easy  to  apply  them.     All  Zoologists  aim  at  constructing 
a  Natural  System  ;  that  is,  a  system  which  shall  most  fully  de- 
velope  the  general  plan  upon  which  the  Creator  has  formed  and 
arranged  the  almost  numberless  species  of  animals,  which  owe 
their  existence  to  him.     NOWT,  this  system  must  be  constructed 
in  Zoology,  as  in  Botany,  by  the  careful  examination  of  the  whole 
conformation  of  each  species  (BOTANY,  §  486)  ;  and  by  not  resting 
satisfied  with  superficial  resemblances  as  indicating  affinity,  or 
with  variations  of  a  really  trivial,  though  perhaps  very  striking, 
kind,  as  proofs  of  dissimilarity.     Thus,  for  example,  by  the  un- 
informed, the  Whale  and  its  allies  are  commonly  associated  with 
the  class  of  Fishes,  to  which  they  bear  a  very  obvious  resemblance 
in   their   aquatic  habitation,   and  in  their  mode  of  propulsion 
through  the  water  ;  whilst  they  are  supposed  to  be  distinct  from 
the  Mammalia,  with  which  they  really  correspond  in   all   the 
characters  on  which  the  Naturalist  lays  most  stress,  because  they 
live  in  a  different  element,  and  have  bodies  formed  like  those  of 
Fishes. 

25.  Now,  here  we  are  led  to  perceive  the  difference  between 
characters  that  are  essential,  and  those  that  are  merely  adaptive. 
The  essential  characters,  by  which  different  classes  are  separated, 
have  all  reference  to  the  mode  in  which  some  or  other  of  the 
most  important  vital  functions  are  performed.     Thus,  true  Fishes 
breathe  by  means  of  gills,  in  which  the  blood  is  sufficiently  acted 
on  by  the  air  that  is  contained  in  the  water  around  them :  on 


46  NATURAL    SYSTEM    OF    CLASSIFICATION. 

the  other  hand,  Whales  breathe  by  means  of  lungs,  which  require 
to  be  filled  with  air  from  the  atmosphere ;  so  that  these  animals 
are  obliged  to  come  occasionally  to  the  surface  to  breathe.  Thus, 
the  function  of  respiration  is  conducted  on  a  plan  entirely  different 
in  these  two  groups.  Again,  the  heart  of  the  Fish  has  only  two 
cavities,  and  the  blood  does  not  return  to  it  after  passing  through 
the  gills,  but  is  immediately  distributed  to  the  body:  whilst  the 
heart  of  the  Whale  has  four  cavities,  and  the  blood  returns  to  it 
after  passing  through  the  lungs.  Hence,  the  plan  of  the  circula- 
tion also  is  entirely  different  in  the  two  classes, — being  single  in 
the  one,  and  double  in  the  other.  Again,  the  blood  of  the  Fishes 
is  cold,  and  that  of  the  Whales  is  warm ;  another  character  of 
great  importance,  in  regard  to  the  relative  activity  of  the  vital 
operations  in  general,  in  these  two  classes  respectively.  Further, 
Fishes  are  oviparous,  propagating  eggs,  from  which  the  young 
come  forth  in  due  time,  with  little  or  no  attention  on  the  part  of 
the  parent ;  whilst  Whales  are  viviparous,  producing  their  young 
alive,  and  nourishing  them  afterwards  by  suckling.  There  are 
also  many  other  points  in  the  formation  of  the  skeleton,  the  ner- 
vous system,  the  organs  of  secretion,  &c.  in  which  the  Whales 
differ  entirely  from  Fishes,  and  correspond  with  Mammals  ;  and 
these  embrace  all  the  essential  particulars  of  their  structure  and 
physiology. — The  points  of  resemblance  are  only  adaptive  ;  being 
such  as  enable  the  Mammal  to  become  an  inhabitant  of  an  aqua- 
tic element.  For  if  we  were  required  to  modify  a  Mammal,  in 
such  a  manner  that  it  might  lead  the  life  of  a  Fish,  we  should 
necessarily  alter  the  form  of  its  body,  so  that  it  might  be  enabled 
to  swim  through  the  water  with  as  little  resistance  as  possible ; 
and  we  should  also  adapt  its  instruments  of  propulsion  to  the 
new  medium  in  which  they  are  to  act,  and  in  which  the  feet  of 
a  terrestrial  quadruped  would  be  quite  useless  to  it. 

26.  Hence,  then,  in  a  natural  arrangement,  Whales  are  placed 
among  the  Mammals,  as  agreeing  with  them  in  all  essential  cha- 
racters; although  their  external  forms,  and  their  mode  of  life,  are 
so  different.  To  place  them  with  Fishes,  on  account  of  their 
resemblance  in  external  aspect,  would  be  to  adopt  an  artificial 
principle  of  classification ;  that  is,  a  principle  which  leads  us  to 


DIFFICULTIES    IN    CONSTRUCTION    OF    NATURAL    SYSTEM.       47 

associate  the  different  groups  of  animals,  from  their  correspondence 
in  some  one  or  two  simple  and  easily-recognised  characters — all 
the  rest  being  neglected.  By  following  out  such  a  principle,  we 
should  not  only  class  Whales  with  Fishes,  because  they  inhabit  the 
water,  and  have  their  bodies  formed  for  swimming,  but  we  should 
also  place  the  Bats  among  Birds,  because  they  fly,  and  should 
associate  together  Reptiles  and  ordinary  Mammals,  because  they 
walk  upon  four  feet.  No  such  classification  could  be  of  the  least 
use  ;  and,  consequently,  all  artificial  systems  have  been  long  given 
up  in  the  arrangement  of  the  Animal  Kingdom, — Zoologists 
applying  themselves  to  the  completion  of  a  Natural  Classification, 
in  which  every  animal  may  be  placed  among  those  to  which  it 
bears  the  greatest  general  resemblance,  and  in  which  its  relations 
to  others  may  be  exhibited. 

27.  There  are  great  difficulties  attending  the  completion  of 
such  a  System,  however,  arising  from  various  causes.  In  the 
first  place,  of  the  whole  number  of  animals  at  present  existing  on 
the  surface  of  the  earth,  a  large  proportion  are  probably  as  yet 
altogether  unknown  to  us.  This  proportion  is  less,  however, 
in  some  tribes  than  in  others.  Of  the  larger  Mammals  or 
Reptiles,  for  instance,  it  is  not  probable  that  many  living  species 
remain  to  be  discovered  ;  yet,  of  the  smaller  species,  it  is  certain, 
that  a  large  number  must  be  residents  of  countries  which  have 
been  as  yet  but  imperfectly  explored.  This  is  still  more  the  case  in 
regard  to  Birds  ;  and  of  the  whole  number  of  species  of  Insects, 
which  people  our  globe,  we  may  safely  affirm,  that  but  a  small 
proportion  have  been  yet  collected  by  Entomologists,  although 
the  amount  of  those  at  present  contained  in  their  cabinets  is  pro- 
bably not  far  short  of  100,000.  The  reasons  are  obvious  why  so 
little,  comparatively  speaking,  has  yet  been  done  for  this  depart- 
ment of  Zoology,  notwithstanding  the  number  of  persons  engaged 
in  the  pursuit  of  it ;  for  the  small  size  of  the  greater  number  of 
the  objects  it  embraces,  causes  them  to  escape  the  notice  of  ordi- 
nary observers ;  added  to  which,  there  are  many  species  that 
only  exist  in  their  perfect  state  during  a  few  days  or  even  hours, 
and  are  consequently  very  liable  to  elude  the  vigilance  of  the 
most  diligent  Entomologist.  Of  the  animals  which  inhabit  the 


48      IMPORTANCE  OF  STUDY  OF  FOSSILS  IN  ZOOLOGY. 

ocean,  or  live  on  its  borders, — the  various  tribes  of  Fishes,  Mol- 
lusca,  Crustacea,  Worms,  and  Zoophytes, — the  proportion  which 
yet  remains  to  be  discovered  is  douotless  very  large.  Even  on  the 
coasts  that  have  been  most  thoroughly  explored,  new  species  are 
continually  being  discovered;  and  these  are  often  very  dissimilar  in 
form  to  any  previously  known,  presenting  both  to  the  Naturalist 
and  to  the  Physiologist  many  points  of  the  greatest  interest. 

28.  But  it  is  not  only  in  the  extension  of  our  knowledge  of 
existing  species,  that  much  yet  remains  to  be  accomplished,  before 
the  foundation  of  a  Natural  Classification  can  be  regarded  as 
securely  laid.  No  system  can  be  complete,  which  does  not 
include  those  that  formerly  tenanted  the  globe,  as  well  as  those 
that  at  present  inhabit  it.  A  very  slight  knowledge  of  Fossil 
Zoology  is  sufficient  to  convince  the  Naturalist,  that  the  animals 
which  peopled  this  earth  in  its  earlier  ages  were  constructed 
upon  the  same  general  principles,  as  those  now  existing  upon  its 
surface ;  so  that  it  is  safe  to  reason  as  to  the  portions  of  their 
structure  that  are  not  preserved  (which  is  generally  the  case 
with  regard  to  their  softer  organs),  by  comparing  those  which 
are  with  the  corresponding  parts  of  animals  now  living.  Fre- 
quently it  is  found  that  peculiar  forms  of  structure,  which  are  at 
present  exhibited  in  but  few  and  comparatively  insignificant 
tribes,  were  formerly  displayed  in  races,  which  must  have  pos- 
sessed, from  their  number  and  power,  the  predominance  over  all 
the  rest  at  that  epoch.  This  is  the  case,  for  instance,  in  regard 
to  the  Saurian  (lizard-like)  Reptiles,  and  the  enamel  and  bony- 
scaled  Fishes.  Hence  we  should  not  understand  the  true  station 
of  these  as  natural  groups,  from  those  species  alone  which  at 
present  exist ;  these  being  only  the  few  and  feeble  remnants,  as 
it  were,  of  the  numerous  and  gigantic  races  which  they  represent. 
Still  more  frequently  does  it  happen,  that  gaps  or  deficiencies 
exist  in  the  groups,  which  are  formed  by  bringing  together  exist- 
ing animals  alone ;  and  that  these  groups  are  completed,  and  are 
connected  with  others  apparently  far  removed  from  them,  by 
species  which  existed  in  ages  long  since  past,  and  whose  fossil 
remains  are  preserved  to  us,  as  if  for  the  very  purposes  of  the 
Zoologist.  Thus,  for  example,  the  order  PACHYDERM  AT  A,  in  the 


RECOGNITION   OF    FOSSILS.  49 

class  Mammalia,  includes  a  small  number  of  large  animals — 
the  Elephant,  Rhinoceros,  Tapir,  Hippopotamus,  &c. — which 
stand  completely  apart,  as  it  were,  from  each  other,  not  being 
connected  by  intermediate  forms.  But  these  forms  are  abun- 
dantly supplied  by  the  numerous  species,  of  whose  former  exist- 
ence we  have  ample  evidence. 

29.  The  principles  on  which  most  of  the  leading  forms  have 
been  constructed,  in  the  higher  classes  at  least,  are  now  so  well 
understood,  that  the  Zoologist  has  no  difficulty  in  determining 
the  general  characters,  habits,  &c.,  of  the  animals  which  long  since 
tenanted  the  globe  and  its  waters ;  from  the  comparison  of  the 
structure  of  their  hard  parts,  with  those  of  the  existing  species  to 
which  they  are  most  nearly  related.  And  so  far  may  he  carry 
this  reasoning,  that,  from  the  extremity  of  a  single  bone,  he  may 
re-construct,  as  it  were,  in  his  imagination,  the  entire  animal ; 
and  may  form  an  accurate  judgment  of  its  size,  figure,  conforma- 
tion, and  even  of  its  habits.  This  has  been  often  tested,  by  the 
discovery  of  perfect  skeletons  of  animals,  which  had  been  pre- 
viously known  only  from  small  fragments,  but  of  which  a  very 
complete  account  had  been  given  from  these  by  a  sagacious 
Naturalist.  For  the  development  of  this  important  principle, 
the  Science  is  indebted  above  all  to  the  immortal  Cuvier,  whose 
future  reputation  will  be  founded  much  more  upon  his  researches 
into  the  History  of  Fossil  Remains,  than  upon  his  Zoological 
Classification,  which  is  continually  undergoing  great  modification. 
By  the  late  microscopic  inquiries  of  Professor  Owen,  it  has  been 
shown  that  the  minute  structure  of  the  teeth  of  Vertebrata  is 
capable  of  affording  characters  of  the  most  important  nature  in 
the  determination  of  fossil  animals ;  often  supplying  the  means 
of  ascertaining,  by  the  examination  of  an  unformed  fragment 
of  a  tooth,  not  merely  the  class  and  order,  but  even  the 
family  and  sometimes  the  genus,  to  which  the  animal  belonged. 
Some  analogous  inquiries,  respecting  the  minute  structure 
of  the  hard  parts  of  Invertebrata,  are  at  present  being  carried 
on  by  the  Author;  and  promise  to  lead  to  results  of  much 
value. 


50  INSUFFICIENT    KNOWLEDGE    OF    EXISTING    FORMS. 

30.  But  Fossil  Remains  are  sometimes  found,  which  perplex 
the  most  accomplished  Zoologist ;  their  dissimilarity  to  all  the 
forms  of  Animal  structure  with  'vhich  he  is  familiar,  being  such 
as  to  leave  him  very  much  in  the  dark,  as  to  the  true  characters 
and  positions  of  the  animals,  of  which  they  are  the  sole  represen- 
tatives.    It  is  probable,  however,  that  the  progress  of  discovery 
will  bring  to  light  new  facts  regarding  their  structure ;  either  by 
affording  more  complete  specimens  of  the  remains  themselves,  by 
which  it  may  be  better  understood ;  or  by  disclosing  to  us  some 
points  in  the  structure  or  history  of  existing  animals,  which  shall 
unveil  the  close  relationship  that  they  may  really  bear,  although 
this  is  at  present   obscured     by   superficial   differences    (§32). 
In  this  manner,  therefore,  we  may  expect  that  many  spaces  in 
our  Classification   will  be  hereafter  filled  up,  which  at  present 
appear  to  be  altogether  blank. 

31.  It  is  not  only,  however,  from  the  incompleteness  of  our 
knowledge  of  the  various  kinds  of  Animals,  at  present  or  for- 
merly existing,  that  the  foundations  of  a  sound  Zoological  classi- 
fication are  as  yet  very  imperfect ;  for  of  a  large  part  of  those, 
with  whose  external  forms  the  Naturalist  is  familiar,  the  internal 
structure  has  been  but  very  imperfectly,  or  not  at  all,  investi- 
gated.    Hence,  a  great  part  of  their  arrangement  into  groups  is 
founded  upon  a  small  number  of  characters  only ;  and  not  at  all 
upon  that  general  comparison  of  them,  which  alone  can  securely 
indicate  their  real  relationship.     There  is,  consequently,  a  field 
for  investigation,  in  this  department  alone,  which  may  occupy 
an  almost  unlimited  number  of  inquirers  for  a  very  long  time  ; 
and  any  such  systematic  examination,  even   of  very  common 
animals,  if  prosecuted  with  a  sufficient  amount  of  guidance  from 
previous  knowledge,  would  be  attended  with  the  utmost  ad- 
vantage to  science.     And  it  is  not  only  in  determining  the  true 
relations  or  affinities  of  species  or  of  groups,  which  are  known  to 
be  nearly  allied,  that  this  kind  of  knowledge  is  available  ;  for  it 
often  serves  to  indicate  the  most  unexpected  and  beautiful  analo- 
gies, between  groups  far  distant  from  each  other,  but  occupying 
a  corresponding  place  in  their  respective  classes.     Thus  we  shall 


KNOWLEDGE  OF  AFFINITIES  DERIVED  FROM  METAMORPHOSIS.      51 

find  many  points  of  analogy  between  the  order  Carnivora  among 
Mammals,  and  that  of  Raptores  among  Birds ;  each  including 
those  predaceous  species,  which  are  especially  adapted  to  capture 
and  devour  the  weaker  kinds  ;  and  each  having  its  own  particu- 
lar type  or  plan  of  structure  adapted  to  this  purpose,  in  a  manner 
that  strongly  reminds  us  of  the  other.  It  is  by  the  existence  of 
these  analogies  among  distant  groups,  that  the  Unity  of  the  Plan 
of  the  Animal  Creation  is  most  clearly  manifested ;  and  every 
one  which  we  discover  affords  us  a  new,  and  often  very  striking, 
glimpse  of  this  design.  The  most  important  of  them  will  be 
pointed  out  in  their  proper  places. 

32.  Further,  the  changes  of  form  which  many  tribes  of  ani- 
mals undergo,  and  of  which  we  as  yet  have  but  a 
very  imperfect  knowledge,  are  often  very  im- 
portant in  classification  ;  as  indicating  relations 
which  we  should  not  have  otherwise  suspected, 
between  different  groups.  Thus,  there  is  a  cer- 
tain parasitic  animal  of  very  strange  form,  whicli 
attaches  itself  to  Fishes,  and  is 
named  Lerncca  (Fig.  7) ;  the 
true  position  of  which  in  the 
animal  scale  was  not  known,  un- 
til it  was  ascertained  that  it  passes 
through  a  larva,  or  imperfect 
state  (Fig.  8),  in  which  it  bears  Fio  8_LARVA  OF 
so  very  close  a  resemblance  to  the 
larva  (Fig.  9)  of  the  Cyclops 


Fio.  7 — LERNJEA, 


THE  LERNVEA. 


Fio.  9.— LARVA  OF  THE  CYCLOPS. 


Fio.  10.— CYCLOPS, 


(Fig.  10), — a  little  animal  common  in  pools,  and  known  under 

•  2 


52       KNOWLEDGE  OF  AFFINITIES  DERIVED  FROM  METAMORPHOSIS. 


the  name  of  Water-flea, — that  their  real  relationship  is  apparent. 
In  fact,  they  may  be  said  to  have  been  originally  formed  on 
the  same  plan  or  type ;  but  to  Lave  afterwards  departed  from  it, 
— each  in  a  different  direction, — so  as  to  become  very  unlike  one 
another  in  their  adult  forms.  A  still  more  striking  illustration 
may  be  derived  from  the  metamorphosis  of  the  animals  of  the 
class  of  Cirrhipods,  or  Barnacle  tribe  (Figs.  11  and  12).  These 
were  formerly  placed  among  the  Mollusca,  on  account  of  their 
resemblance  to  that  group,  in  having  their  soft  bodies  enclosed 
within  shells,  in  remaining  constantly  attached  to  some  other 
object,  whether  fixed  or  floating,  and  in  the  absence  of  any 
distinct  division  of  the  body  into  segments.  But  it  was  pointed 
out  by  Cuvier,  that  the  arrangement  of  the  arms  and  of  the 
nervous  centres  is  such,  as  to  entitle  them  to  a  place  in  the 
Articulated,  rather  than  in  the  Molluscous  series, — that  is,  to 

be  associated  rather  with 
Insects,  Spiders,  and  Crabs, 
than  with  Oysters,  Snails, 
and  "Whelks.  More  recent- 
ly, it  has  been  shown  that 
they  undergo  a  very  curious 
metamorphosis, — having  in 
their  early  state  a  form 
not  very  unlike  that  of  the 
early  state  of  the  common 
Crab  (Fig.  6),  possessing 
eyes,  and  the  power  of  free 
movement — but  afterwards 
becoming  fixed  to  one  spot 
for  the  remainder  of  their  lives,  losing  their  eyes,  and  forming 
a  shell,  which,  though  composed  of  several  pieces,  has  nothing 
in  common  with  the  jointed  shell  of  the  Crab  or  Lobster.  Hence 
the  affinity  of  the  Cirrhipods  to  the  Crustacea,  unlikely  as  it 
seemed  at  first,  has  been  clearly  demonstrated  by  these  obser- 
vations. 

33.     Now,  we  shall  suppose  that  these  difficulties  had  been 


Fro.  11 — SHELL  OF 
THE  BARNACLE. 


FIG.  12 BODY  OF 

THE  BARNACLE. 


MODE    OP    ARRANGING    SPECIES    NATURALLY.  53 

overcome,  and  that  all  the  animals  forming  a  particular  group 
had  been  collected,  and  their  internal,  as  well  as  external 
structure  carefully  examined  ; — in  what  way,  it  may  be  asked, 
should  we  attempt  to  arrange  them  ?  Is  it  possible  to  form 
such  a  classification,  as  that  they  may  be  placed  one  after 
another  in  a  single  line  or  series,  uninterruptedly  connecting 
the  lowest  and  the  highest  forms?  An  excellent  answer  to 
this  question  is  contained  in  the  following  quotation  from  the 
writings*  of  a  distinguished  Naturalist,  who  has  done  much 
for  the  advance  of  Zoology ;  although  (in  the  opinion  of  the 
Author)  he  has  erred  by  not  following  Nature,  but  by  attempt- 
ing to  apply  a  system  of  his  own  creation,  or  at  least  founded 
upon  a  limited  and  imperfect  generalization,  to  the  arrangement 
of  the  Animal  series.  "Let  us  suppose,"  he  says,  "that  an 
Entomological  student,  with  a  well-filled  cabinet  of  unarranged 
insects,  having  his  mind  well  stored  with  those  simple  facts 
regarding  their  structure  and  economy,  which  he  is  to  look  upon 
as  solid  data, — let  us  suppose  him  to  commence  the  arrange- 
ment of  the  objects  before  him,  according  to  what  he  thinks 
their  true  affinities,  and  with  a  view  of  verifying  or  discovering 
their  natural  arrangement.  He  commences  by  placing,  one  after 
the  other,  those  species  which  bear  the  greatest  mutual  resem- 
blances, and  for  a  time  he  proceeds  satisfactorily, — he  finds  the 
several  links  in  the  chain,  as  it  were,  fit  into  each  other  so  har- 
moniously, that  he  begins  to  think  the  task  much  easier  than 
he  at  first  expected  ;  and  that  he  will  not  only  be  able  to  prove, 
by  these  very  examples  before  him,  the  absolute  connection  of 
one  given  genus  to  another,  but  also  to  demonstrate  that  the 
scale  of  nature  is  simple, — that  is,  passing  in  a  straight  line 
from  the  highest  to  the  lowest  organised  forms.  All  these  ideas, 
however  (generally  resulting  from  partial  reasoning  or  from 
limited  information),  are  soon  found  to  be  fallacious.  As  the 
student  proceeds,  he  meets  with  some  insects  which  disturb  the 
regularity  of  his  series,  and  with  others  which  he  knows  not  where 

*  Swainson's  Discourse  on  the  Study  of  Natural  History,  in   Lardner's  Cyclo- 
paedia, p.  201. 


54  MODE    OF   ARRANGING    SPECIES   NATURALLY. 

to  place.  He  still  goes  on,  however,  introducing  the  former  in 
the  best  way  he  can,  among  those  to  which  they  have  an  evident 
affinity,  and  placing  the  lattei  by  themselves,  in  the  hope  of 
finally  discovering  their  proper  place.  The  further  he  proceeds, 
however,  these  difficulties  are  rather  increased  than  diminished. 
He  remodels  his  groups,  and  alters  his  series ;  still  he  cannot 
reduce  all  into  harmonious  order.  What  he  gains  by  one  modi- 
fication of  arrangement,  he  loses  in  another ;  and  affinities  which 
were  preserved  in  his  first  series,  are  destroyed,  that  a  place  may 
be  found  for  other  insects,  which  seem  to  have  equally  strong 
relations,  although  in  some  respects  they  evidently  disturb  the 
order  of  progression. 

34.  "  But  his  difficulties  do  not  terminate  here ;  for,  admit- 
ting the  possibility  of  his  success  in  bringing  every  species  into 
an  appropriate  group,  the  union  of  these  groups  among  them- 
selves opens  a  new  source  of  embarrassment.  It  is  plain  that,  in 
the  order  of  nature,  they  must  follow  one  another  in  some  sort ; 
for,  if  there  were  no  progression  of  development,  all  animals 
would  be  equally  perfect — that  is  to  say,  would  have  the  same 
complexity  of  structure.  Here,  then,  lies  his  difficulty.  He 
perceives,  perhaps,  an  evident  affinity  between  two  groups,  by 
species  which  seem  to  blend  them  together,  and  to  conduct  him, 
by  an  almost  insensible  gradation,  from  one  to  the  other.  He 
therefore  concludes  this  to  be  the  natural  series,  and  he  approxi- 
mates them  accordingly.  Presently,  however,  upon  looking  more 
attentively  to  his  other  unsorted  groups,  he  finds  not  only  one, 
but  several,  each  of  which,  in  some  way  or  other,  shows  an 
approximation  just  as  close  to  his  first  group,  as  that  does  which 
he  had  previously  made  to  follow  it ;  and  he  is  as  much  at  a  loss 
how  to  dispose  his  groups  in  natural  succession,  as  he  was  how  to 
place  the  species  they  contain.  The  same  results  also  attend  his 
attempts  at  improving  his  arrangement  of  groups ;  what  is  gained 
by  shifting  one  so  as  to  follow  another,  is  lost  by  dissevering  it 
from  that  with  which  it  was  previously  united :  until,  with  all 
his  assiduity  and  trials,  he  finds,  that  there  is  still  a  remnant  of 
*  unknown  things,"1  which  stand  disconnected,  as  it  were,  from  the 


TYPES  OP  NATURAL  GROUPS.  55 

series  he  has  formed,  and  which  cannot  be  made  to  fall  into  place 
by  any  contrivance  he  can  devise." 

35.  The  difficulties  which  are  thus  detailed  as  existing  in  the 
classification  of  Insects,  are  equally  felt  in  every  other  depart- 
ment of  Zoology;  and  they  result  from  this, — that  every  natural 
group  or  assemblage  of  species,  united  by  certain  characters  com- 
mon to  all,  is  connected,  not  with  two  groups  merely,  one  above 
and  the  other  below  it,  but  with  several;  and  that,  of  the  different 
modifications  which  these  characters  present,  a  large  part  are  such 
as  to  form  the  transitions  from  one  to  another.    In  every  natural 
assemblage,  there  is  some  one  which  presents  the  characters  that 
are  common  to  them,  in  a  more  remarkable  and  complete  manner 
than  the  rest — and  this  is  called  the  type  of  the  group.     Thus, 
each  genus  has  its  typical  species;  each  family  its  typical  genus; 
each  order  its  typical  family ;  and  each  class  its  typical  order  : 
the  type,  in  each  instance,  being  that  subdivision  to  which  our 
minds  naturally  revert,  as  best  exhibiting  the  characters  that  be- 
long to  the  entire  group.     "We  may  regard  the  type  of  each  genus 
as  forming  its  centre;  and  the  other  species  as  having  their  places 
at  a  greater  or  less  distance  from  it,  according  as  they  differ  from 
it  more  or  less  in  their  respective  characters.     Some  there  are 
which  do  not  depart  widely  from  the  type;  whilst  there  are 
others  which  differ  from  it  to  such  a  degree,  that  we  might  have 
failed  to  recognise  the  connection,  if  it  were  not  completely  shown 
by  intermediate  links.     These  are  called  aberrant  forms.     Now, 
we  will   suppose   the   centres  or   types   of  these  groups  to  be 
spread  out  over  a  surface,  so  that  each  should  be  surrounded  by 
a  number  of  others  most  nearly  allied  to  it ;  we  should  then  find, 
that  we  might  arrange  the  different  species  round  these  centres 
respectively,  so  as  to  form  groups,  of  which  every  one  shall  come 
into  contact  with  others,  by  species  that  blend,  more  or  less  com- 
pletely, the  characters  of  both. 

36.  The  following  illustration  will,  it  is  hoped,  make  this 
matter  plain.     We  will  suppose  a  large  territory  occupied  by  a 
number  of  distinct  tribes  of  people,  whose  respective  possessions 
are  not  separated  by  any  very  distinct  bounds,  but  of  which  every 


56          ILLUSTRATION   OF   TYPICAL   AND  CONNECTING   FORMS. 

one  is  characterised  by  possessing  a  dialect  peculiar  to  itself.  We 
will  further  imagine,  that  the  principal  residence  of  each  tribe  is 
in  the  centre  of  the  district ;  and  It  will,  of  course,  be  there,  that 
we  should  expect  to  find  the  peculiar  dialect  of  the  tribe  in  the 
greatest  perfection.  For  those  members  of  the  tribe,  which  live 
near  the  borders  of  the  territory,  naturally  acquire,  from  inter- 
mixture with  the  borderers  of  the  several  other  tribes  which  sur- 
round them,  some  combination  of  other  dialects,  whilst  their  own 
is  spoken  with  less  purity  ;  so  that,  however  easy  it  might  be  to 
recognise,  by  their  difference  of  speech,  the  inhabitants  of  the 
central  portions  of  the  respective  districts,  those  that  reside  near 
the  line  which  divides  one  from  another,  do  not  present  the  dis- 
tinctive peculiarity  of  either,  in  a  sufficient  degree  to  enable  us  to 
determine  to  which  they  belong. 

37.  Further,  all  these  tribes  may  agree  in  the  possession  of  a 
common  language^  although  they  speak  different  dialects  of  it ; 
and  may  be  united,  by  this  and  by  other  characters,  into  a  nation, 
to  which  a  certain  territory  belongs.  Other  nations,  each  in  like 
manner  composed  of  several  tribes,  may  inhabit  the  countries  on 
its  borders ;  and  every  one  may  have  its  capital  city  in  the  centre 
of  the  region  it  occupies,  where  the  national  characters  are  most 
fully  displayed,  and  the  language  spoken  in  the  greatest  perfection. 
Now  the  tribes  which  live  near  the  boundaries  that  divide  one 
nation  from  another,  will  have  just  the  same  tendency  to  acquire 
each  other's  national  peculiarities,  as  the  individuals,  that  live  near 
the  borders  which  separate  the  tribes  (provided  there  be  no  ob- 
stacle interposed  by  the  nature  of  the  country),  have  to  acquire 
each  other's  minor  peculiarities ;  so  that,  in  travelling  from  one 
capital  to  another,  we  should  not  find  ourselves  suddenly  trans- 
ferred from  a  people  marked  by  one  set  of  characters,  to  another 
presenting  a  different  series ;  but  should  be  able  to  trace,  as  we 
travel  from  the  capital  towards  the  borders  of  one  kingdom,  a 
gradual  shado wing-off  of  its  characters,  so  that  we  may  enter  the 
other  without  being  aware  of  any  decided  change,  until  we 
approach  the  capital  in  which  its  national  peculiarities  are  fully 
displayed.  This  is  very  much  the  case  in  regard  to  the  division 


ILLUSTRATION    OF    TYPICAL    AND    CONNECTING    FORMS.         57 

between  England  and  Scotland ;  the  residents  on  the  two  sides 
of  the  Border  having  many  of  the  characteristics  of  both  nations, 
so  that  the  English  character  is  not  fully  displayed  in  the  northern 
counties  of  England,  nor  the  Scotch  in  the  most  southern  parts  of 
Scotland.  Further,  as  each  nation  may  be  supposed  to  be  sur- 
rounded, not  by  one,  but  by  several  others,  it  will  have  a  tendency 
to  blend  in  this  manner  with  them  all ;  so  that  of  its  national 
peculiarities,  some  are  lost  as  we  pass  in  one  direction,  some  in 
another,  thus  gradually  obliterating  the  differences  which  may 
exist  between  itself  and  the  various  peoples  that  surround  it.  By 
this  comparison  we  may  represent  the  manner,  in  which  natural 
families,  each  consisting  of  several  distinct  genera,  are  related  to 
each  other ;  and  in  which  they  tend  to  unite,  through  links  of  con- 
nection, which  are  formed  by  the  blending  of  the  characters  of 
two  or  more  in  the  same  tribe. 

38.  Lastly,  we  shall  suppose  all  the  nations  inhabiting  one 
continent,  or  quarter  of  the  globe,  to  have  certain  points  of  gene- 
ral resemblance  to  each  other,  whilst  differing  in  a  large  number  of 
characters  •  and  that  those  by  which  other  continents  are  peopled, 
also  agree  among  themselves,  and  differ  from  the  rest  in  the  same 
manner.     Although,  in  consequence  of  the  more  distinct  separa- 
tion between  the  regions  they  respectively  inhabit,  there  might 
not  be  so  much  tendency  to  the  blending  of  the  characters  of  those 
different  races,  which  live  most  near  to  each  other  on  the  borders 
of  their  respective  continents,  yet  some  approximation  might 
be  expected ;  and  this  would  take  place  on  the  same  plan, — 
the  characters    of    the    nations  that    live   on    the   borders   of 
any  continent,  partaking  in  some  degree   of  those  of  the  people 
of  other  continents  on  the  opposite  side  of  their  respective  boun- 
daries.     In   this   manner  we  may   represent  the-relationships 
that  exist   between  the  orders,  into    which    the  families    are 
united, — or  between  the  classes,  which  are  formed  by  the  union 
of  orders, — or  between  the  sub-kingdoms,  or  primary  subdivi- 
sions of  the  Animal  Kingdom,  which  are  formed  by  a  union  of 
classes. 

39.  It  is  probable,  that  every  natural  group,  if  we  were  in 


58  EXAMPLES    OF    CONNECTION    BETWEEN    ORDERS. 

possession  of  all  the  forms  which  it  contains,  would  present  links 
of  transition  such  as  these,  towards  the  groups  which  surround  it. 
But,  for  the  reasons  already  stated  (§27-30),  they  are  frequently 
wanting,  although  they  are  continually  being  brought  to  light  by 
the  rapid  extension  of  Zoological  research.  A  few  examples  of 
this  kind  may  be  here  adverted  to.  It  has  been  already  stated, 
that  the  different  families  and  genera  of  the  order  Pachydermata, 
widely  as  they  appear  to  be  separated  when  we  look  at  the  exist- 
ing species  alone,  are  in  reality  connected  most  closely  by  fossil 
species,  which  present  the  most  remarkable  and  interesting  com- 
binations of  characters,  that  are  now  found  separately  in  the 
forms  with  which  we  are  familiar.  The  chief  of  these  will  be 
pointed  out  in  their  proper  place.  The  dif- 
ferent orders  of  Reptiles,  although  very  dis- 
tinct as  regards  their  types, — viz.  Turtles, 
Lizards,  Serpents,  and  Frogs, — are  yet  most 
closely  connected  together  by  links  of  tran- 
sition, that  pass  between  the  typical  forms. 
Thus,  between  the  Turtles  (Fig.  13),  and 
the  Lizards  (Fig.  14),  the  passage  is  esta- 
blished by  species  of  Turtles,  which  have  a 
long  neck,  tail,  and  legs,  and  a  small  shell, 
which  only  covers  a  part  of  the  back,  (known 
F/O.  ^-TORTOISE.  ag  Alligator  Tortoises,)— and  species  of 
Lizards,  that  have  a  very  firm  covering  of  large  scales  or  plates 


FJG.  14,— CROCODILE. 


on  the  back,  which  reminds  us  of  the  shell  of  the  Turtle. 
Again,  from  the  true  or  typical  Lizards,  which  have  four  legs, 
we  pass  to  the  Serpents  (Fig.  15),  which  have  none,  by  means 
of  such  species  of  Lizards  as  the  one  represented  in  Fig.  16, 
which  have  the  body  and  tail  very  much  prolonged,  and  the 


EXAMPLES    OP    CONNECTION    BETWEEN   ORDERS. 


59 


legs  very  short,  and  such  Serpents  as  have  the  rudiments  of  legs 
existing  in  the  skeleton,  but  concealed  beneath  the  skin  in  the 
living  animal.  Of  these,  the  common  Blind- worm,  or  Slow- 
worm  of  this  country,  is  a  cha- 
racteristic example  ;  for  so 
completely  does  it  blend  the 
characters  of  the  Lizard  and 
Serpent  tribes,  that  it  has  been 
placed  by  some  Zoologists  in 
one,  and  by  some  in  the  other. 
With  the  Frog  tribe  the  class 
of  Serpents  is  connected  by  a 
very  interesting  animal — the 
Ccecilia,  or  Blind  Snake;  which 
has  the  general  form  of  the 
snake  tribe,  but  which,  in  fact, 
really  belongs  to  the  order 
Batrachia,  having  a  skin  des- 
titute of  scales,  and  being 
found  to  undergo  a  metamorphosis,  having  at  one  period  (like 
the  Frog,  &c.)  the  same  form  of  the  circulating  and  respiratory 
organs  as  the  Fish. 


FIG.  15— NAIA  ASPIC. 


FIG.  1C— CHALCIS. 


40.  But  the  order  Batrachia  is  not  connected  with  the  other 
tribes  of  Reptiles  by  one  link  of  transition  only ;  for  it  contains 
animals  which  may  be  regarded  as  representing  the  Turtles  and 
Lizards  in  its  own  group, — just  as  the  Bats  represent  Birds,  and 
the  Whales  represent  Fishes,  among  the  Mammalia.  Thus, 
there  is  a  species  of  Frog  in  South  America,  whose  back  is  covered 


60 


EXAMPLES    OF    CONNECTION    BETWEEN    CLASSES. 


Flo  17._WATER.NEWT. 


FIG.  18.— AGAMA. 


with  a  hard,  horny  skin,  that  reminds  us  of  the  shell  of  the 
Turtle ;  and  we  have  in 

the  ponds  and  ditches  *s   *  ^ 

of  our  own  country 
more  than  one  species 
of  the  Water-newt, 
(Fig.  17),  which  has 
the/orwof  the  Lizard, 
whilst,  in  its  metamorphosis  and  internal  structure,  it  corresponds 
with  the  Frog.  Among  the  Lizards,  again,  there  is  a  tribe  that 

is  characterised  by  its 
flattened  body  and 
Frog-like  form.  One 
species  of  these  is  seen 
in  Fig.  18 ;  but  there 
are  others,  in  which 
the  tail  is  shorter,  and 
the  body  broader,  so  as  still  more  to  resemble  that  of  a  Frog. 
Thus,  we  have  not  only  the  connecting  link  of  the  Lizard-like 
Frog,  but  of  the  Frog-like  Lizard  ;  the  essential  characters  of  one 
of  the  groups  being  preserved  in  each  case,  but  displayed  under 
the  form  of  the  other. 

41.  Of  a  complete  series 
of  transitional  forms  be- 
tween two  classes,  moreover, 
we  have  a  beautiful  instance 
in  the  case  of  Reptiles  and 
Fishes.  One  of  these  tran- 
sitions is  established  by  the 
metamorphosis  of  the  Frog 
tribe  already  adverted  to  (§  18) ;  but  the  connection  is  shown 
also  in  certain  species,  which,  even  in  their  adult  state,  possess 
both  lungs  and  gills,  and  which  have  the  whole  of  their  conforma- 
tion intermediate  between  that  of  the  true  Fishes  and  that  of 
Reptiles.  Of  this  kind  are  the  Axolotl  (Fig.  19),  which  is  undoubt- 
edly a  Reptile,  since  the  characters  of  the  Reptile  predo- 


FlG,  19.— AxOLOTt. 


EXAMPLES    OF    CONNECTION    BETWEEN    CLASSES. 


61 


minate  over  those  of  the  Fish;  and  the  Lepidosiren  (Fig.  20), 

in  which  the  characters  of  the 
two  classes  are  so  completely 
blended,  that  Zoologists  have 
not  yet  agreed  on  which  side 
it  should  be  placed.  Again, 
the  Lizards  and  Serpents  are 
closely  connected  with  Fishes 
by  two  very  remarkable  ani- 
mals, not  now  existing,  the 
Ichthyosaurus  (Fig.  21),  and 
the  Plesiosaurus  (Fig,  22)  ; 
whose  remains  abound,  in  cer- 
tain rocks,  to  such  an  extent  as  to  show,  that  they  must  have  been 


FIG.  20.— LKPIDOSIREN. 


FIG.  21. — ICHTHYOSAURUS. 


formerly  very  numerous.  On  the  other  hand,  there  are  certain  spe- 
cies of  Fishes  (which  were  more  numerous  and  abundant  at  for- 


Fio.  22 — PLESIOSAURUS. 


mer  epochs  than  at  present),  in  whose  conformation  there  is  much 
that  reminds  us  of  the  Lizards  ;  very  distinct  rudiments  of  lungs 
being  present,  and  the  vertebral  column  and  ribs  possessing 
many  characters,  in  which  they  resemble  those  of  that  order  of 
Reptiles.  In  the  Eels,  again,  we  have  the  form  of  the  Serpent 


62 


EXAMPLE    OF    CONNECTION    BETWEEN    SUB-KINGDOMS. 


so  exactly  repeated,  that  it  is  not  easy  to  distinguish  the  group  to 
which  certain  species  belong,  by  a  cursory  glance  at  their  exterior. 
42.  Lastly,  we  may  advert  tj  an  instance,  in  which  even 
two  sub-kingdoms  are  connected,  by  links  of  transition  so  close, 
that  it  is  not  easy  to  say  where  one  begins  and  the  other  termi- 
nates. Among  the  Mollusca,  but  occupying  the  lowest  place  in 
that  division,  are  usually  ranged  a  collection  of  animals,  which 
do  not  possess  a  shell,  but  which  have  their  organs  enclosed  as  it 
were  in  a  bag  or  tunic ;  from  which  they  derive  the  name  of 
Tunicata.  None  of  them  have  any  considerable  power  of  spon- 
taneous movement ;  and  a  large  proportion  of  them  are  fixed 
during  their  whole  lives.  Many  of  them  are  social  in  their 
habits ;  that  is,  a  number  of  them  live  together,  adhering  to  each 
other  by  their  external  surfaces.  But  there  are  some  which  not 
only  adhere  together,  but  which  are  more  closely  connected ; — 
a  number  being  included  in  one  common  envelope ;  or  being 
attached  singly  to  a  connecting  stem,  as  shown  in  Fig.  23. 

Now,  in  these  last  cases, 
they  propagate,  not  only 
in  the  manner  of  the  other 
Mollusca,  by  the  deposi- 
tion of  eggs,  but  also  in 
the  manner  of  the  Po- 
lypes, by  gemmation  or 
budding  ;  for  all  the  ani- 
mals forming  one  cluster, 
or  mounted  upon  one 
stem,  proceed  from  a 
single  individual,  which  has  thus  extended  itself  in  the  manner 
of  a  Plant.  The  simplicity  of  the  structure  of  these  animals  is 
very  great.  The  tunic  has  two  orifices,  b  and  «,  through  the 
former  of  which,  water  is  continually  drawn  in,  whilst  through 
the  latter  it  is  as  constantly  expelled.  The  liquid  enters  a  large 
chamber,  which  may  be  regarded  as  a  dilated  pharynx  or  gullet  ; 
and  at  the  bottom  of  this  lies  the  entrance  to  the  stomach,  e, 
from  which  the  intestinal  tube,  i,  passes  to  the  orifice  of  dis- 


FIG.  23. — SOCIAL  ASCIDIJE. 


EXAMPLE    OF    CONNECTION    BETWEEN    SUB-KINGDOMS.  63 

charge,  a.     Now,  there  are  certain  species  of  Polypes  (termed 
Bryozoa),  of  which  one  form  is  shown  in  Fig.  24,  that  have  a 


c 
FIG.  24. — PLUMATKLLA  ;  a,  NATURAL  SIZE  ;  6,  A  GROUP  ENLARGED  ;  c,  ANAL  ORIFICE. 

structure  almost  identical  in  all  its  most  obvious  characters. 
The  principal  apparent  difference  is  in  the  presence,  in  these  last, 
of  two  or  more  arms,  which  are  covered  with  cilia  (ANIM. 
PHYSIOL.  §117)>  by  whose  vibration  the  currents  are  established, 
that  convey  food  to  the  mouth.  In  the  Tunicata,  however, 
the  mechanism  is  essentially  the  same ;  but  the  cilia  are  disr 
posed  in  the  lining  of  the  interior  chamber.  So  far,  then,  it 
would  appear  that  the  resemblance  is  so  great,  as  to  permit 
these  two  groups  to  be  associated  in  one  class,  the  place  of  which 
would  be  at  the  head  of  the  Polypes ;  and  this  has  actually  been 
done  by  M.  Milne  Edwards,  a  Naturalist  of  great  eminence, 
who  has  given  much  attention  to  both  groups.  But  there  are 
certain  considerations  which  lead  the  Author  to  the  belief,  that 
the  Tunicata  are  still  to  be  ranked  among  the  Mollusca,  and  the 
Bryozoa  among  the  Polypes ;  the  principal  of  which  are  these. 


64  PRINCIPLES    OF    NATURAL    ARRANGEMENT. 

The  Tunicata  possess  a  distinct  heart,  and  system  of  blood- 
vessels, no  trace  of  which  can  be  discovered  in  the  Bryozoa ;  and 
this  is  a  character  of  great  importance.  Moreover,  they  have  a 
nervous  system,  which  is  arranged  upon  the  type  of  that  of  the 
Mollusca,  though  in  its  most  degraded  form  (ANIM.  PHYSIOL. 
§  435)  ;  whilst  that  of  the  Bryozoa,  if  discoverable,  would 
almost  certainly  present  the  radiated  arrangement,  as  in  other 
Polypes.  Besides,  the  power  of  propagation  by  budding  is  not 
confined  to  the  Polypes ;  for  it  exists  also  in  the  lower  Articu- 
lata  (ANIM.  PHYSIOL.  §  729)  ;  so  that  it  is  not  surprising  to 
meet  with  it  in  the  lowest  Mollusca  also.  Hence  we  shall  pro- 
bably be  most  correct,  in  regarding  the  Tunicata  as  Mollusca, 
which  exhibit  links  of  transition  to  the  Radiated  sub-kingdom, 
through  their  affinity  with  the  Polypes ;  whilst  the  Bryozoa 
are  Polypes  which  present  strong  points  of  resemblance  to  the 
Mollusca",  in  the  elevation  of  their  plan  of  structure  above  that 
of  others  of  their  class. 

43.  It  can  only  be,  then,  by  the  careful  comparison  of  the  dif- 
ferent forms  of  animal  structure,  that  we  can  select  those,  which 
are  entitled  to  rank  as  types  of  groups ;  and  it  is  in  this  that  the  skill 
of  the  Zoologist  is  most  displayed.  Having  satisfied  himself,  how- 
ever, which,  are  to  be  regarded  as  types — i.  e.  as  presenting  their 
respective  plans  of  structure  with  the  most  completeness, — he 
proceeds  to  range  around  these  such  forms  as  have  a  close  resem- 
blance to  them  ;  placing  them  nearer  or  more  distant,  according 
to  the  degree  in  which  the  characters  of  resemblance  or  of  differ- 
ence predominate ;  and  taking  care  that  the  intermediate  forms 
shall  be  so  arranged,  as  to  form  links  of  transition  towards  the 
other  types,  of  whose  characters  they  partake.  Whenever  this 
process  shall  have  been  accomplished  for  the  whole  Animal 
kingdom  (as  it  has  been  in  some  degree  for  certain  divisions  of 
it),  we  shall  be  in  possession  of  a  Natural  System,  as  com- 
plete as  the  deficiency  in  our  materials  permits  it  to  be.  At 
present,  any  general  classification  can  afford  but  an  approximation 
to  it ;  and  the  one  which  is  adopted  in  the  following  Treatise, 
is  not  put  forward  by  the  Author,  as  by  any  means  destitute 


VARYING   IMPORTANCE    OF   CHARACTERS.  65 

of  imperfections,  but  as  the  one  which  he  regards  as  most  free 
from  faults  and  difficulties,  of  any  yet  proposed.  In  almost 
every  instance,  he  has  adopted  the  views  of  some  eminent  Natu- 
ralist, who  has  paid  especial  attention  to  that  particular  group  ; 
and  the  authority  whom  he  has  chiefly  followed,  will  be  men- 
tioned under  each  head. 

44.  It  is  a  question  of  the  greatest  importance  in  Classifica- 
tion, what   characters   are  to   be   relied  on  for  distinguishing 
species,  what  for  separating  genera,  what  for  dividing  families, 
— and  so  on.     To  this  question  no  satisfactory  answer  can  be 
given  ;  not  only  because  similar  characters  have  very  different 
values  in  two  distant  classes ;  but  also  because,  even  in  groups 
not  remote  from  each  other,  they  are  of  very  different  degrees  of 
importance.     Thus  in  one  genus,  there  may  be  a  certain  cha- 
racter, such  as  colour,  which  is  invariably  the  same   in    each 
species  ;  so  that  they  may  be  distinguished  from  each  other  by 
it  alone.     On  the  other  hand,  there  may  be  certain  variations  in 
regard  to  form,  which  the  Zoologist  does  not  regard  ;  because 
he  knows  that,  in  the  group  in  question,  there  is  much  latitude 
in  this  respect.      But  in  another  group,  i\\e  forms  of  particular 
parts,   even  though  they  be  of  great  minuteness,  may  be    so 
constant  for  each  species,  as  to  furnish  very  satisfactory  charac- 
ters for  dividing  them  ;  whilst  the  colours  may  be  so  liable  to 
variation,  that  no  use  whatever  can  be  made  of  them  in  classifi- 
cation.    Some  examples  of  this  kind  have  been  already  given 
(§  15,  16).      Hence,  no  general  rules  can  be  laid  down  on  this 
very  important  subject ;  and  in  each  group  of  whatever  rank, 
whether  it  be  a  class,  an  order,  a  family,  or  a  genus,  it  ought  to 
be  ascertained  what  characters  possess  most  fixity,  and  what  are 
to  be  put  aside  as  unfit  to  be  relied  on. 

45.  There  are  four  principal  types  or  plans,  upon  which  the 
members  of  the  Animal  kingdom  are  constructed ;  and  these 
plans  are  found  to  exert  a  modifying  influence  over  the  conform- 
ation of  all  the  organs  of  the  body.     That  which  prevails  in  the 
lowest  group  is  the  Radiated  arrangement ;  in  which  the  mouth 
is   situated  in  the  centre  of  the  body,  and  the  several  organs 
are  disposed  around  it,  so  as  to  give  to  the  whole  structure  a 


RADIATED  TYPE  OF  STRUCTURE. 


star-shaped  or  a  globular  form.     This  we  see   in   the  Star-fish 
(Fig.  25),  the  Echinus  or  Sea-Urchin,  most  of  the  Jelly-fish, 


FIG.  25.— STAR-FISH. 

and  in  nearly  all  the  Polypes,  when  we  look  at  them  separately 
(Fig.  26).  Sometimes  this  arrangement  is  perfectly  symmetri- 
cal ;  that  is,  every  division  of  the  body  exactly  resembles  the 
others  in  form  and  size ;  but  in  other  instances  we  see  that  the 
parts  of  the  structure  have  a  tendency  to  arrange  themselves 
equally  on  the  two  sides  of  a  central  line,  so  as 
to  approach  that  li-lateral  symmetry,  or  equa- 
lity of  the  two  halves  of  the  body,  which  is 
characteristic  of  the  Articulata  and  Verte- 
brata.  Those  in  which  the  radial  or  circular 
symmetry  is  perfect,  are  to  be  regarded  as  the 
typical  Radiata  ;  whilst  those  in  which  it  gives 
place  to  the  lateral  symmetry,  are  aberrant 
forms,  that  conduct  us  towards  other  groups. 
The  resemblance  of  the  parts  of  the  body,  in  Radiated  animals, 


FIG.  26.— SEA  ANE- 
MONK. 


RADIATED  TYPE  OF  STRUCTURE. 


67 


is  not  confined  to  their  exterior,  but  extends  to  the  internal 
organs  also  ;  which  are  so  constructed,  that  each  is  but  a  repeti- 
tion of  the  rest.  Thus,  in  every  arm  of  the  Star-fish,  we  have 
not  only  the  same  number  of  the  little  plates  of  which  the 
skeleton  is  composed,  and  the  same  arrangement  of  the  small 
tubular  feet  which  are  put  out  between  these,  but  we  have  also 
in  each  a  nervous  ganglion  and  trunk,  a  prolongation  of  the 
stomach,  and  a  set  of  blood-vessels, — all  of  which  are  precisely 
similar  in  the  several  rays. 

46.  This  repetition  of  similar  parts  around  a  common  centre 
strongly  reminds  us  of  the  arrangement  of  the  leaves  in  a  leaf- 
bud  (VEGET.  PHYSIOL.  303) 
and  of  the  sepals,  petals,  &c. 
in  a  flower  (VEGET.  PHYSIOL. 
463).  In  the  Polypes,  which 
constitute  the  largest  and 
most  important  of  the  groups 
exhibiting  this  plan  of  struc- 
ture, a  number  of  individuals, 
each  capable  (like  a  leaf-bud) 
of  living  by  itself,  are  arranged 
on  one  common  plant-like 
structure  (Fig.  27) ;  and  this 
extends  itself  by  budding,  in 
the  manner  of  a  tree  or  shrub. 
It  is  not  only  in  their  exter- 
nal aspect,  and  in  their  ten- 
dency to  form  compound 
structures,  that  the  animals 
exhibiting  the  radial  symme- 
try bear  a  resemblance  to 
Plants;  for  it  shows  itself 
also  in  the  predominance  of 
their  vegetative  over  their  FIG 

animal  life, — that  is,  in  the 

large  proportion  which  their  organs  and  actions  of  nutrition  bear 
to  those  of  sensation  and  locomotion.  The  greater  part  of  the 

F     2 


68  RADIATED    AND    ARTICULATED    TYPES. 

Radiata  are  fixed  to  one  spot  during  all  but  the  earliest  period 
of  their  lives ;  and  though  the  instruments  by  which  they  obtain 
their  food  have  some  power  of  spontaneous  motion,  and  certain 
of  their  actions  appear  to  indicate  sensation,  yet  it  cannot  be 
doubted  by  any  one  who  observes  their  habits,  that  they  possess 
these  endowments  in  a  very  feeble  degree.  The  most  active 
among  them  are  some  of  the  Medusae,  or  Jelly-fish  tribe,  which 
exhibit  the  greatest  departure  from  the  general  type  of  the 
Radiata,  in  the  bi-lateral  symmetry  of  their  bodies;  and  certain  of 
the  Holothurice,  or  Sea-Cucumbers  (Fig.  28),  in  which  the  body 


FIG  28. — HOLOTHURFA. 


is  so  prolonged,  as  to  remind  us  of  that  of  a  Leech  or  Caterpillar; 
although  the  circular  arrangement  of  the  organs  around  the 
mouth  shows  their  place  to  be  in  the  Radiated  sub-kingdom. 

47.  In  the  sub-kingdom  Articulate,  there  is  also  a  consider- 
able repetition  of  parts ;  which,  in  the  lowest  of  the  group,  are 
almost  precisely  similar  to  each  other.  These  parts  are  disposed, 
however,  not  around  a  centre,  but  in  a  line, — as  in  the  Centi- 
pede (Fig.  29)  ;  and  there  is  a  most  exact  similarity  between  the 
two  halves  of  the  body,  or,  in  other  words,  a  most  complete 
bi-lateral  symmetry.  There  is  no  internal  skeleton ;  but  the 
hard  envelope  gives  the  required  degree  of  protection,  and  also 
furnishes  points  of  attachment  to  the  muscles  by  which  the 
body  is  moved.  Where  there  are  distinct  members  or  limbs  for 
aiding  the  motions  of  the  fabric,  we  find  that  they  too  are  covered 


ARTICULATED  TYPE  OF  STRUCTURE.  69 

with  a  jointed  envelope.  Hence  the  character  of  this  series  is 
derived  from  the  inclosure  of  the  body  and  limbs  in  a  jointed 
envelope  ;  and  from  the  perfect  resemblance  of  the  two  halves  to 
each  other.  The  repetition  of  parts  is  found  to  exist  in  great 


FIG.  39. — CENTIPEDE. 

degree  in  the  internal  as  well  as  in  the  external  organs.  Thus  in 
the  Centipede,  every  segment  of  the  body  is  provided  with  its 
own  air-cavity  for  respiration,  and  with  its  own  nervous  ganglia ; 
and  the  dorsal  vessel,  which  represents  the  heart  in  these  animals, 
is  also  divided  by  partitions,  into  a  series  of  chambers  corre- 
sponding to  the  segments.  Further,  the  conformity  Between 
the  two  halves  of  the  body  is  extremely  perfect ;  for  not  only 
are  the  exterior  of  the  trunk  and  limbs  perfectly  symmetri- 
cal, but  the  equality  extends  also  to  the  organs  of  digestion, 
circulation,  and  respiration,  which,  with  very  few  exceptions, 
would  be  divided  into  two  equal  halves,  by  a  line  passing  down 
the  middle  of  the  body.  Now  this  perfect  symmetry,  which 
is  seen  nowhere  else  than  in  the  Articulata,  is  evidently  connected 
with  the  high  development  of  their  powers  of  locomotion.  A 
little  consideration  will  show,  that  it  is  impossible  for  an  animal 
to  move  with  great  energy  and  rapidity,  unless  the  two  sides  of 
its  body  are  equal  in  power  and  weight.  Every  one  knows  that 
a  Bird,  if  one  of  its  wings  be  clipped,  cannot  fly  straight ;  and 
that  a  Man,  having  a  burthen  to  carry,  will  accomplish  it  much 
better  by  dividing  it  into  two  portions,  and  raising  one  with  each 
hand,  than  by  attempting  to  bear  it  all  on  one  side.  We  shall 
hereafter  see  that,  in  rapidity  and  energy  of  movement,  there 
are  no  animals  which,  when  their  size  is  taken  into  account,  can 
be  compared  with  a  large  number  of  the  Articulata.  The  sen- 
sory organs,  too,  are  highly  developed ;  and  in  the  construction 
of  the  eyes  we  again  meet  with  the  repetition,  which  is  so  charac- 
teristic of  the  whole  organisation;  each  of  the  bodies  that  project 


70  MOLLUSCOUS   TYPE    OF    STRUCTURE. 

on  the  two  sides  of  the  head  being  made  up  of  a  vast  number 
(often  many  thousands)  of  minute  eyes,  every  one  perfect  in 
itself  (ANIM.  PHYSIOL.  §  573).  The  possession  of  these  com- 
pound eyes  is  so  characteristic  of  the  Articulata,  that  any  animal 
in  which  they  were  found,  might  be  unhesitatingly  referred  to 
that  series. 

48.  The  characters  that  have  been  enumerated  are  very 
far  from  being  all,  which  belong  to  the  Articulated  series  as  a 
primary  subdivision  of  the  Animal  kingdom ;  but  they  are  the 
most  important,  as  enabling  us  most  readily  to  distinguish  its 
members  from  all  others.  They  will  be  dwelt  upon  in  more 
detail  in  their  proper  place.  The  animals  composing  the  sub- 
kingdom  Mollusca  are  strikingly  contrasted  with  them  in  a  great 
variety  of  particulars.  In  the  first  place,  the  body  is  soft,  and 
has  no  regularity  of  form.  It  may  or  may  not  be  covered  with 
a  shell ;  but  if  this  exists,  it  merely  serves  as  a  protection  to  the 
body,  and  gives  no  assistance  to  its  movements;  no  muscles 
being  attached  to  it,  except  such  as  connect  the  animal  with  the 
shell,  or  the  different  pieces  of  the  shell  (where  there  are  more 
than  one)  to  each  other.  In  fact,  the  entire  muscular  system 
consists  of  a  few  scattered  bands  and  fibres,  except  in  some  of  the 
more  active  species,  which  partake  of  the  characters  of  the  Arti- 
culata or  Vertebrata.  But,  on  the  other  hand,  the  organs  of 
nutrition  attain  a  very  high  degree  of  development  in  this  series ; 
and  the  bulk  of  the  body,  which  is  often  very  considerable,  is 
given  almost  by  them  alone.  "We  do  not  find  in  them  any  ten- 
dency to  symmetrical  arrangement  of  any  kind ;  nor  to  a  repe- 
tition of  parts,  such  as  we  have  seen  in  the  Radiata  and  Articu- 
lata ;  so  that  no  definite  form  can  be  assigned  as  characteristic  of 
their  fabric.  An  idea  of  the  mode  in  which  their  organs  are 
arranged,  in  the  lowest  and  simplest  species,  will  be  derived  from 
the  examination  of  the  accompanying  figure,  which  represents 
the  anatomy  of  the  Oyster.  It  will  be  seen  that  there  is  here  an 
absence  of  anything  like  a  head;  for  the  mouth,  &,  is  buried,  as 
it  were,  among  the  other  organs,  and  cannot  be  projected  from 
between  the  valves  ;  and  there  are  no  other  organs  of  sense,  than 
the  tentacula  or  enlarged  lips,  #,  that  immediately  surround  it. 


MOLLUSCOUS    TYPE    OF    STRUCTURE. 


71 


This  is  the  case  with  all  the  animals  inhabiting  bivalve  shells ; 
although  some  of  them  have  a  fleshy  tongue-like  organ,  termed 


c  m 

FIG.  30. — ANATOMY  OF  THE  OYSTBR. 


v,  one  of  the  valves  of  the  shell ;  v',  its  hinge ;  m,  one  of  the  lobes  of  the  mantle  ; 
m',  a  portion-of  the  other  lobe  folded  back  ;  c,  muscles  of  the  shell ;  br,  gills ;  b,  mouth ; 
t,  tentacula,  or  prolonged  lips ;  /,  liver ;  i,  intestine ;  a,  anus ;  co,  heart 

the  foot,  by  which  they  can  give  motion  to  their  bodies.     But 
among  the  Mollusks  inhabiting  univalve  shells,  and  others  which 

are  allied  to  them 
but  possess  no  shell, 
we  find  the  mouth 
situated  on  a  pro- 
jecting part,  which 
also  bears  the  va- 
rious organs  of  spe- 
cial sense, — sight, 
smell,  hearing,  and 
taste,  —  more  or 
less  fully  deve- 
loped ;  and  we 
find,  in  some,  that 
the  powers  of  motion  are  greater,  so  that  they  are  enabled  to 


FIG.  31 LYMNJEUS  STAGNALIS. 


72  MOLLUSCOUS    TYPE    OF    STRUCTURE. 

go  from  place  to  place  in  search  of  food,  instead  of  waiting  for 
what  is  brought  to  them  by  the  currents,  which  the  action  of  their 
cilia  creates  in  the  surrounding  water.  Now,  in  these  animals 
we  always  find  the  head  possessing  a  symmetrical  arrangement  of 
its  parts, — the  eyes,  tentacula  (or  feelers),  &c.,  being  arranged  in 
pairs,  on  the  two  sides  of  the  central  line,  as  seen  in  Fig.  31. 
But  the  remainder  of  the  body,  which  contains  the  organs  of 
nutrition  or  vegetative  life,  is  very  commonly  unsymmetrical 
externally,  being  disposed  in  a  spiral  which  fills  the  interior  of 
the  shell,  and  having  a  complete  want  of  uniformity  in  the 
arrangement  of  the  organs  themselves. 

49.  In  the  species  which  are  destitute  of  shell,  however,  or 
which  have  but  a  small  one  that  only  partially  covers  the  body, 
we  find  the  symmetry  more  complete,  and 
the  powers  of  motion  greater.  This  is 
the  case,  for  example,  with  the  group  of 
PteropodS)  of  which  an  illustration  is  given 
in  Fig.  32.  Here  we  see  that  the  two 
sides  of  the  body  are  exactly  alike  exter- 
nally ;  and  the  correspondence  extends  in 
great  degree  to  the  internal  organs  also. 
The  movements  of  these  animals  through 
the  water  are  comparatively  active ;  and 
FIG  32  —  HYALS  they  remm(^  us  strongly  of  those  of  Insects 

or  Birds,  to  which  they  may  be  considered 

as  having  a  decided  analogy  (§  4).  Still,  the  general  rule 
holds  good,  in  regard  to  them  also,  that  their  muscular  system  is 
but  little  developed ;  the  several  bands  and  fibres  of  which  it 
consists,  having  no  firm  points  of  attachment ;  and  bearing  no 
proportion,  either  in  number,  or  in  the  variety  of  their  actions, 
to  those  of  even  the  lowest  Articulata.  This  is  the  case  also 
with  the  Cuttle-fish  tribe,  which  presents  many  characters  that 
lead  us  towards  the  Yertebrated  series,  and  which  depart  widely 
from  those  of  the  typical  Mollusks, — the  essential  peculiarity  of 
whose  organisation,  is  unquestionably  the  low  development  of  the 
organs  of  animal  life,  in  comparison  with  those  of  nutritive  or 
vegetative  life. 


MOLLUSCOUS,  ARTICULATED,  AND  VERTEBRATED    TYPES.       73 

50.  Tims  we  have  seen,  that  there  is  a  kind  of  antagonism 
between  the  characters  of  the  Molluscous  and  of  the  Articulated 
series  :  for  the  former  present  the  functions  of  nutrition  in  almost 
exclusive  operation,  their  whole  energy  being  (as  it  were)  con- 
centrated upon  these,  and  their  powers  of  sensation  and  locomo- 
tion being  exercised  almost  exclusively  for  the  acquirement  of 
their  supplies  of  food;  whilst  in  the  latter,  the  functions  of  animal 
life,  sensation  and  spontaneous  motion,  are  seen  in  the  greatest 
activity,  and  the  nutritive  operations  are  carried  on  merely  for 
the  purpose  of  developing  the  mechanism  in  the  first  instance, 
and  of  subsequently  keeping  it  in  repair  and  supplying  its  waste. 
We  observe  a  corresponding  difference  in  the  form  of  their  bodies; 
for  the  symmetrical  arrangement,  which  almost  invariably  pre- 
sents itself  in  the  organs  of  animal  life,  is  so  complete  in  the 
Articulata,  as  even  to  prevail  in  their  organs  of  nutrition  ;  whilst 
an  absence  of  all  symmetry  shows  itself  in  those  Mollusks,  whose 
bodies  are  made  up  almost  exclusively  of  these  last  parts  ; — uni- 
formity on  the  two  sides  being  only  visible  in  those,  which  have 
some  capacity  for  movement ;  and  merely  affecting  the  head  in 
those,  whose  motions  do  not  exhibit  more  than  the  sluggishness, 
which  is  characteristic  of  the  series  taken  as  a  whole. 

51.  Now,  in  the  Vertebrated  subdivision  of  the  Animal 
kingdom,  we  find  the  characters  of  these  two  groups  in  some 
degree  united.  For  there  is  in  almost  every  member  of  it,  a 
large  share  of  the  activity  and  acuteness  of  sensation,  which  is 
characteristic  of  the  Articulated  classes;  whilst  the  nutritive 
apparatus  is  rather  formed  upon  the  plan  of  that  of  the  Mollusca, 
and  attains  a  still  higher  degree  of  development.  -  In  the  external 
form  of  the  body  of  the  Vertebrata,  we  have,  in  almost  every 
instance  (a  small  group  of  Fishes  constituting  the  only  excep- 
tion), a  complete  bi-lateral  symmetry;  and  this  symmetry 
extends  to  the  internal  parts,  so  far  as  the  organs  of  animal  life 
(the  brain  and  nerves,  the  muscles  concerned  in  the  movement 
of  the  body,  and  the  organs  of  sense),  are  concerned  ;  but  we  do 
not  find  it  so  well  marked  in  the  organs  of  nutrition,  which  are, 
for  the  most  part,  unsymmetrical.  Thus  the  heart  of  Man  is  not 
placed  on  the  central  line  of  the  body,  but  on  the  left  side  ;  the 


74  VERTEBRATED  TYPE  OF  STRUCTURE. 

liver,  chiefly  on  the  right  side  ;  the  stomach  and  pancreas  on  the 
left,  —  and  other  parts  in  the  same  irregular  manner.  The 
respiratory  organs,  however,  always  display  more  symmetry; 
probably,  for  this  reason, — that  they  are  more  closely  connected 
than  any  other  of  the  organs  of  nutrition,  with  the  apparatus  of 
muscular  motion,  by  which  their  actions  are  kept  up.  (ANIMAL 
PHYSIOL.  Chap.  VI.).  But  it  is  interesting  to  observe  that,  in 
Birds — the  class  of  Vertebrata  most  distinguished  for  activity  of 
motion — there  is  a  more  complete  symmetry  than  is  found  among 
Mammals,  thus  affording  another  exemplification  of  the  general 
rule  just  stated.  The  peculiarity  in  the  construction  of  Verte- 
brated  animals,  however,  has  reference  not  so  much  to  their 
external  conformation,  as  to  their  possession  of  an  internal 
skeleton ;  expressly  adapted  to  give  support  and  protection  to 
the  nervous  system,  which  in  this  class  attains  its  highest  degree 
of  development,  and  to  afford  fixed  points  of  attachment  to  the 
muscles.  In  this  respect,  therefore,  they  are  readily  distinguishable 
from  the  Articulata,  whose  skeleton  is  external ;  and  from  the 
Mollusca,  most  of  which  have  no  skeleton  at  all.  But  as  among 
the  highest  of  this  last  group,  there  are  some  (of  the  Cuttle-fish 
tribe)  which  have  the  rudiments  of  an  internal  skeleton — so 
there  are  some  among  Fishes,  in  which  the  internal  skeleton 
characteristic  of  the  Vertebrated  series  is  so  little  developed, 
that  it  has  been  doubted  whether  these  animals  deserve  to  be 
ranked  in  it  at  all.  So  that,  well  marked  and  decided  as  the 
line  would  seem  to  be,  which  separates  the  Vertebrata  from 
Invertebrated  animals,  we  may  be  obliged  to  hesitate  through 
what  exact  points  to  draw  it. 

52.    In  the  preceding  sketch  of  the  four  great  plans,  on  which 
the  ever- varying  forms  of  the  Animal  Kingdom  appear  to  have 
been  constructed,  it  has  not  been  attempted  to  embody  all  the 
characters,  by  which  they  are  respectively  distinguished  ;  but  to 
give  to  the  young  Naturalist  such  an  idea  of  each,  as  may  aid  hii 
in  that  first  act  of  classification,  which  consists  in  ascertaining 
to  which  type  a  new  or  doubtful  animal  is  to  be  referred, 
more  detailed  account  of  each  will  be  given  at  the  comment 
ment  of  that  division  of  the  work,  which  treats  of  the  classes  ii 


CHARACTERS    DRAWN    FROM    NERVOUS    SYSTEM.  75 

includes.  But  it  will  be  advantageous  here  to  show,  how  they 
may  be  distinguished  by  the  examination  of  a  single  portion 
only  of  their  structure  ;  because  we  shall  be  thus  led  to  see,  how 
single  and  easily-recognised  characters  become  of  great  importance 
in  classification,  provided  they  are  found  to  be  constantly  associ- 
ated with  certain  general  types  or  plans  of  structure.  A  little 
consideration  will  show,  that  the  Nervous  System,  being  more 
or  less  concerned  with  all  the  functions  of  the  body,  but  particu- 
larly with  those  of  animal  life,  will  probably  exhibit,  in  the 
arrangements  of  its  parts,  very  distinctive  peculiarities  in  the 
four  sub-kingdoms ;  and  this  is,  in  fact,  the  case. 

53.  In  the  Radiated  animals  the  Nervous  System,  where  it 
can  be  traced  at  all  (which  is  often  impossible  on  account  of  the 
small  size  of  the  animal,  and  the  softness  of  its  tissues),  is  arranged 
on  the  same  plan  with  the  other  organs  ;  its  centres  being  disposed 
in  a  circle  around  the  mouth,  and  being  connected  by  a  cord  that 
forms  a  complete  ring,  as  shown  in  Fig.  33.  Each  of  these 


FIG.  33.— NERVOUS  SYSTEM  FIG.  34.— NERVOUS  SYSTEM  OF  AN  INSECT. 

OF  STAR-FrSH. 

centres  or  ganglia  supplies  the  part  of  the  body,  with  which 
it  is  immediately  connected ;  and  seems  to  have  precisely  the 
same  functions  with  the  rest. — In  the  Articulated  animals,  we 
find  a  series  of  ganglia  arranged  along  the  central  line  of  the 
body,  and  connected  by  a  cord,  which  is  always  either  evidently 
double  (as  in  Fig.  34),  or  which  may  be  easily  separated  into 
two  equal  tracts,  one  belonging  to  either  side.  And  at  the  front 
extremity  of  this  cord,  situated  in  the  head,  there  is  a  pair  of 
ganglia  larger  than  the  rest,  connected  with  the  organs  of  special 


76 


MOLLUSCOUS    TYPE    OF    NERVOUS   SYSTEM. 


sense,  and  evidently  having  a  controlling  power  over  the  whole 
system. — In  the  Molluscous  animal,  again,  as  there  is  no  repeti- 
tion in  the  several  parts  of  the  boc'y,  so  there  is  no  repetition  of 
ganglia,  except  on  the  two  sides,  when  there  are  corresponding 
organs  to  be  supplied.  Thus  we  have  usually  a  single  or  double 
ganglion  in  the  head  (where  it  exists),  or  in  the  neighbourhood 
of  the  mouth,  connected  with  the  organs  of  special  sense  ;  another 
for  the  actions  of  the  respiratory  apparatus,  and  another  for  the 
foot.  Of  these,  the  arrangement  in  the  lower  forms  of  Mollusca 
is  represented  in  Fig.  35,  and  in  the  higher,  in  Fig.  36. 
There  is  a  total  absence  of  all  regularity  in  the  arrange- 
ment of  the  several  ganglia;  for  their  position  varies  con- 
tinually in  the  different  species  according  to  that  of  the  organs 
they  supply  :  thus,  in  the  shell- 
less  species,  the  place  of  the 
gills  is  continually  varying ;  and 
that  of  the  respiratory  gan- 
glion varies  accordingly,  being 


FIG.  35.— NERVOUS  SYSTEM  OF  PECTKN. 

A  A,  cephalic  ganglia  ;  B,  branchial 
ganglion  ;  C,  pedal  ganglion  ;  e,  oeso- 
phagus. 


FIG.  36. — NERVOUS  SYSTKM  OF 

API-YSIA. 

A,  cephalic  ganglion  ;  B,  respi- 
ratory ganglion  ;  C  C,  ganglia  of 
the  foot  and  mantle ;  D,  pbaryn- 
geal  ganglion. 


sometimes  in  the  front  of  the  body,  and  sometimes  at  its  hinder- 
part,  as  in  the  Aplysia.  Hence,  if  we  were  to  find  an  animal 
having  a  series  of  nervous  centres  or  ganglia  scattered  through 
the  body — not  forming  a  regular  series  arranged  round  the 


VERTEBRATED    TYPE    OF    NERVOUS   SYSTEM. 


77 


mouth,  as  in  the  Radiata — nor  disposed  in  a  long  row,  as  the 
Articulata — we  should  be  right  in  ranking 
it  as  a  Mollusk. — The  Vertebrata  have 
their  principal  nervous  centres  arranged 
in  one  continuous  mass,  which  is  enclosed 
within  their  bony  skeleton :  this  mass 
consists  of  the  Brain,  which  occupies  the 
skull ;  and  of  the  Spinal  Cord,  which  is 
contained  within  the  back-bone;  and 
from  it  are  supplied  not  only  the  organs 
of  locomotion  and  sensation,  but  those 
concerned  in  the  reception  of  food,  and  in 
the  respiratory  actions,  which  have  dis- 
tinct ganglia  of  their  own  in  most  Inver- 
tebrata. 

54.  A  case    in   which  the   place  of  a 
doubtful  group,  the  Barnacle  tribe,  might 
have  been  decided  by  the  conformation  of 
its   nervous    system,    has    been    already 
adverted  to  (§  32)  :    here  the  division  of 
the  body  into  segments  is  very  indistinct, 
and  its  external  form  has  a  general  resem- 
blance to  that  of  the  Mollusca ;  but  the 
double  nervous  cord,  studded  with  ganglia 
at  intervals,  which  runs  from  one  extremity 
to  the  other,  assigns  its  place  to  be  among 
the    Articulata, — a    decision    which    has 

r>          ,    ,        ,.         ,.  .    ,A       FIG.  3?.— BRAIN  AND  SPINAL 

been  confirmed   by  the   discovery  of  its          CORD  OF  MAN. 
curious  metamorphosis. 

55.  We  have  hitherto  spoken  chiefly  of  the  principles,  upon 
which  a  Natural  System  or  Classification  should  be  constructed; 
a  few  observations  may  be  added,  on  the  manner  in  which  it  may 
be  advantageously  applied.     It  has  been  shown  that,  in  first  ar- 
ranging the  different  species  into  groups,  and  combining  these 
groups  into  others,  we  must   be  guided  by  the  whole  collection 
of  characters,  which  each  animal  presents.       But  if,  whenever 
we  meet  with  a  form  of  animal  life  that  is  new  to  us,  we  were 


78  APPLICATION    OP    NATURAL    SYSTEM. 

obliged  to  examine  its  whole  structure  in  order  to  discover  its 
place  in  the  scale,  we  should  subject  ourselves  to  a  vast  amount 
of  labour,  which  must  be  a  great  Impediment  to  the  progress  of 
Zoology.  This,  however,  is  by  no  means  the  case ;  for  there  are 
certain  external  characters,  simple  and  easily  recognised,  which 
distinguish  almost  every  class  of  animals  from  the  rest;  and  which, 
consequently,  enable  us  to  refer  an  unknown  species  to  the  pri- 
mary group  to  which  it  belongs,  with  very  little  difficulty.  Thus, 
the  Mammals  are  four-legged  animals,  whose  bodies  are  more  or 
less  closely  covered  with  hair.  There  is  no  other  class,  in  which 
these  two  characters  are  united.  All  Reptiles,  except  Serpents, 
are  four-legged ;  but  their  skins,  instead  of  being  beset  with  hair, 
are  either  covered  with  scales,  or  are  altogether  naked.  And, 
again,  some  Insects  and  Spiders  are  hairy ;  but  they  have  never 
so  few  as  four  legs.  Hence,  if  we  meet  with  a  four-legged  animal, 
with  hairs  even  very  thinly  scattered  over  its  body,  we  may  be 
satisfied  that  it  is  a  Mammal.  Again,  as  there  are  no  animals  what- 
ever, save  Birds,  that  have  their  bodies  covered  with  feathers,  any 
creature  on  whose  surface  such  a  covering  exists,  must  be  unques- 
tionably placed  in  that  class.  Further,  in  the  Articulated  Series, 
the  higher  classes  may  be  recognised  by  the  number  of  legs  alone, 
— Insects  having  uniformly  six.  Spiders  eight,  and  Crustacea  not 
less  than  ten.  Hence,  if  we  found  an  animal  having  six  legs,  we 
should  have  no  hesitation  in  stating  it  to  belong  to  the  class  of 
Insects,  even  though  it  may  be  destitute  of  wings,  which  we 
commonly  regard  as  characteristic  of  that  group ;  whilst  any 
animal  with  eight  legs  would  be  placed  among  the  Spider  tribe, 
and  any  animal  with  ten  would  be  associated  with  the  Crabs  and 
Lobsters.  If  the  number  were  greater  than  ten,  it  would  be 
necessary  to  examine  the  organs  of  respiration ;  for,  if  these  were 
aquatic,  the  animal  would  belong  to  one  of  the  lower  groups  of 
the  class  Crustacea ;  whilst  if  they  were  adapted  to  breathe  air, 
it  would  be  one  of  the  Myriapoda,  or  Centipede  tribe. 

56.  The  same  principle  may  be  followed  out  in  the  subdivi- 
sions of  the  classes ;  so  that,  by  a  reference  to  the  external  cha- 
racters alone  of  the  animal  examined,  the  Zoologist  may  be  able 
to  predict  all  the  essential  points  of  its  internal  structure.  Now 


APPLICATION    OF    NATURAL    SYSTEM.  79 

some  of  these  characters  may  be  termed  natural,  because  they 
have  an  obvious  connection  with  the  real  or  essential  differences 
that  distinguish  the  two  groups ;  whilst  others  are  considered  as 
artificial,  because,  though  extremely  convenient  to  the  Zoologist, 
they  do  not  of  themselves  tell  him  anything  respecting  those  dif- 
ferences. Thus,  the  popular  error,  formerly  adverted  to,  of  con- 
founding Whales  with  Fishes,  may  be  avoided  by  attending  to 
either  of  two  very  easily-observed  characters — the  first  natural, 
the  second  artificial.  In  the  Whales,  and  other  Mammals  that 
inhabit  the  water,  the  tail  is  flattened  horizontally,  and  its  stroke 
is  vertical,  or  up  and  down  ;  but  in  Fishes,  the  tail  is  invariably 
flattened  vertically,  and  its  stroke  is  horizontal,  or  from  side  to 
side.  This  is  a  natural  character,  because  it  is  closely  connected 
with  the  mode  in  which  one  of  those  functions  is  performed,  the 
plan  of  which  is  entirely  different  in  the  two  groups  :  the  Whales, 
which  breathe  air  by  lungs,  require  to  come  frequently  to  the 
surface  in  order  to  take  it  in ;  and  the  direction  in  which  their  tail 
strikes  the  water,  enables  them  to  rise  or  fall  in  it  with  great  faci- 
lity :  but  Fish,  which  breathe  by  means  of  the  passage  of  water 
over  their  gills,  do  not  require  such  a  power,  and  the  movement  of 
their  tail  is  chiefly  destined  to  urge  them  rapidly  through  the 
water.  Consequently,  we  could  never  expect  to  meet  with  a 
Whale  having  a  tail  vertically  flattened,  nor  with  a  Fish  having 
a  horizontally  expanded  tail ;  and  this  character,  therefore,  would 
suffice  to  distinguish  the  animals  of  the  two  groups,  without  the 
aid  of  any  other.  But  the  inspection  of  a  small  part  of  its  skin 
would  of  itself  suffice  to  determine,  whether  a  given  animal  were 
one  of  the  Whale  tribe,  or  a  true  Fish ;  for  the  skin  of  the  Fish 
is  covered  with  scales,  whilst  that  of  the  Whales  is  destitute  of 
any  such  protection,  and  has  only  a  few  hairs  scattered  over  it. 
Now,  this  must  be  regarded  as  an  artificial  character  ;  since  we 
cannot  discover  what  essential  connection  there  is,  between  the 
internal  conformation  of  the  Fish  and  its  covering  of  scales,  or 
between  the  arrangement  of  the  internal  organs  of  the  Whale, 
and  the  scanty  covering  of  hair  with  which  its  skin  is  furnished. 
Moreover,  although  no  Fish  possess  hairs,  yet  some  Mammals 
are  partially  covered  with  a  kind  of  scales ;  which  shows  that 


80  APPLICATION    OF    NATURAL    SYSTEM. 

there  is  no  impossibility  in  the  possession  of  a  scaly  skin  by  an 
air-breathing,  warm-blooded  animal;  and  we  could  not  feel  quite 
certain  that  a  Whale-like  animai  might  not  be  hereafter  dis- 
covered possessing  a  scaly  skin — however  improbable  such  a 
thing  may  be. 

57.  It  should  be  the  aim  of  the  Zoologist,  therefore,  in  the 
choice  of  the  characters  which  he  uses,  for  the  most  easy  dis- 
tinction of  the  animals  composing  the  several  natural  groups, — 
into  which,  (it  cannot  be  too  often  repeated),  they  must  be  asso- 
ciated by  their  general  conformity  of  structure, — to  select  those 
which  are  the  most  natural,  as  indicating  the  nature  of  their  in- 
ternal structure,  in  preference  to  those  which  are  artificial,  giving 
no  information  beyond  that  derived  from  themselves.  Hence,  in 
classifying  the  Mammalia,  the  conformation  of  the  teeth  and  ex- 
tremities afford  (in  most  orders  at  least)  characters  of  the  highest 
value ;  since  these  are  intimately  connected  with  the  structure 
of  the  digestive  apparatus,  the  nature  of  the  food  on  which  the 
animal  lives,  the  mode  in  which  it  is  obtained,  and,  consequently, 
the  entire  habits  of  the  species.  And,  in  the  subdivision  of  the 
class  of  Birds,  the  conformation  of  the  bill,  wings,  and  claws, 
afford  characters  of  similar  value.  In  the  arrangement  of  Insects, 
on  the  other  hand,  it  is  often  necessary  to  adopt  artificial  charac- 
ters for  the  separation  of  the  several  groups;  because  they  are  the 
only  ones  which  are  recognised  with  sufficient  facility,  and  be- 
cause our  comparative  ignorance  of  their  internal  anatomy,  as 
well  as  of  their  economy,  prevents  us  from  understanding,  as 
clearly  as  in  the  two  classes  just  mentioned,  how  far  differences 
apparently  trifling  in  external  conformation  are  essentially  con- 
nected with  those  peculiarities,  which  really  characterise  the  re- 
spective groups.  Thus,  the  enormous  order  Coleoptwa  (Beetles) 
is  subdivided  into  sections  or  sub-orders,  according  to  the  number 
of  joints  in  the  tarsus,  or  foot ;  a  character  which,  at  first  sight, 
appears  very  trivial,  but  which  really  does  bring  together  the 
families  that  have  the  greatest  number  of  points  of  general  agree- 
ment, and  separates  them  from  others  which  differ  more  widely 
from  them.  Hence  it  is  probable,  that  an  increased  acquaintance 
with  the  habits  and  structure  of  these  animals  will  show  us,  why 


I 


HARMONY    BETWEEN    DISTINCT    CHARACTERS.  81 

the  presence  of  five  joints  in  the  tarsus  should  always  accompany 
one  set  of  internal  characters ;  and  why  four  joints  should  be 
found  in  the  tarsus  of  those  Beetles,  which  agree  among  them- 
selves, and  differ  from  the  last,  in  certain  other  particulars. 
"When  that  is  the  case,  the  character  will  deserve  to  be  regarded 
as  in  itself  a  natui  al  one  ;  as  it  already  must  be  considered  in 
some  degree,  since  the  classification  founded  upon  it  alone  has  no- 
thing of  the  artificial  nature,  usually  seen  in  arrangements  formed 
upon  single  characters,  and  displaying  itself  so  prominently  in 
the  Linnaean  classification  of  Plants.  (BOTANY,  Chap.  XIII.) 

58.  It  is  from  this  correspondence  between  single  characters, 
and  general  plans  of  structure,  that  the  Comparative  Anatomist 
derives  the  power,  already  adverted  to,  of  determining  the  nature 
of  a  whole  animal  from  a  single  fragment  of  its  skeleton,  or  from 
one  of  its  teeth.  In  no  animal  is  the  body  made  up  of  a  number 
of  disconnected  parts,  united,  as  it  were  at  hazard ;  for  all  its 
organs  have  a  more  or  less  intimate  connection  with  each  other  ; 
so  that  there  is  a  kind  of  harmony  amongst  them  all,  and  be- 
tween every  part  and  the  entire  structure.  Thus, 
the  simple  inspection  of  the  tooth  represented 
in  the  accompanying  figure,  suffices  to  disclose  to 
the  scientific  Naturalist,  the  following  facts  re- 
garding the  animal  to  which  it  belonged.  In  the 
first  place,  there  must  have  been  a  bony  frame- 
work, in  which  this  tooth  was  implanted,  and 
CARNIVOROUS  TOOTH  which  gave  support  to  the  rest  of  the  body ;  and, 
OF  A  LION.  ag  this  internal  framework  does  not  exist  in  any 
other  animals  than  those  of  the  Vertebrated  series,  we  know, 
by  its  possession  of  this  tooth,  that  the  animal  in  question  had 
the  brain  and  spinal  cord,  the  complete  set  of  organs  of  the  senses, 
the  red  blood,  &c.  &c.  which  belong  to  that  sub-kingdom  only. 
Further,  there  are  certain  characters  about  the  roots  of  this  tooth, 
which  enable  the  Anatomist  to  feel  certain,  that  it  must  have 
been  implanted  in  a  deep  socket,  which  is  only  the  case  in  Rep- 
tiles and  Mammals ;  and  he  may  further  determine  from  them, 
that  the  animal  belonged  to  this  last  class,  and  that  it  must  have 
therefore  possessed  the  organisation  which  is  peculiar  to  it.  Again, 


82  HARMONY    BETWEEN    DISTINCT    CHARACTERS. 

by  the  form  of  the  crown  of  the  tooth,  it  is  easily  shown  that  this 
tooth  was  destined  to  divide  animal  flesh;  and  that  it  consequently 
belonged  to  a  Carnivorous  quadruped.     To  digest  this  flesh,  the 
animal  must  have  had  a  stomach  and  intestinal  canal  formed  upon 
a  certain  plan ;  and  in  order  to  obtain  its  prey,  it  must  have  had 
appropriate  organs  of  locomotion  and  of  prehension.     Its  extre- 
mities must  have  terminated  in  separate  fingers,  and  these  must 
have  been  armed  with  claws.     The  limbs  must  have  been  fur- 
nished with  very  powerful  muscles,  to  enable  the  animal  to  give 
chase  to  its  prey,  or  to  spring  upon  it  unawares ;  and  afterwards 
to  drag  it  to  its  den.    The  head,  also,  must  have  been  connected 
with  the  spinal  column  by  ligaments  and  muscles  of  great  power, 
attached  to  elevated  projections  (spinous  processes)  of  the  verte- 
bras ;  in  order  that  it  may  have  the  power  of  lifting  the  heavy 
bodies,  which  the  animal  desires  to  remove.    The  lower  jaw  must 
have  been  connected  with  the  upper,  by  a  hinge  admitting  but  a 
scissars-like  action,  by  which  the  edges  of  the  cutting-teeth  were 
constantly  kept  sharp ;  and  the  muzzle  must  not  have  been  very 
protuberant,  otherwise  the  strength  of  the  muscles  that  raise  the 
jaw,  would  be  applied  at  too  great  a  disadvantage  (ANIM.  PHY- 
SIOL.  §  189).   The  cranial  cavity  must  have  been  comparatively 
large,  in  order  that  the  size  of  the  brain  might  correspond  with 
the  degree  of  intellect  which  the  habits  of  the  animal  required. 
59.     By  inferences  of  this  kind,  and  under  the  guidance  of 
our  knowledge  of  the  forms  at  present  existing,  all  the  leading 
peculiarities  of  an  animal  may  be  deduced  from  any  character- 
istic portion  of  it ;  for  if  any  part,  essential  to  the  action  of  the 
remainder,  had  been  deficient,  the  animal  could  not  have  main- 
tained its  existence.     An  animal  with  the  carnivorous  propensity 
of  the  Tiger,  for  example,  and  the  teeth  or  hoofs  of  a  Horse,  could 
not  remain  alive,  for  want  of  power  to  obtain  and  prepare  its 
nutriment ;  nor  would  a  Horse  be  better  for  the  long  canine  teeth 
of  the  Tiger,  which  would  prevent  the  grinding  motion  of  the 
jaws,  required  for  the  trituration  of  his  food.    The  great  principle 
is,  therefore,  that  every  animal  is  a  combination  of  mutually- 
adapted  parts,  forming  an  harmonious  whole ;  and  that  no  one 
of  these  can  be  altered,  without  affecting  all  the  rest,  more  or  less 
considerably. 


CHAPTER  II. 

GENERAL  CHARACTERS  OF  VERTEBRATED  ANIMALS. 

60.  THE  Fertebrated  sub-kingdom,  including  the  classes  of 
Mammals,  Birds,  Reptiles,  and  Fishes,  is  characterised  by  the 
presence,  in  all  the  animals  which  belong  to  it,  of  an  internal 
skeleton,  composed  of  bone  or  cartilage,  and  forming  an  envelope 
to  the  nervous  centres.     In  the  Articulated  classes,  there  is  no 
vestige  of  any  such  structure  ;  and  the  only  Mollusca  (some  of 
the  Cuttle-fish  tribe),  in  which  there  is  the  least  approach  to  it, 
are  sufficiently  distinguished  by  other  characters.    It  is  true  that, 
among  many  of  the  Radiata*, — such  as  a  few  of  the  Jelly-fish  tribe, 
and  a  large  proportion  of  the  Polypes, — there  is  an  internal  ske- 
leton, sometimes  composed  of  a  horny  or  cartilaginous  tissue,  and 
sometimes  possessing  even  a  stony  hardness ;  but  this  gives  equal 
support  to  the  whole  fabric,  and  is  not  arranged  in  such  a  manner 
as  to  give  the  least  degree  of  peculiar  protection  to  the  nervous 
centres ;  so  that,  although  it  may  be  regarded  as  a  kind  of  sketch, 
or  shadowing-forth,  in  this  lowest  group,  of  the  plan  of  structure 
which  is  characteristic  of  the  highest,  it  cannot  be  said  to  have 
any  real  correspondence  with  it. 

6 1 .  The  animals  of  the  Vertebrated  series  are,  of  all  sentient 
beings,  those  whose  faculties  are  the  most  varied  and  the  most 
perfect.     The  principle  of  the  division  of  labour  is  carried  out  in 
them  to  its  highest  degree ;    every  function  to  be   performed 
having  its  own  separate  organ,  whose  operations  are  limited  to  it 
alone ;  consequently,  the  Vertebrata  are,  of  all  animals,  those  in 
which  the  distinct  organs  are  the  most  numerous  and  the  most 
complicated.    We  may  encounter  many,  among  the  lower  tribes, 
in  which  the  number  of  parts  is  as  great,  or  even  greater ;  but, 


84  GENERAL    CHARACTERS    OF    VERTEBRATED    ANIMALS. 

where  this  is  the  case,  most  of  these  parts  are  but  repetitions  of 
one  another.  It  is  by  the  variety  existing  in  the  form  and  struc- 
ture of  their  several  organs,  and  in  the  perfection  with  which  each 
is  adapted  to  perform  its  allotted  function,  that  the  Vertebrata 
are  chiefly  characterised.  It  is  manifest  that  the  structure  of 
such  animals  must  be  regarded  as  more  elaborate,  than  that  of  be- 
ings, in  which  the  number  of  dissimilar  parts  is  small,  and  every 
one  of  them  capable  of  discharging  a  variety  of  offices ;  and  that 
their  functions  must  be  performed  with  more  energy  and  complete- 
ness^ when  carried  into  effect  by  instruments  peculiarly  adapted 
to  each,  than  when  several  are  the  result  of  the  actions  of  one 
organ.  Hence  we  are  justified  in  ranking  the  Vertebrata  as  the 
highest  group  in  the  Animal  scale,  independently  of  its  being  the 
one  which  contains  Man.  But  we  are  not  justified  in  speaking 
of  the  animals  composing  it,  as  more  perfectly  constructed  than 
any  others ;  since,  in  the  eye  of  the  Creator,  they  must  be  all 
equally  perfect.  In  every  one,  the  adaptation  between  the  ac- 
tions of  its  several  parts  must  be  complete;  or  it  could  not  main- 
tain its  existence.  And  it  should  not  be  less  wonderful  to  us,  to 
meet  in  the  Zoophyte  with  a  simple  structure,  capable  of  per- 
forming all  the  functions  of  absorption,  assimilation,  respiration, 
and  secretion  ;  than  to  contemplate  the  numerous  and  elaborately- 
constructed  organs,  by  which  these  several  operations  are  respec- 
tively performed  in  the  Vertebrated  animal. 

62.  The  development  of  all  the  organs  in  the  Vertebrata 
seems  to  be  subservient  to  that  of  the  Nervous  System ; — their 
object  being  to  give  to  it  the  means  of  the  exercise  of  its  powers. 
In  almost  every  animal  of  the  group,  we  find  that  the  brain  and 
spinal  cord  bear  a  much  larger  proportion  to  the  entire  bulk  of  the 
body,  than  do  the  nervous  centres  of  any  Invertebrated  animal; 
and  in  Man,  this  proportion  is  greatly  increased.  It  is  not  only 
in  the  actual  bulk  of  the  organs,  that  we  see  the  importance  here 
given  to  the  nervous  system ;  for  this  is  still  more  shown  by  the 
quantity  of  blood  which  is  transmitted  to  them.  Thus  it  is  cal- 
culated that  the  brain  of  Man  receives  about  a  fifth  or  sixth  part 
of  the  whole  blood  in  circulation ;  although  its  weight  is  not  more 
than  a  fortieth  or  fiftieth  part  of  that  of  the  entire  body  :  and 


PREDOMINANCE    OF    THE   NERVOUS    SYSTEM. 


85 


of  the  remaining  blood,  by  far  the  largest  portion  is  transmitted 
to  the  muscular  system,  which  is  the  instrument  of  the  nervous 
apparatus,  in  producing  the  movements  of  the  various  parts  of 
the  body.  To  prepare  this  blood,  and  to  keep  it  in  a  state  fit 
for  the  due  performance  of  its  func-  a 

tions,  a  complex  digestive,  respiratory, 
and  secreting  apparatus  is  requisite; 
but  this  vegetative  part  of  the  fabric 
does  not  live  for  itself  alone,  as  it 
seems  to  do  in  Plants,  and  (almost  to 
the  same  extent)  in  Zoophytes,  and  the 
inferior  Mollusks ;  for  it  is  entirely 
subservient  to  the  maintenance  of  the 
functions  of  animal  life,  by  keeping  the 
nervous  and  muscular  systems  (toge- 
ther with  the  bony  frame-work,  and 
other  parts  connected  with  the  move- 
ment of  the  body)  in  a  state  of  good 
repair. 

63.  The  nervous  system  of  Verte- 
brata  cannot,  as  a  whole,  be  properly 
compared  with  that  of  Invertebrate 


*P 


FIG.  41.    BRAINS  OF  FISHES.     A,  Cod  ;  B,  Shark. 


FIG.  40. — BRAIN  AND  SPINAL 
CORD  OF  MAN  ;  a,  cere- 
brum ;  b,  anterior  lobe  ;  c, 
middle  lobe  ;  d,  posterior 
lobe ;  e,  cerebellum ;  f,  me- 
dulla oblongata ;  ff,  spinal 
cord. 


animals,  unless  we  look  at  its  lowest  forms.     In  Man,  we  find 


86          DEVELOPMENT   OF    THE   CEREBRUM. INTELLIGENCE. 

that  the  largest  of  its  masses, — the  brain  proper,  consisting 
of  the  cerebral  hemispheres,  and  the  cerebellum, — acquires 
such  a  size  and  relative  importarce,  as  to  throw  the  others  into 
the  shade.  It  is  therefore  necessary  to  select  for  comparison, 
the  nervous  system  of  the  lowest  Fishes ;  and  here  we  find  a 
very  remarkable  correspondence.  For  the  cerebral  hemispheres 
(ch.  Fig.  41),  and  cerebellum  (ce\  are  here  in  a  comparatively 
undeveloped  state ;  and  of  the  nervous  masses  contained  in  the 
head,  the  optic  and  olfactive  ganglia  (ol  and  op) — which  are 
analogous  to  the  cephalic  ganglia  of  Insects  and  Mollusca  (Figs. 
34  and  36), — are  seen  to  form  at  least  as  considerable  a  part. 
The  spinal  cord  of  Vertebrata  is  evidently  analogous  to  the  chain 
of  ganglia  in  the  bodies  of  the  Articulata ;  so  that  between 
the  lowest  type  of  the  nervous  system  in  the  former,  and  its 
regular  plan  in  the  latter,  there  is  little  essential  difference. 
But  as  we  ascend  the  Vertebrate  series,  towards  Man,  we  find 
the  cerebrum  becoming  larger  and  larger ;  until  it  acquires  a 
size  and  importance,  which  for  a  long  time  induced  the  belief 
among  Physiologists,  that  it  is  the  essential  portion  of  the 
nervous  system, — the  only  centre  of  nervous  power.  This  has 
been  fully  proved,  however,  not  to  be  the  case  (ANIM.  PHYSIOL., 
Chap.  X.)  ;  a  very  large  class  of  actions,  including  all  those 
immediately  concerned  in  the  maintenance  of  life,  being  still 
performed  when  the  cerebral  hemispheres  had  been  removed. 

64*  Upon  comparing  the  relative  development  of  this  organ, 
in  different  Vertebrated  animals,  with  the  mental  faculties  whose 
possession  they  respectively  manifest,  it  is  difficult  to  avoid  the 
conclusion,  that  the  Cerebrum  is  the  instrument  of  Intelligence; 
whilst  the  other  portions  of  the  nervous  centres  minister  to 
Instinctive  actions.  It  has  been  pointed  out  (ANIM.  PHYSIOL. 
§  72)  that  the  high  development  of  the  instincts  is  the  prominent 
character  of  the  Articulata ;  and  that  what  we  regard  as  the 
highest  perfection  of  their  structure,  tends  in  this  direction.  On 
the  other  hand,  there  is  a  tendency  among  the  Vertebrata  to 
the  removal  of  the  animal  from  the  dominion  of  undiscerning 
uncontrollable  instinct,  and  to  place  all  its  operations  under  the 
dominion  of  an  intelligent  Will.  We  no  longer  witness  in  these 


STRUCTURE    OP    THE    VERTEBRAL    COLUMN.  87 

operations  that  uniformity,  which  is  so  remarkable  a  character- 
istic of  those  which  are  under  the  guidance  of  pure  Instinct 
(ANIM.  PHYSIOL.,  Chap.  XIY.)  There  is  evidently,  among  the 
higher  Vertebrata  especially,  a  power  of  choice  and  of  determina- 
tion, guided  by  a  perception  of  the  nature  of  the  object  to  be 
attained,  and  of  the  means  to  be  employed, — constituting  the 
simplest  form  of  the  reasoning  faculty.  In  Man,  the  reasoning 
faculties  seem  to  attain  the  highest  perfection,  that  is  compatible 
with  their  connection  with  a  material  fabric  ;  the  instinctive 
propensities  are  placed  under  their  subjection  ;  and  all  his  acts, 
except  those  immediately  required  for  the  maintenance  of  his 
organic  functions,  are  brought  under  their  controul.  But  among 
the  lowest  of  the  Vertebrated  series,  the  operations  of  instinct 
seem  to  be  as  predominant  as  in  the  Invertebrated  classes ; 
although,  as  they  are  inhabitants  of  the  water,  we  are  much  less 
acquainted  with  them. — Hence  we  seem  justified  in  asserting 
that  the  Cerebrum  is  the  instrument  of  intelligence  ;  and  that  the 
high  development  of  it  is  the  chief  characteristic  of  the  Verte- 
brated sub-kingdom. 

65.  It  is  more  satisfactory,  however,  to  define  this  group  by 
the  presence  or  absence  of  that  internal  skeleton,  which  is  espe- 
cially adapted  for  the  protection  of  the  nervous  centres ; — namely, 
the  vertebral  column.  This  essentially  consists  of  a  series  of 
bones,  termed  vertebrae;  through  a  perforation  in  the  centre  of 
which,  the  spinal  cord  passes.  When  these  bones  are  fitted 
together,  they  form  a  continuous  tube,  in  which 
this  important  organ  is  lodged  ;  and  they  are  con- 
nected together,  in  the  living  state,  by  ligaments  and 
muscles,  attached  to  the  bony  prominences  or  pro- 
cesses with  which  they  are  furnished.  In  this 
manner,  the  vertebral  column  possesses  considerable 
flexibility ;  so  that  it  may  be  bent  into  a  curve, 
without  injury  to  the  organ  which  it  protects.  If  it  had  been 
inflexible,  the  animal  could  not  have  propelled  itself  by  any 
movements  of  its  body,  but  must  have  been  entirely  dependent 
upon  its  limbs ;  and  if  it  had  been  composed  of  but  a  small 
number  of  bones,  the  spinal  cord  would  have  been  liable  to 


STRUCTURE    OF   THE    VERTEBRAL    COLUMN. 

severe  injury,  from  the  sudden  bends  which  its  bony  casing  would 
have  been  forced  to  make. 

66.  The  flexibility  of  the  spinal  column  varies 
much  in  degree,  however,  in  different  species  of 
Yertebrata.  In  Fishes  it  is  very  great ;  the  body 
being  chiefly  propelled  by  the  strokes  of  its 
hinder  part  and  tail  from  side  to  side,  and  the 
side  fins  having  but  little  else  to  do  than  to  direct 
its  movement.  In  Serpents,  we  find  an  entire 
absence  of  members  or  extremities  ;  and  the  whole 
of  the  movement  of  the  trunk  is  effected  by  itself 
alone ;  consequently  the  spine  requires  great  flex- 
FIG.  43"— VKRTE-  ibility.  In  these  two  groups  we  find  an  especial  pro- 
BRAL  COLUMN,  vision  for  this  object ;  for  in  Serpents,  the  bodies  of 
the  vertebras  are  not  flat,  but  are  convex  on  one  side  and  concave 
on  the  other,  so  as  to  form  a  series  of  ball-and-socket  joints, 
admirably  adapted  to  give  the  greatest  flexibility ;  and  in  fishes, 
both  surfaces  of  each  vertebra  are  concave,  and  work  upon  a 
nearly  globular  bag  of  fluid,  which  is  interposed  between  them. 
Such  an  arrangement  as  this  last  weakens  the  spine  to  a  degree, 
which  would  prevent  its  being  ever  employed  in  a  land  animal ; 
in  which  the  weight  of  the  body  is  thrown  upon  only  four  points, 
and  in  which  there  must  be  a  certain  resistance  in  the  connecting 
framework :  but  in  Fishes,  in  which  every  part  of  the  body  is 
equally  buoyed  up  by  the  surrounding  element,  there  is  no  neces- 
sity for  such  power  of  resistance  ;  and  flexibility  is  the  great 
object  to  be  attained.  In  some  of  the  lowest  Fishes,  such  as  the 
Lamprey  (Fig.  44),  there  is  no  proper  vertebral  column ;  the 


FIG.  44.— LAMPREY. 


spinal  cord  being  inclosed  in  a  flexible  cartilaginous  tube,  the 
division  of  which  into  segments  is  only  marked  by  some  cross 
wrinkles :  and  in  one  species,  even  this  is  wanting,  the  spinal 
cord  being  only  surrounded  by  a  membranous  envelope.  Such 


VERTEBRAL    COLUMN    AND    ITS    APPENDAGES.  89 

animals  might  be  thought  to  be  scarcely  entitled  to  a  place  in 
the  Vertebrated  series  ;  but  they  agree  with  Vertebrata  in  other 
points  of  their  conformation  ;  and  the  disappearance  of  even  this 
most  distinctive  character  of  the  group,  in  its  lowest  forms,  is 
exactly  what  we  should  anticipate,  on  the  principles  formerly 
stated  (§  35). 

67.  The  vertebral  column  terminates  at  its  upper  or  anterior 
extremity,  in  the  cranium  or  skull ;  which  is  a  large  bony  struc- 
ture, formed  of  several  pieces,  closely  united  together,  and 
adapted  to  protect  the  brain,  which  it  completely  incloses,  as 
well  as  to  afford  a  secure  lodgment  for  the  organs  of  special 
sense, — the  eyes,  nose,  tongue,  and  ears.  These  organs,  with 
very  few  exceptions  (and  these  principally  relating  to  the  eyes), 
are  all  present  in  every  Vertebrated  animal ;  which  is  not  the 
case  in  regard  to  the  greater  portion  of  the  Invertebrata. — At 
the  opposite  end,  the  vertebral  column  is  usually  contracted  into 
a  tail ;  which  is  composed,  like  the  part  that  gives  support  to  the 
trunk,  of  vertebras  jointed  together ;  but  which  is  not  penetrated 
by  the  spinal  cord.  The  tail  is  developed  in  various  degrees  in 
different  animals  ; — least  in  Man,  and  in  the  Apes  which  approach 
nearest  to  him,  although  even  they  have  a  rudiment  of  it ; — and 
most  in  Serpents  and  Fishes,  in  which  the  tail  is  the  continuation 
of  the  body.  It  has  to  serve  a  great  variety  of  purposes ;  and  is 
often  an  organ  of  the  greatest  importance  in  locomotion. — A 
curious  antagonism  may  often  be  observed,  between  the  develop- 
ment of  the  cranium,  and  that  of  the  tail.  When  the  head  is 
large,  as  in  Man,  the  tail  is  most  commonly  short  and  insignifi- 
cant ;  and  when  the  tail  is  very  large,  the  skull  is  usually  small ; 
but  this  does  not  invariably  hold  good. 

68.  With  the  vertebral  column  are  connected  the  ribs,  which 
are  rarely  absent;  and  also  the  bones  of  the  extremities  or 
members,  which  are  also  occasionally  wanting,  and  which  are 
developed  in  very  varying  degrees  in  different  species.  They  are 
altogether  absent  in  the  Serpent  tribe,  and  also  in  a  considerable 
group  of  Fishes.  In  the  Whale  tribe,  the  posterior  extremities 
are  absent ;  and  the  anterior  members,  forming  the  paddles  or 
flappers,  are  small  in  comparison  with  the  bulk  of  the  body. 


90    MEMBERS,    AND    ORGANS    OF    NUTRITION,    IN    VERTEBRATA. 

The  extremities  attain  their  greatest  development  in  Birds  and 
terrestrial  Mammals ;  whose  motion  is  almost  entirely  due  to 
them.  In  these  cases,  the  spinal  <  olumn  requires  more  firmness ; 
in  order  that  a  sufficient  support  may  be  given  to  the  limbs,  and 
that  the  muscles  that  move  them  may  have  fixed  points  from 
which  to  act.  Hence  the  vertebras  are  often  found  to  be  securely 
locked  together  by  processes,  or  projections  of  bone,  which  fit 
into  each  other,  and  render  displacement  difficult,  even  when  the 
ligaments  have  been  removed.  This  is  most  the  case  in  Birds, 
in  which  class  the  whole  bony  framework  of  the  trunk  is  so 
constructed,  as  to  be  very  little  capable  of  movement ;  the  powers 
of  motion  being  delegated,  as  it  were,  to  the  limbs,  which  can 
act  more  advantageously,  in  proportion  to  the  fixity  of  the  points 
from  which  their  muscles  act.  They  stand  in  remarkable  con- 
trast, therefore,  to  the  groups  of  Fishes  and  Serpents,  just  now 
adverted  to  ;  in  which,  from  the  absence  or  low  development  of 
the  extremities,  the  movements  are  performed  altogether  by  the 
trunk,  and  the  vertebral  column  is  proportionally  flexible. — In 
no  instanc^  is  the  number  of  members  greater  than  four. 

69.  All  the  Vertebrata  are  distinguished  from  Invertebrated 
animals,  by  the  possession  of  red  corpuscles  (commonly  termed 
globules)  in  their  blood ;  and  this  gives  to  their  circulating  fluid 
a  marked  difference  from  that  of  the  lower  tribes,  which  is  colour- 
less or  nearly  so,  containing  only  the  white  or  colourless  corpuscles, 
(ANIM.  PHYSIOL.  §  235).  There  is,  moreover,  a  separate  sys- 
tem of  vessels  for  the  absorption  of  nutrient  fluid,  both  from 
the  alimentary  canal,  and  from  the  substance  of  the  body  itself; 
to  which  we  find  nothing  analogous  in  the  Invertebrata.  These 
vessels  are  termed  absorbents  (ANIM.  PHYSIOL.  §  217) ;  and  they 
empty  the  fluid,  which  they  have  taken  up,  and  which  bears  a 
strong  analogy  to  the  blood  of  the  Invertebrated  animals,  into 
the  current  of  the  circulating  blood.  This  current  is  regularly 
kept  up,  in  Yertebrata,  by  the  action  of  a  heart,  endowed  with 
considerable  muscular  power;  and  the  blood  is  sent,  by  its  means, 
not  only  to  the  body  in  general,  but  also  to  the  respiratory 
organs,  in  which  it  is  to  be  exposed  to  the  influence  of  the  air. 
These  organs  are  always  restricted  to  some  particular  portion  of 


DIVISION    OF    VERTEBRATA    INTO    CLASSES. 


91 


the  body,  not  being  in  any  instance  diffused  or  scattered  through- 
out the  whole,  as  in  Insects  and  some  other  tribes.  In  all  but 
the  lowest  group,  namely  Fishes,  and  the  lowest  tribe  of  Reptiles 
during  their  larva  state,  the  organs  of  respiration  are  adapted 
to  breathe  air ;  but  in  those,  the  aquatic  respiration,  characteristic 
of  the  Molluscous  classes,  is  still  retained.  In  the  classes  in 
which  the  respiration  is  carried  on  most  actively,  and  in  which 
the  whole  mass  of  the  blood  is  exposed  to  its  influence,  before  again 
circulating  through  the  system, — namely,  Mammals  and  Birds, — 
the  animal  has  the  power  of  maintaining  an  elevated  temperature, 
independent  of  that  of  the  surrounding  air  ;  and  they  are  termed 
warm-blooded  from  this  circumstance ;  those  in  which  the  tem- 
perature of  the  body  varies  with  that  of  the  surrounding  air  or 
water,  being  cold-Hooded.  There  is  further  essential  distinction 
among  the  different  classes  of  Yertebrata,  dependent  on  the  mode 
in  which  the  function  of  reproduction  is  performed  in  them ;  this 
takes  place  by  eggs  in  the  three  lowest  classes  ;  but  in  the  highest, 
that  of  Mammals,  the  young  are  born  alive,  and  are  nourished 
afterwards  by  suckling. 

70.  It  is  upon  the  mode  in  which  the  functions  of  Circula- 
tion, Respiration,  and  Reproduction,  are  performed,  in  the  different 
groups  of  Vertebrata,  that  the  division  of  them  into  classes  is 
founded ;  and  the  following  table  will  show,  at  a  glance,  the 
principles  on  which  this  is  accomplished;  besides  furnishing  some 
other  characters,  which  have  not  been  here  adverted  to,  but 
which  will  be  hereafter  considered  in  detail,  under  their  respec- 
tive heads  : — 


MAMMALS. 

BIRDS. 

REPTILES. 

FISHES. 

Reproduction 

Viviparous, 

Oviparous, 

Oviparous, 

Oviparous. 

Respiration 

Aerial, 

Aerial, 

Aerial, 

Aquatic. 

Heart 

Four  cavities, 

Four  cavities, 

Three  cavities, 

Two  cavities. 

Circulation       \ 

Complete 

Complete 

Incomplete 

Complete 

I 

double, 

double, 

double, 

single. 

Temperature 

Warm, 

Warm, 

Cold, 

Cold. 

Blood-discs 

Circular,* 

Oval, 

Oval, 

Oval. 

Covering 

Hair, 

Feathers, 

Scales,  or  none, 

Scales. 

ed  for 

Movement  on 
the  ground, 

}Flight>      { 

Movement  on     lSwinmiing. 
the  ground,    1  J 

»  Oval  in  a  few  exceptions. 


CHAPTER  III. 

OF  THE  CLASS  MAMMALIA. 

7 1 .  THE  class  MAMMALIA  is  composed  of  Man,  and  of  all  the 
animals  which  resemble  him  in  the  most  important  points  of  their 
organisation.      It  is  naturally  placed  at  the  head  of  the  Animal 
Kingdom,  because  composed  of  the  beings,  whose  movements  are 
the  most  varied,  whose  sensations  are  the  most  delicate,  whose 
faculties  are  the  most  numerous,  and  whose  intelligence  is  the 
most  developed ;  and  it  interests  us  more  than  any  other,  as  it 
furnishes  us  with  the  animals  which  are  most  useful,  whether 
as  serving  for  our  nourishment  and  for  labour,  or  as  supplying  the 
materials  of  our  manufactures. 

72.  It  is  in  general  easy  to  distinguish  a  Mammal,  at  the 
first  glance,  from  a  Bird,  a  Reptile,  a  Fish,  or  any  other  animal ; 
by  the  single  observation  of  its  external  form,  and  the  nature  of 
its  covering :  for  the  Mammalia  are  the  only  vertebrated  animals 
whose  bodies  are  covered  with    hair;    and  their  general  form 
usually  differs  but  little  from  that  of  the  species,  which  we  have 
continually  before  us,  and  which  we  naturally  take  as  the  types 


FIG.  45. — PORPOISK. 


of  this  group.  But  sometimes  they  are  not  recognised  by  so  slight 
an  examination ;  for  there  are  some,  whose  skin  is  completely 


DEVELOPMENT    AND    LACTATION    OF    MAMMALIA.  93 

bare,  and  whose  body,  instead  of  resembling  that  of  a  Dog,  a 
Horse,  or  any  ordinary  Mammal,  presents  the  form  belonging  to 
Fishes.  Such  are  the  Porpoise,  the  Whale,  and  other  Mammals 
of  the  order  Cetacea,  which  are  commonly,  but  erroneously, 
reckoned  as  Fishes.  (§  25). 

73.  Development  and  Lactation. — That  which  is  most  dis- 
tinctive of  the  Mammalia,  is  their  mode  of  development  and  of 
nourishment  during  the  earliest  period  of  life.  These  animals 
are  all  viviparous ;  and  whilst  in  an  embryo  condition,  their  life 
is  not  supported  by  their  own  store  of  nutritive  matter,  as  we  see 
is  the  case  amongst  oviparous  animals,  but  they  derive  their 
nourishment  direct  from  the  blood  of  the  mother;  and,  after 
birth,  the  young  still  live  at  her  expense,  as  she  suckles  them  for 
a  longer  or  shorter  time.  The  milk,  destined  for  this  purpose,  is 
a  white  and  opaque  liquid,  composed  of  water,  holding  in 
solution  sugar,  casein,  salt,  and  a  little  free  lactic  acid;  and 
holding  in  suspension  some  globules  of  butter.  Its  qualities  vary 
a  little  amongst  different  animals,  and  may  be  modified  by  the 
food  of  which  they  make  use.  In  general  it  leaves,  by  evapora- 
tion, from  ten  to  twelve  per  cent,  of  solid  parts ;  but  its  richness 
may  vary  much  according  to  circumstances.  This  nutritious 
liquid  is  secreted  by  particular  glands,  named  mammary;  which 
exist  in  both  sexes ;  but  which  only  serve  for  the  support  of  the 
young,  amongst  the  female.  Analogous  organs  are  not  to  be  met 
with  in  any  other  class  of  the  Animal  Kingdom ;  and  it  is  from 
their  existence,  amongst  all  the  animals  composing  the  group 
whose  history  we  are  commencing,  that  Zoologists  have  given  to 
these  beings  the  name  of  MAMMALIA.  The  number  of  the  mam- 
mary glands  is  in  general  nearly  in  proportion  to  that  of  the 
young  produced  at  each  birth.  There  are  often  only  two  (amongst 
the  Monkeys,  the  Elephant,  the  Goat,  and  the  Horse,  for  ex- 
ample) ;  but  sometimes,  also,  their  number  is  much  more  con- 
siderable. Thus,  the  Cow,  the  Stag,  the  Lion,  have  four ;  the 
Cat,  eight;  the  Pig  and  the  Rabbit,  ten;  the  Rat,  ten  or  twelve; 
and  the  Agouti,  twelve  or  fourteen.  The  position  of  these  glands 
varies  also.  Amongst  the  Monkeys  and  Bats  they  are  placed 
under  the  thorax,  as  in  Man ;  in  the  greatest  number  of  Carni- 


94  DEVELOPMENT    AND    LACTATION    OP    MAMMALIA. 

vorous  animals,  they  are  situated  on  the  abdomen,  as  well  as  the 
thorax ;  and  in  the  Horse,  Cow,  and  Sheep,  &c.,  they  are  placed 
still  farther  back,  near  the  hip-joirt. 

74.  Sometimes  the  young  are  born  with  their  eyes  open,  and 
can  immediately  run  about,  and  procure  their  own  food ;  but  a 
great  number  of  the  Mammalia  come  into  the  world  with  their 
eyes  shut,  and  in  a  state  of  such  weakness  that  they  can  scarcely 
move.  There  are  even  some,  that  appear  as  if  born  prematurely; 
for  their  body  is  hardly  formed,  and  they  could  not  live  if  they 
did  not  become  grafted,  as  it  were,  on  the  breast  of  their  mother, 
where  they  remain  suspended  for  a  considerable  time.  It  is  also 
to  be  remarked,  amongst  the  greater  part  of  the  animals  which 
are  born  in  this  extreme  state  of  imperfection,  that  the  skin  of 
the  abdomen,  in  front  of  the  mammary  glands,  forms  a  pouch, 


FIG.  46. — OPOSSUM. 


which  contains  and  protects   the  young.     This   peculiarity  of 
structure  characterises  the  Opossums  (Fig.  46),  the  Kangaroos, 


COVERING    OP    THE    MAMMALIA. HAIR.  95 

and  the  other  Mammalia  of  the  order  Marsupialia ; — animals 
which  principally  inhabit  New  Holland.  The  young  complete 
their  development  in  the  interior  of  this  pouch,  each  suspended 
by  a  teat,  which  penetrates  deeply  into  its  mouth,  and  from  which 
the  milk  is  conveyed  into  the  throat,  by  the  contraction  of  the 
muscles  of  the  mammary  glands.  When  arrived  at  a  certain  age, 
they  detach  themselves :  but  they  still  continue  to  derive  support 
from  their  mother ;  and,  even  for  a  long  period  after  having  left 
the  pouch,  which  has  until  then  been  their  home,  they  seek  it  as  a 
refuge  against  cold,  or  the  dangers  by  which  they  are  threatened. 

75.  Teguments. — The  skin,  as  we  have  already  stated,  pre- 
sents amongst  the  Mammalia  many  remarkable  peculiarities.  In 
a  small  number  of  these  animals  it  is  bare ;  but  in  the  principal 
part  it  is  covered  with  hairs,  which  serve  to  protect  it,  and  to 
preserve  the  heat  developed  within  the  body.  The  existence  of 
these  appendages  of  the  skin  is  so  characteristic  of  this  class,  that 
one  of  the  best  Zoologists  of  the  day,  M.  de  Blainville,  has  pro- 
posed to  replace  the  name  of  Mammalia  by  that  of  Pilifers  (hair- 
bearing);  which  would  contrast  with  the  word  Pennifers  (feather- 
bearing),  and  Squamifers  (scale-bearing),  which  he  would  wish 
to  be  adopted  to  designate  Birds  and  Fishes.  The  hairs  are  pro- 
duced by  small  secreting  organs  in  the  thickness  of  the  true  skin, 
or  immediately  under  it.  Each  hair  is  formed  in  a  small  egg- 
shaped  bag,  with  white  and  resisting  walls;  which  opens  at  the 
surface  by  a  narrow  orifice,  and  which  is  called  the  capsule. 
The  interior  of  this  cavity  is  lined  by  a  membrane,  some- 
times reddish,  sometimes  differently  coloured,  which  appears  to 
be  a  continuation  of  the  outer  layer  of  the  skin;  and  at  its  lower 
part  is  found  a  conical  papilla  or  bulb,  which  receives  a  nerve  and 
blood-vessels,  and  which  produces  the  hair.  The  substance  of 
which  these  appendages  are  principally  composed,  is  more  analo- 
gous to  horn  than  any  other.  In  examining  them  with  a  micro- 
scope we  sometimes  see  very  distinctly,  that  they  are  formed  of 
a  number  of  small  cones  one  within  the  other ;  but,  in  general, 
they  have  the  appearance  of  a  simple  horny  tube,  whose  interior 
seems  to  be  filled  with  pulpy  matter.  Amongst  the  greatest 
number  of  Mammals  the  hairs  are  cylindrical,  or  rather  larger  at 


96 


COVERING    OF    MAMMALIA. HAIR,    QUILLS,    ETC. 


the  bottom  than  at  the  top;  they  are  frequently  more  or  less 
flattened,  and  some  are  completely  laminated,  or  pressed  into 
plates,  like  blades  of  grass.  Sonutimes  their  surface  appears  to 
be  perfectly  smooth,  and  at  other  times  it  is  fluted,  or  furnished 
with  little  elevations,  or  else  presents  a  bead-like  appearance.  In 
short,  their  size,  their  shape,  and  their  elasticity,  vary  greatly 
among  different  animals,  and  even  in  different  parts  of  the  body 
of  the  same  individual. 

76.  The  name  by  which  we  distinguish  the  numerous  varie- 
ties of  hair,  differs  according  to  the  properties  of  these  horny 
filaments,  and  according  to  the  parts  on  which  they  grow.  Thus 
they  are  termed  prickles  when  they  are  very  large,  pointed  and 
stiff,  resembling  spines  (in  the  Porcupine  and  the  Hedgehog  for 
instance)  ;  and  bristles  when  they  are  smaller  and  less  resisting, 
but  still  very  stiff,  except  towards  their  extremity,  as  the  Hog. 


''      SALUr.rD.OlOT 


FIG.  47-  —  PORCUPINE. 


Horse-hair  only  differs  from  Bristles,  in  being  a  little  more 
supple,  and  of  smaller  size  ;  in  general  it  is,  like  them,  quite 
straight  ;  sometimes,  however,  especially  when  very  long,  it  is 


HAIRY    COVERINGS    OF    THE    MAMMALIA.  97 

slightly  curled.  Wool  is  a  kind  of  long  hair,  very  fine,  and 
twisted  in  every  direction ;  and  lastly,  Down  is  composed  of  hairs 
of  extreme  fineness  and  softness,  and  is  principally  found  hidden 
under  a  more  or  less  dense  covering  of  common  hair. 

77.  The  colour  of  hair  varies  much,  but  is  almost  always 
some  modification  of  white,  black,  brownish-red,  or  yellow  ;  it 
appears  to  depend  on  the  existence  of  a  coloured  fatty  matter, 
which  is  soluble  in  boiling  alcohol.  When  this  oil  is  extracted 
by  the  action  of  the  liquid  just  mentioned,  the  hair  always 
becomes  of  a  grayish  yellow.  In  white  hair  we  also  find  a 
white  oil,  which  in  red  hair  is  replaced  by  a  reddish  oil ;  and  in 
black  hair,  the  existence  of  an  oil,  tinged  of  a  blackish-blue  by 
sulphuret  of  iron,  has  been  observed.  Sometimes  the  hairs  pre- 
serve the  same  colour  through  their  entire  length  ;  sometimes 
their  hue  is  deeper  at  the  point  than  at  the  base  ;  and  sometimes, 
also,  they  present  a  series  of  white  and  coloured  rings.  More- 
over, their  colour  varies  nearly  always  in  different  parts  of  the 
body ;  and  the  general  arrangement  of  these  tints  is  character- 
istic of  particular  species  of  Mammals.  These  colours  are  gene- 
rally much  deeper  on  the  upper  than  on  the  under  surface  of  the 
body  ;  and  when  they  form  spots,  these  are  nearly  always  dis- 
posed symmetrically  on  each  side  ; — provided,  at  least,  that  the 
animals  have  not  been  domesticated,  for  then  their  markings  often 
present  very  great  irregularity.  The  colour  and  marking  are 
usually  the  same  in  both  sexes,  and  in  general  vary  but  little 
at  different  ages.  In  some  species,  however,  the  young  have 
spots,  and  a  variety  of  shades,  which  disappear  in  the  adult ; 
and  it  frequently  happens  that  the  colour  of  the  Mammalia 
changes  with  the  seasons. 

78.  The  hairs  generally  fall  off  at  a  certain  period  of  the 
year,  and  are  replaced  by  others ;  this  moulting  chiefly  takes 
place  in  Spring  and  Autumn.  Sometimes  this  is  effected  without 
the  colour  being  altered ;  at  other  times  it  causes  very  consider- 
able changes  both  in  the  colour,  the  quantity,  and  the  nature 
of  the  hair.  Thus  our  common  Squirrel  (Fig.  48),  whose  hair 
is  deep-red  in  summer,  becomes  a  beautiful  blue-grey  in  winter. 
In  this  latter  season,  the  fur  of  the  Mammalia  is  generally  much 


98 


FUR    AND    SCALES    COVERING    MAMMALIA. 


thicker  than  in  summer ;  and  under  the  softer  hairs  we  find  a 
greater  or  less  quantity  of  down,  which  forms  a  part  of  it.    The 

influence  of  temperature  is 
perceived  in  the  same  man- 
ner, in  the  covering  of 
animals  inhabiting  different 
climates  ;  for  those  of  cold 
countries  have  a  thick  fur, 
abundantly  furnished  with 
down  ;  whilst  those  of 
warmer  climates  have 
nothing  but  a  few  short, 
dry  hairs.  That  which 
particularly  distinguishes 
Furs,  is  the  fineness, 
softness,  brightness,  and 
abundance  of  the  hair; 
and  after  what  has  been 
said  with  regard  to  the  influence  of  the  seasons  and  climate  upon 
the  covering  of  the  Mammalia,  we  may  anticipate  that  it  is  in 
the  coldest  countries,  on  the  mountains,  and  particularly  during 
the  winter,  that  the  most  beautiful  fur-skins  are  found  ;  and,  in 
fact,  it  is  from  the  North,  that  the  greatest  part  of  these  are 
brought.  France,  and  the  neighbouring  countries,  furnish  some 
furs  ;  but  it  is  chiefly  in  Siberia,  and  the  northern  part  of  Ame- 
rica, that  the  trade  in  Furs  becomes  really  important. 

79.     When  the  bulbs  of  the  hair  are  set  very  close,  the  horny 


FIG.  48. — SQUIRREL. 


FIG.  49. — PANGOLIN. 

filaments  which   they   produce  unite  themselves   (as   it   were) 


SCALY    COVERING,    AND    SKELETON  OF    MAMMALIA. 


99 


together,    and  form   solid    plates  ;    it  is  in    this  way  that  the 
scales  are  produced,  which  cover  the  body  of  some  very  remark- 

able Mammalia,  known 
under  the  name  of  Pango- 
lins (Fig.  49)  ;  and  the  cui- 
rass of  the  Armadillos  (Fig. 
50).  Anatomists  agree  also 
in  regarding  the  nails  and 
the  horns  of  other  Mam- 

mals, as  having  the   same 

Fio.aa-AHMAu.Lu> 


80.     Skeleton.     The  general  form  of  the  body  is  principally 
governed  by  that  of  the  Skeleton  ;  sometimes,  however,  it  pre- 


FIG.  51. — SKELETON  OF  THE  CAMBL. — vc,  cervical  vertebrae ;  vd,  dorsal  vertebrae ; 
vl,  lumbar  vertebrae ;  vs,  sacral  vertebra?  ;  vg,  caudal  vertebrae  ;  e,  ribs  ;  0,  scapula  ; 
h,  humerus;  CM,  bone  of  fore-arm;  ca,  carpus;  me,  metacarpus;  ph,  phalanges; 
ft,  femur ;  ro,  patella ;  ti,  tibia  ;  ta,  tarsus  ;  ml,  metatarsus. 

sents  peculiarities  which  do  not  correspond  with  the  arrange- 
ment of  the  internal  frame-work  ;  thus  the  hump  on  the  back  of 
the  Camel  is  not  supported  by  bone,  and  only  consists  of  a  mass 

H  2 


100  SKELETON    OF   MAMMALIA. 

of  fatty  tissue. — The  Skeleton  of  Mammals  always  shows  in  its 
conformation  a  great  analogy  with  that  of  Man  (  ANIM.  PHYSIOL. 
§  616 — 649).  The  differences  which  are  remarked  amongst  the 
various  animals  of  this  class,  depend  essentially  ; — First,  on  the 
absence  of  abdominal  members  in  the  fish-like  Mammalia,  such 
as  the  Porpoise,  and  the  Whale,  which  Zoologists  have  included 
in  the  order  Cetacea; — Secondly,  in  the  diminution  of  the 
number  of  fingers,  and  in  the  absence  of  the  Clavicle,  amongst 
the  greater  number  of  those  species  whose  members  serve  only 
for  walking  ; — Thirdly,  in  variations  in  the  number  of  Verte- 
brae, especially  in  the  dorsal  and  caudal  regions; — Fourthly,  in 
the  inequalities  in  the  relative  sizes  of  the  same  bones. 

8 1 .  Conformation  of  the  head.  The  shape  of  the  bony  part 
of  the  head  varies  much,  according  as  the  face  is  more  or  less 
extended,  or  the  skull  developed  in  a  greater  degree ;_  and  the 
study  of  these  differences  in  proportion  is  not  without  interest ; 
for  as  we  have  already  seen,  there  exists,  in  general,  a  very  direct 
connection  between  the  degree  of  intelligence  with  which  an 
animal  is  endowed,  and  the  relative  size  of  that  portion  of  its 
skull  which  contains  the  brain.  The  further  we  remove  from 
Man,  we  see  the  cranium  diminish,  the  jaws  and  the  nasal  cavi- 
ties become  more  extended  ;  the  orbits  are  directed  more  and 
more  outwards,  and  become  less  and  less  distinct  from  the  tem- 
poral fossse;  and  finally  the  occipital  foramen,  (the  aperture  which 

gives  a  passage  to  the 

t  f     o          n  m  ' 

spinal  marrow,)  and 
the  two  condyles  by 
which  the  head  is 
connected  with  the 
vertebral  column,  in- 
stead of  being  placed 
towards  the  middle 
mi  mo  c  of  the  inferior  sur- 

FIG.  52.— SKULL  OF  HORSE;  oc,  occipital  bone;  t,  tern-  face    Of    ^he    cranium, 

poral ;  /,  frontal ;  n,  nasal ;  TO,  superior  maxillary ;  im,  . 

intermaxillary ;  mi,  inferior  maxillary ;  o,  orbit ;  t,  in-  are      earned       turther 

cisor  teeth ;  c,  canines;  mo,  molars.  and  further  back>  and 

end  by  occupying  the  posterior  aspect  of  it.     So  that  the  jaws, 


l 


HORNS    OF    MAMMALIA. 


101 


instead  of  forming  a  right  angle  with  the  vertebral  column, 
become  parallel  with  the  axis  of  the  body.  The  mode  in  which 
the  lower  jaw  is  articulated  with  the  cranium,  is  characteristic  of 
the  Mammalia  ;  this  bone  is  directly  connected  with  the  skull,  by 
two  projecting  condyles ;  and  the  portion  of  the  temporal  bone 
which  receives  it,  is  united  with  that  which  forms  part  of  the 
walls  of  the  skull ;  whilst  amongst  Birds,  Reptiles,  and  Fishes, 
the  jaw  is  suspended  by  an  intermediate  bone,  interposed 
between  it  and  the  main  portion  of  the  temporal. 

82.  Some  of  the  Mammalia  have  a  remarkable  peculiarity  in 
the  conformation  of  their  head, — the  existence  of  horns  of  various 
lengths.  Sometimes  these  prolongations  are  only  appendages  of 
the  skin,  and  appear  to  be  formed  of  hairs  united  together ;  this 

is  the  case  with  the  tusk  with 
which  the  nose  of  the  Rhinoceros 
is  armed.  In  general,  however, 
it  is  otherwise;  the  axis,  or  centre 
of  these  appendages  being  formed 
by  a  prolongation  of  the  frontal 
bone.  The  Mammalia  which  are 
furnished  with  bony,  branching 
horns,  all  belong  to  the  order  of  the  Ruminants ;  and  exhibit  very 

considerable     differ- 
\f  ences  in  the  structure 

of  these  organs.  The 
bony  protuberance 
is  sometimes  covered 
by  the  skin  of  the 
forehead,  which  does 
not  differ  at  this  part 
from  that  of  the  rest 
of  the  body,  and 
which  does  not 
change  ;  this  is  the 

case  with  the  Giraffe. 
PIG.  54.-STAG.  In  other  cageS)   the 

bony   portion  of  these   horns   is  at  6rst    covered  with  a  hairy 


FIG.  53.— RHINOCEROS. 


102  GROWTH    OF    HORNS. 

skin,  which  wears  away ;  and  after  it  has  remained  bare  for  a 
certain  time,  it  falls  off  and  gives  place  to  a  new  horn,  which 
is  destined  to  experience  the  same  changes  in  its  turn. 
These  perishable  horns  are  called  antlers;  and  they  are  only 
found  amongst  animals  of  the  Stag  tribe.  In  other  instances, 
again,  the  bony  axis  grows  during  the  whole  of  life,  never  falls 
off,  and  is  covered  with  a  kind  of  sheath  composed  of  an  elastic 
substance,  named  horn,  which  is  analogous  to  that  of  the  nails, 
and  which  increases  by  different  layers.  The  name  of  hollow 
horns  is  given  to  these  appendages,  when  thus  inclosed  in  a  case 

which  seems  formed  of  united 
hairs ;  and  we  find  them  amongst 
the  different  kinds  of  Oxen,  Sheep, 
Goats,  and  Antelopes.  It  is 
further  to  be  noticed,  that  in  all 
these  animals,  with  the  exception 
of  the  Antelope,  the  bony  core 
of  the  horns  is  hollowed  out  into 
large  cells,  which  communicate 
FIG.  55.-H*AD  OF  A  GOAT.  with  tne  frontal  sinus  of  the  nose, 

and  thus  receive  air  into  their  interior. 

83.  The  mode  of  formation  and  renewal  of  the  kind  of  horn 
known  under  the  name  of  antler,  is  very  simple,  and  is  worthy 
of  notice  in  this  place.  At  a  certain  age,  there  is  developed  on 
each  side  of  the  frontal  bone,  a  projection,  whose  formation  may 
be  compared  to  that  of  the  tumours  known  in  medicine  under  the 
name  of  exostoses  ;  or  to  that  of  the  callus^  which  is  deposited 
around  the  extremities  of  the  ordinary  bones  in  cases  of  fracture, 
and  which  causes  the  consolidation.  These  protuberances,  whose 
tissue  is  very  compact,  grow  rapidly,  and  raise  up  the  skin  which 
covers  them.  This  receives  a  great  quantity  of  blood  from 
numerous  vessels  which  run  along  the  surface  ;  but  there  is  soon 
formed,  at  the  base  of  this  bony  protuberance,  a  circle  of  little 
eminences,  or  tubercles,  which,  by  their  growth  compress  the 
vessels  and  destroy  them.  Now  when  this  cutaneous  envelope 
of  the  horn  receives  no  more  blood,  it  dies,  withers  away,  and 
peels  off.  The  horn  is  then  laid  bare ;  and  soon  experiences  the 


GROWTH    OF    HORNS. PROBOSCIS. 


103 


fate  of  all  bones  deprived  of  their  soft  surrounding  parts  and 
remaining  exposed  to  the  air ;  that  which  takes  place  as  a  result 
of  injury  in  the  human  body,  here  occurs  in  consequence  of  the 
natural  changes  which  have  been  just  related.  The  bone  is 
affected  with  the  disease  termed  Necrosis^  dies,  and  finally 
detaches  itself  from  the  head,  and  falls  off.  The  animal  then 
remains  unarmed  ;  but  after  a  short  time  (generally  24  hours), 
a  thin  pellicle  covers  the  wound  created  by  the  fall  of  the  horn, 
and  a  fresh  bony  prominence  soon  rises  up  in  the  place  of  the 
old  one.  In  general  the  new  horn  acquires  much  greater  size 
than  that  which  it  succeeded.  The  number  of  its  branches  is 
also  usually  much  more  considerable  ;  but  it  does  not  last  longer, 
and  it  passes  through  the  same  changes  as  the  first.  It  is 

generally  in  spring  that  these  curious 
phenomena  take  place  ;  and  the  re- 
newal of  these  horns  occurs  nearly 
every  year.  The  male  alone  usually 
has  the  head  adorned  in  this  manner. 
One  remarkable  species,  the  Rein- 
deer, forms,  however,  an  exception 
to  this  rule ;  the  female  having 
horns  as  well  as  the  male. 

84.  A  curious  anomaly,  which  is 
met  with  in  the  conformation  of  the 
head  in  certain  Mammalia,  depends 
on  an  excessive  development  of  the 
nose,  which  is  prolonged  so  as  to 
form  a  movable  and  prehensile 
trunk.  Such  is,  in  fact,  the  nature 
of  the  organ  which  gives  so  peculiar 
an  appearance  to  the  Elephant,  and 
to  which  it  owes  its  great  address. 
The  trunk  of  these  animals  is  a  double  tube,  which  is  continuous 
above  with  the  cavity  of  the  nose,  and  which  is  lined  internally 
with  a  nbro-tendinous  membrane ;  around  this  are  fixed  some 
thousands  of  small  muscles,  variously  twisted  and  arranged,  so 
as  to  lengthen  it,  to  shorten  it,  and  to  bend  it  in  all  directions. 


FIG.  56 — TRUNK  OF  AN  ASIATIC 
ELEPHANT. 


104  TRUNK    OF    THE    ELEPHANT. 

At  its  upper  extremity  there  exists  a  cartilaginous  and  elastic 
valve,  which,  except  when  raised  by  the  voluntary  contraction 
of  its  muscles,  intercepts  the  communication  between  the  nasal 
cavity  and  the  outside ;  and  at  its  free  extremity  is  found  an 
appendage,  shaped  like  a  finger,  and  equally  movable.  This 
long  trunk  serves  the  animal  to  seize  whatever  it  wishes  to 
carry  to  its  mouth,  to  take  up  the  grass  and  the  leaves  with 
which  it  supports  itself,  and  to  suck  up  the  water,  which  it 
then  ejects  into  its  throat :  without  it,  the  general  confor- 
mation of  its  body  would  render  its  continued  existence  im- 
possible ;  for  in  order  that  an  animal  may  conveniently  obtain 
its  nourishment  from  the  grpund,  it  is  requisite,  if  it  is  not 
provided  with  special  organs'  of  prehension,  that  the  length  of  its 
neck  should  be  proportional  to  that  of  its  legs ;  so  that,  by  its 
head,  it  may  be  able,  without  bending  them,  to  touch  the  ground 
with  its  lips.  If  it  is  high  on  its  feet,  it, must,  therefore,  have  a 
long  neck ;  and  this,  in  its  turn,  would  be  incompatible  with  a 
very  large,  heavy  head,  the  weight  of  which  would  become  still 
more  difficult  to  support,  if  it  were  placed  at  the  end  of  a  still 
longer  neck.  Hence  we  observe,  that  amongst  all  the  animals 
whose  legs  are  long,  and  whose  mouth  serves  for  the  prehension 
of  their  food  (the  Giraffe,  for  example),  the  neck  is  long,  and  the 
head  small ;  whilst  among  those  whose  head  is  strong  and  heavy, 
or  destined  to  execute  very  energetic  movements,  the  neck  is 
more  or  less  short.  Now,  the  Elephant  is  a  very  large  animal, 
whose  head  is  very  far  removed  from  the  ground,  and  of  a  size  in 
proportion  with  the  enormous  defences  with  which  the  upper  jaw 
is  armed  ;  its  weight  is  consequently  very  considerable,  and  the 
neck  which  supports  it  very  short.  If  it  were  deprived  of  its 
trunk,  it  would,  therefore,  be  necessary  to  reconstruct  the  whole 
remainder  of  its  organisation  upon  a  different  plan. 

85.  The  Elephants,  of  which  there  are  only  two  species  at 
present  existing, — the  one  belonging  to  Africa,  and  the  other  a 
native  of  India, — are  the  only  Mammalia  that  are  provided  with 
such  an  organ  of  prehension ;  but  there  exists  something  analogous 
to  it  amongst  certain  animals  of  the  same  class,  which  are  destined 
to  seek  their  nourishment  from  the  ground.  Thus  the  Tapirs, 


PROBOSCIS.—  VE11TEBRAL    COLUMN.  105 

animals  nearly  allied  to  the  Hog,  have  their  nose  much  prolonged 
in  front  of  the  mouth,  constituting  a  little  trunk,  capable  of 
lengthening  and  shortening  itself.  The  Desmans,  small  insecti- 
vorous animals,  nearly  allied  to  the  Shrews,  but  formed  to  swim 


FIG.  58.— DESMAN. 
FIG.  57.— HEAD  OF  TAPIR. 

with  ease,  and  to  live  at'  the  bottom  of  ourrows  hollowed  in  the 
banks  of  rivers,  also  exhibit  a  similar  conformation. 

86.  The  vertebral  iolumn  in  this  class  presents  only  slight 
modifications ;  and  everywhere  shows  the  same  characteristics  as 
in  Man.  "We  shall  only  remark,  that  it»  length  varies  much,  and 
that  the  number  of  vertebrae  of  which  it  is  composed  is  far  from 
being  uniform.  These  numerical  differences  principally  depend 
on  the  unequal  development  of  the  caudal  portion  (or  tail-end) 
of  the  column.  Thus,  the  coccygeal  vertebrae  sometimes  do  not 
exist  at  all,  (as  amongst  certain  Bats,  for  example)  ;  in  other  in- 
stances, we  reckon  forty,  fifty,  and  even  more  than  sixty  of  them. 
It  is  also  observed,  that  these  coccygeal  vertebrae  are  of  two  kinds; 
in  the  one  kind  a  passage  is  retained  for  the  spinal  marrow,  whilst 


Fro.  59.— FKELKTOV  OF  DUGOXG. 


the  others  have  none.     Their  processes  are  much  larger  when  the 
tail  is  very  strong  and  movable ;  but  among  the  greater  part  of 


106 


VERTEBRAL   COLUMN    OF    MAMMALIA. 


the  Mammalia  this  organ  is  of  little  use  for  locomotion,  though 
amongst  others  it  becomes  a  very  powerful  instrument  for  it. 
Thus,  in  the  Kangaroos,  the  Jerboas,  &c.,  the  tail,  with  the  hind 
feet,  forms  a  kind  of  tripod,  upon  which  the  animal  sits,  and  makes 
its  spring.  Among  a  great  number  of  the  American  Monkeys  it 
is  prehensile,  and  serves  these  animals  as  a  fifth  hand,  to  suspend 
themselves  from  the  branches  of  trees ;  and,  lastly,  amongst  the 
Cetacea,  it  grows  to  an  enormous  size,  and  becomes  the  principal 
instrument  for  swimming.  Under  the  first  caudal  vertebrae  of 

these  last  animals  are  certain  bones 
in  the  shape  of  a  V ;  which  seem 
to  represent  the  ribs  ;  and  which 
are  of  use  in  increasing  the  power 
of  the  muscles  that  bend  this  part 
of  the  body.  The  length  of  the 
neck  also  varies  very  much. — 
Amongst  the  Giraffes,  for  ex- 
ample, it  is  very  considerable ; 
whilst  in  the  Whales  it  is  ex- 
tremely short,  and  yet  the  number 
of  vertebras,  which  are  seven  as  in 
Man,  is  really  the  same.  We  only 
know  one  exception  to  this  rule — 
the  Lamantin,  which  has  only  six. 
The  Ai,  or  Three-toed  Sloth,  con- 
stitutes an  additional  apparent  ex- 
ception ;  the  number  of  its  cervi- 
The  first  and  second  are  the  lowest  cai  vertebrae  seeming  to  be  nine; — 

true  cervical,  the  third  and  fourth  the  ad- 
ditional or  false  cervical,  and  the  lower    but   the    tWO  lowest  of   these    are 

ones  the  dorsal.  famished  with  rudiments  of  ribs, 

as  seen  at  3,4,  in  the  accompanying  figure,  and  are  therefore 
really  dorsal. 

87.  The  conformation  of  the  thorax  varies  but  little ;  the 
number  of  the  ribs  corresponds  with  that  of  the  dorsal  vertebrae, 
and  is  in  general  from  twelve  to  fourteen  pairs  ;  sometimes,  how- 
ever, it  increases  still  more.  Thus,  in  the  Horse,  there  are 
eighteen  pairs,  and  in  the  Indian  Elephant  twenty  pairs.  The 


FIG.  60 VERTEBRAE  OF  Ai. 


MEMBERS   OF   MAMMALIA.  107 

Sternum  is  generally  narrow  and  flat ;  but  amongst  the  Bats, 
where  the  lower  muscles  of  the  wing  are  required  to  have  great 
power,  and  must  find  a  large  surface  for  their  insertion  in  this 
bone,  it  often  presents  on  the  medial  line  an  elevated  crest,  which 
somewhat  resembles  the  keel  of  the  breast-bone  in  Birds.  In 
all  the  animals  of  this  class,  the  thoracic  cavity  is  separated 
from  the  abdomen,  by  a  complete  division  formed  by  the  dia- 
phragm. 

88.  Members.     The  Members  are  four  in  number  among  all 
the  ordinary  Mammalia ;  but  in  the  Whale,  and  other  fish-like 
Mammalia  usually  known  under  the  name  of  Cetacea,  there  are 
only  two,  the  abdominal  members  being  absent.     As  in  Man, 
these  organs  are  always  composed  of  a  jointed  lever,  which  is 
divided  into  three  principal  parts;  —  the  arm  or  the  thigh,  the 
fore-arm  or  the  leg,  and  the  hand  or  foot;  but  the  mode  of  con- 
formation of  these  different  parts  varies  a  little ;  in  accordance 
with  the  uses  to  which  they  are  destined. 

89.  The  frame- work  to  which  the  upper  or  thoracic  extre- 
mity is  attached,  is  principally  composed  of  a  large  flat  bone, 
which  is  supported  on  the  ribs,  and  which  gives  an  attachment  to 
the  humerus;  this  is  called  the  blade-bone,  or  Scapula  (0,  Fig.  51). 
This  bone  is  prolonged  in  a  direction  parallel  to  the  vertebral 
column,  in  proportion  to  the  violence  of  the  efforts,  which  the 
animal  is  destined  to  make  with  the  member  attached  to  it ;  and 
by  this  extension,  it  affords  greater  space  for  the  attachment  of 
the  muscles,  which  draw  the  arm  towards  the  body.     In  those 
Mammals  which  employ  their  upper  extremities  for  prehension, 
or  as  organs  of  flight,  and  which  require  to  draw  them  inwards 
forcibly  towards  the  chest,  we  find  that  the  scapula  is  kept  in  its 
proper  position  by  means  of  the  clavicle,  which  is  united  to  it  at 
one  extremity,  whilst  by  the  other  it  bears  against  the  sternum 
(Fig.  85) ;    but  in  those  species,  in  which  movements  of  this 
kind  are  but  little  or  not  at  all  required,  the  clavicle  is  completely 
wanting,  or  only  a  rudiment  of  it  is  found.     This  is  the  case  in 
all  the  hoofed  Quadrupeds,  as  well  as  in  many  others.     In  cer- 
tain of  the  very  remarkable  Mammalia  of  New  Holland,  such  as 
the  Ornithorhyncus,  on  the  contrary,  the  bones  of  the  shoulder 


108     CONNECTION    OF    MEMBERS    WITH    VERTEBRAL    COLUMN. 


FIG.  61.    STERNAL  APPARATUS  OF 
ORNITHORHYNCUS. 


attain  a  very  high  degree  of  development ;  and  their  arrange- 
ment more  resembles  that  which  is  found  in  Lizards  and  Birds, 
than  that  which  prevails  among  ordinary  Mammals.  A  bone  in 
the  form  of  a  Y  (J,  Fig.  61)  is  applied  on  the  upper  or  anterior 

extremity  of  the  sternum,  s,  and 
sends  its  two  branches  to  the  two 
scapulae,  in  the  same  manner  as 
the  furcula  or  merry-thought  of 
Birds  (ANIM.  PHYSIOL.  §  89  ); 
two  pieces,  c0,  situated  beneath 
this  fork-like  pair  of  clavicles, 
represent  the  coracoid  bone  of 
Birds  and  Lizards,  which  in  ordi- 
nary Mammals  is  but  a  small 
projection  from  the  scapula,  not 
nearly  long  enough  to  reach  the 
sternum  ;  and  finally  the  scapula 
itself,  s,  instead  of  terminating  in 
the  cavity,  A,  which  lodges  the 

head  of  the  humerus,  is  prolonged  beyond  it,  and  comes  to  meet  the 
sternum,  s ; — thus  having  three  bony  connections,  where  in 
many  Mammals  there  is  none  at  all,  and  in  no  others  more  than 
one.  The  functions  of  the  lower  or 
hinder  members  vary  less  than  those 
of  the  upper ;  hence  the  mode  in  which 
they  are  connected  with  the  trunk 
is  much  more  uniform,  except  amongst 
the  Cetacea,  in  which  they  exist  only 

in  a  rudimentary  state ;  the  bones  of          Vm£?mY/ / 

the  hip  are  always  immovably  fixed 
to  the  sacrum,  and  are  united  together 
at  their  lower  extremities,  so  as  to 
form  a  complete  ring  more  or  less  deep,  Plo  62._pKLVrs 

termed  the  pelvis  or  bason.  The  c,  base  of  the  vertebral  column ;  /, 
f  ,  .  A  ,1  '  i  •  i  iliac  bone;  m,  marsupial  bone; 

torm  and  Size  Of  this  bony  Circle  vary  /,  cavity  for  the  head  of  the  femur. 

greatly;  and  it  may  be  remarked  that, 

when  other  things  are  equal,  the  vertical  position — in  which  the 


FORM    OF    THE    MEMBERS. 


109 


trunk  is  raised  upon  the  abdominal  members,  is  much  easier  in 
proportion  as  the  pelvis  is  larger.  It  is  further  to  be  mentioned 
that,  amongst  the  Opossums  and  the  other  Marsupial  Mammals, 
the  muscles  of  the  abdomen,  forming  the  pouch  of  these  animals, 
are  supported  by  two  bones  which  arise  from  the  anterior  part 
of  the  pelvis,  and  are  known  to  Anatomists  under  the  name  of 
Marsupial  bones.  (Fig.  62.) 

90.     The   arm   and  the  thigh  each   present,   among  all  the 
Mammalia,  but  one  bone,  the  humerus  and  the  femur.     The 


FJO  63.— BONKS  OK  THE  ANTERIOR  EXTREMITY  OF  THE  MOLE. 

bones  of  the  fore-arm  and  of  the  leg  are  generally  the  same  as  in 
Man  ;  but  amongst  the  Bats,  there  is  a  distinct  bone  resembling 
a  knee-pan,  in  the  elbow-joint,  as  well  as  in  the  posterior  mem- 
bers. All  these  bones  are  generally  shorter  and  larger,  in  propor- 
tion as  the  animal  has  occasion  to  move  these  limbs  with  greater 
force ;  and  on  the  contrary,  they  are  long  and  thin,  when  quick- 
ness is  the  essential  character  of  the  movement  they  are  destined 
to  execute.  The  Mole, 
which  uses  its  anterior 
members  to  dig  the 
ground  (Fig.  63),  and  the 
Antelopes  (Fig.  64)  or 
the  Musk-deer,  which  as- 
tonish us  by  the  lightness 
and  extent  of  their  leaps, 
will  serve  as  examples  of 
these  two  kinds  of  modi- 
fications. 

91.     When    the  hand 
becomes  the  organ  for  locomotion,  and  not  for  prehension,  the 


/ 


FIG.  64.— BUSS-BOK  ANTELOPE. 


110  MEMBERS,    AND    ORGANS    OF    SENSATION. 

radius  can  no  longer  turn  upon  the  ulna ;  and  is  so  closely 
united  to  it,  that  it  can  no  longer  be  distinguished ;  this  is  also 
the  case  with  fhejibula,  which  is  joined  with  the  tibia  among  the 
hoofed  quadrupeds.  The  conformation  of  the  hand  and  foot 
vary  greatly  in  this  class  of  animals,  according  as  these  mem- 
bers are  intended  to  serve  for  walking,  for  prehension,  for 
swimming,  or  for  flying.  These  curious  modifications  have  been 
elsewhere  dwelt  upon  (ANIM.  PHYSIOL.  Chap.  XII.),  and  con- 
sequently it  is  not  necessary  for  us  to  describe  them  here ;  we 
shall  only  add,  that  the  number  of  fingers  never  exceeds  five,  and 
diminishes  in  proportion  as  the  four  members  are  devoted  more 
exclusively  to  walking. 

92.  Organs  of  Sensation. — The  degree  of  flexibility  of  the 
fingers,  and  the  nature  of  their  movements,  influence  their  use, 
not  only  as  organs  of  locomotion  and  of  prehension,  but  also  as 
instruments  of  the  sense  of  feeling.    When  they  cannot  take  hold 
of  the  objects  to  feel  them,  and  when  the  hand  cannot  mould  it- 
self, as  it  were,  upon  their  form,  feeling  becomes  necessarily  very 
imperfect ;  and  that  which  tends  to  deaden  it  still  more,  is  when 
the  nail,  instead  of  leaving  the  end  of  the  finger  in  great  part 
uncovered,  completely  envelopes  it,  and  takes  the  form  of  a  hoof. 
Now  the  greater  or  less  perfection  of  this  sense  influences,  in  its 
turn,  the  development  of  the  intellect ;  and  it  may  be  said  with 
truth,  that  in  the  immense  majority  of  cases,  if  not  in  every 
instance,  the  faculties  of  Mammalia  are  elevated  in  proportion 
as  their  members  are  better  formed  to  seize  and  to  feel. 

93.  The  organs  of  the  other  senses,  in  all  the  animals  of  this 
class,  present  nearly  the  same  mode  of  organisation  as  in  Man. 
In  those  which  are  remarkable  for  the  delicacy  of  their  smell  (as 
is  the  case  among  the  Carnivora  more  than  any  others — the  Dog, 
for  example),  the  nasal  bones  and  the  frontal  sinuses  are  increased 
very  considerably,  and  the  spongy  bones,  which  project  within 
the  olfactory  cavity,  are  much  more  developed.  (ANIM.  PHYSIOL. 
§  506) .    It  is  easy  to  perceive  the  usefulness  of  these  differences, 
as  they  tend  to  give  to  the  lining  membrane,  which  is  the  seat  of 
this  sense,  a  more  extended  surface. 

94.  The  Eyes  are  in  general  proportionally  larger  among  the 


ORGANS   OF    THE    SENSES    IN    MAMMALIA.  Ill 

nocturnal  Mammalia,  than  in  those  which  seek  their  food  by  day ; 
and,  among  the  former,  the  pupil,  when  contracting  under  the 
influence  of  light,  instead  of  preserving  its  rounded  form,  usually 
becomes  a  narrow  slit.  Amongst  those  which  are  condemned, 
by  their  subterranean  life,  to  complete  darkness,  (as  the  Moles, 
for  example),  the  eyes  become  extremely  small,  and  sometimes 
only  exist  in  a  rudimentary  state ;  and  in  those  Mammalia  which 
live  in  the  water,  the  crystalline  lens  is  more  spherical  than 
among  those  that  live  in  the  air.  This  arrangement  is  necessary, 
in  order  to  increase  the  refractive  power  of  the  eye ;  which,  every 
thing  else  being  equal,  requires  the  power  of  refracting  the  rays 
of  light  with  greater  power,  in  proportion  to  the  density  of  the 
medium  in  which  it  is  placed.  It  is  remarked,  also,  that  among 
many  of  these  animals  there  is,  on  the  choroid  at  the  bottom  of 
the  eye,  a  brilliantly-coloured  spot,  which  is  called  the  tapetum  ; 
but  of  its  use  we  are  ignorant.  There  are  several,  also,  which 
have  a  third  well-developed  eye-lid,  placed  vertically  at  the  in- 
ternal angle  of  the  two  others.  The  direction  of  the  eyes  varies 
much.  In  Man,  they  are  placed  nearly  straight  forwards ;  but, 
as  we  descend  in  the  series  of  Mammalia,  towards  those  whose 
faculties  are  less  developed,  we  see  these  organs  becoming  more 
and  more  lateral  in  their  direction,  until,  among  several,  the 
sphere  of  vision  is  extremely  different  for  each  eye,  so  that  the 
animal  can  scarcely  see  directly  before  him.  This  is  particularly 
the  case  in  such  as  are  most  liable  to  be  pursued  by  others,  and 
is  an  obvious  adaptation  to  their  timorous  habits,  giving  them 
nearly  as  complete  a  survey  of  the  country  behind  as  of  that  in 
front  of  them. 

95.  The  apparatus  of  Hearing  also,  presents,  amongst  the 
Mammalia,  some  modifications  which  appear  to  be  connected  with 
the  habits  of  the  animals.  Among  those  which  live  in  the  water 
or  beneath  the  ground,  the  external  ear  is  generally  very  small, 
or  even  altogether  rudimentary ;  and,  as  we  descend  from  Man 
to  the  Herbivorous  Mammals,  we  find  this  part  of  the  ear  more 
and  more  trumpet-shaped,  becoming  more  and  more  detached 
from  the  head,  and  also  more  movable.  Among  the  Nocturnal 
Quadrupeds,  the  membrane  of  the  tympanum  generally  occupies 


112  NERVOUS    SYSTEM    OF    MAMMALIA. 

more  space,  and  is  placed  more  on  a  level  with  the  outer  surface 
of  the  skull. 

96.  Nervous  System. — The  nervous  system  differs  among  the 
various  Mammalia,  only  in  the  greater  or  less  development  of  cer- 
tain of  its  parts.     In  all  these  animals  the  nervous  mass,  con- 
tained in  the  head,  is  very  considerable,  both  in  proportion  to  the 
extent  of  the  body,  and  relatively  to  the  size  of  the  nerves ;  but 
all  the  organs  which  compose  it  do  not  equally  agree  in  this  de- 
velopment.   Thus,  the  cerebral  hemispheres  are  very  large,  whilst 
the  optic  tubercles  or  ganglia  are  very  small,  and  even  nearly 
rudimentary ;  and  we  shall  hereafter  see,  that  amongst  Birds, 
Reptiles,  and  Fishes,  it  is  quite  otherwise.     The  cerebellum  is  of 
considerable  size  among  the  greater  part  of  the  Mammalia.     It 
always  consists  of  a  central  lobe  of  two  hemispheres,  which  have 
their  surface  marked  by  transverse  furrows ;  and  of  a  commissure, 
or  connecting  band,  which  passes  round  beneath  the  spinal  mar- 
row.    Moreover,  the  development  of  these  parts  varies  much 
among  the  different  Mammalia,  not  only  as  to  their  size,  but  also 
in  regard  to  the  channels  and  convolutions  of  their  surface.    For 
as  we  pass  from  Man  to  the  Apes,  from  these  to  the  Carnivora, 
and  from  the  Carnivora  to  the  Rodentia,  and  to  the  Herbivorous 
Animals,  we  generally  see  the  brain  become  smaller  and  much 
smoother.      It  is  also  to  be  noticed  that,  amongst  the  Mammalia 
of  the  order  Marsupialia,  the  brain  presents  another  character  of 
imperfection,  resulting  from  the  absence  of  the  great  central  com- 
missure, or  corpus  callosum,  which,  in  all  the  other  animals  of  the 
same  class,  connects  together  the  two  cerebral  hemispheres. — 
(ANIM.  PHYSIOL.  §  458.) 

97.  Functions  of  Nutrition. — The  functions  of  nutrition  are 
performed  among   all  the  Mammalia  very  nearly  as  in  Man  ; 
hence  the  structure  of  the  organs,  destined  for  their  exercise, 
varies  but  little  in  this  great  class  of  animals.    It  is  in  the  diges- 
tive apparatus  that  the  most  important  differences  are  exhibited. 
Nearly  all  the  Mammalia  are  provided  with  teeth,  destined  to 
divide  their  food ;  but,  as  we  have  elsewhere  seen  (ANIM.  PHY- 
SIOL. §  182),  the  number  and  form  of  these  organs  varies  accord- 
ing to  the  habits  of  the  animal.    These  organs  are  sometimes  re- 


RUMINANT    STOMACHS.  113 

placed  by  horny  plates,  which  among  the  Whales  constitute  the 
whalebone ;  and  in  another  instance,  again,  the  muzzle  is  pro- 
longed into  a  very  broad  horny  beak,  flat,  and  furnished  at  the 
side  with  transverse  plates ;  thus  showing  the  greatest  resem- 
blance to  the  beak  of  the  Duck,  and  causing  the  animal  in 
which  it  exists  to  receive  the  name  of  Ornithorhyncus,  or  Duck- 
billed Platypus. 

98.  The  conformation  of  the  stomach  varies  much  in  the 
class  Mammalia  ;  and  from  these  differences,  physiological  pecu- 
liarities of  great  importance  sometimes  result.  In  general,  this 
organ  is  simple,  as  in  Man,  and  the  Monkey ;  but  sometimes  it 
is  composed  of  a  numerous  series  of  distinct  sacs ;  and  in  this 
case  it  generally  happens  that  the  food,  after  having  remained 
some  time  in  the  first  cavity  of  the  stomach,  returns  into  the 
mouth, — there  to  undergo  a  more  complete  mastication,  before 
passing  into  the  other  portions  of  the  digestive  tube. — This 
phenomenon  is  known  under  the  name  of  rumination.  The 
number  of  the  stomachs  of  the  animals  which  ruminate  (the  Ox 
and  Sheep,  for  example)  is  four.  The  first,  which  is  the  largest 


CEsophagus   — 


Intestine  - 


Pylorus.    4th  Stom.  2d  Stom.         1st  Stom. 
FJO.  64. — STOMACHS  OF  THE  SHEEP. 


of  all,  is  named  the  paunch.  Its  internal  surface  is  covered  with 
papillae,  and  is  lined  by  a  layer  of  the  epidermis  (Fig.  65).  It 
occupies  a  large  part  of  the  abdomen,  particularly  on  the  left 
side.  The  second  stomach,  called  the  honeycomb,  is  small,  and 


114  RCMINANT   STOMACHS. 

is  found  on  the  right  of  the  oesophagus,  and  in  front  of  the  third  ; 
of  which,  at  first  sight,  it  seems  to  be  an  appendage.  The  mucous 
membrane,  which  lines  its  interior,  forms  a  multitude  of  folds,  so 
arranged  as  to  constitute  polygonal  cells,  like  those  of  a  bee's 
comb.  The  third  stomach,  which  is  smaller  than  the  second,  is 
placed  to  the  right  of  the  paunch,  and  has  received  the  name  of 
manyplies,  on  account  of  the  large  longitudinal  folds  with  which 
its  interior  is  furnished,  and  which  resemble  the  leaves  of  a  book. 
The  fourth  stomach,  or  reed,  which  is  intermediate  in  size  be- 
tween the  paunch  and  the  manyplies,  is  found  on  the  right  of 
this  last  sac.  Its  internal  surface  is  irregularly  folded  ;  and  is 
continually  moistened  by  an  acid  liquid — the  gastric  juice.  It 
is  on  account  of  the  property  which  this  liquid  possesses  of  curd- 
ling milk,  that  the  reed  of  the  calf  is  preserved  as  rennet,  to  be 
used  in  making  cheese.  The  three  first  stomachs  communicate 
directly  with  the  oesophagus.  This  passage  opens  at  first  nearly 
equally  into  the  paunch  and  the  honeycomb ;  and  is  then  conti- 
nued as  a  furrow  or  demi-canal  (Fig.  65.)  which  runs  along  the 


Intestine.  Honeycomb.       Paunch. 

FIG.  65.— SECTION  OF  THE  STOMACHS  OF  THE  SHEEP. 

upper  side  of  the  honeycomb,  and  terminates  in  the  manyplies, 
which,  in  its  turn,  communicates  with  the  reed. 

99.  It  is  in  the  paunch,  that  the  food,  which  is  partially 
reduced  by  a  first  mastication,  accumulates ;  and  it  is  only  after 
having  been  brought  back  into  the  mouth,  and  chewed  a  second 


MECHANISM    OP    RUMINATION.  115 

time,  or,  in  other  words,  ruminated,  that  it  descends  into  the 
manyplies,  and  thence  into  the  fourth  stomach,  which  is  the 
true  seat  of  digestion.  It  is  at  first  very  astonishing  to  see  the 
food  descending,  sometimes  into  the  paunch  and  sometimes  into 
the  manyplies,  according  as  the  deglutition  is  taking  place  for 
the  first  time,  or  as  the  substances  have  been  already  chewed  ; 
and  we  might  be  almost  tempted  to  attribute  this  phenomenon 
to  a  kind  of  tact,  almost  amounting  to  intelligence,  with  which 
the  respective  openings  might  be  endowed.  But  the  recent 
experiments  of  M.  Flourens  show,  that  it  is  a  necessary  conse- 
quence of  the  anatomical  arrangement  of  the  parts ;  and  they  give 
an  explanation  of  it  equally  simple  and  satisfactory.  When  the 
animal  swallows,  unchewed,  the  solid  substances  on  which  it 
generally  feeds,  these  substances,  having  arrived  at  the  point 
where  the  oesophagus  is  continued  as  a  furrow  or  imperfectly- 
covered  channel,  mechanically  separate  the  sides  of  this  demi- 
canal  (which  is  usually  transformed  into  a  tube  by  the  contrac- 
tion of  these  walls),  and  fall  into  the  two  first  stomachs  placed 
beneath  ;  but  when  the  animal  swallows  any  liquid,  or  food 
which  has  been  softened  and  become  semi-fluid,  their  presence  in 
this  canal  does  not  produce  the  separation  of  its  sides.  This  last 
portion  of  the  oesophagus  consequently  preserves  the  form  of  a 
tube,  and  conducts  the  whole  food,  or  the  greater  part  of  it,  into 
the  manyplies,  where  it  terminates.  It  is  consequently  the 
opening  or  shutting  of  this  portion  of  the  oesophagus,  which 
determines  the  entrance  of  the  food  into  the  two  first  stomachs 
or  its  passage  into  the  third  ;  and  it  is  the  state  of  the  food  itself 
which  decides  this, — according  as  it  is  sufficiently  bulky,  or  not, 
to  separate  the  walls  of  the  oesophagus,  which  are  naturally 
pressed  together, — or  to  flow  through  the  channel  that  is  always 
open,  by  which  this  passage  leads  towards  the  manyplies.  The 
food,  after  its  first  deglutition,  is  only  imperfectly  divided,  and 
consists  of  tolerably  large  pieces  ;  whilst  after  having  been  again 
chewed,  they  are  changed  into  a  soft  half-fluid  paste ;  this  cir- 
cumstance is  consequently  sufficient  to  determine  their  fall  into 
the  paunch,  or  their  passage  into  the  manyplies.  With  regard 
to  the  regular  regurgitation,  by  which  the  food  contained  in  the 

i2 


116  RUMINATION. INTESTINAL    CANAL. 

paunch  and   honeycomb  returns  into  the  mouth,   there  to  be 
chewed,  it  has  generally  been   attributed  to  the  action  of  the 
second  stomach  itself,  which  has  been  supposed  to  take  hold  of  a 
portion  of  the  alimentary  mass,  to  compress  it  so  as  to  form  a 
rounded  ball  or  pellet,  and  then  to  send  it  into  the  oesophagus, 
whose  progressive  contractions  from  one  end  to  the  other  com- 
plete the  operation.      But  according  to  the  recent  experiments  of 
the  physiologist  just  quoted,  it  would  appear  that  the  paunch 
and  the  honeycomb  by  their  contraction  force  the  alimentary 
mass  which  they  contain,  between  the  borders  of  the  furrow  of 
the  oesophagus ;  and  that  this,  contracting  in  its  turn,  takes  up  a 
portion  of  it,  separates  it,   and  forms  it  into  the  ball  which  is 
destined  to  return  along  the  oesophagus. — The  paunch  is,  as  we 
have  already  said,  extremely  large ;  but  it  is  not  always  of  the 
same  size ;  and  the  differences  which  are  observed  in  it,  show 
how  much  the  organs  of  animals  may  be  modified  by  the  circum- 
stances in  which  they  are  placed.     In  fact,  whilst  the  animals  of 
the  Ruminant  tribe  are  young,  and  are  living  only  on  milk,  the 
paunch  is  smaller  than  the  reed  ;  and  only  attains  its  enormous 
size  when  it  has  to  receive  grass,  a  substance  that  contains  but 
little  nourishment,  and  of  which  the  animal   is    consequently 
obliged  to  eat  a  considerable  quantity. 

100.  The  intestinal  canal,  as  elsewhere  stated  (ANIM.  PHY- 
SIOL.  §  213),  presents  very  considerable  differences  in  its  length 
and  diameter,  according  as  the  food  which  has  to  pass  through 
it  has  been  obtained  from  the  Animal  or  Vegetable  kingdom. 
Thus,  in  many  of  the  Carnivora  its  length  is  only  about  three  or 
four  times  that  of  the  body ;  whilst  amongst  the  Herbivora  it  is 
usually  from  ten  to  twelve  times,  and  sometimes  nearly  twenty- 
eight  times,  this  length  (in  the  sheep,  for  example).  In  general, 
it  terminates  by  a  direct  external  aperture  ;  sometimes,  however, 
it  enters  a  cavity  named  the  cloaca,  into  which  the  urinary  canals 
also  open.  This  arrangement  is  found  in  the  Ornithorhyncus ; 
and  is  met  with  again  in  the  class  of  Birds  ;  hence  it  is  an  addi- 
tional point  of  connection  between  that  curious  animal,  and  the 
oviparous  vertebrata.  The  salivary  glands,  the  liver,  the  pan- 
creas, the  peritoneum,  and  the  other  appendages  of  the  digestive 


CIRCULATING   APPARATUS   OP    MAMMALS.  117 

canal,  nearly  always  resemble  those  which  have  been  described 
in  Man.  (ANIM.  PHYSIOL.) 

101.  This  is  the  case  also  with  the  Circulating  apparatus, 
and  with  the  respiratory  organs.  The  heart  possesses,  in  every 
instance,  four  cavities ;  known  as  the  two  auricles,  and  the  two 
ventricles  (Fig.  66).  The  lungs  are  always  divided  into  an  im- 


Superior    Pulm.  Pulmonary 

venacava.    art.      Aorta.       artery. 


—  -7  Pulmonary  veins. 
x     «£  (     I — 1-.   fv     V    SS   S 
Pulmonary  veins.  •<-._. 

Right  auricle. ~(^Hjfc/HIP/- Left  auricle. 

Tricuspid  valves.   -— ffi    WmiUm  '    Mitral  valve' 

Inferior  vena  cava.    ~~~L,       |B|M  ^_  . 

Left  ventricle. 
Right  ventricle.     ' 

Partition. 

Aorta. 
FIG.  66.— IDEAL  SECTION  OK  THK  HUMAN  HEART. 

mense  number  of  very  small  cells,  and  do  not  allow  the  air  to 
pass  from  their  interior  into  the  different  parts  of  the  body, 
as  takes  place  amongst  Birds.  It  is  further  to  be  remarked,  that 
the  blood  in  this  class  of  animals  is  always  very  rich  in  organ- 
ised matter,  and  that  its  red  particles  are  nearly  always  of  a 
circular  form. 

102.  The  Mammalia  are,  of  all  animals,  those  which  approach 
the  nearest  to  Man,  in  regard  to  their  intellectual  powers.  But 
in  this  respect  they  present  the  greatest  differences  amongst  them- 
selves, which  have  been  elsewhere  noticed  (ANIM.  PHYSIOL. 
§  717) ;  and  if  space  would  permit  us  here,  it  would  be  easy  to 
multiply  the  proofs  of  this  inequality.  The  study  of  the  habits 
of  the  Mammalia  would  furnish  us  also  with  curious  examples 
of  the  various  kinds  of  instincts  given  by  Nature  to  these  beings, 
to  supply  the  want  of  the  more  elevated  faculties  ;  the  most  im- 


118  MEANS    OF    SUBJUGATING    AMIMALS. 

portant  of  these,  however,  will  be  considered  in  subsequent  parts 
of  this  Treatise. 

103.  The  class  Mammalia  is  also,  of  all  the  divisions  of  the 
Animal  Kingdom,  that  which  interests  us  the  most,  on  account 
of  the  services  which  it  renders  to  Man.  Indeed,  it  is  to  this  that 
nearly  all  the  domestic  animals  belong, — the  Dog,  the  Horse, 
the  Sheep,  and  the  Cow,  for  example ;  and  every  one  is  aware 
how  useful  has  been  their  subjection  to  us.     Our  dominion  over 
these  beings  is  become  so  complete,  that  the  primitive  race,  living 
in  a  savage  state,  has  in  nearly  every  instance  disappeared  from 
the  globe;  and,   by  domestication,    we  are  able  to   exercise  a 
considerable  influence  even  upon  the  physical  forms  and  moral 
qualities  of  those  individuals,  which  spring  from  the  races  that 
are  thus  subjugated  (§  13). — But  by  what  power  can  we  thus 
subjugate  animals,  and  how,  by  domestication,  can  we  modify 
their  forms  and  qualities  ?     The  instinct  of  these  beings  leads 
them  to  fly  from  all  which  inspires  them  with  distrust ;  it  is, 
then,  not  by  violence  that  we  could  compel  a  savage  animal 
to  obedience.    It  would  not  naturally  be  disposed  to  approach  us, 
who  are  not  of  its  own  kind ;  and,  at  the  first  feeling  of  fear 
which  we  might  cause  it  to  experience,  it  would  fly  from  us  if  it 
were  free,  or  would  take  a  dislike  to  us  if  it  were  in  captivity. 
It  is  only  by  inspiring  it  with  confidence,  that  we  can  attract  it 
and  render  it  familiar ;  and  it  is  only  by  kindness  that  we  can 
give  birth  to  confidence. 

104.  To  satisfy  the  natural  wants  of  these  animals,  is  one  of 
the  first  means  of  bringing  them  into  submission.     The  custom 
of  receiving  their  food  from  our  hand,  by  familiarising  them  with 
us,  also  attaches  them  ;  and,  as  the  extent  of  a  benefit  is  always 
in  proportion  with  the  need  which  is  felt  for  it,  their  gratitude  is 
also  much  greater  and  deeper,  when  the  food  that  we  give  them 
is  become  necessary  to  them.     Thus  hunger  is  in  our  hands  a 
powerful  lever,  to  work  upon  all  animals  in  captivity ;  for  at 
the  same  time  that  it  gives  birth  to  affectionate  sentiments,  it 
produces  a  physical  weakening,  which,  by  reacting  upon  the  will, 
weakens  it  in  its  turn.     If,  to  the  influence  of  hunger,  we  add 
that  of  choicely-selected  food,  and  especially  if  we  flatter  their 


tic 

: 


MEANS    OF    SUBJUGATING    ANIMALS.  119 

taste  with  food  which  nature  does  not  furnish  to  them,  we  excite 
in  them  a  still  greater  gratitude ;  and  they  show,  from  an  arti- 
ficial treatment,  new  wants,  which  man  alone  can  satisfy  *  ;  and, 
finally,  to  these  means  we  may  unite  caresses  also,  the  influence 
of  which  is  very  great  over  certain  animals.  When  once,  by 
habit  and  kindness,  familiarity  is  established  and  confidence 
obtained,  Man  may  make  his  authority  felt,  and  may  apply 
punishment,  in  order  to  transform  the  sentiments,  whose  mani- 
festation he  wishes  to  repress,  into  that  of  fear.  By  the  associa- 
tion of  ideas  which  result  from  this  practice,  the  first  of  these 
sentiments  is  weakened  by  degrees,  and  is  sometimes  even  at  last 
completely  destroyed ;  but  the  employment  of  force  ought  never 
to  be  without  a  limit,  for  excessive  punishment  often  excites  to 
revolt ;  and,  at  other  times,  when  fear  is  carried  too  far,  it  dis- 
turbs the  faculties.  The  prevention  of  sleep  is  also  a  powerful 
means  of  weakening  the  will  of  the  animal,  and  of  reducing  it  to 
obedience ;  for  it  does  not  know  how  to  refer  the  fatigue  and 
uneasiness  which  it  experiences  from  it,  to  that  which  is  really 
the  cause  of  it :  and  in  this  state  the  affectionate  feelings  occa- 
sioned by  kindness  experience  less  resistance,  and  take  root  more 
deeply  ;  whilst,  on  the  other  hand,  fear  acts  with  more  readiness 
and  force. 

105.  Thus  we  see,  that  it  is  through  those  wants,  over  which 
we  can  exercise  some  influence,  and  by  repressing  the  manifesta- 
tion of  certain  feelings  by  the  development  of  some  others, 
at  we  are  enabled  to  reduce  animals  to  subjection.  All  the 
ammalia  are  not,  however,  equally  sensible  to  kindness ;  and, 
consequently,  do  not  allow  themselves  to  be  subdued  with  the 
same  readiness,  or  in  so  complete  a  manner.  Their  passions  are 
often  too  violent,  for  the  animal  ever  to  arrive  at  the  mastery  of 
them,  and  to  become  obedient  to  his  master.  Their  natural 
distrust  is  often  so  great,  and  their  excitability  such,  that  we 
know  not  how  to  impose  any  rule  of  conduct  on  them  ;  and  in 
other  instances,  again,  the  intelligence  of  these  beings  appears  too 

*  It  is  chiefly  by  means  of  sugar  and  other  sweetmeats  that  horses  and  deer  are 
trained  to  the  extraordinary  exercises  which  we  sometimes  witness  in  our  circuses. 


120  DOMESTICATION    OF    ANIMALS. 

confined  for  the  remembrance  of  kindness  to  continue  after  its 
cause  has  ceased,  and  for  them  to  associate  in  their  memory  the 
kindness  and  the  benefactor. 

106.  By  such  means,  we  can  reduce  to  more  or  less  complete 
subjection,  a  considerable  number  of  animals;  but  between  this 
state  of  individual  subjection,  and  complete  and  hereditary 
docility,  there  is  still  a  great  difference.  To  obtain  this  last  result, 
the  animals  must  be  in  some  degree  predisposed  to  domestica- 
tion, by  the  instinct  of  sociality,  that  is,  the  tendency  to  associate 
either  with  others  of  their  own  species,  or  with  Man.  In  short, 
the  feeling  which  leads  them  to  live  alone,  and  in  some  cases 
to  fly  from  each  other,  or  that  which  unites  them  into  societies, 
and  disposes  them  to  be  guided  by  a  chief, — the  strongest  and 
most  experienced  of  the  number, — exercises  the  greatest  influence 
upon  their  readiness  to  become  domesticated.  No  solitary  Mam- 
malia, however  easy  it  may  be  to  tame  them,  have  become  com- 
pletely domestic ;  whilst  nearly  all  the  animals,  whose  race  is 
subdued  to  the  dominion  of  Man,  live  naturally  in  societies 
composed  of  a  greater  or  smaller  number.  Sociality  is  one 
condition  of  domestication  :  and  it  is  by  developing  to  our  benefit, 
and  by  directing  towards  us  by  our  kindnesses,  the  feeling  which 
leads  these  animals  to  unite  with  each  other,  that  Man  has  been 
able  to  bind  their  existence  to  his ;  and  to  exercise  over  them  the 
same  authority,  that  the  chief  of  the  troop,  of  which  they  would 
have  formed  a  part,  would  have  possessed,  if  they  had  lived  in 
their  natural  condition.  It  has  been  well  shown  by  M.  Fred. 
Cuvier,  that  the  disposition  to  domestication  may  be  considered 
as  the  extreme  development  of  the  instinct  of  sociality ;  and 
domestication  itself  as  a  state,  in  which  the  social  animals 
acknowledge  Man  as  a  member,  and  as  the  chief  of  their 
number. 

107.  We  can  now  understand  how  Man  can  subjugate  to  his 
dominion  entire  races  of  animals.  We  shall  next  inquire  how 
he  is  able  to  influence  the  forms  and  qualities,  which  belong 
to  them  from  their  birth  :  and  to  create,  as  we  may  say,  new 
varieties  at  will.  It  is  a  physiological  law,  known  to  every  one, 
that  animals  have  a  tendency  to  resemble  their  parents,  not  only 


PRODUCTION    OF    NEW    RACES.  121 

iii  their  general  conformation,  but  also  in  whatever  peculiarities 
may  distinguish  the  latter.  In  the  Human  species,  for  example, 
hereditary  influences  are  manifested  in  a  number  of  forms. 
Bodily  constitutions,  mental  faculties,  characters,  even  infir- 
mities, are  bequeathed  from  generation  to  generation ;  and  in 
animals  among  which  fewer  external  circumstances  act  upon  the 
individuals,  producing  irregularities  in  this  repetition  of  the  same 
forms  and  qualities,  the  tendency  of  the  young  to  resemble  the 
authors  of  their  existence  is  still  more  evident.  Now  all  the 
individuals  of  the  same  species  do  not  possess,  to  the  same  degree, 
the  physical,  moral,  and  intellectual  qualities,  with  which  each 
of  them  is  endowed ;  and  by  the  exercise  or  the  influence  of 
physical  conditions,  we  can  develope  a  particular  faculty,  and 
consequently  increase  these  differences.  It  follows,  then,  that 
Man  may,  within  certain  limits,  modify  races  at  his  pleasure  ; 
for  he  is  able  to  choose,  or  even  to  produce,  individual  differ- 
ences, which  are  transmissible  from  one  to  the  other ;  and  to 
regulate  the  succession  of  generations,  so  as  to  remove  from  them 
all  that  would  tend  to  separate  the  race  from  the  type  which  he 
wishes  to  produce;  and  he  can  thus  influence  the  hereditary 
qualities  of  the  young,  as  he  had  done  those  of  their  parents. 
It  results,  therefore,  from  this,  that  at  each  new  generation,  he 
advances  a  step  nearer  to  the  end  that  he  proposed  to  himself; 
for  he  acts  upon  individuals  already  affected  by  the  modifications 
that  had  been  impressed  upon  their  parents. 

108.  A  very  good  example  of  the  degree  in  which  accidental 
peculiarities,  appearing  in  a  single  individual  only,  may  be  taken 
advantage  of  by  Man,  for  some  purpose  useful  to  him,  is  of  com- 
paratively recent  occurrence.  In  the  year  1791,  one  of  the  ewes 
on  the  farm  of  Seth  Wright,  in  the  state  of  Massachusets, 
produced  a  male  lamb,  which,  from  the  singular  length  of  its 
body,  and  the  shortness  of  its  legs,  received  the  name  of  the 
otter  breed.  This  peculiar  conformation,  rendering  the  animal 
unable  to  leap  fences,  appeared  to  the  farmers  around  so  desir- 
able, that  they  wished  it  continued.  Wright  determined  on 
breeding  from  this  ram ;  but  the  first  year  only  two  of  its 
offspring  were  marked  by  the  same  peculiarities.  In  succeeding 


122  PRODUCTION    OF    NEW    RACES. 

years,  he  obtained  greater  numbers ;  and  when  they  became 
capable  of  breeding  with  one  another,  a  new,  and  strongly- 
marked  variety,  before  unknown  to  the  world,  was  established. 
— This  example  show,s  the  influence  which  a  scanty  population 
may  have  formerly  had,  in  the  production  of  varieties,  both  in  the 
human  and  other  species.  At  the  present  time  the  natural 
tendency  is,  for  any  peculiarity  of  this  kind  to  be  speedily  lost, 
by  the  intermixture  of  the  individuals  which  exhibit  it  with  the 
large  proportion  of  those  in  which  it  is  absent ; — unless  this  be 
prevented,  as  in  the  instance  just  cited,  by  the  interference  of 
Man.  But  it  may  be  imagined  that,  in  the  earlier  ages  of  the 
world,  some  individuals  in  which  a  peculiarity  existed,  may  have 
been  so  far  separated  from  the  rest,  that  frequent  union  took 
place  among  themselves;  so  that  the  character  would  be  rendered 
still  more  marked,  instead  of  disappearing ;  and,  being  propa- 
gated for  a  few  generations,  would  be  rendered  permanent  in 
this  manner.  Thus  by  the  force  of  circumstances,  the  same  crea- 
tion of  a  new  race  would  be  effected,  as  the  breeder  of  animals 
now  accomplishes,  by  the  system  he  adopts. 

109.  It  is  easy  to  adduce  many  instances,  in  which  pecu- 
liarities that  have  been  developed  by  education,  or  by  the 
influence  of  particular .  circumstances  on  the  constitution,  have 
become  hereditary.  The  peculiar  habits  of  the  various  kinds  of 
Dogs  used  in  sporting,  were  doubtless,  for  the  most  part, 
originally  forced  upon  them  (as  it  were)  by  education ;  but  they 
now  become  almost  a  part  of  their  constitution.  Thus  it  is  not 
only  much  easier  to  teach  a  young  Dog  of  the  Pointer  breed  to 
point  game,  than  it  is  to  teach  a  dog  of  any  other  breed  to  do  the 
same ;  but  a  Pointer  puppy,  when  first  taken  into  the  field, 
will  sometimes  perform  its  peculiar  duty  nearly  as  well  as  an 
old  and  experienced  dog.  The  same  has  been  noticed  of  the 
Retriever,  a  breed  of  dogs  whose  duty  it  is  to  stay  by  their 
master  until  the  game  falls  wounded,  and  then  to  bring  it  in ; — 
a  habit  which  might  have  been  supposed  to  be  still  less  likely  to 
be  transmitted,  because  more  unlike  the  ordinary  habits  of  the 
species.  It  would  seem,  however,  that  habits  of  this  kind, 
which  have  been  grafted  upon  an  individual  by  education,  are 


ACQUIRED    INSTINCTS    BECOMING    HEREDITARY.  123 

not  transmitted  to  the  offspring,  when  thoy  are  entirely  wanting 
in  relationship  to  the  natural  condition  of  the  animal.  Thus,  by 
a  long  and  laborious  training,  a  Pig  has  been  taught  to  point 
game  ;  but  there  is  no  reason  to  believe  that  a  breed  of  Pointer 
Pigs  could  be  established. 

110.     The   following  examples    will  show   the    influence   of 
climate,  and  other  circumstances  affecting  the  bodily  constitution, 
in  modifying  the  character  of  a  race.     It  is  well  known  that  the 
Spaniards,  when  they  first  invaded  America,  introduced  a  large 
number  of  blood-hounds ;  which  had  been  previously  trained  to 
hunt  stags,  but  were  then  directed  by  these  savage  (though  pro- 
fessedly civilized)  conquerors  against  their  fellow-men.     Similar 
dogs  have  been  since  employed   in   the  West  Indian  Islands, 
and  in  Florida ;  and,  by  a  most  disgusting  kind  of  education, 
have   been   taught  to    distinguish    and  pursue   the   black    and 
coloured  races,  without  showing  any  animosity  towards  white 
men.     Now  of  the  descendants  of  the  original  stock,  a  consider- 
able portion  have  degenerated,  under  the  influence  of  insufficient 
nourishment,  admixture  with  other  races,  &c.     But  among  some 
of  these,  new  instincts  have  sprung  up,  conformable  to  their 
altered  circumstances,  and  have  become  hereditary.     Thus,  on 
the  banks  of  the  Magdalena,  they  are  employed  in  hunting  the 
white-lipped  Pecari,   which  associate   in    herds,  and  require  a 
peculiar  mode  of  attack.     The  address  of  these  dogs  consists  in 
restraining  their  ardour,  and  attaching  themselves  to  no  animal 
in  particular,  but  keeping  the  whole  herd  in  check.    Now  among 
these  dogs,  some  are  found,  which,  the  very  first  time  they  are 
taken  into  the  woods,  show  themselves  to  be  acquainted  with 
this   mode  of  attack  ;   whereas,  a  dog  of  another  breed  starts 
forward  at  once,  is  surrounded  by  the  Pecari,  and,  whatever 
may  be  his  strength,  is  destroyed  in  a  moment. — Some  English- 
men, who  were  engaged  in  conducting  the  operations  of  the 
Real  del  Monte  Company  in  Mexico,  carried  out  with  them  some 
Greyhounds  of  the  best  breed,  to  hunt  the  hares  which  abound 
in  that  country.     The  great  platform  which  is  the  scene  of  the 
sport,  is  at  an  elevation  of  about  9000  feet  above  the  level  of  the 
sea  ;  and  the  mercury  in  the  barometer  stands  habitually  at  the 


124  PRODUCTION    OF    NEW    RACES    OR    BREEDS. 

height  of  about  19  inches.  It  was  found  that  the  Greyhounds 
could  not  support  the  fatigues  of  a  long  chase  in  this  attenuated 
atmosphere  ;  and  before  they  could  come  up  with  their  prey,  they 
lay  down  gasping  for  breath  ;  but  these  same  animals  have  pro- 
duced whelps,  which  have  grown  up,  and  which  are  not  in  the 
least  degree  incommoded  by  the  want  of  density  in  the  air,  but 
run  down  the  hares  with  as  much  ease  as  the  fleetest  of  our  races 
in  this  country. 

111.  By  endeavouring,  then,  to  develope  from  generation  to 
generation,  a  particular  quality,  or  physical  peculiarity,  we  may 
carry  it  much  further  than  it  would  have  been  possible  to  do  at 
first ;  and  we  thus  can  create  artificial  races,  of  which  the  cha- 
racters will  only  be  effaced,  when  the  opposite  circumstances  to 
those  which  have  occasioned  these  peculiarities,  come  to  destroy 
the  effect  of  them.     It  is  in  this  manner  that  we  accomplish  our 
end,  when  a  powerful  interest  gives  perseverance  to  our  efforts  ; 
and  thus  it  is,  that  in  the  present  day  races  of  Sheep,  Oxen,  and 
Horses  have  been  produced, — characterised  by  the  most  remark- 
able peculiarities.       It  has  been  remarked,   for   instance,   that 
Sheep  which  present  certain  peculiarities  of  conformation,  are 
fattened  much  more  easily  than  others ;  and  Bakewell,  one  of 
those  who  have  rendered  the  greatest  services  to  English  Agri- 
culture, having  taken  care  to   cause  the  Sheep  amongst  which 
these  external  characters  were  seen  in  a  high  degree,  to  breed  with 
each  other,  was  able  to  create  a  race  of  great  value  in  this 
respect.     The  weight  of  the  four  hind  quarters  of  the  carcass  of 
the  large   Sheep  of  the  Wurtemberg  breed, — which  was  intro- 
duced into  some  of  the  provinces  of  France,  as  being  particularly 
good  for  the  purposes  of  the  butcher, — was  from  52  to  55  per 
cent,  of  the  total  weight  of  the  animal ;  whilst  in  the  English 
Sheep  of  the  Dishley  or  New  Leicester  breed,  this  proportion 
was  raised  to  70  or  75  per  cent.       It  is  also  known  to  Agricul- 
turists, how  much  the  fineness  of  the  wool  is  increased  by  similar 
care ;  and  how  much,  in  this  respect,  our  native  breeds  have  been 
improved  by  their  mixture  with  the  Merinos  of  Spain. 

112.  Again,  the  different  races  of  Horses,  which  are  of  so 
high  an  interest  to  us,  are  also  a  proof  of  the  influence  of  Man 


PRODUCTION  OF  NEW  RACES  OR  BREEDS.         125 

over  the  animals  living  under  his  dominion.  The  horses  which 
are  reared  in  our  breeding  establishments,  partly  owe  their  size, 
their  form,  and  their  qualities,  to  the  race  from  which  they  are 
descended  ;  but  the  circumstances  in  which  they  are  placed  at 
an  early  age,  exercise  over  them,  in  process  of  time,  an  influence 
not  less  great.  It  is  remarked,  that  in  general  the  colt  receives 
its  size  and  weight  more  from  its  mother  than  its  father;  whilst 
in  the  shape  of  the  head  and  feet,  its  courage  and  swiftness,  it 
more  resembles  the  latter.  Defects,  likewise,  as  well  as  good 
qualities,  are  transmitted  from  generation  to  generation ;  and, 
to  maintain  a  race  in  its  purity,  or  to  improve  it,  care  must  be 
taken  to  remove  from  it  all  those  individuals,  which  do  not 
possess  the  qualities  that  we  desire  to  obtain.  In  order  to 
make  a  blemish  disappear,  we  cross  the  individuals  of  this 
defective  race,  during  several  generations,  with  others  having 
an  opposite  disposition  ;  and  by  perseveringly  matching  toge- 
ther horses  which  possess  particular  perfections,  we  create  a 
race  in  which  it  becomes  hereditary  and  general.  It  is  owing, 
in  a  great  degree,  to  care  of  this  nature,  that  the  Arab  horses 
owe  their  well-merited  celebrity.  The  Arabs  attach  such 
importance  to  the  purity  of  the  race  of  their  noble  horses,  called 
Jcochlani,  that  their  descent  is  always  attested  by  authentic 
pedigrees.  They  can  even  go  back  nearly  two  thousand  years, 
in  the  genealogy  of  these  fine  animals ;  and  there  are  some 
whose  lineage  can  be  attested  by  written  documents,  during  a 
period  of  four  centuries.  On  the  other  hand,  the  influence  of 
crossing  a  race  is  equally  well  shown  by  the  English  race- 
horses ;  for  it  is  by  a  mixture  of  the  native  mares  with  the 
males  brought  from  the  East,  that  we  owe  the  creation  of  this 
race,  so  remarkable  for  the  delicacy  of  its  shape,  and  its  asto- 
nishing fleetness. 

113.  Again,  the  greater  or  less  abundance  and  the  quality 
of  the  food,  the  dryness  or  humidity  of  the  country,  the  daily 
labour,  and  even  a  number  of  circumstances  apparently  of 
very  little  importance,  exercise  a  powerful  influence  upon  the 
shape,  the  size,  and  the  qualities  of  horses.  To  give  a  proof  of 
this,  we  might  show  with  what  rapidity  the  finest  English 


126    INFLUENCE    OF    EXTERNAL    CIRCUMSTANCES    ON    GROWTH. 

horses  degenerate  in  certain  localities,  such  as  the  neighbourhood 
of  Kopschan,  upon  the  borders  of  Moravia ;  but  without  going 
so  far,  we  shall  find  still  more  striking  examples  of  the  modify- 
ing power  of  external  circumstances.  If  of  two  colts  sprung 
from  the  same  race,  in  Lorraine,  for  example, — one  is  trans- 
ported into  Flanders  and  the  other  into  the  pastures  of  Nor- 
mandy, instead  of  preserving  the  same  characters,  they  will 
present,  at  the  age  of  five  years,  nearly  as  much  difference  as  if 
they  had  proceeded  from  two  distinct  races.  One  will  become  a 
light  and  elegant  carriage-horse ;  the  other  an  enormous  animal, 
almost  incapable  of  going  a  trot,  but  fitted  to  draw  the  heaviest 
loads  at  a  slow  pace.  Where  food  is  abundant,  and  where  by 
the  foresight  of  man  it  never  fails  at  any  season,  the  horses  are 
generally  large  and  fat ;  whilst  in  countries  where  it  is  less 
abundant,  even  during  but  one  season  of  the  year,  these  ani- 
mals only  acquire  a  small  or  middle  size.  Physiologists  have 
proved  something  similar  to  this,  in  studying  the  laws  of  the 
growth  of  Man  ;  and  to  convince  us  of  the  truth  of  this  observa- 
tion relatively  to  horses,  it  is  sufficient  to  compare  those  which, 
in  the  same  country,  belong  to  the  poor  labourer  or  to  the  rich 
landowner.  Pasturage  in  rich  and  damp  meadows,  such  as  are 
most  suitable  to  fatten  cattle,  tends  to  give  to  horses  a  heavy 
and  clumsy  appearance ;  to  render  their  skin  thick,  and  their 
hair  coarse,  and  to  diminish  the  vivacity  of  their  character. 
The  food  supplied  by  dry  meadows  produces  no  such  effect ; 
and,  when  it  has  been  rendered  still  firmer  by  the  addition  of  a 
considerable  proportion  of  corn  grains,  it  becomes  eminently 
fitted  to  preserve,  and  even  to  produce,  the  elegance  of  form 
and  the  muscular  energy,  which  are  characteristic  of  a  noble 
race.  When  a  somewhat  lower  temperature  adds  its  influence 
to  that  of  dampness,  and  of  abundant  and  watery  food,  the  horses 
acquire  a  much  heavier  form,  but  become,  at  the  same  time, 
much  less  energetic,  and  more  inert.  In  very  cold  or  very 
hot  countries,  on  the  contrary,  the  growth  is  checked  much 
sooner ;  and  even  the  largest  races  soon  lose  their  high  stature. 
Again,  the  daily  attention  which  is  given  to  some  horses,  and  of 
which  others  are  completely  destitute,  also  has  its  effect  upon 


SUBDIVISION    OF    MAMMALIA    INTO    ORDERS.  127 

the  beauty  of  these  animals  ;  thus  the  frequent  rubbing,  the  use 
of  coverings,  the  precaution  of  washing  and  drying  the  extremi- 
ties, and  even  of  surrounding  them  with  bands  of  flannel,  are 
circumstances  which  contribute  powerfully  to  give  to  the  horses 
of  our  own  country  that  neatness,  which  is  remarked  in  the  lower 
part  of  their  limbs,  and  to  render  their  skin  and  their  hair  so 
soft  and  fine. 

114.  Thus,   by  modifying  the   circumstances  in  which   an 
animal  is  placed,  we  impress  certain  modifications  on  its  struc- 
ture ;  and  by  employing  for  the  propagation  of  the  race  only 
the  individuals  thus  modified,  Man  gives  to  the  entire  race  a 
particular  character,  and  developes  in  it  qualities  which  it  did 
not  at  first  possess.     It  is  probably  in  this  way  that  he  has 
obtained  the  various  races  of  dogs,  whose  forms  are  so  different, 
that  at  first  sight  we  can  hardly  believe  that  they  belong  to  one 
and  the  same  species.     But  this  modifying  power  is  always 
restrained  within  certain  limits ;   and  it  never  effaces  the  dis- 
tinctive marks,  which  serve  as  the  zoological  characters  of  the 
species. 

115.  Classification  of  Mammalia. — There  exist,  as  we  have 
already  seen,  considerable   differences  amongst  the  Mammalia  ; 
and  these  modifications  serve  as  a  basis  for  the  division  of  this 
class  into  groups  of  an  inferior  rank,  named  Orders.  The  greater 
part  of  these  groups  are  so  clearly  separated  from  the  surrounding 
ones,  that  there  can  be  no  doubt  regarding  their  limits  ;  and  all 
Zoologists  have  agreed  to  admit  them  as  forming  such  natural 
divisions.     But  in  others  the  principal  type  is  so  modified,  that 
an  almost  insensible  passage  is  made  from  the  one  to  the  other, 
and  it  becomes  very  difficult  to  draw  the  line  of  division.     A 
certain  Mammal,  for  example,  has  quite  as  much  analogy  with 
the  type  which  represents  the  order  Quadrumana,  as  with  that 
of  the  Rodentia;  and  it  may  with  nearly  as  much  reason  be 
placed  in  the  one  as  in  the  other  of  these  divisions. 

116.  It  has  been  elsewhere  explained  (  ANIM.  PHYSIOL.  §  750), 
that  the  essential  peculiarity  which  distinguishes  the  reproduc- 
tive process  in  the  Mammalia,  is  not  so  much  that  the  egg  is 
retained  within  the  body  of  the  parent,  so  that  the  young  is  born 


128  SUBDIVISION    OF    MAMMALIA    INTO    ORDERS. 

alive, — for  this  happens  in  certain  animals  belonging  to  nearly 
all  the  oviparous  classes,  such  as  Insects,  Fishes,  and  Reptiles  : 
but  that  the  young  animal  is  developed  by  means  of  nutrition 
directly  supplied  to  it  by  the  parent,  through  a  system  of  blood- 
vessels partly  belonging  to  the  embryo,  and  partly  to  the  uterus 
or  cavity  in  which  it  is  contained.  In  oviparous  animals,  the 
development  is  effected  at  the  expense  of  the  store  of  nourishment 
laid  up  in  the  egg  itself;  but  this  is  very  small  in  the  Mammalia, 
because,  at  a  very  early  period  of  its  growth,  the  embryo  begins 
to  draw  its  support  directly  from  the  parent.  From  the  surface 
of  the  chorion  (which  is  the  membrane  that  covers  the  egg,  re- 
sembling that  which  lines  the  shell  in  Birds),  a  number  of  little 
tufts  shoot  out,  and  insinuate  themselves  amongst  the  vessels  of 
the  uterus,  from  which  they  absorb  a  nutritious  fluid,  that  ulti- 
mately finds  its  way  to  the  embryo.  This  is  the  sole  mode  in 
which  the  embryo  of  the  non-placental  Mammalia  is  ever  con- 
nected with  the  parent:  but  in  the  truly  viviparous  sub-class,  a 
more  direct  communication  is  subsequently  effected,  by  a  set  of 
vessels  proceeding  from  the  embryo  itself,  which  forms,  by  the 
minuteness  of  its  subdivisions,  a  mass  of  considerable  size  and  so- 
lidity, known  as  the  placenta;  this  is  applied  against  the  interior 
of  the  uterus,  and  draws  nourishment  from  its  vessels,  much  in 
the  same  way  that  the  roots  of  a  tree  imbibe  moisture  from  the 
soil,  or  that  the  lacteal  vessels,  spread  out  upon  the  walls  of  the 
intestine,  take  up  fluid  from  its  cavity.  Thus,  the  non-placental 
Mammalia  stop  short,  as  it  were,  at  a  period  of  development, 
which  is  very  early  or  incomplete  as  regards  the  higher  subdivi- 
sion of  the  class. 

117.  The  method  of  division  that  we  shall  here  adopt  is  very 
nearly  that  of  Cuvier.  It  rests  principally  upon  the  differences 
which  the  Mammalia  exhibit  in  their  mode  of  development,  in 
the  conformation  of  their  limbs,  and  in  their  apparatus  of  masti- 
cation ;  parts  whose  modifications  always  involve  a  number  of 
other  differences,  in  the  structure  of  the  various  parts  of  the  body, 
in  their  habits,  and  even  in  their  intelligence.  When  we  take 
the  whole  of  these  characters  into  account,  we  are  led  first  to 
divide  the  class  of  the  Mammalia  into  two  sub-classes,  which 


PLACENTAL    AND    NON-PLACENTAL    MAMMALIA.  129 

may  be  termed  the  placental  or  truly  viviparous,  and  the  non- 
placental  or  ovo-viviparous  Mammalia.  The  truly  viviparous  Mam- 
malia are  the  most  numerous ;  and  are  principally  distinguished 
by  the  mode  of  their  development.  They  do  not  come  into  the 
world  until  they  are  provided  with  all  their  organs  ;  and,  before 
their  birth,  they  derive  their  support  from  a  net- work  of  mater- 
nal blood-vessels,  named  the  placenta.  It  is  also  remarked,  that 
their  brain  is  more  perfect  than  that  of  the  ovo-viviparous 
Mammals  ;  its  two  hemispheres  being  united  together  by  a  large 
commissure,  or  band  of  connecting  fibres,  termed  the  corpus  cal- 
losum  (§  96) ;  lastly,  the  walls  of  the  abdomen  are  never  sup- 
ported by  bony  projections  fixed  on  the  edge  of  the  pelvis,  such 
as  we  shall  see  in  the  second  grand  division  of  this  class.  The 
Mammalia,  thus  organised,  differ  very  much  amongst  themselves 
in  the  general  conformation  of  their  bodies  ;  some  being  adapted 
to  inhabit  the  air,  as  the  Bats ;  others  resembling  Fishes,  as  thd 
Whales ;  whilst  the  ordinary  Mammalia  are  formed  to  live  more 
or  less  completely  on  the  earth. 

118.  In  the  non-placcntal  or  ovo-viviparous  Mammalia,  on 
the  other  hand,  there  are  several  points  of  structure  which  show 
that  they  are  to  be  regarded  as  an  inferior  group — intermediate 
between  the  higher  group  whose  characters  have  just  been  given, 
and  the  Oviparous  Yertebrata.  The  young  are  born  in  an  ex- 
tremely imperfect  state,  closely  resembling  that  of  the  young  of 
the  other  Mammalia  when  they  come  into  the  world  very  pre- 
maturely ;  and  as  they  do  not  remain  long  enough  within  the 
interior  of  the  parent  to  give  time  for  the  formation  of  the  pla- 
centa, they  are  properly  distinguished  by  a  term  which  expresses 
its  absence.  The  term  ovo-viviparous  is  not  so  correct  a  desig- 
nation, in  a  scientific  point  of  view ;  since  it  applies  more  pro- 
perly to  those  animals  just  alluded  to  (§  116),  in  which  the  ani- 
mals are  really  oviparous,  but  in  which  the  young  are  born  alive, 
by  the  retention  and  hatching  of  the  eggs  within  the  body  of  the 
parent :  but  it  serves  to  express,  in  a  popular  manner,  that  this 
division  is  intermediate  between  the  truly  viviparous  Mammals, 
and  the  truly  oviparous  classes  of  Vertebrata,  which  is  shown  to 
be  the  case  in  many  points  of  their  structure.  Of  these,  the  two 


130  SUBDIVISION    OF    MAMMALIA    INTO    ORDERS. 

most  remarkable  have  already  been  noticed — the  deficiency  of 
the  corpus  callosum,  or  band  of  fibres  connecting  the  two  hemi- 
spheres of  the  brain  ; — and  the  termination,  at  least  among 
the  lowest  of  them,  of  the  intestinal  canal  and  the  ^urinary 
ducts,  with  the  uterine  passage,  in  one  common  receptacle,  as  in 
Birds  and  Reptiles  (§  100).  In  accordance  with  the  general 
rule, — that  the  less  the  amount  of  assistance  given  to  the  germ 
of  a  vegetable  or  animal  in  its  early  development,  the  lower  is 
the  grade  which  it  ultimately  attains,  we  find  that  in  many 
points  of  their  conformation,  as  well  as  in  their  degree  of  intelli- 
gence, the  non-placental  Mammalia  are  much  inferior  to  the  truly 
viviparous  portion  of  the  group.  The  former  are  further  distin- 
guished by  the  presence  of  the  marsupial  bones  (§  90),  even 
when  there  is  no  external  pouch. 

119.  The  Placental  Mammalia  are  subdivided  into  orders 
chiefly  by  the  structure  of  their  extremities,  and  of  their  teeth  ; 
with  which,  as  has  been  already  shown,  a  great  part  of  their 
internal  conformation  is  closely  connected  (§  58).  Thus  we 
distinguish  the  Unguiculated  Mammals,  which  have  separate 
fingers,  terminated  by  distinct  nails  or  claws ;  and  the  Ungu- 
Iated9  in  which  the  fingers  are  more  or  less  consolidated,  and 
inclosed  at  their  extremity  in  a  hard  hoof.  Ungulated  animals 
are  necessarily  herbivorous;  inasmuch  as  the  conformation  of 
their  feet  precludes  the  possibility  of  their  seizing  a  living  prey  ; 
and  they  have  flat-crowned  grinding  teeth  for  triturating  their 
food.  The  summits  of  these  teeth  are  usually  not  covered  by  a 
smooth  coat  of  enamel,  but  present  a  series  of  elevations  and  de- 
pressions ;  these  are  occasioned  by  the  peculiar  structure  of  the 
teeth,  which  consist  of  alternating  plates  of  enamel,  ivory  or 
dentine,  and  cementum  or  bony  substance  ;  and  as  these  three 
substances  are  of  different  degrees  of  hardness,  their  unequal 
wear  will  keep  the  surfaces  constantly  rough. — Among  the  Un- 
guiculated Mammals,  we  find  more  variety  as  to  the  character 
of  the  food.  In  some  it  is  almost  exclusively  vegetable,  as  in 
the  Rodentia  (Rat  and  Squirrel  tribe) ;  but  here  the  power  of  the 
separate  fingers  is  the  least  possible,  the  bones  of  the  fore  arm 
and  leg  being  so  constructed,  that  the  hand  cannot  be  turned 


UNGULATED    AND    UNGUICULATED    MAMMALIA.  131 

round  by  the  movement  of  one  of  these  bones  on  the  other  (ANIM. 
PHYSIOL.  §  639).  In  this  order,  the  mouth  is  remarkably  adapted 
for  grinding  down  hard  vegetable  substances ;  the  molar  teeth 
being  furnished  with  transverse  ridges  of  enamel,  and  the  jaws 
having  a  powerful  movement  forwards  and  backwards.  In 
others,  again,  there  is  an  almost  exclusive  adaptation  to  animal 
food;  and  in  these  we  find  the  unguiculated  structure  in  the 
highest  perfection,  the  claws  being  sharp  and  long,  and  the  hand 
or  fore-foot  being  capable  of  being  placed  in  a  great  variety  of 
positions,  by  the  rotation  of  the  two  bones  of  the  leg.  The 
grinding  teeth  are  very  narrow,  and  are  raised  into  sharp  points 
and  edges,  so  as  to  be  adapted  for  dividing  animal  flesh ;  and 
these  are  firmly  set  in  short  strong  jaws,  which  are  fitted 
together  like  the  blades  of  a  pair  of  scissars,  having  no  action 
but  a  vertical  one.  In  this  group,  too,  we  find  the  greatest 
development  of  the  canine  teeth  ;  which  are  commonly  absent, 
or  but  slightly  developed,  among  herbivorous  quadrupeds.  These 
are  the  most  powerful  weapons  with  which  carnivorous  animals 
are  furnished ;  serving  both  for  the  first  attack  of  their  prey, 
and  for  subsequently  tearing  it  in  pieces.  To  this  division,  also, 
belongs  the  Bat  tribe,  in  which  the  extremities  are  provided 
with  distinct  claws,  and  the  teeth  adapted  (for  the  most  part,  at 
least)  to  an  animal  diet ;  and  to  it  we  are  also  to  refer  a  portion 
of  the  Fish-like  Mammals,  in  which  the  structure  of  the  teeth 
and  digestive  apparatus  is  closely  allied  to  that  of  the  Carnivora, 
as  is  the  case  in  the  ordinary  Whales  and  their  allies ;  whilst 
another  portion,  consisting  of  but  a  few  species,  is  to  be  referred 
to  the  herbivorous  division,  on  account  of  a  similar  conformity 
in  general  structure. 

120.  Among  the  Unguiculated  Mammalia,  there  are  some 
which  have  the  power  of  opposing  one  of  the  fingers  to  the  rest ; 
and  this,  either  on  the  two  anterior  extremities  alone,  or  on  the 
posterior  also.  This  is  a  character,  which  is  so  closely  connected 
with  the  general  conformation  and  habits  of  the  animals  that 
possess  it,  as  to  be  of  the  highest  importance  in  classification  ; 
and  accordingly  it  serves  to  distinguish  the  two  first  orders  of 
the  Unguiculated  from  all  the  rest.  These  orders  are  : — 

K2 


132          ORDERS  BIMANA  AND  QUADRUMANA. 

I.  BIMANA,   or  two-handed  Mammals;  so  termed  from  the 
restriction  of  the  thumbs  or  opposable  fingers  to  the    anterior 
extremities  only,   which  are  employed  for  prehension,  whilst  the 
posterior  are  employed  for  locomotion.     By  this  character,  and 
by  his  naturally  erect  position,  Man  is  distinguished  from  all 
other  animals ;  and  consequently  this  order  is  composed  of  the 
Human  Races   only.      We  shall  presently  see  that,  however 
various  the  characters  of  different  races,   they  are  all  entitled 
to  rank  as  belonging  to  the  same  species.      The  order  Bimana  is 
further  distinguished  by  the  number  and  character  of  the  teeth ; 
— there  being  4  Incisors  or  cutting-teeth  in  each  jaw ;  Canine 
teeth  in  each  jaw,   moderately  developed  ;    and  (in  the  adult,  in 
whom  the  last  molars  or  wise  teeth  have  been  cut,)  5  Molar 
teeth,  having  rounded  or  tuberculated  summits,   on  each  side  of 
each  jaw.     It  is  usual,  in  order  to  express  briefly  the  number  of 
teeth  in  the  jaws  of  an  animal,  to  use  the  following  method  : — 
Those  of  the  upper  jaw  are  placed  above  a  horizontal  line,  and 
those  of  the  lower  jaw  below  it ;  like  the  numerator  and  deno- 
minator of  a  fraction ;  thus,   |-  would  mean  that  there  were  6 
teeth  of  a  particular  kind  in  the  upper  jaw,  and  4  in  the  lower. 
The  incisors,  being  all  together  in  the  centre,  are  specified  by  a 
single  number  ;  but  the  canines  and  molars,  which  are  found  on 
either    side,   are  expressed  by   two  numbers, — as  thus  4 — 4, 
meaning  that  there  are  4  on  each  side.     Hence  the  dental  for- 
mula, as  it  is  termed,  of  Man,  is  as  follows ;  incisors  J,  canines 
jE[,  molars  ^J     The  value  of  such  a  short  and  simple  expression 
will  hereafter  become  evident. 

II.  QUADRUMANA,  or  four-Jianded  Mammals,  embracing  the 
Monkey  tribe ;  so  termed  from  the  possession  of  thumbs  on  all 
the  four  extremities  (in  part  of  the  group),  thus  giving  to  all  of 
them,  in  greater  or  less  degree,  the  peculiar  power  of  prehension 
which  this  conformation  imparts.     But  they  are  all,   likewise, 
concerned  in  locomotion  also  ;    as  the  distinction  between  the 
anterior  and  posterior  extremities,   which  is  so  remarkable  in 
Man,  does  not  here  present  itself,  or  is  only  seen  in  a  slight 
degree.     The  number  of  incisors   is  still  £,  and  of  canines  \ ; 
but  that  of  the  molars  is  ^,  in  a  certain  part  of  the  group. 


ORDERS    CHEIROPTERA,  INSECTIVORA,  AND    CARNIVORA.    1  33 

121.  We  may  further  separate  from  the  other  Unguiculated 
Mammalia,  by  very  obvious  characters,  the  following  order  : — 

III.  CHEIROPTERA,    or   wing-handed  Mammals ;    a   group 
which  is  identical  with  the  Bat  tribe.     The  peculiar  adaptation 
of  the  anterior  extremities   of  these  animals  i<yc  flight,  by  the 
enormous  development  of  the  bones  of  the  fingers,  and  by  the 
extension  of  the  skin  over  them,  so  as  to  form  a  widely  expanded 
wing,  distinguishes  them  from  all  other  Mammals.     The  teeth 
do  not  here  afford  so  distinctive  a  character ;  being  somewhat 
irregular  in  number,  and  of  great  variety  of  forms, — most  of  the 
species  being  adapted  to  feed  on  Insects,   but  some  of  them,  like 
the  greater  part  of  the  Monkeys,  being  formed  to  subsist  on 
fruits  and  other  soft  vegetable  substances. 

122.  The  remainder  of  the  Unguiculated  Mammals  may  be 
first  arranged,  according  to  the  presence  of  all  three  kinds  of 
teeth,  or  the  absence  of  some  of  them.     These  which  have  in- 
cisors, canines,  and  molars,  are  destined  to  live  on  animal  food ; 
but  this  may  be  of  two  kinds,  either  the  bodies  of  insects,  or 
animal  flesh.     Hence,  we  have  no  difficulty  in  distinguishing  the 
two  following  orders  : — 

IV.  INSECTIVORA,  or  insect-eating  Mammals  ;  a  term  which 
might  be  applied  to  many  animals  in  other  groups,  such  as  the 
Bats,  and  even  some  Quadrumana ;  but  which  is  peculiarly  cha- 
racteristic of  these — the  form  of  their  teeth,  and   their  whole 
economy,  being  adapted  to  the  capture,   mastication,   and  diges- 
tion of  hard-bodied  beetles,  locusts,  &c.     Their  teeth  are  easily 
distinguished  by   the  conical   elevations   they  present,    which 
differ  on  the  one  hand  from  the  rounded   summits  of  those  of 
animals  destined  to  feed  on  soft  animal   or  vegetable  substances 
indiscriminately,  and  from  the  sharp  edges  of  those  of  the  truly 
carnivorous  Mammals.     Their  number  is  somewhat  irregular ; 
but  there  are  usually  6  incisors  and  2  canines  in  each  jaw. 

V.  CARNIVORA,  m flesh-eating  Mammals;  which  are  at  once 
known  from  all  others,  by  the  possession  of  six  incisor  teeth  in 
each  jaw,  two  long  canines,  and  a  variable  number  of  molars,  of 
which  some  are  provided  with  cutting  edges.     They  are  pre- 
eminently beasts   of  prey ;    and    their  whole  conformation  is 


134  ORDERS    CETACEA,    RODENTIA,    AND    EDENTATA. 

adapted  to  their  habits.  Some  of  these,  as  the  Seal,  pass  a 
large  portion  of  their  time  in  the  water,  and  have  the  extremi- 
ties formed  for  swimming ;  and  these  naturally  lead  us,  there- 
fore, towards  the  next  order. 

VI.  CETACEA,  or  fish-like  Mammals ;  which  are  distinguished 
from  all  ordinary  mammalia  by  the  absence  of  the  posterior 
extremities,  and  by  the  conversion  of  the  anterior  into  swim- 
ming paws  or  paddles.     Of  the  animals  thus  adapted  to  the 
life  of  Fishes,  however,  those  only  are  included  in  this  order 
which  are  carnivorous  in  their  habits,  and  whose  alimentary 
canal  is  formed  to  digest  animal  food. 

123.  The  unguiculated  Mammals  which  do  not  possess  the 
three  kinds  of  teeth,  are  divisible  into  two  orders,  which  exhibit 
the  unguiculated  structure  in  its  lowest  grade. 

VII.  RODENTIA,  or  gnawing  animals ;  a  group  very  easily 
distinguished  by  the  peculiar  conformation  of  the  front  teeth, 
which    are    two   in  each   jaw,  very  strong,   with    sharp   cut- 
ting edges,  and  constantly  growing  at  the  roots ;  thus  forming 
admirable  instruments  for  gnawing.    Of  this  group,  the  Squirrel, 
Rat,  Beaver,  &c.,  are  examples.    These  front  teeth  are  really  to 
be  regarded  as  the  canines ;  the  incisors  being  altogether  absent, 
so  as  to  allow  them  to  come  together  on  the  central  line.     The 
number  of  molars  is  variable ;  but  they  are  all  formed  with 
ridges  of  enamel,  placed  more  or  less  transversely  to  the  jaw. 

VIII.  EDENTATA,  or  toothless  animals ;  a  term  which  is  not 
altogether  correct,  but  which  serves  to  express  the  character  of 
a  large  proportion  of  the  order  designated  by  it.     This  group  is 
properly  characterised  by  the  entire  absence  of  front  teeth  in 
both  jaws ;    and  in  the  Ant  Eaters,  &c.,  there  are  no  teeth 
whatever;    whilst    the  Sloths  are   possessed   of    molar   teeth, 
though  of  very  imperfect  formation. 

124.  The  ungulated,  or  hoofed  Mammals,  are  easily  subdi- 
vided into  two  orders,  by  the  presence  or  absence  of  the  rumi- 
nating faculty,  and  of  the  peculiar  conformation  which  apper- 
tains to  it  (§  98). 

IX.  RUMINANTIA,  or  ruminating  animals  :   a  group  which 
is  composed  of  the  Ox,  Sheep,  Antelope,  Camel,  and  other  well- 


ORDERS    RUMINANTIA    AND    PACHYDERM  ATA.  1#5 

known  animals ;  all  of  which  agree  in  possessing  the  ruminat- 
ing apparatus,  as  well  as  in  having  the  hoof  cleft  (or  rather 
double) ;  and  nearly  all  in  the  following  dental  formula : — 
incisors  -J,  canines  ^,  molars,  ^,  the  last  being  marked  on  the 
surface  with  crescents,  which  are  formed  by  ridges  of  enamel. 

X.  PACHYDERMATA,  or  thick-skinned  animals ;  a  group  that 
includes  a  great  variety  of  dissimilar  forms,  which  agree  rather 
in  the  absence  of  other  characters,  than  in  the  possession  of  any 
that  are  common  to  all.  Thus  the  Elephant,  Horse,  and  Pig, 
would  seem  to  possess  very  different  types  of  structure, — the 
Elephant  having  the  bones  of  its  toes  distinct,  but  included 
together  in  a  sort  of  horny  skin, — the  Pig  having  four  distinct 
toes,  with  separate  hoofs, — and  the  Horse  having  all  the  bones 
of  the  toes  consolidated  into  a  single  row,  which  is  terminated  by 
a  single  hoof.  The  characters  afforded  by  the  teeth  are  equally 
various ;  some  having  incisors,  others  none  ;  some  having  large 
canines,  others  small  ones,  and  others  being  destitute  of  them ; 
and  the  number  of  molars  also  being  subject  to  great  variation. 
Yet  these  very  dissimilar  forms  are  connected  by  intermediate 
links,  recent  and  fossil  (§  28) ;  and  it  appears  as  if  we  were  to 
unite  with  this  order  those  whale-like  animals,  whose  food  is  of 
a  vegetable  character, — their  whole  conformation  being  very 
different  from  that  of  the  true  Cetacea,  and  more  closely  resem- 
bling that  of  certain  aquatic  Pachydermata. 

125.  The  foregoing  arrangement  of  the  orders  of  the  vivipa- 
rous Mammalia  is  more  adapted  to  distinguish  them  from  each 
other,  than  to  represent  their  relative  positions  in  a  natural 
series.  Tims,  the  Edentata  and  Rodentia  are  unquestionably 
lower,  in  regard  to  their  intelligence  and  their  general  conforma- 
tion, than  the  Ruminantia  and  Pachydermata  ;  and  the  Roden- 
tia are  those,  among  the  truly  viviparous  Mammals,  which 
approach  the  nearest  to  the  non-placental  group,  in  the  low 
development  of  their  brain ;  as  well  as  in  several  points  of  their 
general  structure.  It  is  impossible  to  represent  their  mutual 
relations  by  any  arrangement  of  them  in  a  single  line ;  since 
each  group  has  connections,  not  only  with  those  before  and 
behind  it,  but  with  others  at  a  distance.  Nevertheless  it  is 


136  GRADATION    OP    ORDERS. MARSUPIALIA. 

necessary  to  follow  some  order  in  the  more  particular  description 
of  them ;  and  the  following  is  probably  the  most  correct,  in 
regard  especially  to  the  grade  which  the  different  groups  possess 
in  the  scale.  I.  BIMANA.  II.  QUADRUMANA.  III.  CHEIRO- 
PTERA. IV.  INSECTIVORA.  V.  CARNIVORA.  YI.  CETACEA. 
VII.  PACHYDERMATA.  VIII.  RUMINANTIA.  IX.  EDENTATA. 
X.  RODENTIA.  Thus  from  Man  we  pass  to  the  Quadrumana 
by  the  Apes  which  most  nearly  resemble  him  in  bodily  struc- 
ture. From  these  we  descend  to  the  Lemurs,  in  which  the 
teeth  show  an  insectivorous  character,  and  certain  species  exhi- 
bit a  tendency  to  the  formation  of  organs  of  flight ;  by  which 
characters  we  are  conducted  to  the  Cheiroptera,  or  Bats.  From 
the  insectivorous  forms  of  these,  the  transition  is  not  difficult  to 
the  proper  Insectivora ;  which,  again,  lead  us  to  the  Carnivora; 
and  these,  by  their  aquatic  species,  to  the  Cetacea.  From  the 
Cetacea  we  naturally  pass  to  the  whale-like  Pachydermata ; 
and  then,  through  the  terrestrial  tribes  of  these,  to  certain 
species  which  conduct  us  to  the  Ruminants.  The  Edentata  and 
Rodentia  are  not  closely  connected,  by  any  existing  species,  with 
either  of  the  two  last  orders ;  but  there  are  certain  fossil  forms, 
which  seem  to  link  them  to  both. 

126.  The  division  of  non-placental  Mammalia  contains  two 
orders  only,  which  are  chiefly  distinguished  by  certain  peculiarities 
affecting  the  reproductive  apparatus. 

XI.  MARSUPIALIA,  or  pouched  animals  ;  being  those  in  which 
the  young  are  carried  during  the  early  part  of  their  lives,  in  a 
marsupium,  formed  by  folds  of  the  skin  of  the  abdomen,  which 
are  supported  by  peculiar  bones.  The  species  included  in  this 
group  differ  greatly  among  each  other,  both  in  the  general  form 
of  their  bodies,  and  in  the  conformation  of  their  teeth  and  diges- 
tive apparatus.  Indeed  they  bear,  in  these  respects,  a  striking 
resemblance  to  animals  of  different  orders  among  the  truly  vivi- 
parous Mammals.  Thus,  the  Opossums  have  an  opposable  thumb 
on  all  four  extremities ;  so  that  they  are  truly  quadrumanous,  or 
four-handed.  Others,  again,  bear  a  close  resemblance  to  the 
Carnivora ;  and  others  to  the  Rodentia ;  so  that  the  order  Mar- 
supialia  was  really  distributed  amongst  these  groups,  when  the 


MARSUPJALIA    AND    MONOTREMATA. —  ORDER    BIMANA.      137 

principles  of  classification  were  not  so  well  established  as  they 
are  at  present.  But  it  is  now  almost  universally  considered, 
that  the  absence  of  the  placenta,  connected  as  it  is  with  the  low 
development  of  the  brain,  and  with  other  evidences  of  an  inferior 
grade,  is  a  character  of  the  most  essential  nature,  completely 
distinguishing  the  animals  by  which  it  is  manifested,  from  any  to 
which  they  may  bear  a  general  resemblance  in  adaptive  charac- 
ters (§  25).  And  this  can  be  hardly  otherwise  than  true; 
since  we  find  that  the  Marsupialia,  taken  as  a  group,  have  more 
points  of  real  agreement  with  each  other,  than  any  of  them  have 
with  animals  of  other  orders. 

XII.  MONOTREMATA,  or  animals  with  a  single  outlet ;  a  cha- 
racter which  has  been  already  explained  (§  117).  This  order  is 
very  limited,  containing  only  two  genera ;  which  were  formerly 
placed  among  the  Edentata,  on  account  of  the  absence  of  teeth  in 
their  jaws.  They  are  altogether  most  remarkable  animals ;  and 
present  several  points  of  the  greatest  interest  both  to  the  Physio- 
logist and  Zoologist, — as  do  generally,  indeed,  those  animals 
which  stand  on  the  borders  of  two  great  divisions. 


ORDER  I.— BIMANA. 

127.  The  name  Bimana  is  the  most  appropriate  that  could 
be  found  for  an  order  constituted  by  the  human  species  only ;  for 
Man  alone  is  two-handed.  "  That,"  says  Cuvier,  "  which  con- 
stitutes the  hand,  properly  so  called,  is  the  faculty  of  opposing 
the  thumb  to  the  other  fingers,  so  as  to  seize  the  most  minute 
objects, — a  faculty  which  is  carried  to  its  highest  degree  of  per- 
fection in  Man,  in  whom  the  whole  anterior  extremity  is  free, 
and  can  be  employed  in  prehension."  Some  Naturalists  refuse 
the  term  hand  to  the  extremities  of  the  Monkey  tribe,  preferring 
to  call  them  graspers;  for  it  is  certainly  true  that,  although  most 
of  them  possess  an  opposable  thumb,  yet  they  are  destitute  of  the 
power  of  performing  many  of  those  actions,  which  we  regard  as 
most  characteristic  of  the  hand.  These  actions  are  dependent 
upon  the  size  and  power  of  the  thumb,  which  is  much  more  de- 


138  THE    HAND    PECULIAR   TO    MAN. 

veloped  in  Man,  than  it  is  in  even  the  highest  Apes.  The  thumb 
of  the  Human  hand  may  be  made  to  meet,  at  its  point,  the  ex- 
tremities of  each  finger  singly,  or  of  all  in  combination  ;  whilst 
in  those  Quadrumana,  which  most  nearly  approach  Man,  the 
thumb  is  so  short  and  weak,  and  the  fingers  so  long  and  slender, 
that  their  tips  can  scarcely  be  brought  in  opposition,  and  can 
never  be  opposed  in  near  contact  with  each  other  with  any  degree 
of  force.  Hence,  although  admirably  adapted  for  clinging  round 
bodies  of  a  certain  size,  such  as  the  small  branches  of  trees,  &c., 
the  extremities  of  the  Quadrumana  can  neither  seize  very  minute 
objects  with  that  precision,  nor  support  large  ones  with  that 
firmness,  which  are  essential  to  the  dexterous  performance  of  a 
variety  of  operations,  for  which  the  hand  of  Man  is  admirably 
adapted.  Hence  the  possession  of  four  hands  is  not,  as  might  be 
supposed,  a  character  which  raises  the  animals  that  possess  it 
above  ^'0-handed  Man ;  since  none  of  these  four  hands  are  adapted 
to  the  same  variety  of  actions  of  prehension,  of  which  his  are 
capable ;  and  all  of  them  are  in  some  degree  required  for  support. 
In  this  respect,  their  character  approaches  much  nearer  to  that  of 
the  extremities  of  the  lower  Mammalia. 

128.  We  ought,  then,  as  Sir  Charles  Bell  remarked,  "to 
define  the  hand  as  belonging  exclusively  to  Man."  There  is  in 
him,  what  we  observe  in  none  of  the  Mammalia  that  approach 
him  in  other  respects, — a  complete  distinction  between  the 
functions  of  his  two  pairs  of  extremities ;  the  upper  being  adapted 
for  prehension  alone,  the  lower  for  support  only.  Thus  each 
function  is  performed  with  a  much  higher  degree  of  perfection 
than  it  can  be,  where  two  such  opposite  purposes  have  to  be 
united.  The  arm  of  the  Ape  has  as  wide  a  range  of  motion  as 
that  of  Man,  so  far  as  this  can  be  given  by  the  joints ;  but  it  is 
only  when  the  animal  is  in  the  erect  attitude,  that  its  arm  can 
have  free  play.  Thus  the  structure  of  the  whole  frame  must 
conform  to  that  of  the  hand,  and  must  act  with  reference  to  it. 
But  it  cannot  be  said  with  truth,  (as  some  have  maintained,) 
that  Man  owes  his  superiority  to  his  hand  alone ;  for  without  the 
directing  mind,  the  hand  would  be  comparatively  valueless.  His 
elevated  position  is  due  to  his  mind  and  its  instruments  con- 


ERECT    ATTITUDE    PECULIAR    TO    MAN.  139 

jointly;  for,  if  destitute  of  either,  the  Human  race  would  either 
be  speedily  extinguished  altogether,  or  would  be  reduced  to  a 
kind  of  life  not  above  the  level  of  that  of  the  brutes. 

129.  Man  is  further  distinguished  from  all  other  animals  by 
his  erect  attitude  ;  which  involves  a  considerable  number  of  mo- 
difications in  his  general  structure.     Thus,  his  head  is  set  upon 
the  top  of  the  spinal  column  in  such  a  manner,  that  its  weight 
bears  directly  downwards  upon  it ;  and  it  is  so  nearly  balanced, 
owing  to  the  position  of  the  articulation  on  which  it  is  supported, 
that  very  little  muscular  exertion  is  required  to  keep  it  in  the 
erect  position.     Now  if,  with  the  same  form  of  the  head  and 
neck,  Man  had  been  destined  to  walk  upon  all-fours,  the  head 
would  have  been  without  proper  support ;  since  the  neck  of  Man 
is  destitute  of  the  powerful  muscles  and  ligaments  by  which  the 
large  heads  of  the  herbivorous  quadrupeds  are  sustained  in  this 
position,  (ANIM.  PHYSIOL.  §  29)  :  and  the  face  would  be  directed 
towards  the  ground,  instead  of  commanding  the  horizon  around. 
Among  those  Quadrumana  which  most  nearly  approach  Man, 
we  find  that  the  point  on  which  the  head  is  supported  is  placed 
much  further  back  than  in  him ;  and  that  it  bears  obliquely  on 
the  spinal  column.    This  corresponds  with  the  semi-erect  position 
which  seems  natural  to  them, — the  spinal  being  inclined  forwards, 
so  that  the  body  is  partly  supported  upon  the  anterior  extremi- 
ties ;  and  in  this  state,  the  face  looks  directly  forwards.     But 
these  animals  occasionally  assume  the  completely-erect,  or  the 
completely  horizontal  posture;   and  they  can  easily  adapt  the 
position  of  the  head  to  either  of  these,  its  usual  angle  being  inter- 
mediate between  them. 

130.  The  position  of  the  face  immediately  beneath  the  brain, 
so  that  its  front  is  nearly  in  the  same  plane  with  the  forehead, — 
making  the  facial  angle  (ANIM.  PHYSIOL.  §  719)  large, — is  pecu- 
liarly characteristic  of  Man ;  for  the  brains  of  the  Chimpanzee 
and  Orang,  which  approach  most  nearly  to  that  of  Man,  are 
almost  entirely  behind,  and  not  above,  the  face.     In  the  young 
Ape,  however,  there  is  a  much  greater  resemblance  to  Man,  in 
this  respect,  than  there  is  in  the  adult.    For  at  the  time  that  the 
second  set  of  teeth  appears,  the  muzzle  of  the  Ape  undergoes  a 


140  ERECT    ATTITUDE    PECULIAR    TO    MAN. 

great  increase  in  length,  so  that  it  projects  much  more  beyond 
the  forehead.  The  whole  cast  of  the  features  is  altered  at  the 
same  time ;  so  that  it  approaches  more  nearly  to  that  of  the 
Baboons,  and  other  inferior  Quadrumana,  than  would  be  supposed 
from  observation  of  the  young  animal  only.  This  increased  pro- 
jection of  the  muzzle  is  an  evidence  of  want  of  perfect  adaptation 
to  the  erect  posture ;  whilst  the  absence  of  it  in  Man  shows  that 
no  other  position  is  natural  to  him.  Supposing  that,  with  a  head 
formed  as  at  present,  he  were  to  move  on  all-fours,  so  that  his 
face  would  be  brought  into  the  same  plane  with  the  ground, — as 
painful  an  effort  would  be  required  to  examine  with  the  eyes  an 
object  placed  in  front  of  the  body,  as  is  now  necessary  to  keep 
the  eyes  fixed  on  the  zenith ;  the  nose  would  be  unable  to  per- 
ceive any  other  odours  than  those  which  proceed  from  the  earth,  or 
from  the  body  itself,  their  aperture  being  directed  backwards ; 
and  the  mouth  could  not  touch  the  ground  to  take  up  food  (which 
it  must  have  done  if  the  anterior  limbs  were  used  for  support), 
without  bringing  the  forehead  and  chin  also  into  contact  with  it. 
131.  The  vertebral  column  in  Man,  though  not  absolutely 
straight,  has  its  curves  so  arranged,  that,  when  the  body  is  in  an 
erect  posture,  a  vertical  line  from  its  summit  would  fall  exactly 
on  the  centre  of  its  base.  It  increases  considerably  in  size  in  the 
lumbar  region,  so  as  to  be  altogether  somewhat  pyramidal  in 
form ;  and  it  is  set  upon  the  sacrum  by  a  very  broad  base.  The 
iliac  bones  are  widely  expanded,  so  that  the  whole  pelvis  is  very 
broad ;  in  this  manner  the  hip-joints  are  thrown  farther  apart 
from  each  other,  so  as  to  give  a  firmer  basis  of  support.  The 
breadth  of  this  is  still  further  increased  by  the  oblique  position 
of  the  neck  of  the  thigh  bone.  The  position  of  this  bone,  in 
which  its  head  is  most  secure  in  its  deep  socket,  is  when  it  is 
supporting  the  body  in  a  vertical  position, — that  is,  when  it  has 
the  same  direction  with  the  spinal  column.  In  the  Chimpanzee 
and  Orang,  on  the  other  hand,  the  most  secure  position  is  when 
the  spinal  column  is  bent  forwards  at  an  angle  upon  it ;  in  several 
other  Mammals,  as  the  Elephant,  the  spinal  column  forms  a  right 
angle  with  the  thigh  bone ;  and  in  many  others,  as  the  Horse, 
Ox,  &c.,  the  angle  is  less  than  a  right  angle,  the  thigh-bone 


Frontal  bone 


Parietal  bone 


Orbit 


Lower  Jaw  — 

Cervical  Vertebr 

Scapula- 


—  Temporal  bone 


Clavicle 


H  umeruF_, . — 


Lumbar   Vertebra- ffk 


fl Ilium 


Carpus 
Metacarpu.- . 


Fio.  67. — SKELETON  OF  MAN. 


142  ERECT    ATTITUDE    PECULIAR    TO    MAN. 

being  drawn  up  (as  it  were)  towards  it.  The  formation  of  the 
knee-joint  of  Man,  again,  is  such,  that  the  whole  weight  of  the 
body  falls  directly  upon  the  head  of  the  tibia,  when  the  joint  is 
in  the  firmest  position  in  which  it  can  be  placed ;  and  this  is  not 
the  case  even  with  the  Apes,  that  approach  nearest  to  him  in 
form.  The  conformation  of  the  foot  of  Man  is,  of  itself,  an  in- 
disputable evidence  that  the  erect  position  is  natural  to  him.  It 
is  proportionally  larger,  broader,  and  stronger,  than  the  foot  of 
any  other  Mammal,  save  the  Kangaroo.  The  sole  of  the  foot  is 
concave,  a  sort  of  arch  being  formed  by  the  bones  and  ligaments 
of  which  it  is  composed  ;  and  the  weight  of  the  body  is  thrown 
upon  the  summit  of  this  arch,  by  the  mode  in  which  the  ankle- 
joint  is  constructed.  This  is  far  from  being  the  case  with  the 
semi-erect  Apes ;  for  they  have  the  os  calcis^  or  bone  of  the  heel, 
small,  straight,  and  more  or  less  raised  from  the  ground,  which 
they  touch,  when  standing  erect,  with  the  outer  side  of  the  foot 
only,  so  that  they  cannot  stand  at  all  firmly  on  their  posterior 
limbs  only.  In  animals  more  remote  from  Man,  the  os  calcis  is 
brought  still  more  into  the  line  of  the  tibia,  (Fig.  5J )  ;  and  the 
foot  being  more  lengthened  and  narrowed,  the  extremities  of  the 
toes  alone  come  in  contact  with  the  ground.  Hence  Man  is  the 
only  species  of  Mammal,  that  can  'stand  upon  one  leg  without 
other  support ;  the  Kangaroo,  when  using  one  of  its  hind  legs  to 
kick  backwards  at  its  pursuers,  keeps  itself  erect  on  the  other 
by  means  of  its  powerful  tail. 

132.  The  modification  of  the  hind-foot  of  the  Apes,  which 
renders  it  unable  to  support  the  body  firmly  in  the  erect  posture, 
is  exactly  that  which  gives  it  somewhat  of  the  character  of  the 
hand;  and  consequently  the  hand  of  Man,  in  which  this  mo- 
dification is  still  more  completely  effected,  is  still  less  adapted 
for  the  support  of  the  body.  The  disproportion  in  length,  be- 
tween the  anterior  and  posterior  extremities,  is  another  indication 
of  the  natural  erectness  of  his  posture.  His  legs  are  longer, 
relatively  to  the  size  of  his  trunk,  than  those  of  any  other  Mam- 
mal, except  the  Kangaroo  ;  and  his  arms  are  shorter  in  propor- 
tion, than  are  those  of  the  Apes  that  approach  him  most  closely. 
For  whilst  his  hands  only  reach  the  middle  of  the  thighs,  they 


PECULIARITIES    OP    STRUCTURE    OP    MAN.  143 

hang  in  the  Chimpanzee  on  a  level  with  the  knees,  and  in  the 
Orang  they  descend  to  the  ankles ;  hence,  when  the  bodies  of 
the  latter  are  thrown  but  a  little  forwards,  their  anterior  extre- 
mities are  ready  to  support  them  in  this  inclined  position.  Now 
it  is  evident  that  progression  on  all-fours  would  be  rendered 
excessively  inconvenient,  in  consequence  of  this  disproportion. 
Either  Man  would  be  obliged  to  rest  on  his  knees,  with  his 
thighs  bent  towards  the  trunk,  and  his  legs  and  feet  entirely 
useless  ;  or  he  must  elevate  his  trunk  on  the  extremities  of  his 
toes,  throwing  his  head  downwards,  and  making  the  pelvis  much 
higher  than  the  shoulders.  In  either  case,  the  only  useful  move- 
ment would  be  at  the  hip  ;  and  the  knee  and  ankle  joints  would 
be  of  little  or  no  use  to  him.  Many  other  facts  might  be  brought 
together,  in  addition  to  these,  in  support  of  the  conclusion 
(which  scarcely  admits  of  being  reasonably  disputed),  that  the 
erect  attitude,  and  biped  progression,  are  natural  to  Man;  and 
we  must  regard  as  in  great  degree  fabulous  all  those  histories 
of  supposed  wild  men,  who,  it  has  been  said,  were  found  in 
woods,  dumb,  hairy,  and  crawling  upon  all-fours.  The  most 
elaborate  investigation  of  the  structure  of  the  highest  Apes,  and 
the  fullest  acquaintance  with  their  habits,  concur  in  proving, 
that  their  movements  are  not  easy  or  agile,  unless  they  employ 
all  their  limbs  for  the  support  of  their  bodies. 

133.  Thus,  then,  although  the  order  Bimana  cannot  be 
separated  from  the  Quadrumana,  by  any  single  obvious  point  of 
structure,  like  that  which  characterises  the  Cetacea,  Cheiroptera, 
Rodentia,  or  Ruminantia,  it  is  really  as  far  removed  by  the 
minuter,  but  not  less  important,  modifications  which  have  been 
detailed.  A  few  others  will  now  be  noticed.  "With  one  excep- 
tion (the  fossil  genus  Anoplotherium,  which  is  allied  to  the 
Tapir  tribe)  Man  is  distinguished  from  all  other  animals,  by  the 
equality  in  the  length  of  all  his  teeth,  and  by  their  being  closely 
ranged  together  in  both  jaws.  Even  the  Apes  have  the  canine 
teeth  (especially  in  adult  age)  longer  than  the  others  ;  and  an 
interval  in  the  line  of  teeth  in  each  side  of  the  jaw,  to  receive 
the  canines  of  the  opposite  jaw.  The  vertical  position  of  the 
Human  teeth,  on  which  one  of  the  most  characteristic  features 


144  BODILY    CHARACTERISTICS    OF    MAN. 

of  the  Human  face, — the  prominent  chin,— depends,  is  also  quite 
peculiar  to  him ;  and  is  intimately  connected  both  with  his  erect 
attitude,  arid  with  the  perfection  of  the  hands,  by  which  the 
food  is  divided  and  conveyed  to  the  mouth.  He  has  no  occasion 
for  that  protrusion  of  the  muzzle  and  lips,  which,  in  animals 
that  seize  their  food  with  the  mouth  only,  is  required  to  prevent 
the  whole  face  from  coming  into  contact  with  it. — The  absence 
of  any  weapons  of  offence,  and  of  any  direct  means  of  defence, 
are  remarkable  characteristics  of  Man,  and  distinguish  him  from 
other  animals.  On  those,  to  whom  Nature  has  denied  weapons 
of  attack,  she  has  bestowed  the  means  either  of  passive  defence, 
of  concealment,  or  of  flight.  Yet  Man,  by  his  superior  reason, 
has  not  only  been  enabled  to  resist  the  attacks  of  other  animals, 
but  even  to  bring  them  under  subjection  to  himself.  His  intel- 
lect can  scarcely  suggest  the  mechanism,  which  his  hands  cannot 
frame ;  and  he  has  devised  and  constructed  arms  more  powerful 
than  those  which  any  other  creature  wields,  and  defences  so 
secure  as  to  defy  the  assaults  of  all  but  his  fellow  men.  As  we 
might  expect  from  his  far  higher  intelligence,  the  brain  of  Man 
far  exceeds  that  of  the  most  elevated  Quadrumana  in  size  ;  and 
at  least  equally  surpasses  it  in  the  complexity  and  high  develop- 
ment of  its  internal  parts,  and  in  the  depth  and  number  of  its 
convolutions. 

134.  Man  cannot  be  regarded  as  distinguished  from  Mam- 
malia, however,  either  by  acuteness  of  sensibility,  or  by  muscular 
power.  His  swiftness  in  running,  and  agility  in  leaping,  are 
inferior  to  that  of  other  animals  of  his  size, — the  full-grown 
Orang  for  example.  The  smallness  of  his  face,  compared  with 
the  remainder  of  the  skull,  shows  that  the  portion  of  the  ner- 
vous system  distributed  to  the  organs  of  sense  is  proportionally 
less  developed  in  him  than  it  is  in  most  other  animals  ;  and  we 
find  that  he  is  surpassed  by  many  among  them  in  the  acuteness 
of  his  sensibility  to  light,  sound,  &c. ;  though  he  stands  alone  in 
the  power  of  comparing  his  sensations,  and  of  drawing  conclu- 
sions from  them.  Moreover,  although  none  of  his  senses  are 
very  acute  in  his  natural  state,  they  are  all  capable  (as  is  also 
his  swiftness  of  foot)  of  being  much  improved  by  practice,  when 


BODILY   CHARACTERISTICS    OP   MAN.  145 

circumstances  strongly  call  for  their  exercise.  This  power  of 
adaptation  to  varieties  in  external  conditions,  which  makes  him 
to  a  great  extent  independent  of  them,  is  manifested  in  other 
features  of  his  structure  and  economy.  He  is  capahle  of  sus- 
taining the  lowest,  as  well  as  the  highest,  extremes  of  atmo- 
spheric pressure  ;  and  in  this  respect  he  is  strikingly  contrasted 
with  the  Quadrumana,  to  all  of  which  a  warm  climate  is  a 
necessary  condition  of  their  existence.  Thus  the  Chimpanzee  is 
restricted  to  the  hottest  parts  of  Africa,  and  the  Orang  Outan 
is  only  found  in  Borneo  and  Sumatra ;  they  cannot  be  kept 
alive  in  temperate  climates  without  the  assistance  of  artificial 
heat ;  and  even  when  this  is  afforded,  they  speedily  become 
diseased  and  die.  The  diet  of  Man,  as  indicated  alike  by  the 
conformation  of  his  teeth  and  digestive  apparatus,  and  by  his 
natural  tastes,  is  properly  of  a  mixed  kind  ;  but  he  may  sup- 
port himself  in  health  and  strength  on  animal  or  vegetable  food 
exclusively.  It  is  partly  to  this  capability  of  adaptation,  that 
we  are  to  attribute  the  various  modifications  of  his  form  and 
external  appearance,  which  are  so  remarkable  in  the  various 
races  that  inhabit  different  parts  of  the  globe.  Some  of  these 
will  be  presently  noticed. 

1 35.  The  slow  growth  of  Man,  and  the  length  of  time  during 
which  he  remains  in  a  state  of  dependance  upon  his  parents,  are 
additional  characters,  by  which  he  is  distinguished  from  other 
animals,  and  which  are  closely  connected  with  his  ultimate 
superiority  over  them.  He  is  unable  to  seek  his  own  food 
during  at  least  the  three  first  years  of  his  life  ;  and  he  does 
not  attain  his  full  stature,  until  he  is  more  than  twenty  years  of 
age.  This  circumstance  influences  all  the  relations  of  parent 
and  offspring  ;  and  is  closely  connected  with  that  association  of 
the  members  of  the  same  family,  and  that  continued  affection 
amongst  them,  which  we  have  no  reason  to  regard  as  existing 
among  any  other  animals.  In  proportion  to  his  size,  the  dura- 
tion of  the  life  of  Man  is  greater  than  that  of  other  Mammalia. 
The  greatest  age  of  the  Horse,  for  example,  which  is  an  animal 
of  much  superior  bulk,  is  between  thirty  and  forty  years  ;  that 
of  the  Orang,  which,  when  full  grown,  surpasses  Man  in  stature, 


146  MENTAL    CHARACTERISTICS    OF    MAN. 

is  about  the  same,  so  far  as  can  be  ascertained.  The  age  to 
which  the  life  of  Man  is  ordinarily  prolonged  under  favourable 
circumstances,  may  be  stated  as  about  seventy -five  years  j  but 
it  frequently  surpasses  a  hundred, — and  this  among  individuals 
of  all  nations. 

136.  It  cannot  be  doubted,  however,  that  the  mental  endow- 
ments of  Man,  and  the  habits  of  life  which  result  from  them, 
distinguish  him  much  more  completely  from  the  lower  animals, 
than  do  the  peculiarities  of  his  bodily  structure  and  actions.  In 
the  highest  among  brutes,  the  mere  instinctive  propensities  are  the 
frequent  springs  of  action  (ANIM.  PHYSIOL.  Chap,  xiv.) ;  and 
though  the  intelligence  and  will  may  operate  to  a  certain  extent, 
the  character  never  rises  beyond  that  of  the  child.  In  fact,  the 
correspondence  between  the  mental  faculties  of  the  Chimpanzee, 
and  those  of  the  Human  infant  of  between  two  and  three  years  old, 
is  very  close.  In  adult  Man,  however,  the  instinctive  propen- 
sities only  manifest  themselves  strongly,  when  the  intellect  is 
undeveloped  ;  and  nearly  all  his  actions  are  performed  under  the 
immediate  guidance  of  his  intelligent  will.  From  the  intelligence 
of  Man  results  his  power  of  improvement ;  and  this,  acting  from 
generation  to  generation,  is  the  cause  of  the  comforts  now  enjoyed 
by  civilized  races,  and  of  the  means  which  they  possess  of  still 
further  civilization.  In  the  mode  in  which  these  are  attained, 
we  observe  a  remarkable  difference  between  the  character  of 
Man,  and  tha't  of  the  lower  animals.  The  arts  of  which  they 
are  capable,  are  limited  and  peculiar  to  each  species  ;  and  there 
seems  to  be  no  general  power  of  adapting  these  to  any  great 
variety  of  purposes,  or  of  profiting  by  the  experience  of  others. 
Where  a  particular  adaptation  of  means  to  ends,  of  actions  to 
circumstances,  is  made  by  an  individual  (as  is  frequently  the  case 
where  some  amount  of  intelligence  or  rationality  exists),  the 
rest  do  not  seem  to  profit  by  it  (ANIM.  PHYSIOL.  §  695)  ;  so  that 
there  is  no  proof  of  any  species  or  race,  among  the  lower  animals, 
ever  making  an  advance  towards  an  improvement  or  alteration 
in  its  condition.  It  has  been  already  pointed  out  (§  110),  that 
modifications  in  structure  and  instincts  may  be  induced  by  cir- 
cumstances in  some  of  the  most  improvable  species ;  but,  in 


MENTAL    CHARACTERISTICS    OF    MAN.  147 

order  that  these  may  be  hereditarily  transmitted,  they  must  not 
be  foreign  to  their  natural  character.  This  may  be  accomplished 
in  a  still  higher  degree,  in  regard  to  Man.  Under  the  influence 
of  Education,  corporeal  and  mental,  continued  through  successive 
generations,  the  capabilities  of  his  whole  nature,  and  especially 
those  of  his  brain,  are  called  out ;  so  that  the  general  character 
of  the  race  is  greatly  improved.  On  the  other  hand,  under  the 
influence  of  a  degraded  condition,  there  is  an  equally  certain 
falling-back ;  and  the  longer  this  operates,  the  more  difficulty 
will  there  be  in  again  elevating  the  race.  Hence,  to  bring  up 
the  New  Holland  Savage,  or  the  African  Bushman,  to  the  level 
of  the  European,  would  probably  require  centuries  of  civilization. 

137.  One  of  the  most  important  aids  to  the  use  and  develop- 
ment of  the  Human  mind,  is  the  power  of  producing  articulate 
sounds,  or  language  ;  of  which,  as  far  as  we  know,  Man  is  the 
only  animal  in  possession.     There  is  no  doubt,  that  in  many 
other  species,  certain  powers  of  communication  exist ;  but  these 
are  probably  very  limited,  and  of  a  kind  very  different  from  a 
verbal  language, — more  resembling,  in  fact,  the  language  of  signs. 
How  little  this  can  convey,  in  comparison  with  verbal  language, 
we  can  only  realize  when  we  attempt  to  hold  converse  with  a 
foreigner  whose  tongue  we  do  not  understand,  or  with  one  of 
those  unfortunate  persons,  in  whom  there  is  deficiency  of  the 
powers  of  hearing  and  speech.     In  fact,  such  language  can  only 
apply  to  things  ;  and  cannot  express  those  general  and  abstract 
ideas,  which  form  a  large  part  of  our  own  current  of  thought. 
For  example,  we  could  not  convey  by  signs  the  qualities  of  hard- 
ness or  softness,  smoothness  or  roughness,  without  referring  to 
some  object  which  exhibits  them.      And  all  we  know  of  the 
mental  habits  of  the  lower  animals  leads  to  the  belief,  that  in 
such  general  ideas  they  are  completely  deficient.     Above  all,  it 
would  seem  that  the  mind  of  Man  is  distinguished  from  theirs 
by  the  faculty  of  conceiving  of  a  Superior  Being,  enjoying  a 
purely  spiritual  existence,  Omnipotent,  Omniscient,  and  Omni- 
present (ANIM.  PHYSIOL.  §  721,  722). 

138.  It  is  well  known  that  there  is  a  considerable  variety  of 
races  of  men ;  differing  from  each  other,  not  only  in  language, 

L  2 


148  UNITY    OF    THE   SPECIES   OP    MAN. 

habits,  degree  of  civilization,  &c. ;  but  in  the  conformation  of 
their  bodies,  the  colours  of  the  surface,  the  degree  in  which  it  is 
covered  with  hair,  &c.  And  it  conies  to  be  a  question  of  great 
scientific  interest,  as  well  as  one  that  considerably  affects  the 
mode  in  which  we  view  and  treat  the  races  that  differ  from  our 
own, — whether  they  are  all  of  one  species,  that  is,  whether  they 
may  have  all  descended  from  a  common  stock, — or  whether  they 
are  to  be  regarded  as  distinct  species,  having  had  an  originally 
distinct  parentage.  It  has  been  a  favourite  idea  with  some 
of  those,  who  wished  to  excuse  the  horrors  of  slavery  or  the 
extirpation  of  savage  tribes,  that  races  thus  treated  might  be 
considered  as  inferior  species,  and  as  legitimately  placed  under 
our  dominion  ;  but  this  doctrine,  which  has  had  its  origin  in  the 
desire  to  justify  as  expedient  what  could  not  be  defended  as 
morally  right,  finds  no  support  from  scientific  inquiries  con- 
ducted in  an  enlarged  spirit.  For  although  it  would  be  easy  to 
select  from  amongst  different  races,  such  as  the  European,  the 
Guinea-coast  Negro,  the  Kafir,  the  Tartar,  the  Malay,  the  New- 
Holland,  and  the  American  Indian,  a  set  of  forms,  which,  when 
placed  side  by  side,  should  present  very  strongly-marked  distinc- 
tions,— yet  it  would  be  found  that,  among  all  these  races, 
examples  would  occasionally  present  themselves,  in  which  these 
distinctions  would  be  much  less  obvious.  Thus,  among  the 
inhabitants  of  our  own  country,  we  may  not  unfrequently  meet 
with  individuals  of  pure  European  descent,  who  have  the  reced- 
ing forehead,  the  woolly  hair,  the  thick  lips,  and  the  projecting 
muzzle  of  the  Negro ;  and  who  want  little  else  than  a  dark  colour 
in  the  skin,  to  have  all  the  chief  peculiarities  of  that  race.  On 
the  other  hand,  among  some  of  the  Negro  races,  examples  are 
not  unfrequently  to  be  seen,  in  which  the  general  form  of  the 
head  and  body  is  that  of  the  European  ;  the  chief  difference 
being  in  colour.  That  colour  alone  cannot  be  at  all  relied  upon 
as  a  distinction,  is  proved  by  the  fact,  that  a  large  number  of 
pigment-cells  exists  in  the  skin  of  all  the  races  of  Man  ;  and  that 
the  nature  of  their  secretion,  and  the  consequent  hue  of  the  skin, 
depends  greatly  upon  the  degree  in  which  the  surface  is  exposed 
to  light  and  heat  (ANIM.  PHYSIOL.  §  492).  Moreover,  amongst 


UNITY    OP    THE    SPECIES    OP    MAN.  149 

the  various  races  that  unquestionably  belong  to  a  common  stock, 
we  find  varieties  of  colour  almost  as  great  as  those  which  exist 
between  the  so-called  distinct  species.  Thus,  the  Moors  of 
Northern  Africa,  the  Hindoos  of  India,  the  fair-haired  Saxons, 
and  the  sun-burnt  inhabitants  of  Southern  Europe,  may  be  all 
referred  with  certainty  to  a  common  parentage ;  the  differences 
between  them  being  for  the  most  part  only  "  skin-deep,"  and  the 
relationship  between  them  being  shown  by  affinities  in  language, 
customs,  &c.,  as  well  as  by  general  conformity  in  the  structure 
of  their  bodies.  The  same  may  be  said  of  the  various  races 
inhabiting  Africa ;  which,  with  the  exception  of  those  of  Moorish 
origin,  undoubtedly  belong  to  one  family ;  yet  they  differ  most 
widely  from  each  other  in  colour,  and  in  many  points  of  general 
conformation.  Some  of  them,  as  the  Kafirs,  and  some  nations 
in  the  interior  of  that  vast  continent,  appear  to  be  elevated 
above  the  ordinary  Negro  type  ;  and  present  much  resemblance 
to  the  European  stock  :  whilst  others,  as  the  Negroes  of  the 
Guinea  Coast,  with  whom  we  are  most  familiar,  are  evidently 
degraded  from  it.  In  fact,  there  is  fully  as  much  difference 
between  these,  as  there  is  between  those  of  the  Negro  and  Euro- 
pean races,  which  most  nearly  resemble  each  other. 

139.  Such  considerations  alone  would  induce  us  to  hesitate 
much,  before  giving  the  character  of  distinct  species  to  these 
various  races;  more  especially,  as  we  find  that  the  differences 
they  present  are  such  as  exist  among  the  breeds  of  domestic 
animals,  which  we  have  every  reason  to  refer  to  a  common  origin 
(§  13  and  107).  There  is  not  so  much  difference,  for  example, 
between  the  European  and  the  Negro,  as  there  is  between  the 
Mastiff  and  the  Greyhound.  And,  as  before  remarked,  the 
conformation  of  the  human  body  is  such,  that  it  easily  adapts 
itself  to  variations  in  its  external  conditions,  and  must  therefore 
change  in  accordance  with  them  ;  so  that  we  should  be  justified 
in  expecting  at  least  as  much  difference  among  the  races  of  Men, 
whose  circumstances  in  regard  to  climate,  food,  nature  of  the 
country,  &c.,  are  of  an  opposite  character,  as  among  the  breeds 
of  domesticated  animals.  All  argument  from  analogy,  therefore, 
is  in  favour  of  this  view  ;  and  there  are  some  additional  grounds 


150  UNITY    OF   THE    SPECIES    OF   MAN. 

for  the  belief  in  the  common  origin  of  the  human  family,  which 
seem  to  give  it  the  rank  of  a  scientific  fact. — Thus  there  is  a 
complete  agreement  amongst  all  rac  js  of  Man,  however  different 
they  may  be  in  aspect  and  habits,  as  to  the  manner  in  which 
the  most  important  functions  of  the  body  are  performed,  the 
periods  at  which  they  take  place,  the  average  duration  of  life, 
&c. ;  or,  at  least,  whatever  variations  may  present  them- 
selves in  these  respects  between  different  races,  they  are  not 
greater  than  those  which  are  found  among  individuals  of  the 
same  race,  under  different  circumstances  in  regard  to  climate, 
food,  &c.  If  the  test  which  has  been  laid  down  for  the  distinc- 
tion of  species  (§  14,  note)  be  really  valid,  its  application  to  this 
question  removes  all  doubt ;  for  it  is  well  known,  that  not  only 
does  a  mixture  of  different  races  produce  offspring,  but  the  indi- 
viduals of  the  mixed  race  thus  originated  are  fertile  with  each 
other,  so  that  the  mixed  race  is  continued, — which  is  not  the 
case  with  hybrid  races,  that  originate  in  a  crossing  of  different 
species.  Moreover,  the  mixed  race  is  generally  equal  in  personal 
qualifications,  and  sometimes  even  superior,  to  either  of  the 
parent  stocks ;  and,  instead  of  having  a  tendency  to  degenerate 
and  die  out,  its  fertility  is  usually  greater,  so  that  it  rapidly 
increases.  It  is  probable  that,  in  many  parts  of  the  world, — 
such  as  South  America  and  Hindostan,  the  races  that  have  been 
produced  by  the  intermixture  of  Europeans  with  the  natives  of 
those  countries,  will  ultimately  attain  the  predominance.  Now, 
even  if  it  should  ever  occur  in  Animals,  as  it  sometimes  does  in 
Plants  (YEGET.  PHYSIOL.  §  454),  that  a  hybrid  race,  produced 
between  distinct  species,  should  be  able  to  keep  itself  up  for  a 
few  generations,  it  would  be  safe  to  affirm  that  it  would  ulti- 
mately cease  to  exist, — either  being  lost  altogether,  or  merging 
into  one  of  the  parent  races,  by  intermixture  with  it. — Conse- 
quently it  is  evident,  from  this  test,  that  we  are  justified  in 
regarding  the  different  races  of  Man,  not  as  distinct  species,  but 
as  varieties,  which  have  arisen  in  course  of  time,  and  under  the 
influence  of  peculiar  circumstances,  in  the  same  manner  as  the 
breeds  of  the  domesticated  races  (§  107 — 114). 

140.     The  same  conclusion  has  been  arrived  at  from  a  com- 


VARIETIES    OP    HUMAN    RACE.  151 

parison  of  the  mental  characters  of  the  several  races  ;  for  it  has 
been  shown  that,  however  various  the  degree  in  which  they  have 
been  respectively  developed,  the  same  elements  exist  in  all; 
and  that  individuals  of  even  the  most  degraded  races  have 
exhibited,  under  the  influence  of  education,  the  same  exalted 
powers  and  elevated  tendencies,  which  many  of  those  in  whom 
they  are  most  fully  developed,  are  accustomed  to  regard  as 
peculiar  to  themselves. 

141.  Notwithstanding  that  we  have  determined  to  refer  all  the 
existing  races  of  Men  to  one  common  origin,  yet  it  would  appear 
that  the  chief  varieties  of  form  must  have  presented  themselves 
at  a  very  early  period.  Thus,  the  hieroglyphic  records  of  Egypt 
afford  testimony,  of  an  older  date  than  that  to  which  any  written 
language  carries  us  back,  as  to  the  existence  of  black  and  red 
races  at  those  periods ;  and  the  traditions  and  remains  of  the 
Chinese  and  American  nations,  seem  to  carry  back  their  exist- 
ence as  distinct  stocks,  to  an  epoch  almost  equally  remote. 
Although  almost  every  nation  has  its  distinctive  peculiarities  at 
the  present  time,  yet  it  is  easy  to  see  that  there  is  a  comparatively 
small  number  of  prevailing  types  of  form,  to  which  they  may  be 
referred, — as  the  different  forms  of  the  domesticated  animals  are 
referred  to  certain  breeds.  Some  have  thought  that  these  might 
be  reduced  to  three  ;  and  have  supposed  that  they  derived  their 
origin  from  the  three  sons  of  Noah,  respectively.  The  more  usual 
division  has  been  into  fae;  the  Caucasian,  Mongolian,  African 
or  Negro,  Malay,  and  American.  From  a  most  profound  and 
extensive  comparison,  however,  of  their  physical  characters, 
languages,  and  customs,  Dr.  Prichard  sees  reason  to  arrange 
them  under  seven  classes.  These  are: — 1.  Those  nations  (com- 
monly termed  Caucasian)  which,  in  the  form  of  their  skulls  and 
other  physical  characters  resemble  Europeans ;  this  division  in- 
cludes all  the  European  nations,  with  the  exception  of  the  Lap- 
landers and  Finnish  races,  inhabiting  the  north-eastern  portion  ; 
and  also  comprehends  several  nations  in  the  north  of  Africa,  and 
in  the  west  and  south  of  Asia :  of  this  race,  the  Greeks  seem  to 
afford  the  most  perfect  model. — 2.  Those  nations  (commonly 
termed  Mongolian)  which  bear  a  resemblance  in  the  figure  of 


152  VARIETIES   OF    HUMAN    RACE. 

their  skulls,  and  in  their  general  conformation,  to  the  Kalmucks, 
Mongoles,  and  Chinese ;  these  occupy  the  north  and  east  of 
Asia  ;  and  the  Laplanders  and  Finnish  races  of  Europe,  and  the 
Esquimaux  of  America,  seem  to  belong  to  the  same  class. — 3.  The 
third  class  includes  the  native  American  races  (excluding  the 
Esquimaux),  which  bear  a  very  strong  resemblance  to  one 
another,  both  in  physical  and  moral  characters,  notwithstanding 
the  immense  extent  of  country  over  which  they  are  distributed. 
Here,  as  in  the  nations  of  the  first  division,  we  find  great  differ- 
ence in  regard  to  colour  ;  the  temperate  regions  being  inhabited 
by  white  races  of  a  florid  complexion  ;  whilst  the  tropical  portions 
of  that  vast  continent  are  tenanted  by  tribes  of  very  dark  or 
even  black  hue. — 4.  To  the  fourth  class  belong  only  the  Hot- 
tentot and  Bushman  races,  which  inhabit  the  south  of  Africa, 
and  differ  so  strongly  from  the  other  nations  of  that  continent, 
as  to  require  being  placed  together  in  a  distinct  group. — 5.  The 
Negro  races,  including  the  inhabitants  of  the  African  continent, 
between  the  parts  occupied  by  the  Moorish  and  other  nations  of 
the  first  class  in  the  north,  and  those  belonging  to  the  Hottentots 
and  Bushmen. — 6.  ThePapuas,  or  woolly-haired  races,  which  are 
diffused  through  New  Guinea  and  the  islands  of  the  Malayan 
Archipelago. — 7-  The  Alfourou  and  Australian  races,  which 
exhibit  the  characters  of  the  human  species  in  its  most  degraded 
form.  These  are  found  in  New  Holland,  and  in  the  interior  of 
some  of  the  larger  islands  of  the  Malayan  Archipelago. 

142.  In  regard  to  the  evidence  which  Geology  affords,  as  to 
the  distribution  of  Man  over  the  globe  at  former  periods  of  its 
existence,  it  is  sufficient  to  observe  that  it  affords  a  most  striking 
confirmation  to  the  Scriptural  statement  on  the  subject ;  for  no 
fossil  remains  of  Man  have  ever  been  found,  except  in  deposits 
which  we  have  good  reason  for  affirming  to  be  of  very  recent  date, 
or  to  be  still  going  on  ;  and  wherever  the  remains  of  other 
animals  are  associated  with  his,  they  belong  to  species  at  present 
existing.  Thus,  Geology  and  Zoology,  so  far  from  being  opposed 
to  Revelation,  confirm  it  in  these  very  important  particulars ; — 
1.  That  Man  has  not  been  a  perpetual, inhabitant  of  this  globe, 
but  that  his  introduction  into  it  took  place  not  many  thousand 


ORDER    QUADRUMANA.  153 

years  since,  probably  at  the  same  time  with  the  creation  of  a 
large  number  of  other  animals  ;  and  that  no  very  great  change 
has  since  been  made  in  its  surface. — 2.  That,  notwithstanding 
the  diversities  among  the  races  now  existing,  they  may  have  all 
originated,  and  probably  did  originate,  from  one  common  stock. 


ORDER  II.— QUADRUMANA. 

143.  The  characters  upon  which  this  order  is  founded  have 
been  already  explained  (§  120)  ;  and  the  points  in  which  it 
chiefly  differs  from  the  preceding,  have  been  adverted  to  under 
the  last  head.  It  remains  to  notice  some  other  general  charac- 
ters, however ;  and  to  point  out  how  these  become  modified  in 
the  different  subdivisions  of  the  order. — In  the  first  place,  as 
already  remarked,  the  Quadrumana  are  not  the  only  animals 
possessing  opposable  thumbs  on  the  feet  as  well  as  the  hands 
(§  J26) ;  nor  do  we  find  this  character  to  be  universally  presented 
by  them.  In  one  large  division  of  the  order,  indeed,  we  find 
that  the  thumbs  are  possessed  by  only  one  pair  of  the  members  ; 
but  this  is  the  hinder  pair,  which  is  thus  converted  into  hands  ; 
whilst  the  front  pair  of  extremities,  not  being  possessed  of 
thumbs,  lose  the  distinctive  character  of  hands.  It  would  be  a 
more  correct  designation  of  the  whole  group,  therefore,  to  term 
it  Pedimana,  or  foot-handed^ — implying  that  the  posterior  ex- 
tremity is  converted  into  a  hand,  which  is  a  constant  character  of 
the  order, — rather  than  Quadrumana^  or  four-handed,  which  does 
not  correctly  apply  to  a  large  portion  of  it. — We  must  connect 
with  this  description,  in  order  to  distinguish  these  animals  from 
other  four-handed  Mammals,  the  characters  derived  from  their 
teeth ;  for  in  them  alone  do  we  find  all  the  three  kinds  present. 
Yet  even  this  is  not  an  invariable  character;  for  there  are 
certain  aberrant  forms,  which  have  a  dentition  that  leads  us 
towards  the  Rodentia,  and  in  which  only  two  kinds  of  teeth  are 
present.  But  these  so  closely  resemble  the  Quadrumana  in 
their  general  characters,  that  there  can  be  little  doubt  of  their 
real  affinity  to  them. 


154  GENERAL   CHARACTERS    OF    QUADRUMANA. 

144.  There  are  very  marked  differences  among  the  different 
tribes  of  this  order,  as  to  the  degree  in  which  they  approach 
Man  in  their  general  conformation  ;  some  of  them  bearing  a 
strong  resemblance  to  him  in  structure,  aspect,  and  gait ;  whilst 
others  are  but  little  removed  from  the  type  of  the  ordinary 
Mammals.     The  difference  between  the  young  and  adult  form 
is  very  considerable,  especially  as  regards  the  shape  of  the  head ; 
this  is  seen  in  a  very  striking  manner  in  the  Orang  Outan  ;  of 
which  the  young  specimen  has  been  placed  at  the  head  of  the 
order,  being  supposed  to  form  the  nearest  approach  to  Man ; 
whilst  the  old  one,  supposed  to  be  altogether  a  different  animal, 
has  been  degraded  below  the  level  of  the  Baboons,  on  account  of 
the  great  diminution  in  its  facial  angle. 

145.  There  are  also  considerable  differences  among  them,  as 
to  food  and  habits.     As  a  general  rule,  they  may  be  said  to  be 
omnivorous^ — that  is,  disposed  to  eat  anything,  or  to  subsist  on 
a  mixed  diet.     The  Apes,  Monkeys,  and  Baboons,  search  after 
and  devour  the  eggs  of  birds,  locusts,  and  even  small  lizards,  with 
great  diligence  and  appetite ;  and  in  confinement  they  devour 
animal  flesh  with  great  delight.     But  their  natural  tastes  lead 
them  to  mingle  their  animal  prey  with  fruits  or  other  succu- 
lent vegetable  substances ;    and  if  they  are  kept    from   these 
when  in  confinement,  they  become  unhealthy. — In  regard  to 
their  habits  of  life,  too,  there  is  great  variety.     Some  of  them 
live  solitarily,  or  in  pairs  ;  others,  and  these  the  larger  propor- 
tion, in  societies.     Some  go  in  search  of  their  food  by  day  ;  but 
the  greater  proportion  are  nocturnal  in  their  activity.     For  the 
most  part,  they  inhabit  trees ;  but  some  species   live  on   the 
ground;    and    others    among    rocky  and    almost    inaccessible 
heights. 

146.  The  order  seems  to  be  most  properly  subdivided  into 
three  families,  which  present  well-marked  differences  in  struc- 
ture,  and  which  are  also  most  curiously  limited  in  their  geogra- 
phical distribution.   The  first  is  that  of  SIMIAD.E,  which  includes 
the  Apes,    Monkeys,  and  Baboons,  of  the  Old  World ;  these 
have  the  same  number  of  teeth  as  Man,  and  for  the  most  part 
have  thumbs  on  both  pairs  of  extremities.      The  second  is  that  of 


ORDER   -QUADRUMANA  ; FAMILY    SIMIAD^.  155 

CEBID.E,  or  Monkeys  of  the  New  World,  in  which  there  ia  a,  par- 
tial or  complete  absence  of  the  thumb  upon  the  hands,  and  in  most 
of  which  there  is  an  additional  molar  tooth  in  either  side  of  each 
jaw,  as  also  a  long  tail,  which  serves  as  an  additional  organ  of 
prehension.  The  third  is  that  of  LEMURID^,  a  group  of  animals 
confined  to  the  island  of  Madagascar  and  the  adjacent  parts  of 
the  world,  in  which  both  pairs  of  extremities  are  provided  with 
thumbs,  but  in  which  the  teeth  are  less  regular,  both  in  their 
form  and  number,  and  which  approach  the  lower  Mammals  in 
various  points  of  their  structure. 

147.  The  popular  division  of  the  family  SIMIADJE  into  Apes, 
Monkeys,  and  Baboons,  is  more  scientifically  correct  than  such 
arrangements  usually  are.  The  Apes  are  distinguished  by 
having  neither  tails  nor  cheek-pouches ;  and  by  the  partial  or 
entire  absence  of  the  callosities, — or  hard  spaces,  destitute  of 
hair,— which  are  found  on  the  buttocks  of  the  other  two  groups. 
They  inhabit  the  woods,  and  walk  principally  on  their  hinder 
extremities ;  steadying  and  directing  their  motions  with  their 
long  arms,  which  they  use  also  to  swing  themselves  from  branch 
to  branch.  The  Monkeys  have  cheek-pouches,  callosities,  and 
long  tails.  They,  too,  live  among  the  woods ;  but  they  usually 
walk  on  all-fours,  using  their  long  tails  chiefly  for  the  purpose 
of  guiding  and  balancing  themselves,  during  their  rapid  and 
agile  movements.  The  Baboons  also  have  cheek-pouches  and 
callosities,  by  which  they  are  distinguished  from  the  Apes ; 
whilst  they  are  known  from  the  Monkeys  by  the  shortness  of 
their  tails,  which  never  possess  any  muscular  power,  and  can- 
not give  any  efficient  assistance  in  the  movements  of  the  animals. 
The  Baboons  live,  for  the  most  part,  among  rocks  and  moun- 
tains, being  seldom  or  never  found  in  the  forests  ;  and  they  walk 
on  all-fours.  These  three  tribes  further  differ  in  their  mental 
characters.  The  Apes  possess  great  intelligence,  patience,  cour- 
age, and  docility ;  and,  when  taken  young,  may  be  made  to 
receive  a  considerable  degree  of  education.  Their  actions  are 
grave,  circumspect,  and  deliberate  ;  they  are  seldom  moved  to 
violent  passion,  though  occasionally  peevish  and  fretful  when 
teazed  or  thwarted  ;  and  they  easily  give  their  confidence  to 


156 


FAMILY   S1MIAD.E. CHIMPANZEE. 


those  who  treat  them  kindly,  and  seem  to  study  to  comprehend 
the  directions  given  to  them.  On  the  other  hand,  the  Monkeys 
are  characterized  by  cunning,  petr lance,  caprice,  and  mischievous 
curiosity  ;  their  actions  are  far  more  rapid  than  those  of  most  of 
the  Apes,  and  are  destitute  of  that  gravity  which  marks  the  lat- 
ter; and  they  are  far  from  being  as  intelligent  and  educable,  and 
display  much  less  attachment  to  individuals.  The  Baboons  are 
much  less  amiable  than  either,  and  exhibit  a  sullen  ferocity, 
together  with  a  comparative  absence  of  intelligence,  which  pre- 
vents them  from  receiving  any  large  measure  of  education,  or 
from  being  even  properly  reduced  to  subjection. 

148.  The  Apes  are  principally  confined  to  the  Peninsula  of 
Malacca,  and  the  great  islands  of  the  Indian  Ocean.  One  species, 
the  Chimpanzee,  inhabits  Western  Africa  ;  and  this  is  the  one 
which  presents  the  nearest  approach  to  Man,  of  the  entire  group. 

The  conformation  of  the  lower  extre- 
mities enables  it  to  walk  erect  with 
considerable  firmness ;  and  in  the 
same  proportion  it  is  rendered  unfit 
for  climbing.  All  the  accounts  we 
possess  (and  they  are  still  very 
imperfect)  represent  this  animal,  in 
its  natural  state,  as  living  on  the 
ground,  rather  than  in  trees ;  and 
it  is  described  as  building  a  hut  for 
its  residence,  and  using  a  club  for 
attack  and  defence, — in  this  and 
many  other  respects,  more  parti- 
cularly when  its  habits  are  observed 
in  captivity,  exhibiting  a  degree  of 
intelligence  which  is  manifested  by 
no  other  Ape.  It  feeds  upon  fruits 
and  nuts,  and  lives  in  small  socie- 
ties-  No  full-grown  specimen  has 
ever  been  brought  alive  to  this 

country  ;  and  it  is  only  within  the  last  few  years,  that  even  the 
dead  body  of  an  adult  has  been  scientifically  examined.  The 


1AMILY    SIMIAR£. OR.VNG    OUTAN.  1  ;")  7 

height  of  a  well-developed  individual  seems  to  be  above  four 
feet ;  but  the  young  specimens  that  have  been  exhibited  in  this 
country  have  not  much  exceeded  half  that  stature.  —  The 
Orangs,  of  which  two,  perhaps  three,  species  exist,  are  natives 
of  Borneo  and  Sumatra.  They  exceed  the  Chimpanzee  in  height, 
and  are  said  even  to  surpass  the  ordinary  stature  of  Man  ;  but 
they  depart  much  more  widely  from  his  general  conformation, 
being  evidently  adapted  for  arboreal  rather  than  terrestrial 
habits, — that  is,  for  living  amongst  trees,  rather  than  for  resi- 
ding on  the  ground.  When  we  look  at  the  position  of  the  legs, 
we  observe  that,  instead  of  being  in  the  same  straight  line  as 
the  thighs,  they  are  bowed  outwards  at  the  knees,  so  that  the 
soles  are  turned  inwards  and  opposed  to  one  another.  This 
accounts  for  the  great  difficulty  which  the  Orang  Outan  has 
been  observed  to  experience,  in  preserving  the  upright  posture, 
or  walking  upon  the  surface  of  the  earth ;  as  well  as  for  the 
amazing  facility,  with  which  it  has  been  observed  to  climb 
trees,  and  make  its  way  through  forests.  In  these  last  actions, 
it  is  greatly  assisted  by  the  anterior  members,  the  great  length 
of  which  enables  them  to  bear  a  part  in  the  support  of  the  body, 
when  it  is  but  slightly  thrown  forwards.  The  Orangs  which 
have  been  captured  when  young,  and  put  under  the  training  of 
Man,  show  great  docility,  gentleness,  and  intellectual  capacity  ; 
but  in  no  instance  have  their  lives  been  prolonged  through  their 
second  dentition,  at  which  period  a  great  change  seems  to  take 
place  in  their  characters.  They  then  display  great  unsociability 
and  gloominess  of  temper  ;  but  when  irritated,  manifest  a  degree 
of  activity  and  force,  together  with  even  some  ferocity  of  temper, 
which  would  scarcely  have  been  expected  from  them.  They  are 
said  to  form  a  sort  of  rude  huts  among  the  trees  in  which  they 
reside,  by  intertwining  their  branches  ;  and  in  these  they  spend 
most  of  their  time,  seldom  moving  abroad,  except  when  urged 
by  the  calls  of  appetite.  They  feed  entirely  on  fruits,  and  are 
never  known  to  eat  flesh  or  even  eggs,  in  their  natural  state  ; 
but  in  confinement,  they  may  be  readily  taught  to  relish  animal 
food.  They  seem  to  lead  a  solitary  life;  never  more  than  two  or 
three  being  found  in  each  other's  neighbourhood. 


158  FAMILY    SIMIAD.E. — GIBBONS. 

149.  The  Gibbons  (forming  the  genus  Hylobates)  differ  from 
the  preceding  Apes,  chiefly  in  the  slenderness  of  their  form,  and 
in  the  great  length  of  their  arr.is,  which  reach  nearly  to  the 
ankle-joints  when  the  animal  is  standing  erect ;  hence  they  are 
commonly  known  as  long-armed  Apes.  The  hands  and  feet  are 
still  more  adapted  for  climbing  than  are  those  of  the  Orang  ;  and 
the  feet,  which  are  very  long,  have  their  soles  turned  so  much 
inwards,  as  to  afford  no  firm  support  in  the  erect  posture.  They 
are  distributed  through  Java,  Borneo,  Sumatra,  Malacca,  and 
Siam  ;  where  they  tenant  the  forest  branches,  among  which  they 
display  the  most  astonishing  activity.  They  sweep  from  branch 
to  branch  with  arrow-like  velocity ;  their  mode  is  to  suspend 
themselves  by  their  long  arms,  and  by  an  energetic  muscular 
movement  to  launch  themselves  onwards,  aiming  at  distant 
branches,  which  they  seize  with  the  most  wonderful  precision  ; 
and  often,  without  any  pause,  and  almost  without  any  percep- 
tible effort,  they  swing  themselves  forwards  in  a  similar  manner 
to  another  equally  distant  branch.  The  most  remarkable  known 
species,  in  this  respect,  is  the  Hylobates  agilis,  or  Agile  Gibbon, 
better  known  by  its  native  appellation  of  Ungka-puti  ;  a  living 
specimen  of  which  was  recently  exhibited  in  this  country.  This 
animal  was  about  three  feet  in  height ;  but  the  space  between 
the  points  of  the  fingers,  when  the  arms  were  extended,  was  not 
less  than  six  feet, — or  as  much  as  that  of  a  tall  Man.  When 
allowed  to  move  freely  in  a  large  room,  it  would  clear,  without 
any  effort,  distances  of  18  or  20  feet ;  bounding  round  and 
round,  with  no  other  support,  than  that  which  it  derived  from 
the  projections  at  which  it  caught,  as  it  were  momentarily, 
in  passing.  The  ease  with  which  this  feat  was  accom- 
plished, renders  the  statement  of  those  who  have  observed 
it  in  its  native  haunts  quite  credible, — that  it  can  thus  clear 
a  space  of  forty  feet  at  one  swing.  This  animal  is  further 
remarkable  for  a  very  curious  song,  or  call-note,  which  is 
uttered  ever  and  anon  during  its  most  active  movements, 
but  especially  in  the  morning.  It  is  timid  and  gentle  in 
its  character,  and  easily  becomes  attached;  but  it  does  not 
associate  much  with  others  of  its  own  species.  The  Hylobates 


FAMILY    SIMIAD^. GIBBONS  ;    MONKEYS. 


1.59 


syndactylus,  *  or  Siamang  (Fig.  69),  is  another  species  of 
Gibbon,  of  greater  size,  and  more  robust  proportions,  also  inha- 
biting Sumatra.  It  is  remarkable  for  possessing  a  pouch,  or 
sac,  in  its  throat,  which  is  connected  with  the  larynx,  and  seems 
to  have  some  influence  on  the  voice  ;  this  is  described  as  a  hollow 
barking  sound.  The  Siamang  is  a  bold  and  powerful  animal  ; 

but  is  easily  domesticated,  and  is 
then  gentle  in  its  manners,  forming 
strong  attachments.  In  their  na- 
tive haunts  they  associate  together 
in  troops,  under  the  direction  of  a 
leader  ;  and  they  utter  their  cries 
simultaneously  in  the  morning  and 
evening,  making  a  most  discor- 
dant noise.  Their  movements 
are  not  nearly  so  active  as  those  of 
the  species  just  named  ;  but  their 
vigilance  is  great,  and  their  hear- 
ing seems  remarkably  acute;  so 
that  they  are  enabled  to  make  a 
timely  retreat  from  danger.  The 
specific  name  of  this  animal  is 
derived  from  the  adhesion  of  the 
first  and  second  fingers,  as  far  as 
the  last  joint  which  bears  the  nail. 

— Several  other  species  of  Gibbon,  of  which  less  is  known, 
inhabit  the  same  portion  of  the  globe. 

150.  The  Monkeys  are  distinguished,  as  already  stated,  by 
possessing  cheek-pouches,  callosities  on  the  buttocks,  and  long 
tails ;  and  all  these  peculiarities  of  structure  are  intimately  con- 
nected with  their  habits.  The  cheek-pouches  enable  them  to 
stow  away  and  carry  off  large  quantities  of  nuts  and  fruits  for 
future  consumption;  and  these  stores  they  usually  obtain  by 
periodical  excursions  from  the  forests  in  which  they  reside,  to 
the  more  open  and  fertile  spaces,  and  especially  to  cultivated 


FIG.  69. — SJAMANO. 


*  Meaning  "  united-fingered." 


160  FAMILY    SIMIADJE. MONKEYS. 

tracts,  if  such  should  be  in  their  neighbourhood.  The  callosities 
enable  them  to  take  their  repose  in  a  sitting  posture,  and  thus 
render  them  more  independent  of  a  convenient  place  of  rest  than 
are  most  of  the  Apes.  "We  find  some  approach  to  them,  how- 
ever, in  the  Gibbons ;  whose  habits  more  resemble  those  of  the 
Monkeys,  than  do  those  of  the  higher  Apes.  And  the  tail  serves 
to  them  very  much  the  same  purpose  as  the  pole  to  the  rope- 
dancer,  acting  as  a  balance  to  ensure  their  equilibrium,  when 
their  hands  are  otherwise  occupied,  and  guiding  them  like  a  rud- 
der in  their  leaps  through  the  air.  In  accordance  with  the  prin- 
ciples so  often  alluded  to,  we  do  not  find  that  the  characters  which 
distinguish  the  group  of  Monkeys  are  possessed  by  all  the  mem- 
bers of  it.  Thus,  in  the  genus  Semnopithecus^  we  find  the  cheek- 
pouches  almost  completely  absent ;  but  this  deficiency  is  compen- 
sated by  a  very  remarkable  development  of  the  stomach,  which 
has  several  distinct  pouches,  or  sacs,  branching  off"  as  it  were  from 
its  principal  cavity  (Fig.  70).  The  thumb,  too,  is  very  short 


FIG.  70 THE  STOMACH  OF  SEMNOPITHECUS. 


and  imperfect  in  these  animals ;  and  in  the  genus  Colobus  it  is 
entirely  absent. 

151.  The  first  genus  of  Monkeys,  that  of  Semnopithecus, 
bears  many  points  of  resemblance  to  the  Gibbons,  besides  the 
absence  of  cheek-pouches  in  the  one,  and  the  presence  of  rudi- 


INDIAN    MONKEYS. ENTELLUS. 


161 


mentary  callosities  in  the  other ;  and  through  these  two  genera, 
the  tribes  of  Apes  and  Monkeys  may  be  regarded  as  pretty 
closely  connected.  They  are  readily  distinguished,  however,  by 
the  long,  slender,  but  powerfully  muscular  tail,  of  which  the  Sem- 
nopithecus  is  possessed.  The  animals  included  in  this  genus  are 
commonly  termed  "  Slow  Monkeys,"  from  their  gravity  of 
habit,  and  the  absence  of  the  restlessness  usually  seen  in  the  tribe. 
But  their  slowness  is  rather  that  of  disposition  than  of  action  ; 
for,  when  roused,  they  show  themselves  capable  of  the  most  sur- 
prising exertions,  and  astonish  the  spectator  by  the  rapidity,  va- 
riety, and  precision  of  their  movements.  The  species  represented 
in  the  accompanying  figure  is  very  abundant  in  some  parts  of 


Fro.  71.— ENTBLLUS,  OR  HOONUMAN. 

India,  and  receives  divine  honours  from  the  natives,  by  whom  it 
is  termed  Hoonuman.  "  Splendid  and  costly  temples  are  dedi- 
cated to  these  animals;  hospitals  are  built  for  their  reception 
when  sick  or  wounded ;  large  fortunes  are  bequeathed  for  their 
support ;  and  the  laws  of  the  land,  which  compound  for  the  mur- 
der of  a  man  by  a  trifling  fine,  affix  the  punishment  of  death  to 


162       FAMILY   SIMIADJE. INDIAN    AND    AFRICAN   MONKEYS. 

the  slaughter  of  a  Monkey.  Thus  cherished  and  protected,  the 
Entellus  abounds  over  almost  every  part  of  India,  enters  the 
houses  and  gardens  of  the  natives  at  will,  and  plunders  them  of 
fruit  and  eatables  without  molestation.  The  visit  is  even  consi- 
dered an  honour ;  and  the  Indian  peasant  would  consider  it  an 
act  of  the  greatest  sacrilege  to  disturb  or  drive  them  away." 
They  generally  take  up  their  residence  in  the  groves  which  the 
natives  plant  round  their  villages ;  and  the  celebrated  banyan- 
tree,  named  Cubbeer-bur,  which  forms  a  grove  in  itself  (VEGET. 
PHYSIOL.  §  152),  is  the  residence  of  a  numerous  colony  of  them. 
They  are  often  allowed  to  occupy  the  roofs  of  the  houses ;  and 
may  be  not  unfrequently  seen  perched  with  much  gravity  at  the 
open  verandas,  observing  the  passing  crowd.  To  this  genus,  also, 
belong  the  Kahau,  or  Proboscis  Monkey  (Semnopithecus  larvatus)^ 
a  native  of  Borneo  and  Cochin-China,  which  is  remarkable  for 
the  extraordinary  development  of  its  nose ;  and  the  Douc,  or 
Cochin-China  Monkey  (S.  nemeus),  which  is  distinguished  by 
the  singular  variety  and  brilliancy  of  its  colours, — giving  it  an 
appearance  as  if  it  were  clothed  with  a  suit  of  garments  of  dif- 
ferent materials.  There  are  other  species  of  Semnopithecus, 
which  also  inhabit  India  and  the  Malay  Archipelago ;  and  it  is 
curious  to  notice,  that  all  the  Monkeys  of  these  regions  should 
be  of  a  kind  that  most  nearly  resembles  the  Apes,  which  are  all 
but  exclusively  confined  to  it. 

152.  The  continent  of  Africa,  however,  may  be  regarded  as 
the  head-quarters  of  the  Monkey  tribe ;  for  no  other  portion  of 
the  earth  swarms  with  these  animals  to  such  a  degree  as  its 
western  coasts, — their  number  being  due,  not  only  to  the  multi- 
plication of  individuals,  but  to  the  great  variety  of  species  which 
are  spread  over  the  face  of  the  country.  Between  twenty  and 
thirty  different  kinds  are  known  to  inhabit  the  west  coast  alone ; 
and  it  is  probable  that,  if  we  were  equally  acquainted  with  the 
interior  and  eastern  coast,  we  should  be  able  to  reckon  up  at  least 
a  hundred.  It  is  believed  that  each  of  the  different  species  is  re- 
stricted to  a  small  extent  of  country ;  and  it  is  said  that  they 
live  in  large  troops,  each  of  which  has  its  own  domain,  violently 


AFRICAN    MONKEYS.  1G3 

resisting  any  intrusion  upon  it.  The  African  Monkeys  are  mostly 
of  small  size ;  and  are  remarkable  for  the  agreeable  variety  and 
intermixture  of  their  colours,  and  for  their  playful,  lively  dispo- 
sitions. They  are  classed  under  two  genera,  Colobus  and  Cerco- 
pithecus.  Of  the  genus  Colobus  little  is  at  present  known,  no 
specimens  having  been  brought  alive  to  Europe ;  and,  of  several 
of  its  species,  only  mutilated  skins  having  been  examined.  The 
reason  of  this  is  partly  that  the  skins  are  much  valued  by  the 
negroes  on  account  of  their  long,  soft,  silky  hair ;  and  that  the 
hunters  will  not  be  at  the  trouble  of  skinning  and  preparing  the 
head  and  limbs,  so  long  as  the  fur  of  the  body  is  the  only  part  of 
value  to  them.  It  is  certain,  however,  that  numerous  species 
exist,  which  may  be  all  readily  distinguished  from  those  of  the 
Cercopithecus  by  this  simple  and  apparently  trifling  character, — 
that  the  hairs  of  the  former  are  of  the  same  colour  throughout, 
although  different  hairs  have  different  hues, — whilst  the  hairs  of 
the  latter  are  marked  by  rings  of  various  shades.  Thus  a  very 
small  piece  of  the  skin  will  enable  us  to  separate  the  two  genera ; 
but  the  character  which  essentially  distinguishes  them,  is  the 
absence  of  the  thumb  from  the  hands  of  the  Colobus,  and  its 
presence  in  the  Cercopithecus.  It  has  been  stated  that  in  the 
Semnopithecus,  this  organ  is  but  slightly  developed ;  still,  how- 
ever, it  can  be  opposed  to  the  fingers.  In  some  species  of  the 
Colobus  a  rudiment  of  it  is  perceptible ;  but  this  never  rises 
above  the  skin,  and  is  totally  destitute  of  motion  :  and  in  what 
may  be  regarded  as  the  typical  species,  it  is  entirely  absent. 
This  deficiency  is  in  some  degree  compensated  by  the  great  length 
of  the  other  fingers.  Nothing  is  known  of  the  habits  of  the 
Colobi,  and  but  little  of  their  internal  structure  ;  there  is  reason 
to  believe,  however,  that  their  stomachs,  if  not  so  complex  in 
form  as  those  of  the  Semnopithecus,  are  larger  than  those  of 
ordinary  Monkeys ;  notwithstanding  that  they  possess  fully- 
developed  cheek-pouches. 

153.  To  the  genus  Cercopithecus  belong  nearly  all  the  Monkeys 
of  the  Old  World,  with  which  we  are  most  familiar ;  and  it  may 
probably  be  regarded  as  the  typical  genus  of  the  tribe, — possess- 
ing, as  it  does,  in  a  pre-eminent  degree,  all  the  characters  which 

M2 


164      FAMILY  SIMIAD.E. — MONKEYS  AND  BABOONS. 

distinguish  it.  These  Monkeys  have  cheek-pouches,  callosities, 
well-developed  thumbs  on  their  hands,  and  long  tails  ;  and  they 
are  further  known  hy  the  annulat:d  or  ringed  character  of  their 
fur,  which  gives  them  a  speckled  appearance.  They  are  slender 
in  their  structure,  and  light  and  agile  in  their  movements  ;  and 
their  characters  display  vivacity,  impetuosity,  and  restlessness, 
with  occasional  caprice  and  petulance.  They  are  a  pre-eminently 
sylvan  race,  never 'abandoning  the  forests,  and  living  chiefly 
upon  wild  fruits  and  the  seeds  and  buds  of  trees.,  with  an  occa- 
sional intermixture  of  insects  and  birds1  eggs.  The  true  Cerco- 
pitheci  are  confined  to  Africa ;  but  there  are  a  few  species  of 
Monkeys  in  Asia  (commonly  included  among  the  Macaques), 
which  approach  the  Baboons  in  their  general  characters,  but 
which  are  probably  to  be  united  with  this  genus,  as  they  agree 
in  its  essential  characters,  except  in  having  a  shorter  tail; 
and  by  these  we  should  make  a  natural  transition  to  the  next 
tribe. 

154.  The  Baboons  are  distinguished  from  the  other  Quadru- 
mana,  not  only  by  the  peculiar  distinctive  characters  which  have 
been  already  mentioned  (§  147) ;  but  also  by  certain  obvious, 
though  less  easily  defined,  characters.  The  body  is  much  more 
massive,  and  the  strength  is  increased  in  even  greater  proportion. 
The  projection  of  the  muzzle,  at  the  ends  of  which  the  nostrils 
are  situated,  gives  to  the  face  much  more  of  the  aspect  of  the 
Carnivora;  and  they  move  much  more  exclusively  upon  all- 
fours,  than  do  any  of  the  other  SIMIAD^S.  Their  temper  is 
gloomy  and  sullen ;  and  they  exhibit  a  considerable  degree  of 
ferocity  when  they  are  attacked,  together  with  a  large  amount 
of  malice  and  revengeful  feeling  when  they  are  offended.  These 
characters,  however,  are  not  exhibited  in  an  equal  degree  by  the 
two  genera  of  which  the  tribe  consists, — Papio  and  Cynocephalus; 
for  in  the  animals  belonging  to  the  former  group,  they  are 
softened  down,  as  it  were,  so  that  the  line  of  separation  between 
them  and  the  Monkeys  is  by  no  means  distinct ;  whilst  in  those 
of  the  latter,  they  are  manifested  in  their  highest  degree.  It  is 
an  interesting  circumstance,  that  these  two  genera  should  be 
restricted  to  different  quarters  of  the  globe, — the  Papios  being 


BABOONS. 


165 


almost  exclusively  Asiatic,  and  the  Cynocephali  exclusively 
African.  They  are  not,  for  the  most  part,  inhabitants  of  the 
forests,  but  rather  of  mountainous  or  rocky  districts ;  and  their 
food  consists  at  least  as  much  of  animal,  as  of  vegetable  sub- 
stances. 

155.  The  genus  Papio  is  spread  over  India  and  the  Indian 
Archipelago;  and  is  distinguished  from  those'species  ofCercopitkeci, 
which  have  a  similar  geographical  distribution,  by  the  comparative 
shortness  of  the  tail.  There  is  a  difference  in  this  respect  amongst 
its  several  species  ;  some  of  them  having  tails  several  inches  long, 
whilst  in  others  this  organ  is  a  mere  rudiment.  But  even  where 
it  is  longest,  it  is  not  muscular ;  and  it  hangs  down  vertically  as 
in  ordinary  Mammals,  instead  of  being  extended  horizontally  as  it 
is  in  the  Monkeys,  who  use  it  as  an  instrument  of  progression. 
In  their  young  state,  they  are  docile  and  active,  possessing 
the  playfulness  of  the  Monkeys,  with  more  intelligence ;  but  as 


FIG.  72 — WANDEROO. 

they  advance  in  age,  they  exhibit  more  of  the  sullen  ferocity  of 
the  true  Baboon  character,  completely  losing  their  docility,  if  not 
their  intelligence,  and  becoming  alike  insensible  to  blows  or 
caresses.  As  an  example  of  this  genus  we  may  notice  the  Papio 
siknus,  or  Wanderoo,  which  is  a  native  of  Malabar  and  Ceylon, 


166  FAMILY    SIMIAD^E. — BABOONS. 

and  is  remarkable  for  its  look  of  wisdom  and  importance,  and 
for  the  gravity  of  its  demeanour.  The  peculiarity  of  its  aspect 
is  chiefly  due  to  a  kind  of  mane  of  greyish-dun  hair,  which 
surrounds  the  face  and  neck,  and  bears  some  resemblance  to  a 
judge's  wig. — Although  most  abundant  in  Asia,  the  genus 
Papio  extends  also  along  Northern  Africa ;  and  one  species,  the 
Papio  inuus,  or  Magot,  is  commonly  known  as  the  Barbary  Ape. 
This  is  remarkable  as  being  the  only  Quadrumanous  animal, 
which  is  at  present  a  regular  inhabitant  of  Europe.  A  large 
number  tenant  the  Rock  of  Gibraltar ;  where  they  seem  to  thrive 
as  well  as  on  the  opposite  side  of  the  strait.  This  species  was 
well  known  to  the  ancients,  by  whom  many  fables  are  related 
respecting  it ;  and  it  has  been  the  "  showman's  ape  "  from  time 
immemorial.  To  the  appellation  Ape  it  would  seem  to  be  entitled 
by  the  complete  absence  of  the  tail ;  but  the  presence  of  callosities 
and  cheek-pouches,  independently  of  its  general  conformation, 
prove  its  real  position  to  be  among  the  Baboons.  When  young, 
it  may  be  educated  in  some  degree ;  but  as  it  advances  towards 
maturity,  it  becomes  morose,  sullen,  and  mischievous  in  confine- 
ment. In  its  native  haunts,  however,  it  is  represented  as  social, 
active,  and  courageous ;  and  is  particularly  distinguished  by  its 
attachment  to  its  young. 

156.  The  genus  Cynocephalus  (dog-headed)  receives  its  name 
from  the  strong  resemblance  which  the  face,  and  especially  the 
muzzle,  bear  to  that  of  the  dog.  The  Baboons  of  this  group  are 
of  large  stature  and  prodigious  force,  never  voluntarily  assuming 
the  erect  attitude,  and  dwelling  amongst  craggy  rocks  and  preci- 
pices, which  they  climb  with  great  agility.  Their  diet  partly 
consists  of  bulbous  roots,  berries,  and  grain ;  and  partly  of  eggs, 
insects,  and  scorpions, — which  last  they  devour  with  great  dex- 
terity, nipping  off  the  sting  with  an  action  so  rapid,  as  to  prevent 
their  being  wounded  by  it.  They  are  morose  and  daring  in  their 
temper ;  and  their  physical  power  renders  them  very  formidable 
opponents.  They  congregate  in  troops,  and  are  bold  and  skilful 
in  their  predatory  excursions,  maintaining  their  ground  even 
against  large  parties  of  men.  The  accompanying  figure  represents 
the  Cynocephalus  hamadryas,  or  Grey  Baboon,  which  is  a  native 


GREY    BABOON.  —  MANDRILL.  167 

of  the  Eastern  coast  of  Africa/being  found  also  along  the  opposite 
shores  of  Arabia.     It  is  the  only  species  of  this  genus  which 


FIG.  73. — GREY  BABOON. 

extends  beyond  the  African  continent ;  and  grows  to  the  size  of 
a  large  pointer  ;  measuring  upwards  of  four  feet  in  height  when 
standing  erect,  and  two  feet  and  a  half  when  in  a  sitting  posture. 
The  head,  neck,  and  front  of  the  body  are  covered  with  long 
shaggy  hair ;  whilst  that  on  the  hips,  thighs,  and  legs,  is  short ; 
and,  when  contrasted  with  the  former,  has  the  appearance  of 
having  been  clipped,  so  that  the  whole  animal  somewhat  resem- 
bles a  shaved  French  poodle. — The  largest  and  most  ferocious  of 
all  the  Baboons  is  the  C.  maimon,  or  Mandrill ;  the  ordinary 
height  of  which,  when  standing  erect,  is  nearly  the  same  as  that 
of  a  man  ;  and  the  head  of  which  presents  a  strange  mixture  of 
colours,  as  if  it  were  painted  for  show.  The  body  is  thick  and 
extremely  robust,  the  limbs  short  and  powerful, — the  head  is 
large  and  almost  deprived  of  forehead,  the  eyebrows  remarkably 
prominent,  the  eyes  small  and  deeply  sunk  in  the  head,  the 
cheek-bones  swollen  to  an  enormous  size,  and  forming  projections 
of  the  size  of  a  man's  fist  on  each  side  of  the  nose,  which  are 


168 


FAMILY    SIMIAD^E. BABOONS. 


marked  with  numerous  prominent  ribs  of  light  blue,  scarlet,  and 
deep  purple  ; — the  hair  is  a  light  olive-brown  above,  and  a 
silvery  grey  beneath  ;  but  of  a  deep  orange  colour  beneath  the 
chin,  where  it  forms  a  small  pointed  beard;  and  directed 
upwards  above  the  forehead  and  temples,  so  as  to  meet  in  a 
point  on  the  crown,  so  as  to  give  to  the  head  a  triangular 
appearance  ; — the  ears,  palms,  and  soles  are  violet-black  : — and 
the  callosities  are  of  a  bright  scarlet.  In  its  native  wilds,  the 
Mandrill  associates  in  large  troops,  which  are  more  than  a  match 
for  the  fiercest  beast  of  prey ;  and  they  often  make  excursions 
into  villages  and  cultivated  fields,  which  they  plunder  with 
impunity.  Their  voice  is  deep  and  guttural,  consisting  of  hoarse 
abrupt  tones,  which  indicate  fury  and  malice ;  and  in  captivity 
they  are  very  furious  and  violent,  killing  any  animals  that  come 
within  their  reach,  when  their  passions  are  excited,  and  being 
more  than  a  match  for  the  strongest  unarmed  man.  This  for- 
midable animal  is  a  native  of  the  Western  Coast  of  Africa ;  as  is 
also  another  species,  the  Drill,  which  is  rather  smaller  in  stature 
than  the  Mandrill,  and  less  fero- 
cious. The  face  is  black  ;  but  the 
beard  is  orange-coloured.  The  ac- 
companying delineation  of  the  head 
shows  the  marked  approach  in  its 
form  to  that  of  the  Carnivorous 
Mammals. 

157.  In  concluding  this  account 
of  the  SIMIAD^E,  we  may  stop  to 
notice  some  peculiarities  in  the 
geographical  distribution  of  the 
family,  which  are  of  much  interest 
to  the  philosophic  naturalist.  It  is 
evident  that  the  south-east  of  Asia 
may  be  regarded  as  the  head- 
quarters of  the  Ape  tribe ;  since  we  find  but  one  species,  the 
Chimpanzee,  beyond  its  limits.  Neither  the  Monkeys  nor  the 
Baboons  which  inhabit  that  region  present  the  full  development 
of  their  respective  characters ;  for  the  Semnopitheci  want  the 


FIG.  74.— HEAD  OF  THE  DRILL. 


FAMILY   CEBID.E. — AMERICAN    MONKEYS.  169 

cheek-pouches  and  thumbs  of  the  typical  Monkeys ;  whilst  the 
Macaques  are  equally  far  from  possessing  the  stoutness  of  build 
and  the  muscular  energy,  which  characterise  the  true  Baboons. 
— On  the  other  hand,  in  Africa,  where  we  find  but  a  single 
species  of  Ape,  the  Monkeys  and  Baboons  are  most  abundant, 
and  their  characters  most  fully  displayed.  The  only  African 
genus  that  is  deficient  in  the  peculiarities  of  its  tribe,  is  that  of 
Colobus,  which  seems  to  represent  in  Africa  the  Semnopithecus 
of  Asia ;  and  this  bears  a  very  small  proportion,  in  the  number 
of  its  species,  to  the  typical  Monkeys  and  Baboons. — Lastly,  it 
is  curious  to  observe  that,  whilst  all  the  African  Simiadaa,  save 
the  Chimpanzee,  possess  cheek-pouches,  these  do  not  exist  in 
any  of  the  Asiatic  species,  except  a  few  Cercopitheci,  and  the 
Macaques. 

158.  FAMILY  CEBID.E.  This  family  includes  all  the  American 
Monkeys ;  which  differ  from  those  of  the  Old  World  in  several 
particulars,  besides  those  already  stated  (§  146).  The  thumb  of 
the  fore-hands  is  never  opposable  to  the  fingers,  and  is  very 
frequently  wanting.  The  callosities  and  cheek-pouches  are 
altogether  absent.  The  tail  is  usually  of  considerable  length, 
never  wanting,  and  often  prehensile  (that  is,  capable  of  laying 
hold  of  branches  Sec.,)  especially  in  the  species  that  are  destitute 
of  thumbs.  In  all  but  the  Marmozets,  there  is  a  third  bicuspid 
molar  on  each  side ;  making  the  molars  in  all  U  instead  of 
E|  ;  and  bringing  the  total  number  of  teeth  to  36,  instead  of  32, 
— as  in  Man  and  the  Simiadae.  A  very  obvious  and  simple  cha- 
racter, which  is  constant  in  each  group,  but  the  connection  of 
which  with  their  general  organisation  seems  by  no  means  evi- 
dent, serves  to  distinguish  the  Cebidse  from  the  SimiadaB ; — the 
apertures  of  the  nostrils  in  the  former  are  directed  laterally,  or 
outwards  ;  whilst  in  the  latter  they  are  directed  downwards  or 
forwards,  according  to  the  position  of  the  head. — The  Cebidae 
are  exclusively  confined  to  the  warmer  regions  of  the  New 
World  ;  so  that,  although  the  species  are  numerous,  their  extent 
of  territory  is  far  more  limited  than  that  occupied  by  the  Old 
World  Monkeys.  They  inhabit  the  northern  portion  of  South 
America,  from  the  Caribbean  Sea,  to  about  the  twenty-fifth 


170 


FAMILY    CEBID.E. — SPIDER    MONKEYS. 


degree  of  south  latitude ;  and  are  especially  numerous  in  those 
vast  forests  which  occupy  the  plains  between  the  rivers  Oronoko 
and  Amazons,  and  which  are  so  liitle  interrupted,  save  by  the 
intervening  streams,  that  the  Monkeys  might  almost  pass  along 
the  tops  of  the  trees,  for  several  hundred  miles  together,  with- 
out touching  the  earth.  Of  these  forests,  they  are  the  chief 
inhabitants  ;  all  of  them  being  arboreal  in  their  mode  of  life, — 
that  is,  residing  exclusively  in  trees. 

159.  Of  the  genera  which  this  family  contains,  we  shall 
notice  the  principal.  The  Ateles,  or  four-fingered  Monkeys 
(§  143),  are  distinguished  by  the  great  length,  slenderness,  and 
flexibility  of  their  limbs,  and  by  the  prehensile  power  of  their 


- 


FIG.  75 — SPIDER  MONKEYS. 


tails.  From  the  former  qualities,  they  have  received  the  appel- 
lation of  Spider  Monkeys.  Their  movements  on  the  ground 
are  much  wanting  in  firmness,  even  when  they  are  resting  on  all 
the  four  extremities  ;  giving  them  the  aspect  of  crawlers,  rather 


SPIDER    MONKEYS. HOWLERS.  171 

than  of  walkers.  They  tread  on  the  inner  edge  of  the  fore-paws, 
and  on  the  outer  edge  of  the  hind-paws;  and  endeavour  to 
assist  themselves  by  attaching  the  tail  to  any  object  as  they  pro- 
ceed. They  often  assume  the  erect  attitude,  however ;  and  then 
use  the  tail  as  a  means  of  balancing  themselves.  The  proper 
place  for  these  monkeys,  however,  is  among  the  branches  of  the 
forest ;  their  movements  are  there  rapid,  easy,  and  unconstrained  ; 
and  they  swing  from  branch  to  branch,  by  means  of  their  spider- 
like  limbs  and  their  prehensile  tails,  with  the  greatest  agility. 
The  tail  is  not  only  an  instrument  of  prehension,  but  an  organ 
of  touch  ;  the  end  of  it  is  destitute  of  hair,  and  furnished  with  a 
sensitive  skin  ;  and  it  is  capable  of  seizing  small  objects  with  great 
address.  These  animals  are  said  to  introduce  the  extremity  of 
the  tail,  as  a  feeler,  into  the  fissures  and  hollows  of  trees,  for  the 
purpose  of  hooking  out  eggs  or  other  substances.  In  the  great 
length  of  their  arms,  these  Monkeys  evidently  represent  the 
Gibbons  ;  and  they  correspond  with  them  also  in  temper, — being 
timid,  gentle,  and  contemplative,  with  more  intelligence  than 
most  other  Monkeys,  and  displaying  agility  only  when  roused. — 
The  Myceti,  or  Howling  Monkeys,  are  distinguished  from  the 
last,  by  their  greater  robustness,  and  by  the  diminished  length 
of  their  limbs  ;  by  the  presence  of  a  thumb,  which  is,  however, 
not  opposable ;  and  by  the  dilatation  of  the  os  hyoides  ( ANIM. 
PHYSIOL.  §  684)  into  a  hollow  drum,  which  communicates  with 
the  larynx,  and  gives  great  additional  resonance  to  the  voice. 
The  bowlings  uttered  by  the  troops  of  these  Monkeys  are  de- 
scribed by  travellers  as  astounding.  They  are  usually  sent  forth 
early  in  the  morning,  at  sunset,  and  during  the  darkness  at 
night ;  but  they  are  also  heard  when  the  overclouded  sky 
threatens  an  approaching  storm.  In  their  dispositions  the 
Howlers  are  melancholy  and  morose ;  their  movements  are 
tardy  and  inert,  and,  when  on  the  ground,  they  never  attempt  to 
walk  on  the  hinder  limbs  alone.  They  feed  principally  upon 
fruits  and  leaves. — In  the  genus  Cebus,  comprehending  the 
Monkeys  known  as  Sapajous,  Sajous,  and  Capucins,  the  tail  is 
covered  with  fur  to  its  extremity ;  so  that,  although  it  is  still 
prehensile,  it  is  not  so  delicate  an  organ  of  touch  as  in  the  pre- 


172 


FAMILY  CEBID.E. SAJOUS  AND  SAKIS. 


ceding  genera.     The  thumb  is  present  on  all  the  extremities. 
These  Monkeys  are  for  the  most  part  of  small  size,  and  are  very 


FIG.  76. — WHITE-THROATED  SAJOU. 


lively  and  docile  in  their  tempers,  as  well  as  active  in  their 
movements;  but  they  are  somewhat  capricious  in  their  dis- 
positions. In  their  native  forests,  they  live  in  troops  ; 
feeding  on  fruits,  grain,  eggs,  and  insects,  in  obtaining 
which  they  display  great  address.  They  have  been  termed 
Weepers,  from  the  plaintive,  piping  noise  which  many  of  them 
utter. 

1 60.  In  the  other  genera  of  CebidaB,  the  tail  is  but  very 
little,  or  not  at  all,  prehensile,  although  it  is  frequently  of  con- 
siderable size.  This  is  the  case  with  the  genus  Pithecia,  which 
includes  the  Sakis,  or  Fox-tailed  Monkeys  ;  these  animals  live  in 
small  troops  of  ten  or  twelve  individuals,  usually  residing  in  the 
outskirts  of  forests,  bordering  rivers;  and,  like  the  Howlers, 
utter  loud  cries  before  sunrise  and  after  sunset.  They  display 
a  morose  and  savage  temper ;  menacing  the  offender  with  their 


SQUIRREL  MONKEYS;  MARMOZETS.  173 

teeth,  upon  very  slight  provocation.  In  their  dentition,  they 
somewhat  approach  the  Lemurs. — The  genus  Callithrix  compre- 
hends the  Sagoins,  or  Squirrel  Monkeys ;  a  group  of  little  animals 
which  are  extremely  light,  active,  and  graceful  in  their  move- 
ments, as  well  as  elegant  in  their  forms;  and  presenting  no 
inconsiderable  resemblance  to  the  Squirrel  in  their  general  aspect, 


FIG.  77.— SQUIRREL  MONKEY. 

though  differing  from  it  most  completely  in  the  shape  of  the 
head.  Though  the  tail  is  completely  destitute  of  prehensile 
power,  it  is  used  as  a  protection  against  cold ;  to  which  these 
animals  are  acutely  sensitive.  Their  food  seems  to  consist  more 
of  insects,  eggs,  and  small  birds,  than  of  fruits  ;  and  although 
habitually  gentle  and  timid,  they  become  animated  even  to 
ferocity  at  the  sight  of  living  prey.  The  day  is  their  period  of 
activity  ;  and  they  pass  the  night  in  repose. — Nearly  allied  to 
this  genus  is  an  interesting  animal,  best  known  as  the  Douroucouli, 
which  seems  to  represent  the  Lemur  tribe  in  America  ;  its  habits 
are  completely  nocturnal,  and  its  movements  are  almost  cat-like. 
The  Marmozets,  or  Oustitis,  belonging  to  the  genus  Hapale,  are 
distinguished  from  the  rest  of  the  American  Monkeys  by  the 
absence  of  the  additional  molar,  and  by  the  sharpness  and 
crookedness  of  their  nails.  The  thumb  is  not  opposable,  being 


174  FAMILY    CEBID^E. — MARMOZETS. 

placed  in  the  same  line  with  the  other  fingers  ;  and  that  of  the 
hind  feet  is  very  short.     The  tail  is  large,  and  thickly  covered 


FIG.  78.— OUSTITI. 

with  hair  ;  but  it  is  not  prehensile ;  and  its  principal  purpose 
seems  to  be  the  regulation  of  the  movements,  and  the  prolonga- 
tion of  the  leaps,  as  in  the  Squirrel, — though  it  is  probably  of  use 
also  in  keeping  the  animals  warm  when  asleep,  in  which  state 
they  coil  themselves  up  into  a  ball.  They  are  very  nimble  and 
agile  in  their  movements,  and  extremely  cautious  in  their  habits, 
retreating  at  the  slightest  alarm  ;  though  they  will  defend  them- 
selves with  great  spirit  when  actually  attacked.  When  in  con- 
finement, they  still  exhibit  a  degree  of  wildness  and  distrust, 
which  it  is  difficult  to  overcome  completely;  and  they  do  not 
show  the  same  marks  of  attachment  to  those  who  treat  them 
with  kindness,  as  most  other  Monkeys  display.  Their  intelli- 
gence does  not  seem  high  ;  and  their  brain  is  almost  destitute  of 
convolutions  ;  but  they  show  much  instinctive  sagacity  in  their 
search  for  food,  especially  insects,  which  they  devour  with 
eagerness.  In  their  manner  of  holding  their  food,  they  strongly 
remind  us  of  the  Squirrel ;  for  they  do  not  grasp  it  with  the 
fingers,  but  press  it  between  the  two  fore-paws.  In  many 
species,  the  tail  is  marked  by  transverse  bars,  giving  it  a  very 
elegant  appearance  ;  and  several  are  also  distinguished  by  tufts 
of  hairs,  projecting  from  the  sides  of  the  head. 

161.     The  last  family  of  Quadrumana,  that  of  the  LEMUR- 


FAMILY    LEMURID^E. 


175 


,  or  Lemur  tribe,  presents  a  combination  of  characters, 
which,  although  no  single  one  may  be  very  striking  in  itself, 
evidently  points  out  the  animals  it  contains,  as  forming  the  link 
between  the  typical  Quadrumana,  and  the  lower  classes  of  Mam- 
mals. They  agree  with  the  Simiadae  in  having  opposable  thumbs 
on  both  pairs  of  extremities,  but  differ  from  them  in  dentition. 
The  number  and  form  of  the  teeth  vary  in  the  different  genera. 
Not  unfrequently  the  incisors  appear  to  be  6  below,  instead  of 
4 ;  but  this  is  owing  to  the  peculiar  form  and  position  of  the 
lower  canines  and  first  molars, — the  former  seeming  like  addi- 
tional incisors,  and  the  latter  taking  their  place  as  canines.  In 
the  true  Lemurs,  the  formula  is  as  follows  : — incisors  -J,  canines 
JEr»  molars  ^.  The  contour  of  the  body  is  very  peculiar.  The 
general  form  is  slender  and  elongated ;  the  head  pointed,  and 
somewhat  fox-like ;  the  nostrils  terminating  at  the  end  of  a 


FIG.  79- — HAND  AND  FOOT  OF  LEMUR. 


sharp,  naked,  and  somewhat  prominent  muzzle ;  the  eyes  large, 
as  in  nocturnal  animals ;  and  a  long  curved  claw  on  the  first 
(sometimes  the  first  two)  fingers  of  the  hind  feet.  This  last 
character  serves  to  distinguish  them  from  all  other  Quadrumana. 
The  tail  varies  in  length  ;  being  sometimes  large,  and  sometimes 


176  FAMILY    LEMTTRHXE. LEMURS. 

nearly  absent;  it  is  never  prehensile.  The  form  of  the  skull 
would  of  itself  indicate  the  inferior  grade  of  these  animals.  The 
size  of  the  cranial  cavity  is  greatly  diminished,  in  proportion  to 
that  of  the  face ;  no  trace  of  a  forehead  remains  ;  and  the  head 
is  placed  (as  it  were)  at  the  end  of  the  neck,  as  in  the  lower 
Mammals,  instead  of  being  seated  upon  it,  as  in  Man  and  the 
Quadrumana.  The  orbits  are  not  completely  walled  in,  but 
open  behind  into  the  temporal  fossae, — the  sunk  space  on  either 
side  of  the  skull,  which  lodges  the  temporal  muscle  (ANIM. 
PHYSIOL.  §  621,  624)  :  this  is  a  character  of  marked  degradation. 
The  tubercles  of  the  molar  teeth  are  no  longer  rounded  ;  but  are 
raised  into  points,  which  lock  into  each  other,  as  in  the  Insec- 
tivora.  Their  canines  are  sharp  ;  and  their  tongue  is  rough,  as 
in  the  Cat  tribe.  It  is  evident  that  they  are  much  more  adapted 
for  an  animal  diet,  than  are  the  typical  Quadrumana  ;  and  they 
show  great  address  in  seizing  this,  as  well  as  courage  in  defending 
themselves  when  attacked.  In  consequence  of  the  length  of 
their  hind  legs,  which  (contrary  to  the  general  rule  among  the 
Monkeys)  greatly  exceeds  that  of  the  anterior  extremities,  they 
are  for  the  most  part  agile  leapers  ;  but  the  greater  number  of 
them  are  active  only  during  the  night,  spending  the  whole  day  in 
sleep,  and  always  secluding  themselves  as  completely  as  possible 
from  light,  which  seems  painful  to  them. 

162.  Nearly  all  these  characters  are  most  completely  mani- 
fested in  the  true  Lemurs,  which  are  the  types  of  the  family. 
These  animals  are  exclusively  confined  to  the  island  of  Madagas- 
car, where  they  replace  the  Simiadse  ;  none  of  these  being  found 
there.  They  are  gentle  and  harmless  animals  :  but  will  defend 
themselves  with  great  resolution  when  attacked,  and  inflict  severe 
wounds  with  their  sharp  canines.  In  their  natural  haunts  they 
associate  in  troops ;  and  send  forth  a  hoarse  dissonant  roar, 
which  fills  the  woods  after  sunset.  They  have  little  of  the  pry- 
ing, mischievous,  petulant  disposition  of  Monkeys  ;  but  seem  also 
destitute  of  their  intelligence.  Their  fur  is  usually  very  fine 
and  silky ;  and  the  tail  long  and  bushy.  Nearly  allied  to  the 
Lemurs,  but  differing  from  them  in  not  possessing  a  tail,  and  in 
having  the  tubercles  of  the  molar  teeth  more  pointed,  are  the 


LORIS,    OR   SLOW    LEMURS.  177 

Loris,  or  Slow  Lemurs;  which  are  natives  of   India  and  the 
adjacent  islands.     They  are  remarkable  for  the  slowness  and 


FIG.  80.— WHITB-FBONTKD  LBMUR. 

caution  of  their  movements,  and  for  the  tenacity  of  their  grasp, 
which  is  due  to  their  power  of  keeping  up  muscular  contraction 
for  a  long  time.  They  are  completely  inactive  during  the  day ; 
but  at  night  they  prowl  stealthily  among  the  branches  in  search 
of  food.  Having  detected  their  prey,  which  consists  chiefly  of 
insects  and  small  birds,  they  approach  it  with  the  greatest  wari- 
ness ;  and,  when  they  are  within  reach  of  it,  they  pounce  upon 
it  with  the  utmost  certainty.  They  devour  eggs  greedily,  and 
seem  also  partial  to  fruit.  When  irritated  during  their  period 
of  repose,  their  motions  are  very  languid  ;  and  they  utter  a 


178 


FAMILY    LEMURID^E. POTTO,    TARSIUS. 


FIG.  81 — HAND  OF  POTTO. 


plaintive  drawling  cry,  which  somewhat  resembles  that  of  the 
American  Sloths. — Several  other  genera  of  Lemurine  animals 
are  found  in  Africa  and  the  Indian  Archipelago  :  of  these  we 
may  mention  the  Perodicticus  or  Potto,  which  is  distinguished 

by  the  absence  of  the  first- 
finger  of  the  hands  (Fig.  81)  ; 
the  Tarsius,  or  Malmag,  in 
which  we  find  the  bones  of  the 
tarsus  very  much  elongated, 
and  the  hind-legs  resting  only 
upon  the  points  of  the  toes, 
as  shown  in  Fig.  82  ;  and 
the  Otolicnits  or  Galago,  which, 
with  the  same  peculiarity, 
combines  the  large  mem- 
branous ears  of  the  Bats, 
which  double  down  when  the 
animal  is  at  rest.  All  these  are  nocturnal  in  their  habits,  and 
feed  partly  upon  fruits,  partly  upon  insects,  and  small  mammals, 
birds,  or  reptiles.  The  teeth  of  the 
Tarsiers  present  several  peculiarities, 
which  are  interesting  as  showing  the 
tendency  to  irregularity  in  this  re- 
spect, in  the  aberrant  forms  of  this 
family;  of  which  tendency,  a  very 
striking  example  will  be  presently 
noticed.  The  upper  canines  are  very 
small;  and  the  middle  incisors  are 
of  great  length  and  resemble  canines ; 
the  lower  incisors  are  only  two  in 
number,  and  have  more  of  the  ordi- 
nary form  and  direction. 

168.  To  the  family  of  Lemurs  we 
are  probably  to  refer  a  very  remark-  FIG.  82.— FOOT  OF  THB  MALMAG. 
able  animal,  the  Galeopithecus,  or  Flying  Lemur,  sometimes 
termed  the  Colugo  ;  a  native  of  the  Molluccas,  Philippines,  and 
other  islands  of  the  Indian  Archipelago.  Its  chief  peculiarity 


ABERRANT    LEMURIDJ5. GALEOPITHECUS.  179 

consists  in  the  extension  of  its  skin  between  the  anterior  and 
posterior  limbs  on  each  side,  and  also  between  the  two  posterior 
limbs,  including  the  tail ;  so  as  to  form 
a  parachute  of  considerable  extent, 
which,  though  it  does  not  enable  the 
animal  to  fly,  gives  it  support  in  the 
air,  sufficient  to  enable  it  to  take  long 
sweeping  leaps  from  tree  to  tree  with 
the  utmost  facility  (ANIM.  PHYSIOL. 
§  668).  The  extraordinary  combina- 
tion of  characters  exhibited  by  this 
animal,  has  caused  great  doubt  to  be 
entertained  by  Naturalists,  as  to  its 
proper  place  in  the  scale.  By  Cuvier 
it  was  placed  at  the  end  of  the  series 
of  Bats ;  and  by  Geofiroy  among  the 
no.  8&-GAUOPITB.CD..  Carnivora.  The  situation  assigned  to  it 
by  Linnaeus,  however, — who  regarded  it  as  connecting  the  Lemurs 
and  the  Bats, — is  probably  the  true  one.  The  general  aspect  of 
the  head  is  Lemurine,  the  extremities  are  all  furnished  with  five 
fingers,  of  which  the  first  (or  thumb)  is  separated  from  the  rest, 
but  does  not  antagonise  with  them,  being  short,  whilst  the 
remaining  four  are  nearly  equal,  and  are  all  armed  with  large, 
deep,  hooked,  sharp-edged,  retractile  claws, — resembling  those 
of  the  Cat  tribe.  The  incisors  are  four  in  each  jaw ;  but  the 
upper  ones  do  not  meet  in  front,  a  wide  interval  being  left 
between  the  two  pairs  :  the  canines  are  absent  in  the  upper  jaw, 
but  present  in  the  lower ;  the  molars  are  six  on  either  side  in 
each  jaw,  and  are  raised  up  into  pointed  tubercles.  During  the 
day,  these  animals  remain  in  the  depths  of  the  forests,  suspended 
like  Bats  from  the  branches,  with  the  head  downwards,  and 
clinging  by  their  hind  claws.  At  night  they  rouse  themselves  ; 
and  are  active  in  traversing  the  trees  in  every  direction  ;  sweep- 
ing from  one  to  another  with  great  address  in  search  of  their 
food,  which  consists,  like  that  of  the  Lemurs  in  general,  of  fruits, 
insects,  eggs,  birds,  &c. — As  we  find  a  similar  parachute-like 
expansion  existing  in  other  groups  of  Mammalia,  it  is  evident 

x2 


180 


ABERRANT    LEMURID^E. — CHEIROMYS. 


that  we  are  to  regard  its  presence  as  an  adaptive  character  only  ; 
and  that  we  are  to  be  guided,  in  determining  the  place  of  this 
species,  by  its  essential  characters  (J  25),  which,  as  regards  the 
conformation  of  its  teeth  and  extremities,  are  those  of  the  Lemurs, 
more  than  of  any  other  group. 

164.  As  the  Galeopithecus  leads  us  towards  the  Bats,  so  does 
another  curious  modification  of  the  Lemur  type  conduct  us 
towards  the  Rodentia;  in  which  order  it  has  been  placed  by 
Cuvier  and  other  eminent  Zoologists.  This  is  the  Cheiromys,  or 
Aye- Aye,  a  native  of  Madagascar  ;  an  animal,  which  is  very  rare 
even  in  its  native  country,  and  of  which  only  one  specimen  has 
been  brought  to  Europe.  In  its  general  conformation  it  is  strictly 

Lemurine,  though  having  much  of 
the  aspect  of  a  Squirrel.  The  bones 
of  the  fore-arm  are  movable  on  one 
another,  which  is  not  the  case  with 
those  of  the  Rodentia ;  and  the  ex- 
tremities have  five  fingers,  of  which 
the  first  is  separated  from  the  rest, 
and  shorter,  so  as  clearly  to  repre- 
sent the  thumb,  although  it  is  not 
opposable;  the  first  toe  is  armed 
with  a  straight-pointed  claw,  as  in 
the  Lemurs.  Its  habits,  too,  are 
those  of  the  Lemurs ;  during  the 
day  it  conceals  itself  in  some  hollow, 
and  passes  its  time  in  sleep  ;  but  at 
night  it  issues  forth  in  search  of  its 
food,  which  consists  of  buds  and 
fruit,  with  insects  and  larvse,  like  that  of  the  Lemurs  in  general. 
It  was  remarked  upon  two  specimens  kept  in  captivity,  that 
they  never  set  up  their  long  bushy  tail  in  the  manner  of  a 
Squirrel;  but  always  kept  it  trailing  at  length. — It  is  in  the 
conformation  of  the  teeth,  that  the  chief  relationship  to  the 
Rodentia  is  shown.  Each  jaw  contains  only  two  front  teeth, 
which  are  very  large  and  strong,  flattened  at  the  sides,  and  very 
deep  from  back  to  front ;  their  roots  extend  backwards  along 


FIG.  84 — AYE-AYE. 


CHEIROMYS. ORDER    CHEIROPTERA.  18 

almost  the  whole  length  of  the  jaw  ;  whilst  their  points  are  sharp, 
and  resemble  the  end  of  a  ploughshare.  Between  these  and  the 
molars,  there  is  a  wide  interval,  as  in  the  Rodents ;  the  molars, 
however,  are  not  formed  in  the  manner  of  theirs,  with  transverse 
ridges  of  enamel,  but  are  simple  in  their  structure.  It  is  doubtful 
whether  the  front  teeth  are  to  be  regarded  as  incisors  or  canines; 
it  is  not  improbable  that  they  really  represent  the  latter,  since  in 
several  of  the  Lemuridas  we  find  the  real  incisors  very  small, 
whilst  the  canines  project  forwards,  and  almost  take  their  place. 
The  bony  portion  is  completely  surrounded  by  enamel ;  which 
is  not  the  case  in  the  Rodentia,  in  whose  cutting- teeth  the 
enamel  occupies  the  front  edge  only  :  and  it  is  believed  that  the 
teeth  do  not  continue  to  grow  from  permanent  pulps,  as  in  that 
order  (  ANIM.  PHYSIOL.  §  177)- — One  of  the  points  in  which  the 
Aye- Aye  strongly  resembles  the  Rodentia,  is  the  position  of  the 
mammary  glands ;  which  are  situated  near  the  groin,  and  not 
on  the  chest,  as  in  the  Quadrumana  generally.  But  in  the 
Tarsiers  (§  162),  two  pairs  of  mammse  are  present, — one  on  the 
chest,  the  other  in  the  groin  ;*  so  that  the  Aye- Aye  does  not 
depart  so  widely,  in  this  respect,  from  the  general  type  of  the 
Lemurs,  as  would  be  at  first  supposed. 


ORDER  III.— CHEIROPTERA. 

1 65.  The  animals  of  this  Order,  all  of  them  commonly  known 
as  Bats,  are  distinguished  from  all  other  Mammalia  by  the  power 
of  flight;  that  is,  they  are  able  not  only  to  sustain  themselves  in 
the  air,  but  also  to  move  through  it  in  any  direction  they  may 
desire  (ANIM.  PHYSIOL.  §  668,  669).  This  power  they  derive 
from  the  peculiar  conformation  of  the  anterior  member,  the  bones 
of  which  are  very  much  prolonged,  especially  those  of  the  fingers; 
and  constitute  a  framework  (like  that  of  an  umbrella),  over 
which  is  spread  a  thin  membrane,  continued  from  the  skin  of  the 
body,  but  not  clothed  with  hair.  The  organs  thus  formed  are 


The  same  conformation  sometimes  presents  itself  in  the  Human  female. 


182 


ORDER    CHEIROPTERA  ;    GENERAL   CHARACTERS. 


true  wings  ;  being  capable  of  motion  in  such  a  manner,  as  to 
strike  the  air,  and  thus  to  raise  or  propel  the  body  by  the  resist- 
ance which  it  affords  to  their  extended  surface.  In  their  function, 
therefore,  they  are  completely  analogous  to  the  wings  of  Birds ; 
which  class  may  be  considered  as  represented  by  the  Bat  tribe 
among  the  Mammalia.  And  in  their  structure  they  only  differ 
in  this  respect, — that  the  expanded  surface,  which  is  given  in 
Bats  by  the  extension  of  the  skin  itself  over  a  complex  bony 
framework,  is  afforded  in  Birds  by  the  feathery  appendages, 
which  are  supported  upon  a  framework  of  much  simpler  con- 
struction.— On  looking  at  the  skeleton  of  the  Bat,  we  observe, 
in  the  first  place,  that  the  kumerus  or  arm-bone  (k.  Fig.  85,)  is 
long  and  large  in  proportion  to  the  body ;  but  that  the  lengthen- 
ing is  still  more  remarkable  in  the  bones  of  the  fore-arm,  cu,  r. 


FIG.  85 — SKELETON  OF  BAT. 

cl,  clavicle;  h,  humerus;  cu,  ulna;  c,  radius;  ca,  carpus;  po,  thumb;  me,  metacar- 
pus ;  ph,  phalanges ;  0,  scapula  ;  /,  femur ;  ti,  tibia. 

The  bones  of  the  carpus,  or  wrist,  ca^  do  not  show  any  consider- 
able increase ;  but  the  most  extraordinary  extension  is  seen  in 
the  metacarpal  bones  of  the  four  fingers,  which  spread  out  widely 
from  each  other  when  the  wing  is  extended,  but  are  capable  of 
being  closed  together,  like  the  stretchers  of  an  umbrella.  Upon 
these  are  situated  the  phalangeal  or  true  finger-bones,  ph  ;  the 


ORDER    CHEIROPTERA  ;    GENERAL    CHARACTERS.  183 

number  of  which  varies  in  different  genera  ;  being  only  one  in 
the  first  finger,  but  four  in  the  second,  in  the  specimen  here 
figured.  These  taper  to  a  point,  and  are  not  terminated  by 
claws  or  nails.  The  thumb,  however,  does  not  partake  of  this 
extension  in  length,  nor  does  it  assist  in  the  support  of  the  wing- 
membrane  ;  but  it  is  short  and  free,  and  is  terminated  by  a 
hooked  claw.  The  clavicle,  c/,  and  scapula,  o,  to  which  are 
attached  the  muscles  that  move  this  member,  are  of  great 
strength  ;  and  the  sternum,  or  breast-bone,  has  a  keel-like  projec- 
tion, similar  to  that  which  exists  in  Birds  (ANIM.  PHYSIOL. 
§  89)  for  the  attachment  of  the  powerful  muscles  by  which  the 
wing  is  drawn  down.  The  hinder  limbs  do  not  present  any- 
thing peculiar  in  their  structure  ;  they  serve  to  assist  in  keeping 
the  wing-membrane  extended  (as  does  also  the  tail,  where  it 
exists)  ;  and  the  toes  are  five,  armed  with  sharp  claws,  by  which 
the  animal  can  suspend  itself,  when  at  rest  in  its  retreat. 

166.  The  whole  powers  of  the  animal  seem  concentrated 
upon  its  organs  of  flight  ;  and  when  it  is  neither  asleep  nor 
torpid,  this  kind  of  movement  is  evidently  its  natural  condition. 
It  can  only  move  along  a  solid  surface,  by  folding  its  wings,  and 

using  the  hooked  thumbs  to  lay 
hold  of  any  inequality,  and  to 
draw  itself  forwards.  Hence 
its  motions  are  awkward  and 
shuffling  ;  and  on  a  polished 
surface,  like  that  of  a  table,  it 
is  greatly  embarrassed.  But 
in  the  hollows  of  trees,  the 
crevices  of  mas°nr  and  the 


F,G.86.-BAT 

chinks  or  fissures  of  a  rock,  it 

can  climb  and  crawl  about  with  great  facility.  The  air,  how- 
ever, is  its  home  ;  and  through  this  it  moves  with  vast  rapidity, 
and  with  great  apparent  ease,  wheeling  in  every  direction  in 
search  of  its  insect  prey,  and  performing  the  most  abrupt  evolu- 
tions to  secure  it.  In  these  movements  it  is  very  much  assisted 
by  the  tail,  which  serves  as  a  rudder  ;  and  we  shall  find  that 
this  organ  is  most  developed  in  the  Bats  which  pursue  insects  on 


184  ORDER    CHEIROPTERA  ;    GENERAL    CHARACTERS. 

the  wing,  whilst  it  is  small  or  entirely  wanting  in  those  which 
live  on  fruits.  In  their  mode  of  flight,  Bats  bear  a  very  strong 
resemblance  to  Swallows,  which  like  them  pursue  insects  on  the 
wing ;  but  whilst  the  latter  seek  their  food  during  the  day,  the 
former  come  forth  only  at  twilight ;  and  thus  the  Bats  exercise  the 
same  purpose  in  the  economy  of  Nature,  in  restraining  the  multipli- 
cation of  the  crepuscular  (twilight-flying)  and  nocturnal  insects, 
as  the  Swallows  do  in  regard  to  the  diurnal.  During  the  day,  the 
Bats  sleep  in  their  recesses,  suspended  by  their  hind-feet,  their 
heads  consequently  hanging  downwards  (Fig.  92)  ;  and  they 
assume  the  same  position  during  the  whole  winter,  which  is 
passed  by  them  (in  our  climate  at  least)  in  a  state  of  torpidity. 

167.  The  senses  of  hearing  and  smell  are  developed  in  Bats 
to  an  extraordinary  degree  ;  as  we  might  judge  by  the  size  of 
the  organs,  especially  in  the  insectivorous  species.     In  the  long- 
eared  Bat  of  this  country  (Fig.  91),  the  external  ear  is  nearly  as 
long  as  the  body  ;  and  there  is  frequently  an  inner  fold,  which 
seems  like  a  smaller  ear  within  the  principal  one.     The  nose, 
again,  frequently  presents  an  extraordinary  development,  being 
furnished  with  curious  leaf-like  appendages,  formed  by  a  prolon- 
gation of  the  skin,  which  is  folded  and  doubled  in  various  direc- 
tions, so  as  frequently  to  present  a  most  grotesque  appearance. 
The  membrane  of  the  wing,  too,  is  endowed  with  a  very  high 
degree  of  sensibility,  so  as  to  receive  impressions  from  the  resist- 
ance of  the  air,  which  guide  the  animal  in  its  flight  through  the 
darkest  recesses,  preventing  it  from  striking  against  obstacles, 
even  in  a  complete  labyrinth  (ANIM.  PHYSIOL.  §  495).      The 
eyes  are  usually  small,  and  can  be  of  little  use  to  those  which 
pass  nearly  their  whole  time  in  obscure  caverns,  or  in  the  dark 
chambers  of  old  buildings. — On  the  other  hand,  the  frugivorous 
species,  which  sail  over  gardens,  plantations,  or  forests,  in  search 
of  their  food,  are  guided  chiefly  by  their  sight ;  their  eyes  are 
accordingly  rather  large  than  otherwise,  whilst  the  ears  and  nose 
have  no  extraordinary  development. 

1 68.  The  insectivorous,  or  insect-eating,  Bats  constitute  by 
far  the  largest  division  of  the  Order ;  they  are  recognised,  not 
only  by  the  characters  already  noticed,  but  by  the  conformation 


ORDER    CHEIROPTERA  ;    GENERAL    CHARACTERS. 


185 


of  their  teeth  and  digestive  system,  which  is  in  accordance  with 
their  particular  kind  of  food.  Their  molars  are  beset  with 
pointed  tubercles,  adapted  to  crush  the  hard  envelopes  of  Insects; 
and  their  canines  are  not  unfrequently  of  large  size,  as  shown 

in  the  accompanying 
figure  of  the  Head  of 
Vampyrus  spectrum. 
The  intestinal  canal  is 
short,  and  is  evidently 
adapted  to  the  diges- 
tion of  animal  food ; 
in  the  Great  Bat  of 
our  own  country  it  is 
only  twice  the  length 
of  the  body ;  whilst  in 
the  true  Vampyres  of 
South  America,  which 
chiefly  live  on  the 
blood  of  other  animals, 
it  proceeds  from  the 
mouth  to  its  opposite 
termination  nearly  in 
a  straight  line.  The 
Bats  of  this  division 
are  arranged  under 
four  families  : — (I.) 
RHINOLOPHID^E,  in 
which  the  nose-leaf  is 
of  complicated  structure,  and  formed  of  membranous  folds ;  the 
first  or  fore-finger  has  but  one  joint ;  and  the  wings  are  large 
and  broad.  (II.)  PHYLLOSTOMIDJE,  which  have  but  a  simple 
and  fleshy  appendage  to  the  nose,  and  a  fore-finger  of  two  joints. 
(III.)  VESPERTILIONID^:,  which  are  altogether  destitute  of  nose- 
leaf,  but  have  broad  and  large  wings,  and  a  prolonged  tail,  but 
with  only  a  single  joint  in  the  fore-finger.  (IV.)  NOCTILIONID.S, 
which  are  also  destitute  of  nose-leaf,  but  have  long  narrow 
wings,  and  a  short  thick  tail,  with  two  joints  in  the  fore-finger. 


Fio.  87.— HEAD  AND  SKULL  OF  VAMPYRUS  SPECTRUM. 


186  FAMILY    RHINOLOPHIDJE. — HORSE-SHOE   BATS. 

— These  families  are  all  distributed  in  large  numbers  over  a  con- 
siderable part  of  the  globe,  extending  almost  to  the  coldest 
regions;  but  it  is  in  tropical  regions  that  the  Bats  are  most 
abundant,  and  attain  the  largest  dimensions.  No  fewer  than 
fifteen  species  are  known  to  inhabit  this  country ;  of  these,  all 
but  two  belong  to  the  family  Vespertilionidae. 

169.  The  family  RHINOLOPHID.E,  distinguished  from  the 
other  insectivorous  Bats,  by  the  extraordinary  development  of 
the  nasal  appendage,  contains  a  large  number  of  species,  most  of 
which  are  inhabitants  of  the  Eastern  hemisphere,  especially  the 
islands  of  the  Indian  Archipelago.  Two  species  are  known  in 
England,  under  the  name  of  the  Greater  and  Lesser  Horse-shoe 
Bats  ;  which  designation  they  have  received  from  the  peculiar 
form  of  the  front  of  the  nose-leaf.  These  animals  are  not 
common  ;  for  they  inhabit  only  the  darkest  and  least  accessible 
caverns,  subterranean  quarries,  and  other  like  situations,  scarcely 
ever  coming  forth  into  daylight.  Hence  their  habits  are  but 

little  known.  Most  of  this 
family  are  remarkable  for 
the  great  development  of 
their  integuments ;  in  the 
Megaderms  of  Africa  and 
the  Indian  Archipelago, 
there  is  not  only  an  enor- 
mous nose-leaf,  but  a  very 
large  pair  of  ears;  the 
wings  too,  being  of  great 
size  ;  whilst  in  the  Nyc- 
terins  of  the  same  coun- 
tries, the  skin  is  loosely 
attached  to  the  body, 
and  may  be  distended  by 
air  blown  beneath  it,  so 
as  to  make  the  animal 
look  like  a  little  balloon, 

FIG.  88.— HEAD  or  MBGADERMA  FRONB-  f        .  ,      ,       .  ,    ,        , 

furnished  with  head,  wings, 
and  feet.     This  is  done  by  the  animal  itself,  through  an  aper- 


FAMILY    PHYLLOSTOMIDJE. — VAMPYRES. 


187 


ture  at  the  bottom  of  the  cheek-pouch  on  each  side ;  these 
apertures  are  furnished  with  a  circular  muscle,  which  prevents 
the  return  of  the  air  except  at  the  will  of  the  animal;  and 
large  valves  for  the  same  purpose  exist  in  the  head  and  back. 
The  use  of  this  singular  provision  is  not  known,  unless  it  be  for 
diminishing  the  specific  gravity  of  the  body,  by  increasing  its 
bulk ;  which  seems  to  be  at  least  one  of  the  purposes  answered 
by  the  air-cells  of  Birds. 

170.  The  Bats  of  the  second  family,  PHYLLOSTOMIDJS,  are 
for  the  most  part  inhabitants  of  South  America ;  where  they 
may  be  regarded  as  representing  the  preceding.  Although  the 
greater  number  of  them  are  insectivorous,  there  are  several  species 
which  seem  destined  to  subsist  on  the  blood  of  other  animals ; 
possessing  a  peculiar  arrangement  of  the  front  teeth  for  making 
the  incision ;  and  a  conformation  of  the  tongue,  which  specially 
adapts  it  for  suction.  This  is  the  case  with  the  genus  Desmodus, 
which  includes  the  True  Vampyres.  The  upper  jaw  is  furnished 

with  two  large  upper  incisors 
in  the  centre,  and  two  lancet- 
shaped  canines,  separated  from 
them  by  an  interval ;  all  these 
teeth  are  extremely  sharp- 
pointed.  In  the  lower  jaw 
there  are  four  smaller  incisors, 
with  a  space  in  the  centre  into 
which  the  upper  ones  pass 
when  the  jaw  closes;  the 
canines  also  are  smaller  than 
those  of  the  upper  jaw.  By  these  teeth,  a  deep  triple  puncture 
will  obviously  be  made.  The  molars  are  imperfectly  developed  ; 
and  seem  unfit  for  mastication  ;  and  the  intestine  is  shorter  than 
in  any  known  animal  of  its  size.  One  of  these  bats  was  taken 
by  Mr.  Darwin,  during  his  travels  in  South  America,  in  the  act 
of  sucking  blood  from  the  neck  of  a  horse ;  and  he  states  that 
the  injury  which  horses  sustain  from  their  attacks,  is  due,  not  so 
much  to  the  loss  of  blood,  as  to  the  inflammation  which  the  bite 
produces,  and  which  is  aggravated  by  the  pressure  of  the  saddle, 


FIG.  89. — TEETH  OF  DESMODUS. 


188  VAMPYRES. — FAMILY    VESPERTILIONID^E. 

if  this  be  put  on  too  soon.  The  species  to  which  the  name  of 
Vampyre  is  commonly  attached  (Fig.  87),  is  about  the  size  of  a 
Magpie,  its  wings  measuring  two  ;r  three  feet  across,  when  ex- 
panded ;  it  seems  to  have  similar  blood-thirsty  propensities  to 
those  just  described;  but  from  the  structure  of  its  teeth  it  may 
be  imagined  to  be  less  exclusive  in  its  tastes  than  the  preceding. 
Many  marvellous  stories  have  been  told  of  the  performances  of 
these  animals  ;  but  they  contain  much  fiction  mingled  with  some 
truth.  There  is  no  well-authenticated  instance  of  any  animal 
larger  than  a  fowl  ever  having  died  from  the  effect  of  their  bite ; 
although  their  attacks  are  so  frequent  that,  according  to  the  tes- 
timony of  some  travellers,  the  horses  and  mules  turned  out  to 
graze  at  the  end  of  a  day's  journey,  are  often  brought  in  by  the 
guides  in  the  morning  with  their  shoulders  and  haunches  covered 
with  blood  ;  nor  is  it  an  uncommon  thing  for  the  Varapyres  to 
enter  the  habitations  of  the  natives,  and  fasten  on  the  legs  of 
some  incautious  sleeper,  who  has  not  secured  his  feet  within  the 
coverlid.  But  "  nobody  fears  these  animals,  or  gives  himself 
any  trouble  about  them."  The  story  of  the  Vampyre  fanning 
its  victim  with  its  large  wings,  to  keep  him  cool,  and  render  his 
sleep  more  profound,  is  probably  a  fiction  of  the  imagination. — 
Other  species  of  this  family  inhabit  the  Eastern  Hemisphere,  and 
are  insectivorous  or  partly  frugivorous  (fruit-eating)  in  theirhabits. 
171.  To  the  third  Family,  VESPERTILIONHXE,  most  of  the 
Bats  of  temperate  climates  belong  ;  and  the  number  of  species 
of  these  is  very  numerous,  no  less  than  thirteen  being  natives  of 
Britain.  Of  these  one  of  the  largest  is  the  Fespertilio  noctula, 
the  Noctule,  or  Great  Bat,  which  measures  fifteen  inches  across  the 
wings;  this  is  gregarious  in  its  habits,  associating  in  considerable 
numbers  ;  and  seeks  its  retreat  sometimes  in  the  hollow  of  trees, 
at  others  under  the  roofs  and  eaves  of  houses.  The  Fespertilio 
murinus,  or  Mouse-coloured  Bat,  exceeds  the  preceding  by  about 
an  inch  in  the  expanse  of  its  wings  ;  it  is  very  common  in  many 
parts  of  the  Continent,  living  in  ancient  buildings,  the  towers  of 
churches,  &c.,  but  not  resorting  to  the  woods  ;  and  is  the  one 
usually  implied  by  continental  writers  as  the  Bat,  or  Common 
Bat ;  in  Britain,  however,  it  is  very  rare.  Although  gregarious 


FAMILY    VESPERTILIONIDjE. PIPISTRELLE.  189 

in  its  habits,  it  is  very  quarrelsome,  and  will  fight  desperately 
with  its  fellows. — The  Vespertilio  pipistrellus,  the  Flitter- Mouse 
of  some  country  people,  is  ordinarily  known  in  Britain  as  the 

CommonBat;  being, 
with  the  Long-eared 
Bat,  the  most  abun- 
dant of  the  tribe. 
This  species  has  a 
shorter  period  of 
torpidity  than  any 
other,  coming  forth 
from  its  winter  quar- 
ters as  early  as  the 
middle  of  March, 
and  not  permanently 
retiring  until  the 

FIG.  90 — COMMON  BAT.  .  ,      .  ,     ,, 

winter  has  decidedly 

set  in.  Its  food  consists  especially  of  gnats  and  other  dipter- 
ous (two-winged  insects)  and  as  long  as  these  are  to  be 
found,  the  Bat  seems  to  remain  in  activity, — coming  forth,  as 
the  season  advances,  during  the  daytime  rather  than  at  night, 
since  then  only  is  the  temperature  sufficiently  elevated  to  call 
forth  its  insect  prey.  The  Pipistrelle  frequents  the  haunts  of 
Man  more  than  any  other  species ;  its  usual  retreat  being  under 
the  roofs  of  houses,  and  in  the  nooks  or  crevices  of  buildings  of 
every  description, — as,  for  instance,  in  the  cracks  of  old  door- 
frames, or  behind  the  leaden  rain-pipes.  In  its  flight,  which  is 
quick  and  flitting,  it  particularly  frequents  the  neighbourhood  of 
rivers,  flying  about  the  trees  which  grow  on  the  banks,  or  over 
the  surface  of  water,  in  search  of  gnats  and  other  small  insects. 
It  will  readily  feed,  however,  on  meat ;  being  easily  supported 
on  this  diet  in  confinement ;  and  even  sometimes  finding  its  way 
into  larders,  and  making  a  hearty  meal  upon  the  joint  it  finds 
there. — The  Plecotus  auritus,  or  Long- eared  Bat,  is  remarkable, 
as  already  mentioned,  for  the  extraordinary  development  of 
its  external  ears ;  these  are  beautifully  transparent,  and  are  often 
thrown,  by  the  will  of  the  animal,  into  the  most  elegant  curves. 


190 


FAMILY    VESPERTILIONID.E. LONG-EARED    BAT. 


It  is  very  easily  tamed,  and  is  soon  brought  to  show  a  con- 
siderable degree  of  familiarity  with  those  who  feed  and  caress  it, 


H 


FIG.  91 — LONG-EARED  BAT. 


so  as  to  take  a  fly  from  the  hand,  or  even  from  between  the  lips. 

It  is  very  playful  in  confine- 
ment, when  placed  with  others 
of  its  own  species,  its  gambols 
being  very  amusing  ;  and  it  is 
very  cleanly  in  its  habits. 
The  ears  are  usually  folded 
under  the  arm  during  sleep 
and  hybernation;  and  its  ap- 
pearance is  so  remarkably 
altered  by  this  action,  that  it 
would  be  scarcely  supposed 
to  be  the  same  animal,  by 
a  person  who  had  not  wit- 
nessed the  change.  It  has  an 
acute  and  shrill,  but  not  a 
loud  cry  ;  but  when  disturbed, 
the  sound  becomes  more  pierc- 
ing. Its  retreat  is  nearly  the 

same  as  that  of  the  Common  Bat ;  and  in  some  parts  of  the 

country  it  is  the  more  abundant  of  the  two. 


FIG.   92. — LONG-EARED  BAT  IN  REPOSE. 


FAMILY    NOCTILIONID.E. NOCTtJLES. 


191 


172.     The  Bats  of  the  fourth   family,    NOCTILIONID.E,    are 
almost  exclusively  confined  to  tropical  countries,  where  a  large 


FIG.  93. — NOCTILIO. 


number  of  species  exist, — some  in  the  Eastern,  and  others  in 
the  Western  hemisphere.     Little  is  known,  however,  of  their 


FIG.  94.— DYSOPUS  CHEIROPUS. 

habits.     The  Noctilios,  or  Noctules,  of  South  America,  are,  com- 


192  FAMILIES    NOCTILIONID^    AND    PTEROPID.E. 

monly  known  as  Bull-dog  Bats,  on  account  of  their  short  thick 
muzzle,  which  is  cleft,  in  some  species,  by  a  furrow  similar  to  that 
in  the  lip  of  a  Hare.  The  tail  projects  beyond  the  membrane 
that  connects  the  hind-legs  ;  and  the  claws  of  the  hind-feet  are 
large  and  strong.  The  length  of  the  body  is  about  four  or  five 
inches  ;  and  the  spread  of  the  wings  at  least  a  foot  and  a  half. 
In  an  East  Indian  genus,  Dysopus,  or  Cheiromeles  (Fig.  94),  the 
wings  of  which  measure  nearly  two  feet  across,  the  hinder  thumb 
is  placed  at  a  distance  from  the  rest  of  the  toes,  and  is  capable 
of  being  opposed  to  them, — a  character  which  obviously  connects 
this  group  with  the  Quadrumana.  The  tail  is  here  short ;  and 
there  is  an  almost  entire  absence  of  the  membrane  connecting  the 
hind-legs. 

173.     The  Bats  of  the  frugivorous  section  have  molar  teeth 
with  rounded  eminences,  for  bruising  and  grinding  their  food ; 
and  the  complex  structure  of  their  stomach,  with  the  length  of 
the  intestinal  canal  (which  in  the  Pteropus  is  seven  times  that  of 
the  body),  also  indicate  that  they  are  destined  to  subsist,  in  part 
at  least,  upon  a  vegetable  diet.       Like  many  of  the  Monkeys, 
however,  they  are  probably   in  a  degree  omnivorous ;    feeding 
chiefly  upon  fruits,  but  pursuing  small  birds  or  large  soft -bodied 
insects  (such  as  moths),  which  may  be  obtained  without  much 
difficulty.     This  tribe  contains  but  one  family,  the  PTEROPID.E  ; 
which  is  characterised  by  the  entire  absence  of  the  nose -leaf,  the 
simplicity  of  the  ears,  the  shortness  of  the  tail,  and  the  absence 
(partial  or  entire)   of  the  membrane   stretching  between   the 
thighs.     The  Bats  of  this  family  are  widely  diffused  throughout 
the  tropical   regions   of  the   Old   World  ;  and   many   of  them 
exceed  in  size  any  others  of  the  order.     One  of  the  most  remark- 
able species  is  the  Pteropus  Javanicus,   or  Roussette  of  Java,  a 
Bat  with  a  fox-like  head,  the    expanse  of  whose  wings  is  no 
less  than  five  feet.     It  is  very  abundant  in  the  lower  parts  of 
the  island,    and  lives  in  troops,  which  do  not  appear  to  visit 
the  more  elevated   districts.      Numerous  individuals,  says  Dr. 
Horsfield,  select  a  large  tree  for  their  resort ;    and  suspending 
themselves   by   the   claws   of   their  hind-limbs  to   the   naked 
branches,  often  in  companies  of  several  hundreds,  afford  to  a 


FAMILY    PTEROPID.E. ROUSSETTE. 


193 


Fio.  95 — HEAD  OF  PTEROPUS. 


stranger  a  very  singular  aspect, — being  readily  mistaken  for  a 
part  of  the  tree,  or  for  a  fruit  of  uncommon  size  suspended  from 

its  branches.  In  ge- 
neral these  animals 
preserve  a  perfect  si- 
lence during  the  day  ; 
but  if  they  are  dis- 
turbed, or  a  contention 
arises  among  them, 
they  emit  sharp  pierc- 
ing shrieks:  and  their 
awkward  attempts  to 
extricate  themselves, 
when  oppressed  by  the 
light  of  the  sun,  ex- 
hibit a  ludicrous  spec- 
tacle. In  consequence 
of  the  sharpness  of 

their  claws,  their  attachment  is  so  strong,  that  they  cannot 
readily  leave  their  hold  without  the  assistance  of  the  expanded 
membrane ;  and  if  suddenly  killed  during  the  day,  they  con- 
tinue suspended  after  death.  Hence,  if  it  be  desired  to  obtain 
them  in  the  day-time,  it  is  necessary  to  cause  them  to  take  wing 
by  alarming  them.  Soon  after  sunset  they  successively  quit 
their  hold,  and  pursue  their  nocturnal  flight  in  quest  of  food. 
They  direct  their  course  by  an  unerring  instinct  to  the  forests, 
villages,  and  plantations,  attacking  fruit  of  every  kind,  and 
doing  a  vast  amount  of  mischief.  In  order  to  protect  valuable 
fruits  from  their  ravages,  the  natives  are  obliged  to  inclose  them 
in  nets  or  baskets.  There  are  few  situations  in  the  lower  parts 
of  Java  where  this  night- wanderer  is  not  constantly  observed  ; 
as  soon  as  the  light  of  the  sun  has  retired,  one  animal  is  seen  to 
follow  the  other  at  a  small  but  irregular  distance ;  and  this  suc- 
cession continues  uninterrupted,  till  darkness  obstructs  the  view. 
The  flight  of  this  Bat  (termed  by  the  natives,  the  Kalong) 
is  slow  and  steady,  pursued  in  a  straight  line,  and  capable  of 
long  continuance. — The  Harpyia  Pallasii  of  Timour,  is  a  sin- 


194 


HARPYIA. — ORDER   INSECTIVORA. 


gular  looking  Bat,  having  nostrils  projecting  in  a  kind  of  cylin- 
der, and  a  claw  on  the  fore-finger. — The  flesh  of  many  of  the 


Fm.  96.— HARPYJA  PALLASII. 


frugivorous  Bats  is  eaten  as  a  dainty  by  the  inhabitants  of  the 
countries  in  which  they  are  found ;  having  a  flavour  which  has 
been  compared  to  that  of  the  hare  and  partridge.  It  is  possible 
that  some  of  larger  species,  which  may  have  been  known  to  the 
ancients,  gave  rise  to  the  fabulous  account  of  the  Harpy. 


ORDER  IV.— INSECTIVORA. 

174.     Although,  as  we  have  already  seen,  a  large  proportion 

of  the  Bat  tribe,  as  well  as  many 
of  the  lower  Quadrumana,  are 
adapted  to  derive  their  chief  sup- 
port from  Insects,  and  have  their 
teeth  and  their  general  conforma- 
tion arranged  accordingly,  yet  it 
is  in  this  order  that  we  find 
FIG.  97.— TBETH  OF  INSECTIVOROUS  these  characters  developed  to 
their  fullest  extent.  Though 
the  animals  which  it  contains  differ  very  greatly  in  other  respects, 


ORDER    INSECTIVORA  J    GENERAL    CHARACTERS.  195 

yet  they  all  agree  in  having  the  teeth  raised  into  conical  and 
pointed  tubercles,  for  the  purpose  of  crushing  the  hard  envelopes 
of  their  insect  prey.  They  agree  also,  in  being  for  the  most  part 
nocturnal  animals  ;  and,  with  some  exceptions,  in  living  under- 
ground, or  at  least  in  exhibiting  a  tendency  to  such  a  mode  of 
life ;  and  all  those  which  inhabit  cold  countries  pass  the  winter 
in  a  state  of  torpidity.  They  are  timid  little  creatures;  and 
although  constantly  at  work  around  us,  and  in  a  manner  most 
important  to  our  welfare,  their  habits  are  so  unobtrusive  as  to 
escape  our  observation.  They  are  especially  appointed  to  check 
the  overwhelming  increase  of  the  worm  and  insect  tribe,  and 
especially  of  those  species  which  live  beneath  the  soil ;  the 
ravages  of  which,  if  not  thus  kept  within  bounds,  would  be 
speedily  destructive  to  man  and  beast,  by  preventing  the  growth 
of  those  vegetables  on  which  they  depend  for  food.  Their  general 
conformation  varies  according  to  their  mode  of  life  ;  but  they 
agree  in  the  possession  of  clavicles,  and  in  the  application  of  the 
sole  of  the  foot  to  the  ground  ;  and  their  limbs  are  generally 
short. — The  order  may  be  divided  into  four  families  ;  which 
are  characterized  by  their  habits,  as  well  as  by  their  external 
form  and  internal  structure.  1.  The  TALPID^E,  or  Mole  tribe, 
which  are  pre-eminently  subterranean,  and  are  distinguished  by 
their  extraordinary  habit  of  forming  long  complicated  burrows 
underground,  in  which  they  are  born,  and  in  which  they  pass 
their  whole  lives, — feeding,  hybernating,  breeding,  and  dying, 
in  these  subterranean  retreats.  2.  The  SORICIDJE,  or  Shrew 
tribe,  which  are  a  sort  of  carnivorous  mice  ;  these,  although 
they  do  not  actually  burrow,  retreat  during  the  winter,  and  for 
their  ordinary  repose,  into  holes ;  they  feed,  however,  on  the 
surface  and  in  the  water, — several  of  them  being  purely  aquatic, 
diving  with  facility  after  aquatic  insects,  and  remaining  a  long 
time  under  water  without  inconvenience.  3.  The  ERINACEADJS, 
or  Hedgehog  tribe,  contains  animals  which  do  not  burrow  or 
descend  into  deep  excavations ;  but  which  conceal  themselves 
during  hybernation  beneath  a  covering  of  leaves,  or  in  some 
superficial  hollow  ;  and  which  live  upon  food  that  they  find 
either  upon  or  near  the  surface.  These  are  further  characterised 

o  2 


196  FAMILY    TALPIDjE; MOLE. 

by  having  the  body  covered  with  spines,  instead  of  with  hair  ; 
and  by  being  for  the  most  part  capable  of  rolling  the  body 
into  a  ball,  so  as  to  present  nothing  but  spines  on  every  side, 
to  their  enemies.  4.  The  TUPAID.E,  or  Banxrings,  which 
live  n  trees,  and  climb  them  with  the  agility  of  a  Monkey 
or  a  Squirrel ;  these  are  evidently  allied  to  the  insectivorous 
Quadrumana. 

175.     Of  the  TALPID^E  we  may  take  the  common  Talpa,  or 
Mole,  of  this  country  for  an  example.     The  general  form  and 

aspect  of  this  ani- 
mal are  wellknown, 
and  the  remarkable 
conformation  of  its 
anteriorextremities, 
by  which  it  is  ena- 
bled to  dig  its 
extensive  subter- 

98.-COMMON  MOL«.  ranean  excavations, 

has     been     already 

noticed  (§  90).  It  here  only  remains,  therefore,  to  describe  certain 
other  peculiarities,  in  its  structure  and  habits,  which  are  of  great 
interest.  The  head  is  much  prolonged,  especially  the  muzzle, 
which  projects  far  beyond  the  jaws,  and  is  very  flexible,  serving 
to  seize  and  convey  food  to  the  mouth ;  it  is  furnished  with  a 
little  bone  at  its  extremity,  which  renders  it  a  very  efficient 
borer.  The  portion  of  the  bones  of  the  face  appropriated  to  the 
organ  of  smell  is  very  large  ;  and  that  sense  appears  to  be  very 
acute.  On  the  other  hand,  there  is  scarcely  any  hollow  for  the 
reception  of  the  eyes ;  which  organs  are  but  little  developed,  and 
do  not  receive  a  true  optic  nerve.  There  is  good  reason  to  be- 
lieve, however,  that  the  common  Mole  possesses  some  degree  of 
sight ;  although  the  Mole  of  Italy  and  Greece,  which  is  a  dif- 
ferent species,  is  completely  blind.  The  apparatus  of  hearing 
is  very  highly  developed  ;  so  that,  although  there  is  no  external 
ear,  the  sense  is  probably  very  acute.  Thus  the  deficiency  of 
sight, — which  could  very  seldom  be  of  use  to  an  animal  that 
rarely  shows  itself  above  the  surface  of  the  ground, — is  compen- 


FAMILY    TALPID.4E  ; MOLE.  197 

sated  by  the  high  development  of  the  senses  of  smell  and  hearing, 
which  are  much  more  adapted  to  communicate  information  to  it 
in  its  subterranean  abode.  The  body  of  the  Mole  is  nearly 
cylindrical  in  form,  and  is  thus  evidently  adapted  to  move  readily 
through  its  tunnels  ;  it  is  covered  with  a  very  soft  thick  fur, 
the  hairs  of  which  are  inserted  vertically  in  the  skin,  and  lie 
smoothly  in  every  direction,  so  as  not  to  offer  more  resistance  to 
the  backward  than  to  the  forward  movement  of  the  animal. 
The  form  of  the  anterior  limbs,  and  the  powerful  muscles  with 
which  they  are  furnished,  enable  the  animal  not  merely  to  dig 
through  the  soil,  cutting  through  the  roots,  &c.,  which  may  tra- 
verse it ;  but  also  to  throw  backwards  with  great  energy  the 
earth  which  has  been  removed  at  each  stroke.  The  hind  limbs 
are  small,  and  the  feet  feeble,  in  comparison  with  the  anterior ; 
but  they  serve  to  enable  the  animal  to  run  through  its  galleries 
with  great  rapidity.  The  food  of  the  Mole  consists  chiefly  of 
earth-worms  and  the  larvae  of  insects  ;  in  search  of  which 
it  makes  a  large  part  of  its  extensive  subterranean  excava- 
tions. But  it  is  not  confined  to  these ;  for  during  the  sum- 
mer months  it  not  unfrequently  leaves  its  runs  under  the  turf, 
and  wanders  during  the  night  upon  the  surface  (occasionally 
also  during  the  day),  in  quest  of  prey,  such  as  birds,  mice,  frogs, 
lizards,  snails,  &c. ;  and  during  these  nocturnal  excursions,  it  not 
unfrequently  falls  a  prey  to  the  Owl.  It  is  an  extremely  vora- 
cious animal,  taking  a  large  quantity  of  food  at  a  time,  and  so 
soon  requiring  more,  that  a  short  fast  proves  fatal.  Its  hunger 
amounts  to  rage ;  and  under  the  influence  of  this  passion,  it 
fastens  on  its  prey  with  intense  eagerness.  It  is  fierce  and  com- 
bative in  its  disposition  ;  and  will  attack  and  devour  its  fellows, 
if  confined  with  them,  without  a  due  supply  of  food.  The  very 
remarkable  excavations  made  by  the  Mole,  which  are  formed 
upon  a  regular  plan,  and  have  several  distinct  purposes,  will  be 
described  in  that  portion  of  the  Treatise,  which  will  be  parti- 
cularly appropriated  to  the  Habits  and  Instincts  of  Animals. 

176.  There  are  a  few  other  animals,  in  different  quarters  of 
the  globe,  which  correspond  with  the  Moles  in  general  structure 
and  habits,  but  which  differ  from  them  in  some  important  features. 


198  FAMILY    SORECIDJE. — SHREWS. 

Among  the  most  curious  are  the  Chrysochloris*  or  Cape  Mole, 
which  is  distinguished  by  the  splendid  colours  of  its  fur,  and  is 
the  only  known  Quadruped,  which  exhibits  anything  like  the 
metallic  lustre  that  adorns  numerous  birds,  fishes,  and  insects  : 
— and  the  Condylura,  a  Mole-like  animal  of  North  America, 
which  has  the  termination  of  the  nostrils  surrounded  by  mov- 
able cartilaginous  points,  that  radiate  like  a  star  when  expanded. 
The  use  of  this  curious  apparatus  is  unknown. 

177.  Of  the  family  SORECJOE,  the  common  Sorex,  or  Shrew, 
of  this  country  may  be  taken  as  the  type.  This  is  a  small  ani- 
mal, covered  with  a  velvetty  fur,  and  having  much  of  the  general 

form  and  aspect  of  the  mouse ;  in- 
deed it  is  commonly  known  by  the 
name  of  Shrew-mouse,  and  believed 
to  be  nearly  allied  to  that  little  ani- 
mal. The  Shrews  may  be  easily 
distinguished,  however,  by  their  long 
taper  movable  snout ;  their  eyes, 

no.  99.-SHREW.  too>   are   verF   minute>   and  almost 

hidden   in   the    surrounding   hairs  ; 

and  their  ears  are  small  and  close.  The  body  exhales  a 
musky  odour,  which  renders  them  distasteful  to  cats,  though 
these  will  readily  destroy  them  ;  but  it  does  not  seem  to  be 
disliked  by  weasels,  hawks,  and  owls,  which  destroy  these 
little  nocturnal  Insectivora  in  great  numbers.  They 
are  common  in  hedge-rows,  thickets,  gardens,  &c. ;  and  make 
long  superficial  burrows,  or  runs,  in  banks,  and  among  the 
roots  of  trees  or  brushwood  ;  the  female  makes  a  sort  of  nest 
of  soft  herbage,  with  an  aperture  at  the  side.  They  feed  upon 
worms,  insects,  &c. ;  after  which  they  grub  with  their  pointed 
snout,  turning  up  the  loose  soil,  or  making  their  way  through 
the  close  herbage  ;  and  they  show  much  of  the  voraciousness  and 
pugnacity  of  the  Mole.  Besides  the  common  Shrew,  two  other 
species,  the  Water  Shrew,  and  the  Oared  Shrew,  inhabit  this 
country ;  the  habits  of  both  are  aquatic,  as  their  names  import, 
— their  burrows  being  formed  in  the  banks  of  streams,  and  their 
food  consisting  of  aquatic  insects  and  larvae,  in  pursuit  of  which 


SHREWS. FAMILY    ERINACEAD^E,    OR    HEDGEHOGS.         199 

they  dive  with  great  facility.  The  feet  and  tail  are  so  formed 
as  to  strike  the  water  with  force  ;  the  fur  has  the  power  of  re- 
pelling water  (or  rather,  it  has  a  strong  adhesion  for  air,  which 
prevents  water  from  ever  coming  into  complete  contact  with  it, 
MECHAN.  PHILOS.  §  34),  so  that  it  is  never  wetted  ;  and  the 
orifices  of  the  ears  can  be  closed,  so  as  to  prevent  the  entrance 
of  water.  The  Desmans,  or  Musk-rats  (Fig.  58),  of  which  one 
species  inhabits  Russia,  and  another  the  Pyrenees,  agree  with  the 
Water  Shrews  in  their  general  habits,  but  differ  in  their  denti- 
tion. They  are  much  larger  animals,  the  head  and  body  mea- 
suring ten  inches,  and  the  tail  seven  ;  and  they  feed  on  leeches 
and  small  fishes,  whilst  they  become  in  their  turn  the  prey  of  the 
larger,  to  which  they  communicate  their  musky  odour.  Other 
Shrew-like  animals  are  found  in  different  parts  of  the  globe  ;  and 
one  of  these,  the  Canadian  Shrew-mole,  appears  to  be,  in  its 
general  conformation  and  habits,  a  complete  connecting  link  be- 
tween the  two  families  now  described. 

178.  Of  the  family  ERINACEAD^E  we  have  also  a  character- 
istic example,  in  the  common  Hedgehog,  or  Urchin,  of  this  country; 
an  animal  which  is  not  uncommon  in  woods,  copses,  hedgerows, 
&c.,  where  it  remains  rolled  up  in  its  retreat  during  the  day, 
coming  forth  on  the  approach  of  twilight,  and  continuing  on  the 
alert  until  morning.  The  power  of  doubling  up  the  body,  so  as 
to  conceal  the  head  and  feet,  and  to  present  nothing  but  a  ball, 
thickly  covered  with  spiny  points,  is  more  or  less  possessed  by  all 
the  animals  of  this  family ;  but  it  is  nowhere  so  striking  as  in  the 
common  Hedgehog,  which  possesses  a  peculiar  muscle  for  the 
purpose.  The  action  of  this  muscle  is  not  only  to  roll  up  the 
body,  but  to  set  up  and  fix  the  spines,  in  such  a  manner  that 
they  shall  radiate  from  the  ball.  "  Deprived  by  its  structure," 
says  Mr.  Bell  (British  Mammalia,  p.  76),  "  of  all  means  of 
attacking  its  enemies,  of  defending  itself  by  force,  or  of  seeking 
safety  in  flight,  this  harmless  animal  is  yet  endowed  with  a 
safeguard  more  secure  ajid  effectual  than  the  teeth  and  claws  of 
the  "Wild  Cat,  or  the  fleetness  of  the  Hare.  Its  close  covering 
of  sharp  spines, — which  are  hard  without  brittleness,  sufficiently 
elastic  to  bear  great  violence  without  breaking,  and  fixed  with 


200  FAMILY    ERINACEAD.E  ; — HEDGEHOGS. 

astonishing  firmness  in  the  tough,  leathery  skin, — forms  not  only 
a  solid  shield  to  protect  it  from  the  effect  of  blows  or  falls,  but 
a  shirt  of  prickly  mail  sufficiently  sharp  and  annoying  to  deter 
all  but  a  few  thorough-bred  Dogs,  or  a  half-starved  Fox,  from 
venturing  to  attack  it.  Immediately  that  it  is  touched,  or  that 
it  sees  any  danger  approaching,  it  rolls  itself  up  into  a  compact 
round  ball,  and  presents  this  impenetrable  panoply,  beset  by 
innumerable  spines  standing  out  in  every  direction  ;  and  the 
more  it  is  irritated  or  alarmed,  the  more  firmly  it  contracts,  and 
the  more  strongly  and  stiffly  the  spines  are  set.  The  strength 
and  elasticity  of  this  covering  is  such,  that  I  have  repeatedly 
seen  a  domesticated  Hedgehog  in  my  own  possession  run  towards 
the  precipitous  walls  of  an  area,  and,  without  hesitation,  without 
a  moment's  pause  of  preparation,  throw  itself  off, — contracting 
at  the  same  time  into  a  ball,  in  which  condition  it  reached  the 
ground  from  a  height  of  12  or  14  feet ;  after  a  few  moments  it 
would  unfold  itself  and  run  off  unhurt."  The  food  of  the  Hedge- 
hog in  its  natural  state  consists  of  insects,  slugs,  frogs,  toads, 
mice,  and  even  snakes,  which  last  it  destroys  with  great 
dexterity;  it  also  devours  eggs,  young  nestlings,  and  various 
kinds  of  vegetable  matter,  for  some  of  which  it  will  bore  with 
its  long  snout.  Its  fondness  for  insects  occasions  it  to  be  kept  in 
many  houses  in  London,  for  the  purpose  of  ridding  the  kitchens 
of  the  innumerable  hosts  of  cockroaches,  by  which  they  are 
infested.  It  is  easily  rendered  familiar,  but  does  not  manifest 
any  peculiar  degree  of  intelligence.  The  hybernation  of  the 
Hedgehog  is  very  complete ;  the  whole  winter  being  passed  by 
it  in  a  state  of  complete  torpidity.  It  makes  its  retreat  in  banks, 
under  the  hollow  roots  of  trees,  in  holes,  or  other  sheltered  and 
convenient  places,  constructing  a  sort  of  nest  or  bed  of  grasses, 
dried  leaves,  and  moss,  with  which  it  covers  itself  very  closely. 
—The  Tenrecs  of  Madagascar  and  the  Mauritius  closely  resemble 
the  Hedgehog  in  their  general  characters ;  but  differ  in  their 
dentition,  as  also  in  the  feebleness  of  their  spines,  and  in  the  less 
complete  power  of  rolling  themselves  into  a  ball.  Their  habits 
seem  to  resemble  those  of  the  common  Hedgehog ;  but  they  are 
active  only  when  the  temperature  is  extremely  high.  They 


FAMILY    TUPAID^E. ANALOGIES    TO    RODENTIA.  201 

exhale  a  strong  musky  odour.  The  Gymnurus  of  Sumatra 
appears  to  approach  the  Tenrecs  and  Hedgehogs  in  its  dentition, 
as  well  as  in  its  spiny  covering ;  but  it  has  the  long  scaly  tail, 
and  pointed  muzzle,  of  the  Shrews. 

179.  The  last  family,  that  of  TUPAIDJE,  at  present  contains 
only  one  genus,  the  Tupaia,  or  Banxrmg  ;  a  remarkable  animal, 
of  which  only  three   species  are  known  to  exist,  and  these  are 
inhabitants  of  Sumatra  and  Java.     They  differ  so  decidedly  in 
conformation  and  habits  from  the  other  Insectivora,  as  not  to  be 
capable  of  being  placed  in  any  of  the  preceding  families ;  and 
they  must,  therefore,  constitute  a  group  by  themselves.     Instead 
of  being  strictly  terrestrial  in  their  habits,  like  the  other  Insect- 
ivora, they  lead  the  life  of  Squirrels ;  and  have  all  the  spright- 
liness  and  activity,  together  with  much  of  the  general  appearance, 
of  those  animals.     They  are  covered  with  soft  and  glistening 
hair,  and  have  a  long,  bushy  tail ;  so  that,  if  it  were  not  for  their 
long,  pointed  snout,  they  could  not  be  easily  distinguished  at  a 
distance  from  Squirrels.      Their  habits  are  diurnal ;  and  they 
feed  on  fruits  and  Insects. 

180.  We  can  scarcely  take  even  a  cursory  view,  like  the 
present,  of  the  different  forms  contained  in  the  order  Insectivora, 
without  perceiving  that  it  offers  many  striking  analogies  to  the 
Rodentia, — far  distant  as  that  order  undoubtedly  is.  The  analogy 
between  the  Shrews  and  the  Mice,  the  Water  Shrews  and  the 
Water  Rats  or  Voles,  the  Hedgehogs  and  the  Porcupines,  and 
the  Banxrings  and  the  Squirrels,  is  very  obvious ;  and  it  may 
not  be  altogether  so  far-fetched  a  comparison  as  it  appears  at  first 
sight,  to  compare  the  Mole  and  the  Beaver, — both  being  distin- 
guished above  all  the  rest  of  their  respective  orders  for  their 
instinctive  propensities, — these  propensities  being  directed  towards 
the  construction  of  their  habitations, — and  the  whole  conforma- 
tion of  each  being  modified  in  accordance  with  its  particular 
object ;  the  dwelling  of  the  Mole  being  excavated  beneath  the 
surface  of  the  ground,  and  that  of  the  Beaver  being  erected  above 
it.     Altogether  it  may  be  afiirmed  that  the  Insectivora  hold  a 
rank  in  the  Carnivorous  division  of  the  Mammalia,  analogous  to 
that  which  the  Rodentia  take  in  the  Herbivorous.     Both  would 


202       ORDER  CARNIVORA  ;  GENERAL  CHARACTERS. 

seem  to  rank  lower  than  any  of  the  groups  to  which  they  bear 
the  nearest  relationship,  in  regard  to  their  intelligence ;  and,  in 
the  economy  of  both,  Cybernation  is  a  leading  feature. 


ORDER  V.— CARNIYORA. 

181.  This  group  includes  all  the  unguiculated  Mammalia, 
which  show,  in  the  structure  of  their  teeth  and  digestive  appa- 
ratus, and  in  their  general  conformation,  an  adaptation  to  a  diet 
consisting  of  animal  flesh.  We  have  seen  that,  in  many  tribes 
which  have  already  come  under  our  notice,  there  is  a  power  of 
subsisting  in  part,  or  even  entirely,  upon  food  of  this  kind ; 
such  is  the  case,  for  instance,  with  Man,  and  several  of  the 
Monkey  tribe.  But  all  these  animals  are  also  capable  of  digesting, 
and  of  subsisting  on,  food  of  a  vegetable  nature  also;  and  where 
the  diet  is  exclusively  animal,  as  in  a  large  proportion  of  the 
Bats,  and  in  the  Insectivora,  it  consists  of  Insects,  Worms,  &c., 
and  not  of  the  flesh  of  larger  animals,  on  which  the  true  Car- 
nivora,  in  a  state  of  nature,  depend  entirely  (with  few  excep- 
tions), for  their  support.  The  members  of  this  order  are  readily 
distinguished  from  all  others,  by  the  character  of  their  teeth  ; 
•which  are  formed  for  seizing,  cutting,  and  tearing  animal  flesh. 
In  the  greater  number  of  them,  the  size  of  the  canine  teeth  is  the 
most  obvious  mark  of  distinction ;  these  are  large,  strong,  and 

pointed,  and  project  somewhat 
forwards,  so  as  to  present  them- 
selves rather  in  front  of  the  line 
of  the  other  teeth.  Between  the 
canines  of  the  two  sides,  are  six 
incisor  teeth  in  each  jaw;  these 
are  of  moderate  size,  but  are  pro- 
vided with  sharp  cutting  edges. 
The  molar  teeth,  situated  behind 
FIG.  loo.— TEETH  OF  CARNIVOROUS  the  canines,  are  usually  from  four 

to  seven  in  number ;  they  are  of 
three  different  kinds; — those  which  immediately  follow  the  canines 


ORDER    CARNIVORA  ',    GENERAL    CHARACTERS.  203 

(occupying  the  same  position  with  the  bicuspid  teeth  of  Man, 
ANIM.  PHYSIOL.,  Fig.  92),  being  more  or  less  pointed,  and 
termed  false  molars ;— the  next  being  especially  adapted  for 
dividing  animal  flesh,  by  the  form  of  its  summit,  which  is  raised 
into  a  cutting  edge,  and  termed  carnivorous  teeth  ; — and  the  last, 
or  hindmost,  having  summits  more  or  less  rounded  or  tulerculated. 

182.  The  proportion  which  these  different  classes  of  molar 
teeth  bear  to  each  other  in  degree  and  development,  accords  with 
the   relative   carnivorous   propensity  of  the  different   families. 
Thus,  in  the  Cat  tribe,  which  in  a  state  of  nature  is  exclusively 
carnivorous,  the  tuberculated  molars  are  entirely  wanting  in  the 
lower  jaw,  and  are  very  small  in  the  upper ;  whilst  the  carni- 
vorous  molars  are   of  very   large   size,  and   the   false   molars 
partake  of  their  form.     On  the  other  hand,  in  the  Bears,  which 
are   adapted  to  derive  a  great  part  of  their  subsistence  from 
vegetable  food,  there  are  three  large  tuberculated  molars  on  each 
side  of  each  jaw  ;  and  the  size  and  sharpness  of  the  carnivorous 
tooth  are  not  nearly  as  remarkable  as  in  the  preceding  group. 
And  in  the  Dog  tribe,   which  is  intermediate  in  this  respect 
between  the  two  extremes,  there  are  two  tuberculous  grinders 
behind  each  carnivorous  tooth ;  and  this  tooth  is  itself  partly 
tuberculated, — that  is,  a  portion  of  its  sharp  cutting  edge  is 
superseded  by  a  rounded  summit.     We   find  the   alimentary 
canal  formed  in  accordance  with  the  character  of  the  teeth ;  for, 
the  nature  of  the  food  being  such  that  it  is  easily  reduced  to  a 
fluid  form  by  the  process  of  digestion,  and  the  whole  of  the 
nutritious  matter  being  easily  removed  from  it,  a  long,  compli- 
cated intestinal  tube  would  have  been  superfluous  ;  and  instead 
of  its  length  being  thirty  times  that  of  the  body  (as  in  many 
herbivorous  animals),  it  is  no  more  than  three  times  as  long  as 
the  body  in  the  Cat  tribe,  though  of  greater  length  in  the  less 
carnivorous  species.  The  stomach,  too,  is  very  simple  in  its  form, 
and  is  of  small  size  in  comparison  to  the  bulk  of  the  animal ;  for 
the  facility  with  which  the  food  is  digested,  allows  it  to  pass 
rapidly  through  that  organ,  instead  of  its  being  long  delayed 
there,  as  it  is  in  the  capacious  paunch  of  the  Ruminantia. 

183.  The  whole  conformation  of  these  animals  is  evidently 


204     ORDER  CARNIVORA;  GENERAL  CHARACTERS. 

adapted  to  the  same  purposes.  We  do  not  find  such  differences 
in  the  structure  of  the  anterior  and  posterior  limbs,  as  we  have 
seen  in  Man,  the  Bats,  and  the  Mole ;  all  of  them  are  equally 
adapted  for  supporting  the  body  on  the  ground,  and  for  enabling 
it  to  execute  rapid  and  energetic  movements  upon  the  surface  of 
the  earth,  as  in  running,  leaping,  &c.  The  only  exceptions  to 
this  principle  are  among  the  aquatic  species,  such  as  the  Otter 
and  Seal,  in  which  we  find  an  adaptation,  more  or  less  complete, 
for  residence  in  the  water ;  and  the  comparatively  sluggish 
Bears,  a  large  part  of  whose  life  is  passed  among  trees.  The 
muscular  energy  of  the  Carnivora  is  very  great ;  their  respiration 
and  circulation  very  active ;  and  the  demand  for  food,  therefore, 
(on  the  principles  elsewhere  stated,  ANIM.  PHYSIOL.,  §  140),  is 
very  constant.  The  rapid  movement  which  they  require  for 
pursuing  a  living  prey  is  provided  for  in  the  structure  of  their 
limbs,  which  are  usually  long,  and  moved  by  powerful  muscles. 
As  these  limbs  have  but  little  variety  of  movement  (their  action 
in  running  and  leaping  being  simply  backwards  and  forwards), 
a  clavicle  is  but  little  required  ;  and  this  bone  is  usually  very 
small,  not  uniting  the  shoulder  to  the  breast-bone,  and  is  some- 
times almost  entirely  deficient.  In  the  Bears,  however,  whose 
fore-limbs  must  be  kept  more  apart,  for  the  purpose  of  climbing, 
and  must  be  provided  with  strong  muscles  to  draw  them 
together,  we  find  a  more  complete  clavicle  than  in  most  others 
of  the  order.  The  two  bones  of  the  fore-arm  still  remain  distinct, 
and  are  capable  of  being  in  some  degree  rotated,  one  on  the  other, 
as  in  Man. 

184.  In  regard  to  the  arrangement  of  the  bones  of  the  hands 
and  feet,  we  find  a  marked  variation  in  different  species.  In  the 
most  active,  and  especially  in  those  which  have  the  greatest 
powers  of  leaping,  these  bones  are  so  connected  with  those  above, 
as  to  form  nearly  a  continuous  line  with  them  ;  and  the  animal 
rests  upon  the  points  only  of  the  toes.  But  in  others,  the  hands 
and  feet  are  so  united  with  the  limbs  above,  that  the  animal 
bears  upon  its  palms  and  soles,  thus  acquiring  a  firmer  footing, 
but  losing  in  activity.  The  animals  which  have  the  former  con- 
formation are  said  to  be  digiiigrade  ;  those  possessing  the  latter 


ORDER  CARNIVORA  J  GENERAL  CHARACTERS. 


205 


to  be  plantigrade.  The  Cats  are  an  example  of  the  first ;  the 
Bears  of  the  second.  The  conformation  of  the  extremities  in  the 
Seals  offers  a  third  variety  ;  for  their  bones  are  flattened  and 
shortened,  but  spread  out  from  one  another,  so  as  to  give  support 
to  the  fin- like  expansion  of  the  skin,  that  envelopes  and  connects 
them  nearly  to  their  extremities.  In  all  instances  the  phalan- 

geal  bones  are  terminated  by 
claws,  which  are  both  strong 
and  sharp,  and  are  usually 
curved.  This  is  especially 
the  case  in  the  Cat  tribe; 
in  which  there  is  also  a  very 
remarkable  provision  for  en- 
abling the  animal  to  project 
them  only  when  they  are 
required,  keeping  them  drawn 
in  at  other  times.  The  last 
phalangeal  bone,  to  which 
the  claw  is  attached,  has  a 
rotatory  movement  upon  the 
preceding  one ;  this  move- 
ment  is  effected  in  one  direc- 
tion by  a  powerful  muscle, 
which  draws  the  bone  down- 
wards and  causes  the  claw  to  project ;  whilst  there  is  a  ligament 
composed  of  elastic  fibrous  tissue  (  ANIM.  PHYSIOL.,  §  29),  which 
draws  the  bone  in  the  other  direction,  and  retracts  the  claw 
within  a  kind  of  sheath.  When  the  animal  is  walking,  running, 
or  leaping,  the  claws  are  thus  drawn  in,  without  any  exertion  on 
the  part  of  the  animal,  by  the  simple  elasticity  of  the  ligament ; 
and  they  are  thus  secured,  either  from  receiving  injury  by  wear 
against  the  ground,  or  from  impeding  the  movements  of  the 
animal  by  becoming  entangled  in  the  inequalities  of  its  surface, 
or  in  the  vegetation  that  covers  it.  In  this  state  of  the  claws 
the  animal  bears  upon  a  number  of  soft  cushions,  one  beneath 
each  toe ;  which  enable  it  to  steal  with  noiseless  steps  upon  its 
prey,  and  thus,  by  surprising  them,  to  vanquish  animals  whose 


Fio.  101. — LKO  AND  CLAW  OF  LION. 


206  DIVISION    OF   CARNIVORA    INTO    FAMILIES. 

size  would  make  their  resistance  formidable,  or  whose  swiftness 
would  give  them  a  good  chance  of  escape  from  direct  pursuit. 
But  when  they  have  made  their  spring,  the  claws  are  caused  to 
project,  by  the  action  of  the  muscle  just  mentioned ;  and  they 
are  then  used  to  seize  and  tear  their  prey,  for  which  purposes 
their  strength,  sharpness,  and  curved  form  render  them  very 
efficient.  The  movement  here  described  may  be  readily  observed 
by  every  one,  in  the  foot  of  the  Domestic  Cat. 

1 85.  The  division  of  this  order  into  families  is  chiefly  based  upon 
the  conformation  of  the  teeth  and  extremities,  which  here  afford 
very  constant  and  distinct  characters,  and  are  closely  connected  with 
the  general  structure  and  habits  of  the  animals.  1 .  FELIDJE,  or 
Cat  tribe  ;  this  is  evidently  the  typical  family  of  the  order,  being 
the  one  in  which  the  carnivorous  propensity  is  most  strongly 
manifested,  and  in  which  the  instruments  of  destruction  are  most 
completely  adapted  for  its  exercise.  The  family  is  characterised  by 
the  short  powerful  jaws,  the  digitigrade  extremities,  the  retractile 
claws,  and  the  peculiar  adaptation  of  the  teeth  for  cutting.  The 
dentition  is  as  follows ;  incisors  -|,  canines  ^,  false  molars  |j|, 
carnivorous  molars  J^,  tuberculated  molars  ~.  The  canines  are 
of  great  size  and  strength ;  the  molars  have  sharp  edges,  the  car- 
nivorous tooth  is  very  large  and  sharp,  the  tuberculated  molar 
behind  it  very  small  in  the  upper  jaw,  and  not  at  all  developed 
in  the  lower.  2.  MUSTELID^E,  or  Weasel  tribe  ;  these  are  dis- 
tinguished by  their  long  narrow  bodies,  and  by  their  propensity 
to  suck  blood,  rather  than  to  devour  flesh ;  they  are  mostly 
semi-plantigrade,  a  portion  of  the  sole  touching  the  ground,  espe- 
cially in  the  hind  feet ;  and  their  dentition  is  as  follows  ;  incisors 
£j|,  canines  |^,  false  molars  |^,  carnivorous  tooth  ^,  tubercular 
molar  (small)  £J.  Thus  we  see  that  they  approach  the  Felidse 
in  their  dentition,  as  they  do  in  their  sanguinary  habits.  3.  The 
CANID^:,  or  Dog  tribe;  the  animals  of  this  family  are  digitigrade, 
like  the  Cats,  but  their  claws  are  not  retractile  ;  their  carnivor- 
ous propensity  is  not  so  strong  ;  the  jaws  are  more  elongated ; 
and  the  dentition  is  as  follows  ;  incisors  -f ,  canines  i^,  false 
molars  — ,  carnivorous  molars  ^,  tuberculated  molars  |— . 


DIVISION    OF    CARNIVORA    INTO    FAMILIES. FELIDJE.       207 

4.  VIVERRID^E,  or  Civet  tribe ;  this  family  is  closely  connected 
with  all  the  preceding,  and  also  with  the  Ursidas ;  and  it  does  not 
possess  any  well-marked  distinguishing  characters ;  nevertheless 
we  shall  see  that  the  animals  it  contains  bear  a  strong  general 
resemblance  to  each  other.  The  body  is  somewhat  elongated;  the 
claws  partly  retractile  ;  the  feet,  in  some  digitigrade,  in  some 
semi-plantigrade  ;  their  habits  are  nocturnal ;  and  many  (espe- 
cially the  types  of  the  family)  are  remarkable  for  their  strong 
musky  odour.  The  dentition  is  variable  ;  in  the  true  Civets  it 
is  as  follows ;  incisors  -|,  canines  ~,  false  molars  ^,  carnivorous 
tooth  |=|,  tuberculated  molars  |^.  5.  URSID^E,  or  Bear  tribe  ; 
the  animals  of  this  family  are  characterised  by  their  robust 
figure,  heavy  gait,  and  plantigrade  walk  ;  as  well  as  by  the 
adaptation  of  their  teeth  to  a  partly  vegetable  diet.  The  incis- 
ors are  f,  and  the  canines  J^T,  as  usual  (the  latter,  however, 
being  small)  ;  the  molars  are  usually  ^,  the  three  hindmost  of 
which  are  tuberculated,  the  carnivorous  tooth  of  small  size  and 
not  possessing  its  characteristic  form,  and  the  false  molars  very 
small,  often  dropping  out  at  an  early  age.  6.  PHOCIDJE,  or 
Seal  tribe ;  these  are  at  once  distinguished  by  the  adaptation  of 
their  form  to  residence  in  the  water,  the  body  being  elongated 
and  tapering  from  the  chest  to  the  tail,  the  hinder  limbs  being 
directed  backwards,  so  as  to  terminate  the  body,  and  the  extre- 
mities being  converted  into  paddles.  The  dentition  is  variable 
in  the  different  genera,  but  it  differs  completely  from  that  of  the 
other  Carnivora  ;  the  teeth  are  especially  formed  for  laying  hold 
of  the  slippery  prey  on  which  these  animals  feed,  and  for  divi- 
ding the  body  of  the  fish  they  devour  into  large  portions. 

186.  The  FELIDM  are  all  essentially  carnivorous  ;  in  no  in- 
stance touching  vegetable  food,  except  under  the  influence  of 
domestication,  and  even  then  only  in  small  quantity.  They  will 
not,  unless  pressed  by  hunger,  devour  any  flesh  which  they  have 
not  themselves  killed ;  and  altogether  reject  that  which  is  un- 
dergoing decomposition.  They  are,  consequently,  of  all  Mam- 
malia, the  most  destructive  in  their  propensities ;  and  their 
bodily  powers  are  in  admirable  accordance  with  their  instincts. 
Their  frame  is  vigorous,  but  agile, — the  limbs  short, — the  joints 


208  FAMILY    FELID.E,    OR    CAT    TRIBE. 

well-knit,  but  supple, — and  every  motion,  is  easy,  free,  and 
graceful.  There  is  no  superfluous  flesh  ;  but  the  whole  seems 
composed  of  bone,  nerve,  muscle,  and  sinew.  They  are  sur- 
passed in  fleetness  by  many  of  the  animals  on  which  they  prey, 
— these  being  provided  with  longer  limbs ;  but  none  of  these 
approach  them  in  the  power  of  leaping  and  bounding.  Their 
footfall  is  rendered  noiseless,  by  the  pads  with  which  the  under 
surface  is  provided.  Their  senses  are  for  the  most  part  very 
acute.  Their  sight  is  adapted  for  vision  by  night  as  well  as  by 
day;  the  sense  of  hearing  is  exquisite;  that  of  smell  also  is 
in  great  perfection,  though  in  this  particular  they  are  surpassed 
by  the  Canidse  ;  and  the  long  whiskers  are  most  acute  organs  of 
touch,  which  must  be  of  the  greatest  value  when  the  animal  is 
stealing  upon  its  prey  at  night,  through  a  thicket  or  jungle. 
The  tongue  is  furnished  with  rough  horny  papillse,  directed  back- 
wards ;  these  serve  a  very  important  purpose  in  enabling  the 
animal  to  scrape  off  the  minute  particles  of  flesh  adherent  to  the 
bones  of  its  prey.  In  the  moderate  degree  in  which  this  pecu- 
liar conformation  exists  in  the  tongue  of  the  common  Cat,  it  is 
familiar  to  every  one ;  in  the  Lion  and  Tiger,  however,  the 
roughness  is  so  great,  that  one  stroke  of  the  tongue  would  lick 
off  the  skin  from  a  man's  hand.  As  already  stated  (§  15),  the 
different  species  of  this  family  for  the  most  part  bear  a  very  close 
resemblance  to  one  another,  in  general  conformation,  though 
differing  widely  in  size  ;  and  it  is  chiefly  by  their  variation  in 
this  last  respect,  that  their  habits  are  guided.  Thus  the  Lion, 
and  Tiger,  the  largest  of  the  Felines,  are  confined  to  the  ground ; 
the  Leopard,  Panther,  and  various  species  of  Tiger-Cats  some- 
times spring  upon  their  prey  from  the  branches  of  trees,  some- 
times from  the  ground ;  whilst  the  Wild  Cats  are  almost 
exclusively  arboreal,  seeking  their  food  amongst  trees,  and  com- 
paratively seldom  frequenting  the  ground.  Most  of  the  Felidse 
may  be  tamed,  if  early  brought  under  the  influence  of  Man  ; 
and  they  show  considerable  intelligence  when  domesticated. 
They  are  for  the  most  part  liable,  however,  to  occasional  out- 
breaks of  ferocity,  which  show  that  their  natural  instincts  are 


FAMILY   FELIDJS  ; — LION.  209 

repressed  rather  than  subdued  ;  and  too  much  confidence,  there- 
fore, should  not  be  placed  in  them. 

187.  Some  species  of  this  family  are  found  in  every  quarter 
of  the  globe  except  Australia,  where  they  are  replaced  by  carni- 
vorous Marsupials  ;  it  is  of  tropical  climates  alone,  however,  that 
the  largest  are  inhabitants.  The  Lion  is  at  present  restricted  to 
the  interior  wilds  of  Africa,  to  some  of  the  districts  of  Arabia 
and  Persia,  to  the  country  bordering  the  Euphrates,  and  to  some 
parts  of  India.  It  is  more  disposed  to  exhibit  varieties,  than 
most  other  species  of  the  family,  except  the  Domestic  Cat.  Thus 
the  Barbary  breed,  the  Senegal  breed,  the  Cape  breed,  the  Ben- 
gal breed,  and  the  Persian  or  Arabian  breeds,  all  present  slight 
differences  from  each  other,  in  the  development  of  the  mane,  and 
the  colour  of  the  fur ;  and  a  nearly  maneless  breed  has  lately 
been  described  as  occurring  in  Guzerat;  yet  they  all  unques- 
tionably belong  to  the  same  species.  The  Lion,  too,  is  more 
easily  domesticated  than  the  Tiger ;  and  shows  a  degree  of  gene- 
rosity and  nobleness  of  temper,  which  more  approaches  that  of 
the  Dog.  The  common  appellation, — "  king  of  the  forest" — is 
misapplied  to  the  Lion  ;  for  he  frequents,  not  forests,  but  burning 
desert  plains,  and  wide  karroos  covered  only  with  shrubby  vege- 
tation, or  interspersed  with  tracts  of  low  brushwood.  During 
the  day  he  usually  slumbers  in  his  retreat ;  and  as  night  sets  in, 
he  rouses  from  his  lair  and  begins  his  prowl.  The  nocturnal 
tempests  of  rain  and  lightning,  which  in  Southern  Africa  are 
of  common  occurrence,  seem  to  be  peculiarly  congenial  to  him, 
and  excite  him  to  increased  activity.  His  voice  then  mingles 
with  the  roar  of  the  thunder,  and  adds  to  the  confusion  and 
terror  of  the  beasts  on  which  he  preys,  and  upon  which  he  now 
advances  with  less  caution  and  with  a  bolder  step.  In  general, 
however,  he  waits  in  ambush,  or  creeps  insidiously  towards  his 
victim  ;  and  then  springs  on  it  with  a  tremendous  bound,  and 
terrific  roar.  Various  extraordinary  stories  are  related,  of  the 
degree  in  which  the  eye  of  Man,  steadily  fixed  upon  a  Lion,  can 
keep  him  at  bay  ;  yet  this  is  no  proof  of  want  of  courage  ;  on 
the  contrary,  the  Lion,  when  attacked,  displays  the  utmost 
daring  resolution.  His  strength  is  such,  as  to  enable  him  to  carry 


210    FAMILY  FELIDJB; — TIGER,  LEOPARD,  AND  PANTHER. 

off  a  large  heifer  or  antelope,  as  easily  as  a  cat  carries  off  a  rat. 
The  muscles  which  raise  the  jaw  are  of  enormous  size  ;  and  those 
which  support  the  head,  as  well  as  the  ligamentum  nuchce  which 
runs  along  the  spinous  processes  of  the  vertebrae  to  the  occiput 
(ANIM.  PHYSIOL.,  §  29),  are  very  highly  developed. 

188.  The  Tiger  must  be  regarded  as  the  typical  species  of 
the  family ;  presenting,  as  it  does,  all  the  peculiarities  of  the 
group,  most  strongly  marked.  It  is  exclusively  confined  to  the 
south-east  of  Asia,  and  to  the  larger  islands  of  the  Asiatic 
Archipelago ;  where  its  ravages  are  often  terrific.  It  is  equal 
in  size  to  the  Lion,  but  of  a  more  elongated  form,  and  is  pre- 
eminently graceful  in  its  movements ;  the  head,  also,  is  shorter 
and  more  rounded.  Its  body  and  tail  are  marked  by  bands  of  a 
dark  colour ;  and  these  are  much  more  constant  (although  the 
particular  shade  varies)  than  the  mane  and  other  peculiarities  of 
the  Lion.  The  presence  of  dark  bands  or  patches  on  a  tawny 
ground,  may  be  regarded  as  very  characteristic  of  the  Felidas  in 
general ;  and  this  is  another  point  in  which  there  is  a  deficiency 


FIG.  101. — PANTHKR, 


in  the  Lion. — The  Leopard  and  Panther,  between  which  it  is  not 
easy  to  distinguish,  are  more  widely  spread  through  the  tropical 


I 


LEOPARD,    PANTHER,    AND    CHEETAH. 


211 


portions  of  the  Old  "World  ;  being  natives  of  Africa,  India,  and 
the  Indian  islands,  as  Ceylon,  Sumatra,  &c.  They  are  very 
graceful  and  active  animals ;  possessing  bodies  of  great  flexibility; 
and  being  able  to  bound,  swim,  climb  trees,  or  crawl  like  a  snake 
upon  the  ground,  with  nearly  equal  facility.  They  generally 
take  refuge  in  trees  when  pursued  ;  and  occasionally  spring  upon 
their  prey  from  its  branches.  The  Monkeys  and  other  small 
arboreal  animals,  as  well  as  the  terrestrial  quadrupeds,  fall  a 
prey  to  them. — Several  other  species  of  Felines  inhabit  the  East; 
but  of  these  we  shall  only  mention  the  Cheetah  or  Hunting 
Leopard  (Felis  jubata)  ;  which  departs,  in  many  particulars,  from 


Fto.  102 — HUNTING  LROPARD. 

the  general  characters  of  the  family.  The  foot,  instead  of  being 
rounded,  is  long  and  narrow  ;  its  claws  are  but  slightly  retractile  ; 
and  the  body  and  limbs  are  longer  and  narrower  than  in  the 
Leopard,  with  which  it  corresponds  in  size.  This  animal  is  a 
native  of  Africa  and  India  ;  and  in  the  latter  country  it  has  been 
long  employed  in  hunting  Deer,  Antelopes,  &c.  In  captivity, 

p  2 


212  FAMILY    FELID^J  ; — PUMA,    JAGUAR. 

it  is  familiar,  gentle,  and  playful ;  and  becomes  greatly  attached 
to  those  who  feed  or  notice  it.  When  carried  out  to  the  field,  it 
is  blinded  ;  and  the  hood  is  taken  off  when  a  Deer  or  Antelope 
separates  itself  from  the  herd.  The  Cheetah  then  crouches  until 
it  approaches  its  prey,  and  then  bounds  on  it  by  a  few  vigorous 
springs.  When  once  it  has  tasted  the  blood  of  its  victim,  its 
original  nature  breaks  out,  and  it  can  with  difficulty  be  drawn 
away  by  its  keeper. 

189.  These  animals  are  represented  in  America  by  the  Puma, 
Jaguar,  and  other  species.  The  Puma  has  been  commonly 
termed  the  American  lion,  on  account  of  its  uniformity  of  colour, 
which  is  a  silvery-fawn  ;  in  its  young  state  it  is  marked  with 
blackish-brown  streaks,  but  these  disappear  with  the  advance 
of  age.  Though  the  largest  of  the  American  Felines,  it  by  no 
means  equals  the  Lion  in  size  and  strength.  It  is  extensively 
diffused  through  North  and  South  America  ;  but  it  is  more  scarce 
than  formerly,  and  its  range  is  more  contracted  ;  and  as  civilisa- 
tion advances,  it  will  be  still  further  reduced.  The  Puma  is 
very  destructive  to  the  native  animals  and  cattle  in  its  vicinity, 


FIG.  103. — JAGUAR. 


but  it  seldom  attacks  man.  The  Jaguar  may  be  regarded  as  the 
Panther  of  America ;  but  it  is  even  more  powerful,  and  almost 
rivals  the  Tiger  of  the  Indian  jungles.  It  swims  and  climbs 


FAMILY    PELID^:; OCELOT,    WILD    CAT.  213 

with  equal  ease  ;  and  preys  not  only  on  the  larger  domestic 
quadrupeds,  and  on  the  wild  mammals,  but  also  on  birds,  fish, 
and  tortoises,  and  on  the  eggs  of  the  turtle.  It  will  not  attack 
Man,  however,  unless  hard  pressed.  —  Several  Tiger-Cats  inhabit 
South  America ;  of  which  the  Ocelot  is  among  the  most  beau- 
tiful. It  is  often  exhibited  in  menageries,  and  is  good-tempered 
and  playful  if  kindly  used.  It  inhabits  the  deep  forests,  living 
chiefly  in  trees,  and  preying  upon  small  quadrupeds  or  birds,  for 
which  it  lies  in  wait,  concealed  under  the  foliage. 

190.     The  Wild  Cat  is  the  only  species  of  this  family  that  can 


FIG.  104.— WILD  CAT. 


be  properly  said  to  belong  to  our  own  country, — the  Domestic 
Cat  having  been  probably  introduced  at  a  very  remote 
period.  In  earlier  times,  when  woods  and  forests  covered  many 
parts  of  the  kingdom  which  are  now  reclaimed  and  devoted  to 
agriculture,  the  Wild  Cat  was  much  more  generally  distributed  ; 
but  it  is  now  confined  to  Scotland,  some  of  the  woods  in  the 
North  of  England,  the  woody  mountains  of  Wales,  and  some 
parts  of  Ireland.  Their  favourite  places  of  resort  are  the  most 
inaccessible  mountainous  woods ;  where  they  retreat  not  only  to 
hollow  trees,  or  the  depth  of  thickets,  but  to  concealed  fissures 
of  rocks,  in  which  they  seek  their  safety  and  repose,  and  bring 
forth  and  rear  their  young.  Hares,  leverets,  rabbits  and  birds 


214 


FAMILY  FELID.E; — DOMESTIC  CAT,  LYNX. 


are  its  chief  prey.  The  Wild  Cat  is  found  throughout  all  those 
countries  of  Europe,  in  which  extensive  forests  exist ;  especially 
in  Germany,  and  in  the  wooded  portions  of  Russia,  Hungary, 
and  Northern  Asia.  It  was  at  one  time  supposed,  that  the 
Domestic  Cat  is  a  descendant  of  this  wild  species;  but  the 
points  of  difference  between  them  are  such,  as  to  render  this  idea 
very  improbable ;  especially  as  the  specimens,  not  unfrequently 
to  be  met  with,  of  Domestic  Cats  which  have  gone  back  to  their 
original  wild  life  in  the  woods,  do  not  exhibit  any  tendency  to  re- 
turn to  this  form.  There  is  a  species  of  "Wild  Cat  in  Egypt,  which 
corresponds  with  the  race  that  seems  to  have  been  domesticated 
by  the  ancient  Egyptians ;  of  this  race,  specimens  are  still  pre- 
served in  the  mummy  state.  To  this  species,  our  own  Domestic 
Cat  has  been  referred  by  some  naturalists  ;  whilst  others  think 
that  the  origin  of  the  race  has  yet  to  be  discovered.* 

191.     The   Lynxes  differ  slightly  from  the  other  Felines,  in 
having  the  ears  tufted  with  pencils  of  hairs,  in  the  shortness  of 


FJG.  105. — COMMON  LYNX. 

the  tail,  and  in  the  greater  elevation  of  the  body  at  the  haunches. 
They  are  less  courageous,  as  well  as  less  domesticable,  than  the 
other  Felines ;  and  show  a  sullen  and  suspicious  disposition. 
There  are  several  species ;  of  which  some  inhabit  Europe,  others 
Asia  and  Africa,  and  others  America.  They  live  upon  small 

*  See  Bell's  British  Quadrupeds,  p.  185. 


FAMILY    MUSTELnXffi; POLE-CAT,    STOAT,    ETC.  215 

quadrupeds  and  birds,  pursuing  the  latter  to  the  tops  of  trees  ; 
some  of  them  also  resort  to  the  water,  to  feed  on  fishes ;  and  it  is 
said  that  they  have  less  indisposition  to  carrion  than  the  other 
members  of  the  family,  and  will  follow  the  Lion  and  other  large 
beasts  of  prey,  for  the  purpose  of  feeding  on  what  they  leave. 

192.     The  animals  of  the  family  MUSTELIDJE  are  smaller,  for 
the  most  part,  than  those  of  the  preceding  group,  and  conse- 
quently less  formidable,  as  far  as  Man  is  concerned ;  but  they 
are  equally  sanguinary  in  their  propensities  and  habits,  and  are 
equally  destructive  to  the  races  on  which  they  are  appointed  to 
prey, — the  smaller  mammals,  with  birds,  reptiles  and   fishes. 
From  the  shortness  of  the  legs,  the  elongation,  slenderness,  and 
flexibility  of  their  bodies,  and  their  gliding  movements,  they 
have  been  not  unaptly  called  Vermiform  (worm-like)  Carnivora. 
They  are  silent,  cautious,  and  creeping ;  and  attack  their  prey 
with  unflinching  resolution.     Having  seized  their  victim,  they 
never  let  go  their  hold.     They  generally  aim  at  the  neck  below 
the  ear,  where  they  pierce  the  large  blood-vessels  with  their 
teeth ;  or  they  fix  upon  the  back  of  the  head,  and  drive  their 
teeth  through  the  skull.      Few  quadrupeds  surpass   them  in 
agility  and  address ;  they  bound  and  spring  with  vigour,  and 
climb  trees  with  astonishing  dexterity,  traversing  the  branches 
with  a  rapid  gliding  motion.     Their  habits  are  nocturnal ;  and 
they  pass  the  greatest  part  of  the  day  in  their  retreats,  which 
are  the  hollows  of  decayed  trees,  burrows,  holes  in  walls,  and 
similar  places.    With  the  approach  of  night,  they  rouse  from  their 
slumbers,  and,  greedy  for  blood,  begin  their  prowl.     A  Pole-cat 
in  the  neighbourhood  of  a  farm-yard,  is  a  direful  pest ;  and  will 
destroy  in  one  night  a  whole  brood  of  poultry,  for  the  sake  of  the 
blood  and  the  brains.     Most  of  these  animals  have  a  strong  disa- 
greeable odour;  which  is  extremely  offensive  in  some  species. 
Several  of  the  most  costly  and  beautiful  furs  are  obtained  from 
this  family ;  among  them  those  of  the  Sable  and  Ermine. — The 
Pole-cat,  Stoat,  Ferret,  Marten,  and  Weasel,  are  British  repre- 
sentatives of  this  family  :  they  strongly  resemble  each  other  in 
structure  and  habits  ;  and  all  present  the  characters  which  have 
been  just  detailed.     The  Stoat  is  of  the  same  species  with  the 


216        FAMILY    MUSTELID.E  ; MARTEN,    GLUTTON,    SKUNK. 

Ermine  ;  the  latter  being  the  Stoat  in  its  winter  dress.     In  our 
own  climate  this  change  is  not  complete ;  but  in  more  northern 


FIG.  106.— MARTEN. 


regions,  the  whole  body  becomes  white,  except  the  tip  of  the 
tail,  which  remains  black.  The  Pine-Marten  of  North  America, 
the  Sable  of  Northern  Asia,  and  the  Zorilla  of  Southern  Africa, 
are  also  typical  species,  nearly  allied  to  these. 

193.  This  family  includes,  however,  several  other  animals, 
which  connect  it  with  neighbouring  groups,  and  manifest  its  pecu- 
liarities in  a  less  striking  degree.  Among  these  are  the  Gluttons  of 
the  northern  regions  of  the  Old  and  New  World ;  which  (though 
by  some  placed  among  the  Ursidae)  are  evidently  intermediate 
between  the  Polecat  and  the  Badger,  agreeing  with  the  former 
in  their  dentition,  and  having  somewhat  more  of  the  general 
figure  and  aspect  of  the  latter.  They  are  slow  and  comparatively 
deficient  in  agility ;  but  they  are  very  persevering  and  deter- 
mined, as  well  as  cunning.  They  often  proceed  at  a  steady  pace 
for  miles,  hunting  out  weak  or  dying  animals,  and  stealing 
unawares  upon  hares,  marmots,  birds,  &c.  They  are  said  to 
surprise  the  larger  animals,  such  as  the  Reindeer  and  the  Elk,  as 
they  lie  asleep ;  and  to  tear  the  neck  and  throat  in  the  same 
manner  as  the  Weasel.  The  Glutton  fights  very  resolutely; 
and  its  great  strength  renders  it  more  than  a  match  for  a  single 
Dog  of  its  own  size.  The  Skunk,  another  intermediate  genus, 
is  remarkable  for  the  intolerable  odour  of  the  secretion  from  its 


FAMILY    MUSTELID^E  ; — SKUNK,    RATEL,    BADGER.  217 

glandular  pouches ;  which  neither  man  nor  dog  can  endure.  This 
fluid  it  has  the  power  of  ejecting  upon  its  pursuers,  when  hard 
pressed ;  and  it  serves  as  a  most  complete  means  of  defence,  a 
single  drop  being  enough  to  produce  nausea,  and  a  sense  of  suffo- 
cation. Of  this  genus,  four  or  five  species  are  known  ;  which 
are  all  American.  In  the  preceding  animals,  the  walk  is  slightly 
plantigrade ;  and  it  is  still  more  so  in  the  Ratel,  of  which  one 
species  inhabits  the  Cape  of  Good  Hope,  whilst  another  is  a 
native  of  India.  This  a  thick-set  clumsy  animal,  nearly  resem- 
bling the  Badger  in  aspect,  as  well  as  in  dentition.  The  Cape 
Ratel  is  celebrated  for  the  destruction  it  makes  among  the  nests 
of  the  wild-bee,  to  the  honey  of  which  it  is  very  partial ;  and  in 
the  discovery  of  these  nests  it  is  said  to  be  guided  by  the  actions 
and  voice  of  a  bird,  called  the  Honey-guide.  The  Badger* 


Fio.  107.— COMMON  BADGER. 

which  is  almost  completely  plantigrade  in  its  walk,  presents  a 
strong  resemblance  to  some  of  the  Ursidae  in  its  general 
aspect;  but  is  separated  from  that  family  by  an  important 
distinction.  All  the  Bears  and  their  allies,  have  at  least 
two  tuberculated  molars  ;  whilst  the  Badger  has  but  one. 
This,  however,  is  of  very  large  size  in  the  upper  jaw,  and  is 
adapted  for  the  mastication  of  vegetable  aliment.  Its  food 


218  FAMILY  MUSTELID^E; — BADGER,  OTTER. 

consists  of  roots,  earth-nuts,  fruits,  and  eggs,  as  well  as  of  small 
mammals ;  and  it  is  said  also  to  attack  the  nests  of  the  wild-bee, 
plundering  the  store  of  honey,  und  also  devouring  the  larvae, 
without  dread  of  the  stings  of  the  enraged  insects,  which  cannot 
penetrate  its  tough  skin.  Its  favourite  haunts  are  obscure  and 
gloomy  ;  it  retires  to  the  deepest  recesses  of  woods,  or  to  thick 
coppices  on  the  side  of  hills ;  and  there,  with  its  long  and  power- 
ful claws,  it  digs  for  itself  a  deep  and  well-formed  domicile, 
consisting  of  several  chambers,  the  inner  one  of  which  is  of  a  cir- 
cular form,  and  is  comfortably  lined  with  grass  and  hay.  Here  the 
animal  spends  the  day  in  repose,  moving  out  only  at  night  in 
search  of  food.  The  Badger  possesses  great  muscular  power, 
especially  in  the  jaws ;  and  the  firmness  of  the  grasp  which  it 
can  take  with  its  teeth  is  increased  by  a  peculiar  conformation 
of  the  joint, — the  condyle,  or  articulating  head  of  the  lower  jaw 
being  received  deeply  into  the  glenoid  cavity,  (ANIM.  PHYSIOL., 
§  623),  which  bends  over  it  before  and  behind,  so  as  to  retain  it 
in  its  place,  even  when  all  the  muscles  and  ligaments  have  been 
removed.  It  may  be  easily  tamed,  if  taken  young ;  and  shows 
great  attachment  to  Man.  The  common  species  is  still  found  in 
some  parts  of  England  and  Scotland,  and  in  almost  every  other 
country  in  Europe,  though  it  is  nowhere  very  abundant ;  it  also 
extends  over  Middle  Asia,  and  is  said  to  be  very  common  in 
China,  where  it  is  used  as  food.  There  is  a  distinct  species  in 
India,  and  another  in  North  America  ;  but  their  habits  seem  to 
bear  a  close  resemblance  to  those  of  the  one  best  known. 

1 94.  A  still  more  aberrant  form  of  the  Weasel  tribe,  is  the 
Otter,  an  aquatic  animal,  which  conducts  us,  in  its  general  con- 
formation and  habits,  towards  the  Seals.  Many  of  the  true 
Weasels  resort  occasionally  to  the  water  in  quest  of  food  ;  and  in 
those  species,  the  form  of  the  body  approaches  that  of  the  Otter. 
In  their  dentition,  the  Otters  differ  but  little  from  the  Polecats, 
Martens,  and  Skunks ;  the  false  molars  being  |jj|,  the  carnivor- 
ous teeth  ~,  and  the  tuberculated  molars  |^J.  The  body  is 
elongated  and  flattened  in  its  form  ;  the  limbs  short  and  stout ; 
the  toes  (five  on  each  foot)  are  webbed  and  spreading  ;  the  soles 
are  naked.  The  tail  is  long,  stout  and  muscular  at  its  base, 


FAMILY   MUSTELIDJE; — OTTER.  219 

tapering  towards  the  extremity,  and  somewhat  flattened  horizon- 
tally. The  fur  is  close,  short,  and  fine ;  consisting  of  a  thick 
woolly  undercoat,  and  an  upper  layer  of  smooth  glossy  hairs. 
The  head  is  broad  and  flat ;  the  ears  are  very  small  and  close  to 
the  skull ;  and  the  eyes  are  provided  with  a  nictitating  membrane 
(or  third  half- transparent  eyelid,  like  that  of  Birds)  as  a  defence 
to  their  surface.  All  these  characters  plainly  indicate  the  adapt- 
ation of  the  animal  to  an  aquatic  residence  ;  and  an  acquaint- 
ance with  its  habits  shows  their  purpose.  On  land,  the  move- 
ments of  the  Otter  are  by  no  means  free  or  rapid  ;  but  it  makes 
to  the  water  when  attacked,  and  there  it  swims  with  the  greatest 
facility.  Its  motions  in  the  water  are  remarkably  graceful ;  it 
swims  at  every  depth  with  great  rapidity,  every  now  and  then 
coming  up  to  the  surface  to  take  breath,  and  then  diving  like  a 
shot,  following  its  prey  through  every  turn  with  the  greatest  per- 
severance, until  its  exhausted  victim  can  no  longer  escape  the 
jaws  of  its  rapacious  foe.  Its  food  naturally  consists  entirely  of 
the  Fish  which  it  thus  captures ;  and  in  pursuit  of  them  it  will 
even  descend  along  rivers  to  the  sea  :  but  when  fish  are  scarce, 
it  will  assume  the  habits  of  the  Stoats  and  Weasels,  resorting  far 
inland  to  the  neighbourhood  of  the  farm-yard,  and  attacking 
lambs,  sucking-pigs,  and  poultry.  The  Otter  does  not  excavate 
a  burrow  for  itself,  as  some  have  affirmed ;  but  avails  itself  of 
any  convenient  hollow  for  its  residence, — such  as  those  beneath 
the  overhanging  roots  of  trees  which  grow  on  the  banks  of 
rivers.  It  is  capable  of  being  domesticated,  when  taken  young ; 
and  may  be  used  to  catch  fish  for  its  master.  Bishop  Heber 
mentions  that  the  Indian  fishermen  keep  the  Asiatic  species  for 
this  purpose,  and  that  they  find  them  of  great  use  in  fishing ; 
and  justly  remarks  that  "  the  simple  Hindoo  here  shows  a  better 
taste  and  judgment,  than  half  the  Otter-hunting  and  Badger- 
baiting  gentry  of  England."  There  is  a  species  of  Otter,  found  on 
the  North-west  coast  of  America,  and  on  the  opposite  coast  of 
Asia,  which  frequents  the  sea-shore  almost  exclusively,  and  bears 
a  still  stronger  resemblance  to  the  Seals,  than  does  the  common 
species.  Its  tail  is  shorter  ;  and  its  hind-feet,  which  form  very 
broad  and  powerful  paddles,  are  directed  far  back.  The  teeth 


220  FAMILY    CANID^E  ; WOLF. 

are  evidently  formed  for  bruising  hard  substances ;  and  the  ani- 
mal probably  lives  upon  Mollusks  and  Crustacea,  as  well  as  upon 
Fish. 

195.     The  family  CANIDJE,  or  Dog  tribe,  will  not  detain  us 
long ;  since  the  number  of   distinct   forms    which   it   contains 
(according   to  the  classification  here  adopted)  is   small  :    and 
several  of  the  most  interesting  questions  relating  to  them  have 
been  already  discussed.      If    the    idea   put    forwards    in    the 
Introductory  Chapter  (§  14), — that  the  Dog  and  Wolf  are  of 
the  same  species, — should  prove  correct,  we  shall  be  of  course 
led  to  regard  the  Wolf  as  the  type  of  the  family.     This  animal, 
as  is  well  known,  is  no  longer  an  inhabitant  of  our  own  country ; 
having  been  completely  extirpated  from  England  many  centuries 
ago,  and  more  recently  from  Scotland  and  Ireland.     The  last 
record  of  their  existence  in  England  in  any  formidable  numbers, 
was  in  the  year  1281 ;  but  it  is  stated,  that  in  1577,  they  were  very 
destructive  to  the  flocks  in  Scotland;  and  in  Ireland  they  were  ex- 
terminated only  at  the  beginning  of  the  last  century.     The  Wolf 
is  still  spread,  however,  through  almost  every  part  of  the  Conti- 
nent of  Europe,  and  Northern  Asia  ;  especially  in  mountain  and 
forest  districts,  and  where  the  population  is  scanty.     It  is  ex- 
tremely destructive  to  domesticated  animals  in  the  districts  where 
it  abounds  ;    as  is  shown  by  the  following  official  report  made  to 
the  Russian  Government,  of  the  slaughter  committed  by  the 
Wolves  of  the  district  of  Livonia, — a  tract  about  250  miles  long 
by  150  broad,— in  the  year!822.     Horses,  1841  ;  cattle,  1807  ; 
calves,  733;   sheep,  15,182;   lambs,  726  ;    goats,  2545;    kids, 
183  ;   swine,  4190  ;    young  pigs,  312  ;   dogs,  703  ;  geese,  673 ; 
fowls,  1243.     It   seldom  attacks  Man,  however,  except  when 
pressed  by  hunger,  and  when  associated  with  others  of  its  kind. 
The  general  aspect  of  the  Wolf  is  well  known.     Its  frame  is 
robust  but  gaunt,  its  gait  skulking  and  irresolute,  its  physiog- 
nomy has  a  wild  and  sinister  expression,  and  its  character  is 
marked  by   mingled  ferocity,   cunning,  and   cowardice.     It  is 
habitually  cautious  and  suspicious,  so  that  it  is  not    easy  to 
take  it  in  traps  ;   and  when  pursued  it  rushes  along  with  great 
velocity  ;   but  when   brought  to  bay,  it  defends  itself  with  the 


FAMILY  CANIDJE; — WOLF,  DOG,  JACKAL,  FOX.         221 

greatest  determination.  Its  strength  is  very  great,  especially  in 
the  muscles  of  the  head,  neck,  and  shoulders ;  and  its  bite  very 
severe.  Its  capability  of  being  domesticated  has  been  already 
noticed.  Several  distinct  species  of  Wolves  are  found  in  different 
parts  of  the  globe,  especially  in  America ;  they  vary  somewhat 
in  size  and  power,  and  in  the  degree  of  predominance  of  the  cun- 
ning or  of  the  ferocity  of  their  characters ;  but  their  general 
habits  are  much  the  same  as  those  of  the  common  "Wolf. 

196.  Of  the  Dog,  it  is  unnecessary  (after  what  has  been 
already  said)  to  give  any  Zoological  description ;  an  account  of 
its  varieties  or  breeds  would  not  fall  within  the  province  of  this 
work  ;  and  instances  of  its  sagacity  and  reasoning  power  will  be 
more  properly  given  in  the  last  division  of  this  Treatise.  We 
shall  therefore  pass  on  to  notice  briefly  some  other  species  of  this 
family. — The  Jackal  is  somewhat  intermediate  in  its  character 
between  the  Wolf  and  the  Fox ;  resembling  the  former  in  its 
habits,  and  the  latter  in  its  appearance.  It  associates  in  troops, 
which  lie  concealed  in  holes  during  the  day,  and  which  come 
forth  at  night  with  dismal  shrieks,  attacking  any  animals  they 
are  capable  of  overcoming.  It  feeds  greedily  also  upon  carrion 
and  offal  of  every  description  ;  and  is  thus  of  service  in  removing 
what  has  been  left  by  other  beasts  of  prey.  The  Common 
Jackal  has  a  range  from  the  North  of  Africa,  through  Syria, 
Persia,  and  the  greater  part  of  India;  and  other  species  are 
found  in  the  middle  and  South  of  Africa,  where  they  may  be 
considered  as  replacing  the  Wolf. — The  Fox  is  chiefly  charac- 
terised by  its  sharp  muzzle  and  long  bushy  tail  ;  as  well  as  by 
the  cunning  of  its  character,  which  has  passed  into  a  proverb. 
The  common  species  is  an  inhabitant  of  most  parts  of  Europe, 
as  well  as  of  Britain  ;  and  extends  also  into  Northern  Asia. 
Its  senses  are  extremely  acute,  so  as  alike  to  inform  it  of  the 
neighbourhood  of  its  prey,  and  to  warn  it  of  the  approach  of 
danger.  It  usually  remains  concealed  during  the  day,  in  a  bur- 
row which  it  has  either  made  for  itself,  or  usurped  ;  and  ventures 
abroad  chiefly  at  night,  with  stealthy  movements,  in  search  of 
food.  Though  slightly  made,  the  Fox  has  great  muscular  vigour, 
and  bites  with  much  severity.  Even  when  taken  at  a  very 


222         FAMILY  CANID^E; — COMMON  AND  ARCTIC  pox. 

early  age,  it  is  never  properly  domesticated  ;    and  adults,  when 
placed  in  confinement,  show  great  ferocity  and  soon  die.     It  is 


FIG.  108.— COMMON  Fox. 


to  its  power  of  endurance  and  its  great  speed,  as  well  as  to  the 
cunning  which  dictates  various  expedients  for  escape,  that  the 
chase  of  this  animal  owes  its  exciting  character  ;  and  were  it 
not  for  the  artificial  preservation  of  the  race,  for  the  purpose  of 
the  sportsman,  it  would  long  since  have  been  extirpated  from  this 


FIG:  109— ARCTIC  Fox. 


country.     Among  the  most  common  of  its  expedients  for  escape, 
is   feigning    death ;  which    is   done    by  several    other  animals 


FAMILY    CANIDJE  J FOX,    LYCAON.  223 

also.  Numerous  other  species  of  Fox  exist  in  the  Old  and 
New  Worlds ;  of  these,  however,  we  shall  only  stop  to  notice 
the  Arctic  Fox,  which  is  confined  to  the  high  northern  latitudes. 
The  hair  of  this  animal,  in  summer,  is  of  a  dusky  ash  or  leaden 
hue  ;  but  in  winter  it  assumes  a  pure  white.  The  fur  also 
becomes  fuller  and  thicker,  and  even  deeply  covers  the  soles  of 
the  feet. — The  Lycaon  pictus,  or  Cape  Hunting-dog,  is  the  last 
species  of  this  family,  to  which  we  shall  advert.  It  forms  a 
complete  transition  to  the  next  family,  from  its  strong  resem- 


Fio.  110.  —  LVCAON  PICTUS. 


blance  to  the  Hyama,  not  only  in  general  aspect,  but  also  in  pos- 
sessing but  four  toes  on  its  fore  and  hind-feet.  It  agrees  with 
the  Canidae,  however,  in  its  dentition  and  habits  ;  and  may  be 
regarded  as  just  such  an  aberrant  form  of  that  family,  as  we 
might  expect  to  find  making  a  transition  to  the  next.  It  is  a 
wild,  fleet,  and  savage  animal,  hunting  in  packs  by  day  as  well 
as  by  night  ;  and  advancing  by  stealth  on  prey,  which  it  will 
not  venture  to  attack  openly. 

197.  Of  the  family  VIVERRIDJE,  we  shall  first  notice  one  of 
the  typical  genera,  the  Viverra  or  Civet  ;  which  is  characterised 
by  the  possession  of  a  double  pouch,  that  secretes  a  fatty  sub- 
stance of  a  strong  musky  odour,  used  as  a  perfume  ;  by  the  half- 
retractile  power  of  the  claws  ;  and  by  the  pupil  of  the  eye  being 
circular  during  the  day,  instead  of  being  contracted  into  a  vertical 


224       FAMILY    VIVERRID.E  ; CIVET,    GENET,    ICHNEUMON. 

line  as  in  the  Cat  tribe.     The  general  aspect  of  this  animal  is 
shown  in  the  accompanying  figure ;    it  is  wild  and  savage  in 


FIG-  111.— CIVET. 

its  character,  preying  upon  birds,  reptiles,  and  small  mammals, 
which  it  takes  by  surprise ;  it  exhibits  great  energy  and  bodily 
activity ;  and,  though  the  young  are  easily  tamed,  adults  can 
never  be  reconciled  to  captivity.  The  best  known  species  is 
peculiar  to  North  Africa,  and  is  especially  common  in  Abyssinia ; 
but  others  are  found  in  different  parts  of  the  warmer  regions  of 
the  Old  World.  The  Genets,  of  which  one  species  inhabits  the 
South  of  Europe,  present  many  points  of  resemblance  to  the 
Feline  tribe,  in  manners,  as  well  as  in  anatomical  characters  and 
general  aspect ;  their  claws  are  completely  retractile.  And  the 
connection  of  the  two  families  is  still  more  closely  established  by 
certain  other  species,  which  have  been  classed  with  the  Cats. 
On  the  other  hand,  the  Ichneumon  of  Egypt, — in  the  form  of  its 
long  agile  body,  its  short  limbs,  semi-plantigrade  feet,  small 
glowing  eyes,  pointed  nose, — as  well  as  in  its  bold,  active,  san- 
guinary, unrelenting  disposition, — and  in  the  habits  which  result 
from  this, — bears  a  very  close  resemblance  to  the  Weasel  tribe. 
It  glides  towards  its  prey  with  a  snake-like  movement,  and  then 
darts  suddenly  upon  it.  It  feeds  upon  birds,  and  small  reptiles, 
and  mammals  ;  also  upon  eggs  :  and  it  is  particularly  serviceable 


FAMILY    VIVERRID^  ; — ICHNEUMON,    HY.ENA.  225 

in  restraining  the  multiplication  of  the  Crocodile,  by  devouring 
its  eggs,  and  also  the  young  Crocodiles  when  newly-hatched. 
The  Ichneumon  is  easily  domesticated,  and  seems  to  form  an  at- 
tachment to  its  place  of  residence  ;  it  is  not  unfrequently  kept 
tame  in  the  countries,  of  which  it  is  a  native,  for  the  purpose  of 
clearing  the  houses  of  mice,  rats,  &c. 

198.  Certain  other  less-known  genera  seem  to  connect  the 
Viverrine  family,  with  the  Raccoons  and  other  aberrant  forms  of 
the  UrsidcB  ;  but  we  must  pass  these  by,  to  notice  the  remark- 
able section  of  it,  which  presents  a  very  near  approach  towards 
the  Canida, — that  of  the  Hy&na  and  its  allies.  The  molar 
teeth  of  this  animal  are  as  follows  ;  false  molars  gz3>  carnivorous 
teeth  ^rj,  tuberculated  molars  ~.  Notwithstanding  the  difference 
in  their  dentition,  however,  they  are  closely  related  in  many 
points  to  the  Civets,  and  are  connected  with  them  by  a  remark- 
able genus  to  be  presently  noticed.  The  skull  of  the  Hyaena  is 
short,  and  remarkable  for  its  solidity;  the  muzzle  also  is  short;  and 
the  temporal  muscles,  which  raise  the  lower  jaw,  together  with 
those  of  the  neck,  are  enormously  developed.  The  vertebra  of 
the  neck,  in  adult  animals,  are  often  found  to  be  united  together  ; 
as  if  for  the  purpose  of  resisting  the  most  violent  strains.  The 
general  form  of  the  body  is  very  peculiar.  The  neck,  chest,  and 
shoulders  are  extremely  powerful ;  but  the  hind-quarters  are  low, 
and  the  hind  legs  seem  comparatively  feeble,  giving  a  kind  of 

awkward  shuffle  to  the  pace. 
The  toes  are  four  on  each  foot ; 
and  are  furnished  with  blunt, 
stout,  unretractile  claws.  Be- 
neath the  tail  is  a  deep  pouch, 
analogous  to  that  of  the  Civets, 
but  not  secreting  a  similar  odorous 
substance.  The  Hyaenas  are  es- 
sentially carrion-feeders  ;  and  are 

FIG.  112.— SPOTTED  HY^NA:  * 

destined  to  fill  up  an  important 

station  in  the  economy  of  nature.  They  cleanse  the  earth  of  the 
decaying  carcasses  of  the  larger  beasts,  whose  remains,  if  not 
speedily  removed,  would  infect  the  atmosphere  with  pestilential 


226  FAMILY    VIVERRID.E  ; — HY.ENA,    PROTELES 

effluvia.  They  devour,  too,  the  remains  left  by  other  beasts  of 
prey  ;  being  specially  enabled  to  do  so  by  the  enormous  strength 
of  their  jaws,  and  by  the  peculiar  conformation  of  their  teeth, 
which  are  adapted  rather  for  crushing  hard  substances,  than  for 
dividing  animal  flesh ;  and  these,  by  their  combined  power, 
enable  them  to  crunch  even  the  largest  bones,  so  as  to  extract 
from  them  the  nutritious  matter  they  contain.  The  Hyaenas  will 
seize  upon  living  animals  also  ;  but  seldom  attack  Man  openly, 
except  in  self-defence.  Their  haunts  by  day  are  dens  and  caves, 
gloomy  rocks,  and  the  ruins  of  towns  and  sepulchral  monuments 
of  antiquity.  As  darkness  sets  in,  these  fierce  beasts  emerge 
from  their  lair,  and  prowl  in  search  of  their  prey,  with  menacing 
teeth  and  glaring  eyes.  Notwithstanding  the  ferocity  of  its  dis- 
position, the  Hyaena  is  easily  tameable  when  young ;  and  shows 
much  of  the  attachment  to  its  master,  which  is  characteristic  of 
the  Dog.  The  Hyaena  is  confined  to  Africa  and  Asia  ;  the 
striped  species  is  a  native  of  northern  and  central  Asia,  and  of 
northern  Africa ;  the  spotted  species,  and  another  that  bears 
more  resemblance  to  the  striped,  are  found  in  Southern  Africa, 
and  are  great  pests  to  the  colonists. — The  Proteles  or  Aard-Wolf 


FIG.  113 — PROTELES  LALANDF. 


(earth- wolf)  of  the  Cape  of  Good  Hope,  is  evidently  the  con- 
necting link  between  the  Hyaenas  and  the  Civets  ;  resembling 
the  former  in  its  general  contour  and  manners,  though  of  infe- 


FAMILY    URSID^E; BEARS.  227 

rior  size  and  strength ;  and  having  more  of  the  lengthened  head 
and  pointed  muzzle  of  the  latter.  There  are  five  toes  on  the 
hind-feet,  but  only  four  on  the  fore-feet.  The  dentition  presents 
a  remarkable  anomaly ;  there  are  but  three  small  false  molars 
above,  and  one  small  tuberculous  molar;  and  but  three  false 
molars  below, — no  vestige  of  the  carnivorous  tooth  presenting 
itself.  The  canines,  however,  are  of  considerable  size.  This 
animal  is  very  destructive  to  the  young  lambs ;  and  is  said  to 
attack  the  massive  fatty  protuberance  on  the  tails  of  the1  African 
sheep. 

199.  The  animals  of  the  family  URSID^E  are,  of  all  the  Car- 
nivora,  those  which  are  most  omnivorous  in  their  diet, — some  of 
them  living  almost  entirely  upon  vegetable  food, — and  nearly 
all  being  capable  of  supporting  themselves  upon  it.  Most  of 
them  are  expert  climbers  ;  they  conceal  themselves  in  caves,  in 
holes  of  the  earth,  and  in  hollow  trees  ;  and  in  such  retreats  they 
usually  pass  the  winter  in  a  state  bordering  on  torpidity,  and 
there  the  female  brings  forth  her  young.  The  characters  of  the 
family  are  most  strongly  marked  in  the  animals  of  the  genus 
Ursus  or  Bear ;  which  are  distinguished  by  their  ponderous 
bulk,  massive  limbs,  and  heavy  gait.  They  are  completely  plan- 
tigrade in  their  walk,  and  can  rear  themselves  without  difficulty 
on  their  hind-legs.  They  have  large  claws,  which  are  adapted 
for  digging,  and  which  are  powerful  weapons  of  attack  and  de- 
fence ;  these  are  not  retractile.  Bears  are  for  the  most  part  un- 
social animals,  frequenting  the  recesses  of  mountains  and  caverns, 
and  the  depths  of  the  forests.  They  are  expert  climbers,  ascend- 
ing trees  and  rocks  with  great  dexterity.  The  food  of  the  dif- 
ferent species  varies  in  some  degree ;  being  almost  exclusively 
vegetable  in  some  species,  such  as  the  American  Black  Bear,  which 
will  not  touch  animal  flesh,  if  vegetable  aliment  can  be  obtained  ; 
whilst  it  is  almost  as  exclusively  animal  in  others,  such  as  the 
Polar  Bear.  Even  the  most  carnivorous  of  them,  however,  will 
seldom  attack  Man,  unless  provoked  to  do  so  by  aggression,  or 
strongly  incited  by  hunger ;  but  when  attacked,  they  become 
very  formidable  opponents,  displaying  greater  activity  and  address 
than  might  be  expected  from  their  heavy  clumsy  figures. 

Q2 


228  FAMILY    URSID^E  ; — BEARS. 

Various  species  of  Bear  are  diffused  through  Europe,  Asia,  and 
America ;  but  Africa  is  almost  (although  not  entirely,  as  has 
been  supposed,)  destitute  of  them.  The  Brown  Bear  is  the 
species  best  known  ;  it  inhabits  the  mountainous  parts  of  Europe, 
from  the  Arctic  circle  to  the  Alps  and  Pyrenees,  and  also  the 
north  of  Asia  and  Siberia  ;  it  was  formerly  a  tenant  of  the  hills 
and  forests  of  our  own  island,  whence  it  was  exported  to  Rome, 
to  be  a  partaker  in  the  cruel  fights  exhibited  in  the  Circus.  It 
has  been  long,  however,  exterminated  from  Britain;  the  year 
1057  being  the  date  of  the  latest  mention  of  it  in  Scotland,  where, 
like  the  Wolf,  it  seems  to  have  lingered  after  being  driven  from 
England.  The  Black  Bear  is  very  widely  diffused  through 


FIG.  114. — AMERICAN  BLACK  BEAR. 

North  America,  from  the  Arctic  Sea,  to  its  southern  extremity ; 
and  its  skin  was  at  one  time  a  considerable  article  of  com- 
merce. One  of  the  largest  known  species,  is  the  Grisly  Bear 
of  North  America,  which  is  everywhere  dreaded  for  its  strength 
and  ferocity,  and  which  even  attacks  and  vanquishes  the  huge 
Bison.  And  the  Polar  Bear,  whose  residence  is  amidst  the  snow 
and  ice  of  the  arctic  regions,  seems  to  attain  a  yet  larger  size, — 
the  length  of  one  killed  in  Captain  Lyon's  expedition  being  stated 
at  eight  feet  and  a  half,  and  its  weight  at  1600  Ibs.  This  for- 
midable animal  feeds  chiefly  upon  Seals  ;  in  pursuit  of  which  it 


FAMILY    URSID^J  J BEAR,    RACCOON,    COATI.  229 

will  not  only  traverse  vast  fields  of  ice,  but  will  also  swim  for 
considerable  distances  through  the  sea.  It  will  devour  the  re- 
mains of  Fishes,  Cetacea,  and  other  marine  animals ;  and  has 
been  even  seen  to  dive  after  and  capture  living  Fish.  In  sum- 
mer, the  Polar  Bear  devours  mountain-berries ;  and  does  not 
reject  even  sea- weeds  and  marsh-plants.  Of  the  devotion  of  the 
female  Polar  Bear  to  her  young,  and  of  her  courage  in  their 
defence,  many  instances  are  well  known. 

200.  We  have  now  to  notice  certain  aberrant  genera  of  this 
family ;  in  which  the  characters  of  the  group  are  less  prominently 
displayed.  The  Raccoon  differs  from  the  Bears  in  its  dentition  ; 
having  only  6  instead  of  7  molars  in  the  lower  jaw  ;  and  the  car- 
nivorous tooth  being  formed  like  the  posterior  molars,  and  ill 
suited  to  cutting  flesh.  In  size,  it  equals  a  common  Fox  ;  it  has 
a  stout  body  with  moderate  limbs,  and  a  semi-plantigrade  walk ; 
the  toes  are  five  on  each  foot,  and  armed  with  sharp  claws  ; 
the  muzzle  is  sharp,  the  nose  tapering  beyond  the  lips,  and 
flexible  ;  the  tail  is  somewhat  bushy.  The  Raccoon  is  nocturnal 
in  its  habits,  sleeping  by  day  in  its  hole,  and  prowling  at  night  in 
search  of  food.  It  frequents  the  margins  of  swamps  and  rivers, 
and  the  sea-shore ;  and  preys  upon  small  animals,  birds,  eggs, 
insects,  and  shell-fish,  with  the  addition  of  roots  and  sweet  suc- 
culent vegetables.  Its  dexterity  in  opening  Oysters  has  been 
particularly  noticed.  Its  gait  on  the  ground  consists  of  a  series 
of  bounds,  reminding  us  of  the  Lemurs,  but  without  their 
grace  or  agility  ;  it  climbs  trees  readily,  in  the  same  manner  as 
the  Bear.  When  taken  young,  this  animal  is  easily  tamed,  and 
its  habits  are  gentle  and  playful  ;  but  it  is  at  the  same  time 
capricious  and  easily  offended,  and  seldom  forgives  its  enemy. — 
The  Coati  is  distinguished  by  the  elongation  of  its  snout,  to 
which  its  scientific  name  Nasua  refers  ;  to  this  character  an 
approach  was  pointed  out  in  the  Raccoon.  The  snout  is  a  sort  of 
short  flexible  proboscis,  at  the  extremity  of  which  the  nostrils 
open ;  the  animal  turns  it  about  in  various  directions  when  in 
search  of  food,  and  uses  it  to  root  up  the  earth  in  quest  of  worms 
and  insects.  In  its  general  characters  and  habits,  it  strongly 
resembles  the  Raccoon  ;  and  like  it  is  confined  to  the  New  World. 


230 


COATI,    PANDA. FAMILY    PHOCID.E, 


FIG.  115 — AILURUS  OR  PANDA. 


It  lives  more  among  trees,  however,  than  upon  the  ground  ;  and 
preys  especially  upon  birds,  the  nests  also  of  which  it  rifles 

for  the  eggs  and 
unfledged  young. 
It  is  more  active 
than  the  Raccoon 
in  confinement, 
not  spending  so 

much  of  the  dax 

in  sleep ;  its  snout 
seems  to  be  in 
perpetual  motion, 
when  the  animal 

is  examining  the  objects  around  it. — These  genera  are  repre- 
sented in  the  Old  World  by  the  Ailurus  or  Panda  (Fig.  115), 
which  is  an  inhabitant  of  the  Himalayan  ridge ;  it  is  evidently 
adapted  to  a  cold  climate  by  its  thick  covering  of  fur,  which 
consists  of  a  woolly  undercoat,  with  long  soft  hair  overlying  it. 

201.  The  animals  of  the  family  PHOCID^E,  or  Seal  tribe,  are, 
of  all  four-limbed  Mammalia,  those  which  display  the  most 
complete  adaptation  to  residence  in  the  water.  We  have  seen 
an  approach  to  this  in  the  Otters,  especially  in  the  marine  species 
(§  194)  ;  but  it  is  carried  much  further  in  the  Seals.  The  body 
is  elongated  and  conical,  tapering  from  the  chest  to  the  tail, — 
the  pelvis  being  so  narrow  as  not  to  interrupt  the  gradual 


FIG.  116 — SEAL. 


decrease,     The  spine  is  provided  with   strong  muscles,  which 
bend  it  with  considerable  force ;  and  this  movement  is  of  great 


FAMILY    PHOCID2E; SEALS. 


231 


assistance  in  the  propulsion  of  the  body.  The  limbs  are  con- 
verted into  oars  or  paddles.  The  anterior  pair  have  the  arm 
and  fore-arm  so  short,  that  little  more  than  the  paw  advances 
from  the  body  ;  in  this  the  bones  of  the  fingers  are  separate,  but 
they  are  inclosed  in  a  skin  common  to  all  of  them,  which  extends 
to  their  tips,  so  that  they  are  externally  marked  only  by  the 
claws  which  terminate  them.  The  hinder  limbs  are  directed 
backwards,  so  as  almost  to  seem  like  a  continuation  of  the  body ; 
the  thigh  and  leg  are  very  short,  and  the  foot  ,is  formed  on  the 
same  plan  as  the  fore-paw, — the  toes  being  in  contact,  however, 
and  the  web  folded,  when  it  is  not  in  use  as  a  paddle,  but  being 
spread  out  into  a  broad  surface  when  the  animal  is  swimming 
through  the  water.  Between  these  paddles  is  the  short  and 
compressed  tail.  On  land,  or  on  masses  of  ice,  the  movements 
of  the  Seal  are  awkward,  its  under-side  resting  on  the  ground, 
and  its  body  being  forced  onward  by  the  action  of  the  fore-limbs 
only,  whilst  the  hinder  ones  are  dragged  after  it.  But  it  swims 
with  great  rapidity  and  ease  ;  and,  by  a  peculiar  arrangement 
of  its  blood-vessels,  analogous  to  that  which  exists  in  the  Whale- 
tribe,  (ANIM.  PHYSIOL.,  §  265),  it  can  remain  under  water  for 
a  considerable  time.  The  head  is  of  a  rounded  form,  and  is 
furnished  with  long  stiff  whiskers ;  the  nostrils  are  provided 
with  a  valve,  which  can  be  closed  at  will,  so  as  to  keep  out 

the  water ;  a  similar 
valve  exists  in  the 
orifices  of  the  ears ; 
and  the  clothing  of 
the  body  consists  of 
stiff  glossy  hairs,  very 
closely  set  against 
the  skin.  The  form 
of  the  teeth  varies 
considerably  in  the 
different  genera  of 
this  family;  but  in 
all  they  are  adapted  rather  to  hold  the  slippery  prey  on  which 
these  animals  feed,  than  to  cut  or  to  crush  what  offers  much 


Fio.  117. — TEETH  OF  STERRINCK. 


232  FAMILY    PHOCIDJE  ; — SEALS. 

resistance.  Of  this  prehensile  character,  the  accompanying 
figure  affords  a  good  illustration.  The  incisors  are  either  |-  or  \  ; 
the  canines  are  always  present,  aiid  are  large  and  strong ;  the 
molars  are  usually  from  20  to  24  in  number,  that  is,  either  5  or 
6  on  either  side  of  each  jaw. 

202.  A  considerable  number  of  species  of  Seal  exist ;  all  of 
them  inhabiting  either  the  temperate  or  the  frigid  regions  of  the 
globe.  At  least  four  are  known  to  visit  the  shores  of  Britain. 
The  Common  Seal  (Fig.  116)  is  from  four  to  five  feet  long  ; 
its  physiognomy  is  mild  and  expressive,  like  that  of  a  Dog  ;  it 
is  readily  domesticated,  and  shows  great  intelligence  and  attach- 
ment to  Man.  The  Grey  Seal,  on  the  other  hand,  which  some- 
times attains  the  length  of  twelve  feet,  is  much  less  intelligent, 
and  cannot  be  tamed  ;  it  shows  considerable  resolution,  and  even 
ferocity,  when  attacked.  The  Greenland,  or  Harp  Seal,  is 
remarkable  for  the  changes  of  colour  which  it  undergoes  in  the 
course  of  its  advance  towards  maturity ;  the  markings  of  the 
body  are  so  distinct  in  different  years,  that  the  precise  age  of  the 
animal  may  be  known  by  them.  The  immature  species  has 
been  regarded  (as  in  many  other  instances,  §  18),  as  distinct 
from  the  adult,  by  those  who  were  not  acquainted  with  its 
history.  The  Elephant  Seal  of  the  South  Seas  is  the  largest 
known  species  ;  its  length  being  from  20  to  30  feet ;  and  its 
girth  at  the  largest  part  of  the  body  being  from  1 5  to  18  feet. 
A  full-grown  male  will  yield  70  gallons  of  oil.  This  seal  lives 
in  troops,  which  migrate  towards  the  tropic  in  winter,  and 

return  southwards  in  summer. 
It  is  much  sought  after,  on 
account  of  the  large  quantity  of 
oil  which  it  yields ;  and  also 
for  the  skin,  which  is  extensively 
used  in  harness,  on  account  of 
its  strength  and  thickness.  It 
is  a  very  inert  animal,  not  being 
easily  alarmed,  and  making 

FIG.  118.— TKETH  OF  ELEPHANT-SKAL.        ,..,,      ,  f  ,  ,      ,    T, 

little  defence  when  attacked.  Its 
food  appears  to  consist  in  part  of  sea- weeds  and  cuttle-fish  ;  the 


URSAL  ;    FUR    SEAL. 


233 


remains  of  both  having  been  taken  in  its  stomach.  The  name  of 
Elephant  Seal  is  given  to  it,  in  part  from  the  large  size  of  its 
tusk-like  canines ;  and  in  part  from  the  prolongation  of  its 
snout  into  a  kind  of  proboscis. — Several  species  of  Seal  are 
known  under  the  names  of  Sea-Lion,  Sea-Bear,  &c.  One  of 
these,  the  Ursal,  an  inhabitant  of  the  shores  of  the  North  Pacific 
Ocean,  is  represented  in  the  accompanying  figure.  It  is  said  to 
be  one  of  the  most  pugnacious  and  ferocious  of  the  whole  tribe. 
There  is  a  remarkable  disproportion  in  the  number  of  the  sexes 
in  this  species ;  each  family  consisting  of  but  one  male  with  a 
crowd  of  females.  If  one  family  encroaches  on  the  station  of 
another,  a  general  fight  is  the  consequence;  and  Man,  if  he 
approach  within  their  range,  is  by  no  means  safe  from  their 
attacks.  The  Fur  Seal,  which  is  nearly  allied  to  this,  is  an 
inhabitant  of  the  Southern  Pacific ;  it  was  formerly  very  abun- 
dant in  certain  localities,  so  that  for  a  period  of  fifty  years,  not 
less  than  J  ,200,000  skins  were  annually  obtained  from  a  single 


FIG.  119 — THE  URSAL. 


island  ;  but  its  numbers  have  been  much  thinned  by  this  exces- 
sive destruction. 

203.     A  very  aberrant  form  of  this  family  is  presented  by  the 


234  FAMILY    PHOCID^E  ; WALRUS. 

genus  Trickecus,  of  which  only  one  species  is  known,  the  Walrus, 
Morse,  or  Sea-Cow.  In  general  form,  as  well  as  in  habits,  the 
Walrus  resembles  the  larger  species  of  Seal ;  but  it  differs  from 
them  entirely  in  dentition.  Its  chief  peculiarity  consists  in  the 
enormous  development  of  the  canine  teeth  of  the  upper  jaw, 
which  are  from  18  to  24  inches  in  length,  stout  and  solid ;  with 
large  roots,  of  which  the  sockets  project  considerably,  giving  a 
swollen  aspect  to  the  face,  which  is  increased  by  the  thickness  of 
the  lips.  These  tusks  are  instruments  of  defence  and  of  progres- 
sion ;  and  are  also  very  serviceable  to  the  animal  in  obtaining  its 
food.  It  uses  them  with  great  effect  in  defending  itself  from 
the  attacks  of  the  Polar  Bear,  which  may  be  regarded  as  its 
chief  adversary  ;  it  assists  itself  with  them,  in  climbing  up  float- 
ing icebergs  and  the  sides  of  rocks ;  and  it  employs  them  to 
tear  up  the  long  wreaths  of  sea- weed,  which  constitute  a  great 
part  of  its  food.  In  the  lower  jaw  there  are  no  incisors  or 
canines;  and  the  jaw  itself  is  narrow  in  front,  so  as  to  fit  in 
between  the  large  canines  of  the  upper.  The  Walrus  is  pursued 
for  the  sake  of  its  oil  and  skin ;  its  flesh  also  is  very  palatable. 
It  inhabits  the  polar  regions  of  both  hemispheres  ;  but  it  is  much 
less  abundant  than  formerly. 

204.  The  animals  of  this  family  are  of  the  greatest  use  to 
the  natives  of  the  countries  near  which  they  abound ;  the  fol- 
lowing account  of  the  various  purposes,  to  which  the  Seal  is 
applied  by  the  Greenlanders,  is  given  by  Crantz,  a  Danish 
traveller.  "  Its  flesh  supplies  them  with  their  most  palatable 
and  substantial  food  ;  the  fat  furnishes  them  with  oil  for  lamp- 
light, chamber  and  kitchen  fire  ;  and  whoever  sees  their  habita- 
tions presently  finds  that,  even  if  they  had  superfluity  of  wood, 
it  would  not  be  of  use, — they  can  use  nothing  but  oil  in  them. 
They  also  mollify  their  dry  food,  mostly  fish,  with  oil;  and 
finally  they  barter  it  for  all  kinds  of  necessaries  with  the  factors. 
They  can  sew  better  with  fibres  of  the  seals'  sinews  than 
with  thread  or  silk ;  of  the  skins  of  the  entrails  they  make 
window-curtains  for  their  tents,  and  shirts  ;  part  of  the  bladder 
they  use  as  a  float  to  their  harpoons ;  and  they  make  oil-flasks 
of  the  stomach.  Neither  is  the  blood  wasted ;  but  is  boiled  up 


GEOGRAPHICAL    DISTRIBUTION    OF   CARNIVORA.  235 

with  other  ingredients  and  eaten  as  soup.  Of  the  skin  of  the 
seal  they  stand  in  the  greatest  need ;  because  they  must  cover 
with  seal-skins  both  the  large  and  small  boats,  in  which  they 
travel  and  seek  their  provisions.  They  must  also  cut  out  of  them 
their  thongs  and  straps,  and  cover  their  tents  with  them,  without 
which  they  could  not  subsist  in  summer.  No  man,  therefore,  can 
pass  for  a  right  Greenlander,  who  cannot  catch  seals.  This  ia 
the  ultimate  end  they  aspire  at,  in  all  their  device  and  labour  from 
their  childhood,  up." 


205.  There  are  some  points  of  much  interest,  in  the  Geogra- 
phical distribution  of  the  Carnivora  at  present  inhabiting  the 
globe;  as  well  as  in  the  Geological  distribution  of  the  fossil 
remains,  which  indicate  the  races  that  existed   in  its  several 
quarters,  at  former  epochs.     We  cannot  but  be  struck,  when  we 
consider  the  distribution  of  the  typical  family, — the  FELID^J, — 
with  their  almost  entire  restriction  to  the  tropical  regions,  and  to 
the   countries  bordering  on  them  ;  and  with  their  consequent 
absence  from  Europe,  and  from  the  northern  parts  of  Asia  and 
America, — the  comparatively  small  and  feeble  Wild  Cat  being 
the  only  representative  of  the  Lions,  Tigers,  Panthers,  Jaguars, 
&c.,   of  the   tropics. — The   same  may   be   said   of  the  family 
VIVERRID^E  ;  of  which  the  Genet  is  the  only  European  repre- 
sentative, whilst  the  tropical  regions  contain  not  only  the  Civets 
and  Ichneumons,  with  many  allied  species,  but  the  savage  and 
formidable   Hyaena   and   Proteles.     On   the   other   hand,    the 
CANID.E  and  the  MUSTELID^J  are  more  abundant  in  temperate 
climates ;  and  the  PHOCID^E  in  the  colder  regions ;  whilst  the 
URSIDJE  seem  to  have  been  everywhere  distributed,  though  they 
are  now   being    gradually   expelled   from    Europe   and  North 
America  by  the  increasing  human  population. 

206.  Now   there   is  abundant   evidence, — derived  from  the 
fossil  remains  which  occur  in  the  newer  tertiary  strata  (those 
that  lie  above  the  chalk),  in  gravel  beds,  and  in  caves, — that  the 
larger   Feline  and   Viverrine  animals  were  formerly  distributed 


236  GEOLOGICAL    DISTRIBUTION    OP   CARNIVORA. 

much  more  extensively ; — that  Lions  and  Tigers,  of  greater  bulk 
than  any  at  present  existing,  formerly  roamed  over  the  plains, 
and  inhabited  the  jungles  of  Europe,  and  even  of  our  own  country ; 
and  that  gigantic  Hyaenas  and  enormous  Bears  dwelt  in  the 
caves,  which  occur  so  frequently  in  our  limestone  rocks,  dragging 
thither  the  carcasses  of  the  animals  they  had  slaughtered,  and 
prowling  about  at  night,  with  glaring  eyes,  and  savage  howls,  in 
search  of  prey.*  In  many  of  these  caves  are  now  found  vast 
heaps  of  bones  of  the  animals  thus  destroyed,  which  must  have 
accumulated  during  many  years  ;  together  with  the  bones  of  the 
rapacious  beasts  which  had  their  dwelling  there ;  and  it  is  a 
remarkable  proof  that  these  caves  really  were  the  dens  of  Hyaenas, 
and  that  the  collections  of  bones  found  in  them  were  not  merely 
washed  into  their  entrances  by  some  great  convulsion  which 
swept  these  races  from  this  part  of  our  globe, — that  many  of  the 
bones  of  the  Oxen,  Antelopes,  Deer,  &c.,  which  accompany 
them,  bear  the  distinct  marks  of  the  Hyaena's  teeth;  and  that  the 
fossilised  excrements  of  these  last  animals  (which,  like  those  of 
other  Carnivora,  are  nearly  white,  consisting  of  little  else  than 
bone-earth,)  have  been  clearly  recognised.  The  existence  of 
these  gigantic  Carnivora  in  what  are  now  the  temperate  regions 
of  the  globe,  seems  clearly  to  indicate  that  the  climate  of  these 
parts  must  have  been  formerly  much  warmer  than  at  present ;  a 
conclusion  which  is  confirmed  by  many  other  circumstances.  (See 
Treatise  on  GEOLOGY).  It  is  further  interesting  to  remark,  that 
as,  at  the  present  time,  we  only  find  the  larger  Carnivora 
existing  in  countries  inhabited  by  large  species  of  Herbivorous 
quadrupeds,  on  which  they  may  prey,  so,  in  former  epochs,  we 
never  find  the  one  set  of  races  present  without  the  other ; — the 
Herbivorous  to  supply  the  Carnivora  with  food, — the  Carnivora 
to  restrain  the  otherwise  excessive  multiplication  of  the  Herbivora, 
and  to  remove  their  decomposing  remains  from  the  surface  of 
the  earth. 

*  In  a  fissure  recently  laid  open  on  Durdliam  Down,  near  Bristol,  are  found, 
besides  numerous  other  remains,  teeth  of  Hyaenas,  as  much  surpassing  in  size  those 
of  the  largest  Tiger  now  existing,  as  these  last  exceed  those  of  the  largest  Hyaena. 


237 


ORDER  VI.— CETACEA. 

207.  This  order,  in  regard  to  the  number  of  species  included 
in  it,  ranks  nearly  the  lowest  "among  the  orders  of  Mammalia ; 
but  in  regard  to  the  bulk  of  the  individuals  which  it  contains,  it 
far  surpasses  every  other  tribe  of  animals  at  present  existing, 
being  only  rivalled  by  some  of  the  gigantic  Lizards  of  former 
epochs.      No  terrestrial  quadruped,  not  even  the  Elephant  and 
Hippopotamus,  can  be  compared  to  the  Whale ;  and  even  the 
smallest  species,  the  Dolphins  and  Porpoises,  much  surpass  the 
average  size  of  land  animals.     As  already  mentioned  (§  24), 
the  form  of  the  animals  of  the  Whale  tribe  bears  so  strong  a 
resemblance  to  that  of  Fishes,  that  most  of  the  ancient  Zoologists, 
and  even  some  modern  ones,  placed  them  in  the  same  class ;  and 
they  are  still  spoken  of  as  "  fish"  in  common  parlance,  notwith- 
standing that  a  knowledge  of  their  internal  structure  has  shown 
that  they  are,  in  every  essential  respect,  Mammals. 

208.  The  modifications  in  the  form  of  the  body,  which  have 
been  pointed  out  as  adapting  the  Seals  for  aquatic  progression, 
are  here  carried  still  further.     The  body  is  still  more  lengthened, 


FIG.  120.— TAIL-FIN  OF  WHALE. 


the  tapering  of  its  hinder  portion  still  more  gradual,  and  the 
anterior  extremities  still  more  exclusively  adapted  for  propulsion 


238  ORDER    CETACEA  J    GENERAL    CHARACTERS. 

in  water.  But  there  is  a  marked  difference  in  the  arrangement 
of  the  posterior  instruments  of  propulsion  ;  for  the  pelvis  and 
hinder  extremities  are  here  entirely  wanting  (or,  at  least,  only 
rudiments  of  them  can  be  discovered),  and  the  tail  is  expanded 
horizontally,  so  as  to  present  a  large  surface  for  striking  the 
water.  In  some  of  the  larger  species,  the  breadth  of  this  tail -fin 
is  20  feet,  and  its  surface  not  less  than  100  square  feet.  The 
force  with  which  it  strikes  the  water  is  enormous,  the  muscles  by 
which  it  is  moved  being  of  prodigious  size.  The  greatest  rapidity 
of  motion  is  produced,  when  its  strokes  are  alternately  upwards 
and  downwards;  but  the  more  ordinary  progression  of  the 
animals  is  accomplished  by  an  oblique  movement  of  the  tail 
downwards  and  laterally,  first  to  one  side  and  then  to  the  other ; 
much  in  the  same  manner  as  a  boat  is  propelled  by  sculling.  The 
vertical  motion  of  the  tail  is  most  employed,  when  the  animal 
desires  to  come  to  the  surface  to  breathe. — The  paddles  or 
swimming  paws  are  comparatively  short ;  but,  as  the  enormous 

development  of  the 
head  in  the  true 
"Whales  causes  them  to 
be  situated  near  the 
centre  of  gravity  of 
the  whole  mass,  they 
act  with  considerable 
power.  They  contain 
the  same  bones  as  the 
anterior  extremities  of 
other  Mammals ;  but 

P.O.  WI.-SWU.MING.PAW  or  WHA.K.  thfi7  m  ™Te  COMoli- 

dated  together  than  in 

any  of  the  orders  we  have  yet  considered  ;  and  there  is  but  little 
motion  except  at  the  shoulder-joint.  They  are  completely 
enveloped  in  a  thick  skin ;  which  prevents  any  trace  of  these 
bones  from  being  seen  externally. 

209.  The  character  of  the  skin  in  these  animals  is  very  pecu- 
liar. In  other  animals  in  which  there  is  a  tendency  to  the 
accumulation  of  oily  matter,  it  is  disposed  as  a  layer  of  adipose 


ORDER   CETACEA  ;    GENERAL   CHARACTERS.  239 

tissue  (ANIM.  PHYSIOL.,  §  44)  beneath  the  skin ;  but  in  the 
Cetacea  it  is  deposited  in  the  substance  of  the  skin  itself,  which 
is  of  enormous  thickness,  consisting  of  elastic  fibres  interlacing 
in  every  direction,  in  the  interstices  of  which  the  oil  is  contained. 
This  substance  is  commonly  known  as  blubber.  The  arrangement 
which  has  been  described  appears  to  serve  two  purposes;  it 
serves  to  keep  in  the  heat  of  the  body,  which  would  otherwise 
be  too  rapidly  carried  off  by  the  conducting  power  of  the  water 
in  which  it  floats ;  and  it  enables  these  animals  to  sustain  the 
enormous  pressure,  to  which  they  are  subjected,  when  they  sink 
deep  below  the  surface, — a  pressure  sometimes  amounting  to  a 
ton  upon  every  square  inch.  The  thickness  of  this  layer  of 
blubber  is  never  less  than  several  inches,  and  it  is  sometimes 
between  one  and  two  feet ;  its  weight  not  unfrequently  amounts 
to  thirty  tons ;  but  being  lighter  than  water,  it  buoys  up  the 
enormous  body  which  it  incloses,  instead  of  weighing  it  down. — 
The  remarkable  conformation  of  the  circulating  apparatus,  by 
which  the  necessity  for  frequent  respiration  is  dispensed  with,  has 
been  elsewhere  described  (ANIM.  PHYSIOL.,  §  265). — The  act  of 
respiration  is  facilitated  by  the  position  of  the  nostrils,  which  are 
situated  nearly  at  the  highest  point  of  the  head ;  so  that  the 
animal  can  breathe  as  soon  as  the  head  comes  to  the  surface  of 
the  water.  The  Whales  have  the  power  of  forcing  out  water 
through  these  passages,  by  means  of  a  peculiar  apparatus  with 
which  they  are  provided.  This  consists  of  two  pouches  or  reser- 
voirs, situated  beneath  the  nostrils,  and  communicating  with  the 
back  of  the  mouth  by  the  usual  nasal  passage,  which  is  furnished 
with  a  valve.  When  the  animal  wishes  to  eject  water  contained 
in  its  mouth,  it  moves  its  tongue  and  jaws  as  if  about  to  swallow 
it ;  but,  by  closing  the  pharynx,  it  compels  the  water  to  ascend 
through  the  nasal  passage,  whose  valve  it  forces  open,  and  to 
distend  the  reservoirs.  There  it  may  be  retained,  until  the 
animal  desires  to  spout ;  and  this  is  effected  by  a  forcible  com- 
pression of  the  pouches,  which  compels  the  water  to  escape  by  the 
nostrils  or  blow-holes,  its  return  to  the  mouth  being  prevented 
by  the  valve  just  mentioned.  The  aperture  of  the  nostrils  is 
guarded  by  a  conical  valve  or  stopper ;  composed  of  numerous 


240  ORDER    CETACEA ;    GENERAL    CHARACTERS. 

fibres  so  closely  interwoven  and  compressed,  that  it  is  difficult  to 
cut  it  with  a  knife ;  and  so  perfectly  adapted  to  the  opening,  that 
not  even  the  enormous  pressure  j^st  now  stated  can  disturb  or 
injure  it,  or  force  a  drop  of  water  between  its  sides,  and  the  tube 
which  it  closes.  Of  the  sense  of  smell,  the  Whale  can  possess 
but  little.  The  aperture  of  the  ear  is  closed  by  a  similar 
valve.  It  appears  that,  when  under  water,  the  Whale  can  hear 
the  smallest  sounds,  such  as  the  slightest  splash  of  an  oar ;  but 
that  to  sounds  in  the  air  above,  even  the  report  of  a  cannon,  it  is 
insensible. 

210.  The  Cetacea  are  all  carnivorous  ;  but  the  nature  of 
their  food  varies  considerably.  In  some  it  consists  of  Fishes  ; 
others  seem  peculiarly  to  prefer  the  Cuttle-fish ;  others  feed  upon 
the  smaller  species  of  their  own  order ;  whilst  the  Whale,  the 
largest  of  all,  is  supported  chiefly  by  minute  Mollusks  and 
Medusae. — The  teeth  vary  extremely  in  the  different  genera ;  and 
cannot  be  alone  trusted  to,  as  characters  for  subdividing  the  order 
into  families.  Excluding  the  MANATID^, — which,  though  Whale- 
like  animals,  belong  to  the  herbivorous  series,  and  differ  from  the 
true  Cetacea  in  many  important  particulars, — we  may  naturally 
divide  the  order  into  three  families. — 1 .  DELPHINID.E,  or  Dol- 
phin tribe,  characterised  by  the  moderate  size  of  the  head  ;  and 
usually  by  the  presence  of  teeth  in  both  jaws. — 2.  CATODONTID^E, 
the  Cachalots  or  Spermaceti-Whales,  characterised  by  the  very 
large  size  of  the  head,  which  constitutes  one-third,  or  even  nearly 
one-half,  of  the  entire  length  ;  and  also  by  the  presence  of  teeth 
in  the  lower  jaw. — 3.  BAL^NHXE,  the  Whalebone-Whales,  also 
distinguished  by  the  enormous  size  of  the  head,  but  altogether 
destitute  of  teeth. 

211.  The  family  DELPHINID^;  includes,  with  the  Dolphin 
and  Porpoise,  many  animals  which  are  ordinarly  called  Whales. 
A  large  proportion  of  these  are  occasional  visitants  of  our  own 
coasts,  especially  towards  the  north  of  Scotland,  and  off  the 
Orkney  and  Shetland  islands.  The  teeth  are  usually  numerous ; 
simple  in  their  structure,  and  conical  in  form. — The  common 
Porpoise  is  an  active  and  voracious  animal,  feeding  especially 
upon  fish,  and  following  in  the  wake  of  the  shoals  of  Herring  and 


FAMILY    DELPHINID^E. PORPOISE,    DOLPHIN,    GRAMPUS.     241 

other  species  which  periodically  visit  our  coasts.     It  frequents, 
often  in  large  troops,  the  bays  and  inlets  of  our  coasts,  and  espe- 


Fio.  122. — PORPOISE. 

cially  the  mouths  of  rivers  ;  and  occasionally  advances  to  a  con- 
siderable distance  up  the  stream.  It  is  very  common  in  the 
estuary  of  the  Thames.  Its  length  is  from  four  to  eight  feet. 
The  Dolphin  chiefly  differs  from  the  Porpoise  in  having  the 
muzzle  prolonged  into  a  kind  of  slender  beak.  It  is  a  peculiarly 
agile  animal ;  and  often  follows  ships  in  numerous  herds,  execut- 
ing the  most  amusing  gambols,  apparently  for  no  other  purpose 
than  mere  pastime.  The  flesh  of  the  Dolphin  and  Porpoise  was 
formerly  used  as  food ;  but  it  is  rank  and  oily,  and  is  now  seldom 
or  never  eaten.  The  length  of  the  common  Dolphin  is  from  six 
to  eight  or  even  ten  feet. — The  Grampus  is  another  animal  of 
this  family,  nearly  allied  to  the  Porpoise,  and  chiefly  distinguished 
from  it  by  its  high  dorsal  fin.  It  is  very  powerful  and  vora- 
cious ;  and  preys  not  only  upon  Fishes,  but  upon  the  smaller 
Cetacea.  The  stories  of  its  attacking  the  Whale,  however,  are 
probably  without  foundation.  The  Grampus  is  less  disposed  to 
associate  with  others  of  its  kind,  than  are  most  of  the  Del- 
phinidae ;  but  it  is  sometimes  seen  in  shoals  of  six  or  eight. 
The  Author  has  known  one  to  keep  company  with  a  ship  for 
several  days  ;  swimming  round  and  round  it,  when  it  was  going 
through  the  water  at  the  rate  of  eight  or  ten  miles  an  hour,  with 
the  greatest  ease. — Another  allied  species  is  the  Round-headed 
Porpoise^  or  Caaing  Whale,  which  is  remarkable  for  its  tendency 
to  associate  in  large  numbers,  and  for  its  strong  instinct  of 
attachment.  It  not  unfrequently  appears  on  the  shores  of  the 
Orkney,  Shetland,  and  Feroe  islands,  and  also  of  Iceland,  in 
herds  of  from  two  or  three  hundred  to  a  thousand  in  number ; 


242    FAMILY  DELPHINIDJE; — CAAING  WHALE,  NARWHAL,  ETC. 

the  fishermen  of  the  neighbourhood  endeavour  to  close  in  upon 
them  from  without,  and  drive  them  towards  the  beach  ;  and  no 
sooner  is  one  individual  driven  on  shore,  than  the  rest  of  the  herd 
rush  with  a  blind  impetuosity  towards  the  spot,  and  throw 
themselves  forwards  with  such  violence,  that  they  are  stranded 
on  the  beach,  and  become  an  easy  prey  to  their  pursuers.  There 
is  reason  to  believe,  that  the  cries  of  distress  uttered  by  the  first 
victims  attract  the  others  to  their  rescue;  and  that  their  de- 
struction is  thus  due  to  their  strong  attachment  to  each  other. 
It  is  thought  by  others,  however,  that  they  are  led  towards  the 
shore  by  their  tendency  to  follow  their  leaders  with  a  blind  con- 
fidence. The  common  name  of  this  species,  "  Caaing,"  is  under- 
stood to  mean  "  driving"  in  Zetland. — The  Beluga,  or  White 
Whale,  an  allied  genus,  is  remarkable  for  the  clear  white  hue  of 
its  skin,  which  is  slightly  tinged  with  yellowish  or  rose  colour. 
It  rarely  visits  our  own  coasts  ;  but  is  often  seen  in  the  northern 
regions,  sporting,  feeding,  and  migrating,  in  herds  of  moderate 
numbers.  Its  teeth  are  fewer  in  number  than  are  those  of  most 
other  Delphinidae ;  and  of  the  few  which  it  possesses,  the  greater 
number  fall  out  before  it  attains  an  advanced  age. 

212.  There  are  some  aberrant  genera  of  this  family,  in  which 
the  number  of  teeth  is  small  ;  or  in  which  they  are  even  entirely 
absent  from  one  of  the  jaws.  This  is  the  case  with  the  Hype- 
roodon,  or  Bottle-head  Whale,  in  which  there  are  only  two  teeth, 
and  these  situated  in  the  lower  jaw.  It  is  a  large  animal,  usually 
more  than  twenty  feet  long ;  it  rarely  visits  our  coasts  and 
little  is  known  of  it.*  A  much  more  remarkable  animal  is  the 
Monodon,  or  Narwhal,  commonly  known  as  the  Sea  Unicorn  ; 
which  derives  its  name  from  its  obvious  peculiarity, — the  presence 
(in  the  Male)  of  a  single  tooth  of  great  length,  projecting  from 
the  front  of  the  upper  jaw.  The  usual  length  of  this  extraor- 
dinary appendage  is  about  six  feet ;  but  it  sometimes  reaches 
nine  or  even^ten  feet.  It  is  quite  straight,  and  tapers  gradually 
from  its  base  to  its  point ;  but  it  has  a  spiral  twist  from  left  to 
right.  It  would  be  a  strange  anomaly  if  such  a  weapon  were 

*  A  specimen  -was  taken  a  few  years  since  in  the  Severn,  -whose  length  was 
twenty-two  feet ;  its  skeleton  is  now  in  the  Museum  of  the  Bristol  Institution. 


FAMILY    DELPHINID^E  ; NARWHAL,    INIA.  243 

really  tingle  ;  but  the  fact  is,  that  the  rudiments  of  two  teeth 
are  always  present,  and  this  not  in  the  male  only,  but  in  the 
female.  Sometimes  the  tooth  on  the  right  side  is  developed ; 
sometimes  that  on  the  left ;  the  corresponding  tooth  remaining 
small,  or  even  permanently  concealed.  But  instances  are  occa- 
sionally met  with,  in  which  both  teeth  have  been  developed  to  a 
considerable  extent, — even  in  the  female.  The  use  of  the  tooth 
seems  to  be  merely  that  of  an  organ  of  defence  ;  it  cannot  assist 
the  animal  in  obtaining  its  food ;  for  this  consists  merely  of 
mollusks  and  other  soft  animals.  Its  body  much  resembles  that  of 
the  Beluga  in  form,  and  agrees  with  it  in  being  without  a  dorsal 
fin.  It  is  an  active  powerful  creature,  swimming  with  almost 
incredible  swiftness ;  it  inhabits  the  northern  seas,  rarely 
coming  so  far  south  as  even  the  Orkney  Islands.  When*  attacked, 
it  shows  great  ferocity ;  and  has  been  known  to  drive  its  horn, 
or  rather  tusk,  deep  into  the  thick  oak  timbers  of  a  ship. 
Besides  these,  may  be  mentioned  the  Inia  ;  a  remarkable  fresh- 
water genus  of  Delphinidae,  of  which  only  one  species  is  known, 
recently  discovered  in  the  remote  tributaries  of  the  Amazons, 
and  the  elevated  lakes  of  Peru,  some  thousands  of  miles  from  the 
sea.  It  has  the  external  form  of  the  Dolphin,  with  some  coarse 
bristly  hairs  on  the  snout ;  the  lips  are  deeply  cleft ;  and  the 
nostrils  are  placed  far  back,  above  the  paddles.  A  female  speci- 
men measured  seven  feet  in  length  ;  and  the  males  are  stated  to 
be  double  that  size. 

213.  Of  the  family  CATODONTID^E,  only  two  species  are 
known  ;  the  common  Cachalot,  or  Spermaceti  "Whale  ;  and  the 
high-finned  Cachalot.  The  former  is  the  one  which  is  the  object 
of  pursuit,  on  account  of  the  oil  and  spermaceti  which  it  yields; 
the  latter  is  comparatively  rare.  The  head  of  the  Spermaceti 
Whale  nearly  equals  the  rest  of  the  body  in  length,  and  surpasses 
it  in  bulk.  This  enormous  size,  however,  is  not  due  to  the  great 
development  of  the  brain ;  but  to  the  presence  of  a  very  large 
receptacle  for  the  spermaceti,  which  lies  in  a  hollow  on  the  upper 
part  of  the  cranium.  This  receptacle  consists  of  a  dense  bag, 
divided  into  compartments ;  and  the  substance  which  it  contains 
is  in  a  semi-fluid  state,  consisting  of  spermaceti  united  with  oil. 


244        FAMILY  CATODONTIDE; — SPERMACETI  WHALE. 

The  oil  is  separated  by  draining  and  squeezing ;  and  the  sper- 
maceti is  purified  by  melting  it  in  water.  A  similar  oleaginous 
substance  exists  in  cavities  placed  along  the  back,  and  in  other 
parts  of  the  body.  The  Spermaceti  Whale  is  also  furnished  with 
a  layer  of  blubber,  which  yields  a  thinner  and  purer  oil  than 
that  of  the  Common  Whale  ;  but  its  amount  is  less.  Another 
substance  of  some  value  is  yielded  by  this  animal, — namely, 
ambergris.  This  is  a  rather  hard  brittle  matter  of  a  gray  colour, 
having  a  peculiar  odour,  for  which  it  is  much  esteemed  by 
some  persons  as  an  agreeable  perfume;  it  is  formed  by  a 
secretion  within  the  intestines,  and  seems  to  be  a  product  of 
diseased  action,  occasioned  by  the  accumulation  of  indigestible 
substances.  The  Cachalot  sometimes  reaches  the  length  of  seventy 
feet.  It  is  a  very  powerful  animal,  and  swims  with  considerable 
rapidity  ;  and  from  the  violence  of  its  fury  when  attacked,  it  is 
one  of  the  most  dangerous  of  the  monsters  of  the  deep,  with 
which  the  daring  sailor  is  called  upon  to  combat.  Not  only  are 
the  strong  whaling  boats  occasionally  dashed  to  pieces  by  a 
single  blow  of  the  tail,  but  even  a  ship  of  large  size  has  had  its 
bottom  stove  in  by  a  blow  inflicted  by  the  head  of  an  infuriated 
male  Cachalot.  The  Spermaceti  Whale  is  found  in  all  seas ;  but 
is  most  abundant  in  those  near  the  southern  pole.  It  associates 
in  small  parties,  which  usually  consist  of  half-grown  males,  or  of 
females  attended  by  their  young,  and  guarded  by  one  or  two  very 
large  males.  When  solitary  Cachalots  are  observed,  they  inva- 
riably prove  to  be  aged  males.  The  food  of  these  gigantic 
animals  consists  of  fishes,  cuttle-fish,  &c. 

214.  The  family  BALJENID^  or  Whalebone  Whales,  contains 
two  genera,  each  including  but  one  species ;  these  are  the  Balcena, 
or  Greenland  Whale,  and  the  Balcenoptera,  or  Rorqual.  The 
former  is  the  one  best  known ;  the  latter  is  distinguished  from 
it  by  the  slenderer  form  of  the  head,  and  by  the  presence  of  a 
dorsal  fin.  In  both  there  is  an  absence  of  teeth  (although  the 
rudiments  of  them  may  be  detected  in  each  jaw),  and  the  palate 
is  furnished  with  an  apparatus  for  straining  out  the  small 
mollusks,  minute  fishes,  and  medusae,  on  which  these  huge 
animals  are  supported.  This  consists  of  a  series  of  plates  of 


FAMILY 


;  -  GREENLAND    WHALE. 


245 


baleen,  or  whalebone,  which  are  suspended  from  the  roof  of  the 
mouth  ;  the  base  of  each  plate  is  imbedded  in  the  substance  of 


Fro.  123. — GREENLAND  WHALE. 

the  gum,  or  membrane  that  covers  the  palate ;  whilst  its  edge 

forms  a  sort  of  loose 
fringe,  composed  of 
matted  fibres.  The  fila- 
ments of  the  fringe  fill 
up  the  cavity  of  the 
mouth,  sufficiently  to 
form  a  most  complete 
sieve.  When  the  im- 
mense mouth  of  the 
Whale  is  opened,  a  great 
number  of  the  small 
marine  animals  with 

which  the  Arctic  seas  are  often  crowded,  are  engulphed  in  its  vast 
cavity  ;  and  the  water  being  got  rid  of  by  the  process  of  spouting, 
already  described,  all  that  floated  in  it  is  retained  within  the 
mouth  upon  the  fringes  of  baleen.  In  this  manner  the  gigantic 
fabric  of  this  animal  derives  its  nutriment ;  though  its  swallow  is 
not  large  enough  to  admit  even  small  fish.  The  Whale  usually 
rises  to  the  surface  to  breathe,  about  every  seven  or  eight  minutes; 
but  it  can  remain  under  water  for  half  an  hour,  or  even  longer. 
When  struck  with  the  harpoon,  it  descends  rapidly  to  a  great 


FIG.  124. — WHALEBONE  AND  SKULL  OF  WHALE. 


246  GREENLAND    WHALE. — ORDER    RODENTIA. 

depth,  —  sometimes  nearly  1000  fathoms ;  and  it  has  been 
known  to  strike  itself  so  violently  against  the  hard  bed  of  the 
ocean,  as  even  to  fracture  its  jaws.  This  Whale  usually  lives  in 
pairs,  but  sometimes  the  abundance  of  food  in  a  particular  spot 
draws  a  number  together.  The  female  shows  the  most  devoted 
attachment  to  her  young  ;  always  coming  to  its  assistance  when 
it  is  attacked,  even  to  her  own  certain  destruction.  The  length 
of  the  Greenland  Whale  is  from  60  to  70,  or  even  80  feet ;  that 
of  the  Rorqual  (of  which  a  skeleton  was  exhibited  not  long  since 
in  the  principal  towns  of  this  country)  often  exceeds  100  feet. 
The  latter  is  not  often  chased ;  as  the  quantity  of  blubber  it 
yields  is  small,  and  the  whalebone  of  inferior  quality. 


ORDER  YIL— RODENTIA. 

215.  We  now  proceed  to  the  Herbivorous  series  of  the  higher 
division  of  the  Class  Mammalia ;  and  we  shall  have  to  notice  in 
it  a  series  of  forms  very  different  from  those  which  have  hitherto 
engaged  our  attention.  The  order  RODENTIA,  which  next  presents 
itself  to  our  consideration,  occupies,  in  many  respects,  an  inter- 
mediate place  between  the  purely  carnivorous  and  the  purely 
herbivorous  Mammalia,  so  as  to  form  the  connecting  link  between 
them.  We  have  seen  that  in  the  first  (with  the  exception  of  the 
Cetacea,  which  are  aberrant  forms  of  the  Carnivorous  series,  and 
a  few  other  aberrant  genera),  three  kinds  of  teeth  are  always 
found  ;  the  bones  of  the  fore-arm  are  separate,  so  that  the  hand, 
or  fore-foot,  has  the  power  of  rotation ;  and  that  the  fingers  are 
distinct,  and  terminated  by  separate  nails  or  claws.  In  the 
Ruminant  quadrupeds,  which  may  be  considered  as  the  types  of 
the  second  group,  there  is  a  complete  want  of  canine  teeth  ;  the 
bones  of  the  fore-arm  are  consolidated  together,  so  that  the  fore- 
foot loses  all  power  of  rotation  ;  and  the  bones  of  the  toes  are 
also  partly  united,  and  their  extremities  inclosed  in  a  hoof,  which 
totally  destroys  the  power  of  prehension,  and  blunts  the  sensibi- 
lity of  the  organ,  so  that  it  becomes  merely  an  instrument  of 
support  and  motion.  Now  in  the  order  RODENTIA,  or  Gnawers, 


ORDER  RODENTIA;  GENERAL  CHARACTERS.  247 

we  observe  an  interesting  gradation  between  these  two  divisions 
of  the  class.  Although  the  animals  comprising  it  are  chiefly 
adapted  to  a  vegetable  diet,  their  feet  are  endowed  with  a  greater 
variety  of  function,  than  are  those  of  the  Ruminant  quadrupeds. 
They  are  still,  like  those  of  the  Carnivora,  unguiculated^  or  fur- 
nished with  claws ;  their  toes  remain  separate,  as  do  also,  for  the 
most  part,  the  bones  of  the  fore-arm ;  and  in  many  species  the 
clavicles  or  collar-bones  are  present,  which  serve  to  keep  apart 
the  shoulders,  and  thus  to  give  to  the  upper  extremities  a  greater 
freedom  of  motion. 

216.  The  chief  peculiarity  of  this  order  is  seen  in  the  remark- 
able conformation  of  the  teeth.  All  the  animals  which  it  includes 
may  be  at  once  recognised  by  the  presence  of  two  large  cutting 
teeth,  which  project  from  the  front  of  each  jaw.  These  teeth 

have  been  usually  regarded  as  inci- 
sors ;  but  they  are  really  canines^ 
the  direction  of  which  has  been 
changed  by  the  absence  of  the  inci- 
sors ;  this  is  proved  by  the  fact  that, 
in  the  Hare,  and  a  few  others  of  the 
order,  small  true  incisors  may  be 
seen  behind  the  two  large  gnawing 

P.O.  125.-SKU.L  OP  ROX.KKT  ANNUL.  ^^       ^^  approach  to  this  strUC- 

ture  may  be  seen  in  the  Lemur  tribe,  especially  in  the  Aye-aye, 
which  was  placed  by  Cuvier  among  the  Rodentia  (§  164). 
The  conformation  of  the  gnawing  teeth  is  beautifully  adapted  to 
the  purpose  they  have  to  fulfil.  In  order  to  make  their  way 
through  tough  vegetable  substances,  a  sharp  edge  is  required  for 
them  ;  and  they  must  at  the  same  time  possess  great  strength 
and  firmness.  For  this  purpose,  the  tooth  is  principally  com- 
posed of  very  tough  t'wry,  with  a  plate  of  hard  enamel  in  front 
only  (See  ANIM.  PHYSIOL.,  §  177-180).  By  the  friction 
of  the  teeth  against  each  other,  their  substance  is  continually 
being  worn  down ;  but  the  hard  enamel  of  course  wears  most 
slowly,  and  is  always  left  as  a  sharp  projecting  edge.  These 
teeth  differ  also  from  any  which  exist  in  the  Mammalia  previously 
described,  in  the  circumstance  that  their  growth  is  continually 


248  ORDER  RODENTIA;  GENERAL  CHARACTERS. 

going  on,  instead  of  stopping  at  an  early  period  of  life.  Each 
tooth  passes  far  backwards  into  the  jaw,  and  is  quite  hollow  at  its 
lower  extremity,  which  is  filled  wi^li  pulp  ;  from  the  surface  of 
this,  new  ivory  is  continually  formed,  and  thus  the  tooth  is  con- 
stantly being  pushed  up,  at  about  the  same  rate  as  it  is  worn 
away  at  the  top,  so  that  its  edge  is  kept  up  to  its  proper  level. 
If,  however,  in  consequence  of  the  fracture  of  the  opposite  tooth, 
or  from  any  displacement  of  the  jaw  (which  sometimes  results 
from  accident),  the  usual  wear  of  the  summit  of  the  tooth  does 
not  take  place,  its  length  continues  to  increase,  often  to  the 
great  inconvenience  of  the  animal.  In  fact,  cases  have  been 
known  in  which  death  was  the  result ;  the  unchecked  growth  of 
the  tooth  having  caused  its  point  to  advance  in  a  curve  upwards 
and  backwards,  until  it  penetrated  the  skull  and  entered  the 
brain. — The  molar  teeth,  which  are  separated  from  the  canines 
by  a  wide  interval,  are  composed  of  alternate  plates  of  enamel 
and  ivory ;  the  former  of  which  will,  from  their  slower  wear, 
always  remain  standing  up  in  ridges,  so  as  to  give  a  rasp-like 
surface  to  these  teeth.  The  ridges  are  always  transverse,  or  in 
a  direction  from  side  to  side  of  the  head ;  and  as  the  lower  jaw 
is  endowed,  by  the  peculiar  form  of  its  joint,  with  considerable 
power  of  moving  backwards  and  forwards,  these  teeth  obviously 
become  very  powerful  instruments  for  the  reduction  of  hard 
vegetable  substances.  In  the  frugivorous  (fruit-eating)  species 
of  the  order,  however,  such  as  the  Squirrel,  the  surface  of  the 
molar  teeth  is  raised  into  rounded  tubercles,  as  in  the  frugivorous 
animals  ;  whilst  in  those  which  have  any  carnivorous  tendency, 
such  as  the  Rat,  they  are  raised  into  sharp  points,  so  as  to  bear 
some  resemblance  to  those  of  the  purely  Carnivorous  quadrupeds. 
— The  digestive  apparatus  in  this  order  is  evidently  adapted, 
by  the  length  and  complexity  of  the  alimentary  canal,  to  the 
reduction  and  preparation  of  vegetable  food;  and  this  is  the 
prevailing  habit  of  all  the  animals  which  it  includes.  Their 
function  obviously  is,  to  make  the  hard  portions  of  plants,  which 
are  rejected  by  other  animals,  available  as  nourishment ;  but 
there  are  some  which  are  so  omnivorous  in  their  propensities,  as 
to  devour  with  voracity  almost  anything  that  falls  in  their  way. 


ORDER  RODENTIA;  GENERAL  CHARACTERS.  249 

Of  this  some  extraordinary  instances  will  be  given,  when  the 
Rat  family  is  described. 

217.  The  animals  composing  this  order  are  mostly  of  small 
size, — the  Capylara  (§  234),  which  is  the  largest,  not  equalling  a 
pig  in  bulk :  but  they  are  very  numerous,  and  are  widely 
diffused  over  the  globe.  They  are  most  abundant,  and  present 
themselves  in  the  greatest  variety,  in  South  America ;  whilst 
they  are  the  rarest  in  New  Holland,  which  contains  but  six 
known  species  of  this  order,  its  place  being  occupied  in  that 
region  by  the  rodent  forms  of  the  Marsupialia.  The  Rodentia 
exhibit  considerable  variety  of  disposition;  some  being  very 
docile  and  gentle,  whilst  others  are  savage  and  untameable  :  but 
the  former  is  certainly  the  general  character  of  the  group.  Some 
of  them  are  remarkable  for  the  high  development  of  their 
instinctive  powers,  but  none  of  them  exhibit  any  considerable  de- 
gree of  sagacity  (ANIM.  PHYSIOL.,  Chap.  XIV.)  :  and  their  brain, 
in  the  nearly  entire  absence  of  convolutions,  and  in  other  charac- 
ters, more  resembles  that  of  Birds  than  that  of  the  higher 
Mammalia.  It  has  been  justly  remarked,  that  they  are  more 
easily  tamed  than  educated  ;  their  intelligence  not  being  sufficient 
to  enable  them  to  learn.  These  animals  usually  multiply  very 
fast :  they  produce  large  litters  several  times  a  year ;  and  the 
young  speedily  arrive  at  maturity,  requiring,  for  the  most  part, 
but  little  care  on  the  part  of  their  parents  during  the  period  of 
infancy.  This  is  one  example,  therefore,  of  the  general  prin- 
ciple, the  applications  of  which  have  been  elsewhere  dwelt 
upon,  that,  the  higher  the  development  which  is  ultimately  to  be 
attained  by  a  Plant  or  Animal,  the  longer  is  the  period  of  prepa- 
ration for  it,  and  the  greater  is  the  assistance  which  it  needs 
during  its  early  state.  With  the  exception  of  some  remark- 
able aberrant  forms,  there  is  a  considerable  similarity  throughout 
the  whole  group.  Nearly  all  of  them  agree  in  the  large  size  of 
the  posterior  extremities,  as  compared  with  the  anterior;  and 
this  is  sometimes  almost  as  considerable  as  in  the  Kangaroos.  Most 
of  them  have  the  habit  of  sitting  upon  their  haunches,  and  of 
using  their  anterior  members  for  the  prehension  of  food,  &c. ; — 
not,  however,  as  in  higher  animals,  by  grasping  it  in  either 


250  ORDER  RODENTIA;  GENERAL  CHARACTERS. 

hand,  but   by  holding  it  between  the  two  paws,  as  seen  in 
Fig.  48. 

218.  The  principles  upon  which  iue  division  of  this  order  into 
families  should   be   founded,  have   not  yet  been  satisfactorily 
established.     It  is  convenient,  however,  to  distribute  them  in  the 
first  instance  into  two  sections ;   of  which  the  first,  possessing 
clavicles,  includes  the  Squirrels,  Mice,  and  Beavers;  whilst  to 
the    second,    in   which   the  clavicles  are  nearly  or   completely 
absent,  belong  the   Porcupines,  Hares,  and  Guinea-pigs.     The 
three  principal  families  constituting  the  first  section,  may  be 
distinguished  by  the  form  of  the  tail,  and  the  number  of  the 
molar  teeth.     In  the  SCITJRID.&,  or  Squirrel  tribe,  the  tail  is 
large  and  bushy ;  and  the  molar  teeth  are  four  on  each  side,  with 
a  fifth  in  the  upper  jaw,  which  soon  drops  out.     The  MURID.E, 
or  Mouse  and  Rat  tribe,  have  a  round  scaly  tail,  and  only  three 
molars  on  each  side.     The  family  CASTORID^E,  which  includes 
none  but  the  Beavers^  is  at  once  distinguished  by  the  peculiar 
flattening  of  the  tail,  which  is  covered  with  scales  ;  there  are  four 
molars  on  each  side.     Between  the  two  last  families  may  be 
placed  the  group  of  ARVICOL^E,   or  Voles,  which  include  many 
species  that  are  commonly  termed  Rats  and  Mice ;  but  these  are 
distinguished  by  a  peculiarity  in  their  teeth,  that  indicates  a 
greater  affinity  to  the  Beavers,  with  which  they  are  classed  by 
some   Naturalists. — It  is  remarkable  that  the  Rodents  of  this 
series  should  be  much  more  extensively  diffused  over  the  globe, 
than  those  of  the  families  hereafter  to  be  described.     There  is  no 
part  in  which  some  kinds  of  Mice  and  Rats  are  not  to  be  found ; 
and  Squirrels  are  as  widely  diffused,  with  the  exception  of  New 
Holland.    The  order  is  most  abundant  in  temperate  regions, — the 
reverse  of  which  is  the  case,  in  regard  to  Mammals  of  large  size. 

219.  The  family  SCIURID^J,  or  Squirrel  tribe,  contains  a  large 
number  of  species,  many  of  which  bear  a  strong  resemblance  to 
each  other.     Some  of  them,  like  the  common  Squirrel  of  this 
country,  (Fig.  48,)  have  a  very  extensive  range,  and  are  liable 
to  undergo  great  alterations  in  colour.     The  form  of  this  little 
animal  is  sufficiently  well  known,  to  render  a  particular  descrip- 
tion of  it  unnecessary.     Living  entirely  upon  vegetable  food, — 


ORDER   SCIORIDJ2; — SQUIRREL,    PTEROMYS.  251 

especially  buds  and  young  shoots  in  the  spring  and  summer,  and 
nuts,  acorns,  &c.  in  the  autumn  and  winter, — it  spends  nearly 
its  whole  time  amongst  trees,  leaping  from  branch  to  branch  with 
great  agility,  and  seldom  descending  to  the  ground,  except 
for  the  purpose  of  passing  to  another  tree.  They  are  usually 
found  in  pairs,  which  pairs  are  believed  to  associate  for  life  ;  and 
they  construct  little  spherical  nests,  near  the  tops  of  the  highest 
trees,  by  weaving  twigs  together,  leaving  an  opening  at  the  top. 
In  such  places,  they  and  their  young  are  out  of  the  reach  of  all 
quadruped  foes;  but  they  occasionally  become  the  prey  of 
ravenous  birds,  when  these  roam  on  the  wing  over  the  forests 
they  inhabit.  Some  species  of  Squirrel  associate  in  large 
numbers ;  and  others  so  far  resemble  the  next  family,  as  to  form 
their  nests  by  burrowing  amongst  the  roots  of  trees. — As  already 
mentioned,  the  business  of  the  tail  is  the  peculiar  characteristic 
of  the  Squirrel  tribe ;  and  this  is  of  great  assistance  to  them  in 
leaping ;  for  not  only  does  the  tail  serve  to  guide  them,  but  even 
to  give  them  a  degree  of  support,  its  hairs  spreading  out  sideways, 
when  the  animal  is  in  motion,  into  a  sort  of  feathery  expansion. 


FIG.  126.— FLYING  SQUIRREL. 

In  the  Pteromys,  or  Flying  Squirrel,  this  sustaining  power  is 
much  increased,  by  an  extension  of  the  skin  of  the  flank  between 
the  fore  and  hind  legs ;  and  this,  with  the  tail,  forms  a  kind  of 
parachute,  on  which  the  agile  little  animals  are  sustained  in 
their  long  leaps  from  bough  to  bough,  the  first  impulse  being 
given  by  their  powerful  hind-legs.  But,  as  elsewhere  explained, 


252 


FAMILY    SCITJRIDjE  ; PLYING   SQUIRREL,    MARMOT. 


(ANIM.  PHYSIOL.  §  668,)  this  movement  cannot  be  rightly 
designated  i&  flight ,  since  the  animal  is  not  able  to  propel  itself  in 
the  air,  nor  even  to  sustain  itself  a*  the  same  height. — In  some 
of  the  Squirrels,  the  tail  is  rounder  and  less  bushy  than  in  the 
common  one  of  this  country;  these,  consequently,  have  less 
power  of  taking  sustained  leaps  through  the  air ;  and  they  live 
more  upon  the  ground. 

'  220.  The  Marmot  and  the  Dormouse  seem  to  occupy  an 
intermediate  position  between  this  family  and  the  next.  The 
Marmot  has  been  commonly  associated  with  the  Rats ;  but  in  its 
dentition  it  more  nearly  resembles  the  Squirrels.  The  body  is 


FIG.  127-— ARCTOMYS,  OR  MARMOT. 

heavier,  however,  than  it  usually  is  in  that  family,  and  the  limbs 
are  shorter ;  the  tail  is  of  moderate  length,  and  hairy.  The 
Marmots  construct  extensive  burrows,  with  long  galleries,  pre- 
ferring the  sides  of  high  and  cold  mountains.  They  pass  the 
winter  in  a  state  of  profound  torpidity ;  not  even  occasionally 
arousing  themselves  to  take  nourishment.  They  prepare  a  couch 
of  dry  grass,  in  which  they  nestle  ;  and  they  securely  close  the 
mouth  of  the  burrow,  and  prevent  the  changes  in  the  external 
temperature  from  affecting  their  bodies,  by  carrying  in  a  ball  of 
hay  backwards,  and  drawing  it  firmly  into  the  orifice.  A  sub- 
division of  this  group,  peculiar  to  North  America,  is  remarkable 
for  its  large  cheek-pouches,  which  enable  these  little  animals  to 
carry  the  stores  of  grain  on  which  they  feed.  They  are  described 
by  Dr.  Richardson  as  living  in  communities,  and  as  occasionally 


FAMILY  SCIURID^E; — DORMOUSE,  JERBOA.  253 

gambolling  for  hours  together  near  the  mouths  of  the  burrows  ; 
sentinels  having  been  previously  appointed,  which  indicate  to 
them,  from  some  elevated  situation,  the  approach  of  danger,  and 
which  also  reconnoitre  when  they  are  about  to  go  on  their  preda- 
tory excursions. 

221.  The  Dormouse.,  also,  has  been  commonly  associated  with 
the  Rats ;  but  in  its  general  habits,  the  structure  of  its  teeth, 
and  the  hairiness  of  its  tail,  (which  in  some  species  spreads  out 
into  a  tuft  at  the  end,)  it  presents  a  nearer  approach  to  the 
Squirrels.    It  has  their  lively  expression  and  active  movements  ; 
and,  like  them,  it  builds  a  kind  of  nest  in  the  foliage,  which 
is  usually,  however,  situated  near  the  ground.     A  species  which 
inhabits  Southern  Europe  is  known  to  attack  small  birds ;  but 
the  usual  food  of  that  which  inhabits  this  country,  consists  of 
haws,  young  hazel-nuts,  and  fallen  acorns.     Of  these  it  lays  up 
a  hoard  for  the  winter ;  which  period  is  passed  by  it  in  a  state 
of  almost  constant  torpidity,  though  it  occasionally  awakes  to 
take  food.     The  peculiar  nature  of  this  state  of  Cybernation, — 
which  is  better  displayed  in  the  Dormouse,  than  in  any  other 
warm-blooded  animal  of  our  own  country,  except  the  Bats, — has 
been  elsewhere  explained  (ANIM.  PHYSIOL.  §  309).     The  true 
Squirrels  also  pass  a  large  part  of  the  winter  in  sleep ;  but  they 
frequently  awake  to  take  food,  of  which  they  lay  up  a  plentiful 
store  during  the  autumn. 

222.  Another  intermediate  link  between  the  Squirrels  and 
Rats,  but  agreeing  with  the  latter  rather  than  with  the  former, 
is  the  Jerboa,  which  is  distinguished  by  the  enormous  develop- 
ment of  its  hind-legs  and  tail ;  causing  it  to  bear  considerable 
resemblance  in  form  to  the  Kangaroo  ;  and  enabling  it,  like  that 
animal,  to  take  prodigious  leaps.      It  resembles  the  Squirrels  in 
possessing  a  hairy  and  tufted  tail,  and  also  in  the  disproportion 
of  its  fore  and  hind-legs ;  but  in  the  conformation  of  its  teeth, 
it  is  more  allied  to  the  Rats.   It  is  a  native  of  Egypt,  Syria,  &c. ; 
and  was  known  to  the  ancients  under  the  name  of  Dipus  (two- 
footed),  which  it  still  bears  as  its  scientific  appellation. 

223.  The  family  MURIDJE,  consisting  of  Mice,  Rats,  and  other 
animals  allied  to  them,  contains  the  smallest,  and  at  the  same 


254  FAMILY    MURID^; — BLACK    AND    BROWN    RATS. 

time  the  most  numerous,  of  the  Mammalia.  As  already  men- 
tioned, the  animals  composing  it  are  distinguished  by  their  long 
round  scaly  tails,  and  by  the  presence  of  only  three  molars  in 
each  jaw ;  these  are  originally  furnished  with  rounded  tubercles, 
but  wear  down  into  roughened  disks.  No  undomesticated 
animals  are  better  known  than  mice  and  rats.  Of  the  common 
Mouse,  Cuvier  thus  concisely  speaks, — "  known  in  all  times  and 
in  all  places."  Of  the  Rats,  two  species  are  known  in  this 
country,  in  which  they  have  become  completely  naturalized, 
though  there  is  reason  to  believe  that  neither  is  an  original  inha- 
bitant of  it.  The  Black  Rat  is  commonly  termed  the  old  English 
Rat,  having  been  known  before  the  introduction  of  the  other ; 
but  it  appears  not  to  have  been  known  in  England  before  the 
middle  of  the  16th  century,  when  it  was  introduced  from  France. 
This  is  now  becoming  rather  a  rare  animal  in  this  country ; 
having  been  nearly  extirpated  by  the  other  species,  for  which, 
on  account  of  its  inferior  size  and  strength,  it  is  an  unequal 
match.  It  is  now  chiefly  found  in  the  old  houses  of  large  cities, 
such  as  London  and  Edinburgh  ;  and  especially  in  the  cellars  and 
stables  of  the  former.  The  Brown  species  is  commonly  known 
as  the  Norway  rat ;  but  to  this  title  it  has  no  claim  whatever, 
since  probably  not  a  single  individual  had  existed  in  that  country 
at  the  time  it  received  the  appellation.  It  is  believed  to  have 
originally  come  from  Persia,  where  it  lives  in  immense  burrows ; 
and  is  said  to  have  first  arrived  on  the  European  side  of  the 
Volga  after  an  earthquake  in  1727-  From  that  time  it  gradually 
spread  through  Europe,  and  was  introduced  into  England  about 
the  middle  of  the  last  century.  Its  astonishing  fecundity,  its 
omnivorous  habits,  the  secrecy  of  its  retreats,  and  the  ingenious 
devices  to  which  it  has  recourse,  either  to  retain  its  existing  place 
of  abode,  or  to  migrate  to  a  more  favourable  situation,  all  con- 
duce to  keep  up  its  overwhelming  numbers.  By  its  power  of 
adapting  itself  to  a  great  variety  of  circumstances,  in  regard  to 
food,  temperature,  and  habits,  it  has  been  enabled  to  spread 
itself,  by  means  of  British  vessels,  to  America,  New  Holland, 
and  almost  every  other  part  of  the  globe;  and  has  already 
become  a  source  of  inconvenience  in  many  of  these  localities. 


FAMILY  MURIDJE; — VORACITY  OF  RATS.  2-55 

224.  Both  kinds  of  Rat  are  extremely  voracious,  and  occa- 
sionally show  great  ferocity  when  attacked.  They  have  been 
not  unfrequently  known  to  attack  children  and  infirm  persons 
•when  asleep  ;  and  will  even  "  show  fight "  against  more  power- 
ful opponents.  Of  all  the  Rodentia,  the  Brown  Rat  seems 
most  capable  of  subsisting  upon  an  exclusively  animal  diet ;  of 
this,  the  following  is  a  remarkable  example.  At  Montfau9on,  in 
the  neighbourhood  of  Paris,  is  a  very  large  establishment  for  the 
slaughtering  of  horses ;  and  the  number  of  rats  which  exist  in 
the  neighbourhood,  and  which  gain  their  subsistence  from  this 
source  alone,  is  so  enormous,  that  the  carcasses  of  the  horses 
killed  in  the  course  of  a  day,  (sometimes  amounting  to  thirty- 
five  in  number,)  are  found  the  next  morning  picked  bare  to  the 
bone.  A  proposition  was  made,  some  time  since,  for  the  removal 
of  the  establishment  to  a  greater  distance  ;  and  one  of  the  chief 
obstacles  urged  against  it  was  the  fear  entertained  of  the  danger- 
ous consequences  that  might  result  to  the  neighbourhood,  from 
suddenly  depriving  these  voracious  animals  of  their  proper  suste- 
nance. The  following  experiment  was  made  by  the  head  of  the 
establishment,  with  the  view  of  gaining  an  idea  of  the  number  of 
Rats  in  its  vicinity.  A  part  of  it  consists  of  a  yard  inclosed 
by  solid  walls,  at  the  foot  of  which  are  several  holes  made  for 
the  ingress  and  egress  of  the  Rats.  Into  this  inclosure  he  put 
the  carcasses  of  two  or  three  Horses  ;  and,  towards  the  middle 
of  the  night, — having  first  cautiously,  and  with  as  little  noise 
as  possible,  stopped  up  all  the  holes, — he  got  together  several 
of  his  workmen,  each  having  a  torch  in  one  hand,  and  a  stick 
in  the  other.  Having  entered  the  yard,  and  closed  the  door 
behind  them,  they  commenced  a  general  massacre.  It  was 
not  necessary  to  take  any  aim  ;  for  no  matter  how  the  blow 
was  directed,  it  was  sure  to  immolate  a  Rat ;  and  those  which 
endeavoured  to  escape,  by  climbing  up  the  walls,  were  quickly 
knocked  down.  By  a  recurrence  of  this  experiment,  at  inter- 
vals of  a  few  days,  16,050  Rats  were  killed  in  the  space  of  a 
month.  After  one  night's  massacre,  the  dead  amounted  to 
2,650 ;  and  the  result  of  four  hunts  was  9,101.  Even  this 
can  give  but  an  imperfect  idea  of  the  number  of  these  vermin ; 


256  FAMILY    MDRID^E  ; — VORACITY   OP    RATS. 

for  the  inclosure  in  which  they  were  thus  killed,  contains  not 
above  the  twentieth  part  of  the  space  over  which  the  dead  bodies 
of  Horses  are  spread,  and  which,  i4  is  but  fair  to  suppose,  must 
equally  attract  the  Rats  upon  all  points.  These  animals  have 
made  burrows  for  themselves,  like  Rabbits,  in  the  adjoining 
fields,  and  hollowed  out  into  catacombs  all  the  surrounding 
eminences ; — and  this  to  such  an  extent,  that  it  is  not  unusual  to 
see  the  latter  crumble  away  at  the  base,  leaving  these  subterra- 
nean works  exposed.  So  great  is  the  number  of  these  animals, 
that  they  have  not  all  been  able  to  lodge  themselves  in  the 
immediate  vicinity  of  the  slaughter-houses ;  for  paths  may  be 
distinctly  traced,  leading  across  the  fields,  from  the  inclosures  in 
which  the  Horses  are  killed,  to  a  burrow  about  five  hundred 
paces  distant. 

225.  The  voracity  and  ferocity  of  Rats  cause  them  not  even 
to  spare  their  own  kind.  If  several  be  inclosed  together  in  a 
box,  they  fight  furiously  ;  and  the  weaker  is  not  only  killed  but 
devoured  by  the  stronger.  (The  same  has  been  observed  even  of 
the  common  Mouse.)  Their  burrowing  propensities  have  often 
been  productive  of  great  injury ;  for  they  have  not  unfrequently 
excavated  the  foundations  of  a  dwelling  to  a  dangerous  extent ; 
and  there  are  many  instances  of  their  fatally  undermining  the 
most  solid  mason-work,  or  burrowing  through  dams,  which  had  for 
ages  served  to  confine  the  waters  of  rivers  and  canals.  The  Brown 
Rats  wims  with  great  ease.  Mr.T.  Bell  *  mentions  that  the  gardens 
of  the  Zoological  Society  of  London,  in  the  Regent's  Park,  are 
greatly  infested  by  them ;  but  as  they  are  too  cunning  to  risk  the 
danger  of  being  caught  during  the  day-time,  or  alarmed,  perhaps, 
at  the  concourse  of  persons  by  whom  the  gardens  are  frequented, 
they  are  often  seen  towards  evening  crossing  the  canal  in  a  body 
from  the  opposite  shore,  in  order  to  land  in  the  gardens,  and  enjoy 
their  night's  depredations,  returning  in  the  morning  in  the  same 
manner  to  their  daily  retreat.  This  animal  is  probably  one  of 
the  most  sagacious  of  the  Rodentia  ;  for  the  instances  in  which 
it  has  been  observed  to  show  an  adaptation  of  means  to  ends,  to 
which  it  can  scarcely  have  been  led  by  its  natural  instincts,  and 
*  History  of  British  Quadrupeds,  p.  319. 


FAMILY     MURID^E  ; RATS    AND    MICE.  257 

\vhich  must  be  attributed  to  intelligence,  are  very  numerous.  It 
has  been  mentioned  to  the  Author  by  a  trustworthy  eye-witness, 
that  she  once  saw  a  number  of  Rats  conveying  eggs  safely  down 
a  flight  of  stairs,  from  a  store-room  above  to  their  haunts  below. 
Each  egg,  held  between  the  fore-paws  of  a  Rat,  was  delivered 
by  it,  over  the  edge  of  the  step,  to  another  reared  upon  its 
haunches  on  the  step  below ;  and  in  this  manner  the  eggs  were 
safely  transferred  from  the  top  to  the  bottom.  In  another  instance, 
the  following  expedient  was  adopted  by  a  number  of  Rats,  to  get 
at  some  treacle  contained  in  a  jar,  of  which  the  neck  was  too 
narrow  to  permit  them  to  obtain  direct  access  to  it.  One  Rat 
after  another  inserted  his  tail  into  the  orifice,  and  dipped  it  in 
the  treacle  ;  then,  withdrawing  it,  he  allowed  his  companions  to 
lick  off  the  fluid;  and  in  his  turn  received  a  share  of  that 
abstracted  by  his  companions  in  like  manner. 

226.  To  the  group  of  true  Mice  belongs  the  beautiful  little 
Harvest  Mouse, — the  smallest  of  British  quadrupeds,  and  one  of 
the  smallest  of  the  whole  class, — which  constructs  a  curious 
globular  nest  for  its  young,  by  weaving  together  the  blades  of 
wheat  :  and  also  the  Long-tailed  Field  Mouse,  which  burrows 
beneath  the  ground,  or  lives  in  natural  excavations,  which  it 
enlarges  to  suit  its  purpose.  Both  these  are  very  beautiful  little 
animals,  and  highly  interesting  to  the  natural- 
ist, though  very  injurious  to  the  Agricul- 
turist. A  great  number  of  species  of  the 
same  group  exist  in  different  parts  of  the 
world,  which  closely  resemble  one  another. 

227.  Connecting  the  Rats  with  the  Mar- 
mots is  a  curious  animal  of  larger  size,  the 
Capromys  or  Hog-rat,  which  inhabits  Cuba, 
where  it  is  called  Hutia  or  Utia.  This  is  a 
climbing,  not  a  burrowing  species ;  it  lives 

Fm.  128.— NKSTOF  ,  ,  ,,  ,         -    ~    f 

HARVEST  MOUSE.         in    large   numbers  in    the  woods  of  Cuba, 

and   feeds  entirely   on  vegetable  matter, — 

reaching  the  leaves  of  those  short  plants  which  it  does  not  require 

to  climb,  by  making  use  of  the  tail  as  a  third  foot,  somewhat  in 

the  manner  of  a  Kangaroo.     In  its  mode   of  walking  on  the 


258 


FAMILY  MURIDJE; — HAMSTER,  MOLE-RAT. 


ground,  in  the  rough  and  bristly  hair  on  the  upper  part  of  its 
body,  and  in  the  low  grunt  it  makes  when  pleased,  it  bears  a 
slight  resemblance  to  a  Hog  ;  whencr  the  first  part  of  its  common 
name  has  originated.  This  species  is  easily  domesticated,  and 
is  very  docile  in  captivity. — The  Hamster,  which  has  been  else- 
where noticed  on  account  of  its  remarkable  instincts  (ANIM. 
PHYSIOL.,  §  699),  is  another  species  of  the  Rat  kind  ;  and  is  dis- 
tinguished by  its  two  enormous  cheek-pouches,  in  which  it  carries 
grain  to  be  stored  up  in  its  extensive  hoards.  Its  tail  is  short 
and  somewhat  hairy.  It  inhabits  the  sandy  districts  of  the 
north  of  Europe  and 
Asia,  from  Germany  to 
Siberia  ;  and  is  very 
injurious  to  the  Agricul- 
turist, on  account  of  the 
quantity  of  grain  which 
it  devours.  It  does  not 
restrict  itself  to  vegeta- 
ble food,  however;  but 
attacks  and  devours 
other  small  quadrupeds  and  birds. 

227.  There  is  another  very  interesting  species,  which  seems 
intermediate  between  this  group  and  the  next ; — the  Spalax  or 
Mole  Rat  of  Southern  Russia  in  Europe.  This  animal  is  nearly 


FIG.  129.— HAMSTER. 


FIG.  130. — SPALAX  OR  MOLE-RAT. 


allied  to  the   Rats  in  general  conformation ;  but  presents  some 
remarkable  points  of  resemblance  to  the  Mole,  both  in  structure 


FAMILY  MURIDJE;  MOLE-RAT; — VOLES.  259 

and  habits.  It  lives  underground,  like  the  Mole,  and  throws 
up  the  earth  in  the  same  manner,  although  provided  with  very 
inferior  instruments  for  the  purpose  ;  but  instead  of  feeding  on 
worms  and  grubs,  it  subsists  entirely  on  roots.  It  works  stoutly 
and  rapidly ;  and  on  the  approach  of  an  enemy  instantly  digs  a 
perpendicular  burrow.  The  most  curious  point  in  its  structure, 
is  that  in  which  it  resembles  the  Mole, — the  deficiency  of  eyes 
fitted  for  vision.  These  organs  are  in  an  undeveloped  or  rudi- 
mentary state,  being  small  black  globules  no  larger  than  poppy- 
seeds  ;  they  are  hid  beneath  the  skin,  which  passes  over  them 
without  opening  or  even  becoming  thinner,  and  which  is  as  much 
Covered  with  hair  at  that  part  as  at  any  other.  The  Russian 
species  is  somewhat  larger  than  the  common  Rat ;  but  there  is 
another,  in  the  islands  of  the  Straits  of  Sunda,  which  is  as  large 
as  a  Rabbit. 

228.  The  tribe  of  ARVICOL^E  or  Voles  includes  many  species 
which  are  commonly  termed  Rats  and  Mice,  but  which  are  dis- 
tinguished by  a  peculiarity  in  the  teeth,  that  indicate  an  affinity 
with  the  Beaver.  To  this  group  belongs  the  Short-tailed  Field- 
mouse.,  which  is  remarkable  for  its  extraordinary  voracity,  and  for 

the  rapidity  of  its 
multiplication.  It 
burrows  through  the 
ground,  destroying 
the  roots  of  plants 
and  trees  which  come 
in  its  way ;  and  it 
also  devours  their 
bark.  In  this  man- 

Fio.  131 — SHORT-TAILED  FIELD  MOUSE.  Her  it  has  done  great 

in j  ury  to  young  plant- 
ations, especially  in  the  Forest  of  Dean,  and  in  the  New  Forest, 
Hampshire  ;  and  in  the  years  1813  and  1814  its  ravages  were  so 
great,  as  to  create  considerable  alarm,  lest  the  whole  of  the 
young  trees  in  these  extensive  woods  should  be  destroyed  by 
them.  Various  plans  were  suggested  for  their  destruction  ;  but 
none  proved  so  successful  as  the  digging  of  holes  about  18  or  20 

5=   2 


260    VOLES; — FIELD-MOUSE,  WATER-RAT,  LEMMING,  MUSK-RAT. 

inches  in  depth,  and  much  wider  at  the  bottom  than  at  the  top, 
so  that  the  Mice  which  should  fall  in  might  not  easily  get  out 
again.  It  was  calculated  that,  in  the  Forest  of  Dean,  not  fewer 
than  100,000  Mice  were  taken  by  means  of  these  holes,  in  the 
course  of  a  few  months  ;  as  many  as  30,000  having  been  counted 
out  from  them  ;  and  a  much  larger  number  having  been  probably 
destroyed  by  Stoats,  Weasels,  Kites,  Hawks,  Owls,  and  other 
predaceous  quadrupeds  and  birds,  which  resorted  to  these  holes 
to  secure  an  easy  and  abundant  prey.  An  equal  number  was 
destroyed  in  the  New  Forest ;  and  the  evil  has  not  since  re- 
turned, to  anything  like  the  same  extent.  The  Field  Voles, 
like  Rats,  will  kill  and  eat  their  own  kind,  when  pressed  by 
famine,  or  kept  in  confinement.  The  so-called  Water  Rat  is  also 
in  reality  a  Vole.  It  burrows  in  the  banks  of  streams,  forming 
its  retreat  at  some  distance  from  the  water ;  and  in  this  it  lays 
up  a  store  of  vegetable  substances,  on  which  alone  it  feeds.  It 
dives  and  swims  with  great  facility,  instantly  seeking  the  water 
when  alarmed,  and  plunging  at  once  to  the  bottom  ;  it  is  obliged, 
however,  to  return  to  the  surface  for  respiration,  at  intervals  of 
about  a  minute.  The  Lemmings  of  Siberia  and  Northern  Russia 
also  belong  to  this  group  ;  they  burrow  and  ordinarily  feed  on 
grass,  rein-deer  lichen,  &c. ;  but  they  sometimes  multiply  to 
such  a  degree,  as  to  be  forced  to  migrate,  in  order  to  obtain  food. 
These  migrations  are  performed  by  immense  numbers  at  once  ; 
they  move  straight  onwards,  destroying  everything  in  their  way, 
until  they  arrive  at  the  ocean,  where  most  of  them  are  drowned. 
— A  curious  animal,  which  closely  connects  this  group  with  the 
Beaver,  is  that  known  in  Canada  as  the  Muskquash,  or  Musk- 
Rat,  on  account  of  the  musky  odour  it  produces.  It  is  about  the 
size  of  a  Rabbit ;  its  fur  is  of  a  reddish-gray  ;  its  feet  are  partly 
webbed,  and  its  tail  somewhat  flattened.  In  summer  it  burrows 
in  the  banks  of  streams  and  swamps  ;  and  in  winter  it  builds 
mud  huts  on  their  margins,  and  sometimes  even  on  the  ice  itself. 
The  entrance  to  these  huts  is  under  water,  for  the  purpose  of 
procuring  food,  which  consists  entirely  of  aquatic  vegetables; 
and  by  very  severe  frost,  these  animals  are  consequently  de- 
stroyed, through  want  of  food  and  air.  It  is  said  that,  when  the 


FAMILY  CASTORID^E; — BEAVER.  261 

ice  closes  their  holes,  they  attack  and  devour  one  another. 
Their  fur,  like  that  of  the  Beaver,  is  peculiarly  adapted  for 
felting ;  and  from  four  to  five  hundred  thousand  skins  are 
annually  imported  into  England,  for  the  manufacture  of  hats. 

229.     The  preceding  group  is  probably  to  be  associated,  with 
the  Beaver,  in  the  family  CASTORIDJE;  of  which  the  Beaver  is  to  be 


FIG.  132.— BEAVER. 

regarded  as  the  type.  This  animal  is  distinguished  from  all 
other  Rodents,  by  its  horizontally-flattened  tail,  which  is  of  a 
nearly  oval  form,  and  covered  with  scales ;  the  hind  feet  are 
webbed,  and,  together  with  the  tail,  serve  to  propel  it  through 
the  water  with  considerable  facility.  The  incisor  teeth  are 
very  large  and  peculiarly  hard  ;  and  they  were  employed  by  the 

North  American  Indians,  as  instru- 
ments to  cut  bone  and  to  fashion 
their  horn-tipped  spears,  till  they  were 
superseded  by  the  introduction  of 
iron  tools  from  Europe.  The  molar 

FIG.  133. — MOLAR  TEETH  OF  THE  .  ,    .     , 

BBAVER.  teeth  are  four,  above  and  below,  on 

each  side ;  they  are  furnished  with 

layers  of  cortical  substance,  as  well  as  with  ivory  and  enamel 
(ANIM.  PHYSIOL.,  §  178)  ;  their  crowns  are  flattened  ;  and  they 
present  very  much  the  aspect  of  a  riband  folded  upon  itself,  as 


262  FAMILY    CASTORID^; BEAVER,    COYPU. 

shown  in  Fig.  133.  The  Beavers  are  best  known  as  inhabitants 
of  Canada,  and  of  the  northern  parts  of  the  United  States ;  where 
alone  their  remarkable  building  propensity  (which  has  been 
elsewhere  described,  ANIM.  PHYSIOL.,  §  706),  is  fully  manifested. 
But  they  are  at  present  found  also  on  the  banks  of  the  Rhone, 
Danube,  "Weser,  and  other  continental  rivers;  and  there  is 
sufficient  historical  evidence,  that  they  were  formerly  inhabitants 
of  Britain.  As  these  Beavers  do  not  build,  however,  but 
burrow  under  ground,  it  has  been  supposed  that  they  are  not  of 
the  same  species  with  the  American  Beaver ;  but  a  colony  has 
been  recently  discovered  in  a  lonely  spot,  near  the  source  of 
the  river  Elbe,  in  which  regular  habitations  have  been  con- 
structed ;  and  it  is  known  that  the  American  Beavers  take  to 
burrowing  instead  of  building,  when  molested  by  Man. — The 
Beaver  is  pursued  both  for  its  fur,  and  for  the  sake  of  a  peculiar 
odoriferous  secretion,  termed  Castor,  which  was  formerly  much 
used  in  medicine,  but  is  now  chiefly  employed  by  perfumers. 
The  fur  was  formerly  a  most  important  article  of  commerce. 
In  the  year  1788,  upwards  of  170,000  skins  were  exported  from 
Canada ;  and  in  1808,  as  many  as  126,927  were  sent  from 
Quebec  alone  to  this  country,  the  value  of  which  was  estimated 
at  nearly  120,000^.  Of  late  years,  however,  the  exportation 
has  greatly  diminished  ;  although  the  country  now  occupied  by 
the  hunters  is  of  far  greater  extent  than  formerly;  the  animals 
have  been  exterminated  from  many  extensive  tracts,  which  they 
formerly  inhabited.  In  the  year  1827,  the  importation  into 
London  was  little  beyond  50,000  skins.  This  diminution  has 
caused  greater  care  to  be  taken  than  formerly,  to  prevent  the 
destruction  of  the  race ;  but  it  may  be  doubted  whether  these 
animals  will  ever  become  so  plentiful  as  they  once  were. 

230.  The  deficiency  in  Beaver  skins  is  partly  supplied,  as 
already  mentioned,  by  those  of  the  Muskquash  ;  and  partly  by 
those  of  a  South  American  Eodent,  the  Myopotamus  or  Coypu^ 
which  connects  this  family  with  the  Cavidae.  This  animal  re- 
sembles the  Beaver  in  many  respects,  but  is  of  smaller  size. 
Its  hind-feet  are  webbed ;  but  its  tail  is  round,  instead  of  being 
flattened ;  and  its  scaly  covering  is  partly  concealed  by  scattered 


FAMILY    HYSTRICID^l  ; — PORCUPINE.  263 

hairs.  It  swims  with  great  ease,  and  burrows  in  the  neighbour- 
hood of  water.  It  is  easily  domesticated  ;  and  its  manners  in 
captivity  are  very  mild.  As  many  as  600,000  or  800,000  skins 
of  this  species  are  annually  imported  into  Britain  from  South 
America,  chiefly  from  the  Rio  de  la  Plata,  under  the  name  of 
Neutria  skins. 


231.  The   second   section   of  the   Rodentia,   in  which  the 
clavicles  are  either  absent  or  are  imperfectly  developed,  altogether 
occupies  a  lower  place  in  the  scale ;  the  animals  composing  it 
being  for  the  most  part  less  highly  organised,  not  capable  of 
executing  so  great  a  variety  of  actions,  and  less  remarkable  for 
their  instinctive  propensities.     It  is  observable  that,  with  the 
exception  of  the  Porcupines  and  Hares,  which  are  spread  over 
nearly  the  whole  of  the  globe,  almost  all  the  very  numerous 
genera  of  which  this  section  consists,  are  restricted  to  South 
America  and  the  West  Indian  Islands.     The  principal  families 
comprehended  in  it,  are  the  HYSTRICID^J  or  Porcupine  tribe, 
the  CAVID^I  or  Guinea  Pig  tribe,  the  CHINCHILLIDJE  or  Chin- 
chilla tribe,  and  the  LEPORID^E  or  Hare  tribe.  These  are  separated 
from  each  other  chiefly  by  characters  supplied  by  the  teeth.     In 
the  first  and  last  only  of  these  families,   the  molar  teeth  are 
possessed  of  growing  roots  ;  in  the  others,  they  are  destitute  of 
them.     The  last  is  distinguished  (as  already  remarked,  §  216), 
by  the  presence  of  small  incisors  behind  the  great  cutting-teeth  ; 
and   the  Chinchillidae   differ    from  the  Cavidse,   in   possessing 
clavicles. 

232.  The  animals  properly  composing  the  family  HYSTRI- 
CID.E,  are  well  known  under  the  name  of  Porcupines^  which  is 
derived  from  the  French  porc-epin,  signifying  a  spiny  hog, — a 
designation  conferred  upon  them  on  account  of  their  heavy  pig- 
like  aspect  and  grunting  voice,  and  the  curious  spiny  covering 
which  their  bodies  possess  (Fig.  47).     These  spines,  as  already 
explained  (§  76),  are  nothing  else  than  enormously  developed 
hairs.     The  best  known  species  of  Porcupine  is  the  one  which 
inhabits  the  South  of  Italy,  Sicily,  Spain,  and  Barbary ;  it  is 


264  PORCUPINE,   COENDOU. FAMILY    CAVIDJE. 

between  two  and  three  feet  in  length,  and  is  nearly  the  largest 
of  the  Rodentia.  The  spines,  especially  those  covering  the 
upper  part  of  its  body,  are  large  and  long ;  some  of  them 
measuring  more  than  a  foot  from  end  to  end,  and  having  annular 
marks  of  black  and  white  alternating.  Its  head  and  neck  have 
a  crest  of  long  bristles  ;  and  its  short  tail  is  furnished  with  quills 
of  a  very  singular  structure,  being  open  thin-sided  tubes,  about 
two  inches  long,  and  supported  upon  slender  flexible  stalks, 
which  make  a  considerable  sound  when  they  are  caused  to  strike 
against  each  other  by  the  shaking  of  this  appendage.  When 
the  Porcupine  is  irritated,  it  erects  its  spines  in  the  manner  of 
the  Hedgehog,  and  these  spines  are  often  easily  detached  ;  but  it 
is  quite  a  mistake  to  suppose  that  it  can  lance  them  at  its 
enemies.  It  is  a  nocturnal  and  solitary  animal,  remaining 
concealed  during  the '  day  at  the  bottom  of  its  burrow,  and 
becoming  torpid  during  the  winter. — Several  other  species, 
most  of  them  possessing  shorter  spines  and  a  longer  tail,  are 
found  in  different  parts  of  the  world ;  and  there  is  one,  the 
Coendou,  that  inhabits  Brazil,  which  has  a  long  prehensile  tail, 
like  that  of  the  Sapajous,  and  has  the  spines  hidden,  during  part 
of  the  year,  by  long  grayish-brown  fur.  This  animal  lives 
among  trees,  instead  of  burrowing. 

233.     The  family  CAVID^E,  or  Guinea-Pig  tribe  contains  the 


FlG.    134.— COBAYA   OR  GUINEA-PIG. 


largest  species  of  this  order ;  though  even  these  would  be  con- 
sidered small,  when  compared  with  other  quadrupeds.     They  are 


FAMILY  CAVIDJE; — GUINEA-PIG,  CAPYBARA.  265 

naturally  restricted  to  tropical  America,  where  they  seem  to 
replace  the  hares  and  rabbits  of  other  countries  ;  but  one  species, 
the  common  Guinea-Pig^  has  been  so  long  domesticated  in  this 
and  other  European  countries,  as  now  to  have  become  quite 
naturalised  in  the  Old  World.  "Whence  the  name  was  derived, 
which  this  species  bears,  there  does  not  seem  now  a  possibility  of 
ascertaining ;  for  it  seems  to  have  been  introduced  into  Europe 
at  a  very  early  period  after  the  discovery  of  South  America.  This 
animal  possesses  a  very  low  degree  of  intelligence ;  it  lives  in 
societies,  inhabiting  dry  lands  covered  with  low  brushwood  ;  and 
remains  concealed  during  the  day,  coming  forth  on  the  approach 
of  evening  to  seek  its  food.  It  possesses  neither  cunning  to  avoid 
danger,  strength  to  resist,  nor  swiftness  to  escape  from  it ;  and 
nothing  could  save  the  race  from  extermination,  except  its  extra- 
ordinary rapidity  of  multiplication.  In  this  respect  this  species 
equals,  or  perhaps  surpasses,  any  other  mammiferous  animal. 
The  ordinary  litter  consists  of  six  or  eight,  sometimes  as  many  as 
twelve  ;  and  young  are  produced  several  times  in  the  year.  These 
young  come  into  the  world  in  a  state  which  at  once  renders  them 
nearly  independent  of  their  parents  ;  and  although  they  do  not 
attain  their  full  growth  until  they  are  eight  or  nine  months  old, 
they  themselves  begin  to  breed  at  the  age  of  six  or  eight  weeks. 
There  is  little  besides  this  readiness  of  multiplication,  and  a 
certain  degree  of  prettiness  in  their  external  appearance,  which 
can  render  the  keeping  of  these  animals  a  matter  of  either 
pleasure  or  profit.  "  Devoid  of  sense  or  docility,  though  inces- 
santly restless,  tame  from  stupidity,  and  harmless  from  impotence, 
they  perhaps  possess  as  few  claims  upon  our  interest  and  affection, 
as  any  animal  of  equally  innoxious  habits."* 

234.  Nearly  allied  to  the  Guinea-Pig  is  the  Hydrochcerus  or 
Capylara,  which  is  the  size  of  a  small  pig,  and  is  the  largest 
known  animal  of  the  order.  It  has  a  thick  muzzle,  short  legs, 
coarse  yellowish-brown  hair,  and  no  tail.  Its  feet  are  webbed, 
showing  its  aquatic  habits ;  and  it  is  said  to  exist,  in  consider- 
able numbers,  near  all  the  large  rivers  of  the  tropical  portion  of 

*  Bell's  "  British  Quadrupeds,"  p.  355. 


266 


FAMILY  CAVID^E;— CAPYBARA,  AGOUTI. 


South  America,  readily  taking  to  the  water,  and  swimming  and 
diving  with  facility.     It  runs  badly,  however,  upon  land,  owing 


Fro.  135.— CAPVBARA. 

to  the  shortness  of  its  legs.  In  its  disposition  it  strongly  resem- 
bles the  Cavy ;  and  like  it,  is  capable  of  being  readily  domesti- 
cated. A  friend  of  the  Author's  had  one  alive  in  his  house  for 
some  years ;  and  it  gave  very  little  trouble,  though  commonly 
allowed  to  go  at  large. — The  Agouti  is  another  of  the  Cavida3  ; 

resembling  the  Por- 
cupines, however,  in 
possessing  roots  to  its 
molar  teeth ;  and  re- 
sembling the  Hares, 
also,  in  the  length  of 
its  hind  legs,  by 
which  it  runs  or 
rather  leaps  with 
considerable  swift- 
ness. When  first  taken  possession  of  by  Europeans,  the  West 
India  Islands  and  all  the  more  fertile  parts  of  South  America 
were  literally  overrun  with  the  various  species  of  this  animal ; 
they  are  still  very  numerous  in  most  places  which  are  not  settled 
and  cultivated ;  and  even  in  some  which  are  under  cultivation, 
then:  numbers  are  so  great,  as  to  give  no  little  annoyance.  They 
live  for  the  most  part  upon  the  surface  of  the  ground,  not  climbing, 


FIG.  136.— COMMON  AGOUTI. 


AGOUTI. — FAMILY    CHINCUILLID^E. 


267 


nor  digging  to  any  depth ;  and  they  commonly  sit  upon  their 
haunches,  when  at  rest,  holding  their  food  between  their  fore- 
paws,  in  the  manner  of  Squirrels.  They  feed  both  upon  the 
green  vegetation  of  the  surface,  and  upon  the  roots  which  they 
find  a 'little  below  it ;  and  by  destroying  those  of  the  sugar-cane, 
they  are  often  of  great  injury  to  the  planters.  It  is  said  that, 
when  angry,  the  Agouti  stamps  with  the  fore-feet,  grunts  like  a 
young  pig,  and  erects  the  bristly  hair  of  the  crupper  in  the 
manner  of  a  Porcupine. 

235.  The  family  CHINCHILLID^E  consists  of  a  number  of  small 
South  American  Rodents,  which  have  been  until  recently  only 
known  by  the  skins  of  some  of  them;  these  have  been  long  highly 
valued  on  account  of  their  fur,  and  have  been  largely  imported. 
This  is  especially  the  case  in  regard  to  the  Chinchilla,  a 


FIG.  137 — CHINCHILLA. 

native  of  the  valleys  in  the  high  mountain  districts,  where  the 
cold  is  often  very  severe ;  its  fur  is  of  a  dense  woolly  character, 
which,  together  with  its  fineness  of  texture,  causes  it  to  be  highly 
valued.  Its  colour  is  clear  gray  above,  varying  however  in 
depth,  and  passing  into  white  on  the  under  parts.  The  ancient 
Peruvians  are  said  to  have  made  of  this  wool  coverlets  for 
beds,  and  valuable  stuffs  ;  but  there  is  reason  to  believe  that,  on 
account  of  the  present  extensive  destruction  of  the  species,  it  is 
becoming  more  and  more  scarce.  Of  its  habits  in  a  state  of 
nature,  little  is  known,  save  that  it  associates  in  numbers,  and 
excavates  burrows  in  which  it  resides,  feeding  chiefly  upon  roots, 


268  CHINCHILLA,    VISCACHA. FAMILY    LEPORID^E. 

especially  those  of  a  bulbous  kind.  In  captivity,  its  manners 
strongly  resemble  those  of  the  Cavy  and  Rabbit.  The  Viscacha 
of  the  Pampas  is  another  animal  of  this  family,  allied  to  the 
Chinchilla,  but  larger,  being  when  full  grown  of  the  size  of  the 
common  Badger.  It  burrows  so  extensively  in  the  plains  between 
Buenos  Ayres  and  San  Luis,  as  to  make  it  dangerous  to  travel 
over  them,  especially  at  night ;  their  holes  being  so  large  and 
deep^  that  a  horse  is  almost  sure  to  fall,  if  he  steps  into  one 
of  them.  The  animal  is,  for  the  most  part,  nocturnal  in  its 
habits,  being  seldom  seen  until  the  evening,  when  it  comes  forth  to 
feed  and  to  sport  near  its  holes.  It  is  remarkable  that  the  burrows 
of  the  Viscacha  are  also  inhabited  by  vast  numbers  of  small 
Owls;  which  are  said  to  sit,  during  the  day,  gazing  at  the 
passing  travellers,  and  making  a  very  ludicrous  appearance. 

236.  The  LEPORID.E  or  Hare  tribe  constitutes  the  last  family 
of  the  Rodentia ;  distinguished,  as  already  mentioned,  by  the 
presence  of  two  small  incisors  behind  the  cutting  teeth  of  the 
upper  jaw.  Few  undomesticated  animals  are  better  known  than 
the  common  Hare  of  this  country  ;  which  is  spread,  also,  over 
the  greater  portion  of  Europe.  Its  timidity  and  defencelessness 
are  beautifully  compensated  by  its  watchfulness,  the  acuteness  of 
its  senses,  and  its  swiftness  of  foot.  Its  eyes  are  so  situated, 
that  the  animal  can  see  nearly  all  around  it ;  and  its  large  ears 
can  be  raised  and  directed  towards  any  point  from  which  the 
faintest  sound  issues.  Its  brown  fur,  also,  aids  to  conceal  it, 
by  its  resemblance  to  the  russet  herbage,  in  the  midst  of  which 
the  Harems  form  (as  the  slight  hollow  made  by  it  is  termed)  is 
usually  situated.  The  Hare  is  an  exclusively  vegetable-feeder, 
devouring  various  kinds  of  herbage  and  the  bark  of  young 
trees ;  it  is  nocturnal  in  its  habits,  remaining  on  its  form  during 
the  day.  In  its  stomach  there  is  a  partial  division,  which  gives 
it  a  degree  of  resemblance  to  that  of  the  Ruminant  Quadrupeds; 
and  in  the  Levitical  directions  respecting  clean  and  unclean 
animals,  it  is  enumerated  as  one  of  those  that  chew  the  cud.  It 
swims  well,  and  takes  fearlessly  to  the  water,  whether  to  escape 
from  pursuit,  or  to  seek  for  food.  Besides  the  common  Hare, 
the  Alpine  or  varying  Hare  (so  named  from  its  usual  residence, 


FAMILY    LEPORID.E  ; HARES    AND    RABBITS.  269 

and  from  the  changes  of  colour  which  it  undergoes),  inhabits  the 
northern  parts  of  Scotland,  the  mountainous  parts  of  Ireland,  and 
has  been  occasionally  seen  in  the  mountains  of  Cumberland.  It 
is  intermediate  in  size  between  the  Rabbit  and  the  common 
Hare;  and  tenants  the  sides  and  summits  of  mountains,  hiding 
in  the  clefts  of  rocks,  or  among  rocky  fragments.  Its  ordinary 
food  is  similar  to  that  of  the  other  species ;  but  during  the 
winter  it  feeds  on  lichens  and  on  the  seeds  of  pines.  During  the 
summer  its  colour  is  a  light  grey,  except  on  the  lips  and  at 
the  tips  of  the  ears,  which  are  black  ;  but  at  the  approach 
of  winter,  it  gradually  becomes  completely  white,  with  the 
exception  of  these  parts,  which  remain  black.  At  the  return 
of  spring,  the  white  fur  is  thrown  off,  and  a  new  gray  coat 
is  obtained,  which  in  its  turn  undergoes  the  autumnal  change. 
That  this  change  is  solely  due  to  the  effect  of  cold  upon  the  hair, 
is  evident  from  this  fact, — that  a  Lemming  (which  undergoes  a 
similar  change),  caught  in  the  summer,  during  one  of  the  Arctic 
voyages,  and  kept  in  the  cabin  of  the  ship,  at  a  warm  tempera- 
ture, retained  its  summer  coat  far  beyond  the  usual  time ;  but 
when  taken  on  deck,  on  the  1st  of  February,  and  exposed  to 
the  intense  cold  of  30°  below  Zero,  the  colour  of  its  fur  began  to 
change  in  a  few  hours,  and  was  completely  turned  in  the  course 
of  a  week.  The  purpose  of  this  curious  phenomenon  is  evidently 
to  afford  concealment  to  the  animals  which  undergo  it ;  by  the 
resemblance  between  the  hue  of  their  fur,  and  that  of  the  sur- 
rounding snow. — The  common  Hare  of  Ireland  has  been  lately 
shown  to  be  a  species  different  from  that  of  England ;  and  it  is 
curious  that,  besides  some  constant  differences  in  its  form,  its  fur 
is  valueless  as  an  article  of  commerce ;  being  destitute  of  the 
long  fine  dark  hairs,  which  constitute  the  beauty  of  that  of  the 
common  species. 

237.  The  structure  of  the  Rabbit  closely  resembles  that  of  the 
Hare;  the  smaller  size  of  the  former  constituting  its  chief  variation ; 
but  in  its  habits,as  is  well  known,  it  is  extremely  different, — living 
in  societies,  instead  of  alone ;  and  burrowing  extensively  beneath 
the  soil,  instead  of  squatting  upon  it.  There  is  reason  to  believe 
that  the  Rabbit  was  not  originally  a  native  of  our  island ;  but  the 


270  LAGOMYS. —  FOSSIL  REMAINS  OF  RODENTIA. 

date  of  its  introduction  is  unknown. — The  Lagomys  or  Pica  of 
Siberia,  an  animal  nearly  allied  to  the  Hare,  is  of  much  interest, 
on  account  of  its  peculiar  instincts.  It  is  about  the  size  of  a 
Guinea-pig,  and  lives  on  the  sides  of  mountains,  concealed  in 
hollows  in  the  rocks,  or  inhabiting  burrows  which  it  has  itself 
excavated.  In  the  autumn  it  selects  and  dries  herbage  for  its 
winter  provision ;  and  of  this  it  makes  regular  stacks,  which  are 
sometimes  four  or  five  feet  in  height,  by  eight  in  breadth.  A 
subterranean  gallery  leads  from  the  burrow  to  the  stack ;  so  that 
neither  frost  nor  snow  can  intercept  the  communication  with  it. 
The  herbage  is  most  carefully  selected,  and  consists  chiefly  of  the 
choicest  grass  and  the  sweetest  herbs,  all  cut  when  most  vigorous, 
and  dried  so  slowly  as  to  form  a  green  and  succulent  fodder ; 
and  the  collections  of  it  furnish  a  valuable  supply  of  food  for  the 
horses  of  the  Sable-Hunters.  The  Picas  are  also  remarkable  for 
their  voice ;  the  tone  of  which  so  much  resembles  that  of  a  quail, 
as  to  be  often  mistaken  for  it,  even  by  the  inhabitants  of  their 
native  districts.  Their  peculiar  loud  and  sonorous  note  or  call 
is  heard  only  in  the  morning  and  evening  (except  in  dark  and 
cloudy  weather),  and  is  repeated  by  each  animal,  both  male  and 
female,  at  regular  intervals. 

238.  The  Fossil  animals  belonging  to  this  order  are  mostly  found 
in  very  recent  strata,  and  generally  bear  a  very  close  resemblance 
to  those  already  existing.  Some  of  them,  however,  were  of  much 
larger  size ;  especially  those  inhabiting  South  America.  Thus 
the  remains  of  a  species  of  Capylara  has  been  found  there,  which 
must  have  been  nearly  five  feet  in  length ;  so  as  to  stand  mid- 
way between  the  existing  species,  and  the  South  American 
Tapir.  Remains  of  an  Agouti,  also,  have  been  discovered,  of 
such  a  size  that  the  long  bones  of  its  hind  legs  were  nearly  as 
large  as  those  of  a  Roebuck.  And  of  the  Coendou  (or  prehen- 
sile-tailed Porcupine),  a  species  must  have  formerly  existed,  very 
little  inferior  to  the  wild  Hog  in  bulk.  Vast  numbers  of 
remains  of  various  Rodents  allied  to  the  existing  species,  are 
found  in  a  fossil  state  in  the  caves  of  that  country ;  and  great 
heaps  of  bones  of  the  smaller  animals  of  this  group  at  present 
existing  there,  are  met  with  in  the  soil  of  other  caves,  in  such  a 


ORDER  EDENTATA; — GENERAL  CHARACTERS.  271 

state  as  to  lead  to  the  belief,  that  they  were  brought  together 
by  Owls.  Remains  of  Mice  and  Water-Rats  have  been  found 
in  the  Kirkdale  Cave  in  Yorkshire. 


ORDER  VIII.— EDENTATA. 

239.  This  order  contains  a  number  of  animals,  recent  and 
fossil,  which  differ  from  each  other  most  widely  in  habits,  and  in 
those  points  of  their  structure  which  especially  adapt  them  to 
those  habits ;  and  which  yet  agree  in  so  many  essential  charac- 
ters, and  are  connected  together  by  so  many  intermediate  links, 
as  evidently  to  require  being  associated  in  the  same  group.  The 
leaf-eating,  tree-inhabiting  Sloths,  at  present  existing  in  South 
America, — the  gigantic  Mylodon  and  Megatherium,  which 
formerly  inhabited  that  Continent,  and  gained  their  subsistence, 
not  by  climbing  the  trees  that  afforded  it,  but  by  uprooting  them 
with  their  immense  digging  feet, — the  armour-clothed,  insectivo- 
rous Armadillos,  also  inhabiting  South  America, — the  hairy, 
toothless  Ant-Eaters  of  the  same  Continent, — and  the  scaly 
Pangolins  of  Southern  Africa, — might  almost  be  regarded  as 
types  of  distinct  groups,  so  widely  do  they  differ  from  each  other 
in  external  form  and  covering.  The  name  given  to  the  order  is 
very  liable  to  mislead  ;  for  it  might  be  inferred  from  it,  that  the 
animals  composing  the  group  are  altogether  toothless,  which  is 
the  case  in  regard  to  a  small  section  of  it  only.  They  all  agree, 
however,  in  the  absence  of  teeth  in  the  front  of  the  jaws ;  and 
the  molar  teeth,  in  those  which  possess  them,  are  comparatively 
imperfect  in  their  structure,  being  destitute  of  enamel  and  of 
distinct  roots.  The  Edentata  constitute  the  last  group  of  Un- 
guiculated  animals ;  and  in  the  diminution  of  the  number  of 
toes  which  some  of  them  present,  as  well  as  in  the  complete 
enclosure  of  these  in  a  large  hoof-like  nail,  there  is  an  obvious 
tendency  towards  the  ungulated  structure,  which  is  fully  deve- 
loped in  the  succeeding  orders.—The  existing  species  of  this  order 
may  be  subdivided  into  two  principal  groups,  according  to  the 
nature  of  the  food  on  which  they  respectively  subsist ; — the  first, 


272  FAMILY  TARDIGRADA; — SLOTH. 

to  which  the  name  of  TARDIGRADA  has  been  given,  on  account 
of  the  slowness  of  the  movements  of  the  animals  composing  it, 
consists  of  the  Leaf-eaters  ; — and  the  second,  which  includes  the 
Insect  and  Flesh-eaters,  has  received  the  name  of  EFFODIENTIA, 
on  account  of  the  digging  habits  which  prevail  in  it.  These 
names  are  not,  however,  by  any  means  universally  applicable  ; 
for  there  are  digging  animals  in  the  first  group ;  and  slow-paced 
ones  in  the  second. 

240.  The  family  TARDIGRADA,  contains  but  a  single  genus  of 
animals  now  existing,  the  Bradypus  or  Sloth ;  an  animal  on 
which  Naturalists  have  most  liberally  bestowed  their  pity.     Not 
only  did  Buffon  fall  into  the  error  of  supposing  it  to  be  an 
imperfectly-constructed  being,  whose  existence  must  be  a  burthen 
to  it ;  but  even  Cuvier,  whose  views  were  in  general  much  more 
sagacious,  fell  into  the  same  mistake.     In  the  construction  of  the 
Sloth,  he  remarks,  "Nature  seems  to  have  amused  herself  in 
producing  something  imperfect  and  grotesque ;"  and  he  after- 
wards goes  on  to  speak  of  their  "  disproportioned  structure,"  and 
the  "  inconveniency  of  their  organisation."      The  fact  is,  as  Dr. 
Buckland  has  well  shown,*  that  the  organisation  and  habits  of 
the  Sloth  are  as  completely  adapted  to  each  other,  as  are  those  of 
any  other  animal ;  and  that  our  different  notion  respecting  it  is 
founded,  on  our  usually  seeing  it  only  in  an  unnatural  condition, 
for  which  it  is  not  fitted.    For  the  Sloth  is  formed  to  be  produced, 
to  live,  and  to  die,  not  on  the  ground,  but  in  trees ;  and  not  on 
the  branches,  like  the  Squirrel  or  Monkey,  but  under  them  ; 
and  when  this  is  once  fully  understood,  the  complete  adaptation 
of  its  whole  structure  to  its  mode  of  life  becomes  apparent. 

241.  The  first  peculiarity  in  the  construction  of  the  Sloth, 
which  especially  strikes  the  observer,  when  the  animal  is  placed 
upon  the  ground,  is  the  length  of  the  fore-legs,  which  are  twice 
as  long  as  the  hinder  pair ;  and  the  very  oblique  connection  of 
the  hind-legs  with  the  body,  arising  from  the  great  breadth  of 
the  pelvis.     The  structure  of  the  wrist  and  ankle-joints  is  such, 
that  the  palm  or  sole,  instead  of  being  directed  towards  the 

*  Linnsean  Transactions,  1835. 


FAMILY  TARDIGRADA  ; SLOTHS. 


273 


surface  of  the  ground,  is  turned  towards  the  body ;  so  that  the 
animal  is  obliged  to  rest  upon  the  side  of  the  hind-foot,  and 
upon  the  elbow  (not  upon  the  extremity)  of  the  fore-limb  ;  and 
it  can  only  advance  itself,  by  a  most  awkward  shuffling  move- 
ment ;  or  by  laying  hold,  with  its  long  crooked  claws,  of  some 
fixed  object,  towards  which  it  draws  itself.  But  these  peculi- 
arities ought  no  more  to  excite  our  pity  and  compassion,  than 
the  circumstance  of  Fishes  being  deprived  of  legs,  and  unable  to 
move  upon  dry  ground;  for  when  the  Sloth  is  placed  in  its 
natural  condition,  they  show  themselves  to  be  most  perfectly 
adapted  to  its  peculiar  mode  of  existence,  for  which  no  other 

animal  is  equally  fitted. 
When  placed  in  a  tree, 
the  Sloth  is  no  longer  the 
slow-moving,  piteous- 
looking,  animal  which 
it  is  commonly  reputed ; 
for  it  climbs  the  trunk, 
and  passes  from  branch 
to  branch,  with  consi- 
derable rapidity,  having 
been  known  to  ascend, 
in  a  minute,  from  the 
bottom  to  the  top  of  a  lofty  tree.  The  only  three  species  of 
Sloth,  at  present  known  to  exist, — the  Ais,  or  three-toed  Sloths, 
(of  which  there  are  two  species,  slightly  differing  from  each 
other),  and  the  Unau,  or  two-toed  Sloth, — are  inhabitants  of  the 
dense  forests  of  the  tropical  portion  of  South  America,  the  branches 
of  whose  trees  are  so  intertangled  with  one  another,  that  hundreds 
of  miles  may  be  traversed  by  passing  from  one  tree  to  another. 
Clinging  by  the  hinder  claws,  the  posterior  limbs  securely  em- 
bracing the  bough,  and  generally  holding  by  one  of  their  fore- 
limbs  also,  they  employ  the  other  to  hook  towards  them  the 
foliage  on  which  they  browze.  Their  long  arms,  with  the  firm 
claws  by  which  they  are  terminated,  enable  them  to  pass  from 
branch  to  branch,  even  when  these  are  at  some  distance  from  each 
other;  and  when  they  live  in  the  more  open  parts  of  the  forest, 


FIG.  138  —Ai,  OR  COMMON  SLOTH. 


274  FAMILY  TARDIGRADA  ; SLOTHS. 

where  the  trees  are  less  contiguous,  they  take  advantage  of  windy 
weather,  which  blows  the  boughs  together,  to  effect  their  passage, 


FIG.  139. — UNAU,  OR  TWO-TOED  SLOTH. 

— seldom  coming  to  the  ground,  and  completely  stripping  the  tree 
of  its  leaves  and  young  shoots,  rather  than  do  so.  From  the 
peculiar  construction  of  the  Sloth,  and  the  remarkable  power  of 
resisting  tension,  or  strain,  which  its  limbs  seem  to  possess,  it  ap- 
pears to  feel  no  more  fatigue  from  remaining  suspended  beneath  a 
branch  for  a  long  time  together,  than  we  do  from  sitting  or  stand- 
ing erect, — a  position  which  the  Sloth  could  not  maintain  for  an 
instant  without  support.  The  position  which  the  Sloth  assumes 
during  sleep,  is  no  less  peculiar  than  that  of  its  period  of  activity. 
It  takes  its  place  at  the  fork  of  a  tree,  the  arms  embracing  the 
trunk,  the  back  resting  upon  the  angle  of  the  branch,  and  the 
head  reclining  on  the  chest.  The  animal  is  thus  rolled  up  almost 
in  the  form  of  a  ball ;  the  entire  vertebral  column,  including  the 
neck,  assumes  a  nearly  circular  curve ;  and  not  only  is  the  weight 
of  the  whole  body  maintained  in  an  attitude  of  ease  and  safety,  but 
the  head  is  supported  between  the  arms  and  chest,  and  the  face 


FAMILY    TARDIGRADA  ; SLOTHS.  275 

lies  buried  in  the  long  wool  which  covers  those  parts,  and  is  thus 
protected  during  sleep  from  the  myriads  of  insects  which  would 
otherwise  attack  it. 

242.  Although  the  Sloths  might  appear  to  be  totally  unpro- 
vided with  the  means  of  defence,  and  liable  to  fall  an  easy  prey 
to  their  enemies,  yet  this  is  really  very  far  from  being  the  case  ; 
since  their  structure  is  no  less  adapted  for  their  defence  from 
attacks,  than  it  is  for  their  peculiar  dwelling-place  and  supply  of 
food.  In  the  first  place,  their  long  shaggy  hair  defends  them  from 
the  insects,  which  in  that  climate  are  so  troublesome ;  its  texture 
is  very  peculiar,  more  resembling  dry  hay,  or  grass  shrivelled 
and  withered  by  the  sun,  than  the  hair  of  ordinary  quadrupeds ; 
and  its  appearance  so  much  resembles  that  of  the  bark  and  moss 
of  the  branches  on  which  the  Sloth  lives,  as  to  prevent  the  animal 
from  being  easily  detected,  except  when  it  moves.     Its  usual 
position  places  it  above  the  reach  of  ordinary  carnivorous  quad- 
rupeds ;    but  its  powerful  claws,   and  the  peculiarly  enduring 
strength  of  its  long  arms,  make  them  very  efficient  weapons  of 
defence.  When  attacked  on  the  ground,  the  Sloth  throws  himself 
on  his  back,  fixes  his  claws  on  his  adversary,  and  grasps  him 
with  enormous  power ;  in  this  manner  he  has  been  known  to 
strangle  a  dog,  holding  him  all  the  while  at  ami's  length  ;  and 
in  the  same  mode  he  grapples  with  snakes  of  large  size,  which, 
in  his  natural  residence,  are  probably  his  chief  enemies. 

243.  The  teeth  of  the  Sloths  are  not  fitted  to  grind  down 
their  food,  on  account  of  the  absence  of  the  ridges  of  hard  enamel 
which  we  find  in  the  molar  teeth  of  other  herbivorous  quad- 
rupeds ;  but  they  are  adapted  merely  to  bruise  it,  or  break  down 
the  tender  structure  of  the  buds  and  leaves.      This  deficiency  is 
compensated  by  the  complex  structure  of  the  stomach,  which 
somewhat  resembles  that  of  the  Ruminants  (§  98).     In  the  Two- 
toed  Sloth,  the  stomach  is  almost  completely  divided  into  two 
cavities,   of  which  the  first  is  again  partially  subdivided    into 
three  others ;  four  chambers  are  thus  formed,  which  are  obviously 
analogous  to  the  four  stomachs  of  the  Ruminantia ;  but  there  is  no 
reason  to  think  that  anything  like  actual  rumination  takes  place. 

244.  We  next  proceed  to  a  family  entirely  consisting  of  huge 
fossil  animals,  which  have  entirely  passed  from  the  surface  of  the 

T2 


"276  FAMILY  GRAVIGRADA  ; MYLODON. 

earth,  and  which  have  been  named  GRAVIGRADA  from  their  mas- 
sive character.  Of  one  of  these,  the  Mylodon  (of  which  there  is 
a  magnificent  skeleton  in  the  Museum  of  the  Royal  College  of 
Surgeons,  London),  an  elaborate  account  has  recently  been  pub- 
lished by  Professor  Owen ;  in  which  the  other  animals  of  the 
same  group  are  also  noticed.  All  of  them  appear,  from  the 
structure  of  their  teeth,  to  have  been  adapted  to  the  same  kind 
of  food  with  the  comparatively  pigmy  Sloths  of  the  present  day  ; 
but  instead  of  possessing  limbs  adapted  for  climbing  trees,  which 
could  not  have  borne  their  enormous  weight,  their  feet  were  con- 
structed for  digging ;  and  the  evidence  adduced  by  Professor 
Owen  from  the  structure  of  their  skeletons,  together  with  the 
beautiful  chain  of  reasoning  which  he  connects  with  this,  leave 
no  room  for  doubt,  that  they  obtained  their  food  by  digging 
around  the  bases  of  the  trees,  and  uprooting  their  trunks. 
"  Conceive  of  a  Sloth  of  the  size  and  bulk  of  a  Rhinoceros  or 
Hippopotamus,  but  with  bones  infinitely  more  massive,  muscles 
infinitely  more  voluminous  and  powerful,  with  a  thick  tail  acting 
as  a  support,  and  forming  with  the  hind  limbs  a  firm  tripod, 
•while  the  animal  thus  raised  upright,  and  exerting  its  enormous 
strength,  sways  the  tree  to  and  fro,  and  lays  it  at  last  prostrate  • 
— and  the  reader  will  have  a  good  idea  of  what  this  mighty 
devastator  (the  Mylodon)  of  the  primitive  forests  of  South 
America  must  have  been."  *  It  is  an  interesting  circumstance, 
that  the  skull  of  the  specimen  described  by  Professor  Owen  had 
at  some  time  been  fractured  and  had  healed, — the  animal  living 
long  afterwards ;  and  it  is  evident  that  these  animals  must  have 
been  unusually  liable,  from  their  habits,  to  blows  from  heavy 
falling  bodies.  It  appears  to  be  for  the  sake  of  meeting  these 
accidents,  that  the  outer  and  inner  layers  of  the  bones  of  the  skull 
are  separated  from  each  other  by  large  air-cells;  so  that  the 
fracture  of  the  outer  table  might  occur  without  injury  to  the 
brain.  The  same  structure  exists  in  the  Sloths  ;  and  is  evidently 
a  provision  against  injury  from  the  severe  falls,  to  which  these 
animals  must  be  occasionally  liable,  from  the  giving- way  of  the 
branches  to  which  they  cling. 

245.     The  Megatherium  was  an  animal  nearly  allied  to  the 

*  Pictorial  Museum,  Vol.  I.,  p.  178. 


FAMILY    GRAVIGRADA  ; MEGATHERIUM. 


277 


Mylodon  in  structure  and  habits  ;  and  several  remains  of  it 
have  been  found  in  different  parts  of  South  America.  Its  name 
indicates  its  enormous  bulk,  which  may  be  judged  of  from  the 
following  statement  of  its  dimensions.  Its  length,  when  full 
grown,  must  have  been  14  feet,  including  the  tail ;  and  its  height 
upwards  of  8  feet.  Its  thigh-bone  was  twice  the  thickness  of 
that  of  the  largest  Elephant ;  its  fore-foot  measured  more  than  a 
yard  in  length  by  twelve  inches  in  width,  and  the  toes  were 

terminated  by  en- 
ormous claws;  and 
the  width  of  the 
upper  part  of  the 
tail  could  not  have 
been  less  than  two 
feet.  With  the  re- 
mains of  the  Me- 
gatherium have 
been  not  unfre- 
quently  found  as- 
sociated the  relics 
of  a  bony  armour, 
resembling  that  of 
the  Armadillo  ; 
and  it  has  been 
supposed  that 
these  belonged  to 
it.  But  it  is  now 
known  that  they 
formed  the  cover- 
ing of  a  gigantic 
animal  of  the 
Armadillo  kind, 
which  will  be 
presently  noticed. 
The  genus  Mega- 
lonyx  (or  animal 
with  a  large  claw)  is  founded  on  some  remains  which  have  been 


FIG.  140. — FOOT  OF  MEGATHERIUM. 


278 


FAMILY    LORICATA  ; ARMADILLOS. 


discovered  in  North  and  South  America ;  from  the  size  and 
form  of  the  claw,  it  was  at  first  supposed  to  be  that  of  a  carni- 
vorous animal ;  but  Cuvier  rectified  the  error,  and  referred  it  to 
this  group.  The  Megalonyx  seems  to  have  been  closely  related 
to  the  Megatherium  in  structure  and  habits,  but  to  have  been  of 
less  dimensions  ;  its  size  was  about  that  of  an  Ox  ;  but  it  was 
much  more  solidly  and  heavily  built. 

246.  The  Insectivorous  Edentata  may  be  divided  into  two 
families, — the  LORICATA,  or  scaly  animals, — and  the  TRUE  EDEN- 
TATA, or  strictly  toothless  animals.     The  former  comprehends 
the  Armadillos  and  other  animals  allied  to  it ;  to  the  latter 
belong  the  Ant-eaters  and  Pangolins. 

247.  The  Armadillos  are  distinguished  from  all  other  Mam- 
malia by  the  inclosure  of  their  bodies  in  a  bony  armour  ;   this 
consists,  first,  of  a  large  triangular  or  oval  plate  on  the  top  of 
the  head,  which  projects  backwards,  so  as  to  cover  the  neck ; 
secondly,  of  a  large  buckler  over  the  shoulders,  and  a  similar 


FIG.  i4J. — PKBA,  OR  EIGHT-BANDED  ARMADILLO. 

buckler  over  the  haunches  ;  and  thirdly,  of  a  series  of  transverse 
bands  which  intervene  between  these,  and  are  united  to  each 
other  in  such  a  manner  as  to  allow  freedom  of  motion  to  the 
body.  Each  of  these  separate  portions  consists  of  a  number  of 
small  pieces  united  together,  like  the  separate  portions  of  a 
mosaic,  or  of  a  tesselated  pavement.  The  tail,  also,  is  covered 
by  a  series  of  bony  rings.  The  limbs,  which  are  short  and 
thick,  are  almost  entirely  concealed  by  the  edges  of  this  armour ; 


FAMILY    LORICATA  ; ARMADILLOS. 


279 


and  the  skin  of  the  under  surface  of  the  body  is  very  tough,  and 
is  beset  with  long  scattered  hairs,  of  which  some  are  also  seen  to 
issue  forth  between  the  joints  of  the  armour.  The  feet  are 

peculiarly  adapted  for  dig- 
ging, in  regard  both  to  their 
size  and  strength,  and  in 
being  terminated  by  very 
strong  and  sharp  claws. 
The  muzzle  is  pointed,  and 
the  mouth  small ;  the  teeth 
are  feeble  and  destitute  of 
true  roots  ;  they  are  set 
apart  from  one  another,  in 
such  a  manner  that,  when 
the  jaws  are  closed,  those  of 
each  jaw  fit  into  the  inter- 
vals between  those  of  the 
other.  The  tongue  is  smooth 
and  slender,  and  is  moist- 
ened with  a  glutintius  saliva. 
The  Armadillos  are  burrow- 
ing animals,  and  remain  in  their  retreats  during  the  day,  issuing 
forth  at  night  in  search  of 
food.  They  hasten  to  their 
burrows  when  alarmed,  and 
seem  to  be  peculiarly  sensi- 
tive to  unusual  sounds;  when 
they  have  gained  their  holes, 
they  stoutly  resist  any  at- 
tempt to  draw  them  forth,  Fro.  14a-SKULL  OF  ARMADCLLO. 

by  clinging  to  the  walls  with 

their  strong  claws  ;  so  that  they  have  been  known  to  leave  their 
tails  in  the  hands  of  the  hunters,  who  attempted  thus  to  secure 
them.  When  unable  to  gain  their  burrows,  they  either  endea- 
vour to  dig  a  temporary  place  of  refuge,  or  roll  up  their  bodies 
in  such  a  manner,  that  almost  every  part  is  defended  by  their 
strong  coat  of  mail.  Their  food  consists  chiefly  of  succulent 


Fm.  142 — FOOT  OF  ARMADILLO. 


280        FAMILY    LORICATA  ; ARMADILLO,  CHLAMYPHORUS. 

roots,  fallen  fruits,  and  other  soft  vegetable  substances ;  but  they 
will  feed  on  carrion  when  it  falls  in  their  way ;  and  greedily 
devour  worms,  small  lizards  and  serpents,  the  eggs  of  birds  which 
build  upon  the  ground,  and  also  (it  is  believed)  ants.  Those 
which  live  near  the  Pampas,  glut  themselves  on  the  half-putrid 
carcases  of  the  wild  cattle,  which  are  slaughtered  for  the  sake  of 
their  skins  and  tallow  ;  and  becoming  extremely  fat  upon  this 
diet,  they  are  esteemed  great  delicacies  (roasted  whole  in  their 
shells),  not  only  by  the  Indians,  but  also  by  the  Spanish  and  Por- 
tuguese Americans.  Numerous  other  species  exist;  but  they  are 
all  confined  to  South  America.  The  largest  at  present  existing 
is  the  Great  Armadillo,  which  inhabits  Brazil  and  the  Northern 
parts  of  Paraguay  ;  this,  although  3  feet  3  inches  from  the  nose 
to  the  origin  of  the  tail,  must  have  been  a  pigmy  in  comparison 
with  the  gigantic  Glyptodon,  a  fossil  species,  of  whose  armour 
a  nearly  complete  specimen  is  contained  in  the  Museum  of  the 
College  of  Surgeons,  London. 

248.  In  South  America,  also,  is  found  another  very  remark- 
able animal,  named  the  Chlamyphorus  truncatus,  or  Pichiciago  ; 
in  which  several  characters  of  different  tribes  are  remarkably 
blended.  Like  the  Armadillo,  it  has  a  tesselated  shield ;  the 
consistence  of  which  is  not  bony,  however,  being  between  horn 
and  leather.  This  shield  commences  on  the  head,  and  extends 
over  the  back  and  haunches,  dipping  abruptly  down  over  the 
latter,  so  as  to  look  as  if  the  body  were  cut  off  there  (whence 
the  specific  name  of  the  animal  is  derived) ;  it  is  divided  by  inter- 
secting furrows  into  a  series  of  bands  or  strips,  each  of  which 
is  made  up  of  a  row  of  square  plates ;  but  instead  of  being 
firmly  attached  by  its  whole  under-surface  to  the  integuments 
beneath  (as  is  the  case  with  that  of  the  Armadillo),  it  is  con- 
nected with  the  back  only  by  a  ridge  of  skin  along  the  spine, 
and  with  the  skull  by  two  bony  prominences  from  the  forehead. 
The  sides  and  under  surface  of  the  body  are  covered  with  fine 
silky  hair,  like  that  of  the  Mole  ;  to  which  animal  it  bears  a 
strong  resemblance  also,  in  the  form  of  its  fore-feet,  in  the  im- 
perfection of  its  eyes  (which  are  not  visible  externally),  in  the 
conical  form  of  its  snout,  and  in  its  general  habits  of  life.  It  is 


•  FAMILY  LORICATA;  ORYCTEROPUS. — TRUE  EDENTATA.     281 

a  native  of  Chili,  where,  like  a  Mole,  it  works  out  galleries  in 
the  rich  soil  of  the  valleys,  living  for  the  most  part  under  ground 
in  quiet  seclusion,  and  feeding  upon  the  insects,  worms,  and 
larvae  which  it  meets  with  in  its  mining  operations.  It  is  a 
very  rare  animal,  being  regarded  by  the  natives  themselves  as  a 
curiosity. 

249.  The  only  known  species  of  this  group  which  is  found 
elsewhere  than  in  South  America,  is  the   Orycteropus,  of  the 
Cape  of  Good  Hope  ;  which  is  termed  by  the  Dutch  Colonists 
Aard-vark,  or  Earth-hog.     This  animal,  which  is  about  the  size 
of  a  Badger,  connects  the  preceding  group  with  the  toothless 
Ant-Eaters;  having  the  molar  teeth  and  strong  digging  fore- 
feet of  the  Armadillos  ;  but  being  destitute  of  their  scaly  armour, 
and  possessing  the  hairy  covering  and  long  extensible  tongue  of 
the   true   Ant-eaters.     The   Aarti-vark   is  insectivorous  in  its 
habits, — attacking  the  large  ant-hills  of  the  districts  it  inhabits, 
by  tearing  open 'the  roofe  of  the  mud- walled  hillocks  which 
these  insects  construct;  and  it  forms  very  extensive  burrows 
at  a  little  distancfc  beneath  the  surface  of  the  ground,  which  are 
sometimes  so  numerous,  as  to  become  sources  of  danger  to  horses 
and   waggons  traversing  the  ^oo'untry.      When  alarmed  in  its 
retreat,  it  mines  onwards  with  such  rapidity,  as  frequently  to 
elude  the  search  of  those  who  would  dig  it  out. 

250.  Of  the  TRUE  EDENTATA,  or  toothless  Ant-eaters^  which 
constitute  the  second  family  of  the  insectivorous  division  of  this 
order,   there  are  two  genera, — the  Myrmecophaga,  or  proper 
Ant-eater  of  South  America, — and  the  Manis  or  Pangolin  of 
Africa  and  India.     Both  these  are  characterised  by  the  total 
absence  of  teeth,  by  the  pointed  form  of  the  muzzle  and  the 
narrowness  of  the  mouth,  by  the  possession  of  a  long,  slender, 
extensible  tongue,  which  is  moistened  by  an  extremely  viscid 
saliva,  and  by   strong  feet  armed   with   sharp  cutting  claws. 
These  last  are  adapted  rather  for  tearing  open  the  dwellings  of  the 
Termites,  or  White  Ants,  on  which  these  animals  feed,  than  for 
excavating  burrows  in  the  soil ;  when  an  entrance  has  been  thus 
forced,  the  long  tongue  is  sent  down  in  the  nest,  and,  when  with- 
drawn, brings  back  into  the  mouth  a  large  number  of  Ants, 


282 


TRUE   EDENTATA  ; ANT-EATER,  PANGOLIN. 


which  are  glued  to  its  surface  by  the  secretion  that  covers  it. 

The  Ant-eaters  and  Pangolins  differ  completely,  however,  in 

external  aspect,  and  in 
the  nature  of  their 
covering ;  though  they 
are  both  furnished  with 
very  efficient  means  of 
defence  against  the  In- 
sects on  which  they 
make  war.  For,  in 
the  Ant-Eater,  the 
whole  body  is  covered 
with  long  shaggy  hair, 
which  forms  a  kind  of 
mane  along  the  back  ; 
and  its  tail,  which  is 
carried  erect,  is  very 
bushy.  In  the  Pan- 
golin, (Fig.  49,)  on 

the  other  hand,   the  whole  body,  as  well  as  the  tail,  is  covered 

with  dense  horny  scales,  which  have  an  imbricated  arrangement 


FIG.  144. — HEAD  AND  FOOT  OF  ANT-EATER. 


FIG.  145 — GREAT  ANT-EATER. 


(each  row  being  partly  covered  by  the  rest,  like  the  tiles  on  a 
roof) ;  and  when  attacked,  it  rolls  itself  up  into  a  ball,  wraps  its 
tail  over  its  head,  and  raises  all  its  pointed  and  sharp-edged  scales 
in  such  array,  as  to  defy  the  onset  of  any  enemy.  There  is  a 


ORDER  RUMINANTIA  ; — GENERAL  CHARACTERS.      283 

small  species  of  Ant-Eater,  inhabiting  the  forests  of  Guiana  and 
Brazil,  which  is  remarkable  for  having  only  two  toes  on  the 
fore-foot,  and  for  possessing  a  prehensile  tail,  by  which  it  can 
suspend  itself  from  the  branches  of  trees,  in  the  bark  and  fissures 
of  which  it  seeks  the  insects  that  serve  for  its  food. 


ORDER  IX.— RUMINANTIA. 

251.  The  division  of  the  herbivorous  Mammalia,  which  is 
designated  by  the  title  of  Ruminant,  forms  a  remarkably  na- 
tural and  well-defined  order ;  by  which  is  meant,  that  all  the 
animals  composing  it  agree  in  their  most  important  characters, 
and  differ  from  all  those  of  other  orders ;  so  that  there  can  be  no 
doubt  in  regard  to  the  position  of  any  one  of  them.     They  seem, 
indeed,  as  if  they  were  all  constructed  upon  the  same  model, — 
the  variations  being  often  so  trifling,  that  it  is  difficult  to  assign 
definite  characters  to  the  subordinate  groups.    The  Camels  alone 
constitute  an  exception  to  this  general  statement ;  for  these,  in 
the  structure  of  their  teeth,   and  in  some  other  peculiarities, 
depart  from  the  Ruminant  type,  and  exhibit  an  approach  to  the 
order  Pachydermata ;  but  in  this  manner  they  form  just  that 
bond  of  connexion  between  the  two  orders,  which  allied  groups, 
that  are  really  natural,  always  present. 

252.  The  animals  of  this  group  are,  of  all  the  Herbivora, 
those  which  are  most  completely  restricted  to  vegetable  food. 
We  have  seen  that  among  the  Rodentia,  there  are  many  which 
do  not  reject  animal  food,  and  some  which  greedily  devour  it. 
Of  the  Edentata,  a  large  proportion  live  on  insects  ;  and  many 
of  these  also  devour  animal  flesh  with  avidity.      Among  the 
Pachydermata,  too,  there  are  several  species  (as  we  shall  here- 
after see),  to  which  an  animal  diet  appears  by  no  means  un- 
natural.     But    this  is  not  the  case  with  a  single  Ruminant 
quadruped ;  for  the  whole  order  seems  destined  to  feed  upon 
vegetable  matter,  and  upon  this  exclusively.       Some,  as  the 
Camel  and  Giraffe,  are  adapted  rather  for  browzing  upon  the 


284      ORDER  RUMINANTIA  ; GENERAL  CHARACTERS. 

leaves  and  young  shoots  of  trees  or  shrubs  ;  whilst  the  great  pro- 
portion have  their  mouths  fitted  for  grazing  upon  the  herbage 
that  covers  the  surface  of  the  soil. 

253.  All  the  animals  of  this  order  agree  in  the  absence  of 
incisor  teeth  from  the  upper  jaws, — the  hardened  gum  sustain- 
ing the  pressure   of  the  lower  incisors  (which  are  apparently 
eight  in  number)  with  their  broad  edges.     Of  these  teeth,  how- 
ever, the  two  outer  ones,  which  are  usually  smaller  than  the  rest 
and  more  oblique  in  their  position,  are  really  to  be  regarded  as 
canines,  somewhat  modified  in  their  form  ;  this  is  evident  in  the 
Camels,  in  which  these  teeth  have  the  ordinary  form  and   size 
of  canines.     The  molar  teeth  are  six  on  either  side  of  each  jaw. 
Their  surface  exhibits  crescent-shaped  ridges,  formed  by  enamel 
surrounding  a  centre  of  bony  matter  or  cortical  substance  (AmM. 
PHYSIOL.,  §  182).     In   the  Camels,   there  are  apparently  five 
molars  on  each  side ;  but  a  sixth  molar  really  exists,  although 
it  is  shaped  like  a   canine   tooth,  and  is  placed  immediately 
behind  the  true  canine,  far  in  front  of  the  other  molars,  so  as  to 
resemble  a  second  canine.     The  Camels  are  further  remarkable 
for  possessing  canine  and  incisor  teeth  in  the  upper  jaw ;  the 
latter  are  originally  four  in  number ;  but  the  two  central  ones 
fall  out  early,  and  those  which  remain  resemble  the  canines  in 
figure.    In  the  Musk-Deer,  too,  there  are  canines  of  considerable 
length  in  the  upper  jaw,  though  the  incisors  are  absent ;  and  the 
presence  of  canines  in  the  upper  jaw  is  by  no  means  un frequent 
among  the  males  of  the  ordinary  Ruminants, — their  rudiments 
being  also  discoverable  in  the  female. 

254.  The  structure  of  the  feet  of  the  Ruminantia  varies  no 
more  than  that  of  the  teeth ;  and  where,  as  in  the  Camel  tribe, 
we  find  a  departure  from  the  usual  type  as  to  the  latter,  we  may 
notice  it  also  in  regard  to  the  former.     The  feet  are  invariably 
terminated  by  two   toes,   whose  extremities  are   enveloped  in 
distinct  hoofs;    and    the  surfaces  of  these  hoofs,   which  look 
towards  each  other,  are  so  flattened,  that  the  appearance  is  that 
of  a  single  cleft  hoof.     Each  toe  has  three  phalangeal  bones ; 
and  these  are  articulated  with  a  single  long  metatarsal  or  canon- 
bone.     Besides  the  two  large  or  true  toes,  there  are  two  small 


ORDER  RUMINANTIA; — GENERAL  CHARACTERS. 


285 


short  lateral  toes  in  some  groups,  each  having  three  phalanges, 
connected  with  a  small  splint-bone  like  that  of  the  Horse 
(Fig.  167).  Now  in  the  Camels,  the  toes, — 
instead  of  being  short  and  strong,  and  abruptly 
terminated  by  hoofs  which  afford  a  flattened  sur- 
face for  the  limb  to  bear  upon, — are  lengthened, 
and  are  only  tipped  with  small  hoofs,  the  bearing 
Surface  being  a  large  pulpy  sole  or  pad,  covered 
with  a  hard  callous  skin,  and  placed  like  a  cushion 
beneath  the  toes.  The  use  of  this  peculiar  con  - 
formation  will  be  apparent,  when  the  habits  of  the 
Camel  are  considered. 

255.  The  name  of  this  order  is  derived  from 
the  singular  process  of  rumination,  which  the 
food  undergoes  in  all  the  animals  composing  it ; 
as  the  nature  of  this  process  has  been  already 
described,  it  need  not  be  here  repeated.  (See  §  99, 
and  ANIM.  PHYSIOL.,  §  198).  But  we  may  stop  and  second  rows  of 

,.  .  .,          ,,  _      .  .      tarsal  bones  ;c,me- 

for  an  instant  to  consider   the   purpose   of  this  tatarsai  or  canon- 
curious  provision:  which  has  a  very  interesting  b"nf;    *•***  pti 

J  »   phalangeal  bones. 

connection  with  the  rest  of  their  organisation.  The 
Ruminantia,  taken  as  a  group,  are  timid,  and  are  destitute  of 
powerful  means  of  defence  against  their  foes ;  seeking  safety  in 
flight,  when  alarmed,  rather  than  stopping  to  defend  themselves. 
A  large  proportion  of  them  are  natives  of  tropical  regions,  where 
they  are  liable  to  the  attacks  of  the  larger  beasts  of  prey.  Now 
their  food, — consisting  as  it  does  of  grasses  and  herbage  of 
various  kinds,  which  contain  a  considerable  amount  of  woody 
fibre, — requires  to  be  thoroughly  masticated,  before  it  can  be 
properly  digested.  "When  feeding  on  the  pastures  they  frequent, 
they  are  subject  to  many  alarms ;  and  if  they  were  compelled  to 
spend  a  considerable  time  in  masticating  their  food  before 
swallowing  it,  they  would  often  be  in  danger  of  starvation,  by 
being  obliged  to  leave  their  pasture  before  their  wants  were 
supplied.  But  by  their  power  of  subsequently  returning  their 
food  to  the  mouth,  and  chewing  it  at  their  leisure,  they  are 
enabled  to  dispense  entirely  with  any  mastication,  previously  to 


286         ORDER  RUMINANTIA; — GENERAL  CHARACTERS. 

first  swallowing  it,  and  to  feed  with  comparative  quickness. 
They  thus  convey  a  store  of  food  into  the  first  stomach  or  paunch, 
as  the  Monkey  does  into  its  cheek-pouches ;  and  then,  retiring  to 
a  secluded  place  among  their  mountain  fastnesses,  they  masticate 
their  aliment  in  comparative  security.  Moreover,  the  macera- 
tion (or  soaking)  in  the  fluids  of  the  first  and  second  stomachs, 
to  which  the  food  has  been  subjected,  causes  it  to  be  much  more 
readily  ground  down,  than  if  it  were  triturated  immediately  on 
being  first  cropped  from  the  pasture. — In  this  respect,  there  is  a 
remarkable  analogy  in  the  process  of  rumination  to  that  of 
digestion  in  the  Fowls  and  other  grain-eating  Birds  (ANIM. 
PHYSIOL.,  §  200)  ;  for  their  food  is  first  swallowed,  then  mace- 
rated in  the  fluids  of  the  crop,  and  then  triturated,  before  it  is 
submitted  to  the  true  digestive  process, — the  only  essential  differ- 
ence being,  that  this  trituration  is  accomplished  in  a  portion  of 
the  stomach  termed  the  gizzard,  instead  of  between  the  jaws, 
which  in  this  class  are  destitute  of  teeth.  This  is  only  one  of 
many  remarkable  analogies,  which  will  be  hereafter  pointed  out 
between  the  order  RUMINANTIA  among  Mammalia,  and  that  of 
RASORES  among  Birds. 

256.  The  general  structure  of  the  Ruminantia  is  obviously 
adapted  to  what  has  been  just  stated  of  their  habits.  Their 
senses  are  extremely  acute,  and  serve  to  indicate  to  them  the 
approach  of  danger,  as  well  as  to  direct  them  in  their  choice  of 
food.  Their  eyes  are  placed  at  the  side  of  the  head,  rather  than 
in  front ;  and  in  this  manner  they  have  a  great  range  of  vision, 
which  is  further  extended  by  the  horizontally-oval  form  of  the 
pupil  (ANIM.  PHYSIOL.,  §  534),  so  that  they  can  see  almost  as  far 
behind  as  before  them.  The  ears  also  are  placed  far  back,  and 
are  very  movable  ;  so  that  they  can  be  turned  to  catch  sounds  in 
any  direction.  The  sense  of  smell  seems  particularly  acute  in 
these  animals,  chiefly  in  consequence  of  the  prolongation  of  the 
muzzle,  which  affords  a  large  surface  for  the  distribution  of  the 
olfactory  nerve  within  the  nose  ;  by  its  means,  they  are  warned 
of  the  presence  of  an  enemy  at  a  considerable  distance,  especially 
in  the  direction  of  the  wind,  so  that  the  hunters  often  find  it 
necessary  to  approach  them  from  the  contrary  quarter.  As 


ORDER  RUMINANTIA  ; — GENERAL  CHARACTERS.      287 

already  stated,  they  commonly  seek  safety  in  flight  when  alarmed ; 
and  the  structure  of  their  bodies  usually  adapts  them  to  great 
swiftness  of  foot.  Their  legs  are  long  in  proportion  to  the  size 
of  the  trunk  ;  and  the  spinal  column  is  very  flexible ;  both  which 
conditions  are  favourable  to  great  activity  of  motion.  It  is  for 
the  most  part  among  the  domesticated  species,  in  which  there  is 
an  accumulation  of  flesh  and  fat,  at  the  expense  of  muscular 
firmness  and  vigour,  that  there  is  a  deficiency  in  this  respect. 
The  Ruminantia  are  not  destitute,  however,  of  means  of  attack 
and  defence,  which  they  employ  in  their  contests  with  each  other, 
or  when  brought  to  bay  by  their  enemies.  Their  strong  horns 
are  used  by  them  to  gore  their  opponents,  and  their  heads  to  lift 
and  toss  them  ;  or,  presenting  their  hind  quarters,  they  inflict 
most  powerful  blows  by  kicking  with  their  hind  feet. 

257.  The  Ruminants,  of  all  animals,  are  those  which  are 
most  useful  to  Man.  They  furnish  him  with  nearly  all  the  ani- 
mal flesh  which  he  consumes.  Some  of  them  serve  him  as  beasts 
of  burden ;  and  others  supply  him  with  milk,  tallow,  hides, 
horns,  and  other  products  most  important  to  his  comfort  and 
even  to  his  subsistence.  They  are  universally  distributed  over 
the  globe,  from  the  equator  to  regions  within  the  arctic  circle, — 
being  most  numerous,  however,  between  the  tropics ;  and  this 
wide  range  is  essentially  connected  with  the  well-being,  and 
extensive  distribution,  of  the  Human  race.  From  the  earliest 
periods,  certain  species  of  this  order  have  been  domesticated,  and 
have  accompanied  Man  in  his  gradual  diffusion  over  the  globe  ; 
so  that  there  is  scarcely  a  spot  where  he  exists  (except  the 
inhospitable  regions  tenanted  by  the  Greenlander  and  Esqui- 
maux, which  do  not  afford  the  requisite  pasture, — and  some  of 
the  islands  of  the  Polynesian  Archipelago,  into  which  these  ani- 
mals have  not  yet  been  introduced),  which  is  not  tenanted  also 
by  the  Ox,  the  Sheep,  or  the  Goat.  Other  species,  again, 
although  equally  subject  to  Man,  are  formed  to  inhabit  certain 
localities  only,  to  which  the  peculiarities  of  their  construction 
specially  adapt  them  ;  and  these  have  consequently  not  spread 
with  the  others.  One  of  these  is  the  Rein-deer,  on  which  the 
inhabitants  of  Lapland,  a  country  too  cold  for  the  Sheep  and 


288         ORDER  RUMINANTIA; — GENERAL  CHARACTERS. 

Ox,  almost  entirely  depend  for  their  support,  their  clothing,  and 
for  most  of  the  comforts  and  conveniences  of  their  simple 
manner  of  living.  And  another  is  the  Camel,  the  "  ship  of  the 
desert,"  which  traverses  the  burning  sands,  under  a  heavy  load, 
patient  of  hunger  and  thirst,  and  which  is,  besides,  to  the  wander- 
ing Arab,  all  that  the  Rein-deer  is  to  the  Laplander. 

258.  Notwithstanding  the   acuteness   of  the  senses  of  the 
Ruminants,  the  development  of  their  brain  is  low  ;  and  although 
usually  docile,   they  do  not  show  any  considerable  amount  of 
intelligence.     It  may  be  remarked  of  them,  therefore,  as  of  the 
Rodentia,  that  they  may  be  tamed  rather  than  educated.     Nor 
do  they  attract  notice  on  account  of  anything  peculiar  in  their 
instinctive  propensities ;  for  these  are   usually  of  the  simplest 
kind,  having  reference  only  to  the  selection  of  food,  and  to  the 
avoidance  of  danger. 

259.  As  already  noticed  (§  253),  the  Camels  and  Musk- 
deer  differ  from  the  typical  Ruminants  in  their  dentition ;  they 
also  differ  from  them  in  the  absence  of  horns,  which  are  found 
on  the  heads  of  all  the  other  animals  of  the  order,  in  the  males 
at  least.     It  is  by  the  nature  of  these  horns,  that  the  order  is 
subdivided  into   families  ;  the  aberrant  CAMELID.^  (or  Camel 
tribe),  which  lead  towards  the  Pachyderm ata,  and  the  MOSCHID^ 
(or  Musk-deer),  which  are  intermediate  between  these  and  the 
true   Ruminants,  having  been  first  separated. — The  horns,  as 
formerly  explained  (§  82),  essentially  consist   of  prominences 
of  the  frontal  bone ;  which  are  sometimes  persistent,  or  enduring 
with  the  life  of  the  animal ;  and  sometimes  deciduous,  falling  off 
annually.     1.  The  persistent  bone  may  be  covered  with  a  horny 
substance,  which  grows  with  it  during  life ;  this  is  the  case  with 
that  division  of  the  group, — including  the  Oxen,  Sheep,  Goats, 
and  Antelopes, — to  which  the  term  Cattle  is  commonly  applied. 

2.  The  bone  may  be  covered  with  a  prolongation  of  the  skin  of 
the   head,    bearing   hair ;     as  is    the   case  with    the    Giraffe. 

3.  The  bony  horn  is  covered  with  a  skin,  like  other  parts  of  the 
head,  but  is  altogether  thrown  off  at  intervals,  and  replaced  by 
a  new  growth,  which  is  usually  larger  than  the  preceding  ;  this 
is  the  case  with  the  Deer, 


FAMILY    CERVID^E,    OR    DEER    TRIBE.  289 

260.  The  family  CERVID^J,  or  Deer  tribe,  then,  is  distin- 
guished from  all  the  rest,  by  the  possession  of  bony  deciduous 
horns ;  covered  with  a  soft  skin,  or  velvet,  instead  of  with  horny 
matter ;  and  termed  Antlers.  "  The  animals  of  this  group,  cele- 
brated for  their  beauty,  vigour,  and  speed,  are  spread  very  exten- 
sively over  the  globe,  each  quarter  having  its  own  peculiar 
species.  To  this  universality  of  distribution,  however,  there  are 
certain  exceptions;  none  are  found  in  Australia,  and  none  in 
the  southern  and  central  regions  of  Africa ;  their  place  in  the 
latter  regions  being  supplied  by  the  Giraffe,  and  by  hosts  of 
Antelopes."  Hills  of  moderate  elevation,  wide  plains,  and  forests, 
are  the  localities  to  which  these  fleet-limbed  creatures  give  prefer- 
ence ;  none  tenant  the  peaked  ridges  of  the  mountain-top,  where 
the  Chamois  and  Musk-deer  find  a  congenial  abode.  They  delight 
in  a  wide  range  of  country,  and  trust  to  their  swiftness  of  flight 
for  safety.  Most  of  them  herd  together  in  troops  ;  some  few  live 
singly.  It  may  be  observed  that,  in  general,  their  body  is  round 
and  stout ;  their  limbs  long,  sinewy,  and  powerful ;  their  neck 
long,  but  very  muscular ;  their  head  small  and  carried  high  ; 
their  eyes  large  and  full ;  their  ears  ample.*  "  With  the  excep- 
tion of  the  Rein-deer,  the  female  is  destitute  of  antlers ;  save  in 
a  few  rare  individual  cases,  analogous  to  those  in  which  the  hen 
assumes  the  plumage  of  a  cock  bird.  These  appendages  are  very 
useful  for  the  purposes  of  defence,  and  occasionally  for  attack ; 
and  it  is  remarkable  that  the  species  inhabiting  the  coldest 
climates,  are  those  in  which  the  antlers  are  most  flattened ;  as 
if  they  were  destined  to  be  used  by  the  animal,  like  shovels, 
in  clearing  the  snow  from  off  its  food.  This  is  especially  the 
case  with  the  Elk,  which,  with  the  Rein-deer,  inhabits  the  coldest 
parts  of  the  northern  hemisphere,  in  both  the  Old  and  New  World; 
and  by  this  character  they  are  separated  from  the  other  Deer. — 
The  Elk,  or  Moose-deer,  was  once  tolerably  numerous  in  Europe, 
but  is  now  very  rare  in  that  quarter  of  the  globe ;  it  is  much 
more  abundant,  however,  in  North  America,  its  head-quarters 
being  the  vicinity  of  the  great  lakes,  and  the  forests  on  both 

Pictorial  Museum,  Vol.  I.,  p.  130. 


290 


FAMILY    CERVID.E  ; — ELK,    REIN-DEER. 


sides  of  the  river  St.  Lawrence  ;  and  in  summer  it  frequents 
marshy  districts,  even  feeding  on  grass  that  is  actually  submerged. 
This  animal  is  as  large  as  a  horse,  sometimes  larger ;  it  is  rather 
heavy  in  its  aspect  and  movements ;  but  it  possesses  great  power. 
The  antlers  of  the  male  are,  when  fully  formed,  extremely  large, 
and  weigh  50  or  60  Ibs.  This  development,  however,  is  only 
gradually  attained.  The  first  year,  they  are  not  more  than  an 
inch  in  length,  and  the  second  they  rise  to  a  foot ;  but  they  then 
are  simple  dagger-shaped  spikes,  and  are  termed  dags,  or  prickets. 
In  the  third  year  they  are  forked ;  and  in  the  fourth,  they  are 
somewhat  flattened,  and  have  six  snags  or  projections :  the 
number  of  these  goes  on  increasing  after  each  change,  until  the 
horns  become  extremely  flattened,  and  possess  14  branches  on 
each  side. 

261 .     The  Rein-deer  is  the  only  species  of  this  family,  which 
can  be  considered  as  domesticated  ;  and  this  condition  does  not 


FIG.  14/.— 


seem  natural  to  it,  for  the  domesticated  individuals  are  smaller 
than  the  wild  ones,  even  though  better  fed.  In  the  wild  state, 
the  full-grown  male  is  equal  in  size  to  a  Stag ;  but  it  is  a 
much  less  graceful  animal,  the  neck  being  very  short,  the  head 
carried  in  a  line  with  the  body,  and  the  general  aspect  heavy. 


REIN-DEER,    FALLOW-DEER,    IRISH    ELK.  291 

The  Rein-deer  is  strictly  a  polar  animal;  it  has  never  been 
known  to  come  further  south  in  Europe  than  the  Gulf  of 
Bothnia;  and  from  Lapland  it  extends  eastward  along  the 
borders  of  the  Arctic  Sea,  inhabiting  many  of  the  islands  of  the 
Frozen  Ocean,  and  even  tenanting  Spitzbergen,  where  Man.  with  all 
his  power  of  adaptation  to  climate,  is  unable  to  maintain  a  long 
residence.  Rein-deer,  differing  slightly  from  those  of  the  Old 
Continent,  are  found  in  North  America ;  but  it  is  probable  that 
these  are  mere  varieties,  which  have  introduced  themselves  into 
the  New  World,  by  journeying  along  the  ice  that  connects  it 
with  the  nearest  part  of  Asia.  This  valuable  animal  obtains  its 
subsistence  in  summer  from  the  buds  and  twigs  of  the  small 
arctic  shrubs ;  and  in  winter  from  a  lichen,  which  grows  beneath 
the  snow,  and  which  it  digs  up  with  its  feet.  In  the  wild  state 
it  is  gregarious ;  and  when  domesticated,  it  readily  associates 
with  its  fellows  into  large  herds,  which  are  very  obedient  to  the 
directions  of  the  herdsman.  Many  Laplanders  possess  no 
less  than  two  thousand  of  these  animals ;  and  their  wealth 
is  estimated  by  the  number  they  possess, — as  that  of  the 
Patriarchs  of  old,  and  of  the  Arabs  of  the  present  time,  by  the 
amount  of  their  flocks,  herds,  and  camels. — The  Fallow-deer  also 
belongs  to  the  group  of  CervidEe  possessing  flattened  horns; 
the  species  at  present  existing  in  the  parks  of  this  country, 
appears  to  have  been  introduced  from  the  south  of  Europe, 
where  it  is  occasionally  to  be  met  with  in  a  wild  state ;  but 
remains  of  a  much  larger  species,  now  extinct,  are  not  unfre- 
quently  met  with  in  the  peat  bogs  of  Ireland  and  elsewhere,  and 
are  commonly  designated  as  those  of  the  "  Irish  Elk."  The 
antlers,  however,  are  much  less  palmated  (that  is,  flattened  and 
divided)  than  those  of  the  true  Elks ;  but  they  spread  very  widely 
apart,  some  of  them  having  been  found  as  much  as  thirteen  feet 
between  the  tips.  Judging  from  specimens  of  which  many  of 
the  bones  have  been  discovered,  this  animal  must  have  stood 
more  than  six  feet  high,  and  must  have  been  more  than  nine 
feet  long. 

262.     The  species  of  Deer  with  round  antlers  are  very  nume- 
rous, and  are  diffused  through  the  temperate  and  tropical  portions 

u  2 


292 


FAMILY    CERVIDJE  ; STAG,    WAPITI. 


of  the  Old  and  New  World ;  those  of  temperate  climates  change 
colour,  more  or  less,  with  the  seasons.  As  belonging  to  this 
group,  we  may  especially  notice  the  common  Staff,  or  Red  Deer, 
which  is  a  native  of  the  forests  of  all  Europe,  and  of  the  tempe- 
rate parts  of  Asia ;  although,  not  being  readily  subservient  to 
Man,  it  is  rapidly  disappearing  as  his  influence  extends.  In 
England,  very  few  of  these  noble  animals  still  exist,  and  these 
are  mostly  in  a  half-domesticated  state ;  but  many  still  remain 
in  the  mountainous  and  woody  parts  of  Scotland,  especially  in 


FIG.  148.— STAG,  OB  RED  DEER. 


the  forest  of  Athol,  in  which  several  thousands  are  known  to 
reside. — The  Stag  is  replaced  in  North  America,  by  the  Wapiti, 
(commonly,  but  erroneously,  termed  an  Elk),  which  is  a  fourth 
larger  than  our  Stag,  but  nearly  of  the  same  colour.  Several 


ROEBUCK  ; — FAMILY    CAMELOPARDIDJS.  293 

other  species  of  Deer  exist  in  America  and  Asia.  — The  Roebuck 
s  the  representative  of  a  group  more  nearly  approaching  the  Goats 
in  form  and  habit ;  for  whilst  the  Stag  delights  in  extensive 
forests,  and  the  Fallow-deer  in  wooded  plains,  the  predilection  of 
the  Roebuck  is  evidently  for  mountainous  localities;  and  its 
boldness  and  agility  in  leaping  are  not  much  inferior  to  those  of 
the  Chamois.  Of  this  kind  several  species  exist  in  the  temperate 
parts  of  Europe,  Asia,  and  America.  There  are  species  existing 
in  India,  which  are  of  small  size,  and  have  long  canine-teeth  ; 
presenting,  in  these  and  other  respects,  an  approach  to  the 
Musk-deer. 

263.  The  family  CAMELOPARDIDJE  includes  only  that  very 
remarkable  animal,  the  Giraffe  ;  which,  though  it  most  nearly 
approaches  the  Deer  in  its  general  structure,  has  points  of  affinity, 
also,  with  the  Antelopes  and  Camels,  besides  very  striking  pecu- 
liarities of  its  own.  On  a  first  glance  at  this  animal,  we  notice 
the  enormous  length  of  the  fore-legs,  and  the  height  of  its  neck, 
which  carries  its  small,  and  rather  delicately-formed  head  at  a 
vast  height  from  the  ground, — not  less,  in  some  instances,  than 
eighteen  feet.  Notwithstanding  the  great  length  of  the  neck, 
however,  the  number  of  cervical  vertebrae  is  not  greater  than  in 
other  Mammalia  (ANIM.  PHYSIOL.,  §  627)  '>  and  the  fewness  of 
the  joints  prevents  the  neck  from  being  bent  or  arched  with  that 
elegance,  which  is  displayed  by  the  Swan ;  although  nothing  can 
exceed  the  gracefulness  of  form  which  this  part  sometimes 
presents.  The  aspect  of  the  Giraffe,  with  its  neck  stretched  up 
to  the  full,  while  the  animal  gazes  around  with  his  large  beam- 
ing eyes,  or  plucks  the  foliage  from  the  branches  of  the  trees, 
browsing  beneath  their  shade,  is  described  as  peculiarly  imposing. 
The  peculiarities  of  conformation  which  this  animal  displays,  are 
all  adapted  to  the  mode  of  life  which  is  natural  to  it,  and  which 
differs  from  that  of  any  other  species ;  for  it  is  destined  to  browse 
upon  the  foliage  and  young  shoots  of  trees,  at  a  height  far  greater 
than  that  which  any  other  animal  can  reach,  whilst  standing  on 
the  ground.  For  this  purpose  it  is  furnished  with  an  elongated 
prehensile  tongue,  which  is  analogous  in  its  uses  to  the  proboscis 
of  the  Elephant, — being  at  once  a  feeler,  a  grasper,  and  an  organ 


294  FAMILY    CAMELOPARDHXE  ; GIRAFFE. 

of  taate.      With  this  it  lays  hold  of  the  tender  branches,  and 
draws  them  into  its  mouth ;   being   assisted  by  the  upper  lip, 


FIG.  149.    GIRAFFE. 

which  is  endowed  with  great  flexibility  and  muscular  power,  and 
projects  beyond  the  lower.  The  Giraffe  cannot  readily  bring  its 
mouth  to  the  ground  ;  being  obliged,  in  order  to  do  so,  to  stretch 
its  fore-legs  widely  apart,  and  to  bend  its  neck  into  a  semicir- 
cular form.  It  is  obviously  not  adapted,  therefore,  to  browse 
near  the  earth ;  and  it  seldom  lowers  its  head  to  the  ground, 


GIRAFFE.  295 

except  to  drink,  or  to  pick  up  some  unusual  delicacy.  The  eyes 
of  the  Giraffe  are  full,  dark,  and  lustrous ;  and  are  so  prominent, 
that  they  command,  without  the  animal  moving  its  head,  a  sur- 
vey of  the  whole  horizon.  The  ears  are  long,  pointed,  and 
movable ;  and  the  sense  of  hearing  is  very  acute.  When  warned, 
through  these  channels,  of  the  approach  of  danger,  the  Giraffe 
seeks  safety  in  flight;  and  awkward  as  its  movements  seem, 
when  it  is  slowly  traversing  a  limited  space  of  ground,  they  are 
far  from  being  so  on  its  native  plains ;  for  it  is  there  a  match  for 
the  swiftest  coursers  of  the  desert,  whilst  on  rugged  and  broken 
ground  these  are  utterly  unable  to  overtake  it.  The  peculiarity 
of  its  movements  results  from  the  shortness  of  its  body  in  com- 
parison with  the  limbs  ;  so  that  the  hind-hoofs  are  brought  at 
each  step  as  far  forward,  as  the  spot  occupied  during  the  pre- 
vious moment  by  the  fore-hoofs, — though  somewhat  to  the 
outside  of  it,  as  the  hind-limbs  rather  diverge  from  each  other. 
The  legs  of  either  side  move  at  the  same  time  with  each  other, 
alternating  with  those  of  the  opposite  side,  so  as  to  give  the  pace 
termed  the  amble  (  ANIM.  PHYSIOL.,  §  660).  When  attacked  by 
enemies  from  which  it  cannot  escape,  the  Giraffe  defends  itself 
by  kicking  ;  and  the  blows  it  inflicts  succeed  one  another  so 
rapidly,  that  the  eye  can  scarcely  follow  the  movement.  The 
traveller  Le  Vaillant,  from  whose  observations  we  may  date  our 
first  correct  knowledge  of  this  animal,  says,  "  I  know  beyond  a 
doubt,  that  it  often  tires  out,  discourages,  and  even  beats  off 
the  lion/'  After  his  dogs  had  brought  an  individual  to  bay,  they 
dared  not  make  an  attack,  on  account  of  the  rapid  succession  of 
kicks  with  which  it  defended  itself.  The  horns  appear  never  to 
be  used  in  resisting  an  attack ;  although  the  Giraffes  have  been 
observed  to  butt  each  other  with  them  in  sport.  Two  varieties 
of  this  curious  animal  are  known, — one  of  them  peculiar  to 
Nubia,  Abyssinia,  and  the  adjacent  districts, — the  other  a  native 
of  Southern  Africa.  They  have  been  regarded  by  some  Natural- 
ist as  distinct  species ;  but  this  is  probably  an  error. 

264.  The  ANTELOPID^:,  or  Antelope  tribe,  approach  the  Deer 
in  their  general  conformation,  as  well  as  in  the  activity  of  their 
habits.  This  family,  which  is  remarkable  for  the  slenderness  of 


296  FAMILY    ANTELOPHXE  ; ANTELOPE    TRIBE. 

form  and  swiftness  of  foot  of  the  animals  composing  it,  contains 
more  than  seventy  well-ascertained  species,  bearing  a  strong 
general  resemblance  to  each  other ,  these  are  diffused  through  the 
warmer  parts  of  the  globe, — the  principal  part  being  natives  of 
Africa,  a  few  species  inhabiting  Asia,  a  still  smaller  number 
being  found  in  America,  and  one  only,  the  Chamois,  at  present 
having  its  residence  in  Europe.  The  horns,  of  which  the  persis- 
tence distinguishes  them  from  the  Deer,  are  composed  of  a  solid 
bony  core,  which  is  covered  with  a  horny  sheath  ;  this  consists 
of  fibres  analogous  to  those  of  whalebone,  or  rather  hair,  running 
longitudinally  or  spirally,  and  agglutinated  into  one  uniform 
mass.  One  species  has  four  horns.  (Fig.  150.)  Among  the 

true  Antelopes,  the  family 
likeness  is  extremely  strong ; 
and  it  is  not  easy  to  find 
characters  sufficiently  defi- 
nite for  subdividing  the 
group  ;  but  many  hollow- 
horned  Ruminants,  for 
which  no  other  place  could 
be  found  in  other  families? 
have  come  to  be  associated 

FJG.  ISO.-FOUR  HORNED  ANTELOPE.  with     this  ',     SO    tliat      it      ^Q~ 

sents  a  rather  incongruous 

assemblage.  For  the  sake  of  perspicuity,  the  family  may  be 
divided  into  four  sub-families  ; — True  Antelopes,  Bush  Ante- 
lopes, Capriform  (Goat-like)  Antelopes,  and  Bovine  (Ox-like) 
Antelopes.  Each  of  these  will  be  separately,  though  briefly, 
considered. 

265.  The  True  Antelopes  are  remarkable  for  the  graceful 
symmetry  of  their  bodies,  the  length  and  slenderness  of  their 
limbs,  and  the  lightness  and  agility  of  their  movements.  In 
fleetness,  indeed,  there  are  few  if  any  animals  that  can  approach 
them  by  speed  of  foot ;  the  greyhound  unaided  cannot  overtake 
them  ;  and  stratagem  is  necessary,  therefore,  in  hunting  them. 
They  mostly  prefer  the  open  plains ;  seeking  refuge  in  moun- 
tain fastnesses,  only  when  they  are  alarmed.  One  of  the  most 


TRUE    ANTELOPES  ; — SPRING-BOK,    GAZELLE.  297 

graceful  and  beautiful  species  of  this  group,  is  the  Spring-lok  of 

Southern  Africa  ; 
which  derives  its 
name  from  its  sin- 
gular habit  of  leap- 
ing perpendicularly, 
when  alarmed,  or 
as  it  scours  the 
plain,  to  the  height 
of  several  feet.  This 
animal  lives  in  large 
herds,  which  spread 

FIG.  151.— SPRINO-BOK  ANTKWFE.  themselves  Over  the 

extensive         plains 

that  occupy  a  large  part  of  the  interior  of  that  country.  The 
karroos  (as  these  vast  wilds  are  called)  are  subject  to  seasons  of 
drought,  in  which  the  pasturage  is  completely  dried  up  ;  and 
the  Spring-boks,  driven  to  change  their  quarters,  literally  inun- 
date the  fertile  cultivated  districts,  over  which  swarm  after 
swarm  passes,  like  wave  after  wave,  destroying  the  hopes  of  the 
colonists.  "When  the  rains  begin  to  fall,  the  horde,  thinned  by 
the  attacks  of  man  and  beast,  begins  to  return  to  the  interior ; 
and,  in  a  few  days,  the  whole  disappear.  Mr.  Pringle  mentions 
that  some  of  these  migratory  swarms  with  which  he  fell  in, 
whitened,  or  rather  specked,  the  country,  as  far  as  the  eye  could 
reach  ;  and  he  estimates  the  numbers  at  one  time  in  view,  at  not 
less  than  25,000  or  30,000.— To  the  group  of  true  Antelopes 
also  belongs  the  Gazelle,  so  celebrated  among  the  poetical  writers 
of  the  East.  This  very  beautiful  species  inhabits  Arabia  and 
Syria,  where  it  is  seen  in  large  herds,  bounding  over  the  desert 
with  amazing  fleetness,  and  seeming  to  skim  along  the  level  plain 
almost  without  touching  it.  It  is  usually  hunted  with  the 
assistance  of  falcons,  which  fly  at  its  head  and  thus  check  its 
speed,  giving  time  for  the  dogs  to  come  up, — the  swiftest  grey- 
hound being  completely  distanced  by  it.  It  is  also  captured  by 
stratagem  ;  an  inclosure  being  prepared  near  a  rivulet  or  spring 
to  which  the  Gazelles  resort  to  drink ;  and  the  herd  on  its  approach 


298 


BUSH  ANTELOPES  J  CAPRIFORM  ANTELOPES. 


being  driven  into  the  inclosure,  through  gaps  in  its  sides,  by 
the  shouts  of  the  hunters  and  the  noise  of  their  fire-arms.  When 
taken  young,  the  Gazelle,  though  naturally  so  wild  and  timid,  is 
readily  domesticated,  and  becomes  quite  familiar.  Tame  Gazelles 
are  frequently  seen  at  large,  in  the  court-yards  of  houses  in 
Syria ;  and  their  beauty,  exquisite  form,  and  playfulness,  render 
them  great  favourites. 

266.  The  Busk  Antelopes  are  of  a  more  compact  form,  and 
have  shorter  limbs  ;  hence  they  are  animals  of  less  activity,  but 
of  more  vigour,  than  the  true  Antelopes.  They  live  singly  or  in 
pairs,  frequenting  jungles,  dense  reed-beds,  and  the  underwoods 
of  forests ;  most  of  them  preferring  hills  or  mountain  districts 
of  moderate  elevation.  When  pursued,  they  dive  through  the 
thicket,  and  quickly  disappear.  These  also  are  chiefly  found  in 
the  Southern  and  Western  parts  of  Africa.  The  species  repre- 
sented in  the  accompanying  figure,  is  found  in  the  neighbourhood 
of  Sierra  Leone  ;  and  by  the  English  residents  there  it  is  called 

the  Bush-goat.  It  is  a 
dull  heavy  animal,  lurk- 
ing in  the  thickets 
during  the  day,  and 
resorting  to  the  open 
spaces  in  the  mornings 
to  feed.  Its  back  is 
arched,  its  legs  short, 
and  it  has  altogether 
somewhat  of  a  pig-like 
shape  ;  but  its  flesh  is 
more  esteemed  than  that 
of  the  more  handsome 

and  agile  Antelopes.  Its  length  is  about  five  feet ;  and  its  height 
three.     The  horns  are  very  short. 

267.  The  Capriform  Antelopes  are  more  widely  diffused  ; 
being  inhabitants  of  mountain  ranges  and  hilly  countries  in  all 
quarters  of  the  globe.  They  are  characterised  by  the  very  com- 
pact and  robust  form  of  their  bodies,  and  by  their  general  adap- 
tation for  a  mountain  life.  The  head  is  heavy,  the  neck  short, 


Fro.  152 — BUSH  ANTELOPE. 


CAPRIFORM  ANTELOPES; — CHAMOIS.  299 

and  the  limbs  strong  ;  the  horns  are  small  or  moderate ;  and 
their  bodies  are  covered  with  coarse  or  wiry  hair. — The  species 
which  inhabits  Europe  is  commonly  known  as  the  Chamois  Goat  ; 
it  lives  among  the  Alps,  Pyrenees,  Carpathian  and  Grecian 
mountains,  and  also  the  ranges  of  Caucasus  and  Taurus.  "  Every 
where  it  tenants  the  loftiest  ridges,  displaying  the  most  aston- 
ishing activity.  During  the  summer,  it  is  only  to  be  found  on 
the  mountain  tops,  or  in  sequestered  rock-girt  glens,  where  the 
snow  lies  unmelted  throughout  the  year;  but  in  winter  it 
descends  below  the  line  of  perpetual  snows,  to  the  grassy  slopes, 
where  it  becomes  doubly  cautious  and  wary.  Its  senses  of 
hearing,  sight,  and  smell  are  extremely  acute ;  and  it  scentsjthe 
approaching  hunter  at  the  distance  of  half  a  league.  When  its 
fears  are  once  excited,  it  bounds  from  rock  to  rock,  as  if  to  gain 
a  view  of  the  surrounding  district,  uttering  at  the  same  time  a 
singular  hissing  sound  ;  but  no  sooner  has  it  caught  sight  of  its 
enemy,  than  off  it  bounds,  scaling  the  most  fearful  rocks,  clearing 
chasms,  and  leaping  from  crag  to  crag  with  amazing  rapidity. 
Its  course  is  not  stopped  by  a  perpendicular  precipice  of  twenty 
or  thirty  feet  in  depth  ;  with  astonishing  boldness  it  takes  the 
leap,  striking  the  face  of  the  rock  repeatedly  with  its  feet,  for 
the  purpose  both  of  breaking  its  fall,  and  of  directing  itself  more 
steadily  to  the  point  it  aims  at.  It  pitches  on  the  smallest  ledge, 
where  the  eye  of  man  scarce  discerns  room  for  its  foot ;  and  it 
traverses  with  security  the  beetling  shelf  that  overhangs  the 
deepest  abyss.  The  food  of  the  Chamois  consists  of  mountain 
herbs  and  flowers,  and  the  tender  shoots  of  shrubs :  it  seldom 
drinks,  but  is  extremely  partial  to  salt ;  and  many  stones  are 
met  with  in  the  Alps,  hollowed  out  by  the  continual  licking  of 
the  Chamois,  on  account  of  the  saltpetre  with  which  they 
abound.5'*  Other  Caprine  Antelopes  (often  designated  as 
Goats)  are  found  in  Asia,  the  Asiatic  Archipelago,  and  America. 
268.  We  lastly  proceed  to  the  section  of  Bomform  or  Ox-like 
Antelopes,  which  contains  species  that  present  various  degrees  of 
relationship  to  the  Antelopes  and  Oxen  respectively.  Some  of 

*  Pictorial  Museum,  Vol.  I.  p.  143. 


300 


BOVINE    ANTELOPES  ; NYL-GHAU,    ADDAX,    GNU. 


these,  such  as  the  Nyl-ghau  of  India,  are  closely  allied  to  groups 
among  the  true  Antelopes ;  whilst  others  have  nothing  of  the 
Antelope  in  form  or  appearance,  and  approach  the  Oxen  much 
more  nearly.  In  general  they  are  distinguished  by  their  massive 
contour,  large  size,  and  powerful  limbs;  the  head  is  usually 
large,  the  horns  thick  and  solid,  the  eyes  small,  and  the  neck 
short  and  thick. — The  Nyl-ghau  is  a  magnificent  species,  standing 
upwards  of  four  feet  in  height  at  the  shoulder  ;  it  resides  in  the 
dense  forests,  either  alone  or  in  pairs ;  and  it  is  a  resolute  and 
powerful  animal,  turning  and  defending  itself  against  its  pursuers 
with  great  fury,  and  not  being  tamed  down  by  confinement.  It 
is,  however,  the  common  prey  of  the  Tiger. — The  Addax  is  a 

Bovine  Antelope  of 
Africa,  living  solita- 
rily or  in  pairs,  on 
the  borders  and  oases 
of  the  deserts,  which 
occupy  a  large  part  of 
the  centre  of  that  con- 
tinent. It  is  rather 
heavily  made  ;  and 
its  hoofs  possess  re- 
markable breadth,  to 
pass  more  easily  over 
the  fine  and  loose  sand. — The  last  species  at  present  to  be  noticed, 
the  Gnu,  is  a  very  remarkable  one,  on  account  of  the  singular 
mixture  of  characters  which  it  presents.  The  head  and  horns 
are  those  of  a  Buffalo ;  and  the  eyes  are  large,  wild,  and 
expressive  of  a  savage  and  vindictive  disposition.  The  neck 
with  its  mane,  the  tail,  and  the  general  contour  of  the  body, 
resemble  those  of  the  Horse ;  whilst  the  well-turned  and  vigorous 
legs  remind  the  observer  of  the  Stag  or  Antelope.  The  chin  and 
throat  are  covered  with  a  sort  of  shaggy  beard ;  while  a  full 
mane  flows  down  from  the  chest  between  the  fore  limbs.  The 
action  and  gallop  of  the  Gnus  are  so  much  like  those  of  the 
Horse,  that  a  troop  of  them,  seen  scouring  the  plain  at  a 
distance,  might  easily  be  mistaken  for  Zebras  or  Quaggas,  if  it 


FIG.  153.— AEDAX. 


GNU. FAMILY    BOVIDJE,    OR    OX    TRIBE.  301 

were  not  for  the  difference  in  colour.  Its  usual  size  is  about 
that  of  a  well-grown  Ass ;  its  height  exceeding  four  feet.  It  is 
a  native  of  the  wild  karroos  and  hilly  districts  of  Southern  Africa; 
roaming  mostly  in  large  herds,  which  migrate  according  to  the 
season.  These  are  not  to  be  approached  without  difficulty ;  for 
they  either  take  alarm,  and  retreat  with  great  swiftness,  follow- 
ing a  leader  in  single  file  ;  or,  if  they  are  wounded,  they  turn 
upon  the  assailant,  charging  with  great  fury,  and  using  their 
horns  in  a  very  dangerous  manner.  It  is  not  tamed  by  confine- 
ment ;  but  when  taken  young,  it  may  be  domesticated  with 
the  cattle  of  a  farm,  with  which  it  associates  harmlessly. 

269.  The  animals  of  the  family  BOVIDJE,  or  Ox  tribe,  are 
distinguished  from  those  of  the  Antelope  and  Goat  tribes,  by  the 
bulkiness  of  their  forms  and  their  great  strength ;  and  also  by 
the  uniform  presence  of  horns  in  both  sexes, — these  being  com- 
monly possessed  by  the  males  only,  in  the  other  tribes.  The 
direction  of  the  horns,  which  is  in  the  first  instance  lateral,  then 
inclining  upwards  or  forwards,  is  another  character  of  distinction. 
All  of  the  Ox  group  are  gregarious  in  their  habits;  and  no 
quarter  of  the  globe  is  destitute  of  some  free  native  species.  Of 
the  domesticated  0#,  as  of  other  animals  brought  completely 
under  the  subjection  of  Man  in  early  times,  the  origin  is  obscure. 
The  only  existing  wild  race  with  which  it  can  be  reasonably 
considered  identical,  is  one  of  which  a  herd  is  preserved  in  Chil- 
lingham  Park,  and  another  at  Craven.  It  may  be  doubted, 
however,  whether  these  herds  are  really  the  remains  of  an  original 
wild  race  ;  or  whether,  like  the  wild  horses  of  South  America, 
they  are  not  the  descendants  of  individuals,  which  have  once 
been  in  subjection,  and  which  have  since  returned  in  part  to  their 
original  condition.  The  latter  appears  most  probable ;  since  the 
skeleton  of  these  cattle  bears  a  much  closer  resemblance  to  that 
of  the  domesticated  Ox,  than  it  does  to  that  of  any  wild  species 
either  at  present  existing,  or  known  by  its  remains  to  have 
existed  in  past  times.  It  is  well  known  that  several  breeds  or 
races  of  the  Domestic  Ox  exist,  differing  very  widely  from  each 
other,  not  only  in  stature,  but  also  in  the  proportions  of  the 
several  parts  of  the  body.  None  of  those  known  in  Europe, 


302  FAMILY    BOVID^E  ; BRAHMIN   OX. 

however,  are  so  remarkable  as  the  Zebu  or  Brahmin  Ox,  dis- 
tinguished by  the  large  fatty  hump  which  it  carries  on  its  back  ; 
this  breed  is  spread  over  India,  China,  and  the  Indian  islands, 
and  also  inhabits  Madagascar  and  the  eastern  coast  of  Africa. 


FIG.  154. — ZBBU  OR  BRAHMIN  Ox. 

Various  races  of  this  animal, — differing  in  size  from  that  of  our 
largest  cattle,  to  that  of  a  young  calf, — are  found  in  these 
countries ;  they  are  extremely  docile,  and  are  subservient  to  the 
same  uses  in  their  native  climates  as  those  to  which  we  put  the 
Ox  in  this  country ;  the  larger  breeds  surpass  ours  in  strength, 
and  are  far  more  active.  The  hump  increases  very  much  in 
those  individuals  which  are  plentifully  supplied  with  food,  and 
lead  an  indolent  life ;  whilst  it  diminishes  in  those  which  are 
harder  worked  and  poorly  fed.  There  is  a  doubt  amongst 
Naturalists,  whether  the  Zebu  is  of  the  same  original  stock 
with  the  domestic  Ox,  or  of  a  different  species  ;  but  the  former 
is  probably  the  case. 

270.  The  history  of  the  Human  race  seems  to  show,  that  it 
is  to  central  Asia,  rather  than  to  the  wild  forests  of  central 
Europe,  that  we  are  to  look  for  the  original  types  of  our  domes- 
ticated races  of  animals.  Nevertheless  some  Naturalists  are 


FAMILY    BOVIIhE  ; URUS,    BISON. 


303 


inclined  to  regard  our  domestic  Ox  as  the  descendant  of  a  wild 
species,  which  formerly  inhabited  the  forests  of  central  Europe, 
and  which  was  described  by  Caesar  and  other  ancient  authors 
under  the  name  of  the  Urus.  This  appears  from  historical 
records  to  have  been  far  superior  in  size,  and  especially  in  the 
dimensions  of  its  horns,  to  any  wild  Oxen  now  existing  in 
Europe  ;  and  these  accounts  are  confirmed  by  the  fact,  that  fossil 
skulls  of  very  large  dimensions,  with  the  cores  of  massive  horns, 
are  abundant  in  the  newer  strata  of  Europe.  In  a  specimen 
found  at  Melksham,  the  distance  between  the  ends  of  the  cores 
was  four  feet ;  and  the  space  between  the  tips  of  the  horns  must  of 
course  have  been  much  greater :  from  this  we  may  form  an  idea 
of  the  size  of  the  ancient  Urus,  which  was  doubtless  described  truly 
as  a  savage,  untameable  animal.  The  Urus  of  modern  Natural- 


Fio.  155.— EUROPEAN  BISON. 


ists  is  the  Aurochs  or  European  Bison,  which  inhabits  the 
forests  of  Lithuania ;  it  is  an  animal  of  great  bulk  and  strength, 
and  of  considerable  ferocity.  Such  is  its  innate  wildness,  that 


304  FAMILY  BOVID^E; — BISON,  BUFFALO. 

it  has  never  been  completely  tamed ;  it  is  afraid  neither  of  the 
Wolf  nor  of  the  Bear,  and  assails  its  enemies  both  with  its  hoofs 
and  its  horns.  It  is  extremely  sh) ,  and  avoids  the  approach  of 
Man ;  which,  from  the  acuteness  of  its  smell,  it  can  detect  at  a 
great  distance  :  but,  when  accidentally  and  suddenly  fallen  in 
with,  it  will  passionately  assail  the  intruder. — The  American 
Bison,  commonly  but  erroneously  termed  the  Buffalo,  is  very 
nearly  allied  to  the  preceding,  both  in  structure  and  habits ;  it 
is  rather  smaller,  however,  in  stature.  It  was  formerly  spread 
more  extensively  than  at  present  ;  but  it  still  exists  in  the 
prairies  of  Louisiana,  associating  in  vast  herds,  of  which  some 
have  been  estimated  to  contain  20,000  individuals. 

271.  The  true  Buffaloes  are  inhabitants  of  the  Old  World 
only,  and  were  originally  restricted  to  Asia  and  Africa,  although 
they  have  been  introduced  into  the  South  of  Europe.  The 
common  species  was  originally  a  native  of  India,  where  it  has 
long  been  domesticated,  and  where  its  services  as  a  beast  of 
draught  and  burden  render  it  extremely  valuable.  From  India 
it  has  spread  into  China,  Siam,  the  Indian  Archipelago,  &c. ; 
and  also  into  Egypt,  Greece,  Italy,  and  Spain ;  in  all  of  these 
countries  there  are  races  which  have  almost  returned  to  a  state  of 
nature,  whilst  others  are  brought  under  subjection  to  Man.  The 
Buffalo  differs  materially  in  its  form  and  general  aspect  from  the 
Ox  ;  being  a  heavier  and  more  clumsy-looking  animal,  but  also 
a  more  powerful  one.  The  hide  is  covered  sparingly  with  black 
wiry  hair;  and  the  horns,  which  often  attain  a  large  size,  are 
first  directed  backwards,  and  then  turn  up  sideways.  In  its 
native  state,  it  is  savage  in  its  temper ;  and  it  does  not  com- 
pletely lose  its  ferocity  when  domesticated,  having  been  known 
to  turn  upon  its  keeper  and  destroy  him,  when  irritated  by  over- 
work or  unkind  usage.  It  is  sufficiently  strong  to  be  a  match 
for  the  Tiger,  which  is  often  worsted  in  the  conflict.  The 
favourite  residence  of  the  Buffalo  is  the  hot  morass,  in  which  it  lies 
wallowing  for  many  hours  together  during  the  heat  of  the  day  ; 
and  it  inhabits  the  most  pestilential  parts  of  Italy,  seeming  to  pre- 
fer the  spots  in  which  the  malaria  (or  noxious  exhalations),  so  in- 
jurious to  Man  and  to  most  other  animals,  prevail.  These  habits 


FAMILY    BOVIDA!  ; BUFFALO.    MUSK-OX.  305 

make  it  especially  useful  as  a  beast  of  burden  in  such  situations ; 
for  it  will  pass  through  morasses,  rivers,  and  torrents,  in  which 


Ffo.  156.— INDIAN  BUFFALO. 

horses,  mules,  or  oxen  would  be  useless ;  dragging  large  heavily- 
laden  carts,  with  enormous  wheels,  whilst  itself  chest-deep  in 
mud.  There  are  numerous  races  of  Buffaloes  in  India  and  else- 
where,— some  of  them  wild,  and  others  domesticated,— which 
differ  considerably  from  the  common  species  ;  but  it  is  doubtful 
whether  several  of  these  are  anything  else  than  varieties,  analo- 
gous to  those  widely-different  ones  which  we  meet  with  among 
domestic  Cattle.  Of  these  we  may  notice  the  Arnee,  remarkable 
for  the  large  size  of  its  horns,  which  often  measure  from  four  to 
six  feet  in  length,  and  ten  feet  between  the  tips. — The  last 
species  of  this  family,  claiming  especial  notice,  is  the  Musk-  Ox  ; 
which  is  an  inhabitant  of  the  coldest  regions  of  North  America, 
and  derives  its  name  from  possessing  strongly  the  musky  odour, 
which  is  common  to  the  whole  group,  and  which  is  particularly 
noticeable  in  the  European  Bison.  This  animal  scarcely  equals 
in  size  the  smallest  of  the  Highland  cattle  ;  but  it  appears  larger 
than  it  really  is,  from  the  profusion  of  long  matted  woolly  hair, 
with  which  it  is  covered,  and  which  hangs  on  each  side  almost  to 
the  ground.  The  form  of  its  horns  resembles  that  which  is  seen 
in  the  Cape  Buffalo.  Though  its  limbs  are  short,  it  is  a  fleet 
and  active  animal. 


306         FAMILY    CAPRIDJE  ; — SYRIAN    AND    ANGORA    GOATS. 

272.  Although  from  the  family  Antelopidw,  we  were  led 
by  the  Gnu  and  other  Bovine  species  to  the  family  Bovidce,  the 
family  we  have  now  to  consider,  —the  CAPRIDJE  or  Sheep  and 
Goat  tribe, — is  equally  connected  with  it,  by  the  Caprine  Ante- 
lopes formerly  described  (§267).  This  family  differs  from  that 
of  the  Antelopes,  by  the  structure  of  the  core  of  the  horns,  which 
is  solid  in  the  latter  family,  whilst  in  the  Capridse  and  Bovidae  it 
is  more  or  less  hollowed  into  cavities  or  cells.  Between  the 
Oxen  and  the  Sheep  and  Goats,  the  principal  differences  are  such 
as  have  reference  to  their  size  and  habits.  Between  the  Goats 
and  the  Sheep,  the  differences  are  extremely  trifling  ;  for  although 
the  distinction  is  obvious  enough  in  our  domesticated  breeds,  it  is 
almost  imperceptible  when  we  compare  the  wild  species  and  the 
domesticated  races  of  other  countries. — The  original  stock  of  the 
Common  Goat,  as  of  other  races  of  animals  early  subjugated  by 
Man,  cannot  be  distinctly  traced  ;  but  it  appears  to  be  the  same 
with  that  of  numerous  half-domesticated  breeds,  which  abound  in 
Asia.  Of  these,  the  one  to  which  it  probably  approaches  most 
nearly,  is  the  Syrian  Goat,  whose  long  hair  was  employed  at  a 
very  early  period  for  the  manufacture  of  stuffs ;  whilst  the  milk 
yielded  by  the  females  has  been  a  most  important  article  of  food 
to  the  inhabitants  of  that  region.  The  Angora  Goat  has  the  hair 


FIG.  157.— ANGORA  GOAT. 


longer  and  more  silky  ;  whilst  the  general  aspect  of  the  animal 
more  resembles  that  of  the  Sheep.     The  length  and  silkiness  of 


FAMILY  CAPRICE;— CASHMIR  GOAT,  IBEX.  307 

the  hair  is  still  more  remarkable  in  the  Cashmir  Goat,  a  native 
of  Thibet ;  from  which  material  are  woven  the  Cashmir  shawls, 
that  are  so  highly  valued  in  Europe.  The  quantity  of  wool 
produced  by  each  goat  is  not  above  three  ounces  ;  and  ten  goats 
are  required  to  furnish  sufficient  wool  for  a  shawl,  a  yard  and  a 
half  square.  The  wool  collected  in  Thibet  is  sent  to  Cashmir, 
where  it  is  manufactured  ;  and  a  long  and  toilsome  journey  must 
be  traversed  before  the  shawls  can  be  transmitted  to  Europe. 
Attempts  have  been  made,  but  with  what  success  cannot  yet  be 
known  with  certainty,  to  naturalise  the  Cashmir  Goat  in  Europe ; 
the  most  promising  result  has  been  obtained  by  crossing  the 
Thibet  and  Angora  breeds, — the  mixed  race  being  in  all  respects 
superior  to  both  the  parent  stocks,  and  producing  in  one  season 
thirty  ounces  of  hair,  finer  and  longer  than  that  obtained  from 
either  of  them. 

273.  All  these  varieties  have  small  horns  ;  and  they  are  thus 
distinguished  from  the  Ibex,  a  genus  in  which  the  body  is  more 
robust,  and  the  horns  very  large.  The  Caucasian  Ibex,  a  bold 
and  powerful  animal,  is  an  inhabitant  of  the  alpine  heights  of 
Europe  and  Western  Asia  ;  and  its  chase  is  as  arduous  as  that  of 


FIG.  158  —  JEMLAH  IBEX. 


the  Chamois.     "When  hard  pressed,  the  Ibex  has  been  known  to 
turn  upon  its  foe  with  impetuous  rapidity,  and  to  hurl  him  head- 

x  2 


308  FAMILY    CAPRIOLE  ; IBEX,    SHEEP. 

long  down  the  steep  rocks  or  abrupt  precipices.  It  is  also  said 
that  the  Ibex  will  precipitate  itself  fearlessly  down  precipices, 
always  falling  on  the  horns,  the  elasticity  of  which  secures  it 
from  injury.  Several  distinct  species  are  found  among  the 
mountain-ranges  of  Africa  and  Asia ;  most  of  them  closely 
resembling  each  other  in  structure  and  habits.  One  of  the  hand- 
somest is  the  Jemlah  Ibex,  an  inhabitant  of  the  Himalaya 
mountains.  Its  height  is  thirty-three  inches ;  its  head  is  finely 
formed,  full  of  beauty  and  expression,  and  without  the  least 
vestige  of  a  beard ;  and  its  horns  are  peculiarly  massive  at  the 
base.  It  lives  solitarily  or  in  small  herds  ;  and  though  bold  and 
pugnacious,  it  is  easily  tamed. 

274.  The  Sheep  is  the  animal  of  whose  subjection  to  Man 
we  have  the  earliest  notice  ;  u  Abel  was  a  keeper  of  sheep." 
Consequently,  we  must  look  to  Western  Asia  as  the  original 
habitation  of  the  race ;  and  possibly  some  wild  species,  from 
which  it  descended,  may  still  exist  on  the  slightly-explored  plains 
and  table-lands  of  that  region.  That  this  animal  should  have 
become  greatly  changed  in  its  characters  from  the  original  stock, 
is  not  to  be  wondered  at  ;  for  of  all  our  domesticated  animals,  it 
is  probably  the  one  in  which  the  influence  of  external  circum- 
stances sHows  itself  most  evidently.  Thus,  the  finest  South- 
down Sheep  imported  from  Britain  into  the  West  India  Islands, 
become  quite  lean  in  the  course  of  a  year  or  two;  and  their  thick 
woolly  fleece  is  replaced  by  a  covering  of  short,  crisp,  brownish 
hair.  It  has  been  noticed  as  a  character  distinguishing  the 
domesticated  sheep  from  all  wild  species  at  present  known,  that 
the  tail  in  the  latter  is  always  very  short,  whilst  the  domesticated 
breeds  generally,  if  not  always  (when  unmutilated),  possess  tails 
which  nearly  reach  to  the  ground.  In  the  Egyptian  and  Syrian 
sheep,  this  appendage  often  acquires  an  enormous  size,  sometimes 
attaining  a  weight  of  70,  80,  or  even  100  Ibs. ;  and  in  order  to 
prevent  inconvenience  to  the  animal,  it  is  not  unfrequently  sup- 
ported upon  a  sort  of  little  cart.  Now  although  there  are  several 
instances,  in  which  domestic  animals  lose  part  or  the  whole  length 
of  the  tail  possessed  by  their  original  wild  stocks,  there  are  none 
in  which  an  originally  short  tail  has  been  converted  into  a  long 


FAMILY    CAPRIDyE  ; ARQALI,    MOUFFLON.  309 

one  ;  and  thus  the  difference  is  of  considerable  importance.  The 
Argali,  or  wild  Sheep  of  Siberia,  which  inhabits  the  mountains 
of  Asia,  and  attains  the  size  of  the  Fallow  Deer, — and  the 
Moufflon  of  Corsica,  a  smaller  species  inhabiting  the  mountainous 
parts  of  Corsica  and  Sardinia,  but  not  confined  to  them, — have 
been  supposed  to  be  the  original  stock  of  the  domestic  Sheep ; 
but,  for  the  reasons  already  mentioned,  this  is  probably  an  error. 
In  these  and  other  allied  species  of  wild  Sheep,  some  of  which 
are  found  in  all  quarters  of  the  globe,  the  body  is  covered  with  a 
harsh  kind  of.  hair,  having  beneath  it,  at  its  roots,  a  short  spiral 
wool,  which  in  winter  becomes  longer  and  fuller.  In  some 
neglected  breeds  of  the  common  Sheep,  the  wool  becomes  mixed 
with  long  hairs,  which  more  or  less  obscure  the  wool ;  and  in 
the  Cashmir  and  Angora  Goats,  the  long  outer  garment  is  hair, 
and  the  short  under-coat  exquisitely  fine  wool.  Hence  it  may 
be  reasonably  inferred  that,  whatever  the  original  stock  of  the 
common  Sheep,  its  coat  resembled  that  of  the  wild  species  at 
present  existing ;  and  that  in  the  early  ages  of  Man's  history, 
the  shepherds  must  have  selected  those  individuals  for  breeding, 
in  which  the  wool  predominated ;  by  following  up  which  system, 
the  wool-bearing  breed  would  be  at  length  permanently  esta- 
blished. In  the  same  manner,  the  silky-haired  varieties  of  the 
Goat  were  probably  introduced ;  and  the  establishment  of  any 
new  breed  must  take  place  upon  similar  principles  (§  111). 

275.  The  preceding  families  include  all  the  animals  which 
agree   in  the   general  characters  of  the    Ruminant  Order,    as 
formerly  stated  (§  259)  ;  and  there  now  only  remain  two  aber- 
rant groups  ;  the  MOSCHID.E,  Musk-Deer  tribe ;  and  the  CAME- 
LID.E  or  Camel  tribe.     Of  these,  the  latter  conduct  us  towards 
Pachydermata,  with  which  they  have  been  associated  by  some 
naturalists;  whilst  the  former  are   intermediate   between   the 
Camels  and  the  true  Ruminants. 

276.  The  family  MOSCHID.E  takes  its  name  from  the  circum- 
stance, that  the  peculiar  strongly-odorous  substance  termed  Musk 
is  obtained  from  one  of  the  species  which  it  includes  ;    and  with 
this,  other  animals  nearly  allied  to  it  in  structure,  but  not  pro- 
ducing musk,  are  associated,  on  account  of  the  correspondence  in 


310 


FAMILY    MOSCHID.E  ; MUSK-DEER. 


their  characters.  The  Moschidae  closely  resemble  the  Deer  in 
general  form  and  appearance  ;  but  they  resemble  them  in  minia- 
ture ;  for,  with  the  exception  of  the  true  Musk,  which  equals  a 
Roebuck  in  size  and  stature,  the  rest  are  extremely  small,  some 
of  them  not  exceeding  a  Hare  in  magnitude.  They  are  extremely 
beautiful  animals,  and  are  very  graceful  and  animated  in  their 
movements.  The  family  is  distinguished,  as  formerly  stated,  by 
the  absence  of  horns  ;  and  by  the  presence,  in  the  upper  jaw  of 
the  male,  of  long  canines,  which  project  downwards,  and  come 
forwards  between  the  lips.  Moreover  on  each  foot  there  are  two 
accessory  toes,  more  complete  than  those  of  the  ordinary  Rumi- 
nants, each  having  its  own  metacarpal  or  metatarsal  bone. 

277.  The  true  Musk-Deer  inhabits  the  great  extent  of 
elevated  country  which  occupies  a  large  part  of  central  Asia; 
being  common  to  Nepal,  Boutan,  Thibet,  and  the  districts 
adjacent  to  the  North  of  India  and  to  China ;  and  being  abundant 
also  in  the  Altaic  range,  near  Lake  Baikal.  It  is  covered  with 

a  long  stiff  inelastic  fur,  the 
hairs  of  which  grow  erect, 
instead  of  lying  flat  upon 
the  body  ;  and  the  presence 
of  this  substantial  covering 
sufficiently  indicates  the 
adaptation  of  the  animal  to 
a  cold  region.  The  Musk  is 
procured  from  the  male 
only ;  and  is  the  peculiar 
secretion  of  a  glandular 
pouch,  situated  at  the  hinder 
part  of  the  body  ;  from  the 
high  price  of  this  perfume, 

and  the  ease  with  which  it  is  adulterated  (especially  when  fresh), 
it  very  seldom  reaches  Europe  in  a  pure  state.  The  habits  of  the 
Musk-Deer  closely  resemble  those  of  the  Chamois ;  it  exhibits 
peculiar  activity  and  strength  in  its  movements,  and  is  very  shy 
of  Man ;  nevertheless  it  falls  a  prey,  in  large  numbers,  to  the 
hunters  who  pursue  it  for  the  sake  of  its  costly  perfume. — The 


FIG.  159.— MUSK-DEER. 


MUSK-DEKR.  —FAMILY     CAMKLI1XK.  31  i 

other  Musk-Deer,  to  which  the  general  term  of  Chevrotains  is 
given,  are  inhabitants  of  Ceylon,  Java,  Sumatra,  and  Southern 
India  ;  and  are  adapted  to  a  forest  rather  than  to  a  mountain 
life.  They  are  very  small,  peculiarly  elegant  in  their  appearance 
and  movements,  timid  and  wild  in  their  native  haunts,  but  mild 
and  gentle  in  captivity,  to  which  they  soon  become  reconciled. 
The  Napu  of  Java  and  Sumatra  is  particularly  interesting,  as 
having  the  smallest  blood-corpuscles  of  any  animal  at  present 
known.  (AwiM.  PHYSIOL.,  §  229).  No  true  Musk-Deer  is  known 
to  inhabit  America  ;  two  species  which  have  been  described  as 
such,  being  in  reality  the  young  of  the  Deer  of  that  country. 

278.  We  proceed  lastly  to  the  family  CAMELID^E,  which 
includes,  with  the  Camels  and  Dromedaries  of  the  Old  World, 
the  Llamas,  which  may  be  considered  as  representing  them  in  the 
New.  The  peculiarities  which  distinguish  the  animals  of  this 
family  from  the  ordinary  Ruminants,  have  been  already  men- 
tioned (§  253,  254);  these  peculiarities  for  the  most  part  show  an 
approach  towards  the  Pachydermata  ;  and  this  is  indicated,  also, 
by  the  greater  heaviness  in  the  form  and  movements  of  the  body, 
which  contrast  strongly  with  the  grace  and  elegance  of  the  Rumi- 
nantia  in  general.  "  There  is  something  strange  and  imposing 
in  the  aspect  of  the  gaunt  and  angular  camel,  destitute,  as  it  con- 
fessedly is,  of  grace  and  animation.  We  are  amazed  at  its  height, 
its  uncouth  proportions,  its  long  thin  neck,  its  meagre  limbs,  and 
the  huge  hump  on  its  back,  which  conveys  the  idea  of  distortion. 
Quietly  it  stands  in  one  fixed  attitude,  its  long-lashed  eyelid 
drooping  over  the  large  dark  eyes ;  it  moves — and  onward  stalks 
with  slow  and  measured  steps,  as  if  exercise  were  painful.  To 
complete  the  picture,  it  is  covered  with  shaggy  hair,  irregularly 
disposed,  here  forming  tangled  masses,  there  almost  wanting. 
Its  thick  mobile  upper  lip  is  deeply  divided  ;  its  feet  are  large 
and  spreading,  the  toes  being  merely  tipped  with  little  hoofs.* ' 
There  are  two  species  of  this  animal;  the  Bactrian,or  two-humped; 
and  the  Arabian^  or  one-humped.  Both  are  completely  domesti- 
cated. The  former  is  employed  chiefly  in  Central  Asia ;  the 

*  Pictorial  Museum,  Vol.,  I.,  p.  115. 


312  FAMILY    CAMELID^i; — CAMEL. 

latter  in  Arabia,  North  Africa,  Syria,   Persia,  &c.      The  two- 
humped  Camel  is  larger  and  stronger,  being  capable  of  sustaining 


FIG.  160. — BACTRIAN  CAMEL. 


above  1000  Ibs.  weight ;  and  is  best  adapted  for  rugged  ground. 
But  the  Arabian  Camel  is  most  fitted,  by  its  great  power  of 
enduring  hunger  and  thirst,  and  by  the  patience  of  its  disposition, 
for  traversing  the  desert  plains,  whose  expanse  of  barren  land 
interposes  a  more  effectual  barrier  between  the  districts  it  divides, 
tli an  that  of  the  rolling  ocean.  Well,  therefore,  has  the  Camel, 
which  furnishes  the  only  means  of  carrying  on  intercourse  between 
countries  thus  separated,  been  termed  "  the  Ship  of  the  Desert/' 
279.  The  elastic  cushion,  which  extends  between  and 
beneath  the  toes  (§  254)  of  the  Camel,  spreads  at  each  step, 
according  to  the  pressure  made  upon  it,  and  thus  affords  a  firm 
footing  even  upon  sand,  unless  this  be  extremely  loose ;  whilst 
the  callous  skin  with  which  it  is  covered,  prevents  the  animal 
from  sustaining  inconvenience  from  the  heat  of  the  surface  on 
which  it  treads.  Similar  callous  surfaces  are  to  be  seen  on  the 
chest,  and  on  the  joints  of  the  fore  and  hind  limbs ;  and  it  is  upon 


FAMILY    CAMELID.E  ; CAMEL.  313 

these  that  the  animal  rests,  when  it  takes  its  repose,  or  kneels 
down  to  be  loaded.  These  natural  cushions  are  not  produced 
by  the  habit  of  kneeling,  as  some  have  supposed ;  for  the  young 
animal  is  born  with  them.  The  elevation  of  the  Gamers  head, 
and  the  acuteness  of  its  sight  and  smell,  enable  it  to  discern  the 
green  oasis,  and  to  scent  the  refreshing  water,  at  a  great  distance. 
The  eye  is  shielded  from  the  intense  glare  of  light,  by  a  prominent 
overhanging  brow,  and  by  long  eyelashes  ;  and  the  nostrils  are 
so  constructed,  as  to  be  closed  by  the  animal  at  pleasure,  so  as  to 
keep  out  the  fine  sand,  which  is  continually  being  driven  by  the 
wind.  Its  natural  food  consists,  not  of  the  meadow  herbage  and 
rich  pastures  in  which  most  of  the  Ruminants  delight,  but  of 
thorny  shrubs,  date-leaves,  and  the  leaves  and  branches  of  the 
tamarisk  ;  these,  when  it  meets  with  them,  together  with  dates, 
beans,  and  cakes  of  barley,  provided  by  its  master,  constitute  its 
support  during  its  toilsome  journey.  Hence,  we  see  the  utility 
of  its  strong  incisors,  its  canine  teeth,  and  its  canine-like  molars, 
which  enable  it  to  browse  on  the  coarsest  shrubs  with  ease ; 
whilst  its  long  prehensile  lip,  like  the  tongue  of  the  Giraffe, 
serves  to  draw  the  twigs  and  leaves  to  its  mouth,  or  to  hold  the 
tuft  of  herbage  which  is  undergoing  mastication. 

280.  When  the  Camel  is  insufficiently  provided  with  food, 
its  hump  gradually  diminishes  in  size ;  this  results  from  the 
consumption  of  the  fat  of  which  it  is  composed ;  which  is  used 
up,  when  other  materials  are  deficient,  for  the  maintenance  of 
respiration, — just  like  the  thick  layer  of  fat,  with  which 
hybernating  animals  usually  become  covered  during  the  autumn. 
The  Arabs  are  well  aware  of  the  importance  of  the  hump  ; 
and  are  solicitous  about  its  state,  when  about  to  commence 
a  journey.  When  it  has  been  much  exhausted,  three  or  four 
months  of  repose  and  copious  nourishment  are  required  to  restore 
it  to  its  usual  condition.  The  peculiar  construction  of  the  Camel's 
stomach  enables  it  to  dispense  with  a  frequent  supply  of  water, 
— a  store  of  liquid  being  contained  in  the  cells  in  its  wall.  The 
degree  in  which  it  can  sustain  abstinence  from  fluid,  depends, 
however,  in  part  upon  the  habit  of  the  particular  breed,  and  in 
part  upon  the  nature  of  its  food.  The  Arabian  Camel  can  dispense 


314  FAMILY    CAMELID^E  ; CAMEL,    DROMEDARY. 

with  water  until  the  fourth  or  even  the  fifth  day  ;  and  in  spring, 
when  the  young  herbage  is  succulent,  the  journey  across  the  great 
Syrian  desert,  from  Damascus  to  Bngdad,  occupying  twenty-five 
days,  may  be  performed  without  any  water  being  required  by 
the  Camels,  In  the  heavy  caravans  which  traverse  the  desert  for 
mercantile  purposes,  each  Camel  is  loaded  with  from  500  to 
800  Ibs.,  and  the  rate  of  travelling  does  not  exceed  2i  or  2f 
miles  an  hour,  kept  up  for  eight  hours  a  day;  but  a  lighter 
caravan  will  travel  somewhat  more  quickly,  and  will  continue 
the  march  for  nine  or  ten  hours  daily. 

281.  The  Dromedary  is   a  lighter  variety  of  the  Arabian 
Camel,  bearing  much  the  same  relation  to  the  ordinary  Camel,  as 
a  Race-Horse  or  Hunter  does  to  a  Cart-Horse.     It  is  used  princi- 
pally for  journeys  in  which  dispatch  is  required,  and  carries  only 
a  single  rider,  or  a  very  light  burthen.     But  the  quickness  of  its 
journeys  depends  not  so  much  upon  the  rapidity  of  its  rate  of 
movement,  as  upon  its  power  of  uninterruptedly  continuing  a 
moderate  pace  for  a  long  time  together.     Urged  to  a  gallop,  it 
cannot  maintain  its  pace  for  half-an-hour,  and  is  easily  distanced 
by  the  Horse  ;  but  it  can  maintain  a  trot,  at  the  rate  of  from  6  to  8 
miles  an  hour,  for  24  hours  consecutively  :  and  a  gentle  and  easy 
amble  of  from  5  to  5J  miles  an  hour,  which  is  the  favourite  pace 
of  the  Dromedary,  can  be  kept  up  by  it  for  several  days  and 
nights  almost  uninterruptedly.     It  appears  that  there  is  a  swift 
breed  of  the  Bactrian,  or  two-humped  Camel  also ;  which  is  in 
request  in  China.     All  these  animals  are  remarkable  for  their 
docility,    and  for  the  patient  endurance    which  they  manifest. 
Even  when  overloaded  and  fatigued,  or  when  the  load  is  inhu- 
manely laid  on  sores  or  wounds,  the  animal  neither  refuses  to  rise, 
nor  attempts  to  cast  off  its  burden  ;  but  merely  complains  of  the 
injustice  by  crying  out ;    and  his  suffering  must  be  extreme  for 
him  to  complain  at  all.    Besides  its  uses  as  a  beast  of  burden,  the 
Camel  affords  sustenance,  by  its  flesh  and  milk,  to  the  people 
who  possess  it ;  and  also  hair  for  the  manufacture  of  cloth. 

282.  The  Llamas  of  South  America  bear  a  strong  general 
resemblance  to  the  Camels  in  form  and  structure  ;  but  they  are 
of  much  inferior  size.     They  further  differ  in  the  absence  of  the 


FAMILY    CAMELID.E  J — LLAMA. 


315 


FIG.  161. — FOOT  OK   LLAMA. 


hump,  and  the  want  of  water-cells  in  the  stomach ;  as  also  in 
the  conformation  of  the  foot.  This  consists  of  two  toes,  com- 
pletely divided,  each  with  a  rough  cushion  beneath,  and  provided 
at  the  end  with  a  strong  short  hoof ;  the  hoofs  are  pointed  at  the 
tip,  and  hooked  downwards  somewhat  like  a  claw.  This  form 

of  the  foot  is  as 
completely  adapted 
to  the  natural  habi- 
tation of  the  animal, 
as  is  that  of  the 
Camel  ;  for  the 
Llama  is  destined  to 
live  among  the  rough 
and  rocky  Cordille- 
ras, the  craggy  sides 
of  which  it  traverses 
with  a  free  and  fear- 
less step,  deriving  great  assistance  in  climbing  from  the  hooked 
form  of  its  hoofs.  There  appear  to  be  three  species  of  these 
animals,  the  Guanaco,  Paco  or  Alpaca,  and  the  Vicugna.  The 
first  of  these  is  the  species  which  is  commonly  known,  in  subjec- 
tion to  Man,  as  the  domestic  Llama.  It  still  exists  in  a  wild  state, 
however,  on  the  highlands  of  Peru  and  Chili.  In  its  domestic  state, 
the  temper  of  the  Llama  is  characterised  by  the  same  docility  and 
patient  endurance  as  that  of  the  Camel.  At  the  time  of  the 
Spanish  invasion,  it  was  the  only  beast  of  burden  possessed  by 
inhabitants  of  South  America,  and  was  kept  in  immense 
lumbers  for  the  purposes  of  traffic,  and  also  for  food ;  its  skin, 
also,  was  prepared  as  leather,  and  its  wool  spun  and  manufactured 
into  cloth.  It  was  estimated  that  300,000  were  constantly 
employed  in  the  transport  of  the  ore  from  the  mines  of  Potosi 
alone  ;  the  ordinary  load  of  each  Llama  was  about  80  or  lOOlbs.; 
and  its  rate  of  travelling  with  this  burthen  over  rugged  moun- 
tain passes,  was  from  12  to  15  miles  a  day.  At  the  present 
time,  however,  the  Horse,  the  Ass,  and  especially  the  Mule, 
which  have  been  introduced  from  Europe,  have  for  the  most 
part  superseded  the  Llama  as  beasts  of  burthen,  though  it  is 


316  LLAMA. FOSSIL    RUMINANTIA. 

still  employed  in  some  places ;  whilst  the  introduction  of  the 
Sheep,  the  Goat,  and  the  Ox,  has  rendered  it  less  necessary,  as 
affording  either  food,  leather,  or  wool.  The  Paco  or  Alpaca, 
and  the  Vicugna,  inhabit  the  more  elevated  parts  of  the  mountain 
ranges,  living  almost  on  the  borders  of  perpetual  snow.  They 
are  remarkable  for  the  fineness  of  their  wool,  which  has  an  almost 
silken  texture ;  and  they  are  much  in  request  on  this  account. 
There  is  little  doubt  that  they  might  be  introduced  into  this 
country,  and  might  be  profitably  naturalised  in  the  mountain 
districts  of  "Wales  and  Scotland ;  where  the  temperature,  and 
the  character  of  the  herbage,  resemble  those  of  their  native 
residence. — Fossil  bones  of  a  species  of  Llama,  which  must  have 
fully  equalled  the  Camel  in  size,  have  been  found  in  South 
America ;  this  was  probably  an  inhabitant  of  the  plains. 

283.  In  addition  to  the  species  of  fossil  Ruminants  of  which 
mention  has  been  already  made,  it  may  be  here  stated,  that 
numerous  species  of  Deer  and  Oxen  occur  in  the  caverns  and 
bone-beds  of  various  parts  of  the  world  ;  especially  in  the  most 
recent  of  the  tertiary  series  of  strata.  The  Camels  and  Antelopes 
also  had  their  representatives  in  the  ancient  world ;  and  it  would 
appear  that  the  latter  were  much  more  widely  diffused  than  at 
present.  Few  remains,  however,  have  been  found,  that  show 
any  remarkable  differences  from  the  genera  at  present  existing  ; 
and  in  this  respect  the  fossils  of  the  order  Ruminantia  are 
strongly  contrasted  with  those  of  the  Edentata  and  Pachyder- 
mata.  The  most  distinct  fossil  form  yet  discovered  is  that  of  a 
South  American  Ruminant,  to  which  the  apellation  Leptotherium 
has  been  given.  In  the  lightness  of  its  skeleton  it  rivals  the 
most  agile  of  the  Antelopes ;  but  it  departs  from  that  group,  as 
well  as  from  all  others,  in  the  details  of  its  structure.  The 
remains  of  two  species  have  been  found ;  one  of  them  being  less 
than  the  Roe,  and  the  other  larger  than  the  Stag. 


317 


ORDER  X.—PACHYDERMATA. 

284.  The  order  Pacbydermata,  which  includes  all  the 
ungulated  or  hoofed  true  Mammalia  that  do  not  ruminate, 
derives  its  name  from  the  thickness  of  the  skin,  which  is  usually 
so  remarkable  a  character  of  the  animals  it  comprehends, — as 
for  instance,  in  the  Elephant,  Hippopotamus,  Rhinoceros,  and 
common  Hog.  A  very  cursory  glance  through  the  group  of 
animals  thus  brought  together,  serves  to  show  that  they  are  not 
by  any  means  so  closely  allied,  as  are  those  of  the  preceding 
order.  The  Elephant,  the  Horse,  and  the  Hog,  for  example, 
differ  so  much  from  one  another,  that  we  might  be  almost  led  to 
regard  them  as  types  of  distinct  orders;  or  at  any  rate  we  should 
be  forced  to  suppose  that  the  continuity  or  completeness  of  the 
series  had  been  broken  into.  The  interruption  of  the  chain 
-becomes  still  more  striking,  when  we  pass  from  any  of  the 
animals  already  named,  to  the  Dugong  and  other  Whale-like 
species,  which  Naturalists  have  now  generally  agreed  to  place  in 
the  same  order.  But  the  researches  which  have  been  made,  for 
some  time  past,  into  the  structure  of  the  animals  that  formerly 
covered  our  globe,  as  made  known  by  their  fossil  remains,  have 
been  peculiarly  successful  in  their  results  as  regards  this  order; — 
furnishing,  in  a  large  proportion  of  cases,  the  very  forms  which 
are  wanting  as  links  in  the  chain,  and  which,  when  placed  in  their 
proper  position,  give  order  and  completeness  to  that,  which 
previously  seemed  a  confused  assemblage  of  dissimilar  creatures  : 
whilst  the  animals  to  which  these  remains  belonged,  have  their 
strange  forms  accounted  for,  and  their  striking  peculiarities 
explained,  when  they  are  viewed  as  the  intermediate  links 
between  groups,  which,  as  known  only  by  the  animals  at  present 
existing,  seem  far  apart  from  each  other. 

285.  For  the  reasons  just  specified,  it  is  impossible  to  assign 
any  other  general  character  to  the  order,  than  those  which  have 
been  already  given.  The  conformation  of  the  teeth,  and  the 
structure  of  the  extremities,  which  elsewhere  afford  such  import- 


318         ORDER    PACHYDERMATA. FAMILY    ELEPHANTID^E. 

ant  marks  of  resemblance,  are  here  so  various,  as  to  require  a 
separate  description  for  each  family ;  it  can  only  be  stated 
regarding  the  former,  that  they  au  chiefly  formed  for  a  vegetable 
diet  (though  some  species  are  omnivorous)  ;  whilst  the  extremi- 
ties are  constructed  for  support  only, — the  clavicles  being  absent, 
— the  bones  of  the  fore-arm  consolidated,  so  that  the  power  of 
rotation  is  altogether  lost, — and  the  toes  included  in  a  callous 
skin,  or  in  proper  hoofs.  The  order  may  be  subdivided  into  four 
sections;  distinguished  by  the  following  characters: — 1.  The 
PROBOSCIDEA,  possessing  a  prolonged  snout  or  proboscis,  and 
having  five  toes  on  each  foot,  included  in  a  very  firm  horny  skin. 
2.  The  PACHYDERMATA  ORDINARIA,  in  which  the  feet  have  four, 
three,  or  two  toes  on  each  foot.  3.  The  SOLIDTJNGULA,  in  which 
the  foot  has  but  one  apparent  toe.  4.  The  CETACEA  HERBIVORA, 
in  which  the  posterior  extremities  are  wanting,  and  the  anterior 
formed  as  paddles  for  swimming. 

286.  The  Proboscidean  group  contains  but  one  family,  the 
ELEPHANTID.E,  or  Elephant  tribe  ;  and  this  at  present  consists  of 
but  a  single  genus.  The  Elephants,  of  which  only  two  species — 
the  Asiatic  and  the  African — at  present  exist,  are  distinguished, 
not  only  by  their  proboscis,  but  by  the  absence  of  front  teeth  in 
the  lower  jaw,  and  by  the  possession  of  two  enormous  tusks, 
which  project  downwards  from  the  upper.  These,  like  the  long 
canines  of  the  Rodentia,  grow  from  a  pulp  which  is  continually 
forming  new  ivory  (ANIM.  PHYSIOL.,  §  177)  ;  and  may  be 
regarded  as  closely  analogous  to  the  teeth,  which  are  character- 
istic of  that  order.  The  analogies  between  the  largest  and  the 
smallest  of  the  terrestrial  Mammalia  do  not,however,  stop  here. 
They  may  be  traced,  also,  in  the  structure  of  the  molar  teeth, 
which  are  formed  of  alternating  vertical  plates  of  enamel,  bone, 
and  crusta  petrosa,  arranged  transversely  to  the  jaw,  as  in  the 
Rodentia  (§216).  These  grinders  succeed  one  another,  from 
behind  forwards, — each  tooth,  as  it  is  worn,  giving  way  to 
another,  which  is  pushed  into  its  place ;  so  that  the  Elephant 
may  have  one,  or  two,  of  these  large  grinders  on  each  side, 
according  to  the  period  of  their  development.  The  molars  are 
said  to  be  thus  changed  eight  times ;  the  first  tusks  of  the  young 


FAMILY  ELEPHANTID.^  ; — ELEPHANT. 


319 


Elephant  are  shed,  however,  like  the  milk  teeth  of  other  Mam- 
malia, and  are  not  renewed  more  than  once.  In  the  continual 
growth  of  the  molars,  there  is  another  analogy  between  the 
Elephants  and  some  sections  of  the  Rodentia  (§  231)  ;  although 


FIG.  1«2.— ELKPHA.VT. 


the  mode  of  renewal  is  different.  The  African  and  Asiatic 
species  differ  from  each  other  in  the  size  of  the  tusks,  which  are 
much  shorter  in  the  latter  than  in  the  former ;  and  also  in  the 
arrangement  of  the  plates  of  enamel  in  the  molar  teeth,  the 
ridges  of  which  are  nearly  parallel  in  the  latter,  whilst  they  are 
lozenge-shaped  in  the  former.  The  trunk,  which  is  the  peculiar 


320  FAMILY  ELEPHANTID.E ; ELEPHANT. 

distiuctive  character  of  these  animals,  is  nothing  else  than  the 
nose  or  snout,  enormously  prolonged,  and  principally  composed  of 
forty    thousand   or   more   small    r^uscles,   interlaced    in    every 
direction,   which  give  it  an  extraordinary  degree  of  flexibility, 
and  render  it  a  most  efficient  organ  of  prehension.     "We  shall 
hereafter  see  that  approaches  to  this  structure  are  to  be  found  in 
other  animals  of  the  order.     The  large  size  of  the  muscular  mass 
by  which   the  trunk   is  connected  with  the  head,   requires  an 
extensive  bony  surface  for  their  attachment ;  and  this  is  provided 
for  by  the  peculiar  conformation  of  the  skull,   the  outer  plate  of 
which  is  separated  from  the  inner  by  a  number  of  large  bony 
cells,    so  as  to  give  to  the  exterior  of  the  head  a  much  greater 
size,  than  is  required   for  the  mere  enclosure  of  the  brain.     The 
trunk,  which  is  perforated  along  its  whole  length  by  the  nostrils, 
has   at  its   termination   a  small    finger-like   appendage,  which 
serves  to  pick  up  small  objects,  and  also  as  a  feeler;  and  the 
sense  of  touch  appears  to  be   here  peculiarly  delicate.      This 
wonderful  organ  serves  a  great  variety  of  purposes.      The  short- 
ness of  the  neck,  rendered  necessary  by  the  enormous  weight  of 
the  tusks  (of  which  a  single  one  has  been  known  to  weigh  350 
Ibs,  the  ordinary  weight  of  the  pair  being  probably  4  to  5  cwt.), 
is  fully  compensated  by  this  instrument ;  for  by  means  of  it,  the 
Elephant  collects  the  herbage  on  which  it  feeds,  and  carries  it  to 
its  mouth  ;  with  this  he  strips  the  trees  of  their  branches,  or 
grasps  his  enemy  and  dashes  him  to  the  ground  ;    and  with  this 
too  he  takes  up  the  fluid  which  he  requires,  sucking  it  into  the 
extended  nostrils  (from  which  it  is  prevented  from  passing  back- 
wards, by  a  sort  of  valve  placed  where  they  pass  into  the  skull), 
and  then  discharging  it  into  his  mouth  or  over  the  surface  of  the 
body.     The  tusks  are  useful,  not  only  as  weapons  of  offence  and 
defence,  but  also  to  root  up  small  trees,  and  to  tear  down  the 
branches  of  larger  ones,  either  to  obtain  the  leaves  as  food,  or  to 
make  a  passage  for  ^he  bulky  body  of  the  animal  through  the 
tangled  forest. 

287.  The  Elephant  is  the  largest  of  the  terrestrial  Mam- 
malia; for  although  the  Giraffe  carries  his  head  at  a  greater 
elevation,  the  height  of  his  body  is  far  exceeded  by  that  of  the 


FAMILY    ELEPHANTID.E  ; — ELEPHANT,  MAMMOTH.  32 1 

Elephant,  the  back  of  which  has  been  known  to  stand  more  than 
12  feet  from  the  ground.  In  point  of  bulk,  the  Rhinoceros  and 
Hippopotamus  are  the  only  existing  terrestrial  animals,  that  can 
approach  the  Elephant  ;  though  some  other  animals  now  extinct 
must  have  considerably  surpassed  him.  The  enormous  weight 
of  the  body  could  only  be  sustained  by  legs  of  the  most  solid  con- 
struction ;  and  accordingly  we  find  that  these  have  the  aspect  of 
straight  columns,  the  joints  being  so  formed,  that  each  bone  rests 
vertically  upon  the  one  beneath  it.  The  Elephant  derives  much 
dignity  from  its  colossal  bulk  and  vast  powers  ;  but  there  is  no 
grace  in  its  contour,  and  its  movements  are  heavy  and  ungainly. 
From  the  earliest  times,  this  noble  beast  has  been  brought  under 
subjection  to  the  human  race ;  to  whose  use  it  is  particularly 
adapted,  not  only  by  its  vast  strength,  but  also  by  the  extraor- 
dinary combination  of  docility  and  intelligence  which  it  presents. 
Like  the  Dog  and  Horse,  it  seems  peculiarly  susceptible  of  the 
influence  of  Man,  and  disposed  to  attach  itself  to  him.  As  an 
instance  of  its  enormous  power,  it  may  be  mentioned  that  an 
Elephant,  applying  its  forehead  to  the  muzzle  of  a  piece  of  can- 
non, will  urge  it  through  a  bog,  from  which  hundreds  of  cattle 
and  men  could  not  drag  it  ;  or,  winding  his  trunk  round  the 
gun,  it  will  lift  the  piece,  whilst  the  cattle  and  men  pull  it  for- 
wards. The  African  species  is  not  at  present  tamed  by  Man, 
being  pursued  solely  for  its  tusks  ;  but  it  was  this  which  was 
for  the  most  part  employed  by  the  ancient  Romans. 

288.  A  third  species  of  Elephant,  commonly  known  as  the 
Mammoth^  formerly  existed  in  Northern  Asia  in  great  abun- 
dance ;  as  is  proved  by  the  vast  number  of  tusks  and  bones 
which  are  found  buried  in  the  frozen  soil  of  Siberia.  The  tusks 
form  a  regular  article  of  commerce,  and  are  employed  throughout 
Russia  as  the  ordinary  ivory  of  the  turner.  A  complete  carcase 
of  the  animal  was  found  at  the  beginning  of  this  century,  frozen 
up  in  the  ice  at  the  mouth  of  the  river  Lena  in  Siberia  ;  the  flesh 
being  in  such  good  preservation,  that  bears  and  dogs  fed  off  it. 
The  skin  was  covered  with  two  kinds  of  hair, — one  long,  scat- 
tered, and  bristly, — the  other  short  and  closely  set ;  so  that  this 
animal  was  evidently  adapted  for  climates  much  colder  than 


322    FAMILY    ELEPHANTIDJE  ;— MAMMOTH,    FOSSIL  ELEPHANTS. 

those  which  the  Elephants  of  the  present  day  inhabit.  Still  it 
cannot  be  imagined  that  the  temperature  of  Siberia,  at  the  time 
when  the  Mammoths  were  the  denizens  of  its  wilds,  was  as  cold 
as  at  present ;  since  there  would  not  have  been  a  sufficient 
amount  of  vegetation  for  the  support  of  any  numbers  of  these 
immense  Quadrupeds.  And  the  belief  that,  from  some  Geolo- 
gical causes,  a  change  of  climate  has  taken  place  in  that  region 


FIG.   163.— SKELETON  OF  MAMMOTH. 

since  they  inhabited  it, — to  which  change  the  extinction  of  the 
race  is  due, — finds  confirmation  from  the  corresponding  facts 
already  stated  (§  206),  regarding  the  former  inhabitants  of  our 
own  country.  It  is  probable  that  many  other  complete  carcases 
of  the  Mammoth  may  still  remain,  buried  beneath  the  ice  and 
frozen  soil  of  Siberia.  In  its  general  structure,  and  in  the 
arrangement  of  the  plates  of  enamel  in  its  molar  teeth,  the 
Mammoth  approached  the  Asiatic  Elephant,  more  nearly  than 
the  African  species;  the  most  obvious  difference  is  the  large  size  of 
the  alveoli,  or  sockets  for  the  tusks,  and  the  greater  curvature  of 
the  tusks. — Numerous  remains  of  other  species  of  Elephants  are 
found  in  almost  every  part  of  Europe,  and  also  in  America ;  they 
are  usually  buried  in  the  most  recent  and  slightly-consolidated 
strata, —such  as  the  alluvium  filling  the  bottom  of  valleys  or 
forming  the  borders  of  rivers,  the  mud  of  certain  caverns,  the 
crag  formation  of  the  eastern  side  of  our  island,  and  other  fresh 


FAMILY    ELEPHANT1D.E  J MASTODON.  323 

water  deposits  of  the  newest  tertiary  series.  They  are  com- 
monly associated  with  remains  of  other  animals ;  of  which  some 
may  be  referred  to  existing  genera  ;  whilst  many  (some  of  which 
will  be  hereafter  noticed)  present  forms,  of  which  we  have  not 
any  representatives  amongst  the  races  now  living. 

289.  Nearly  allied    to  the  Elephants  is  an  extinct  genus, 
termed  the  Mastodon^  which  was  characterised  by  the  form  of  its 
molar  teeth.     These,  instead  of  having  the  enamel  disposed  in 
ridges,  had  their  crowns  raised  up  into  conical  eminences,  with 
deep  furrows  between  them ;  and  these  were   worn   down   by 
friction,   into  disks  of  various  sizes,  very  much  as  in  the  Pig, 
Hippopotamus,  and  other  Pachydermata.     In  the  young  state, 
moreover,  there  were  small  tusks  projecting  downwards,  in  the 
lower  jaw  (as  well  as  in  the  upper)  of  both  sexes ;  but  both  of 
these  disappear  in  the  adult  female,  and  only  one  remains  in  the 
male.     From  the  examination  of  a  young  specimen  possessing 
these  tusks,  it  was  at  first  supposed  that  it  belonged  to  a  distinct 
genus,  to  which  the  name  of  Tetracaulodon  (or  four-tusked)  was 
given.     The  Mastodon  giyanteus, — of  which  a  very  fine  skeleton 
was  recently  (1842)  exhibited  in  London,  under  the  name  of  the 
Missouri  Leviathan, — must  have  considerably  exceeded  in  size 
the  largest  Elephants  of  the  present  day.     Its  remains  are  con- 
fined to  the  American  continent,  and  are  very  abundant  in  some 
parts,  especially  in  the  saline  morass  popularly  termed  the  Big 
Bone  Lick.     Several  other  species  of  Mastodon,  however,  have 
been  distinguished  by  their  remains  ;  of  these  some  were  natives 
of  the  Old  World,  and  probably  even  of  Britain  ;  but  they  were 
for  the  most  part  considerably  smaller  than  the  gigantic  Mastodon 
of  North  America. 

290.  On  the  principles  which  should  regulate  the  subdivision 
of  the  group  of  ORDINARY  PACHYDERMATA  into  families,  Natu- 
ralists are  not  yet  agreed  ;  the  number  of  dissimilar  forms  which 
it  contains  being  so  great,  as  to  render  their  arrangement  very 
perplexing.     The  division  which  will  be  here  adopted  is  founded 
upon  that  of  Cuvier;  but  may  not  improbably  require  future 
modification.     In  the  first  family  of  this  group,  including  the 
Rhinoceros,  Tapir,  Hyrax,  and  several  extinct  genera,  the  feet  do 

Y  2 


324  FAMILY    TAPIRID.E  ; TAPIR. 

not  present  any  indication  of  a  cleft  in  the  centre,  the  number  of 
toes  being  usually  but  three  ;  and  the  molars  are  six  or  seven  on 
each  side  of  each  jaw,  with  crescentic  ridges  of  enamel ;  the 
incisors  and  canines,  however,  vary  in  the  different  genera.  In 
the  second  family,  including  the  Hog,  Hippopotamus,  &c.,  the 
feet  have  four  toes  and  are  cleft  in  the  centre,  thus  presenting  an 
approach  to  the  Ruminants,  which  is  shown  also  in  the  stomach, 
as  well  as  in  the  foot,  of  the  Peccaries  :  the  teeth  are  variable  in 
number,  but  agree  for  the  most  part  in  their  characters,  the 
molars  being  raised  into  conical  summits,  and  the  canines  being 
of  great  length. 

291.  Of  the  first  family,  to  which  the  name  of  TAPIRID.E  or 
the  Tapir  tribe  may  be  given,  no  members  exist  in  Europe  at  the 
present  time ;  but  fossil  remains  of  numerous  species,  some  of 
them  of  great  size,  exist  in  some  localities.  The  whole  family 
appears  to  be  usually  herbivorous,  although  some  species  are  as 
omnivorous  as  the  Hog.  Of  the  Tapir,  three  species  are  at 
present  known ;  two  of  them  being  natives  of  South  America, 
whilst  the  other  inhabits  Sumatra  and  Malacca.  In  its  general 
form  and  contour,  the  Tapir  reminds  us  of  the  Hog ;  but  it  is  at 
once  distinguished  by  its  snout,  which  is  lengthened  into  a  flex- 
ible proboscis,  that  looks  like  the  rudiment  of  the  trunk  of  the 
Elephant,  and  is  sufficiently  prehensile  to  grasp  fruit  or  bunches 
of  herbage,  or  to  serve  as  a  hook  for  drawing  down  twigs  to  the 
mouth  (Fig.  57).  The  anterior  feet  have  four  toes,  but  the 
posterior  only  three ;  and  these  have  only  their  tips  cased  in 
small  hoofs.  The  incisor  teeth  are  six  in  number ;  the  canines 
small ;  and  the  molars  are  seven  on  each  side  of  the  upper  jaw, 
and  six  in  the  lower.  The  common  American  species,  which  is 
between  three  and  four  feet  in  height,  and  from  five  to  six  in 
length,  is  very  extensively  spread  throughout  the  warmer  regions 
of  South  America,  where  it  inhabits  deep  forests,  leading  a 
solitary  life,  and  going  in  search  of  food  at  night.  Its  enormous 
muscular  power,  and  the  tough  thick  hide  which  defends  its  body, 
enable  it  to  tear  its  way  through  the  underwood  in  whatever 
direction  it  pleases;  when  thus  driving  onwards,  it  carries 
head  low,  and,  as  it  were,  ploughs  its  course.  It  is  very  fond 


: 


FAMILY    TAP11UDJ2  ; — TAPIR,  PAL^OTHERIUM.  325 

the  water,  and  resorts  to  it  when  wounded.  Its  disposition  is 
peaceful  and  quiet,  and  it  never  attempts  to  attack  either  man  or 
beast,  unless  hard  pressed ;  it  is  capable  of  defending  itself 
vigorously,  however,  and  inflicts  severe  wounds  with  its  teeth. 
The  Tapir  is  occasionally  domesticated  in  Cayenne,  and  is  harm- 
less and  familiar  in  its  habits.  The  other  South  American  species 
is  an  inhabitant  of  the  most  elevated  regions  of  the  Andes,  and 
is  covered  with  long,  thick,  black  hair.  In  some  of  its  charac- 
ters, it  approaches  to  the  fossil  Palceotherium.  The  Indian 
Tapir  closely  resembles  that  of  America  in  its  conformation  and 
habits ;  but  it  is  of  larger  stature,  and  its  body,  instead  of  pre- 
senting the  dusky  bay  tint  of  the  latter,  is  strangely  marked  with 
different  colours. 

292.  Intermediate  between  the  Tapir  and  the  Hog,  is  a  very 
interesting  genus,  now  extinct,  but  once  abundant  in  Europe ; 
this  was  termed  by  Cuvier  the  Palceotherium  (ancient  wild- 
beast).  Its  remains  are  very  abundant  in  the  gypsum  quarries 
near  Paris,  as  well  as  in  other  parts  of  the  Continent,  and  in 
this  country ;  and  ten  or  eleven  species  have  been  recognised, 
varying  in  size  from  that  of  the  Rhinoceros  to  that  of  the 
Hog.  The  reconstruction  (so  to  speak)  of  these  animals,  from 
the  fossil  remains  which  have  been  so  long  imbedded  in  the  earth, 
was  one  of  the  first  fruits  of  the  accurate  study  of  Compa- 
rative Anatomy,  prosecuted  by  Cuvier ;  whose  name  has  been 
rendered  immortal  by  the  discovery  of  that  intimate  connexion 
existing  between  the  different  parts  of  the  same  animal,  which 
renders  it  possible  to  predict  the  form  of  the  whole,  with  almost 
positive  certainty,  from  the  examination  of  a  small  part  only. 
The  following  is  his  own  account  of  this  discovery,  to  which  he 
was  led  by  the  study  of  a  collection  of  bones  dug  up  from  the 
neighbourhood  of  Paris.  "I  found  myself,  as  if  placed  in  a 
charnel-house,  surrounded  by  mutilated  fragments  of  many 
hundred  skeletons  of  more  than  twenty  kinds  of  animals  piled 
confusedly  around  me ;  the  task  assigned  to  me  was  to  restore 
them  all  to  their  original  position.  At  the  voice  of  Comparative 
Anatomy,  every  bone  and  fragment  of  bone  resumed  its  place. 
I  cannot  find  words  to  express  the  pleasure  I  experienced  in 


326       FAMILY    TAPIRID^E  ; PALJiOTHERlUM,  RHINOCEROS. 

seeing,  when  I  discovered  one  character,  how  all  the  conse- 
quences which  I  predicted  from  it  were  successively  confirmed. 
The  feet  accorded  with  the  chara'  ters  announced  by  the  teeth  ; 
the  teeth  were  in  harmony  with  those  previously  indicated  by 
the  feet.  The  bones  of  the  legs  and  thighs,  and  every  connect- 
ing portion  of  the  extremities,  were  found  to  be  joined  together, 
precisely  as  I  had  arranged  them  before  my  conjectures  were 
verified  by  the  discovery  of  the  parts  entire.  Each  species  was, 
in  fact,  reconstructed  from  a  single  unit  of  its  component 
elements."  The  deposits  in  which  the  remains  of  the  Palseothe- 
rium  are  found,  are  evidently  of  considerably  older  date  than 
those  in  which  the  bones  and  teeth  of  the  Elephants  and  Masto- 
dons are  buried;  and  the  other  fossil  remains  of  terrestrial 
animals,  that  are  found  with  them,  are  for  the  most  part  very 
dissimilar  to  those  which  now  inhabit  our  globe.  These  deposits, 
however,  were  formed  by  the  agency  of  fresh  water ;  and  there 
can  be  little  doubt  that  the  bones  of  Palaeotheria  which  they 
contain,  are  the  relics  of  animals  which,  like  the  Tapir  and 
Rhinoceros  of  the  present  day,  frequented  the  borders  of  lakes 
and  large  rivers,  by  whose  waters  they  were  occasionally 
ingulphed  in  seasons  of  flood. — Another  fossil  genus  allied  to  the 
Tapirs  is  that  of  Lophiodon,  which  differs  from  Palseotherium  in 
having  only  six  molars  on  either  side  of  each  jaw,  but  in  other 
respects  closely  resembles  it.  No  less  than  fifteen  species  of  this 
genus  have  been  distinguished ;  their  remains  are  commonly 
found  associated  with  those  of  the  Palasotherium. 

293.  Returning  to  the  animals  now  inhabiting  our  globe,  we 
have  next  to  notice  the  Rhinoceros,  a  large  and  ungainly-looking 
animal,  which  inhabits  the  hotter  regions  of  the  Old  World. 
This  genus  (which  contains  six  living  species,  as  well  as  several 
extinct  ones,  whose  remains  occur  in  the  same  strata  with  those 
of  the  Elephant)  is  characterised  by  the  possession  of  three  toes 
on  each  foot,  and  by  the  presence  (in  most  of  the  species  at  least) 
of  seven  molars  on  each  side  above  and  below,  with  only  four 
incisors,  and  no  canine  teeth.  Its  most  distinguishing  mark, 
however,  is  the  possession  of  a  solid  horn,  which  is  supported 
upon  a  very  strong  arch,  formed  by  the  nasal  bones.  The  horn 


FAMILY    TAPIRID.tt  J RUINUCKKUS.  327 

is  curved  and  pointed,  and  arises  from  a  limpet-shaped  base  ;  and 
it  is  composed  of  agglutinated  fibres  analogous  to  those  of  hair, 
and  closely  resembling  those  into  which  whalebone  is  so  easily 
separable.  In  some  species,  there  are  two  horns,  both  on  the 
central  line  of  the  body ;  and  the  hinder  one  is  situated  on  the 
frontal  bone.  The  arch  on  which  the  horns  rest  has  need  of  great 
strength,  not  only  to  sustain  its  weight,  but  also  to  resist  the 


FIG.  164. — TWO-HORNED  RHINOCEROS. 

shock  occasioned  by  the  violent  blows,  which  the  animal  gives 
with  this  powerful  weapon.  The  skin  of  the  Rhinoceros  is  thick 
and  coarse,  with  a  knotty  surface ;  and  is  destitute,  or  nearly  so, 
of  hairs ;  in  the  common  Indian  species,  it  is  disposed  in  large 
folds,  especially  on  the  neck,  shoulders,  haunches,  and  thighs. 
The  upper  lip  is  prolonged,  and  in  some  species  is  as  prehensile 
as  that  of  the  Tapir.  The  best  known  species  of  Rhinoceros 
is  the  one  which  inhabits  India ;  where  it  leads  a  tranquil 
indolent  life,  wallowing  on  the  marshy  borders  of  lakes  and  rivers, 
and  occasionally  bathing  itself  in  their  waters.  Its  movements 
are  usually  slow ;  and  it  carries  its  head  low,  like  the  Hog, 
ploughing  up  the  ground  with  its  horn,  and  making  its  way  by 
sheer  force  through  the  jungle.  Owing  to  the  keenness  of  its 
smell  and  hearing,  the  Rhinoceros  cannot  be  easily  attacked ; 
for  on  any  alarm,  it  retreats  to  its  covert  in  the  almost  impene- 


328  FAMILY    TAPIRIDJ2  ; — RHINOCEROS,  HYDRAX. 

trable  jungle ;  but  when  brought  to  bay,  it  charges  with  great 
fury  and  impetuosity,  and  tramples  down,  or  rips  up  with  its 
horn,  any  animal  that  opposes  it  Even  the  Elephant  cannot 
withstand  its  fury.  Another  species,  less  powerful  and  savage, 
is  found  in  Java ;  and  a  third,  which  possesses  two  horns,  in 
Sumatra.  Three  species,  each  possessing  two  horns,  are  found 
in  Africa,  of  which  the  best  known, — the  black,  or  common 
Rhinoceros, — is  represented  in  (Fig.  164). — The  Rhinoceros 
appears  to  have  been  formerly  as  widely  distributed  as  the 
Elephant  and  Mammoth  ;  and  its  remains  are  found  associated 
with  theirs.  Several  species,  differing  from  those  at  present  exist- 
ing, have  been  distinctly  made  out ;  and  of  one  of  these,  an  entire 
frozen  carcase  has  been  discovered,  in  the  banks  of  one  of  the 
tributaries  of  the  Lena.  It  had  two  horns,  but  differed  in  many 
respects  from  any  two-horned  species  of  the  present  day ;  and  its 
skin,  like  that  of  the  Mammoth,  was  covered  with  long  stiff  hair. 
Remains  of  the  Rhinoceros  are  found  in  almost  every  bone-cavern 
in  England,  France,  and  Germany  ;  and  it  appears  from  the 
researches  of  Dr.  Buckland,  that,  during  a  long  succession  of 
years,  the  Elephant,  Hippopotamus,  Rhinoceros,  and  Hysena, 
were  formerly  inhabitants  of  our  island, — the  last-mentioned  of 
these  devouring  the  others,  or  preying  upon  its  carcase  after 
natural  or  accidental  death. 

294.  There  is  a  curious  genus  of  small  animals,  inhabiting 
the  rocky  districts  of  Africa  and  Syria,  which  is  intermediate  in 
its  characters  between  the  Tapir  and  Rhinoceros,  but  presents 
several  points  of  resemblance  to  the  Rodentia.  This  is  the 
Daman,  or  Hyrax,  an  active  fur-covered  little  animal,  sometimes 
called  the  Rock-Rabbit,  and  probably  the  Cony  referred  to  in  the 
Book  of  Proverbs.  Its  skeleton  closely  resembles  that  of  a  Rhi- 
noceros in  miniature,  and  its  molar  teeth  are  formed  in  the  same 
manner  ;  the  fore-feet  have  four  toes,  which  are  tipped  with  hoof- 
like  nails  ;  whilst  the  hind-feet  have  three,  of  which  the  inner- 
most is  furnished  with  a  long  claw-like  nail.  The  best  known 
species  are  the  Cape  Hyrax,  which  inhabits  Southern  Africa ; 
and  the  Syrian  Hyrax  of  Syria,  Arabia,  and  Abyssinia.  Both 
these  ar«  active,  wary  animals,  somewhat  larger  than  Rabbits, 


FAMILY    SUID.E,    OR    PIG    TRIBE.  329 

living  in  families,  and  taking  up  their  abode  in  caves  or  crevices 
in  the  sides  of  rocks  ;  they  live  upon  the  young  shoots  of  shrubs, 
and  upon  herbs  and  grass ;  and  they  are  playful  in  their  habits, 
and  docile  and  familiar  in  captivity. 

295.  The  family  SUID^E,  or  Pig  tribe,  is  the  only  group  of 
Pachydermata  which  is  widely  distributed  over  the  globe; 
members  of  it  being  found  native  in  Europe,  Asia,  Africa,  and 
South  America.  The  animals  composing  it  are  distinguished  by 
the  conformation  of  their  feet,  which  have  four  toes  inclosed  in 
separate  hoofs,  the  two  central  toes  being  much  the  largest,  and 
divided  by  a  deep  cleft.  In  the  common  Hoy,  each  toe  has  its 
own  distinct  metacarpal  or  metatarsal  bones  ;  but  in  the 
Peccaries,  the  metacarpal  or  metatarsal  bones  of  the  two  middle 
toes  are  consolidated  into  a  single  canon-bone,  which  resembles 
that  of  the  Ruminants  (§  254) ;  and  the  stomach  of  these 
animals  is  partially  divided  into  distinct  sacculi,  thus  presenting 
another  link  of  connexion  between  the  two  groups.  The  charac- 
ters of  the  teeth  in  this  family  have  been  already  mentioned 
(§  290)  ;  but  it  may  be  added  that  the  canines  are  usually  very 
long,  and  project  forwards  as  tusks,  which  are  used  by  the  animal 
as  weapons  of  defence,  and  for  rooting  up  the  ground.  The  Boar, 
or  Wild  Hog,  which  is  distributed  through  the  forests  of  Europe, 
Asia,  and  Africa,  the  Phacochoere,  or  Vlacke  Yark  of  the  Cape 
Colonists,  the  Babyroussa  of  the  Indian  Archipelago,  and  the 
Peccaries  of  South  America,  closely  agree  in  their  general  habits 
and  dispositions.  Their  food  is  naturally  vegetable,  and  consists 
of  the  stems  and  roots  of  plants,  together  with  acorns,  beech- 
mast,  and  similar  materials.  They  are  for  the  most  part  inoffen- 
sive when  not  attacked,  but  display  great  courage,  and  even 
ferocity,  when  brought  to  bay ;  whilst  the  length  of  their  tusks, 
and  the  great  strength  of  the  muscles  of  the  neck  by  which  the 
head  is  thrown  upwards,  or  violently  tossed  from  side  to  side, 
render  them  very  formidable  antagonists.  When  taken  young, 
however,  they  are  easily  domesticated,  and  even  become  trouble- 
some from  their  familiarity;  but  they  commonly  show  a  disposi- 
tion to  escape  from  the  control  of  Man  into  their  native  haunts, 
and  to  resume  their  original  habits.  This  disposition  is  displayed 


330          FAMILY    SUID.E  ; — BOAR,  PHACOCHCERE,  PECCARY. 

also  by  the  Elephant,  the  Tapir,  and  even  by  the  Horse ;  and  it 
seems  to  distinguish  the  Pachydermata  from  the  Ruminants, 
which,  when  once  brought  into  subjection  to  Man,  remain 
peaceably  under  it. 

296.  The  Boar  or  Wild  Hog  is  unquestionably  the  original 
stock  of  our  domestic  race,  and  does  not  differ  from  the  common 
Pig  in  any  essential  peculiarities.  The  snout,  however,  is  more 
elongated,  the  tusks  larger  (sometimes  attaining  the  length  of 
more  than  ten  inches),  and  the  contour  of  the  frame  more  gaunt 
and  bony ;  whilst  the  muscular  strength  is  much  greater,  and 
the  temper  more  savage.  Like  the  domesticated  Pig,  the  Boar 
is  nearly  omnivorous  ;  not  however  attacking  and  killing  other 
animals  for  the  sake  of  their  flesh,  but  devouring  what  may  fall 
in  its  way.  This  animal  was  formerly  a  native  of  the  forests  of 
Britain,  but  has  been  long  since  extirpated,  though  at  what 
precise  epoch  is  not  known ;  it  still  ranges  through  the  forests  of 
France,  Germany,  and  other  parts  of  Europe,  and  extends  also 
as  far  as  India ;  there  is  some  doubt,  however,  whether  the 
European  and  Indian  species  are  the  same.  In  all  ages,  the 
chase  of  the  Boar  has  been  a  favourite  diversion  :  it  is  not  unat- 
tended with  danger,  however ;  for  horses  and  men,  as  well  as 
dogs,  have  not  unfrequently  fallen  a  sacrifice  to  the  fury  of  the 
animal ;  but  this  danger  perhaps  adds  to  the  excitement. — The 
Phacochoeres  of  Abyssinia  and  Southern  Africa  closely  resemble 
the  Hog  in  general  structure  and  habits,  but  differ  from  them 
remarkably  in  their  dentition ;  for  the  molar  teeth  are  formed 
very  much  upon  the  plan  of  those  of  the  Elephant,  and  successively 
replace  one  another,  by  advancing  from  behind  forwards,  as  in 
that  animal. — The  Peccaries  are  the  representatives  of  the  Boar 
in  South  America ;  and  it  is  remarkable  that,  with  the  Tapirs, 
they  constituted  the  only  representatives  of  the  whole  order  of 
Pachydermata,  which  were  found  in  that  continent  at  the  time  of  its 
discovery.  In  ancient  times,  as  we  have  already  seen,  numerous 
species  of  Mastodons,  and  other  gigantic  Pachyderms,  roamed 
over  its  wilds ;  but  they  have  gradually  become  extinct,  and 
have  left  us  only  these  two  comparatively  small  and  feeble  genera 
as  their  representatives.  On  the  other  hand,  since  the  discovery 


FAMILY 


;  —  BABYROUSSA,  HIPPOPOTAMUS. 


331 


of  America  by  Europeans,  many  European  species  have  been 
introduced,  which  have  become  naturalised  in  the  country,  and 
now  run  wild  through  its  plains  and  forests ;  this  is  the  case 
with  the  Boar,  and  with  the  Horse.  Independently  of  the 
peculiarities  already  mentioned,  the  Peccaries, — of  which  there 
are  two  species,  the  collared,  and  the  white-lipped, — differ  from 
the  Hog  in  possessing  only  four  incisors  in  each  jaw  instead  of 
six,  and  only  six  molars  on  each  side  instead  of  seven ;  the 
canines,  too,  are  not  nearly  so  long,  and  do  not  curve  outwards. 
— The  Babyroussa  of  Java  and  the  Molucca  islands  is  chiefly 

remarkable  for  the 
extraordinary  cur- 
vature of  the  tusks 
of  the  upper  jaw, 
which  is  shown  in 
the  acompanying 
figure ;  the  pur- 
pose which  they 
serve  is  entirely 
unknown.  The  in- 
cisors are  four  above 
and  six  below  ;  the  molars  only  five  on  each  side. 

297.     With  this  family  we  may  place  the  gigantic  Hippopo- 
tamus or  River   Horse;  an  inhabitant  of  the  African  rivers, 
which  seems  to  con- 
nect the  Hog  with 
the  Elephant  on  the 
one  hand,  and  with 
the  aquatic  tribe  of 
Pachyderms  (§  304) 
on   the   other.      Its 
body  is  scarcely  in- 
ferior to  that  of  the 
Elephant   in    bulk; 
but  its  limbs  are  RO 
short  that  its  belly  almost  touches  the  ground.     In  its  general 
aspect  it  might  be  compared  to  a  gigantic  Pig,  but  for  its  short, 


FIG.  165.— BABYROUSSA. 


FIG.  166 — HIPPOPOTAMUS. 


332  FAMILY    SUIDJE  ; HIPPOPOTAMUS. 

thick,  and  very  blunt  muzzle.  The  incisors  and  canines  of  the 
lower  jaw  are  long  and  curved  forwards ;  but  the  lips  are  so 
large,  as  usually  to  conceal  them.  The  canines  of  the  two  jaws 
rub  against  each  other,  as  in  the  Rodentia,  and  are  continually 
growing  at  the  base,  from  a  persistent  pulp.  The  stomach  is 
partially  divided  into  several  sacs.  The  feet  possess  four  toes, 
terminated  in  separate  hoofs.  The  nostrils  open  on  the  top  of 
the  muzzle,  and  the  eyes,  which  are  very  small,  are  situated  high 
in  the  head ;  hence  the  animal,  whilst  its  body  is  submerged  in 
the  water,  can  look  around  and  breathe,  by  raising  but  a  very 
small  portion  of  the  head  above  the  surface.  As  its  name 
imports,  it  passes  a  large  part  of  its  time  in  the  water ;  usually 
quitting  it  by  night  in  search  of  its  food,  which  consists  of  the 
herbage  that  grows  near  the  banks  of  the  rivers  and  lakes.  It 
is  not  confined  to  rivers,  however  ;  for  it  also  tenants  the  inland 
lakes,  and  seems  equally  disposed  to  take  up  its  abode  in  the  sea, 
keeping  however  near  the  shore.  It  commonly  resorts  to 
places  where  it  can  walk  along  the  bottom,  covered  with  a  few 
feet  of  water ;  and  comes  every  five  or  six  minutes  to  the  surface 
to  breathe.  It  is  gregarious  in  its  habits ;  and  sagacious  and 
wary  in  its  disposition.  It  seems  quite  inoffensive  when  left  to 
itself,  but  shows  great  fury  when  attacked ;  and  will  sometimes 
become  the  assailant  upon  a  very  slight  accidental  provocation. 
It  is  believed  that  two  species  of  this  animal  exist ;  though 
the  differences  between  them  have  not  been  satisfactorily  ascer- 
tained. Their  range  was  formerly  much  greater  than  at  present ; 
for  they  gradually  retreat  as  Man  advances;  but  they  are  very 
troublesome  on  the  borders  of  some  of  the  colonies,  destroying 
whole  plantations  to  satisfy  the  wants  of  their  enormous  fabrics. 
They  are  in  their  turn  objects  of  pursuit,  on  account  of  their  flesh 
and  hide ;  the  former  is  much  in  request,  and  the  layer  of  fat 
which  lies  beneath  the  skin  is  considered  a  peculiar  delicacy ; 
the  hide  is  of  enormous  thickness,  being  two  inches  deep 
or  more  on  the  back  and  sides,  and  is  made  into  shields, 
whips,  walking-sticks,  &c.  Remains  of  four  species  of  Hip- 
popotamus have  been  found  in  a  fossil  state  in  Europe,  asso- 
ciated with  those  of  the  Elephant  and  Rhinoceros ;  indicating 


FAMILY    SUID.E  ; ANOPLOTHERIUM. —  SOLIDUNGULA.          333 

that  this  unwieldy  monster  must  have  been  once  an  inhabitant 
of  our  rivers. 

298.  With  this  family  we  may  also  associate  a  curious  fossil 
genus,  the  Anoplotherium  (or  beast  without  weapons),  of  which 
remains  have  been  found  with  those  of  the  Palaeotherium.  It 
is  remarkable,  in  the  first  place,  for  the  arrangement  of  its 
teeth,  which  consist  of  six  incisors,  four  canines,  and  fourteen 
molars  in  each  jaw,  forming  a  continued  line, — uninterrupted  by 
that  space  between  the  canines  and  molars  which  is  seen,  more  or 
less,  in  every  other  animal  except  Man.  The  canines  were  small, 
resembling  incisors  in  their  form,  as  in  the  lower  jaw  of  the 
Ruminants  ;  and  the  feet  had  only  two  toes,  sheathed  by  separate 
hoofs;  but  these  toes  had  separate  metacarpal  and  metatarsal 
bones,  as  in  the  Hog,  instead  of  springing  from  a  single  canon 
bone.  In  these  and  other  points,  therefore,  the  Anoplotherium 
seems  to  have  been  intermediate  between  the  Ruminantia  and 
Pachydermata  ;  its  head,  judging  from  the  skull,  partook  of  the 
form  of  that  of  the  Horse  and  of  the  Camel,  and  did 
not  bear  a  prolonged  snout.  Several  species  have 
been  discovered,  varying  considerably  in  their  gene- 
ral form;  thus,  one  was  heavy  in  its  build,  and  low 
on  its  limbs,  and  from  its  flattened  tail  may  be  re- 
-  b  garded  as  of  aquatic  habits ;  whilst  another  present- 
ed a  light,  slender,  graceful  form,  with  much  of  the 
contour  of  the  Gazelle ;  and  was  probably  a  fleet 
and  active  inhabitant  of  the  dry  land,  like  the 
Antelopes  and  Deer.  Others,  again,  seem  to  have 
had  the  size,  form,  and  habits  of  the  Chevrotains. 
299.  We  next  pass  on  to  the  group  of  SOLID- 
UNGULA, distinguished  by  the  complete  consoli- 
dation of  the  toes,  so  that  there  is  only  one  set 
FIG.  167.  FOOT  OP  °^  phalangeal  and  metacarpal  (or  metatarsal) 
HORSE;  t, tibia;  ta,  bones  in  each  foot ;  and  the  extremity  is  included 

fa',  bones  of  tarsus;  .  .     _  .  *  , 

c,  metatarsal,  or  in  a  single  large  hoof.    Occasionally,  however,  the 

spiint-bone*       &>'  Presence  °f  other  toes  is  indicated  ;  for  the  pha- 

pt,  phaiangeai     langes  and  metacarpal  bones  are  sometimes  partly, 

or  even  completely  divided,  into  two ;    and  the 


334  FAMILY    EQUID^E  ; HORSE. 

rudiments  of  another  toe  are  present  on  either  side  as  splint- 
bones  (§  254),  thus  making  four  in  all.  This  is  one  of  the 
monstrosities  or  irregular  formatioi.s,  which  often  enables  us  to 
determine  the  real  nature  of  an  organ,  when  its  character  has 
been  so  changed  as  to  obscure  it.  The  group  of  single-hoofed 
Pachyderms  contains  only  one  family,  the  EQUHXE,  or  Horse 
tribe  ;  and  the  members  of  this  resemble  each  other  so  closely, 
as  to  render  it  almost  doubtful  whether  they  ought  not  to  be 
all  arranged  under  the  same  genus.  They  all  agree  in 
their  dentition,  possessing  six  incisors  in  each  jaw,  and 
six  molars  above  and  below  on  either  side;  the  molars  have 
square  crowns,  with  crescentic  ridges  of  enamel.  The  males 
have  also  two  small  canines  in  the  upper  jaw,  and  sometimes  in 
both  ;  these  are  wanting  in  the  female.  Between  the  canines 
and  the  first  molar,  there  is  a  wide  space,  corresponding  with 
the  angle  of  the  lips;  it  is  in  this  that  the  lit  is  placed,  by  which 
alone  Man  has  been  able  to  subdue  these  powerful  quadrupeds. 

300.  The  Horse  is  thought  by  some  to  deserve  to  rank  as  a 
genus  distinct  from  the  Ass,  Zebra,  &c. ;  on  account  of  the 
entire  tail  being  covered  with  long  hair,  instead  of  the  tip  only  ; 
and  also  because  the  colour  of  the  hair  which  clothes  the  body 
has  a  tendency  to  vary  in  spots  or  patches,  instead  of  in  stripes. 
But  these  are  differences  which,  in  other  families,  would  not  be 
thought  to  separate  even  species  very  widely.  Our  ignorance  of 
the  original  stock  of  the  Horse  prevents  this  question  from  being 
positively  determined.  It  was  domesticated  at  a  very  early 
period,  and  was  used  especially  in  war  and  on  state  occasions. 
The  Egyptians  are  usually  believed  to  have  been  its  first  tamers, 
on  account  of  the  mention  made  of  the  Horse,  as  taken  in  ex- 
change by  Joseph  for  the  corn  which  he  sold*  ;  but  as  we  subse- 
quently readt  of  Horses  as  possessed  and  used  in  war  by  the 
Canaanitish  nations,  the  domestication  of  the  race  must  have 
been  extensive,  even  in  those  remote  times.  As  far  back  as  the 
records  of  profane  history  conduct  us,  we  find  the  Scythians 
possessed  of  Horses,  and  celebrated  as  Horsemen ;  and  when 
Caesar  invaded  Britain,  he  found  himself  opposed  by  horsemen 

*  Genesis,  xlvii.  17.  t  Joshua,  xi.  4. 


FAMILY    EQUIPS  ; — HORSE,    ASS,  DZIGGUETAI.  335 

and  chariots.  Hence  we  have  no  power  of  ascertaining  what  was 
the  original  country  of  the  Horse.  The  races  that  are  now  run- 
ning wild  through  the  plains  of  Tartary,  are  almost  certainly 
descendants  of  animals  that  have  been  in  a  state  of  subjugation  ; 
for  their  habits  closely  correspond  with  those  of  the  wild  horses 
which  now  abound  in  the  Pampas  of  South  America,  and  which 
have  descended  from  the  domesticated  individuals  introduced  into 
that  continent  by  the  Spaniards,  at  the  time  of  their  invasion  of 
it.  They  live  in  troops,  which  are  led  by  an  old  male;  and 
when  attacked,  they  put  the  females  and  colts  in  the  rear,  and 
make  a  vigorous  resistance  by  kicking  with  the  hind  legs.  They 
are  fleet  and  hardy;  but  by  no  means  remarkable  for  beauty.  The 
influence  of  domestication  in  modifying  the  habits  of  the  Horse, 
is  remarkably  shown  by  the  fact — which  rests  on  good  authority, 
— that  it  may  be  brought  to  eat  meat,  though  naturally  as 
exclusively  herbivorous  as  any  animal ;  and  this  diet  is  said  to 
excite  an  unusual  degree  of  spirit  and  mettle,  and  to  enable  it 
better  to  sustain  fatigue. 

301.  The  Ass  appears  to  have  been  domesticated  before  the 
Horse  ;  and  it  was,  as  it  still  is  in  many  parts  of  the  East,  the 
beast  usually  ridden  in  civil  life ;  the  Horse  being  employed 
almost  exclusively  for  war.  "When  treated  with  care,  attention, 
and  kindness,  its  appearance  and  manners  are  very  different  from 
those  of  the  serviceable,  but  undervalued  and  neglected  beast  of 
our  own  country.  It  is  in  Arabia,  Persia,  and  Syria,  that  the 
finest  breeds  of  the  Ass  are  found ;  those  of  Western  Europe  are 
quite  degenerate.  A  fine  race  is  bred  in  Malta.  Several  species 
of  Wild  Ass  have  been  described  as  natives  of  Central  Asia  and 
Africa  ;  but  there  is  much  uncertainty  regarding  them  ;  and  it  is 
not  known  to  which  the  Domesticated  stock  is  to  be  referred,  or 
whether  it  is  derived  from  any  of  them.  It  seems  to  differ  from 
them  all  in  the  mark  which  is  constantly  observed  on  it, — the 
cross  over  its  shoulders. — The  Dzlgguetai  is  one  of  these  species, 
inhabiting  the  greater  part  of  Central  Asia,  and  distinguished  for 
its  fleetness,  which  equals  that  of  a  very  swift  Arabian ;  but  it 
is  not  easily  tamed,  being  vicious  in  temper,  and  kicking  violently 
on  the  most  trifling  provocation. — Of  the  Zebra,  which  is  a 


FIG.  168. — ZEBRA. 


336      FAMILY    EQUID.E  ; ZEBRA,    QUAGGA,    FOSSIL    HORSES. 

native  of  Southern  Africa,  two  species  are  known  ;  one  of  which 
is  an  inhabitant  of  the  mountains,  and  the  other  of  the  plains. 

They  are  both  very 
handsome  and  swift- 
footed  animals  ;  but  are 
not  easily  tamed,  their 
temper  resembling  that 
of  the  last-named  species. 
They  live  in  troops  ; 
and,  from  the  boldness 
of  their  markings,  they 
present  a  very  brilliant 
appearance  when  flying 
before  the  hunter. — The 
Quagga  is  an  animal  of 
the  same  country  with 
the  Zebras,  and  resembles 

them  in  habits ;  but  it  is  far  inferior  in  size  and  beauty.  Its 
colours  are  dull,  and  its  stripes  less  distinct. — The  skeletons  of 
all  these  animals  so  nearly  resemble  one  another,  that  they  can- 
not be  distinguished  by  the  comparison  of  a  few  bones ;  so  that 
even  Cuvier  was  at  fault  in  determining  them.  This  circum- 
stance prevents  any  certainty  from  being  attained,  as  to  the 
relationship  between  the  fossil  remains,  which  have  been  found 
abundantly  in  the  newer  tertiary  strata,  and  the  species  now 
existing.  By  some  it  has  been  supposed  that  the  original 
stock  of  our  domesticated  race  is  to  be  traced  among  these 
remains.  At  any  rate  it  is  certain,  that  very  numerous  animals 
of  the  Horse  tribe  must  have  formerly  peopled  Britain,  as  well 
as  the  continent  of  Europe ;  roaming  over  its  pastures,  and  pro- 
bably climbing  its  hill-sides,  when  its  forests  were  tenanted  by 
the  gigantic  Elephant,  its  jungles  by  enormous  Tigers,  its  marshes 
by  the  massive  Rhinoceros,  its  caves  by  the  savage  Hyaena,  and 
its  rivers  and  lakes  by  the  unwieldy  Hippopotamus. 

302.  We  have  now  considered  the  groups  usually  arranged 
under  the  order  Pachydermata ;  and  it  might  seem  that  the 
space  between  these  and  the  Whale-like  animals — destitute  of 


AQUATIC  PACHYDERMATA; — DINOTHEKIUM.  337 

hind-feet,  living  entirely  in  the  water,  and  having  the  form  of 
the  whole  body  modified  for  an  aquatic  residence — is  too  wide  to 
allow  them  to  be  placed  in  the  same  order.  But  here,  as  else- 
where, the  space  appears  to  be  filled  up  by  fossil  species ;  the 
conformation  of  whose  bones  affords  characters  sufficiently  deci- 
sive, to  permit  their  general  structure  and  habits  to  be  inferred 
with  tolerable  certainty,  from  the  consideration  of  even  a  small 
part  of  the  entire  skeleton.  Before  proceeding  to  these,  however, 
it  may  be  remarked  that  there  is  a  much  nearer  connection 
between  the  existing  species  of  ordinary  Pachyderms  and  the 
family  of  MANATIDJS,  than  might  be  supposed  from  their  form 
alone.  It  has  been  already  remarked  that,  in  those  species 
which  approach  the  Ruminants  in  the  division  of  the  feet,  there 
is  an  approach  also  in  the  complexity  of  the  form  of  the  stomach ; 
this  is  particularly  the  case  in  the  Hippopotamus  ;  and  precisely 
the  same  structure  is  found  in  the  Dugong  and  Manatee,  whose 
stomachs  bear  a  very  close  resemblance  to  that  of  the  Hippo- 
potamus. Both  animals  are  adapted  by  their  conformation  and 
habits,  to  food  of  the  same  description ;  but  whilst  the  Hippo- 
potamus usually  quits  the  water  for  its  food,  and  browses  upon 
the  herbage  and  underwood  in  the  neighbourhood,  the  Manatee  is 
confined  to  that  which  grows  on  the  banks  of  the  streams,  or 
beneath  the  surface.  The  shortness  of  the  legs,  too,  in  the  Hip- 
popotamus, prepares  us  for  the  total  disappearance  of  one 
pair  ;  and  the  flattening  of  the  tail  of  the  common  Anoplotherium 
shows  the  tendency  to  the  more  full  development  of  that  organ 
in  the  Manatees.  There  are  other  points  of  resemblance  between 
the  Hippopotamus  and  the  Lamantins,  in  the  structure  and  con- 
tour of  the  skull,  in  the  position  of  the  eyes  and  nostrils,  and  in 
the  thick  and  complete  layer  of  fat  beneath  the  skin  ;  so  that 
the  gap  is  not  really  so  wide  as  it  appears. 

303.  The  remarkable  genus  which  seems  to  connect  the  two, 
has  received  the  name  of  Dinotherium.  The  skull  is  the  only 
part  yet  found ;  and  this  presents  several  extraordinary  characters. 
It  is  more  than  a  yard  long,  the  nasal  portion  being  so  pro- 
longed, as  to  give  the  idea  that  it  bore  a  proboscis ;  a  similar 
conformation,  however,  is  seen  in  the  Dugong,  which  is  destitute 


338       AQUATIC    PACHYDERMATA  ; DINOTHERIUM,    TOXODON. 

of  that  appendage,  having  only  a  large  upper  lip.  The  upper 
jaw  seems  to  have  been  destitute  of  either  incisors  or  canines ; 
but  the  lower  is  armed  with  two  ^normous  tusks,  which,  instead 
of  projecting  upwards  or  forwards,  sweep  downwards  and  curve 
gently  backwards,  having  their  roots  imbedded  in  enormous 
sockets.  The  general  conformation  of  the  skull  bears  so  much 
resemblance  to  that  of  the  Dugong,  as  to  indicate  that  the  Dino- 
therium  must  have  been  exclusively  aquatic  in  its  habits ;  pro- 
bably having  either  the  hind-feet  formed  as  paddles,  like  the  Seal; 
or  being  entirely  destitute  of  these  members.  Its  diet  was  un- 
doubtedly vegetable  ;  and  we  may  conceive  it  to  have  used  its 
tusks  for  tearing  up  strong- fibred  plants,  by  a  rake-like  action, 
from  the  bed  of  the  river,  or  for  anchors  by  which  it  might  moor 
itself  to  the  banks,  or  for  hooks  by  which  it  might  assist  itself  in 
dragging  its  unwieldy  body  (the  length  of  which  was  probably 
not  less  than  eighteen  feet)  out  of  the  water.  Its  remains  have 
been  found  in  fresh- water  deposits,  with  those  of  the  Rhinoceros, 
Tapir,  &c. — Another  genus,  which  has  been  established  from  the 
skull  only,  is  the  Toxodon,  of  which  the  only  remains  at  present 
known  are  contained  in  the  Museum  of  the  College  of  Surgeons, 
London.  This  was  a  large  South  American  animal,  which 
seems  to  have  been  allied  both  to  the  Pachydermata  and 
Rodentia,  and  to  have  had  the  dimensions  of  the  Hippopotamus, 
though  perhaps  still  more  adapted  for  aquatic  habits. 

304.  Some  remains  of  gigantic  Pachyderms,  that  seem  to 
have  been  intermediate  between  the  Mastodon  and  the  Dinothe- 
rium,  have  been  recently  brought  from  Australia,  in  some  parts  of 
which  they  are  said  to  abound.  "  They  tell  us  plainly,"  says 
Professor  Owen,  "  that  the  time  was,  when  Australia's  arid 
plains  were  trodden  by  the  hoofs  of  heavy  Pachyderms ;  but 
could  the  land  have  then  been,  as  now,  parched  by  long-continued 
droughts,  with  dry  river- courses,  containing  here  and  there  a 
pond  of  water  ?  All  the  facts  and  analogies  which  throw  light 
on  the  habits  of  the  extinct  Mastodons  and  Dinotheres,  indicate 
these  creatures  to  have  been  frequenters  of  marshes,  swamps,  or 
lakes.  Other  relations  of  land  and  sea  than  now  characterise  the 
southern  hemisphere,  a  different  condition  of  the  surface  of  the 


FAMILY  MANATID^E; — DUGONG,  MANATEE.  339 

land  and  of  the  meteoric  influences  governing  the  proportion  and 
distribution  of  fresh  water  on  that  surface,  may  therefore  be  con- 
jectured to  have  prevailed,  when  huge  Mastodontoid  Pachyderms 
constituted  part  of  the  quadruped  population  of  Australia ;  and 
a  change  from  a  humid  climate  to  the  present  particularly  dry 
one,  may  have  been  the  cause,  or  chief  cause,  of  the  extinction 
of  the  race." 

305.  The  family  MANATID^E  or  Dugong  tribe,  has  been 
usually  associated,  as  already  stated  more  than  once,  with  the 
order  Cetacea ;  but  the  animals  composing  it  differ  almost  as 
much  from  the  true  Whales,  as  a  herbivorous  from  a  carnivorous 
Quadruped.  In  their  fishlike  form,  the  absence  of  hinder  limbs 
and  pelvis,  the  conversion  of  the  anterior  extremities  into  paddles, 
the  prolonged  and  horizontally-flattened  tail,  the  nakedness 
and  oiliness  of  the  skin,  and  other  points  of  adaptation  to  the 
life  and  habits  of  a  Fish,  the  two  groups  agree  (Fig.  59)  ;  and 
it  is  interesting  to  observe,  how  completely  the  same  objects  are 
attained  by  similar  means,  in  both  cases.  But  the  food  of  the 
Dugong  and  its  allies  entirely  differs  from  that  of  the  Whales ; 
and  all  the  parts  of  the  structure,  immediately  concerned  in  the 
reception  and  application  of  it,  vary  in  a  corresponding  manner. 
The  molar  teeth  are  formed  upon  the  same  plan  with  those  of 
the  aquatic  Pachyderms,  and  are  obviously  adapted  to  reduce 
the  submarine  vegetables,  which  are  hooked  up  by  means  of 
the  tusk-like  incisors.  The  curious  provision  which  the  true 
Whales  possess,  for  causing  a  large  quantity  of  water  to  pass 
through  their  mouths,  that  they  may  strain  out,  as  it  were,  the 
small  animals  it  contains  (§  209),  is  here  altogether  wanting. 
And  the  stomach,  instead  of  being  simple  in  structure,  and  of 
moderate  size,  is  large  and  divided  into  sacs.  Only  a  few  species 
of  this  family  are  known. — The  Dugong r,  or  Halicore^  is  a  native 
of  the  Indian  Seas,  being  common  among  the  islands  of  the  Indian 
Archipelago,  and  visiting  also  the  coasts  of  New  Holland.  It 
especially  frequents  the  mouths  of  rivers  and  shallow  waters ;  and 
it  is  pursued  on  account  of  its  flesh,  which  is  tender  and  not  unlike 
beef.  Its  length  is  about  seven  or  eight  feet.  Another  species 
inhabits  the  Red  Sea. — The  Manatee,  or  Lamantin,  inhabits  the 

z2 


340       MANATEE,    ZEUGLODON. — OVO-VIVIPAROUS   MAMMALIA. 

mouths  of  the  rivers  opening  on  the  north  and  north-east  of  South 
America,  and  the  coast  of  Mexico ;  it  measures  six  or  seven  feet 
in  length  ;  and  its  paddles  exhibit  rudiments  of  nails,  by  the  aid 
of  which  the  animal  sometimes  drags  its  unwieldly  body  on  shore, 
and  crawls  up  the  banks,  either  to  bask  in  the  sun,  or  to  seek 
for  terrestrial  vegetables.  Another  species  is  found  on  the 
western  coast  of  Africa ;  and  a  third  along  the  shores  of  some 
parts  of  North  America. — Some  fossil  teeth  have  been  discovered 
in  America,  which  are  regarded  by  Professor  Owen  as  having 
belonged  to  an  animal  of  this  family,  to  which  he  has  given  the 
name  of  Zeuglodon.  This  name,  which  means  yoked-toothed, 
was  suggested  by  their  distinguishing  peculiarity, — the  form  of 
the  posterior  molars,  which  resemble  two  teeth  tied  or  yoked 
together. 


SUB-CLASS  II.— OVO-VIVIPAROUS  MAMMALIA. 

306.  The  general  character  by  which  the  animals  of  this  divi- 
sion are  distinguished  from  the  true  Mammalia  have  been  already 
explained  (§  118);  and  it  has  been  shown  that  these  are  of  suffi- 
cient importance,  to  require  that  the  several  species  which  agree 
in  it,  should  be  associated  together  in  a  separate  group ;  even 
although  they  differ  considerably  from  one  another,  in  the  nature 
of  their  food,  and  in  the  conformation  of  those  organs  by  which 
it  is  obtained  and  digested.  Thus  we  find,  in  some  members  of 
this  sub-class,  an  opposable  thumb,  as  perfect  as  that  of  many 
Quadrumana ;  in  others,  a  set  of  teeth  and  sharp  claws,  obviously 
adapted  to  a  Carnivorous  regimen ;  in  others,  again,  the  general 
organisation  of  the  Insectivora ;  in  others,  an  approach  to  the 
peculiar  conformation  of  the  Rodentia;  and  in  others,  the  com- 
plete absence  of  teeth,  which  characterises  the  true  Edentata. 
Hence  some  Naturalists  have  been  disposed  to  arrange  these 
several  animals  under  the  Orders,  to  which  they  would  be  referred 
by  the  characters  just  adverted  to;  forgetting  that  they  are 
distinguished  from  these  by  characters  of  far  higher  importance, 
— those  relating  to  the  structure  of  the  brain ;  which  correspond, 


OVO- VIVIPAROUS    MAMMALIA.  341 

on  one  hand,  with  the  degree  of  intelligence  manifested  by  the 
animal ;  and,  on  the  other,  with  the  manner  in  which  the  pro- 
cess of  reproduction  is  carried  on  in  them.  For  in  the  brain  of 
Birds,  whose  early  development  receives  little  assistance  from  the 
parent,  the  great  central  commissures  (Amu.  PHYSIOL.,  §434) 
are  altogether  wanting  ;  whilst  in  the  true  Mammalia,  in  which 
the  embryo  is  sustained  by  a  direct  connection  with  the  parent, 
until  it  has  nearly  acquired  the  perfect  form,  the  two  hemi- 
spheres of  the  brain  are  united  by  transverse  bands,  which 
increase  in  number  and  complexity  as  we  ascend  towards  Man ; 
and  in  the  Ovo- viviparous  Mammalia,  of  which  the  embryo  is 
born  prematurely  (as  it  were),  the  brain  attains  a  character  but 
very  little  higher  than  that  of  Birds,  and  the  intelligence  is 
proportionably  low.  When  it  is  recollected  that  intelligence, 
depending  on  the  high  development  of  the  cerebral  mass,  is  the 
characteristic  feature  of  the  class  Mammalia,  it  becomes  evident 
that  the  group  of  animals,  which  differs  from  the  rest  in  a  pecu- 
liarity so  essential,  should  be  completely  separated  from  them. 
And  it  is  the  less  surprising  that  they  should  differ  among  them- 
selves in  characters  which  are  elsewhere  deemed  important,  since 
we  find  the  same  occurring  in  other  instances ;  the  lower  or  least 
organised  portion  of  a  group  often  presenting  sketches,  as  it  were, 
of  the  very  dissimilar  forms,  which  occur  in  the  several  divisions 
above  it.  Thus  in  the  Radiata,  we  may  trace  adumbrations  or 
shadowings-forth  of  the  Molluscous,  the  Articulated,  and  even 
the  Vertebrated  types ;  and  its  several  members  differ  far  more 
among  each  other  in  form  and  structure,  than  do  the  members  of 
either  of  the  higher  divisions  of  the  Animal  kingdom. 

307.  By  some  of  those  who  have  recently  attended  to  the 
classification  of  this  group,  it  is  regarded  as  containing  but  a 
single  order,  and  is  divided  at  once  into  families ;  but  in 
general  it  is  first  subdivided  into  two  orders,  which  will  be  here 
adopted.  The  first  of  these  contains  the  MARSUPIALIA  or  pouched 
animals,  so  named  on  account  of  the  peculiar  pouch  or  pocket 
which  most  of  them  possess  at  the  lower  part  of  the  abdomen, 
for  receiving  and  protecting  the  young  during  the  period  of 
suckling.  This  pouch  is  supported  by  two  bones,  termed  the 


342       OVO-VIVIPAROUS   MAMMALIA. — ORDER    MARSUPIALIA. 

marsupial  bones,  the  form  and  position  of  which  have  been  already 
described  (§  90).  This  order  comprehends  the  Kangaroos, 
Opossums,  and  other  less  known  animals.  The  second  order, 
— termed  MONOTREMATA,  and  including  only  two  animals  at 
present  known  to  exist,  the  Ornithorhyncus,  and  the  Echidna, — 
receives  its  name  from  a  peculiarity  in  the  structure  of  the 
reproductive  apparatus,  which  shows  its  near  approach  to  the 
class  of  Birds ;  for  the  termination  of  the  oviducts  is  received, 
with  that  of  the  urinary  duct,  and  of  the  intestine,  into  a  canal 
termed  the  cloaca  ;  so  that  there  is  but  a  single  external  orifice 
for  them  both,  instead  of  two,  as  in  all  higher  animals.  There 
are  many  other  points  of  structure,  in  which  this  remarkable 
group  approximates  to  Oviparous  animals ;  some  of  which  will 
be  hereafter  mentioned. 

308.  The  geographical  distribution  of  this  Sub-Class  is  not 
one  of  the  least  curious  parts  of  its  history.  With  the  exception 
of  the  Opossum  family,  which  inhabits  America  (and  was  the 
first  with  which  naturalists  became  acquainted),  the  group  is 
confined  to  Australia,  and  the  nearest  islands  of  the  Indian 
Archipelago,  where  not  less  than  70  species  have  been  found ; 
more  probably  remaining  to  be  discovered.  And  with  the  excep- 
tion of  the  Dingo  Dog,  a  few  Bats  and  Seals,  and  one  or  two 
Rats,  these  are  the  only  Mammalia  known  to  exist  on  the  vast 
Continent  of  New  Holland ;  a  circumstance  which  is  without 
its  parallel  in  the  distribution  of  the  Animal  Kingdom. 


ORDER  XL— MARSUPIALIA. 

309.  From  what  has  been  just  stated,  of  the  varieties  of  con- 
formation which  are  found  in  this  group,  it  will  be  evidently 
necessary  to  proceed  at  once  to  the  description  of  the  families  into 
which  it  is  subdivided ;  as  no  account  can  be  given  of  their 
general  structure  and  habits,  which  shall  be  applicable  to  more 
than  a  small  section  of  the  order.  The  first  family,  DIDELPHIDJE, 
or  Opossum  tribe,  is  restricted  to  America,  and  chiefly  consists  of 


FAMILY    DIDELPHID^:  J — OPOSSUMS. 


343 


the  genus  Dideljrftis,  or  Opossum,  of  which  about  twenty  species 
are  known,  some  of  them  very  small.  The  teeth  are  more  nume- 
rous than  in  any  other  known  terrestrial  Mammal  except  the 
MyrmecoliuS)* — the  increase  being  in  the  number  of  the  incisors, 
which  are  ten  above  and  eight  below,  the  canines  being  (as  usual) 
one  on  each  side  of  either  jaw,  and  the  molars  seven, — the  four 
last,  or  true  molars,  being  crowned  with  sharp  tubercles.  The 
limbs  are  short ;  the  feet  plantigrade  (or  having  the  sole  applied 
to  the  ground)  ;  and  the  toes,  which  are  five  on  each  foot,  armed 
with  sharp,  strong,  curved  claws,  except  the  inner  toe  or  thumb 


Fro.  169. — VTRGINIAN  OPOSSUM. 

on  the  hinder  feet,  which  is  opposable  and  destitute  of  a  nail. 
The  tail  is  scaly  and  naked,  except  at  its  base;  and  is  usually 
more  or  less  prehensile.  In  some  species  the  pouch  is  almost 

*  A  small  shrew-like  Marsupial,  whose  place  seems  to  be  between  the  two  suc- 
ceeding families. 


344  FAMILY    DIDELPn«,.E  ; OPOSSUMS. 

entirely  wanting,  being  indicated  only  by  a  slight  fold  of  skin. 
The  Virginian  Opossum,  which  is  common  in  many  parts  of 
the  southern  states  of  North  AmeTica,  is  one  of  the  largest  and 
most  robust  of  the  genus,  being  about  the  size  of  a  Cat.  It 
resides  in  branches  and  hollows  of  trees,  remaining  inert  during 
the  day,  but  prowling  at  night  in  search  of  its  food,  which 
consists  of  insects,  eggs,  birds,  and  small  reptiles  and  mammalia, 
as  also  of  fruits  and  roots; — sometimes  even  invading  the  precincts 
of  farm-houses,  destroying  poultry,  and  other  domestic  birds.  Its 
movements  on  the  ground  are  slow ;  but  it  climbs  with  great 
facility,  and  can  suspend  itself  from  branches  with  its  tail,  some- 
times gaining  distant  branches  by  a  kind  of  swinging  motion. 
When  alarmed  or  irritated,  it  emits  a  most  disgusting  odour.  In 
captivity  it  is  slothful,  and  becomes  inordinately  fat,  eating  both 
animal  and  vegetable  food  with  voracity;  it  shows  but  little 
intelligence,  and  evinces  great  apathy  with  some  timidity.  The 
female  produces  several  young  at  a  time,  sometimes  as  many  as 
sixteen  ;  and  she  conceals  herself  in  a  thick  nest  of  dry  grass,  in 
some  obscure  retreat.  "When  first  born,  the  young  are  in  a  very 
undeveloped  state,  being  minute,  blind,  naked,  and  shapeless  ; 
but  they  are  always  found  adhering  to  the  teats  of  the  mother, 
protected  by  her  pouch.  There  they  remain  until  they  have 
attained  the  size  of  a  mouse,  which  is  not  until  the  fiftieth  day  ; 
at  this  period  their  eyes  are  opened,  and  their  bodies  are  covered 
with  hair.  They  now  venture  occasionally  from  their  hiding- 
place,  but  return  to  it  on  the  least  appearance  of  danger ;  and  it 
is  not  until  they  have  attained  to  a  considerable  size,  that  they 
finally  withdraw  from  the  care  of  the  parent.  Even  when  they 
no  longer  resort  to  her  pouch  for  protection,  it  is  said  that  they 
jump  on  her  back,  and  twine  their  tails  securely  with  hers ;  so 
that  she  may  carry  them  off  from  the  threatened  danger. — The 
Crab-eating  Opossum  is  common  in  Guiana  and  Brazil ;  it  climbs 
trees  with  facility,  but  runs  badly ;  and  prefers  marshy  situations, 
where  it  feeds  upon  crabs,  but  also  attacks  small  birds  and 
reptiles,  and  will  eat  insects. — Several  of  the  South  American 
species  are  very  small,  and  are  quite  insectivorous  in  their  habits ; 
so  much  resembling  the  Shrews  in  size  and  general  appearance,  as 


FAMILY    DIDELPHnXE; CHEIRONECTES.  345 

to  have  been  mistaken  for  them  :  others  are  about  the  size,  and 
have  the  appearance  and  habits,  of  the  Rat. — The  only  other  genus 


FIG.  170. — CRAB-EATING  OPOSSUM. 

included  in  the  family  of  Didelphid»,  is  the  Cheironectes,  or 
Yapock,  an  inhabitant  of  the  smaller  streams  and  rivers  of  Brazil 
and  Guiana.  This  interesting  animal  bears  a  strong  general  resem- 
blance to  the  Otter,  but  is  much  smaller.  It  is  incapable  of  climbing, 
but  lives  in  holes  along  the  banks  of  the  rivers  it  frequents ;  and 
it  is  provided  with  cheek-pouches,  in  which  it  stows  away  the 
food  it  obtains  in  the  stream,  consisting  of  fresh- water  Crustacea, 
the  larvae  of  insects,  the  spawn  of  fishes,  &c.  In  this  genus  we 
do  not  find  an  opposable  thumb  on  either  foot ;  and  the  toes  of 
the  hind-feet  are  webbed.  It  differs  from  the  Opossums  also,  in 


346 


FAMILY   DA8YURID.E; — URSINE   DASYURUS. 


the  number  of  molars,  which   are   only  five   on   each   side  of 
either  jaw. 


FIG.  171.— CHEIBONECTUS  OR  YAPOCK. 

310.  If  we  regard  the  Opossums  as  representing  the  Quad- 
rumana  among  the  Ovo- viviparous  Mammalia,  we  shall  find  still 
more  analogy  between  the  next  family,  DASYURID^E,  or  Ursine 
Opossums,  and  the  Carnivora :  this  analogy  is  shown  in  the 
structure  of  the  teeth  and  digestive  organs,  and  also  in  the  habits 
of  the  animals  themselves,  as  is  sufficiently  indicated  by  the 
names,  hycena,  wild-cat,  bear,  devil,  &c.,  which  are  given  to  the 
several  species  by  the  colonists  of  Australia,  where  alone  they 
occur.  As  an  example  of  this  family,  we  may  notice  the  Dasyu- 
rus  ur sinus,  or  Ursine  (bear-like)  Dasyurus,  a  native  of  Van 
Diemens  land,  not  unlike  the  Badger  in  shape,  and  having  the 
gait  of  a  Bear.  It  is  a  stupid,  voracious  animal,  which  conceals 
itself  in  burrows  or  holes  in  the  ground  during  the  day ;  issuing 
forth  at  night  in  search  of  its  food,  which  appears  to  be  entirely 
of  an  animal  nature.  The  flocks  and  domestic  poultry  of  the 
colonists  suffer  considerably  from  its  ravages.  The  teeth  resemble 
those  of  the  Opossum  in  their  general  aspect;  but  differ  in  having 
only  eight  incisors  in  the  upper  jaw  and  six  in  the  lower ;  and 
also  in  the  number  of  the  molars,  which  are  six  instead  of  seven. 


DASYURUS,    THYLACINUS. FAMILY   PERAMELID^.         347 

Their  form,  too,  is  more  decidedly  carnivorous ;  the  individual 
teeth  being  by  no  means  unlike  those  of  the  Dog.  The  limbs 
are  short,  robust,  and  clumsy  ;  and  the  toes,  five  on  the  fore-feet, 
and  four  on  the  hind,  are  armed  with  sharp  claws,  which  the 
animal  can  use  for  burrowing,  as  well  as  for  seizing  its  prey.  Its 
voice  is  a  hollow  barking  growl.  "When  in  captivity,  it  displays 
no  quality  but  a  stupid  ferocity,  and  seems  ready  to  bite  at  the 
least  irritation;  it  does  not  appear  in  the  least  influenced  by 
kind  treatment,  not  even  showing  any  recognition  of  its  keepers, 
or  of  those  who  habitually  feed  it. — In  other  species  of  this 
genus,  there  is  a  stronger  resemblance  to  the  Dog  and  Weasel, 
and  greater  activity  in  the  habits. — The  ThylacinuS)  also  a  native 
of  Van  Diemen's  Land,  has  the  stature  and  habits  of  a  Wolf; 
and  would  prove  a  very  destructive  animal,  if  it  were  not  for  its 
rarity.  It  inhabits  the  caverns  and  fissures  of  therocks,  in  the  deep 
and  almost  impenetrable  glens  of  the  highest  mountains ;  and, 
like  many  others  of  this  group,  it  is  nocturnal  in  its  habits.  It 
seems  to  have  the  power  of  over-mastering  all  the  native  quadru- 
peds of  Australia,  managing  to  eat  even  the  Echidna  or  porcu- 
pine ant-eater;  and  it  is  very  destructive  to  the  sheep  in  its 
neighbourhood.  Owing  to  its  back  being  crossed  by  a  regular 
series  of  black  stripes,  it  has  received  from  the  Colonists  the 
names  of  Zebra- Wolf  and  Zebra- Opossum ;  and  has  also  been 
called  the  Tiger  and  Hyaena. 

311.  The  animals  of  the  next  family,  PERAMELIDJE,  or  the 
Bandicoot  tribe,  are  evidently  analogous  to  the  Insectivora,  and 
take  the  place  in  Australia  of  the  Shrews,  Tenrecs,  &c.  of  the 
Old  World.  In  number  of  teeth,  they  approach  the  Opossums, 
but  have  only  six  instead  of  eight  incisors  in  the  lower  jaw ; 
the  form  of  the  teeth,  however,  is  more  decidedly  insectivorous. 
The  general  form  of  the  Bandicoots  is  Rabbit-like,  the  hind 
legs  being  much  longer  than  the  fore,  and  the  gait  being  inter- 
mediate between  running  and  jumping ;  moreover  they 
resemble  Rabbits  in  the  use  they  make  of  their  fore-paws  in 
burrowing,  and  in  holding  their  food,  when  they  sit  up  on 
their  haunches.  The  form  of  the  muzzle,  however,  is  different ; 
for  this  is  elongated,  narrow,  and  pointed,  the  nose  advancing 


348  FAMILY    MACROPODUXE  ; KANGAROOS. 

considerably  beyond  the  jaw.  Notwithstanding  the  insectivo- 
rous form  of  the  teeth,  it  appears  from  the  accounts  of  the  colo- 
nists, that  these  animals  feed  in  great  part  upon  roots,  and  that 
they  are  very  destructive  to  the  potato-crops,  as  also  to  the 
corn  when  housed  in  granaries.  It  is  probable  that  there  may 
be  a  difference  in  this  respect  among  the  several  species,  which 
are  numerous,  one  of  them  inhabiting  New  Guinea. 

312.  The  family  MACROPODID.E  (long-footed),  or  Kangaroo 
tribe,  receives  its  name  from  the  enormous  length  of  the  foot, 
which  is  the  distinguishing  characteristic  of  the  posterior  extre- 
mity, in  all  the  animals  it  includes.  The  anterior  members  are 
small  and  comparatively  feeble ;  but  the  posterior,  together 
with  the  tail,  attain  a  degree  of  development,  to  which  we  do 
not  see  an  approach  in  any  other  animal,  except  in  the  Jerboa 
and  some  others  of  the  Rodentia.  In  their  ordinary  position, 

these  animals  sit  nearly 
erect  upon  their  haunches, 
the  head  and  shoulders  being 
elevated  and  slightly  in- 
clined forwards;  and  the 
weight  of  the  body  is  coun- 
terpoised by  that  of  the  tail, 
which  is  of  enormous  size, 
and  serves  at  the  same  time 
to  balance  and  support  it. 

FIG.  172.— KANGAROO.  rp,       f  , 

Ihe  form  and  arrangement 

of  the  teeth,  and  the  conformation  of  the  stomach,  remind  us  of 
the  order  Ruminantia ;  to  which  this  family,  being  exclusively 
herbivorous  in  its  diet,  bears  no  inconsiderable  analogy.  The 
canines  are  entirely  wanting,  and  there  are  only  two  incisors  in 
the  lower  jaw,  whilst  there  are  six  in  the  upper ;  the  molars 
are  five  on  each  side,  and  have  a  roughened  surface,  which  is 
given  by  a  vertical  plate  of  enamel  surrounding  a  centre  of  bone. 
The  stomach  is  very  large,  and  is  divided  into  distinct  sacculi ; 
and  the  Kangaroo  appears  occasionally  (though  not  regularly) 
to  perform  a  true  rumination,  which  it  does  in  the  erect  atti- 
tude. "When  feeding,  it  assumes  a  crouching  position,  resting 


FAMILY    MACROPODIDJ2  ; KANGAROOS.  349 

on  its  fore-paws,  as  well  as  on  the  hinder  extremities,  whilst  it 
browses  on  the  herbage ;  and  in  this  attitude  it  hops  gently 
along,  deriving  some  assistance  from  its  tail.  On  the  least 
alarm,  however,  it  raises  itself  on  its  hind  legs,  and  bounds 
away  to  a  distance  with  great  rapidity.  The  leap  is  of  very 
great  length ;  and  is  accomplished  by  the  muscular  action  of 
the  tail,  almost  as  much  as  by  that  of  the  limbs  (ANIM.  PHY- 
SIOL.,  §  661).  Sometimes  the  old  male  of  the  Great  Kangaroo, 


Fro.  173.— SKELETON  OF  KANGAROO. 

when  excited,  stands  on  tiptoe,  and  on  his  tail,  the  three  extre- 
mities forming  a  tripod ;  and  is  then  of  prodigious  height.  The 
great  length  of  the  hind  foot  is  chiefly  given  by  the  elongation 
of  its  metatarsal  bones ;  it  possesses  four  toes,  of  which  the  two 
inner  ones  are  very  small,  and  compacted  together  so  as  to 
appear  like  one ;  the  third  or  middle  toe  is  large  and  powerful, 
and  armed  with  a  strong  hoof-like  nail ;  the  fourth  or  external 
toe  is  smaller  than  the  middle  one,  but  is  larger  than  the  two 
inner  ones  together,  and  it  also  has  a  large  hoof-like  nail.  These 
defences  make  the  foot  a  very  powerful  weapon  ;  a  single  blow 
from  it  being  often  sufficient  to  kill  a  dog.  The  under  side  of 
the  foot  has  a  callous  sole  along  its  whole  length.  The  fore- 
paws  have  five  toes  armed  with  sharp  claws ;  they  enjoy  consider- 
able freedom  of  motion,  the  clavicles  being  well  developed ;  and 
they  are  used  by  the  animal  for  a  great  variety  of  purposes. 
They  even  aid  the  Kangaroo  in  its  defence ;  for  it  will  sometimes 


350  FAMILY    MACROPODIDJ2  ; KANGAROOS. 

clasp  them  around  its  antagonist,  and  hug  it  to  death,  or  hold  it 
beneath  the  surface  of  the  nearest  water  until  it  is  drowned. 

313.  A  considerable  number  Oi  species  of  this  group,  differ- 
ing in  size,  but  bearing  a  strong  resemblance  to  each  other  in 
form  and  habits,  have  been  discovered  in  New  Holland,  Van 
Diemen's  Land,  and  New  Guinea.  The  largest  at  present 
known  is  the  Great  Kangaroo^  which  is  very  extensively  dif- 
fused through  the  two  former  countries,  preferring  the  low 
grassy  hills  and  plains  skirted  by  thin  open  forests  of  brushwood, 
to  which  it  resorts  for  shelter  from  the  oppressive  heat  of  the 
mid-day  sun ;  but  it  is  also  found  on  the  bleak  and  even  snow- 
capped summits  of  mountains.  The  male,  which  greatly  exceeds 
the  female  in  size,  has  been  known  to  measure  nearly  eight  feet 
from  the  nose  to  the  extremity  of  the  tail  (the  length  of  the 
latter  being  three  feet)  ;  and  to  weigh  220  Ibs.  The  other 
species,  however,  are  much  smaller.  The  young  are  produced 
in  an  extremely  imperfect  state.  One  which  was  examined 
twelve  hours  after  birth,  is  thus  described  by  Mr.  Owen.  "  It 
resembled  an  earth-worm  in  the  colour  and  semi-transparency  of 
its  integument,  adhered  firmly  to  the  point  of  the  nipple,  breathed 
strongly,  but  slowly,  and  moved  its  fore-legs  when  disturbed.  Its 
body  was  bent  upon  the  abdomen,  its  short  tail  tucked  in  between 
the  hind-legs,  which  were  one-third  shorter  than  the  fore-legs. 
The  whole  length  from  the  nose  to  the  end  of  the  tail  when 
stretched  out,  did  not  exceed  one  inch  and  two  lines.*"  In  this 
condition  it  is  not  able  to  suck  the  milk  from  the  teat  of  its 
parent ;  but  the  mammary  gland  of  the  Kangaroo  is  acted  on  by 
a  peculiar  muscle,  which  presses  the  fluid  from  it  into  the  mouth 
of  the  young  animal.  The  embryo  (for  such  it  must  be  still 
considered)  continues  to  increase  by  sustenance  derived  exclu- 
sively from  the  mother,  for  a  period  of  eight  months  ;  but  it  then 
begins  to  protrude  its  head  occasionally  from  the  orifice  of  the 
pouch,  and  to  crop  the  grass  at  the  same  time  that  the  mother  is 
browsing.  Having  thus  acquired  additional  strength,  it  quits 
the  pouch,  and  hops  at  first  with  a  feeble  and  vacillating  gait  ; 
but  it  continues  to  return  to  the  pouch  for  occasional  shelter  and 
supplies  of  food,  until  it  has  attained  the  weight  of  10  Ibs. — 


KANGAROO-RAT. FAMILY    PHALANGISTID^E.  351 

There  is  another  genus  belonging  to  this  family,  that  of  Hypsi- 
prymnus^  including  the  Potoroos^  or  Kangaroo-Rats^  of  which 
several  species  are  known  in  Australia.  They  chiefly  differ  from 
the  Kangaroos,  in  possessing  canine  teeth  in  the  upper  jaw ;  but 
in  other  respects  bear  a  close  resemblance  to  them.  They 
present,  however,  a  nearer  approach  to  the  Rodentia,  both  in 
their  dentition  and  habits ;  for  the  foremost  pair  of  incisors  in 
the  upper  jaw  are  larger  and  considerably  longer  than  the  rest, 
and  meet  the  large  incisors  of  the  lower  jaw  ;  whilst  with  their 
long  and  powerful  fore-claws,  they  are  continually  scratching  the 
ground  for  roots,  feeding  rather  upon  these  than  upon  herbage. 
They  are  all  of  small  size  ;  the  largest  having  the  dimensions  of 
a  Rabbit. 

314.  The  family  PHALANGISTID^E,  or  Phalangers,  are  nearly 
allied  to  the  Kangaroos  in  the  conformation  of  the  head  and 
teeth ;  but  they  more  resemble  the  Opossums  in  general  struc- 
ture and  habits,  and  may  be  considered  as  representing  those 
animals  in  Australia  and  the  islands  of  the  Indian  Archipelago, 
in  which  they  are  found.  They  are  nocturnal  in  their  habits, 
and  live  among  trees,  being  expert  climbers.  Their  food 
consists  principally  of  fruits,  buds,  leaves,  &c. ;  but  they  will 
also  eat  insects  and  eggs,  and  even  cooked  meat  when  offered 
them.  They  agree  with  the  Opossums,  also,  in  having  a  large 
opposable  thumb  ou  the  hind-feet ;  but  they  have  only  six 
incisors  in  the  upper  jaw,  with  two  in  the  lower,  as  in  the 
Kangaroo ;  canines  in  the  upper  jaw  only,  as  in  the  Kan- 
garoo-rat ;  and  five  regular  molars,  with  small  additional  ones 
between  these  and  the  canine  teeth  in  some  species.  The  tail  is 
prehensile,  and  the  Phalangers  will  sometimes  remain  suspended 
by  it  for  a  considerable  time ;  and,  like  the  Opossums,  they 
emit  a  very  disagreeable  odour  when  alarmed.  They  are  covered 
with  a  very  soft  and  delicate  woolly  fur.  A  considerable  number 
of  species  are  known,  the  largest  of  which  is  of  about  the  size  of 
a  Wild  Cat.—  Besides  the  true  Phalangista  or  Phalangers^  this 
family  includes  the  Petaurus  or  Flying  Phalanger;  an  animal 
which  bears  the  same  relationship  to  the  true  Phalanger,  as  the 
Flying  Squirrel  does  to  the  ordinary  Squirrel.  The  skin  of  the 


352 


FAMILY   PHALANGISTID.E  ; PETAURU8,    KOALA. 


body  is  extended  between  the  anterior  and  posterior  limbs  on 
each  side,  for  some  distance  beyond  the  flanks ;  and  serves  as  a 
parachute,  by  which  the  animal  cai  partially  sustain  itself  when 
taking  leaps  of  great  length.  Its  aerial  evolutions,  when  roused 
to  activity  by  the  shades  of  evening,  are  said  to  be  peculiarly 
graceful.  It  seems  to  have  the  power  of  altering  the  course  of 
its  movements,  while  suspended  in  the  air,  so  as  to  alight  on  the 
desired  spot.  It  is  destitute  of  the  prehensile  tail  of  the  true 
Phalangers ;  and  seems  to  be  endowed  with  these  wing-like 
appendages,  by  way  of  compensation. — The  Phascolarctos  or 
Koala  is  a  third  form  belonging  to  this  family.  It  is  a'stoutly- 
made  animal,  with  robust  limbs  and  powerful  claws,  but  entirely 
destitute  of  tail.  The 
fore-feet  have  each 
five  toes,  of  which 
two  are  opposed 
to  the  other  three, 
— a  solitary  in- 
stance among  Mam- 
malia ;  but  in  the 
hind-feet  this  power 
does  not  exist,  al- 
though the  thumb 
is  separated  from 
the  rest.  This  ani- 
mal lives  chiefly 
among  trees,  and 
feeds  upon  fruits ; 

and  in  passing  along  the  branches,  it  suspends  itself  by  its  claws, 
beneath  their  lower  side,  in  the  manner  of  a  Sloth.  It  also  visits 
the  ground,  however,  and  there  burrows  with  facility ;  and  it  is 
said  to  lie  dormant  beneath  it  during  the  cold  season.  The  young 
one,  when  it  leaves  the  pouch,  clings  to  the  back  of  the  parent 
for  some  time.  By  the  colonists  this  animal  is  usually  termed 
the  native  Bear  or  Monkey. 

315.     The  last  family,  that  of  the  PHASCOLOMYID^E,  at  present 
contains  only  a  single  species,  the  Phascolomys  or  Wombat,  which 


FIG.  174. — PHASCOLARCTOS  OR  KOALA. 


FAMILY    PHASCOLOMYID^E  ; WOMBAT.  353 

is  evidently  a  representative  of  the  order  Rodentia.  The  in- 
cisors are  two  in  number  in  each  jaw ;  they  are  hollow  at 
the  base,  and  continue  to  grow  as  they  are  worn  away ;  as  do 
also  the  five  molar  teeth  on  either  side.  It  is  a  clumsy-looking 
animal,  having  short  stout  limbs  and  a  blunt  muzzle  ;  it  burrows 
deeply  in  the  ground,  feeding  on  roots  and  hard  vegetable  sub- 
stances ;  and  is  nocturnal  in  its  habits.  Its  temper  is  usually 
placid,  but  it  will  show  considerable  snappishness  when  pro- 
voked ;  and  its  intelligence  seems  extremely  low. 

316.  Fossil  remains  of  several  species  of  Marsupials  have 
been  found  in  the  bone-caves  of  Australia,  in  which  country 
their  occurrence  might  be  fairly  anticipated.  But  there  is 
evidence  that  this  order  was  formerly  diffused  more  widely  over 
the  globe,  than  it  is  at  present ;  for  remains  of  animals  which 
unquestionably  belonged  to  it,  have  been  found  in  Europe,  and 
even  in  our  own  country.  Bones  of  an  Opossum  were  found 
by  Cuvier  in  the  gypsum  beds  of  Montmartre  (near  Paris)  ;  and 
portions  of  the  lower  jaw  of  two  Opossum-like  animals  have  been 
discovered  in  the  oolite  of  Stonesfield  in  Oxfordshire.  These 
last  remains  have  given  rise  to  much  discussion  ;  some  eminent 
Anatomists  having  maintained  that  they  are  not  the  remains  of 
Mammals  at  all,  but  of  animals  of  the  Reptile  class.  But  the 
question  may  now  be  considered  as  finally  settled  ;  since  the 
examination  of  the  microscopic  structure  of  the  teeth  has  shown, 
that  it  corresponds  exactly  with  that  of  other  Marsupials,  and 
differs  entirely  from  that  of  any  Reptiles.  It  is  extremely 
interesting  to  remark,  that  these  remains  occur  in  strata  much 
lower  (and  therefore  older)  than  those  in  which  any  other 
remains  of  Mammalia  are  found ;  whence  it  may  be  concluded, 
that  the  Ovo-viviparous  sub-class  was  called  into  existence  at  an 
earlier  period  in  the  history  of  the  Globe,  than  that  at  which  the 
true  Mammalia  were  created. 


354 


ORDER  XII.— MONOTREMATA. 

317.  The  peculiar  characters  by  which  this  order  is  separated 
from  the  preceding,  have  been  already  noticed  (§  307)  ;  and  it 
now  only  remains,  therefore,  to  describe  the  two  remarkable  ani- 
mals, which  are  its  sole  representatives  at  present  known. — The 
Ornithorhyncus  or  Duck-billed  Platypus^  the  Water  Mole  of  the 
Colonists,  is  peculiar  not  only  in  regard  to  its  internal  structure, 
but  as  to  its  external  aspect.  For  having  the  body  of  an  Otter, 
its  muzzle  is  not  conformed  like  that  of  any  other  Mammal,  but 
is  converted  into  a  bill,  closely  resembling  that  of  a  duck,  being 
broad,  flat,  and  covered  with  a  leathery  membrane.  This  union 
appeared  so  startling  to  the  Naturalists  by  whom  the  stuffed 
specimen  of  the  animal  was  first  inspected,  that  they  imagined 
that  a  clever  deception  must  have  been  practised  ;  the  bill  of  a 


FlG.    175 ORNITHORHYNCrs   PARAPOXfS. 


Bird  having  been  artificially  attached  to  the  skin  of  an  Otter-like 
Quadruped.     This,  however,  was  soon  found  not  to  be  the  case  ; 


V 


ORNITHORHYNCUS.  355 

the  combination  being  one  effected  by  the  hand  of  Nature,  and 
serving  (with  others  of  a  similar  character)  to  draw  together  the 
classes  of  Mammals,  Birds,  and  Reptiles,  which  previously 
appeared  to  be  so  widely  separated.  As  in  Birds,  the  bill 
possesses  no  true  teeth  ;  but  on  each  side  of  either  mandible, 
there  are  two  horny  appendages  without  roots,  of  which  one  is 
large  with  a  rounded  summit,  whilst  the  other  forms  a  long 
narrow  ridge  near  the  anterior  edge  of  the  mandible.  The 
mouth  is  furnished  with  capacious  cheek-pouches.  The  fore-feet 
possess  five  toes,  furnished  with  strong  blunt  burrowing  claws  ; 
and  between  these  a  web  extends,  even  beyond  their  extremities. 
This  web  can  be  folded  back  by  the  animal  aj;  pleasure  ;  and  it 
consequently  presents  no  impediment  in  the  act  of  burrowing. 
The  hind-feet  are  smaller  and  less  powerful  than  the  anterior ; 
they,  too,  have  five  toes,  armed  with  claws,  and  furnished  with  a 
web  ;  but  the  web  does  not  extend  beyond  the  roots  of  the  claws. 
The  hind-feet  are  directed  backwards,  like  those  of  the  Seal ;  and 
they  are  obviously  used  chiefly  for  swimming.  The  foot  of  the 
male  is  armed  with  a  sharp  spur,  resembling  that  of  a  Cock. 
It  does  not  appear,  however,  to  be  used  by  the  animal  as  a  weapon 
of  defence.  J  It  was  formerly  supposed  (but  incorrectly)  to  secrete 
a  poisonous  fluid.  A  rudiment  of  it  is  present  in  the  female. 
The  body  of  the  Ornithorhyncus  is  long  and  flattened,  and  is 
covered  with  a  very  glossy,  closely-set  fur,  resembling  that  of  the 
Mole ;  beneath  this  is  a  layer  of  soft,  short,  waterproof  wadding. 
The  tail  is  strong,  broad,  flattened,  and  of  moderate  length ;  it  is 
covered  above  with  longer  and  coarser  hairs  than  those  of  the 
body,  but  its  under-surface  is  nearly  naked.  The  length  of  the 
whole  animal,  from  the  front  edge  of  its  beak  to  the  tip  of  its 
tail,  is  usually  from  20  to  23  inches. 

318.  The  whole  structure  of  this  singular  animal  proclaims 
its  aquatic  habits  ;  and  these  are  very  much  what  we  might 
expect.  It  passes  a  great  part  of  its  time  in  the  water,  and  in 
the  mud  of  oozy  banks ;  and  seeks  for  the  insects,  small  shell- 
fish, &c.,  on  which  it  feeds,  by  plunging  its  bill  into  the  mud, 
exactly  in  the  manner  of  a  Duck.  It  appears,  that,  when  these 
are  scarce,  it  will  eat  water-weeds, —  such  having  been  found  in 


356  ORNITHORHYNCUS. 

the  cheek-pouches.  The  animals  usually  remain  at  the  surface 
of  the  water,  with  the  head  slightly  raised  above  it ;  but  upon 
the  slightest  alarm  they  instantl}  disappear ;  and  they  are  so 
watchful  of  danger,  that  the  mere  act  of  levelling  a  gun  is 
sufficient  to  cause  them  to  dive.  After  some  little  time,  they 
reappear  at  some  distance  from  the  spot  where  they  sank.  Their 
burrows  are  excavated  in  the  banks  of  the  streams  they  inhabit, 
and  are  of  very  curious  construction.  The  entrance  is  situated 
near  the  water's  edge,  on  a  steep  part  of  the  bank  ;  and  is  con- 
cealed amongst  the  herbage.  It  gradually  rises  from  the  level  of 
the  stream,  proceeding  in  a  serpentine  direction  to  a  distance  of 
twenty  or  even  fiftj  feet  from  the  entrance  ;  and  its  termination 
is  enlarged,  so  as  to  form  a  kind  of  nest  for  the  parents  and  their 
offspring,  which  is  strewed  with  dry  river-weed.  The  burrows 
have  usually  a  second  orifice,  below  the  surface  of  the  water ; 
communicating  with  the  passage  just  within  the  upper  entrance. 
319.  The  young  are  produced  in  a  very  imperfect  state,  and 
are  very  unlike  the  fully-developed  animal.  The  skin  is  entirely 
destitute  of  fur,  and  is  thrown,  by  the  curling  of  the  body,  and 
the  doubling  of  the  head  and  tail  beneath  it,  into  transverse 
folds  ;  the  eyes  are  not  formed,  and  their  place  is  merely  indicated 
by  the  presence  of  a  few  wrinkles  on  the  skin.  The  margin  of 
the  bill  is  at  that  time  soft,  and  the  tongue  (which  in  the  adult 
does  not  extend  between  the  mandibles)  advances  to  its  front 
edge  ;  so  that  the  young  animal  can  obtain  nourishment  by 
sucking,  which  was  at  first  thought  impossible.  The  mammary 
gland  of  the  female  is  very  simple  in  structure,  and  is  divided 
into  a  large  number  of  separate  lobes  ;  this  is  just  what  might 
be  expected,  when  it  is  remembered  that  the  organ  here  makes 
its  first  appearance,  and  presents  therefore  its  lowest  grade  of 
formation  (  ANIM.  PHYSIOL.,  §  358).  The  Ornithorhyncus  is  truly 
ovo- viviparous ;  for  the  embryo  appears  never  to  derive  any 
other  sustenance  from  its  parent,  up  to  the  time  of  its  birth,  than 
that  which  is  stored  up  for  it  in  the  ovum ;  but,  as  in  some 
Lizards  and  Fishes,  the  egg  is  hatched  (as  it  were)  within  t 
oviduct,  so  that  the  young  is  born  alive.  In  consequence  of  i 
'  imperfect  condition,  however,  it  cannot  leave  its  burrow  or 


1 


.1  t»k    u     IMA  a  A      i 


ORNITHORHYNCUS,    ECHIDNA. 


357 


for  some  time ;  and  this  serves  for  the  protection  of  the  young 
Ornithorhyncus,  as  the  pouch  of  the  Opossum  or  Kangaroo  does 
to  its  helpless  offspring.  A  very  interesting  account  has  been 
given  by  Mr.  G.  Bennet,*  of  the  habits  of  some  of  these  ani- 
mals, which  he  kept  in  a  state  of  captivity,  during  his  residence 
in  Australia.  The  Ornithorhyncus  appears  from  this  statement 
to  be  a  lively  interesting  creature.  Its  voice,  which  it  utters 
when  alarmed  or  disturbed,  resembles  the  growl  of  a  puppy,  but 
in  a  softer  key.  It  dresses  its  fur,  combing  it  with  its  feet,  and 
pecking  at  it  with  its  beak  ;  and  seems  to  take  great  delight  in 
keeping  it  smooth  and  clean.  When  asleep,  it  sometimes  rolls 
itself  up  like  a  hedgehog,  or  curls  itself  like  a  dog,  keeping  its 
back  warm  by  bringing  over  it  the  flattened  tail.  The  young 
are  playful,  and  gambol  with  one  another  in  a  very  animated 
manner.  They  appear  to  be  in  a  great  measure  nocturnal,  pre- 
ferring the  twilight  to  the  glare  of  day.  They  may  be  fed  upon 
bread  soaked  in  water,  chopped  egg,  and  meat  minced  very 
small.  Two  species  have  been  described,  differing  slightly  in 
colour  ;  but  it  is  doubtful  whether  these  are  more  than  varieties. 
The  Ornithorhyncus  is  confined  to  New  Holland  and  Yan 
Diemen's  Land. 

320.     The  Echidna,  or  Porcupine  Ant-eater,  seems  at  first 

sight  very  different  in 
its  conformation  from 
the  Ornithorhyncus ; 
but  in  the  most  im- 
portant particulars  of 
its  structure  it  closely 
resembles  it,  though 
differing  widely  in  its 
habits,  and  in  all  the 
peculiarities  connect- 
ed with  them.  It  is 
about  the  size  and  form  of  a  Hedgehog,  which  it  also  resembles 
in  having  its  body  covered  with  spines ;  but  these  are  much 

*  Transactions  of  the  Zoological  Society,  Vol.  I. 


k 


Fio.  176.— ECHIDNA. 


.; 


358  ECHIDNA. 

stouter  than  in  that  animal;  and  the  two  are  easily  distinguished 
by  the  long  narrow  snout  which  the  Echidna  possesses.  This 
snout  is  formed  by  the  elongation  of  the  muzzle,  and  is  cleft  at 
the  point  by  a  very  small  mouth.  The  jaws  are  destitute  of 
teeth,  as  in  the  true  Ant-eater  (§  250)  ;  and  the  tongue  is 
long  and  slender,  and  capable  of  being  protruded  to  a  considerable 
distance.  The  legs  are  short,  but  large  and  strong ;  and  both 
the  hind  and  fore-feet  possess  five  toes,  which  are  armed  with 
strong  slightly-curved  claws.  On  the  heel  of  the  hind-foot 
is  a  curved  horny  spur,  like  that  of  the  Ornithorhyncus.  The 
Echidna  is  a  burrowing  animal ;  and  the  broad  strong  claws  of 
its  fore-feet  appear  to  be  used  for  digging  out  the  earth  ;  while 
the  large  hollow  claws  of  the  hind-feet  are  to  enable  the  animal 
to  cast  away  the  loose  soil.  These  members  are  twisted,  and 
directed  obliquely  backwards,  in  such  a  manner  that  the  sides  of 
the  claws  lie  on  the  ground,  and  the  concave  surface  or  sole  of 
the  foot  is  behind ;  thus  forming  very  efficient  shovels  for  this 
purpose.  The  skin  of  the  Echidna  is  remarkably  thick,  to  give 
attachment  to  the  strong  spines  with  which  it  is  covered ;  and 
it  can  erect  these  in  the  manner  of  a  Hedgehog,  though  unable 
to  roll  itself  into  a  ball,  like  that  animal.  The  spines  are  inter- 
mingled with  coarse  hairs,  which  also  clothe  the  limbs  and  under 
surface  of  the  body.  This  animal  lives  entirely  upon  insects  ; 
which  it  obtains,  in  the  same  manner  with  the  Ant-eaters,  by 
entrapping  them  with  the  viscous  secretion  that  covers  its  long 
tongue.  It  inhabits  the  mountain  ranges  of  Australia,  and  is 
found  also  in  Van  Diemen's  Land  and  the  islands  of  Bass's 
Straits.  It  burrows  with  great  rapidity ;  and  will  even  work 
its  way  under  a  pretty  strong  pavement,  or  the  foundation  of  a 
•wall,  removing  the  stones  with  its  claws.  When  attacked  by 
dogs,  it  quickly  sinks  itself  in  the  earth  or  sand,  so  as  to  present 
nothing  but  its  prickly  back  to  its  adversaries.  In  one  instance, 
a  large  chest  of  earth  containing  plants  being  given  to  an  Echidna 
in  captivity,  it  made  its  way  to  the  bottom  in  less  than  two 
minutes.  This  individual  is  described  as  stupid  and  inert ;  and 
for  the  first  month  after  its  capture,  it  took  no  food  whatever. 
It  became  very  thin,  but  did  not  appear  to  suffer.  It  afterwards 


ECHIDNA.  359 

ate  a  mixture  of  flour,  water,  and  sugar,  upon  which  it  lived  for 
some  time.  It  made  frequent  efforts  to  get  out  of  its  cage,  and 
displayed  very  great  strength.  The  possessor  of  another  captive 
Echidna  speaks  of  it  as  in  his  opinion  the  strongest  Quadruped, 
for  its  size,  in  existence.  To  lift  it  from  the  ground  requires 
more  force  than  would  be  supposed ;  so  firmly  does  it  fix  itself 
to  the  earth,  by  means  of  its  powerful  feet  and  claws.  The 
animal  is  now  very  rare  ;  and  but  little  is  known  of  its  habits 
in  a  state  of  nature.  Two  species  or  varieties  of  it  have  been 
found. 

321.  The  following  Table,  constructed  by  Professor  Owen,* 
is  designed  to  express  the  connexions  of  the  several  orders  of 
Mammalia  with  each  other,  and  the  points  at  which  they  are 
most  nearly  related  to  the  inferior  Vertebrata.  The  names  of 
the  orders  are  printed  in  small  capitals ;  and  those  of  the  con- 
necting genera  in  italics.  Where  the  union  is  by  a  continuous 
line,  it  is  intended  to  show  that  the  connexion  is  very  close ; 
but  where  the  line  is  dotted,  or  a  blank  space  is  left,  the  links 
are  more  or  less  wanting.  Thus  the  order  QUADRUMANA  is 
closely  connected  with  the  CHEIROPTERA  by  the  Galeopithecus 
(§  163);  with  the  CARNIVORA  by  the  Lemur  (§  161);  with 
the  RODENTIA  by  the  Cheiromys  (§  164);  with  the  MARSUPIALIA 
by  the  Didelphis  (§  309)  ;and  less  closely  with  the  EDENTATA 
by  the  Brady  pus  (§  240),  which  approaches  the  QUADRUMANA 
in  certain  particulars.  Again,  the  CARNIVORA  and  the  CHEIRO- 
PTERA are  connected  by  the  INSECTIVORA  ;  and  the  former  are 
united  to  the  CETACEA  by  the  genus  Otaria,  or  Fur-Seal  (§  202). 
The  EDENTATA  are  connected  with  the  PACHYDERMATA  by  the 
fossil  Glyptodon  (§  247)  ;  and  this  last  order  is  connected  with 
the  RODENTIA  by  the  fossil  Toxodon  (§  303).  With  the  RO- 
DENTIA, again,  the  RUMINANTIA  are  connected  by  the  genus 
Moschus  (§  276). 

*  Cyclopaedia  of  Anatomy,  Vol.  III.  p.  245. 


360 


•a     2 


a  < 

§  j  1 

a  s  —  s- 

0  I     I 


11 


i-g 

*  I 


w     3 


*:        °      •    .2     | 

-1 1 S-g-! 


CHAPTER  IV. 

OP  THE  CLASS  OF  BIRDS. 

322.  The   class  of  Birds,  which   includes   all   the   animals 
furnished  with   an  internal  skeleton  and  expressly  adapted  for 
flight,  is  one  of  the  most  distinct  and  clearly  characterised  of  all 
the  subdivisions  of  the  Animal  kingdom ;  whether  we  consider 
merely  the  external  configuration  of  these  beings,  or  attend  exclu- 
sively to  the  peculiarities  of  their  internal  structure,  or  observe  the 
manner  in  which  their  functions  are  executed.     To  define  this 
group,  it  would  be  sufficient  to   say,  that  Birds  are  oviparous 
vertebrated  animals,  whose  circulation  is  double  and  complete; 
but  to  give  an  exact  idea  of  its  principal  characters,  we  must  add, 
that  the  respiration  of  birds  is  atmospheric  and  double  (that  is, 
instead  of  being  carried  on  in  the  lungs  alone,  as  is  that  of  the 
Mammalia  and  Reptiles,  it  takes  place  both  in  these  organs  and 
in  the  whole  interior  of  the  body),  that  their  blood  is  warm  like 
that  of  the  Mammalia ;  that  their  anterior  members  have  the  form 
of  wings  ;  and  that  their  skin  is  covered  with  feathers. 

323.  The  conformation  of  these  animals  varies  but  little ;  and 
harmonises  with  the  mode  of  locomotion  for  which  they  are 
peculiarly  designed.     They  seldom  attain  a  large  size  ;  and  the 
presence  of  a  considerable  quantity  of  air  within  their  body, 
renders  them  very  light.     The  feathers,  which  cover  the  whole 
body  of  the  Birds,  are  productions  very  analogous  to  the  hairs 
of  Mammalia  ;  but  of  a  more  complicated  structure.     We  may 
generally  distinguish  in  them  a  horny  tube,  which  forms  the 
lower  part,  and  which  is  pierced  at  its  extremity  ;  a  stem  which 
surmounts  this  tube  ;  and  lamina,  or  vanes,  on  each  side  of  the 
stem,  which  are  themselves  furnished  with  small  barbs ;    and 
these  sometimes  appear,  in  their  turn,  fringed  on  their  edge.  The 
secreting  organ  intended  to  form  the  feather,   is  termed  the 


362  DEVELOPMENT  OF  FEATHERS. 

capsule;  and  it  often  acquires  a  considerable  length.  From  the 
observations  of  M.  Fred.  Cuvier,  it  would  appear,  that  the 
capsule  grows  during  the  whole  period  of  the  development  of  the 
feathers ;  and  that  in  proportion  as  its  base  lengthens,  its  extre- 
mity dies, — drying  up  as  soon  as  it  has  formed  the  corresponding 
portion  of  this  appendix.  Each  capsule  is  composed  of  a  cylin- 
drical sheath,  lined  internally  with  two  tunics  united  by  oblique 
partitions  ;  and  of  a  central  bulb. — The  substance  of  the  feather 
is  deposited  on  the  surface  of  the  bulb  ;  and,  to  form  the  laminae, 
it  is  moulded  as  it  were  in  the  spaces  between  the  partitions.  In 
the  portion  corresponding  to  the  stem,  the  bulb  is  in  contact  with 
its  lower  surface;  and  after  having  deposited  there  a  spongy 
substance,  it  dries  up  and  dies  ;  but  where  the  trunk  of  the 
feather  is  tubular,  the  plate  of  horny  matter  which  the  secreting 
organ  deposits,  turns  round  it  and  completely  envelopes  it ;  this 
bulb,  however,  when  it  has  fulfilled  its  functions,  dries  up,  and 
forms,  in  so  doing,  a  series  of  membranous  cones,  imbedded  in 
one  another,  which  fill  the  interior  of  the  tube,  and  are  sometimes 
called  the  cores  of  the  quill. 

324.  The  new  feather  is  at  first  inclosed  in  the  sheath  of  its 
capsule,  which  often  projects  several  inches  beyond  the  stem,  and 
is  gradually  destroyed.  The  feather  is  then  uncovered  ;  and  its 
laminae,  at  first  rolled  together,  unfold  laterally  ;  the  extremity  of 
the  tube  remains  imbedded  in  the  skin,  but  in  general  can  be 
easily  detached,  and  falls  off  at  a  certain  period  to  give  place  to  a 
new  feather.  This  removal  of  the  feathers,  which  is  called 
moulting,  generally  takes  place  every  year  after  the  period  of 
incubation  (the  laying  and  hatching  the  eggs),  and  sometimes 
twice  in  the  same  year,  in  spring  and  in  autumn  ;  it  is  earlier  in 
old  individuals  than  in  young  ones,  and  is  a  period  of  discomfort 
to  the  bird,  which  loses  its  voice  whilst  it  is  going  on. 

325.  The  form  of  these  tegumentary  appendages  varies  much ; 
there  are  some  which  are  destitute  of  laminae,  and  resemble  por- 
cupine's quills ;  of  these  there  are  four  or  five  in  the  wing  of  the 
Cassowary.  In  others  the  laminae  are  stiff,  and  provided  with 
small  barbs  which  hook  together,  so  as  to  form  an  expanded 
surface,  which  offers  complete  resistance  to  the  air ;  this  is  the 


PLUMAGE    OF    BIRDS. SKELETON.  363 

case  with  the  wing-feathers  of  the  Eagle  and  the  Crow.  There 
are  others,  again,  in  which  the  vanes  and  their  barbs  are  long  and 
flexible,  and  do  not  hook  into  each  other,  so  that  they  have  an 
extreme  degree  of  lightness  and  softness ;  feathers  of  this  kind 
are  met  with  in  the  wings  and  tail  of  the  Ostrich.  And  lastly, 
there  are  some  which  resemble  mere  down^  the  laminae  being  very 
narrow  and  totally  unconnected  ;  such  are  those,  obtained  from 
the  Adjutant,  which  are  much  valued  as  articles  of  ladies'  dress, 
and  are  known  under  the  name  of  Maraboo  feathers.  The  colours 
of  feathers  are  exceedingly  varied,  and  often  surpass  in  beauty 
and  splendour  those  of  the  most  beautiful  flowers,  or  the  most 
brilliant  stones.  The  plumage  of  the  female  is  generally  less 
varied  than  that  of  the  males  ;  and  the  young  birds  rarely  exhibit 
the  colours  that  they  will  preserve  all  their  lives;  they  often 
change  for  two  or  three  years  successively ;  and  sometimes  the 
adult  has  a  summer  plumage  quite  different  from  its  winter  one. 
Among  aquatic  birds  the  feathers  are  provided  with  a  fatty 
matter,  which  renders  them  impermeable  to  water ;  this  enables 
them  to  preserve  the  skin  of  the  animal  from  contact  with  the 
liquid  in  which  it  is  partly  plunged. 

326.  The  skeleton  which  determines  the  general  form  of  Birds, 
and  which  is  at  the  same  time  one  of  the  most  important  parts 
of  its  apparatus  for  locomotion,  is  composed  of  nearly  the  same 
elements  as  among  the  Mammalia ;  but  the  form  and  arrange- 
ment of  many  of  its  bones  are  different ;  and  with  an  equal 
volume  they  are  also  lighter,  most  of  them  being  hollowed  out 
into  numerous  small  cavities  filled  with  air.  The  head  of  these 
animals  (Fig.  178)  is  generally  small ;  when  young  the  skull  is 
composed  of  the  same  bones  as  in  the  Mammalia;  (viz.  two 
frontal  bones,  two  parietal,  one  occipital,  two  temporal,  one 
sphenoid,  and  one  ethmoid)  ;  but  all  these  parts  are  firmly  fixed 
together  at  a  very  early  age ;  and  then  cease  to  be  recognizable. 
The  face  is  almost  entirely  formed  by  the  jaws,  which  are  much 
elongated,  and  which,  being  destined  to  constitute  the  principal 
organ  of  prehension,  vary  much  in  size  and  form  according  to  the 
nature  of  the  objects  which  the  bird  will  require  to  seize.  The 
upper  mandible  is  so  united  to  the  frontal  bone,  as  to  preserve 

BB2 


364 


SKELETON    OF    BIRDS. 


some  power  of  motion;  and  the  lower,  instead  of  directly  articu- 
lating with  the    cranium  by  a  projecting  condyle,  as  in  the 


_  t 


— «••  ta 


FIG.  177 — SKELETON  OF  VULTURE. 

vc,  cervical  vertebras ;  vs,  sacral  vertebrae ;  vq,  caudal  vertebras ;  cl,  clavicle  ;  Ji,  hume- 
rus  ;  o,  bones  of  forearm ;  ca,  carpus ;  pfi,  phalanges ;  st,  sternum  ;  /,  femur  ;  t,  tibia ; 
ta, 


Mammalia,  is  suspended  to  a  moveable  bone  named  the  tympanic 
bone,  or  os  quadratum,  which  is  analogous  to  a  portion  of  the 

temporal  bone  de- 
tached from  the 
main  part,  to  which 
it  is  united  in  the 
preceding  class. 
Each  of  thebranches 
of  this  jaw  is  com- 
posed of  two  pieces, 

Jbuone!  Lj°awe.r         °8  quadratnm<   instead      of    being 
FIG.  178.-SKULL  OF  EAGLE.  formed  of   a  single 

bone;  and  it  is  b] 
a  cavity,   not    by   a  projecting    condyle,    that    it   articulat 


Upper  ja 


SPINAL   COLUMN    OF    BIRDS.  365 

with  the  tympanic  bone.  The  articulation  of  the  head  with  the 
vertebral  column  permits  more  varied  movement  than  in  the 
Mammalia  ;  for  it  is  effected  by  a  single  condyle,  a  kind  of  half- 
spherical  pivot,  situated  on  the  central  line  of  the  body,  below 
the  large  occipital  foramen,  and  received  into  a  corresponding 
cavity  in  the  atlas. 

327.  The  neck  of  Birds  is  generally  longer  and  more  move- 
able  than  that  of  most  Mammalia ;  as  the  beak  is  generally  the 
only  organ  of  prehension  by  which  they  pick  up  their  food  from 
the  ground,  the  cervical  portion  of  the  vertebral  column  (Fig. 
]  77)  becomes  longer,  in  proportion  as  these  animals  are  more 
elevated  on  their  feet ;  and  where  they  are  essentially  swimmers, 
as  the  Swan,  and  plunge  their  head  in  the  water  to  seize  their 
prey,  the  length  of  their  neck  in  many  cases  much  surpasses  the 
height  of  the  trunk.  The  number  of  cervical  vertebras  varies 
in  different  species ;  generally  there  are  from  twelve  to  fifteen, 
but  in  some  cases  there  are  not  so  many,  and  in  others  there  are 
more  than  twenty,  as  in  the  Swan  for  instance.  They  move 
easily  on  one  another,  and  from  the  nature  of  their  articulating 
surfaces,  the  neck  can  bend  in  the  form  of  an  S,  so  as  to  shorten 
or  lengthen,  as  the  curves  increase  or  diminish.  This  arrangement 
is  particularly  remarkable  in  Waders,  such  as  the  Stork  ;  which, 
to  seize  their  prey,  require  to  dart  their  beak  to  a  considerable 
distance  with  great  rapidity.  The  action  of  the  muscles  destined 
to  move  this  part,  is  also  facilitated  by  the  existence  of  numerous 
processes,  serving  for  their  insertion.  The  vertebra  of  the 
back,  on  the  contrary,  are  in  nearly  all  Birds,  almost  immovable  ; 
and  we  readily  perceive  the  importance  of  this  arrangement  in 
animals  destined  for  flight ;  for  this  portion  of  the  spinal  column, 
serving  to  support  the  ribs,  and  consequently  furnishing  a  point 
of  attachment  to  the  wings,  requires  great  solidity.  In  general 
these  vertebra  are  even  united  to  each  other;  but  in  Birds 
which  do  not  fly,  such  as  the  Cassowary  and  the  Ostrich,  they 
preserve  some  power  of  motion.  The  lumbar  and  sacral  vertebrae 
are  all  united  in  a  single  bone,  which  has  the  same  use  as  the 
sacrum  in  Man.  The  coccygeal  vertebrae  are  small  and  move- 
able  ;  the  last,  which  supports  the  large  feathers  of  the  tail,  is 


366 


BONES    OF    THE    TRUNK    OF    BIRDS. 


generally  larger  than  the  others,  and  elevated  into  a  projecting 
crest. 

328.  The  ribs  of  Birds  also  present  some  peculiarities  of 
structure,  which  tend  to  give  solidity  to  the  thorax.  The  car- 
tilage, which  in  the  Mammalia  fixes  them  to  the  sternum,  is 
here  replaced  by  a  bone ;  and  each  of  them  is  provided  in  the 
middle  with  a  flattened  process,  which  is  directed  obliquely 
backwards  above  the  next  rib ;  so  that  all  these  bones  have 
points  of  support  on  one  another.  But  the  most  remarkable 
part  of  the  osseous  structure  is  the  sternum  ;  which,  as  it  gives 
insertion  to  the  muscles  of  flight,  presents  in  Birds  a  very  high 
development,  and  constitutes  a  sort  of  convex  buckler,  usually 
square,  which  covers  the  thorax  and  a  large  part  of  the  abdomen. 


FIG.  179- — SKELETON  OF  OSTIUCH. 


In  the  Cassowary  and  Ostrich,  which  cannot  rise  in  the  air,  and 
which  have  only  rudimentary  wings,  the  sternum  does  not  present 


BONES    OF    THE    SHOULDER.  367 

any  ridge  on  its  front  surface  ;  but  in  other  Birds  there  is  a  kind 
of  projecting  and  longitudinal  keel,  (£,  Fig.  180),  which  gives 
more  power  to  the  muscles  which  draw  down  the  wing. 

329.  The  shoulder  bones  also  are  so  disposed  as  to  give  the 
greatest  power  to  the  wings.  The  scapula  (0,  Fig.  180),  is  narrow, 
but  much  lengthened  in  the  direction  parallel  to  the  spine  ;    and 
is  supported  on  the  sternum  not  only  by  the  clavicle  (/),  but  also 
by  another  bone  (c)  which  fills  the  office  of  a  second  clavicle, 
and  which  is  called  the  cgracoid  bone,  from  its  apparent  analogy 

to  the  coracoid  process  of  the 
human  scapula.  The  cla- 
vicles of  the  two  sides  are 
generally  united  at  their  an- 
terior extremity  in  the  form 
of  a  V,  whose  point  is  directed 
downwards,  and  are  attached 
to  the  keel  of  the  sternum ; 
this  compound  bone  is  termed 
the  furcula^  and  in  common 
language  the  merry-thought. 

FIG.  180  —BONKS  OF  THE  SHOULDER  AND  The  COracoid  bones  Constitute 

the    buttresses,  which,  with 

the  furcula,  keep  the  shoulders  separated,  and  afford  to  the 
humerus  a  point  of  support,  so  much  the  firmer  as  the  Bird  is  a 
better  flyer.  In  Birds  which  fly  but  little,  or  not  at  all,  the 
clavicles  have,  on  the  contrary,  but  a  slight  development.  Thus 
in  certain  terrestrial  Parroquets  of  Australia,  these  bones  are 
completely  rudimentary  ;  in  the  Cassowary  and  American 
Ostrich  they  are  represented  only  by  slender-pointed  processes  ; 
in  the  African  Ostrich  and  the  Toucans,  they  almost  reach  the 
sternum,  but  are  not  united  together  at  their  lower  extremities ; 
among  some  Owls  they  are  united  by  a  cartilage;  whilst  in 
most  Birds  their  union  is  complete,  and  they  are  often  directly 
supported  on  the  sternum,  by  means  of  a  central  projection  from 
the  point  of  union. 

330.  The  anterior  members  of  Birds  never  serve  either  for 
walking,   prehension,    or   touch ;    but   form  lateral   expansions 


368 


BONES   OF   THE    WING. 


named  wings.  When  speaking  of  Bats,  we  saw  an  example  of 
the  transformation  of  the  thoracic  members  into  an  organ  of 
locomotion  in  the  air  ;  in  those  aniaials  it  is  a  fold  of  skin  which 
serves  to  strike  the  air,  and  the  fingers  are  much  prolonged  for 
its  support ; — but  in  Birds  these  expansions  are  of  a  different 
nature  ;  they  are  formed  of  stiff  feathers,  which  require  to  be 
fixed  only  at  the  base ;  and  the  hand,  consequently,  no  longer  pre- 
sents the  division  into  fingers, 
which  would  impair  its  solidity 
without  being  of  any  use  ;  it 
has  the  form  of  a  flattened,  and 
almost  motionless  stump.  The 
conformation  of  the  arm  and 
fore-arm  differs  little  from  that 
of  the  same  parts  in  Man ; 
thehumerushas  no  peculiarity; 
the  radius  and  ulna  cannot 
turn  on  one  another,  and  are 
generally  longer  as  the  flight 
is  more  powerful.  The  carpus 
is  composed  of  two  small  bones 
placed  together,  and  followed 
by  the  metacarpus,  which  is 
formed  of  two  bones  united 
at  their  extremities  ;  on  the 
radial  side  of  the  base  of  this 
last  part,  is  inserted  a  rudi- 
mentary thumb ;  and  lastly, 

FIG.  181.— BONES  OF  JER-FALCON'S  WING  :  a*    :AQ  pYtrPTni'fir    ic    ft 
i,  elbow-joint  ;n,  wrist-joint  ;    m,  knuckle- 

joint ;  a,  humerus ;  b,  radius ;  c,  metacarpus  ;  finger  composed    of    two 

o,  rudimentary  thumb  ;  1,  2,  3,  4,  rudiment-  -,  n    /M 

ary  phalanges  of  fingers.  langes,    and  a  small  filament 

representing  the  outer  finger. 

331.  The  wing  feathers  are  distinguished  as  primaries, 
secondaries,  or  tertiaries,  according  as  they  are  supported  by  the 
handy  the  fore-arm^  or  the  humerus  ;  and  it  is  on  their  length, 
more  than  on  that  of  the  wing  bones,  that  the  extent  of  the 
wings  and  the  power  of  flight  depend.  Whenever  the  Bird 


MECHANISM    OP   FLIGHT.  369 

wishes  to  strike  the  air,  it  raises  the  humerus,  and  with  it  the 
wing  still  folded  ;  it  then  unfolds  this  by  extending  the  fore-arm, 
as  well  as  the  hand,  and  suddenly  depresses  it ;  the  air,  resisting 
this  movement,  furnishes  the  Bird  with  a  point  of  support  on 

which  it  raises  itself;  it  then 
darts  forward  like  a  projectile ; 
and  an  impulse  being  once  given 
to  the  body,  it  slants  or  folds 
back  the  wing,  to  diminish  as 
much  as  possible  the  new  resist- 
ance, which  the  surrounding  fluid 

FTG.  182.-WIHO  OF  FALCON.  makeg    to    ;tg    courge>        This   re- 

a,  primaries  ;  b,  secondaries ;  c,  tertiaries  ;  sistance,  and  gravitation  which 
d,  spurious  quills,  arising  from  the  thumb.  ,  .  ,.  .  ... 

tends    to    make   all    bodies   fall 

towards  the  centre  of  the  earth,  gradually  diminish  the  speed 
which  the  Bird  has  acquired  by  this  stroke  upon  the  air ;  and 
without  new  movements  it  will  soon  fall ;  but  before  the  speed 
acquired  by  the  first  stroke  of  the  wing  is  lost,  the  Bird  gives  a 
second,  which  adds  new  speed  to  that  which  it  already  had,  and 
thus  proceeds  with  an  accelerated  motion.  This  is,  in  fact,  the 
mechanism  of  flight.  While  the  Bird  is  thus  suspended  in  the 
air,  its  wings  support  all  the  weight  of  its  body ;  and  to  preserve 
its  equilibrium  in  this  position,  its  centre  of  gravity  must  be 
placed  nearly  beneath  its  shoulders,  and  as  low  as  possible ;  on 
this  account,  during  flight,  it  generally  projects  its  head  forwards 
by  stretching  out  its  neck  ;  and  its  trunk,  instead  of  being 
elongated  like  that  of  the  Mammalia,  is  short  and  compact. — It 
is  evident  that  the  resistance  of  the  air  must  be  greater,  in  pro- 
portion to  the  mass  of  that  fluid  struck  at  once  by  the  wings  ; 
and  consequently,  that  the  greater  the  extent  of  the  wings,  other 
things  being  equal,  the  greater  will  be  the  'speed  acquired  by 
their  down-stroke  ; — thus  Birds  with  long  wings  will  not  only 
be  able  to  fly  quicker  than  those  with  short  ones,  but  also  they 
will  be  able  to  support  themselves  longer  in  the  air ;  for  they 
will  not  be  obliged  to  repeat  so  often  the  movement  of  these 
organs,  and  consequently  they  will  be  less  quickly  fatigued.  In 
fact,  all  the  Birds  remarkable  for  their  rapid  and  sustained  flight 


370  WINGS   OF    BIRDS. 

have  large  wings;  whilst  those  whose  wings  are  short,  or  of  a 
medium  size  in  comparison  with  the  size  of  the  body,  fly  with 
much  less  speed,  and  are  obliged  to  rest  more  frequently. 

332.  Among  the  Birds  remarkable  for  the  speed  of  their 
flight,    we   may  mention    the    Condor,    and   the   Frigate-Bird 
(Fig.  304).     The  Condor,  or  great  Vulture  of  the  Andes,  is 
sometimes  thirteen  feet  across  the  wings  ;  and  rises  higher  than 
any  other  Bird ;  it  is  seen  sometimes  on  the  sea-shore,  sometimes 
hovering  over   Chimborazo,  that  is,  at  an  elevation  of  nearly 
22,000  feet  above  the  first   point.     Its  usual  dwelling  is  on 
the  ridges  of  the  Cordilleras  of  the  Andes,  immediately  below 
the  limit  of  perpetual  snow,  at  a  level  of  from  10,000  to  15,000 
feet  above  the  level  of  the  sea.     It  is  from  these  pinnacles  that 
it  descends  into  the  valleys  and  plains  to  seek  its  food,  which 
consists  principally  of  the  corpses  of  large  Mammalia  ;  it  is  even 
said  that  several  together  can  easily  kill  oxen,  and  that  they  are 
strong  enough  to  carry  off  in  their  claws  Sheep  and  Llamas,  and 
thus  transport  them  to  the  top  of  Chimborazo,   and  the  other 
loftiest  mountains  of  the  chain  of  the  Andes.     The  Frigate-Birds, 
whose  wings  are  longer  in  proportion  to  their  size,  and  which 
dwell  on  the  tropical  seas,  have  so  powerful  a  flight,  that  they 
can  venture  to  a  distance  of  more  than  400  leagues  from  land. 

333.  To  rise  vertically  in  the  air,  it  is  necessary  that  the 
wings  of  the  Bird  should  be  entirely  horizontal ;  but  this  is  not 
usually  the  case ;  they  are  generally  inclined  from  before  back- 
wards, so  as  to  give  the  animal  an  obliquely- ascending  movement; 
sometimes  this  inclination  is  such,  that  to  rise  nearly  vertically 
in  the  air,  the  Bird  must  fly  against  the  wind.     The  relative 
length  of  the  wing-feathers  influences  the  facility  with  which  it 
can  rise  in  calm  air ;  the  Birds  whose  primaries  are  the  longest 
and  most  resisting  at  their  extremity,  have  a  more  oblique  flight 
than  those  whose  wing  is  rounded  at  the  end.     Thus  the  Falcons 
which  have   pointed  wings,   can  rise   only  in  a  zigzag,  like  a 
tacking  vessel,  or  by  flying  against  the  wind ;  while  Sparrow- 
hawks,   Eagles,  and  other  Birds  of  prey  termed  ignoble,  whose 
wings  are  truncated  (or  abruptly  cut  short)  at  their  extremity, 
can  rise  vertically  (Fig.   182).     "When  the  Bird  wishes  to  rise 


WINGS    AND    LEGS   OP    BIRDS.  371 

from  the  earth,  it  first  springs  from  its  feet,  spreading  its 
wings  in  such  a  manner 
as  to  be  able  to  strike  the 
air  before  falling  back  on 
the  ground.  Those  that 
have  very  long  wings, 
require  more  space  to  de- 
press them  ;  and  if,  there- 
fore, their  feet  are  too 
short  to  allow  them  to 
spring  very  high,  they 
find  it  difficult  to  raise  c 

themselves  at  first.         The  Fl°-  IBS.— Wwo  OF  SPARROW-HAWK. 

Swallows  are    examples  of  «,  third  primary ;  6,   ninth  primary ;  c,  second- 
,,  .  aries. 

this. 

334.  The  feathers  of    the  tail  also  are  useful  to  Birds,  to 
direct  them  in  their  flight ;  they  spread  and  raise  them,  or  lower 
them,  like  a  rudder,  to  increase  or  diminish  the  obliquity  of  their 
upward  course  :  and  by  inclining  them  to  one  side  or  the  other, 
they  are  aided  in  changing  their  direction. 

335.  When  the  Bird    rests  on   the  ground,   the  posterior 
members  alone  serve  to  support  it ;  it  is  then  truly  a  biped  ;  and 
as  such  it  requires  a  broad  pelvis  firmly  fixed  on  the  vertebral 
column.     The  iliac  (hip)  bones  are  much  developed  in  Birds  ; 
and  form  only  one  piece  with  the  lumbar  and  sacral  vertebras. 
This  bony  circle  is  generally  incomplete  in  front ;  the  pubic 
bones  not  meeting  on  the  central  line.     The  thigh  bone  is  short 
and  straight ;  and  the    leg  is    composed,    as  in    most   of  the 
Mammalia,  of  a  tibia,  a  fibula,  and  a  patella;   but  the  two 
first  of  these  are  united  together  towards  their  lower  extremities. 
A  single  bone,  which  forms  a  continuation  of  the  leg,  represents 
the  tarsus  and  metatarsus ;  and  bears  at  its  inferior  extremity 
the  toes,  which  are  usually  to  the  number  of  four.     They  are 
never  more  numerous;    but   sometimes   the   external,  or  the 
internal  finger,  or  even  both,  disappear,  so  that  only  three  (Fig. 
184),  or  even  two  remain  (Fig.  185).     Three  of  the  four  toes 
are  usually  directed  in  front,  while  the  fourth  is  turned  backwards 


372 


FOOT    OF    BIRDS. 


(Fig.  186) ;  sometimes  the  outer  toe  also  turns  back,  and  an 
arrangement   which   is   to    be   noticed,   especially    among   the 


FIG.  184.— FOOT  OF  BUSTARD. 


FIG.  185. — FOOT  OF  OSTRICH. 


FIG.  186.— FOOT  OF  JER  FALCON. 


climbers,  such    as     Parroquets,    Toucans,    "Woodpeckers,    &c, 
(Fig.  187). 


FIG.  187-— FOOT  OF  PARROT. 


POSITION    OF    THE    LEGS. 


373 


336.  We  have  said  that,  during  flight,  the  centre  of  gravity 
of  the  body  of  the  Bird  ought  to  be  under  the  shoulders ;  but  in 
order  that  it  may  retain  its  equilibrium  on  its  feet,  which  are 
situated  behind  the  trunk,  these  organs  must  be  capable  of 
being  brought  sufficiently  forward,  and  the  claws  must  be 
long  enough  to  project  beyond  the  point,  where  a  vertical  line 
would  fall,  passing  through  the  centre  of  gravity ; — or  else  this 
centre  must  itself  be  further  back,  so  as  to  be  above  the  base  of 
support.  This  explains  the  reason  of  the  great  curvature  of  the 
thigh,  and  the  obliquity  of  the  tarsus  on  the  leg ; — when  the 
foot  is  large,  and  the  neck  can  be  so  bent  back  as  to  carry  back 
the  head,  the  equilibrium  is  thus  established  without  the  body 
being  much  removed  from  the  horizontal  position  (Fig.  188) ; 
but  when  the  neck  is  short,  the  head  large,  and  the  claws  of 


FIG.  188 IBIS. 


FIG.  189. — PENGUIN. 


moderate  length,  the  animal  is  obliged  to  assume  during  rest  or 
walking,  a  nearly  vertical  posture  (Fig.  189).  It  is  to  preserve 
their  equilibrium  more  easily,  that  Birds  generally  place  their 
heads  under  their  wings  while  they  sleep  perched  on  a  single 
foot.  In  many  of  these  animals,  this  position  is  rendered 
singularly  convenient,  by  a  peculiarity  in  the  construction  of  the 
articulation  of  the  knee.  In  Man  and  most  other  Animals,  the 
members  bend  under  the  weight  of  the  body,  as  soon  as  their 
extensor  muscles  cease  to  contract;  and  it  is  the  necessity  of  the 


374  CONFORMATION   OF   THE   LEGS. 

permanent  contraction  of  these  organs,  which  renders  a  stationary 
position  so  fatiguing.  But  in  the  Stork,  and  other  long-shanked 
Birds,  it  is  very  different ;  the  I  jwer  extremity  of  the  femur 
presents  a  hollow,  in  which  is  imbedded,  during  the  extension 
of  the  limb,  a  projection  of  the  tibia,  which  can  escape  from  it 
only  by  a  muscular  effort;  the  foot  once  straightened  con- 
sequently remains  extended,  without  the  animal  requiring  to 
contract  the  muscles,  and  without  any  fatigue  arising  from  it. 

337.  It  is  always  more  difficult  to  a  Bird  to  take  flight, 
when  it  is  on  the  ground,  than  when  it  can  dart  from  an  elevated 
point :  we  have  already  seen  the  reason  of  this  ;  and  every  one 
knows  that  most  of  these  animals  perch  more  frequently  than 
they  settle  on  the  ground.     To  maintain  themselves  in  equili- 
brium on  a  branch,  they  must  grasp  it  closely  with  their  claws  ; 
and  if  it  had  been  necessary  to  employ  for  this  a  considerable  mus- 
cular force,  such  a  position  would  soon  have  become  fatiguing. 
But   here  another  very  simple  mechanism   renders   all  effort 
nearly  useless,  and  enables  the  Bird  to  grasp  the  branch  which 
supports  it.  even  when  it  sleeps.    The  flexor  muscles  of  the  claws 
pass  over  the  articulations  of  the  knee  and  heel  in  such  a  manner, 
that  when  the  latter  bend,  they  necessarily  press  on  the  tendons 
of  the  muscles,  and  make  them  bend  the  toes  ;  the  weight  of  the 
body,  pressing  down  the  thighs  and  legs,  necessarily  produces 
therefore  this   movement;   and  it  results  from  this,  that  the 
animal  grasps,  without  effort,  the  branch  on  which  it  is  perched, 
and  there  maintains  itself  fixed. 

338.  Great  differences  exist  in  the  conformation  of  the  legs, 
according  to  the  kind  of  life  to  which  the  Birds  are  destined. 
Thus  Birds  that  have  the  power  of  walking  with  great  rapidity, 
have  very  long  and  powerful  legs,  and  the  foot  comparatively 
small ;  in  the  Cassowary  and  the  Ostrich  (Fig.  179),  whose  speed 
is  as   great  as  that  of  the  horse,   this   arrangement   is  very 
remarkable;  and  it  is  observed  also  in  the  Secretary,  which 
walks  rapidly  while  pursuing  the  Serpents,  that  constitute  its 
principal  nourishment.     In  the  Eagle,  the  Falcon,  the  Vulture 
(Fig.  177),  these  members  are  equally  strong  but  short ;  and 
the  claws  are  armed  with  large,  sharp,  hooked  talons,  by  the  aid 


I 


STRUCTURE    OP    FOOT. ORGANS   OP    SENSE.  375 

of  which  these  Birds  seize  their  prey,  either  to  tear  it  to  pieces 
on  the  spot,  or  to  carry  it  away  with  them.  In  Birds  adapted 
to  live  on  the  shores  of  rivers,  and  to  seek  by  wading  the  worms 
and  fish  which  constitute  their  food;  the  feet  are  slender,  of 
extreme  length,  and  bare  below  the  knee  (Fig.  286), — an 
arrangement  very  favourable  to  this  kind  of  life,  and  which  has 


FIG.  190.— FOOT  OF  GANNET. 

procured  for  these  birds  in  France  the  name  of  Echassiers  (stilt 
birds),  from  Echasse  (stilt).  Again  in  the  kinds  formed  for 
living  on  deep  water,  the  feet  are  palmated,  or  webbed ;  that  is, 
transformed  into  a  swimming  apparatus,  by  the  addition  of  a 
membrane  which  extends  between  the  claws  without  preventing 
them  from  separating ;  a  character  which  is  observable  in  Ducks, 
Swans,  and  a  number  of  aquatic  Birds. 

339.  The  sense  of  touch  is  but  little  developed  in  Birds ; 
the  feathers  which  clothe  the  whole  body  oppose  great  obstacles 
to  the  exercise  of  this  faculty,  and  the  peculiar  conformation  of 
the  organs  of  prehension  is  equally  unfavourable  to  it.  Taste 
is  more  or  less  obtuse  in  these  animals  ;  their  tongue  is  generally 
cartilaginous,  and  destitute  of  nervous  papillse  ;  and  they  appear 
almost  always  to  swallow  their  food  without  masticating  it. 
The  organ  of  smell  is  more  perfect,  without  presenting,  however, 
all  the  high  development  which  is  found  in  the  Mammalia. 
The  nasal  fossae  are  sunk  in  the  base  of  the  upper  mandible, 
and  do  not  communicate  with  sinuses ;  their  surface  is  covered 
with  a  very  vascular  pituitary  membrane,  and  is  extended  by 
three  cartilaginous  plates  (analogous  to  the  spongy  lones  of 
Mammalia,  ANIM.  PHYSIOL.,  §  506),  turned  on  themselves  and 


376  SENSES   OF   SMELL    AND    SIGHT. 

supported  by  the  sides  of  the  cavity.  The  posterior  nares  unite 
towards  the  centre  of  the  palatal  arch,  so  as  to  form  in  it  a  single 
longitudinal  cleft.  Birds  of  prey  especially  those  that  live  on 
carrion,  have  the  olfactory  organ  more  developed  than  granivor- 
ous  (grain-eating)  or  insectivorous  Birds ;  most  authors  assure  us 
that  among  the  former,  the  delicacy  of  this  sense  is  such,  that 
it  enables  them  to  discover  their  prey,  even  when  at  a  con- 
siderable distance ;  but  the  experiments  of  some  naturalists  seem 
to  prove,  that  in  these  animals  smell  scarcely  exists,  and  that 
they  are  almost  entirely  guided  by  sight.  The  organs  of  hearing 
are  less  complicated  than  in  the  Mammalia ;  the  external  ear  is 
generally  wanting  in  Birds ;  and  the  auditory  canal  consists  of 
little  more  than  a  membranous  tube  placed  between  the  os 
quadratum  and  a  projecting  part  of  the  occipital. 

340.  The  organs  of  sight,  on  the  contrary,  appear  more 
perfect  than  in  the  preceding  class ;  the  eyes  of  Birds  are  larger 
in  proportion  to  the  size  of  the  head,  and  some  new  parts  are 
developed.  The  retina  is  very  thick,  and  there  proceeds  from 
it  a  black  membrane,  folded  like  a  fan,  which  advances  towards 
the  crystalline  lens.  Physiologists  are  not  agreed  respecting  the 
nature  of  this  appendage,  which  is  termed  the  marsupium.  It  is 
regarded  by  some  as  a  part  of  the  choroid  coat;  and  by  others  as 
a  nervous  prolongation,  intended  to  increase  the  extent  of  the 
visual  surface.  The  pupil  is  always  round ;  the  iris  very  con- 
tracted; the  cornea  transparent,  large  and  convex;  and  the 
sclerotic  strengthened  in  front  by  a  circle  of  bony  plates  lodged 
in  its  thickness.  There  are  two  horizontal  eyelids,  the  lower 
of  which  is  the  largest  and  most  moveable ;  and  there  is  also 
a  third  vertical,  semi-transparent  eyelid,  which  occupies  the 
internal  angle  of  the  eye,  and  may  be  drawn  across  so  as  to  cover 
its  whole  surface.  There  are  always  lachrymal  glands.  In  many 
Birds  the  range  of  sight  is  extremely  long ;  there  are  some  which, 
when  raised  in  the  air  to  heights  at  which,  notwithstanding 
their  size,  we  can  scarcely  distinguish  them,  clearly  perceive 
small  animals  on  which  they  feed,  and  pounce  upon  them  with 
an  unerring  aim.  In  these  the  crystalline  lens  is  less  convex 
and  less  dense  than  in  the  Birds  which  rise  but  little  from  the 


NERVOUS    SYSTEM    OF    BIRDS.  377 

ground;  and  it  would  seem  that  the  eye  can  adapt  itself  to  these 
great  differences  in  the  reach  of  its  vision,  by  the  contractions  of 
its  motor  muscles ;  which,  acting  on  the  bony  circle  of  the 
sclerotic  coat,  compress  the  humours  with  which  the  eye  is  filled, 
and  thus  produce  distension  of  the  cornea,  so  as  to  increase  its 
curvature,  when  the  animal  requires  to  become,  as  it  were,  short- 
sighted for  a  time,  to  distinguish  clearly  very  near  objects. 

341.  The  Nervous  System,  which  influences  the  functions  of 
the  organs  we  have  just  described,  presents  remarkable  pecu- 
liarities of  structure.     The  Encephalon  is  less  developed  than  in 
the  Mammalia ;  the  cerebral    hemispheres   are  still   the   most 
voluminous  parts  of  it :  but  they  have  no  convolutions,  and  they 

are  not  united  in  a  manner  as  complete ; 
for  the  great  commissure,  of  which  we  have 
before  spoken  under  the  name  of  corpus  cal- 
losum^  is  wanting  in  this  class.  The  optic 
lobes,  which  in  the  Mammalia  are  small,  and 
concealed  between  the  cerebrum  and  the  cere- 
bellum, here,  on  the  contrary,  assume  a  great 
development,  and  appear  uncovered  behind 
~  and  externally  to  the  cerebral  lobes ;  and  in- 

stead of  being  solid,  they  are  hollow  like  the 
cerebral  lobes.  The  cerebellum  is  transversely 
a,  cerebrum ;  b,  optic  furrowed  by  parallel  and  converging  lines  ;  it  is 
lobes;  c  cerebellum;  formed  almost  entirely  by  the  central  lobe, 

d,  spinal  cord.  <  .     , 

which,  in  the  Mammalia,  is  small  in  comparison 
with  the  lateral  lobes  or  hemispheres  of  the  cerebellum  ;  these 
remain  in  an  almost  rudimentary  state,  especially  in  Birds  that  fly 
badly.  The  spinal  cord  of  Birds  is  generally  very  long,  and 
has  two  enlargements  corresponding  with  the  origins  of  the 
nerves  of  the  wings  and  feet  ;  hi  those  that  fly  best,  the  upper 
enlargement  is  more  developed  than  the  lower ;  whilst  in  those 
that  employ  their  feet  more  than  their  wings,  there  is  an  inverse 
arrangement. 

342.  The  food  of  Birds   is   of  various  kinds;    some   feed 
exclusively  on  Seeds,  others  on  Insects,  others  on  Fish,  others 
again  on  the  flesh  of  Mammalia  or  Birds  still  living,   and  some 


378 


FORM    OF    THE    BILL. 


even  on  putrid  carrion.  Their  feet  sometimes  serve  for  the 
prehension  of  their  food,  but  the  beak  is  always  the  principal 
organ  employed  for  this  purpose  ,  its  form  varies  according  to 
the  nature  of  the  food,  and  according  to  the  more  or  less 
carnivorous  regimen  of  these  animals;  and  hence  it  furnishes 
the  zoologist  with  excellent  characters  for  classification.  A  solid 
horny  substance,  more  or  less  hard,  covers  it  externally,  and 
renders  its  edge  sharp ;  but  it  is  never  armed  with  true  teeth ; 
hence  mastication  is  very  incomplete,  and  in  general  there  is  none 
whatever.  In  Birds  that  live  on  flesh,  and  require  to  tear  their 
prey, — Falcons,  Eagles,  Vultures,  for  instance, — the  upper  man- 
dible is  very  short,  very  strong,  hooked  at  the  extremity,  and 
terminated  by  a  sharp  point;  sometimes  its  edges  are  more  or 
less  dentated  (or  toothed), 
which  makes  it  a  more 
powerful  weapon ;  and  we 
may  judge  the  habits  of 
these  Birds  to  be  more  or 
less  rapacious,  according 
to  the  degree  in  which  it 
possesses  these  characters. 
Thus  the  Falcon  is,  of  all 
Birds  of  Prey,  that  whose  *IG-  ^.-BBAK  OF  J£R  FALCON. 

beak  is  the  shortest,  most  curved,  dentated,  and  strong,  in 
proportion  to  its  size;  it  is  also  the  most  intrepid  hunter. 
"While  the  Kite,  which  scarcely  differs  from  the  Falcon,  except 
in  having  a  weaker  beak,  less  hooked,  and  not  dentated  on  the 
edges,  as  well  as  less  powerful  claws,  is  naturally  a  coward ; 
and  the  Vulture,  whose  beak  is  still  more  elongated,  and  con- 
sequently weaker,  does  not  even  attack  living  animals,  but  feeds 
on  dead  bodies.  Sea  Birds,  which  feed  on  the  flesh  of  fish  too 
large  to  be  swallowed  at  a  mouthful,  are  equally  remarkable  for 
their  thick  and  hooked  beak  (Fig.  193);  but  it  is  more 
elongated  than  in  Birds  of  Prey,  and  consequently  less  powerful. 
When  Birds  that  feed  on  Fish,  seek  only  fishes  and  reptiles 
small  enough  to  be  seized  and  swallowed  with  facility,  the  beak 
becomes  straight,  is  still  more  elongated,  and  resembles  a  long 


FORM    OP    THE    BILL. 


379 


pair  of  pincers.     The  Kingfisher  (Fig.  194)  and  Stork  are  good 
examples  of  this.     Birds  that  live  on  Insects,  Seeds,  or  Fruits, 


FIG.  193.— BEAK  OF  GULL. 


^^— -ss 
have  beaks  very  dissimilar  from  these  ;  the  first  have  generally  a 

very  slender  beak,  much  elongated,  and  straight  or  slightly- 


FIG.  194 — BBAK  OF  KINGFISHI 


curved  (Fig.  195) ;  unless  indeed  it  is  during  flight  that  they 
capture  the  small  insects  on  which  they  feed,  for  then  the  beak 
is  short,  very  wide,  and  deeply  cleft, — an  arrangement  which 
we  see  in  Swallows,  Goatsuckers  (Fig.  196),  &c.;  this  permits 


FIG.  195. — BILL  OF  BEK- 

KATER. 


FIG.  196. — BILL  OF  GOAT- 
SUCKER. 


FIG.  197 — BILL  OF 
SPARROW. 


them  easily  to  engulf  their  prey  in  their  wide  throats.  Grani- 
vorous  Birds,  on  the  contrary,  have  a  short  thick  beak,  arched 
above,  or  conical,  and  generally  straight,  as  in  the  Sparrow 

cc2 


380 


BILL    AND    TONGUE   OF   BIRDS. 


FIG.  198.— BEAK  OF  HORNBILL. 


(Fig.  197).  A  still  more  remarkable  modification  of  this  organ 
is  presented  by  the  Pelicans  (Fig.  303),  aquatic  Birds,  that  carry 
between  the  two  branches  of  the  lower  jaw  a  large  and  very 

extensible  pouch  of 
skin ;  in  which  they 
store  up  the  produce 
of  their  fishing,  after- 
wards disgorging  it, 
and  feeding  on  it  at 
their  leisure.  We 
must  also  remark  that 
the  beaks  of  some 
Birds  present  singu- 
larities of  form,  the 
use  of  which  is  not  known  to  us;  such,  for  instance,  as  the 
kind  of  helmet  on  the  top  of  the  bill  of  the  Cassowary 
(Fig.  276) ;  and  a  similar  excrescence  on  the  beak  of  the 
Hornbill  (Fig.  198). 

343.  The  tongue  is  sometimes  employed  in  the  prehension 
of  food,  as  well  as  in  deglutition;  and  presents  remarkable 
peculiarities  of  structure.  The  Os  Hyoides,  on  which  it  rests, 
is  prolonged  backwards  in  the  form  of  two  horns,  which  rise 
behind  the  head,  and  which  give  attachment  at  their  extremity 
to  muscles  (m  Fig.  199)  fixed  anteriorly  to  the  lower  jaw ; 
when  these  muscles  contract,  they  draw  these  horns  downwards 
and  forwards,  and  conse-  tr  g  p  m  k  t 

quently  push  the  tongue  out 
of  the  mouth.  This  mecha- 
nism is  particularly  curious 
in  the  "Woodpeckers,  and  in 
other  Birds  which  dart  out 
their  tongues  with  rapidity  Fm  199._ToN6UE,  GLOrnSj  &c..  Mongue. 

On    the    insects  which  COnsti-   »,  hyoid  bone;  m,  muscles;  p,  pharynx;  g, 
•  i     .      f      i      /TT       ctf\f\\     glottis;  tr,  trachea;  e,  oesophagus. 

tute  their  food    (Fig.  200).  * 

This  organ   also   presents   important   differences   in   its   form. 
In  Parroquets,  which  to  a  certain  extent  masticate  their  fo< 
the  tongue  is  thick  and  fleshy ;  in  Birds  of  Prey  it  is  broad  ai 


DIGESTIVE   APPARATUS    OF    BIRDS.  381 

very  soft ;  in  most  granivorous  Birds  it  is  dry,  triangular,  and 
beset  towards  the  base  with  small  cartilaginous  points ;  and  in 
some  insectivorous  Birds,  its  extremity  is  armed  with  hooks 


Tongue. 


FIG.  200. — SKULL  OF  WOODPECKER. 

or  is  jagged.  The  salivary  glands  are  placed  under  the  tongue, 
and  consist  of  a  mass  of  small  rounded  follicles ;  the  saliva  is 
generally  thick ;  and  sometimes  it  is  quite  glutinous. 

344.  The  Pharynx  is  not  separated  from  the  mouth  by  a 
movable  partition,  as  in  the  Mammalia ;  and  has  no  peculiarities. 
The  (Esophagus  (Fig.  201)  beginning  at  the  inferior  part  of  the 
neck,  communicates  with  the  first  digestive  cavity  named  the 
crop  ;  the  sides  of  which  are  membranous.  The  food  remains 
for  a  certain  time  in  this  first  stomach,  whose  form  and  size 
vary.  It  is  in  the  granivorous  Birds,  that  the  crop  is  most 
developed ;  it  is  also  found  in  Birds  of  Prey ;  but  it  is  wanting 
in  the  Ostrich,  and  in  most  Birds  that  feed  on  Fish.  Below 
this  part  the  (Esophagus  is  again  contracted,  and  presents 
further  down  a  second  dilatation,  called  the  ventriculus  succen- 
turiatus,  whose  internal  surface  is  perforated  by  a  considerable 
Dumber  of  small  pores,  communicating  with  follicles  that  secrete 
the  gastric  juice ;  in  general,  the  size  of  the  stomach  is  small ; 
but  in  Birds  deficient  in  the  crop  it  is  larger  than  usual,  and 
seems  to  take  the  place  of  it.  The  ventriculus  succenturiatits 
opens  below  into  a  third  stomach  named  the  gizzard;  in  which 
the  process  of  chymification  is  completed.  This  varies  much  in 
capacity;  but  it  is  particularly  in  the  structure  of  its  walls,  that 
important  differences  appear.  In  Birds  that  feed  on  flesh  only, 
the  sides  of  the  gizzard  are  tkin  and  membranous ;  but  in  those 
that  swallow  food,  which  is  harder  and  more  difficult  to  digest, 
it  is  furnished  with  strong  muscles,  intended  to  compress 


382  DIGESTIVE    APPARATUS    OF   BIRDS. 

and  to  grind  down  its  contents.  This  organ  is  most  muscular 
in  granivorous  Birds ;  the  thickness  of  its  fleshy  sides  is  con- 
siderable ;  and  its  inner  surface  is  covered  with  a  sort  of  almost 


CEsophagus. 


p    Crop. 


Ventriculus 
succenturiatus 


Gizzard  1^-—-- Liver. 


—  Gall-bladder. 
r-  Bile-ducts. 


Fio.  201. — DIGESTIVE  APPARATUS  OK  FOWL. 

cartilaginous  epithelium.  Its  strength  is  immense ;  in  the  Ostrich 
for  instance,  the  hardest  bodies  have  been  ground  down  by  its 
contractions ;  and  it  evidently  takes  the  place  of  an  apparatus 
for  mastication. 

345.     The  Intestine,  which  forms  the  continuation  of  this 


DIGESTIVE    APPARATUS    OF    BIRDS.  383 

series  of  stomachs,  is  much  shorter  than  in  most  Mammalia ;  but 
is  composed,  as  in  them,  of  two  portions ; — the  small  and  the 
large  intestine.  The  former,  after  having  taken  its  first  bend, 
turns  in  different  directions  ;  the  second  differs  from  it  but  little, 
and  is  not  much  enlarged  ;  but  it  is  generally  distinguished  by 
the  existence,  at  the  point  of  their  junction,  of  two  tubular 
appendages,  ending  with  a  "  cul-de-sac"  which  are  termed  cceca 
(ANIM.  PHYSIOL.,  §  214).  These  appendages  are  wanting,  or  at 
least  are  very  small,  in  most  Birds  of  Prey  ;  but  they  are  gene- 
rally long  and  large  in  granivorous  and  omnivorous  Birds. 

346.  The  Liver  is  very  large,  and  fills  a  great  part  of  the 
chest,  as  well  as  of  the  upper  portion  of  the  abdomen, — these 
two  cavities  not  being  separated,  as  the  Diaphragm  is  scarcely 
developed.     This  gland  is  divided  into  two  nearly  equal  lobes, 
and  generally  gives  origin  to  two  hepatic  canals,  which,  after 
uniting,  terminate  in  the  intestine.     There  is  almost  always  a 
gall-bladder,  which  receives  only  a  portion  of  the  bile,  and  sends 
it  into  the  intestine  by  a  separate  canal. — The  Pancreas  (sweet- 
bread) is  lodged  in  the  first  bend  of  the  small  intestine ;  it  is 
generally  long,  narrow,  and  more  or  less  divided. — The  Kidneys 
are  large,  and  are  lodged  in  hollows  excavated  in  the  upper  part 
of  the  pelvis  ;  there  is  no  urinary  bladder ;  but  the  ureters  ter- 
minate, as  do  also  the  oviducts,  in  the  dilated  extremity  of  the 
rectum,  which  is   termed  the  cloaca  (Fig.  201).     The  urinary 
excretion  is  almost  entirely   composed  of  uric   acid,   which  is 
not  soluble ;  and  the  amount  of  water  in  it  is  very  small. 

347.  The  nutritious  products  of  digestion  are  conveyed  from 
the  intestine  into  the  general  circulation,  by  the  lacteals ;  which 
by  their  union  form  two  thoracic  ducts ;   these  open  into  the 
jugular  veins  on  each  side  of  the  base  of  the  neck,  as  in  Mamma- 
lia (ANIM.  PHYSIOL.,  §  266). — The  blood  of  Birds  is  richer  in 
red   particles  than  that  of  the  Mammalia ;   and  these  bodies, 
instead  of  being  circular,  are  elliptical  in  form.    There  is  nothing 
peculiar  in  the  manner  in  which  this  fluid  circulates ;   and  the 
course  it  takes  is  the  same  as  in  the  Mammalia.     The  blood 
passes  from  the  left  ventricle  of  the  heart,  into  the  arteries  which 
distribute  it  to  the  several  organs  of  the  body ;  it  returns  into 


384  CIRCULATING    SYSTEM    OF    BIRDS. 

the  right  auricle,  and  from  thence  is  carried  to  the  right  ventricle, 
which  sends  it  to  the  lungs  through  the  pulmonary  arteries  ;  it 
returns  again  to  the  heart,  enters  the  left  auricle,  and  completes 
the  circulation  by  passing  into  the  left  ventricle,  from  which  it  set 
out.  The  heart  has  the  same  form,  the  same  structure,  the  same 


-»  Lingual  artery. 


Trachea   . 


Sacral  artery.  Cloaca. 

FIG.  202. — ARTERIAL  SYSTEM  OF  BIRD. 


position,  and  the  same  coverings  as  in  the  Mammalia  ;  the  walls 
of  the  left  ventricle  are  extremely  thick,  and  the  right  ventricle 
surrounds  it  on  the  right,  and  below,  without  prolonging  itself  to 
the  point  of  that  organ.  The  Aorta  at  its  origin  divides  in 


" 


CIRCULATING   AND    RESPIRATORY    APPARATUS.  385 

three  large  branches  ;  of  which  the  two  first  subdivide  into  the 
trunks  that  convey  the  blood  to  the  head  (the  carotid  arteries), 
to  the  wings  (the  sulclavian\  and  to  the  muscles  of  the  chest 
(the  mammary,  which  are  of  large  size  in  Birds,  on  account  of 
the  great  development  of  those  muscles,  whose  office  is  to  draw 
down  the  wings)  ;  whilst  the  third  curves  downwards  around 
the  right  bronchus,  and  constitutes  the  descending  aorta.  There 
are  some  peculiarities  in  the  mode  of  distribution  of  the  arteries  ; 
but  they  are  not  important,  and  it  is  only  to  be  remarked,  that 
in  different  points  of  the  body  they  constitute  remarkable  plexuses, 
by  frequently  anastomosing  together. — The  venous  system  ter- 
minates in  three  large  trunks  ;  one  of  which  is  analogous  to  the 
Vena  Cava  of  the  Mammalia;  and  the  two  other  nearly  corre- 
spond with  the  two  subelavian  veins,  which  do  not  unite  to  form 
a  common  trunk  (or  superior  vena  cava),  as  in  these  last 
animals. 

348.     The  apparatus  of  Respiration  presents  more  remarkable 
peculiarities  than  that  of  circulation.     The  lungs,  as  we  have 


Trachea"" 


Pulmonary  vessels 


— Bronchial  tube 

_    __      opened. 

Bronchial  or 


Bronchial  tube 
opened. 


FIG.  203 — LUNGS  OF  BIRDS. 


already  said,  communicate  with  large  cells  hollowed  in  the  cellu- 
lar tissue,  and  thus  transmit  the  air  into  all  parts  of  the  body 
(Fig.  203)  ;  so  that  the  respiration  may  be  regarded  as  double, 


386 


RESPIRATION    OP   BIRDS. 


— the  venous  blood  coming  in  [contact  with  the  oxygen,  when 

passing  through  the   capillary  vessels  of  the  general  system,  as 

well  as  when  it  passes  through  the  pulmonary  capillaries. — The 

lungs  are  not  divided  into  lobes  as  in  the  Mammalia,  and  are  far 

from  filling  the   thorax ;   they  adhere  to  the  ribs ;  and  they 

present  at  their  inferior  surface  many  openings,  belonging  to  the 

bronchial  tubes,  which  traverse  them  in  different  directions,  and 

carry  the  air  into  the   air-cells  distributed  among  the  different 

organs  of  the  animal.    These  cavities  are  formed  by  membranous 

partitions,  or  by  laminse  of  cellular  tissue,  and  communicate  with 

one  another ;  some  are  found  in 

the  trunk,  of  very  considerable 

size;    and  others   are   prolonged 

towards  the  head,  and  between 

the  muscles  of  the  limbs ;  the  air 

thus  finds  its  way  into  every  part 

of  the  body,  and  generally  also 

into  the  substance  of  the  bones. 

An  examination   of  the  air-cells 

in  different  Birds,  shows  that  the 

quantity  of  air  thus  distributed 

into   the   different   parts   of   the 

body,  varies,   other  things  being 

equal,  in  proportion  to  the  energy 

and  continuity  of  the  movements 

of  the  animal;   thus  in   Eagles,     FIG  204.-LUNGs OF THK OSTRICH ;«  the 

o       '  heart ;  b ,  the  stomach  ;  c  c,  the  intestines ; 

SparrO Wha  wks,  and  Other  Birds  Of  <*> the  trachea ;  e,  the  lungs ;  ///,  air-cells, 

^  f  i    jj«    vx      AT  •      ji    • -i  in  which  are  also  seen  the  tubes  by  which 

powerful   flight,    this    fluid    pene-  these  air-cells   communicate  with    the 

trates  into  all  the  bones;  while  lungs" 

in  those  which  are  destitute  of  the  power  of  flight,  and  which 
walk  but  slowly,  as  Penguins,  &c.,  it  is  excluded  from  the 
greater  part,  or  even  from  the  whole  of  the  skeleton.  The  air 
is  generally  in  greatest  abundance  in  the  bones  of  the  limbs 
most  employed  in  locomotion ;  thus  in  the  Ostrich,  the  femur 
(thigh-bone)  presents  a  remarkable  development  of  the  air-cells. 
349.  Birds  have  a  more  constantly-active  respiration  than 
any  other  animals ;  they  consume  more  oxygen  in  proportion, 


INCUBATION   OF   BIRDS.  387 

aiid  have  least  power  of  resisting  the  effects  of  the  privation  of 
it.  They  produce  therefore  greater  heat;  the  temperature  of 
their  bodies  rises  to  108°  or  even  to  112°  ;  and  the  feathers  with 
which  they  are  covered  are  very  useful  in  preventing  the  loss  of 
heat  from  their  bodies,  when  they  rise  to  great  heights  in  the 
air,  or  when  they  are  partly  or  wholly  immersed  in  water. — As 
in  the  Mammalia,  the  organ  of  voice  depends  for  its  action  on 
the  respiratory  apparatus ;  but  the  sound  is  produced  at  the 
bottom,  and  not  at  the  top,  of  the  trachea.  As  its  peculiar 
structure  has  been  elsewhere  described  (ANIM.  PHYSIOL.,  §  685), 
it  is  not  requisite  to  dwell  upon  it  here. 

350.  Birds  are  oviparous,  and  do  not  possess,  like  the  ani- 
mals of  the  preceding  class,  mammary  glands  to  suckle  their 
young.  The  duration  of  the  incubation  (or  of  the  time  which 
the  young  Bird  takes  to  develop  itself  in  the  interior)  varies  in 
different  species,  but  is  nearly  constant  in  each  ;  in  the  Humming- 
bird, the  smallest  animal  of  this  class,  it  is  only  twelve  days ; 
in  Canaries,  in  a  domesticated  state,  it  is  from  fifteen  to  eighteen 
days;  twenty-one  days  for  Fowls ;  twenty-five  for  Ducks  ;  and 
from  forty  to  forty-five  for  Swans.  A  certain  degree  of  heat  is 
necessary  for  this  operation ;  that  of  the  sun  is  sufficient  to 
hatch  the  eggs  of  some  Birds  inhabiting  countries  between  the 
tropics  ;  but  generally  it  is  quite  otherwise ;  and  to  keep  up  in 
the  eggs  a  suitable  temperature,  the  mother  covers  them  with  her 
body,  and  places  them  in  a  bed  adapted  to  shelter  them.  Some 
Birds  are  satisfied  with  making  for  this  purpose,  a  rounded 
cavity  in  the  earth  or  sand ;  but  most  display,  in  the  con- 
struction of  this  kind  of  cradle,  an  admirable  skill  and  art ;  and 
a  point  not  less  remarkable,  is  the  regularity  with  which  suc- 
cessive generations  execute  the  same  labours,  and  build  their 
nests  in  exactly  the  same  mode,  even  when  the  circumstances  in 
which  they  have  been  placed  have  not  permitted  them  to  see  any 
others  or  to  take  lessons  from  their  parents.  They  are  guided 
by  an  admirable  instinct,  which  leads  them  to  take  a  number  of 
precautions,  of  whose  utility  they  have  no  previous  knowledge 
derived  from  experience.  The  sides  of  the  nest  are  usually 
formed  of  small  flexible  twigs,  sometimes  cemented  with  earth 
which  has  been  tempered  with  the  gummy  saliva  of  the  animal ; 


388  NURTURE  OP  THEIR  YOUNG. 

bttt ihelf  farm  and  arrangement  vary  considerably,  as  we  have 
<  !  <  \\li<  n  iif-cn  (A  MM.  I'IIVSIOL.,  §  704.)  Nearly  all  Birds  line 
lli«-ir  ne.sts  with  Hoft  substances,  v  Inch  they  collect  with  care,  or 
even  with  a  thick  and  soft  down,  which  they  tear  from  their  own 
breasts.  The  warm  and  li/^ht  substance  employed  in  domestic 
economy  under  the  name  of  cider-down,  comes  from  a  kind  of 
duck  named  Kider(Kig.  i^JIIJ)  ;  which  inhabits  the  isles  of  the 
An-t.ic  seas,  and  which  thus  strips  itself  to  line  its  nest  with  the 
down  torn  from  its  breast. 

.T)  1 .  liird.s  lay  their  eggs  generally  once,  sometimes  twice,  a 
year;  in  a  state  of  domesticity  their  fecundity  becomes  greater. 
The  number  of  eggs  is  greater  in  small  species  than  in  large 
ones  ;  Eagles  lay  only  two  or  three  at  each  season;  Tomtits  and 
Wrens  from  fifteen  to  twenty.  The  constancy  with  which  Birds 
sit  on  their  eggs  is  admirable  ;  sometimes  the  two  parents  divide 
this  labour  between  them  ;  in  other  cases  the  male  is  satisfied 
with  providing  for  the  wants  of  the  female,  while  she  is  sitting  ; 
and  in  other  species,  the  whole  charge  of  the  incubation  rests  on 
the  mother  alone.  In  general  it  is  only  with  reluctance,  and 
when  urged  by  hunger,  that  she  quits  her  offspring  for  a  few 
minutes;  and  when  her  young  ones  are  hatched,  her  maternal 
affection  leads  her  to  lavish  on  them  the  most  tender  cares  ; 
she  covers  them  with  her  wings  to  protect  them  from  the  cold, 
and  brings  them'carcfully-selected  food,  which  she  often  disgorges 
into  their  throats,  after  having  half-digested  it,  to  render  it 
more  suitable  to  their  tender  stomachs.  She  guides  their  first 
steps  ;  teaches  them  to  use  their  wings  ;  and  when  danger 
threatens,  shows  in  saving  them  as  much  courage  as  devoted- 
ness,  wo  may  almost  say  intelligence.  There  are  however  some 
Birds,  that  lay  their  eggs  in  nests  which  do  not  belong  to  them, 
in  order  to  have  them  hatched  by  strange  nurses  :  such  as  the 
Cuckoo,  which  lays  its  eggs  in  the  nests  of  Linnets,  Yellow- 
hammers,  Blackbirds,  or  any  other  insectivorous  Birds,  accustomed 
to  feed  their  young  with  what  would  be  suitable  for  the  young 
Cuckoos ;  and  (which  is  a  remarkable  circumstance)  the  foster- 
mother  becomes  a  tender  and  indefatigable  parent  to  these 
intruders,  although  they  deprive  her  of  her  own  offspring.  Some 
naturalists  assert  that  the  old  Cuckoos  take  care  to  destroy  the 


INSTINCT    OP    THE    CUCKOO. — MIGRATION.  389 

eggs,  which  they  find  in  the  nest  where  they  place  their  own  ; 
but  other  observers  state  that  the  young  Cuckoo  itself  throws 
them  out  of  the  nest,  or  drives  them  away  immediately  after 
their  birth.  The  illustrious  Jenner,  the  discoverer  of  vaccination, 
tells  us  that  he  has  often  seen  the  contrivance,  by  which  this 
little  intruder  gets  rid  of  its  feeble  companions  ;  the  young 
Cuckoo  slides  under  one  of  the  little  Birds  whose  nest  it  shares, 
places  it  on  his  back,  where  he  holds  it  by  the  help  of  his 
wings,  goes  backward  to  the  edge  of  the  nest,  and  throws  it  over  ; 
then  he  recommences  the  same  manoeuvres  with  a  second,  and  so 
on,  until  he  has  made  himself  master  of  the  dwelling.  "We  do 
not  know  what  it  is,  that  leads  Cuckoos  thus  to  abandon  to  other 
Birds  the  cares  of  incubation.  They  often  remain  in  pairs  near 
the  place  where  the  young  ones  have  been  deposited  ;  and  these, 
when  strong  enough  to  fly,  quit  their  foster-parents,  and  rejoin 
their  natural  ones,  which  now  undertake  the  care  of  completing* 
their  education. 

352.  The  instinct  which  leads  Birds  to  sit  on  their  eggs,  is 
generally  one  of  the  greatest  power ;  yet  this  impulse,  which  in 
some  respects  is  a  blind   one,  is  capable  of  being  modified  by 
external  circumstances.     Thus,  Ostriches  sit  on  their  eggs,  when 
they  inhabit  temperate  climates  ;  but  leave  the  incubation  to  the 
heat  of  the  sun,  when  they  live  in  the  torrid  zone.     It  would 
appear  also,  that  several  of  these  large  Birds  often  collect  their 
eggs  into  the  same  hole ;  and  take  it  in  turns  to  sit  on  them. 

353.  The   care  which   Birds   bestow  on   their  young,  is  a 
subject  of  observation  full  of  interest ;  but  it  is  a  more  singular, 
n,nd  consequently  more  remarkable  instinct,  which  leads  certain 
kinds  to  change  their  climate  according  to  the  season,  and  to 
make,  at  fixed  periods  of  the  year,  journeys  more  or  less  distant. 
Some  kinds  migrate  in  order  to  avoid  the  cold,  or  to  seek  a  less 
elevated  temperature,  and  go  to  the  south  or  to  the  north,  to  lay, 
or  to  pass  the  period  of  moulting ;  others  change  their  country  to 
procure  more  easily  the  means  of  subsistence,  as  happens  with  most 
insectivorous  Birds ;  but  there  are  some  Birds  which  take  regular 
journeys,  without  being  influenced  by  any  obvious  cause,  and 
without  their  change  of  place  appearing  to  produce  any  appre- 
ciable change  in  their  condition.     Whatever  may  be  the  circum- 


390  MIGRATIONS    OF    BIRDS. 

stance,  which  renders  the  periodical  migration  of  Birds  useful  to 
themselves  or  to  their  offspring,  it  is  very  evident  that  it  is  not 
this,  which  is  usually  the  cause  that  immediately  produces  the 
change.  Migrating  Birds  seem  to  experience,  at  certain  periods 
of  the  year,  a  necessity  for  changing  their  place  ;  as  they  expe- 
rience at  other  times  a  desire  of  constructing  nests,  without  being 
led  to  it  by  any  intellectual  calculation,  or  by  the  anticipation  of 
the  advantages  which  they  will  derive  from  it.  It  is  a  blind 
instinct  which  guides  them;  and  which  sometimes  developes 
itself  independently  of  everything,  which  would  at  the  time 
influence  the  well-being  of  the  animal.  Thus  in  experiments 
made  on  some  Birds  of  Passage,  this  need  of  change  has  shown 
itself  strongly  at  the  usual  time,  though  care  has  been  taken  to 
maintain  around  them  a  constant  temperature,  and  to  give  them 
proper  food;  individuals  having  been  selected  for  the  experiment, 
that  had  not  yet  formed  the  habit  of  migrating.  When  they 
change  their  climate,  they  do  not  wait  until  the  cold  is  become 
insupportable  to  them,  and  are  not  gradually  driven  towards  the 
south  by  the  approach  of  winter ;  but  they  precede  it,  and  go 
almost  at  once  into  tropical  climates.  They  frequently  return  in 
spring,  when  the  temperature  is  much  below  what  it  was  at 
their  departure  ;  and  in  certain  kinds  the  migrations  do  not  corre- 
spond with  any  distinguishable  external  circumstance.  This 
phenomenon  is  therefore  inexplicable ;  but  in  this  it  does  not 
differ  from  all  those  determined  by  instinct  ;  and  as  we  advance 
in  the  study  of  animals,  we  shall  meet  with  many  examples  not 
less  interesting  and  incomprehensible. 

354.  But  because  migrations  depend  on  an  instinctive  and 
blind  impulse,  we  must  not  conclude  that  external  circumstances 
are  without  influence  in  developing  in  these  Birds  of  Passage  the 
need  they  feel  of  change  of  place :  it  is  remarked  on  the  contrary, 
that  this  phenomenon  generally  coincides  with  atmospheric  varia- 
tions ;  and  that  the  time  of  arrival  or  departure  is  often  hastened 
or  delayed,  according  to   the  cessation  or  continuance  of  the 
cold. 

355.  The  time  at  which  Birds  of  Passage  arrive  in  our  country 
or   quit   it,   varies  according  to  the  species.      Natives  of  the 
northern  countries  of  Europe  come  to  us  at  the  end  of  autumn 


MIGRATIONS    OF    BIRDS.  391 

or  the  beginning  of  winter ;  and  in  the  first  fine  weather,  avoid- 
ing our  heat,  as  they  had  done  excess  of  cold,  they  return  to  lay 
their  eggs  in  the  north.  Other  Birds,  which  are  born  in  our 
own  country,  and  which  may  be  considered  as  properly  belonging 
to  it,  quit  us  in  autumn  ;  and  after  passing  the  winter  in  warm 
climates,  they  revisit  us  in  the  spring,  or  perhaps,  avoiding  the 
moderate  warmth  of  our  summer,  they  emigrate  to  Arctic  regions. 
Others  again,  natives  of  southern  climates,  come  to  the  north  to 
escape  from  the  ardour  of  a  summer's  sun  ;  and  arrive  in  the 
midst  of  our  own  fine  weather.  There  are  also  some  which 
never  remain  in  temperate  countries,  but  merely  pass  through 
them  in  their  annual  migrations.  The  time  of  the  arrival  and 
departure  of  these  travellers,  is  generally  fixed  definitely  for 
each  species ;  and  experience  teaches  us  that,  in  certain  localities, 
sportsmen  may  depend  on  the  arrival  of  such  and  such  Birds  at 
a  given  time,  as  certainly  as  on  rent  which  is  due  on  a  regular 
day.  Age  causes  however  some  difference ;  the  young  seldom 
set  out  till  after  the  old  Birds ;  this  seems  to  arise  from  the 
circumstance,  that  moulting  taking  place  in  them  at  a  later 
period;  so  that  they  are  not  sufficiently  recovered  from  the 
malady  which  attends  this  phenomenon,  to  endure  the  fatigues 
of  such  a  journey,  at  the  time  when  the  old  Birds  are  ready  to 
undertake  it. 

356.  Another  fact  not  less  curious  in  the  history  of  Birds,  is 
the  power  by  which  they  direct  their  course  in  unknown 
countries,  and  distinguish,  at  immense  distances,  the  direct 
course  to  their  nests.  Carrier  Pigeons  afford  a  remarkable 
example  of  this  sense  or  instinct,  quite  incomprehensible  to  Man  : 
Swallows  furnish  another  instance.  These  little  Birds  make 
very  long  journeys  at  the  time  of  migration  ;  and  yet,  by  a 
singular  instinct,  they  know  in  the  following  spring  how  to  find 
again  the  places  where  they  had  formerly  established  themselves, 
and  always  return  to  them.  This  fact  has  been  ascertained,  by 
attaching  to  the  feet  of  several  Swallows  small  silken  threads, 
to  establish  their  identity.  They  build  their  first  nest  near  that 
in  which  they  were  born  ;  the  Chimney-Swallow  makes  its  nest 
every  year  above  that  of  the  preceding  year ;  and  the  House- 
Swallow  establishes  itself  in  that  which  it  had  quitted  the  autumn 


392  MIGRATIONS. SOCIABILITY. GENERAL    HABITS. 

before.  Spallanzani,  a  celebrated  Italian  physiologist  of  the  last 
century,  saw  the  same  couples  return  to  their  old  nests,  almost 
without  taking  the  trouble  to  rrpair  them,  for  eighteen  years 
consecutively.  Swallows  show,  on  other  occasions  also,  a  singular 
power  of  directing  themselves  towards  a  particular  place,  from 
which  they  are  at  a  considerable  distance.  If  a  hen  that  is  sitting 
is  carried  to  a  distance,  shut  up  in  a  cage,  and  her  liberty  is  then 
given  her,  she  first  rises  to  a  considerable  height,  as  if  to  recon- 
noitre the  country,  and  then  flies  in  a  straight  line  to  the  spot 
where  she  has  left  her  brood.  Spallanzani  repeated  this  experi- 
ment successfully  on  several  occasions ;  and  saw  a  couple  of 
River-Swallows  that  he  had  carried  to  Milan,  return  in  thirteen 
minutes  to  their  young  ones  left  at  Pavia. 

357.  The  instinct  of  sociability  is  also  much  developed  in 
certain  Birds ;  we  have  elsewhere  had  occasion  to  speak  of  the 
manner  in  which  several  of  these  animals  unite  in  the  construction 
of  their  habitations  (ANIM.  PHYSIOL.,  §  710) ;  and  we  shall  bring 
together,  in  the  later  portion  of  this  work,  some  facts  yet  more 
remarkable,  in  regard  to  the  association  of  Birds  for  particular 
purposes ;  but  we  must  at  present  be  content  with  observing, 
that  this  instinct  is  scarcely  ever  developed,  except  in  species 
living  on  insects  or  vegetable  substances ;  and  that  Birds  of  Prey 
live  almost  always  solitary,  or  united  only  in  pairs. 

358.  Birds,  as  well  as  Mammalia,  vary  in  the  manner  of 
procuring  their  food  ;  most  seek  it  only  by  day ;  but  some  are 
nocturnal  or  crepuscular  (flying  only  by  twilight) ;   and  it  is 
worthy  of  remark,  that  they  have  generally  dark  colours  and 
downy  plumage,  so  that  their  wings  strike    the  air  without 
noise  ;  as  if  the  Creator,  in  his  infinite  providence,  had  wished 
to  favour  these  Birds  in  their  nocturnal  pursuit  of  food.     The 
several  species  of  the  families  of  Owls,  Goatsuckers,  &c.,  present 
examples  of  this  coincidence,  between  the  habits  of  the  Bird, 
and  the  nature  of  the  plumage. 

359.  The  number  of  species  of  Birds  known  to  naturalists  is 
about  five  thousand ;  and,  as  the  organisation  of  these  anim* 
presents  great  uniformity,  the  classification  of  them  offers  coi 
siderable  difficulties.     The  characters  employed  to  divide  thei 
into  orders,  families,  and  genera,  are  furnished  principally  bj 


CLASSIFICATION    OP    BIRDS.  393 

the  conformation  of  the  beak  and  feet ;  organs  whose  structure 
corresponds  with  the  diet  of  the  animal.  Cuvier,  whose  method 
we  here  follow  with  little  variation,  thus  divides  them  into  six 
orders ;  the  RAPTORES,  or  Birds  of  Prey  ;  the  INSESSORES,  or 
Perching  Birds ;  the  SCANSORES,  or  Climbers ;  the  RASORES, 
or  Scratching  Birds ;  the  GRALLATORES,  or  Waders  ;  and  the 
NATATORES,  or  Swimmers.  To  these  we  shall  add  the  order 
CURSORES,  or  Running  Birds,  consisting  of  the  Ostrich  and 
its  allies  ;  which  are  included  by  Cuvier  among  the  Waders,  but 
which  differ  considerably  from  them. 

I.  The  RAPTORES,  or  Birds  of  Prey,  are  recognised  by  the 
strength  of  their  claws  and  bill  ;  the  upper  mandible  is  powerful, 
bent  at  the  end,  and  terminates  in  a  sharp  point  suitable  for 
tearing  the  flesh  of  the  animals  they  feed  on  (Fig.  192)  ;  and  the 
toes,  equally  vigorous,  are  furnished  with  strong  hooked  talons, 
by  which  they  seize  their  prey  (Fig.  186).     The  general  con- 
formation of  the  body  indicates  considerable  strength  ;  and  their 
appearance  denotes  a  ferocious  character.    Some  are  diurnal,  and 
are  distinguished  by  their  dense  plumage,  and  by  the  lateral 
direction  of  their  eyes ;  such  are  the  Vultures,  the  Griffins,  the 
Falcons,  the  Eagles,  the  Sparrow-hawks,  the  Hawks,  the  Buz- 
zards, &c.     Others  are  nocturnal,  and  constitute  the  family  of 
Owls ;  characterised  by  their  loose  plumage,  and  by  the  anterior 
direction  of  their  eyes. 

II.  The  INSESSORES,  or  Perchers,  have  weak,  slender  feet, 

formed  in  the  ordi- 
nary manner;  that 
is,  neither  palmated, 
nor  armed  with 
strong  hooked  talons, 
nor  elongated  into 
stilts,  and  having 
only  one  toe  di- 
rected backwards. 

Fro.  205.— FOOT  OF  SONG-THRUSH  AND  GOLDEN-  (Fig.    205.)        Their 

beak        is       weak, 
straight,    and  with   little  or  no   curvature   (Fig.  206)  ;    their 


394  CLASSIFICATION    OF    BIRDS. 

wings  are  of  moderate  size,  and  they  have  generally  light  and 
slender  forms.  Some  are 
insectivorous,  others  gra- 
nivorous,  others  again 
are  omnivorous  ;  in  this 
order  are  classed  all  Sing- 
ing Birds,  and  mostBirds  FlG-  206— BILLS  OF  NUTHATCH  AND  KINGLET. 

of  Passage.  The  number  of  INSESSORES  is  immense  ;  we  may 
cite  as  samples,  Magpies,  Blackbirds,  Linnets,  Swallows,  Goat- 
suckers, Larks,  Sparrows,  Crows,  Birds  of  Paradise,  Humming 
Birds,  Wrens,  King-fishers,  Hornbills,  &c. 

III.  The  SCANSORES,  or  Climbers,  are  Birds  which,  with  the 
general  organisation  of  the  Perchers,  have  two  toes  behind  and 
two  before  (Fig.  187) ;  an  arrangement  which  enables  them 
better  to  clasp  the  trunk  and  branches  of  trees  on  which  they 
climb  in  all  directions,  sometimes  employing  even  their  beak  to 
facilitate  their  movements.  Among  these  we  may  class  the 
Toucans,  remarkable  for  their  enormous  beak,  Parroquets, 
Cuckoos,  and  Woodpeckers. 

IY.  The  RASORES,  or  Gallinaceous  Birds,  have  a  beak  of 
moderate  size,  arched  above,  and  calculated  for,  a  granivorous 
diet  only ;  the  wings  are  short,  the  body  heavy,  the  feet  of 
ordinary  structure,  and  the  toes  weak,  but  generally  united  at 
their  base  by  a  small  fold  of  skin.  Most  of  these  Birds  fly  badly, 
do  not  perch  on  trees,  and  seek  their  food  on  the  ground.  This 
order  is  composed  of  two  distinct  families ;  Pigeons, — and  the 
GallinaceEe  properly  so  called,  comprising  the  Fowl,  Pheasant, 
Quail,  Partridge,  Heathcock,  &c. 

Y.  The  CURSORES,  or  Runners,  are  distinguished  by  the 
absence  of  wings ;  and  by  the  conformation  of  their  legs  and 
feet,  which  enables  them  to  run  with  rapidity  on  dry  ground. 
Their  legs  are  usually  long,  and  bare  at  their  lower  part,  as  in 
the  next  order ;  but  their  feet  are  not  in  any  degree  webbed. 
They  are  mostly  large  Birds ;  but  the  number  of  known  species 
is  very  small.  The  Ostrich,  Cassowary,  and  Emu  are  examples 
of  this  order. 

VI.     The  GRALLATORES,  or  Waders,  are  recognised  by  their 


CLASSIFICATION    OF    BIRDS.  395 

very  long  shanks,  and  by  the  nakedness  of  their  legs  towards  the 
bottom — an  arrangement  which  makes  them  look  as  if  mounted 
on  stilts ;  and  which  is  very  favourable  both  to  their  rapidity 
in  running,  and  to  their  fording  deep  waters  ;  their  toes  are 
long,  and  are  in  general  slightly  webbed  (Fig.  207)  ;  their 

figure  is  usually  slender  ;  and 
the  length  of  their  neck  is 
such,  that  however  high  they 
rise  on  their  legs,  they  can, 
without  stooping,  pick  up 
their  food  from  the  ground. 
Some  feed  on  vegetables, 
others  on  aquatic  Reptiles, 

FIG.  207. — FOOT  OK  PLOVER.  -.-•   ,,      1  u     TV  i         o 

Mollusks,  small  Fish,  &c. 

Among  these  are  classed  river  and  shore  birds,  such  as  Herons, 
Cranes,  Storks,  Bitterns,  Woodcocks,  Ibises,  Avocets,*  Fla- 
mingoes, &c. 

VII.  The  NATATORES,  palmated,  or  Swimming  Birds,  are 
characterised  by  having  their  legs,  which  are  of  moderate 
length,  terminated  by  broad  swimming  paddles.  These  oars  are 
formed  by  the  connection  of  the  toes  by  a  fold  of  the  skin 
(Fig.  190)  ;  and  are  generally  placed  very  far  back ;  which 
arrangement  renders  swimming  easy,  but  walking  difficult.  "We 
may  mention  as  examples  of  this  group,  the  Auks  and  the  Pen- 
guins, whose  wings  are  so  short  as  to  render  them  useless  for 
flight;  the  Petrels,  Albatrosses,  Gulls,  and  Sea-Swallows,  which 
have,  on  the  contrary,  long  wings,  and  a  powerful  flight ;  and  the 
Pelicans,  Frigates,  and  Gannets,  which  are  as  well  organised  for 
flight  as  the  preceding,  and  which  are  remarkable  for  a  more 
complete  palmation  of  the  feet ;  also,  Swans,  Geese,  and  Ducks, 
whose  beak  is  covered  with  a  soft  skin,  instead  of  being  protected 
with  horn. 

360.  Of  these  orders,  that  of  INSESSORES  is  probably  to  be 
regarded  as  typical  of  the  class  ;  since  it  presents,  in  the  highest 
degree,  all  those  characters  by  which  the  whole  group  is  distin- 
guished,— swiftness  of  flight,  beauty  of  plumage,  powers  of  song, 
the  small  or  moderate  size  of  the  body,  and  the  high  development 

D  D  2 


396  ORDER    RAPTORES  ; — GENERAL    CHARACTERS. 

of  those  instinctive  propensities,  which  manifest  themselves  in  the 
construction  of  their  nests,  and  in  their  migrations.  It  is  usual, 
however,  to  commence  with  the  order  RAPTORES  ;  as  being  the 
one  that  contains  the  most  powerful  species  of  the  class. 


ORDER  I.— RAPTORES. 

361.  The  Birds  of  Prey  are  for  the  most  part  easily  distin- 
guished from  all  others,  by  their  strong,  curved,  sharp-edged,  and 
sharp-pointed  bills  :  of  which  the  upper  mandible  is  longer  than 
the  lower,  so  as  to  form  a  sort  of  pointed  hook,  which  is  very 
serviceable  in  tearing  their  prey ;  whilst  its  edge  is  notched,  so  as 
to  form  a  kind  of  projecting  tooth  on  either  side.  We  shall 
presently  find  that  the  degree  in  which  these  characters  exist  in 
the  several  families  of  the  order,  corresponds  closely  with  the 
rapacity  of  their  habits.  The  body  is  large  and  muscular  ;  sur- 
passing in  its  dimensions  that  of  nearly  all  other  Birds.  It  is 
supported  upon  robust  legs,  which  are  generally  short  (the 
species  which  have  long  legs  being  aberrant  forms  of  the  order)  ; 
and  the  feet  possess  four  strong  toes,  one  of  them  directed  back- 
wards, which  are  all  armed  with  long  and  crooked  talons.  Their 
wings  are  usually  large,  and  their  flight  prompt,  rapid,  and 
powerful ;  but  in  this  respect  there  are  considerable  variations, 
according  to  the  habits  of  the  several  species,  and  the  food  on 
which  they  are  destined  to  exist.  Thus,  the  true  Falcons  will 
only  devour  (except  in  a  domesticated  state,  or  when  hard- 
pressed  by  hunger)  the  flesh  of  other  Birds  which  they  have 
struck  down  on  the  wing  ;  and  their  whole  conformation  is 
adapted  for  rapid  and  energetic  flight.  The  Eagles  also  are  des- 
tined to  feed  upon  the  flesh  of  animals  recently  killed  ;  but  they 
will  descend  to  the  earth  to  obtain  it,  and  often  carry  off  the 
bodies  of  Mammalia  of  considerable  bulk ;  their  flight  is  not  so 
rapid  as  that  of  the  Falcons,  but  it  is  very  powerful,  in  order 
that  they  may  sustain  great  weights  whilst  on  the  wing.  The 
Vultures,  on  the  other  hand,  gorge  themselves  on  carrion  ;  their 


ORDER    RAPTORES; — GENERAL    CHARACTERS.  397 

office  being  to  remove  the  decomposing  flesh  of  the  larger  animals, 
which  would  otherwise  poison  the  atmosphere  around.  They  do 
not  usually  attempt  to  carry  away  these  masses  to  their  nests, 
but  content  themselves  with  devouring  as  much  as  their  stomachs 
(which  are  very  capacious)  will  hold ;  and  they  consequently 
require  neither  the  same  swiftness  nor  power  of  flight,  that  the 
Falcons  and  Eagles  possess.  Lastly,  the  Owls,  which  are  noc- 
turnal Birds  of  Prey,  obtain  their  food  rather  by  the  stealthiness 
with  which  they  approach  it,  than  by  the  vigour  with  which 
they  attack  it;  and  as  it  consists  of  small  animals,  they  do  not 
require  any  considerable  power  of  flight  in  order  to  carry  it  off. 
The  peculiar  nature  of  their  plumage  is  in  manifest  accordance 
with  these  habits ;  for  the  loose  downy  character  of  their  wing- 
feathers  imparts  to  their  flight  an  extraordinary  noiselessness ; 
whilst  it  prevents  them  from  striking  the  air  with  any  force. 

362.  It  is  impossible  not  to  recognise  the  obvious  analogies 
between  the  different  groups  of  Carnivorous  Mammalia,   and 
those  of  the  Predacious  Birds.     The  bold  and  powerful  Eagles 
obviously  resemble  the  Lion  and  the  other  large  Felines ;  the 
smaller  and  yet  more  active  and  sanguinary  Falcons  correspond 
with  the  smaller  Felines,  and  with  the  Mustelidae ;  the  cowardly 
carrion-feeding  Vultures  resemble  the  Hyaena  and  Wild  Dog ; 
whilst  the  Owls   may  be   likened  to  the  nocturnal  Viverridae. 
We  shall  also  find  that  there  are  certain  species,  which  are  aquatic 
in  their  habits ;  and  which  are  parallel,  therefore,  to  the  Otters 
and  Seals. 

363.  The  RAPTORES  always  associate  in  pairs  ;  and  it  appears 
that  the  same  males  and  females  live  together  during  their  whole 
lives, — instead  of  pairing  afresh  every  season,  which  is  the  case 
with  many  Birds  of  other  orders.     It  is  remarkable  that,  in  a 
large  proportion   of  this  order,  the  female  is  larger  than  the 
male  ;  but  the  general  rule  holds  good  here  as  elsewhere,  that 
her  plumage  is  less  vivid  in  its  colours.     The  Birds  of  prey  are 
seldom  remarkable,  however,  for  the  brilliancy  of  their  aspect ; 
their  feathers  being  generally  of  a  brownish  hue,  more  or  less 
varied  with  white.      They  are  completely  destitute  of  the  power 
of  song ;  a  hoarse  cry,  or  call- note,  being  all  the  sound  that  they 


398  ORDER    RAPTORES  ; DIVISION    INTO    FAMILIES. 

utter.  They  build  their  nests  in  lofty  situations,  such  as  the 
ledges  of  rocks,  the  tops  of  high  trees,  &c.  ;  and  construct  them 
without  any  great  art.  They  s.lolom  lay  more  than  four  eggs; 
— frequently  only  two  or  three ;  and  the  young  come  forth  in 
a  blind  and  feeble  state,  requiring  the  assistance  of  the  parent 
for  some  time.  In  this  respect,  there  is  another  analogy  between 
the  Birds  of  Prey  and  the  Carnivorous  Mammalia ;  the  young  of 
which  last  also  come  into  the  world  in  a  blind  and  weak  condi- 
tion, and  are  long  dependent  upon  their  parents  for  their  nourish- 
ment. The  task  of  supporting  the  young  Birds  of  Prey  chiefly 
devolves  upon  the  female  ;  and  it  is  probably  on  this  account 
that  she  is  larger  and  more  powerful  than  the  male. 

364.  The  order  may  be  divided  into  four  families,  as  follows. 
I.  FALCONID.E,  the  Falcons,  Eagles,  and  Hawks,  in  which  the 
head,  neck,  and  tarsi  (or  shanks)  are  covered  with  feathers ;  the 
bill  short,  very  strong,  and  hooked  at  its  point,  and  the  upper 
mandible  more  or  less  toothed  ;  and  the  talons  very  acute  and 
strongly  curved.  In  this  family,  therefore,  are  most  strongly 
displayed  the  characters  which  mark  the  order ;  and  it  is 
obviously  to  be  regarded  as  the  typical  group. — II.  VULTURID^E, 
the  Vultures,  in  which  the  bill  is  longer,  straight  at  the  base, 
and  slightly  or  not  at  all  toothed  ;  and  in  which  the  head,  neck, 
and  tarsi  are  bare  of  feathers. — III.  The  GYPOGERANIDJE, 
including  only  a  single  species,  the  Secretary,  which  is  allied  to 
both  the  Eagles  and  Falcons,  but  differs  from  both  in  the  extra- 
ordinary length  of  its  tarsi,  in  which  it  resembles  the  Waders. 
— The  preceding  family,  which  all  agree  in  the  lateral  direction 
of  their  eyes,  constitute  the  division  of  the  Diurnal  Birds  of 
Prey;  the  Nocturnal  division,  in  which  the  eyes  are  directed 
forwards,  consists  but  of  one  family ;— IV.  The  STRIGID^:,  or 
Owl  tribe,  which  is  characterised  by  the  downiness  of  the 
plumage ;  the  comparative  weakness  of  the  beak,  and  the 
absence  of  teeth  in  the  upper  mandible ;  and  by  the  compara- 
tive slenderness  of  the  claws,  of  which  the  outer  one  can  in 
general  be  reversed,  so  as  to  bring  two  against  two,  and  thus 
to  give  a  firmer  grasp. 
^  365.  Among  the  family  FALCONID.E,  we  shall  first  notice 


l 


FAMILY    FALCONID.E  ; FALCONS. 


399 


the  true  Falcons,  which  are  the  most  bold  and  daring,  in  propor- 
tion to  their  size,  of  all  the  Birds  of  Prey.  They  are  peculiarly 
symmetrical  in  their  forms;  and  their  flight  is  graceful  as  well  as 
vigorous.  Their  wings  are  exceedingly  firm  in  their  texture,  so 
as  to  oppose  the  most  complete  re- 
sistance to  the  air ;  the  keel  of  their 
sternum  is  extremely  prominent, 
indicating  the  large  size  of  the  pec- 
toral muscles ;  and  the  furcula,  as 
well  as  the  coracoid  bones,  by  which 
the  shoulders  are  rendered  firm,  are 
very  strong.  None  of  the  bones  are 
very  long  ;  and  those  of  the  legs, 
which  are  not  much  used  for  walking, 
are  rather  short :  but  they  are  firm 
and  well-proportioned  ;  and  the  pro- 
cesses towards  their  extremities, 
whether  for  giving  firmness  to  the 
joints,  insertion  to  the  muscles,  or 
lever-power  to  the  tendons,  are  very 
conspicuous.  The  bones  of  the  trunk 
are  very  firmly  knit  together ;  whilst 
those  of  the  neck  and  limbs  are  so 
united,  as  to  give  to  these  parts  great 
flexibility,  in  combination  with 
strength.  The  sight  of  the  Falcons 
is  very  acute ;  enabling  them  to  dis- 
FIO.  208. -SKELETON  OF JER  FALCON,  cern  their  prey  at  great  distances, 
and  to  pounce  down  upon  it  with 

unerring  certainty.  The  wings  are  pointed, — the  primary 
feathers  extending  far  beyond  the  secondaries  ;  the  two  first 
quills  are  the  longest  (the  second  feather  extending  somewhat 
further  than  the  first),  and  the  others  are  gradually  shortened. 
These  pointed  wings  are  not  so  good  for  straightforward  flight  in 
perfectly  still  air,  as  wings  which  are  broader  ;  and  therefore, 
when  there  is  no  wind,  and  the  Falcon  is  desiring  to  move 
steadily  onwards,  its  flight  is  rather  in  ascending  and  descending 


400  FAMILY    FALCONID.E  ; — PEREGRINE    FALCON. 

curves,  than  in  a  straight  line.  The  same  may  be  observed  in 
the  Swallow  tribe,  and  in  other  birds  with  pointed  wings.  But 
the  form  and  position  of  the  wi:igs  adapt  these  birds  to  wheel 
about  with  great  facility;  and  to  gain  a  lofty  elevation  with 
great  rapidity,  by  flying  against  the  wind.  The  attainment  of 
this  elevation  is  the  great  object  of  the  Falcon  in  the  pursuit  of 
its  prey  ;  and  when  it  cannot  succeed  in  coming  up  with  the  Bird 
it  is  chasing  by  simple  onward  flight,  it  always  turns  towards 
the  wind,  and  is  then  seen  to  ascend  almost  perpendicularly. 
This  is  on  the  principle  of  the  composition  of  forces,  which  has 
been  elsewhere  explained  (MECHAN.  PHILOS.,  §  161)  ;  and  which 
is  the  same  that  raises  the  common  paper  kite,  and  keeps  it 
suspended  in  the  air..  For  the  position  of  the  wings  being 
oblique,  and  the  direction  of  the  wind  horizontal,  the  resulting 
motion  is  vertical.-  When  the  requisite  elevation  has  been 
attained,  the  Falcon  poises  itself  for  a  few  seconds,  and  then 
stoops,  or  darts  downwards  with  great  velocity,  striking  its  prey 
with  its  talons. 

366.   One  of  the  most  beautiful  and  powerful  species  of  the  true 
Falcons,  is  the  Peregrine  Falcon,  which  inhabits  all  the  temperate 
and  colder  parts  of  Europe,  ranging  from  Iceland  to  the  islands  of 
the  Mediterranean  ;  frequenting  high  and  rocky  mountains,  and 
building  its  nest  on   the  face  of   precipitous  cliffs.      It  is  an 
extremely  elegant  bird  ;  the  length  of  the  female  is  about  16  or 
17  inches ;  and  the  extent  of  the  wings  somewhat  more  than 
3  feet.     It  is  met  with  on  several  parts  of  our  own  coasts,  as 
well  as  in  the  mountainous  parts  of  Britain  ;  but  it  is  rarely  seen 
in  level  districts,  and  never  in  the  neighbourhood  of  marshy  land. 
The  insulated  rock  on  which  Dumbarton  Castle  stands,  has  been 
particularly  noticed  as  a  breeding-place  of  this  species.     It  is  an 
extremely  courageous  Bird,  and  attacks  other  Birds  of  much  larger 
size.    It  will  sometimes  attack  the  Kite ;  not,  however,  to  destroy 
it,  but  to  compel  it  to  yield  up  its  prey.  The  Gallinaceous  Birds, 
such  as   Partridges,  Pheasants,  Quails,  &c.,  furnish  the   chief 
supplies  of  food  to  the  Peregrine  Falcon  ;  and  from  their  heavy 
flight,  they  become  an  easy  prey  to  it.     But  it  will  also  give 
chase   to   Ducks,   Pigeons,    Snipes,   and   other  Birds  of  much 


PEREGRINE    FALCON. 


401 


greater  power  of  wing ;  and  will  continue  in   pursuit  of  them 

for  many  miles.     Its  forward  flight  is  estimated  to  be  usually 

at  the  rate  of  about 

60  miles  an  hour  ; 

but  its  riish  or  stoop 

is  probably  at  least 

twice    as    rapid   as 

this.      An   instance 

is  on  record,  in  which 

a   Falcon    traversed 

the  distance  between 

Fontainebleau     and 

Malta,  not  less  than 

1350       miles,       in 

twenty-four   hours ; 

in  this  case,  sup- 
posing it  to  have 

been   on   the    wing 

the  whole  time,  its 

rate  of  flight   must 

have  been  nearly  60  miles  an  hour;  but,  as  Falcons  do 
not  fly  by  night,  it  was  probably  not  more  than  16  or 
18  hours  on  the  wing,  and  its  rate  must  have  therefore  been 
70  or  80  miles  an  hour. — Of  all  the  prey  at  which  the 
Peregrine  flies,  the  Heron  appears  the  most  difficult  for  it  to 
master.  This  arises,  in  great  measure,  from  the  height  at 
which  the  Heron  flies ;  which  renders  it  very  difficult  for  the 
Falcon  to  rise  above  him,  or  "  get  the  sky  of  him ;  "  so  that, 
as  Falcons  can  do  little  or  nothing  to  a  Bird  above  them,  the 
Heron  is  in  perfect  safety,  as  long  as  he  can  keep  uppermost. 
Moreover,  the  Heron  can  ascend  as  rapidly  with  the  wind,  as 
the  Falcon  can  do  against  it ;  and  thus,  during  his  ascent,  he 
increases  his  distance  from  his  enemy.  Even  when  the  Falcon 
does  get  uppermost,  its  victory  over  the  Heron  is  not  so  certain 
as  over  most  other  Birds ;  for  the  Heron  can  so  turn  its  neck, 
as  to  cause  its  long  bayonet-like  bill  to  project  upwards  behind 
the  wing,  at  the  same  time  that  its  flight  is  continued  ;  so  that, 


FIG.  209 — PEREGRINS  F.ALCOIST. 


402  FAMILY    FALCONID^E  ; — JER    FALCON,    &C. 

when  the  Falcon  darts  downwards,  it  runs  the  risk  of  being 
impaled  upon  this  formidable  weapon.  The  difficulty  which 
the  Falcon  has  in  mastering  the  Heron,  made  the  hawking  of 
that  Bird  a  very  choice,  and  even  a  royal  sport ;  and  in  the 
days  when  Falcons  were  domesticated  for  this  purpose,  Herons 
also  were  preserved,  as  other  kinds  of  game  are  now. 

367.  There  are  numerous  other  species  of  Falcon,  of  which 
the  Jer  Falcon  is   the   largest.     Of  this  fine  Bird,  the  male 
measures  about  22  inches  in  length,  and  about  four  feet  across 
the  extended  wings ;  and  the  female  is  larger.     In  several  points 
of  its  structure  and  habits,  it  resembles  the  Eagles.     It  is  a 
native  of  the  extreme  north  of  Europe,  and  of  some  parts  of 
Asia ;  and  Iceland  appears  to  be  its  head-quarters.     It  is  some- 
times seen  on  the  coast  of  North  Britain ;  but  it  is  not  certainly 
known  to  breed  there. — The  Hobby,  Lanner,  and  Merlin,  are 
smaller  than  the  Peregrine  Falcon  ;  and  the  last  is  particularly 
distinguished  by  its  elegance  of  form  and  plumage,  its  swiftness 
on  the  wing,  its  courage  in  attack,  and  its  easy  domesticability ; 
qualities  which,  in   the  days    of  Falconry,   gained    it  especial 
repute  as  a  lady's  hawk. — The  Kestrel  is  another  Falcon,  having 
somewhat  the  habits  of  a  Kite ;  it  chiefly  preys  on  Field-mice, 
which  it   discerns  whilst   hovering    stationary  at  a   moderate 
height,  with  the  head  turned  against  the  wind. 

368.  The  true  Falcons  were  formerly  designated  as  noble 
Birds  of  Prey,  on  account  of  their  use  in  the  noble  sport  of 
Falconry  ;  the  remainder  of  the  family,  consisting  of  Birds  which 
cannot  be  trained  to  such  employments,  received  the  name  of 
ignoble  Birds.      The  Ignoble  Birds   of  Prey  are  distinguished 
from   the    Falcon   tribe   by  the  form  of  their  wings  and  bill. 
Their  longest  quill-feather  is  always  the  fourth,  the  first  being 
very  short ;   so    that   the   wing   looks   as   if  its   tip   had   been 
obliquely  cut  off.     Hence  their  powers  of  flight  are  inferior. 
Their  beak,  again,  is  not  so  well  armed  ;  for  instead  of  having  a 
sharp  tooth  near  its  point  on  either  side,  there  is  only  a  wavy 
edge,  or  festoon  about  the  middle  of  its   length.     The  bill  is 
generally   longer,    also,   and  consequently  less  powerful ;    and 
instead   of  being   curved   from   its    commencement,   as  in   the 


FAMILY   FALCONIDJE  ; — EAGLES. 


403 


Falcons,  it  is  generally  straight  for  a  greater  or  less  distance 
from  its  base  (the  part  where  it  is  attached  to  the  skull). 
Although  the  Falcons  are  the  strongest  and  most  courageous  of 
the  whole  order,  in  proportion  to  their  size,  yet  it  is  in  this 
division  of  the  FALCONIDJE  that  we  find  the  largest  and  most 
powerful  species. 

369.  The  Eagles,  which  are  distinguished  by  the  feathering 
of  the  tarsi  down  to  the  very  base  of  the  claws,  are  pre-eminent 
in  this  division  of  the  family } 
for  size  and  boldness.  The 
species  represented  in  Fig. 
210,  is  an  inhabitant  of  our 
own  country  ;  it  is  now  re- 
stricted to  the  mountainous 
parts  of  the  North  of  Eng- 
land, Scotland,  and  Ireland ; 
but  it  is  more  abundant  on 
the  Continent  of  Europe, 
where  it  does  not  confine 
itself  to  the  mountainous 
districts,  but,  in  level  coun- 
tries, frequents  extensive 
forests.  It  is  also  found  in 
Asia ;  and  it  inhabits  North 
America,  from  the  temperate 
to  the  arctic  regions; — so 
that  it  is  among  the  most 
widely-spread  of  all  species  of  Birds.  It  is  everywhere  regarded 
as  an  emblem  of  might  and  courage.  In  ancient  times,  it  was 
deemed  worthy  to  be  regarded  as  the  companion  of  the  gods, 
the  constant  associate  of  Jupiter  himself;  and  it  is  still  regarded 
as  the  "King  of  Birds,"  holding  that  rank  amongst  the  feathered 
creation,  which  is  assigned  to  the  Lion  among  Beasts.  This  dis- 
tinction has  probably  been  conferred  upon  it,  not  merely  on 
account  of  its  size,  strength,  and  courage;  but  also  from  its 
habit  of  soaring  to  a  great  height  in  the  sky,  and  of  its  frequent- 
ing localities  which  have  a  great  deal  of  wild  grandeur  and  rude 


FIG.  210. — GOLDEN  EAGLK. 


404  FAMILY  FALCONID^E; — EAGLE. 

sublimity  about  them.  The  Eagle  does  not  rise  in  the  air  so 
much  for  the  purpose  of  pursuing  its  prey  on  the  wing,  as  that 
it  may  be  enabled  to  take  an  extensive  survey  of  the  country 
beneath  ;  for  its  food  does  not  consist  so  much  of  Birds  that  pass 
most  of  their  time  in  flight,  as  of  those  that  live  on  or  near  the 
ground,  and  of  such  Mammalia  as  it  can  vanquish.  Thus  in 
one  eyrie  (or  Eagle's  nest)  in  Germany,  were  found  the  skeletons 
of  three  hundred  ducks,  and  forty  hares  ;  but  these  were  in  all 
probability  the  relics  of  such  prey  only,  as  it  could  carry  to  its 
nest ;  the  carcases  of  such  animals  as  sheep,  fawns,  roe-bucks, 
&c.,  which  were  too  large  to  be  carried  away  entire,  being  torn 
up  and  stripped  of  their  flesh,  and  the  skeletons  left  behind. 
The  astonishingly  acute  sight  of  the  Eagle  enables  it  to  discern 
its  prey  at  an  immense  distance ;  and,  having  perceived  it,  the 
Eagle  darts  down  upon  it  with  a  swoop  or  rush,  like  that  of  the 
Falcon,  and  more  terrific  as  its  size  and  weight  are  greater.  The 
stroke  of  the  foot  is  sufficient,  not  merely  to  dash  the  animal  'to 
the  ground,  but  to  dislocate  the  spine,  or  fracture  the  skull,  of 
the  smaller  Quadrupeds  and  of  those  Birds  which  form  the 
largest  portion  of  their  prey.  The  length  of  the  male  Golden 
Eagle  is  about  three  feet,  and  the  expanse  of  its  wings  about 
eight  feet.  The  female  is  about  six  inches  longer;  and  the 
spread  of  her  wings  about  twelve  inches  greater.  This  bird  is 
known  to  live  to  a  great  age ;  one  that  died  in  confinement  at 
Vienna  was  104  years  old ;  and,  if  tradition  may  be  believed, 
the  age  of  the  Eagle  in  its  natural  haunts  often  far  surpasses  this. 
In  this  species,  as  in  all  the  FALCONID^,  the  young  have  a  plu- 
mage very  distinct  from  that  of  either  of  the  parent  Birds, 
whose  characters  they  assume  about  the  third  year.  Hence  it 
has  happened,  as  in  many  other  instances  (§  18),  that  the 
young  have  been  described  as  belonging  to  a  species  distinct 
from  the  parent.  The  nest  is  composed  of  sticks,  twigs,  rushes, 
heath,  &c. ;  and  is  generally  placed  upon  the  jutting  ledge  of 
some  inaccessible  precipice ;  or,  in  forests,  near  the  summit  of  a 
lofty  tree.  The  young  are  generally  two,  sometimes  three,  in 
number.  Notwithstanding  the  reputation  of  the  Eagle  as 
a  Bird  of  fierce,  unreclaimable  disposition,  it  is  by  no  means 


EAGLES  ;    ERNES. 


405 


uninfluenced  by  kind  treatment ;  and,  if  taken  young  and  duly 
fed,  it  may  be  gradually  brought  to  familiarity,  and  even  playful- 
ness. Either  this,  or  an  allied  species — the  Imperial  Eagle — is 
employed  by  the  Tartars  in  the  chase  of  Antelopes,  Wolves, 
Foxes,  Hares,  &c. 

370.  There  are  numerous  other  species  of  Eagle,  in  different 
parts  of  the  world ;  varying  considerably  in  size,  and  also  in 
habits.  Many  of  them  frequent  the  sea-shore,  rather  than  the 
inland  heights  ;  and  feed  upon  Fish  as  well  as  upon  aquatic  Birds. 
These  last  are  termed  Ernes  or  Sea-Eagles  ;  and  among  them  may 
be  noticed  the  Cinereous  (ash-coloured)  Erne,  which  is  an  inha- 
bitant of  the  shores  of  many  parts  of  Britain  ;  the  Chilian  Erne 
(Fig.  211)  ;  and  the  White-headed  Erne  of  America.  They  are  all 


FIG.  211. — CHILIAN  ERNE. 


distinguished  from  the  true  Eagles,  by  the  absence  of  feathers  at 
the  lower  part  of  the  tarsi ;  as  is  seen  in  the  accompanying  figure. 
The  White-headed  or  Bald  Erne  is  the  Eagle  which  is  emblazoned 
as  an  emblem  on  the  national  standard  of  the  United  States 
of  America ;  it  is  a  Bird  of  noble  size  and  aspect ;  and  of  great 


406  FAMILY    FALCONIDyE  ; BALD   ERNE  ;    OSPREY. 

energy  of  character.  It  feeds  on  young  Lambs  and  Pigs,  Ducks, 
Geese,  Swans,  and  various  Sea-Fowl ;  and,  like  the  Peregrine 
Falcon,  it  attacks  the  Fish-Hawk,  when  rising  into  the  air  with 
its  finny  prey  in  its  grasp,  forces  it  to  drop  this  in  alarm,  and 
then,  suddenly  descending,  snatches  the  Fish  with  its  feet,  before 
it  reaches  the  water.  The  evolutions  of  the  Eagle  and  Fish- 
Hawk  as  they  rise  in  the  air, — the  one  striving  for  the  mastery, 
and  the  other  to  escape  with  the  prey  it  has  just  obtained  from 
the  sea  beneath, — are  described  by  those  who  have  witnessed 
them,  as  being  really  sublime.  This  Eagle  is  seldom  seen  alone, 
but  generally  in  company  with  its  mate ;  they  hunt  for  the 
support  of  each  other,  and  feed  together.  The  nest  is  usually 
placed  on  some  tall  tree,  and  is  composed  of  sticks,  clods,  weeds, 
and  moss ;  it  measures  five  or  six  feet  in  diameter ;  and  being 
annually  augmented  by  fresh  layers,  it  is  often  as  much  in  depth. 
The  young  are  from  two  to  four  in  number  at  each  brood ;  they 
are  at  least  four  years  before  they  acquire  their  adult  plumage  ; 
but  they  pair  and  breed  in  the  first  spring  after  their  birth. — 
The  Osprey^  or  Fish- Hawk,  departs  still  more  widely  from  the 
true  Eagles ;  being  adapted  for  feeding  exclusively  upon  Fish. 
The  tarsi  are  covered  with  scales  instead  of  feathers ;  and  the 
claws  have  their  under-surface  roughened  with  similar  sharp- 
pointed  scales,  to  enable  them  to  grasp  their  finny  prey  more 
securely.  Their  wings  are  long  and  ample  ;  and  the  second  and 
third  quill-feathers  are  the  longest.  The  Osprey  is  widely  spread; 
being  dispersed  over  Europe  and  a  great  part  of  Asia,  as  well  as 
North  America;  but  it  is  everywhere  a  Bird  of  Passage,  breeding 
in  temperate  regions,  and  going  southwards  at  the  approach  of 
winter.  It  is  more  gregarious  (that  is,  more  disposed  to  associate 
in  numbers)  than  Birds  of  Prey  generally  are ;  several  pairs 
living  in  the  same  neighbourhood,  and  pursuing  their  occupation 
in  harmony.  Indeed,  other  Birds  are  permitted  by  them  to  take 
up  their  abodes  in  the  interstices  of  their  capacious  nests,  which 
are  constructed  of  sticks,  sea- weed,  grass,  turf,  &c.  ;  and  which, 
being  repaired  every  year,  sometimes  becomes  a  good  cart-load. 
No  instance  has  ever  been  known  of  its  attacking  land  animals 
or  Birds,  even  when  pressed  by  hunger ;  and  hence  its  presence 


GRIFFINS  ; LAMMERGEYER.  407 

among  them  does  not  inspire  them  with  alarm.  The  Osprey  is 
about  two  feet  in  length  ;  and  about  five  feet  four  inches  in  the 
expanse  of  its  wings. 

371.  Some  of  the  Eagles  approach  the  Vultures  in  conform- 
ation and  habits ;  this  is  the  case  with  the  Griffins,  which 
belong  to  the  genus  Gypaetus, — a  term  that  includes  the  Greek 
names  of  both  Eagle  and  Vulture.  As  an  example  of  this  group, 
we  may  briefly  describe  the  Lammergeyer,  or  Bearded  Griffin  of 


FIG.  212.— LAMMERGEYER,  OR  BEARDED  GRIFFIN. 

the  Alps.  This  is  a  Bird  fully  equalling  the  largest  Eagle  in 
size  ;  measuring  four  feet  from  the  bill  to  the  end  of  the  tail, 
and  from  nine  to  ten  in  the  expanse  of  its  wings.  It  derives  its 
name  from  a  tuft  of  bristles,  that  projects  downwards  on  each 
side  of  the  lower  mandible.  As  in  the  Eagles,  the  head,  neck, 
and  tarsi  are  clothed  with  feathers  ;  but  the  expression  of  its  eye 
has  by  no  means  the  same  daring  and  resolution,  which  we 
admire  in  the  feathered  monarch  ;  and  its  bill  and  talons  are  far 
less  powerful  instruments  of  attack, — the  former  being  longer, 
and  hooked  only  at  the  point, — and  the  latter  comparatively 
small.  In  its  habits,  too,  the  Lammergeyer  differs  considerably 
from  the  Eagle,  and  approaches  the  Chamois.  It  feeds  upon  the 
bodies  of  animals  that  have  met  their  death  by  disease,  or  by 
falling  down  precipices ;  and  is  not  restricted  to  those  which  it 
has  itself  slaughtered.  Indeed  it  seldom,  unless  pressed  by 
hunger,  attacks  animals  which  can  offer  it  much  resistance ;  its 
general  habit  being  to  prey  upon  Hares,  Lambs,  Kids,  and  the 


408        FAMILY  FALCONID^E; — LAMMERGEYER;  HAWKS. 

weak  and  sickly  of  the  flocks.  It  is  said,  however,  to  destroy 
more  powerful  animals,  by  grappling  with  them  at  the  edge  of 
some  precipice  or  steep  declivity,  and  forcing  them  down  the 
abyss  ;  and,  when  rendered  desperate  by  hunger,  this  ravenous 
Bird  will  even  attack  Man.  Instead  of  carrying  off  its  prey  to 
the  nest,  like  the  Eagle,  the  Lammergeyer  gorges  itself  with  the 
carcass  upon  the  spot ;  removing  only  such  parts  as  it  destines 
for  the  nourishment  of  its  young.  Its  flight  is  sweeping  and 
majestic  ;  and  it  rises  almost  to  the  highest  summits  of  the  Alps, 
when  on  the  outlook  for  its  prey.  If  it  has  fixed  upon  a  living 
animal,  it  darts  down  upon  it  in  the  manner  of  the  Eagle ;  but 
if  it  be  attracted  by  a  carcass,  it  calmly  descends  to  some 
neighbouring  crag,  and  then  sets  out  for  its  repast,  flying  with 
heavy  wings  at  a  short  distance  from  the  ground.  A  number 
are  usually  attracted  by  the  same  object ;  and  feed,  like  the 
Vultures,  in  harmony.  The  Lammergeyer  is  an  inhabitant  not 
only  of  the  high  mountains  of  the  Tyrol,  Switzerland,  and 
Germany;  but  also  of  the  mountain  ranges  of  Africa  and 
"Western  Asia. — There  are  other  species,  belonging  to  the  Eagle 
tribe,  which  still  more  nearly  approach  the  Vultures ;  but  these 
it  is  not  requisite  to  describe  more  particularly. 

372.  The  Hawks  constitute  another  section  of  the  Ignoble 
Birds  of  Prey ;  but,  in  many  of  their  characters  and  habits, 
they  present  a  near  approach  to  the  Falcons.  Indeed  the  Gos- 
hawk was  formerly  among  the  most  valued  of  the  Falconer's 
Birds  :  it  does  not  rise  upon  its  prey,  however,  after  the  manner 
of  the  true  Falcons ;  but  darts  along  near  the  ground  with 
arrow-like  impetuosity,  threading  woods,  glens,  and  ravines. 
It  was  consequently  flown  at  Birds  that  chiefly  inhabit  the 
ground,  such  as  Pheasants,  Land-rails,  Pigeons,  &c.,  and  also 
at  Hares ;  and  for  this  purpose  it  is  still  occasionally  employed. 
The  beak  of  the  Hawks  resembles  that  of  the  Falcons  in  its 
general  form,  being  curved  from  the  base ;  but  the  wings  are 
shorter,  and  want  the  pointed  tips  which  are  characteristic 
that  division  of  the  family.  As  is  the  case  with  the  Falc 
and  Eagles,  the  most  powerful  Hawks  are  found  in  cold  lati- 
tudes ;  but  they  are  not  so  much  Birds  of  the  mountain,  th< 


GOS-HAWK  ;    SPARROW-HAWK. 


409 


storm,  and  of  the  free  sky, — rather  inhabiting  hilly  countries 
where  there  are  woods,  and  seeking  their  prey  near  the  ground. 
The  Gos-Hawk  is  unquestionably  the  finest  of  the  whole  tribe  ; 
being  distinguished  alike  by  its  size,  the  beauty  of  its  plumage, 
and  the  elegance  of  its  contour.  The  female  measures  about  24 

inches  in  length  ;  the  male 
J  9  or  20.  It  frequents  the 
deep  solitudes  of  forests, 
preying  upon  hares,  squir- 
rels, and  the  larger  ground 
Birds;  and  it  builds  its  nest 
in  lofty  trees,  preferring,  it 
is  said,  the  fir.  Notwith- 
standing its  size  and  power, 
it  will  not  attempt  to  con- 
tend with  even  the  smaller 
inhabitants  of  the  air,  such 
as  swallows;  for  when  a 
number  of  them  attack  it 
together,  they  drive  at  it  in 
all  directions,  and  so  perplex 
and  annoy  it,  that  it  retreats  to  a  sheltered  covert.  If  the  prey 
pursued  by  it  should  conceal  itself,  the  Gos-Hawk  waits  in 
patience  on  some  perch  commanding  a  view  of  the  spot,  until 
the  game  flies  away;  in  this  manner  it  has  been  known  to 
watch  a  Pheasant  for  more  than  fourteen  hours.  The  Gos- 
Hawk  is  now  rare  in  the  British  islands,  being  chiefly  restricted 
to  the  Scottish  Highlands;  but  it  is  more  abundant  in  the 
forest  districts  of  Continental  Europe,  and  extends  also  through 
the  temperate  regions  of  Asia  and  America. — The  Sparrow- 
Hawk,  though  much  smaller  (the  female  being  only  15  inches 
in  length),  is  much  more  daring  in  its  character ;  and  is  well 
known  as  one  of  the  terrors  of  the  English  farm-yard,  being 
very  destructive  to  pigeons  and  poultry,  as  also  to  partridges. 
No  Hawk  is  more  pertinacious  in  pursuit  of  its  prey  than  this ; 
for  it  has  been  known  to  follow  its  terrified  victim  through  open 
windows,  into  rooms,  barns,  and  churches,  undeterred  by  the 


FIG.  213. — GOS-HAWK. 


410 


FAMILY    FALCONID/E  ; — SPARROW-HAWK,  KITES. 


presence  of  Man.  This  Hawk  builds  in  trees  and  thorn-bushes, 
making  a  shallow  flat  nest  of  twigs ;  occasionally  it  occupies 
the  deserted  nest  of  a  Crow ;  and  in  the  Orkneys  it  breeds  on 
the  rocks  and  sea-cliffs.  There  is  an  African  Hawk,  equalling 
the  Gos-Hawk  in  size,  which  is  an  exception  to  the  general 
rule  in  regard  to  the  absence  of  the  powers  of  song  in  this 
order ;  having  an  agreeable  voice,  which  it  uses  every  morning 
and  evening,  not  unfrequently  continuing  its  strain  through  the 
whole  night. 

373.  The  Kites  are  much  inferior  in  the  strength  of  their 
bills  and  talons ;  but  their  wings  are  very  long  in  proportion  to 
their  size ;  and  their  tail  is  forked.  They  are  remarkable  for  the 

ease,  grace,  and  buoyancy  of 
their  flight ;  and  for  their 
power  of  remaining  for  a  long 
time  almost  motionless  upon 
the  wing.  They  sweep  through 
the  air  in  wide  circles,  sailing 
on  outspread  wings,  and  using 
the  tail  as  a  rudder;  and  they 
often  mount  to  such  a  height, 
as  to  become  nearly  invisible. 

Their  great  elevation  serves,  as  in  the  Eagles,  to  give  them  a  wide 
range,  over  which  they  cast  their  eyes  in  search  of  their  prey ; 
but,  having  discerned  it,  they  do  not  make  a  stoop  or  rush  towards 
their  victim,  but  skim  it  (as  it  were)  from  the  surface  of  the  earth, 
or  even  the  water,  and  bear  it  away  in  their  talons.  They  habitu- 
ally feed  on  moles,  rats,  mice,  young  poultry,  and  small  reptile 
but  they  do  not  refuse  carrion.  A  very  slight  show  of  resisl 
ance  is  usually  sufficient  to  scare  them  away ;  as  they  are  by 
means  courageous  Birds,  except  when  defending  their  young. 
The  common  Kite  or  dead  (which  last  name  seems  derived 
from  the  word  glide,  significant  of  its  motion),  is  found  in  nu 
parts  of  England;  though  it  is  not  now  so  abundant  as  formerly. 
No  longer  since  than  the  time  of  Henry  VIII.,  the  office 
scavenger  in  London  and  other  towns  was  chiefly  performed 
numerous  Kites ;  and  at  the  present  time  it  answers  the  si 


FIG.  214.— KJTE. 


FAMILY    FALCONID.E  ; KITES,  BUZZARDS. 


411 


useful  purpose  in  Turkey  and  Egypt.  Numerous  Kites,  in  a 
sort  of  half-domesticated  state,  are  seen  hovering  about,  or 
resting  on  the  tops  of  the  houses ;  and  at  the  signal  of  a  whistle, 
they  descend  and  clear  the  ground  of  any  carrion  which  may 
have  been  cast  upon  it.  The  nest  of  the  Kite  is  usually  in  the 
fork  of  a  thick  tree,  where  it  is  concealed  by  the  branches ;  and 
it  is  more  elaborate  in  its  construction,  than  those  of  the  Birds  of 
Prey  usually  are.  The  external  part  is  formed  of  twigs  thickly 
matted  together ;  and  the  interior  is  lined  with  wool,  or  some 
other  soft  and  warm  substance.  The  eggs  are  generally  three 
in  number.  The  young  remain  a  long  time  in  the  nest,  and  are 
extremely  voracious  in  their  appetite,  so  that  to  provide  for 
them  requires  considerable  labour.  At  this  period  the  audacity 
of  the  Kite  is  greater  than  at  any  other.  Several  different 
species  of  Kites  are  known,  inhabiting  various  parts  of  the 
world. 

374.     If  the  Hawks  may  be  regarded  as  an  inferior  kind  of 

Falcon,  the  Buzzards 
may  be  considered  as  hav- 
ing the  same  relation  to 
the  Eagles.  Their  bodies 
are  robust,  their  wings 
ample  and  rounded,  and 
their  tarsi  more  or  less 
feathered,  —  often  to  the 
toes ;  but  they  are  much 
inferior  in  the  strength 
of  the  bill  and  talons  ; 
though  the  former,  as  in 
the  Falcons,  is  curved 
from  its  base.  Their  flight 
is  easy  and  undulating ; 
they  have  neither  the  soar 
and  swoop  of  the  Falcons, 
the  arrow-like  dash  of  the 


FIG.  215.— COMMON  BUZZARD. 


Hawks,  nor  the  circling  sweep  of  the  Kites  ;  but  they  sail  easily 
and  rapidly  along,  and  hunt  in  quest  of  moles,  rats,  mice,  young 


EE   2 


412 


FAMILY     FALCONIDJE  ; BUZZARDS,    HARRIERS. 


rabbits,  reptiles,  and  insects.  The  Common  Buzzard  (Fig.  215) 
is  an  inhabitant  of  all  the  wooded  countries  of  Europe,  and  of  the 
adjacent  parts  of  Asia ;  and  it  is  also  found  in  the  fur  countries 
of  North  America.  It  is  a  Bird  of  considerable  strength  and 
size  ;  but  of  no  great  courage.  It  usually  looks  out  for  its  victims 
from  the  branch  of  a  tree,  on  which  it  perches;  and  when  it  per- 
ceives its  prey,  it  takes  wing,  gliding  rapidly  and  silently  on  its 
victim.  It  usually  builds  its  nest  in  a  tall  tree,  selecting  the 
most  retired  part  of  the  wood ;  and  it  defends  its  young  with 
great  resolution.  The  Honey  Buzzard,  belonging  to  a  different 

genus  from  the  pre- 
ceding, is  remarkable 
for  the  peculiar  cha- 
racter of  its  food, 
from  which  its  name 
is  derived.  This  does 
not  consist  of  honey, 
however  ;  but  of  the 
larvEe  of  bees,  wasps, 
caterpillars,  and  other 
insects, — not  to  the 
exclusion  of  moles, 
rats,  small  birds,  rep- 
tiles, and  slugs.  It 
is  a  very  rare  Bird 
in  Britain ;  but  it  is 
more  common  in  the 
warmer  countries  of 
Europe,  where  it  is  migratory ;  and  it  is  also  found  in  Asia. 
It  flies  low,  and  runs  on  the  ground  with  great  celerity. 

375.  The  Harriers  differ  from  the  Buzzards  in  the  greater 
length  and  slenderness  of  the  tarsi ;  and  in  the  inferior  robust- 
ness of  their  bodies,  and  the  length  of  the  wings  and  tail.  The 
plumage  is  soft,  and  of  looser  texture  than  in  most  of  the  Fal- 
conidse ;  and  the  feathers  round  the  face  are  so  disposed,  as  to 
form  a  sort  of  ruff,  analogous  to  the  disk  which  is  so  conspicuous  in 
the  Owls.  The  Harriers  are  more  active,  and  more  constantly 


FIG.  216.— HONEY  BUZZARD. 


I 


MOOR    HARRIER. FAMILY  VULTURID^E. 


413 


on  the  wing,  than  the  Buzzards;  they  chiefly  frequent  open  moor- 
lands, over  which  they  skim  in  search  of  prey  very  close  to  the 

ground;  and  they 
nestle  and  roost  on 
its  surface,  building 
their  nests  among 
reeds  or  fern.  The 
Moor  Harrier  (Fig. 
217),  the  largest 
species  inhabiting 
this  country,  is 
commonly  known  as 
the  Moor  Buzzard  ; 
it  is  a  native  of  most 
parts  of  Europe, 
Asia,  an'd  Africa  ; 
frequenting  boggy 
moorlands  and  ex- 
tensive marshes.  It 
feeds  upon  various 
kinds  of  Water  Birds,  which  it  surprises  by  its  almost  noiseless 
flight ;  also  upon  water-rats,  and  fish  which  expose  themselves 
to  it  by  swimming  near  the  surface  of  the  water.  It  will 
also  feed  on  carrion ;  and  like  most  Carrion  Birds,  is  somewhat 
gregarious  in  its  habits. 

376.  We  have  seen  that  the  Birds  of  the  family  FALCONIDJE 
have  for  their  office  to  regulate  the  numbers  of  living  Birds  and 
small  Quadrupeds  ;  and  that  their  head-quarters  are  in  the  cold 
and  temperate  regions  of  the  globe.  The  Vultures,  and  other 
Birds  of  the  family  VULTURID.E,  on  the  other  hand,  are  the 
appointed  cleansers  of  the  earth  from  the  dead  bodies  of  such 
animals  as  have  perished  from  other  causes ;  and  their  head- 
quarters are  between  the  tropics,  few  of  them  having  any  exten- 
sive range  to  the  north  or  south  of  these  lines.  Still,  however, 
they  are  for  the  most  part  inhabitants  of  mountainous  regions  ; 
and  their  abodes  are  often  on  the  confines  of  perpetual  snow . 
They  execute  that  kind  of  duty,  which  no  animals  but  Birds 


FIG.  217. — MOOR  HARRIER. 


414 


FAMILY    VULTCRID.E  ; VULTURES. 


could  perform ;  for  although  the  Hyasnas  and  Jackals  may  well 
effect  the  removal  of  decomposing  carcases  from  the  open  and 
level  country,  the  dense  and  tangled  forests  of  tropical  regions, 
and  the  almost  perpendicular  sides  of  their  Alpine  ranges,  would 
prove  inaccessible  to  any  animals  not  endowed  with  the  power 
of  flight.  Vultures  are  Birds  of  enormous  spread  of  wing,  in  pro- 
portion to  the  weight  of  their  bodies ;  and  even  in  walking,  they 
hold  their  wings  half  extended.  Their  flight  is  rapid  when  they 
have  an  object  in  view  ;  but  they  can  also  hover  with  very  little 
effort  over  a  spot  near  which  they  desire  to  remain.  The  bill  of 
these  Birds  is  hooked  at  the  point,  and  is  straight  at  the  base  ; 
their  talons  are  by  no  means  large  or  strong  in  proportion  to 

the  size  of  the  body,  and  they 
are  less  used  than  the  beak  for 
tearing  the  food.  The  cha- 
racter by  which  they  are 
chiefly  distinguished  from  all 
other  Birds  of  Prey,  is  the 
absence  of  feathers  on  the  head 
and  neck  (Fig.  218)  ;  whilst 
round  the  bottom  of  the  latter 
is  a  sort  of  ruff  of  soft  or 
slender  feathers,  arising  from 
a  loose  fold  of  skin,  within 
which  they  can  withdraw  the 
neck,  and  even  the  greatest 
part  of  the  head,  while  they 
remain  in  a  semi-torpid  state,  motionless  as  statues,  during  the 
digestion  of  their  meal.  Their  whole  plumage  is  deficient  in  the 
neat  and  regular  appearance  of  that  of  the  Falconidee  ;  but  it 
offers  so  much  resistance,  as  to  be  almost  impenetrable  to  shot ; 
and  it  suffers  so  little  from  exposure  to  alternations  of  weather, 
that  Vultures  in  confinement  frequently  wash  themselves 
thoroughly  and  hang  out  their  wings  to  the  sun  and  air  to  be 
dried.  In  these  characters  and  instincts  we  see  an  evident  adapt- 
ation to  the  mode  of  life  of  the  Birds  which  manifest  them  ; 
for  the  nakedness  of  their  necks  and  tarsi  prevents  these  parts 


FIG.  218.— TAWNY  VULTURE. 


FAMILY  VULTURID^i  ; VULTURES.  4  1  5 

from  being  rendered  so  foul  by  the  carrion  in  which  they  are 
buried  when  the  Vulture  is  glutting  itself  with  food,  as  they 
would  be,  clothed  with  feathers  ;  and  a  natural  instinct  seems  to 
guide  it  to  a  frequent  cleansing  of  its  plumage  from  the  soils 
which  it  must  receive. 

377.  Much  discussion  has   taken  place  with  respect  to  the 
mode  in  which  Vultures   are  directed  to  their  food, — whether 
by  the  sense  of  sight  or  by  smell.     The  probability  seems  to  be, 
that  they  have  the  power  of  scenting  it  from  great  distances, 
and  are  thus  drawn  to  the  spot  in  which  it  is  to  be  found. 
They  are  often  seen  to  descend  in  considerable  numbers  upon 
the  carcass  of  a  recently-killed  animal,  "  as  if  they  emerged  from 
a  cavern  in  the  sky;" — none  having  been  visible  but  a  few 
minutes  previously.     But  when  they  are  thus  drawn  towards 
their  prey,  they  are  probably  directed  to  the  exact  spot  by  the 
sense  of  sight.     It  is  certain  that  the  Vultures  have  an  organ  of 
smell  more  highly  developed  than  that  of  most  other  Birds. — 
They  can  endure  hunger  for  a  long  time,  and  will  often  sit 
patiently  for  many  hours,  or  even  days,  watching  for  the  death 
of  a  sickly  or  injured  animal ;  they  seldom  attack  it  before  life  is 
extinct ;  but  when  they  once  begin  to  devour  it,  they  gorge 
themselves  until  the  craw  forms  a  large  protuberance  above  the 
furcula ;  and  they  then  remain  for  some  time  in  such  a  state  of 
stupidity,  that  they  may  be  knocked  down  with  a  stick  by  any 
one  who  approaches  them. 

378.  As  interesting  examples  of  this  group,  the  following 
species  may  be  mentioned.     The  Tawny  Vulture  (Fig.  218)  is 
a  native  of  the  mountainous  parts  of  Southern  Europe,  and 
Western  Asia;    its  length  is  upwards  of  four  feet,    and  its 
strength  very  great.     Nevertheless  it  never  attempts  to  carry 
off  in  its  claws  any  portion  of  the  carcass  on  which  it  is  gorging 
itself;    but   feeds   its   young  by  disgorging   the   half-digested 
morsels  from  its  maw.     Occasionally  it  attacks  sickly  animals, 
which  are  incapable  of  defending  themselves ;  but  this  is  only 
when  no  other  mode  of  satisfying  its  appetite  presents  itself. 
The  Egyptian  Vulture  is  not  confined  to  the  country  where  it  is 
best  known ;  but  is  a  regular  visitor  of  Southern  Europe ;   and 


416  FAMILY  VULTURID.E  ; CONDOR,  KING  VULTURE. 

has  even  been  seen  in  this  country.  Its  utility  in  Egypt  and 
other  parts  of  the  East,  in  clearing  the  streets  of  filth  of  every 
description,  has  been  often  alluded  to  by  travellers ;  and  it  was 
fully  appreciated  by  the  ancient  Egyptians,  as  we  may  judge  by 
the  frequent  representations  of  this  Bird  upon  their  monuments. 
Its  common  appellation  is  Pharaoh's  Chicken. — The  Condor  of 
the  Andes  is  the  most  remarkable  of  all  the  Vultures,  in  regard 
to  its  size  and  strength,  and  the  great  height  at  which  it  soars. 
Its  dimensions  have  been  much  exaggerated,  however ;  its  length 
being  usually  somewhat  more  than  four  feet,  and  the  expanse  of 
its  wings  about  nine.  Its  breeding-place  and  habitual  residence 
is  usually  at  a  height  of  from  10,000  to  15,000  feet  above  the 
level  of  the  sea ;  and  it  is  often  perceived  soaring  at  an  elevation 
much  above  this.  Besides  feeding  on  carrion,  the  Condor  will 
frequently  attack  young  goats  and  lambs ;  and  when  two  are  in 
company,  they  will  set  upon  the  Llama,  and  even  the  Puma, 
persecuting  the  animal  until  it  falls  beneath  the  wounds  inflicted 
by  the  beaks  of  its  assailants.  The  strength  of  the  Condor  and  its 
tenacity  of  life  are  both  very  great ;  so  that  it  is  quite  a  sufficient 
match  even  for  a  powerful  man,  if  unarmed.  The  Condor, 
like  some  others  of  the  American  Vultures,  is  distinguished  by 
the  presence  of  fleshy  caruncles,  or  comb-like  appendages, 
resembling  the  wattles  of  a  Turkey,  at  the  base  of  the  beak  and 
on  the  forehead. — The  King  Vulture  of  the  inter-tropical  regions 
of  America  also  belongs  to  the  group  thus  characterised;  it  is 
much  smaller  than  the  Condor ;  but  is  remarkable  for  the 
brilliancy  of  its  appearance.  Its  general  plumage  is  of  a  bright 
fawn  colour ;  but  the  quill  and  tail  feathers  are  glossy  black, 
whilst  the  ruff  round  the  neck  is  of  a  delicate  gray.  The  naked 
skin  of  the  head  and  neck  is  deeply  tinged  with  mingled  scarlet, 
orange,  and  violet ;  over  the  upper  edge  of  the  beak  hangs  a 
loose  comb  of  bright  orange ;  and  there  is  a  circle  of  scarlet  round 
the  eyes,  which  contrasts  singularly  with  the  pearl  white  of  the 
iris.  It  is  not  a  mountain  Bird ;  but  inhabits  the  low  humid 
forests,  keeping  in  subjection  the  Turkey-Buzzard  and  the  Galli- 
nazo,  two  smaller  Vultures  which  frequent  the  same  localities. 
379.  We  next  pass  on  to  the  family  GYPOGERANID^E,  which 


//  tt. 


FAMILY  GYPOGERANIDJE  ; — SECRETARY.  417 

constitutes  the  last  group  of  the  Diurnal  Birds  of  Prey.  This,  as 
already  stated  (§  364),  includes  but  a  single  genus,  the  Secre- 
tary Falcon  or  Vulture ;  of  which  there  are  probably  several 
species,  differing  but  very  slightly  from  each  other.  In  its 
general  characters,  the  Secretary  approaches  some  of  the 
Falconidae,  especially  those  species  which  feed  upon  reptiles 
($  364) ;  thus  its  beak  is  short  and  abruptly  hooked,  and  its 
legs  are  clothed  with  feathers  much  lower  down  than  in  the 
Vultures;  to  which,  also,  it  has  little  resemblance  in  phy- 
siognomy. The  Secretary  was  so  called  by  the  Dutch,  from  the 
plumes  at  the  back  of  its  head ;  which  reminded  them  of  the 
pen  stuck  behind  the  ear,  according  to  the  custom  of  writing- 
clerks.  The  remarkable  feature  in  its  structure,  by  which  it  is 
distinguished  from  all  other  Raptores,  is  the  extraordinary  length 
of  its  tarsi,  which  raise  its  body  above  the  ground,  in  the  manner 
of  that  of  the  Wading  Birds.  This  conformation  adapts  it  to  its 
peculiar  instincts;  which  lead  it  to  prey  upon  Serpents  and 
other  poisonous  reptiles,  in  search  of  which  it  strides  over  the 
dry  open  plains  frequented  by  them.  It  is  further  armed  with 
spurs  on  the  elbow-joints  of  the  wings ;  and  these  are  efficient 
organs  of  defence,  by  which  it  parries  the  attempts  made  by  its 
prey  to  wound  it  by  its  venomous  bite,  and  by  successive  blows 
of  which  it  weakens  its  foe, — destroying  it  at  last  by  a  stroke 
of  its  bill,  that  splits  open  its  enemy's  skull.  Le  Vaillant  men- 
tions, that  having  killed  a  Secretary,  which  he  had  seen  to 
vanquish  a  Serpent,  he  found  in  its  crop  eleven  rather  large 
lizards,  three  serpents  of  an  arrcTs  length,  and  eleven  small 
tortoises  very  entire, — all  of  which  had  received  the  stroke  on 
the  head ;  as  well  as  a  number  of  locusts,  beetles,  and  other 
insects,  very  little  injured.  Besides  these,  the  crop  contained 
a  species  of  pellet,  formed  of  the  undigested  bones,  scales,  &c., 
of  the  animals  previously  devoured  by  the  Secretary ;  which  was 
destined  no  doubt  to  be  ejected  by  the  mouth,  in  the  manner 
common  to  other  Birds  of  Prey.  The  species  inhabiting  Southern 
Africa,  which  is  the  one  whose  habits  are  best  known,  builds  its 
nest  on  high  trees,  or  in  dense  thickets ;  and  is  not  at  all  dis- 
posed to  associate  with  its  fellows.  Another  Secretary,  which 


418 


FAMILY  STRIGID^i,  OR  OWL  TRIBE. 


is  certainly  of  a  different  species  from  the  South  African,  is 
found  in  the  Philippine  Islands ;  and  there  is  also  one  inhabiting 
Senegambia,  which  is  probably  distinct  from  either. 

380.  The  Nocturnal  Birds  of  Prey,  constituting  the  family 
STRJGID.E,  or  the  Owl  tribe,  are  distinguished  from  the  preceding 
by  many  important  peculiarities ;  besides  that  difference  in  the 
character  of  the  plumage,  which  has  been  already  adverted  to 
f  §  364)  :  and  all  these  peculiarities  have  reference  to  their  noc- 
turnal habits.  The  first  thing  that  strikes  us  in  their  appear- 
ance, is  the  large  size  of  the  head ;  this  is  partly  due  to  the 
looseness  of  the  plumage  with  which  it  is  covered ;  but  it  also 
shows  itself  when  this  is  removed,  and  is  caused  by  the  exist- 
ence, between  the  inner  and  outer  tables  (or  bony  layers)  of  the 
skull,  of  a  number  of  large  cells,  which  communicate  with  the 
organ  of  hearing,  and  render  that  sense  more  acute.  We  find  in 
Owls  an  external  ear,  or  conch,  which  exists  in  no  other  Birds  ; 

this  is  concealed  by 
the  feathers,  which 
are  arranged  in  a  sort 
of  hollow  cone  around 
it ;  and  in  some 
species  it  is  covered 
with  a  sort  of  lid,  or 
operculum,  which  the 
Bird  has  the  power  of 
opening  or  shutting 
at  pleasure.  In  many 
species  the  external 
ear  is  much  larger 
than  in  the  one 
here  represented. — 
The  eyes  of  Owls  are 
very  large,  and  are 
directed  forwards ;  they  are  surrounded  by  two  conical  disks  of 
feathers  (Fig.  220),  at  the  bottom  of  which  the  eyes  are  placed  ; 
and  these  being  usually  composed  of  white  and  shining  feathers, 
doubtless  serve  to  cause  the  feeble  rays,  by  the  aid  of  which 


Fio.  219. — EAR  OF  HOWLET. 


FAMILY  STR1GIDJE  ; OWLS. 


419 


FIG.  220.— EYE-DISK  OF  HOWLET. 


these  animals  hunt  for  their  prey,  to  fall  with  more  power  upon 

the  organ  of  vision.     It  is 
in  the  Owls  which  are  the 
least    nocturnal     in    their 
^iiiXfBHt  habits,   that    we   find  the 

external  ear,  and  the  disks 
around  the  eyes,  least  de- 
veloped. The  pupils  of  the 
eyes  are  very  large,  and 

^^  B?!iilHiip    Permit  s°  mucn  %nt  to 

enter,  that  the  Birds  are 
quite  dazzled  if  they  open 
their  eyes  in  full  day.  The 
apparatus  of  flight  is 
feeble  in  the  Owls;  since 
they  are  not  intended  to 
obtain  their  prey  by  swiftness  of  pursuit,  but  by  the  stealthiness 
of  their  approach.  The  loose  downy  plumage  of  the  wings 
allows  a  considerable  quantity  of  air  to  pass  through  it  at  each 
stroke  ;  instead  of  offering  a  firm  resisting  surface,  like  the  wing 
of  the  Eagles  and  Falcons.  To  compensate  in  some  degree  for 
this,  the  wings  are  long  ;  but  the  muscular  apparatus  by  which 
they  are  moved  is  not  remarkable 
for  its  power ;  and  the  bony  frame- 
work to  which  they  are  attached,  is 
much  less  firm  than  in  the  Diurnal 
Birds  of  Prey.  Thefurcula,  in  par- 
ticular, is  very  slender.  The  feet 
are  chiefly  remarkable  for  the  power 
possessed  by  the  external  toe,  of 
being  turned  either  backwards  or 
forwards.  The  digestive  apparatus 
chiefly  differs  from  that  of  the  Fal- 
conidas  in  the  absence  of  the  crop,  or 
craw ;  *  but  the  gullet  is  very  wide 
throughout;  and  the  stomach 
more  muscular  than  in  the  Diurnal  Birds  of  Prey. 

•  It  is  stated  by  Cuvicr  that  Owls  have  a  large  crop ;  but  this  is  an 


420  FAMILY  STRIGID.E,  OR  OWL  TRIBE  ; BARN  OWL. 

381.  The  greater  part  of  the  Owl  tribe  are  thus  adapted  to 
the  pursuit  of  their  prey, — which  consists  in  the  larger  species 
of  hares,  rabbits,  fawns,  birds,  &c.,  and  in  the  smaller  of  mice, 
rats,  moles,  small  reptiles  and  the  larger  insects, — either  by  night, 
or  in  the  dusky  twilight ;  and  we  find  this  family  most  abundant 
in  those  parts  of  the  globe  where  the  twilight  is  most  prolonged, 
— namely,  the  cold  and  temperate  regions.  Nevertheless,  there 
are  some  members  of  it  (constituting  Us  aberrant  forms),  in  which 
the  foregoing  characters  are  much  less  developed,  and  in  which 
the  habits  are  rather  diurnal  than  nocturnal ;  some  of  these  are 
known  by  the  names  of  Eagle  Owl  and  Hawk  Owl,  indicating 
their  resemblance  to  the  Diurnal  Birds  of  Prey.  The  Typical 
Owls,  whose  adaptation  to  nocturnal  habits  is  most  complete, 
appear  scarcely  capable  of  motion  during  the  day ;  they  remain 
at  rest  upon  their  perch,  with  their  eyes  half-shut  or  completely 
closed,  presenting  a  great  appearance  of  gravity  ;  and  when 
attacked,  or  struck  by  the  appearance  of  some  new  object,  they 
do  not  fly  off,  but  stand  more  erect,  assume  grotesque  attitudes, 
and  make  the  most  ludicrous  gestures. — The  family  may  be  sub- 
divided into  the  three  following  groups.  1.  The  Typical  Owls, 
which  have  a  large  external  ear,  and  large  and  complete  disks 
around  the  eyes.  2.  The  Horned  Owls,  in  which  the  conch,  or 
external  ear,  is  smaller,  but  the  disks  around  the  eyes  still  large  ; 
and  in  which  the  head  is  furnished  with  two  feathery  tufts, 
resembling  horns.  3.  The  Diurnal,  or  Hawk  Owls,  in  which 
the  conch  is  very  small,  the  facial  disks  wanting,  and  the  feathery 
tufts  absent. — Of  the  first  of  these  groups,  the  common  Barn 
Owl  is  a  very  characteristic  representative ;  it  is  spread  through 
the  temperate  and  warmer  regions  of  Europe,  but  is  not 
found  in  the  higher  latitudes,  where  it  is  replaced  by  other 
species.  It  conceals  itself  by  day  in  deep  'recesses  among 
ivy-clad  ruins,  in  antique  church-towers,  in  the  hollow 
of  old  trees,  in  barn-lofts,  and  similar  places  of  seclusion; 
and  at  night  it  sallies  forth  in  search  of  its  prey,  which  consists 
of  mice,  rats,  moles,  shrews,  and  large  insects.  Contrary  to  the 
general  opinion,  this  Bird  is  not  unfriendly  to  the  other  feathered 
tribes  ;  it  does  not  attack  them,  nor  do  they  seem  afraid  of  it  ; 


FAMILY    STRIGIDJ3; BARN  OWL,   HORNED  OWLS.  421 

and  it  has  been  found  very  useful  in  the  neighbourhood  of  dove- 
cots, in  keeping  down  the  rats,  which  very  commonly  abound 
there,  to  the  destruction  of  the  young  pigeons.  Mr.  Waterton 
has  noticed  that,  when  it  has  young  to  feed,  it  will  bring  a  mouse 
or  young  rat  to  the  nest  every  twelve  or  fifteen  minutes  during 
the  night.  Its  services  to  the  farmer,  therefore,  are  really  very 
great ;  and  it  ought  to  be  encouraged,  instead  of  being  regarded 
as  a  pest.  The  superstitious  dread  of  the  Owl,  which  is  still 
commonly  entertained,  is  partly  dependent  on  the  dismal  sounds 
it  utters ;  and  the  time  and  circumstances  under  which  this  is 
heard.  The  Barn  Owl  constructs  a  rude  nest,  in  which  three  or 
four  eggs  are  laid  at  once  ;  the  female  often  lays  a  second  time 
before  the  young  are  able  to  leave  the  nest ;  and  this  has  been 
known  to  happen  a  third  time,  so  that  the  nest  at  last  con- 
tained three  broods  of  different  ages. — Many  other  species,  more 
or  less  closely  resembling  the  Barn  Owl,  are  found  in  different 
parts  of  the  temperate  regions  of  the  globe. 

382.  It  is  among  the  Horned  Owls,  that  we  find  the  largest 
Birds  of  this  family.  The  Great  or  Eagle  Owl  (Fig.  222)  is  but  little 
inferior  in  size  to  the  Golden  Eagle  ;  and  is  very  destructive  to 
young  roes  and  fawns,  hares,  rabbits,  rats,  moles,  reptiles,  par- 
tridges, grouse,  and  other  game.  It  is  chiefly  found  in  the 
mountainous  parts  of  Central  Europe  ;  but  it  has  been  occasion- 
ally seen  in  Britain.  It  frequents  deep  forest  glens  ;  and  makes 
its  nest  in  the  fissures  of  rocks,  in  ruined  castles,  and  similar 
places. — The  Harfang  or  Great  Snowy  Owl  nearly  equals  the 
Eagle  Owl  in  size,  and  resembles  it  in  its  general  habits ;  but  it 
is  found  in  very  high  northern  latitudes,  of  both  the  Old  and  New 
World  ;  obtaining  its  food,  and  rearing  its  young,  among  rocky 
mountains  and  islands,  in  spite  of  all  the  vicissitudes  of  tempera- 
ture and  season.  It  is  indeed  one  of  the  hardiest  of  all  Birds. 
Its  head-tufts  are  small  and  inconspicuous  ;  so  that  it  has  been 
described  as  being  destitute  of  them. — Connecting  this  group 
with  the  next,  is  a  curious  species  termed  the  Burrowing  Owl, 
which  is  widely  spread  through  the  American  Continent ;  inha- 
biting the  burrows  of  the  Marmot,  Viscacha,  and  other  small 
Rodentia ;  and,  when  these  do  not  present  themselves,  making 


422  HORNED  OWLS  ;    HAWK  OWL. 

excavations  for  itself.     This  is   a  small   Bird;    its  length  not 
exceeding  ten  inches.     The  habit  is  not  altogether  peculiar  to 


FIG.  222.— THE  GREAT  OWL. 

this  species ;  for  even  the  Barn  Owl  occasionally  takes  up 
its  abode  in  the  burrows  of  rabbits.  Numerous  other 
species  of  Horned  Owls  are  found  in  different  parts  of  the 
globe. 

383.  Of  the  last  subdivision  of  this  family,  the  Hawk-Owl 
of  the  northern  parts  of  Europe,  Asia,  and  America,  may  be 
regarded  as  the  type.  This  is  the  most  diurnal  of  all  the  Owls 
in  its  habits  ;  pursuing  Birds  with  great  boldness  in  daylight  ; 
and  sometimes  even  snatching  game  that  has  been  shot  by  the 
fowler.  It  has,  indeed,  some  of  the  characters  of  the  Hawk  ; 
resembling  that  species  in  the  smallness  of  the  head,  the  narrow 
feet,  and  the  prolonged  tail ;  but  still  the  conformation  of  its 
feet,  and  the  feathering  around  its  eyes  and  bill,  bring  it  decidedly 


ORDER    INSESSORES,  OR    PERCHERS.  423 

within  the  Owl  family.  In  the  character  of  its  plumage,  also, 
it  bears  a  resemblance  to  the  Diurnal  Birds  of  Prey  ;  and  like 
them,  it  dashes  boldly  on  its  victim,  and  seizes  it  on  the  wing, 
instead  of  stealing  noiselessly  upon  it.  In  summer  it  feeds  prin- 
cipally on  mice  and  insects ;  but  in  the  snow-clad  regions  which 
it  frequents  in  winter,  neither  of  these  are  to  be  procured,  and  it 
then  preys  mostly  on  Ptarmigan, — the  flocks  of  which  are 
followed  by  it,  in  their  spring  migrations  to  the  northward. 
— Nearly  allied  to  this  species,  which  is  about  fifteen  inches  in 
length,  are  several  others  ;  which  inhabit  different  portions  of 
the  globe,  and  present  slight  variations  in  structure  and  habit. 
One  of  these,  a  native  of  Northern  Asia,  is  but  little  inferior  to 
the  Snowy  Owl  in  size. 


ORDER  II.— INSESSORES. 

384.  The  group  of  Perching  Birds,  included  in  this  order, 
is  the  most  numerous  and  the  most  varied  in  the  whole  class. 
It  comprehends  all  those  tribes  which  live  habitually  among 
trees,  with  the  exception  of  the  Rapacious  Birds  on  the  one 
hand,  and  the  Climbing  Birds  on  the  other.  From  the  former 
they  are  sufficiently  distinguished,  by  the  absence  of  those 
characters  which  have  been  mentioned  as  peculiarly  marking  the 
Birds  of  Prey ;  and  from  the  latter  they  are  at  once  known  by 
the  position  of  the  toes.  For  in  all  the  true  Insessorial  Birds, 
the  toes  are  three  before  and  one  behind  (Fig.  205);  whilst  in 
the  Scansores,  two  of  the  toes  are  directed  backwards  (Fig.  187). 
The  adaptation  of  the  foot  of  this  order  to  grasping  or  perching, 
is  evident  from  the  situation  of  the  hinder  toe  ;  which  is  in- 
variably placed  on  the  same  level  with  those  in  front,  and  thus 
distinguishes  the  Perchers  from  the  Gallinaceous  and  Wading 
Birds.  These  Birds  pass  the  greater  part  of  their  time  on  the 
wing,  and  only  use  their  legs  as  an  occasional  support ;  these 
members  are  consequently  short  and  weak,  in  comparison  with 
those  of  most  of  the  other  orders.  The  toes  are  slender,  flexible, 
and  of  moderate  length  ;  with  long,  slender,  and  slightly-curved 


424  ORDER    INSESSORES  ; — GENERAL    CHARACTERS. 

claws.  The  foot  of  the  common  Canary  affords  a  good  example 
of  the  usual  conformation. — On  the  other  hand,  the  wings  are 
for  the  most  part  highly  developed ;  and  have  often  a  very 
wide  expanse  in  proportion  to  the  size  of  the  body,  which  is 
never  very  bulky. — The  plumage  of  the  Perchers  varies  greatly 
in  the  different  families ;  being  dull  in  some,  and  of  the  most 
exceeding  brilliancy  in  others.  Taken  as  a  whole,  however,  this 
order  far  surpasses  all  others  in  the  elegance  and  beauty  of  the 
feathered  covering  ;  and  it  contains  those  species,  which  are  pre- 
eminent in  this  respect  above  all  others  of  the  class.  The  male 
is  nearly  always  larger  than  the  female,  and  is  more  distinguished 
for  the  gaiety  of  his  dress.  The  Perchers  live  in  pairs,  and 
display  great  art  in  the  construction  of  their  nests,  which  are 
usually  built  in  trees,  bushes,  &c., — seldom  on  the  ground ;  the 
pairing  very  frequently  lasts,  however,  but  for  a  single  season. 
The  number  of  eggs  is  usually  considerable  ;  and  not  unfre- 
quently  there  are  two  broods  produced  in  every  year.  The 
young  come  forth  from  the  shell  in  a  blind  and  naked  state  ;  and 
they  are  wholly  dependent  for  their  subsistence  on  parental  care, 
during  some  time. — It  is  to  this  group  that  all  our  Singing  Birds 
belong;  with  the  exception  of  those  contained  in  the  nearly- 
allied  order  of  Scansores. — Thus  we  see  that  among  the  Inses- 
sores  are  found  pre-eminently  developed  all  those  characters, 
which  peculiarly  distinguish  the  class  of  Birds;  of  which  it 
should  therefore  be  regarded  as  the  typical  order  (§  360).  And 
it  harmonizes  well  with  this  view,  that  it  should  be  by  far  the 
largest  order  of  the  whole  class. 

385.  There  is  considerable  variety  in  the  food  of  the  Perching 
Birds;  which  is,  of  course,  connected  with  variations  in  the 
form  of  their  beak,  and  in  their  general  habits.  In  some  in- 
stances it  consists  exclusively  of  winged  insects ;  in  others  of 
grubs  and  worms ;  in  others  of  soft  pulpy  fruits ;  in  others 
of  seeds ;  in  others  of  vegetable  juices  ;  in  others  of  small  or 
young  birds ;  in  others  of  carrion ;  whilst  in  some  it  is  of  a 
mixed  character,  the  digestive  apparatus  being  adapted  to  act 
upon  all  the  foregoing  substances.  By  the  form  of  the  beak, 
this  order  is  divided  into  four  subordinate  groups,  as  follows  : — 


SUBDIVISION    OP    IN8E8SORE8. 


425 


I.  CONIROSTRES,    or   conical-billed   Birds ;    having   a  strong 
conical  beak    (Fig. 

223),  the  margin  of 
which  is  generally 
entire, — that  is,  not 
toothed  or  indented. 
The  greater  part  of 
these  are  omnivor- 
ous ;  but  some  are 
exclusively  grani- 
vorous  (or  seed- 
eating).  The  Crows  t 
Starlings,  and 
Finches  are  examples  of  this  group. 

II.  DENTIROSTRES,    or   toothed-billed   Birds,  which   are  cha- 
racterised by  a  notch  or  tooth  near  the  extremity  of  the  upper 


FIG   223.— BILL  OK  GRO.SBKAK. 


FIG.  224. — HEAD  OF  SHRIKK. 


mandible  (Fig.  224).  These  feed  on  Insects,  small  Birds,  &c. 
The  Shrikes  or  Butcher  Birds,  Thrushes,  Warblers,  Tits,  &c., 
belong  to  this  division. 

III.  TENUIROSTRES,  or  slender-billed  Birds,  which  have  a  long 
slender  bill,  specially  adapted  for  sucking  up  vegetable  juices 


a 


r  /  k 


426 


SUBDIVISION    OF    INSESSORES. 


(Fig.  225).  The  Humming  Birds  are  the  most  characteristic 
examples  of  this  group ;  to  which  belong,  however,  many  Birds 
whose  principal  food  consists  of  insects. 


FIG.  225 — HUMMING  BIRD. 

IV.  FISSIROSTRES,  or  gaping-lilled  Birds;  in  which  the 
beak  is  very  much  depressed  (or  flattened  horizontally),  so  as  to 
give  it  an  extremely  wide  opening,  when  the  mandibles  are 
separated  (Fig. 
226).  The  pur- 
pose of  this 
conformation  is 
to  allow  these 
Birds  to  cap- 
ture insects  on 
the  wing ;  we 
have  a  good 
specimen  of  it 
in  the  Swallow^ 
and  a  still  better 
one  in  the  Goat- 
sucker.— Of  the 

very  numerous  families   included  in   these  groups,    our   limits 
prevent  us  from  noticing  more  than  the  most  important. 


FIG.  226.— HEAD  OF  GOAT-SUCKKB. 


427 


TRIBE  I.— CONIROSTRES/ 

386.  The   Birds  of  this  division  are  for  the  most  part  dis- 
tinguished from  the  rest,  not  only  by  the  form  of  the  bill,  but 
also  by  that  of  the  feet  ;  which  are  so  constructed,  that  they 
can  walk  upon  the  ground  with  nearly  the  same  facility  as  they 
perch  upon  branches.     This   faculty  is  of  great   assistance   to 
them  in  the  search  for  food  ;    which  they  chiefly  obtain  from  the 
surface  of  the  earth,  rather  than  among  trees,  or  whilst  upon  the 
wing.     The  families  included  in  this  division  are  the  FRINGIL- 
LIDJE,  or  Finches  ;  the  COLID^E,  or  Colics  ;  the  MUSOPHAGID^E,  or 
Plantain-eaters;  the  CORVIDJE,  or  Crows;  the  STURNID.E,  or 
Starlings ;  the  PARADISEIDVE,  or  Birds  of  Paradise ;  and  the 
BCCERIDJE,  or  Hornbills.     Most  of  the  Birds  belonging  to  it  are 
more  or  less  domesticable ;  showing  a  disposition  to  associate 
with  Man ;    and  being  capable  of  receiving  a  certain  amount  of 
education  from  him. 

387.  The  FRINGILLID^E,  or  Finches,  constitute  a  very  large 
family,  that  includes  several  minor  groups,  such  as  Larks,  Bun- 
tings, Linnets,  Sparrows,   Grosbeaks,  Weaver-Birds,  &c. ;  each 
of  these  groups  consisting  of  several  genera,  more  or  less  closely 
related  to  one  another.     None  of  them  are  of  large  size ;  and 
they  bear  a  very  strong  relationship  in  general  appearance  and 
habits.     They  tenant  fields,  groves,  hedge-rows  and  woodlands  ; 
and  they  feed  chiefly  upon  various  kinds  of  grain  and  seeds, 
occasionally  upon  insects.     Many  of  them  are  remarkable  for 
their  powers  of  song ;  and  hence  they  are  termed  hard-billed 
warblers,  in  contradistinction  to  the  SYLVIAD.E  (§  399),  which  are 
spoken  of  as  soft-billed.      They  are   for  the   most  part  hardy 
Birds ;  and  as  they  can  usually  obtain  a  sufficient  supply  of 
food  in  our  country  through  the  whole  winter,   few  or  none  of 
the    British    Fringillidae    are   migratory ;    although   there   are 
several  species  that  are  driven  hither  for  the  winter  from  more 
northern  climates.       This  is  the  case  with  the  Siskin  or  Aberde- 
vine ;  and  with  the  Redpoll.     Most  of  them  associate  in  flocks 

F     F   2 


428  CONIROSTRES; FAMILY    FRINGILLIDjE. 

during  this  season,  assiduously  searching  for  food  ;    and  they  are 
not  unfrequently  joined  by  others  of  a  different  species.     At  this 


Fro.  227.— SJSKJN  OR  ABERDEVINE. 

time  they  show  more  fearlessness  in  their  disposition,  and 
approach  nearer  to  the  haunts  of  Man,  than  they  do  at  other 
times.  In  consequence  of  the  abundance  of  their  food  in  the 
autumn,  when  the  seeds  and  grains  are  ripe,  they  usually  become 
very  fat ;  and  thus  a  store  is  laid  up  against  the  winter,  which 
contributes  to  maintain  their  heat  (ANIM.  PHYSIOL..  §  412).  It 
is  at  this  period  that  those  species  which  are  employed  as  articles 
of  food,  are  most  prized  ;  as,  for  instance,  the  Ortolan,  one  of  the 
Buntings,  which  is  much  sought  after  on  the  Continent  as  a 
delicacy,  and  is  regularly  fattened  for  the  market ;  and  the 
Sky-Lark,  of  which  large  numbers  are  annually  taken  in  the 
neighbourhood  of  Dunstable,  and  sent  to  the  London  market, 
whilst  others  are  brought  over  from  Holland.— The  geographical 
distribution  of  this  family  is  very  extensive,  in  fact  universal  ; 
some  members  of  it  being  found  in  all  parts  of  the  globe  where 
animal  life  can  be  supported.  Some  of  the  most  interesting 
species  will  now  be  noticed. 

388.  The  Grosbeak,  or  Hawfinch,  is  remarkable  for  the 
strength  of  its  bill  (Fig.  223),  which  enables  it  to  crack  the 
stones  of  cherries,  and  even  of  olives,  with  little  difficulty ;  and 
it  chiefly  lives  upon  hard  seeds  and  the  kernels  of  fruit.  Its 
habits  are  shy  and  retiring,  leading  it  to  choose  the  most  secluded 


FINCH    TRIBE  ;    GOLDFINCH,    CANARY,    BULLFINCH.          429 

spots  for  its  nestling-place ;  and  when  disturbed,  it  is  said  to 
perch  invariably  upon  the  tallest  tree  in  its  neighbourhood.  It 
will  become,  however,  very  familiar  in  confinement. — The  Gold- 
finch surpasses  all  other  British  Finches  in  beauty  and  docility  ; 
hence  it  is  one  of  those  most  frequently  kept  in  captivity.  Its 


FIG.  228. — HEAD  OK  GOLDKI.VCU  ;  MALE  AN'D  KKMALK. 

song,  though  soft  and  pleasing,  is  deficient  in  power.  It  is 
chiefly  remarkable  for  the  beauty  of  its  nest ;  which  is  usually 
in  an  orchard,  large  garden,  or  plantation, — in  the  neighbourhood 
of  Man,  therefore,  but  not  in  immediate  proximity  to  him.  The 
nest,  for  the  situation  of  which  a  dense  evergreen  is  often  selected, 
is  an  elegant  piece  of  workmanship  ;  being  formed  externally  of 
moss,  lichens,  dry  grass,  or  wool ;  and  lined  with  hair,  and  with 
the  down  of  the  willow  or  of  the  seeds  of  various  composite 
plants  on  which  it  feeds, — such  as  the  thistle,  dandelion,  ground- 
sel, &c. — The  Canary,  a  native  of  the  Canary  islands,  is  nearly 
allied  to  our  own  Goldfinch  in  its  general  structure ;  though  in 
some  respects  resembling  the  Linnets.  It  has  long  been  bred  in 
confinement  in  this  country ;  and  now  appears  quite  reconciled 
to  its  situation,  its  habits  being  so  completely  altered,  that  it 
cannot  find  its  subsistence  if  set  free  and  left  to  its  own  resources. 
The  wild  Canary,  which  is  still  found  in  Madeira,  builds  in  the 
immediate  neighbourhood  of  the  towns  ;  and  is  a  most  delight- 
ful songster,  much  surpassing  the  domesticated  race  in  power  of 
voice.  It  breeds  very  rapidly ;  hatching  five  or  even  six  broods, 
of  four  or  five  eggs  each,  in  the  course  [of  every  season. — The 
Bullfinch  is  remarkable  for  the  degree  in  which  its  voice  may  be 
improved  by  training ;  its  native  song  is  low,  soft,  and  pleasing, 
but  inaudible  at  a  short  distance ;  it  may  be  taught,  however,  to 


430      FAMILY    FRINGILLID.E  ; BULLFINCH,    SNOW-BUNTING. 

whistle  airs  with  great  firmness  and  precision.     This  Bird  feeds 

chiefly   during    the   winter    and 

spring  upon  the  buds  of  various 

trees   and  shrubs ;  as   the  thorn, 

larch,    birch,    plum,   gooseberry, 

and  other  fruit-trees;    and  it  is 

from    this    cause   very   injurious 

to  orchards. — The  Snow-Bunting 

or  Snow-flake   is   an    inhabitant 

of  the   Arctic  regions  ;  building 

among  the  rocks,  and  finding  its 

subsistence  upon  the  seeds  of  rushes  and  other  hardy  plants. 

When  the  violence  of  the  polar  winter  sets  in,  however,  it  is 


FIG.— 229.— HKAO  OF  BULLFINCH. 


FIG.  230. — SNOW-BUNTING. 


driven  southwards,  and  comes  in  large  numbers  to  the  various 
countries  of  the  north  of  Europe.  After  their  long  flights,  they 
are  usually  much  exhausted  ;  but  they  soon  recover  and  become 
fat,  and  are  sometimes  called  the  Ortolans  of  the  North.  They 
usually  return  northwards  in  February  and  March.  The  Snow- 
flake  is  a  neat  and  lively  little  Bird,  readily  distinguished  by  its 
peculiar  colouring,  in  which  white  is  very  conspicuous.  The 
winter  plumage  is  of  a  browner  cast ;  the  black  and  white 
feathers  having  a  brown  margin,  which  is  worn  off  in  summer. 
— The  Sky-Lark  is  placed  by  some  Ornithologists  in  the  Den- 
ti rostral  group  ;  but  its  bill  seems  to  indicate  that  its  relationship 


FINCH    TRIBE  ;  —  SKY-LARK. 


431 


FIG.  231.—  HEAD  OF  SKY-LARK. 


is  rather  with  this  family  (Fig.  231).     This  delightful  songster 

is  very  widely  spread  over 
Europe,  Asia,  and  the  north 
of  Africa.  Its  favourite  lo- 
calities are  extensive  arable 
lands  and  open  meadows  ; 
but  it  also  frequents  wild 
mountain  pastures.  Its  foot 
is  of  peculiar  construction, 
being  remarkable  for  the 
great  length  of  the  claws, 
especially  of  the  hinder  one  : 

.     /  . 

by  this  it  is  adapted  to  walk 
over  uneven  surfaces,  and  to  spring  from  the  ground  to  a  height 
sufficient  to  cause  the  wings  to  act.  This  conformation  destroys 
the  perching  characters  of  the  foot  ;  and  in  fact  the  Larks  reside 
but  little  among 
trees,  and  merely 
stand  upon  the 
branches  as 

points  of  obser- 
vation. Their 
food  consists  of 
insects,  worms, 
grains,  and  other 
seeds  ;  the  leaves 

of  the  clover  and  of  various  wild  plants  ;  and  they  are  of  con- 
siderable service  to  the  farmer,  in  destroying  much  that  would 
be  injurious  to  him.  The  clear  and  animated  song  of  the  Sky- 
Lark  is  mostly  uttered  whilst  the  Bird  is  rising  spirally  in  the 
air  ;  but  it  sometimes  sings  while  resting  on  the  ground.  Con- 
trary to  the  usual  habit  of  the  Insessores,  the  nest  of  the 
Sky-  Lark  is  placed  upon  the  ground  ;  and  is  very  rudely  put 
together. 

389.  The  Tanagers  constitute  a  very  interesting  subdivision 
of  this  family,  peculiar  to  the  New  World  ;  where  they  may  be 
considered  as  representing  the  Finches,  &c.,  of  Europe  and  Asia. 


FlG  232_FooT  OF  SKY-LARK. 


432  FAMILY    F1UNGILLIDJ2  ; — TANAGERS. 

They  much  resemble  these  in  general  conformation,  but  are 
remarkable  for  their  gaiety  of  plumage,  which  is  particularly  to 
be  noticed  in  those  species  that  iniiabit  the  tropical  portions  of 
America.  The  number  of  species  is  very  large ;  and  the  differ- 
ences between  them  are  usually  but  very  slight, — though  they 
are  such  as  adapt  them  to  those  varieties  of  climate,  food,  &c., 
which  any  widely-spread  tribe  of  Birds  must  necessarily  encoun- 
ter. Among  other  points  of  difference  between  the  Tanagers 
and  the  Finches  of  temperate  climates,  we  may  notice  the  mode 


FIG.  233.— ORGANIST  TANAGKR. 

of  breeding.  The  nests  in  the  former  group,  as  in  the  latter, 
are  in  general  elaborately  formed ;  and  are  constructed  externally 
of  small  twigs  and  bits  of  the  stalks  of  plants,  and  lined  internally 
with  wool,  feathers,  or  down.  The  eggs,  however,  instead  of 
being  five  or  six  in  number,  are  only  two  or  three  ;  but  there  are 
two  or  more  broods  in  the  year.  This  is  very  common  among 
Birds  of  tropical  climates ;  and  it  is  not  difficult  to  understand  the 
purpose  of  the  arrangement.  The  length  of  the  day  between  the 
tropics  never  varies  very  much  from  twelve  hours ;  and  the 
twilight  is  very  short :  and,  further,  there  is  an  ample  supply  of 
food  throughout  the  year.  On  the  other  hand,  the  length  of  the 
day  in  temperate  climates,  during  the  usual  breeding  season,  is 
much  greater ;  and  it  is  only  at  that  period,  that  a  sufficient 


FINCH    TRIBE  ;— TANAGERS;    WHIDAH    FINCH. 


433 


amount  of  food  can  be  readily  obtained.  It  would  be  difficult 
for  the  tropical  Birds  to  find  enough  nourishment  for  a  numerous 
offspring,  during  their  short  day ;  and  the  Creator  has  wisely 
ordained,  [therefore,  that  their  brood  should  be  divided,  as  it 
were,  into  two  or  more,  and  reared  at  different  periods  of  the 
year.  But  if  this  were  the  case  with  Birds  of  temperate  climates, 
the  second  brood  could  seldom  be  reared,  for  want  of  food  and 
warmth. — The  species  of  Tanager  represented  in  Fig.  233, 
receives  its  name  from  its  musical  powers,  which  are  greater  than 
those  of  most  others  of  the  group,  though  far  from  equalling  the 
Finches  and  other  songsters  of  temperate  climates. 

390.  Two  other  interesting  genera  of  this  family  must  be 
noticed.  One  of  these  is  the  Vidua,  or  Whidah  Finch,  which  is 
remarkable  for  an  astonishing  development  of  plumage  in  the 
male,  during  the  breeding  season.  At  other  times  the  male 
resembles  the  female.  These  beautiful  Birds  are  natives  of 


FIG.  234.— WHIDAH  FINCH. 

Western  Africa,  and  are  particularly  abundant  in  the  kingdom 
of  Whidah, — whence  their  name.  The  term  has  been  corrupted, 
however,  to  Widaw-lird  ;  which  was  thought  not  inappropriate, 
as  if  the  splendid  tail  of  the  male  dropped  off,  after  the  breeding 
season,  in  melancholy  for  the  loss  of  its  mate. — The  genus  Loxia, 
or  Crossbill,  is  an  extremely  remarkable  one,  on  account  of  the 


434  FAMILY    FRINGILLIDvE  ; CROSSBILL. COLID^E. 

peculiar  conformation  of  the  bill,  which  is  represented  in  the 
accompanying  figure.  The  use  of 
this  singular  structure,  which  might 
be  at  first  deemed  an  imperfection, 
becomes  evident  when  the  habits  of 
the  Bird  are  watched.  Its  principal 
food  consists  of  the  seed  of  the  Pine 
and  Fir,  which  is  concealed  beneath 
the  hard  scales  of  which  their  cones 
are  formed.  In  order  to  extract 
them,  the  Bird  fixes  itself  across  the 
cone ;  and  then,  bringing  together  the 
points  of  the  mandibles  (which  are 
FIO.  235.-HEAD  OP  CROSSBILL.  mn(^  compressed),  it  insinuates  them 

beneath  the  scales  of  the  cone.  When  this  has  been  accom- 
plished, the  Bird  separates  the  mandibles,  not  by  opening  the 
beak  in  the  usual  way,  but  by  drawing  the  lower  mandible 
sideways,  which  it  is  enabled  to  do  by  a  peculiar  arrangement 
of  muscles  :  when  the  scale  has  thus  been  raised  up,  the  tongue 
is  brought  forwards ;  and  a  peculiar  horny  scoop,  with  which 
it  is  furnished,  is  directed  beneath  the  seed,  which  is  dislodged 
and  carried  to  the  mouth.  The  common  Crossbill  breeds 
in  this  country,  but  is  much  more  abundant  in  the  large  pine 
forests  of  Germany,  Sweden  and  Norway ;  and  vast  flocks  are 
not  unfrequently  driven  thence  by  the  severity  of  the  winter,  to 
find  shelter  in  the  southern  parts  of  Britain.  It  feeds  upon  other 
seeds,  as  well  as  those  of  the  Pine  and  Fir ;  and  shows  the  enor- 
mous strength  of  its  bill  (its  small  size  being  considered),  in 
extracting  the  kernel  from  the  hard  shell.  When  placed  in  a 
cage,  it  shows  great  restlessness  and  impatience ;  and  exhibits 
much  dexterity  in  drawing  forth  the  ends  of  the  wires  from  the 
woodwork,  so  as  to  set  itself  free. 

391.  The  family  of  COLIDJS,  or  Colics,  entirely  consists  of 
African  Birds,  which  dwell  in  bushes  and  thickets,  living  in 
flocks,  and  feeding  on  fruits  and  buds.  They  are  bad  fliers,  and 
do  not  walk  well  on  the  ground ;  but  run  along  the  branches  of 
trees  with  facility.  They  are  chiefly  characterised  by  the  form  of 


PLANTAIN-EATERS. CROW    TRIBE. 


435 


their  bills  ;  which  are  short  and  stout,  and  compressed  towards 
the  point.  When  they  take  their  rest,  they  sleep  with  the  head 
downwards,  suspended  by  one  foot. 

392.  The  family  MUSOPHAGID^E,  or  Plantain-eaters^  is  inter 
mediate  between  the  Finches  and  the  Hornbills.     It  consists 
entirely  of  Birds  inhabiting  tropical  climates,  and  feeding  upon 
soft  vegetable  substances.    Their  bills  are  strong  and  thick,  more 
or  less  curved  on  the   top,   and  having  their  cutting  margins 
serrated  (or  jagged)  like  the  teeth  of  a  fine  saw.     With  these 
instruments  they  can  readily  divide  the  stems  of  the  plants  on 
which  they  feed ;  cutting  them  off  close  to  the  ground.     One 
tribe  of  this  family  is  peculiar  to  Africa,  whilst  another  inhabits 
South  America. 

393.  The  family  CORVID^E,  or  the  Crow  tribe,  on  the  con- 
trary, is  very  widely  diffused  over  the  globe ;  some  members 
of  it  being  found  in  almost  every  country  except  the  very  coldest; 
— its  general  characters  are  consequently  well  known.     The  bill 
is  strong,  and  is  compressed  at  the  sides  ;  and  it  is  covered  at  the 
base  with  stiff  feathers,  which  advance  forwards  so  as  to  cover 
the  nostrils.    In  several  respects  these  Birds  are  to  be  accounted 
the  most  perfectly  organised  of  the  whole  class ;  exhibiting  a 
more  complete  combination  of  its  distinguishing  peculiarities, 
than  we  meet  with  in  any  other  group.     Thus,  their  digestive 

organs  enable 
them  to  derive 
nutriment  from 
a  great  variety  of 
edible  substances; 
the  bill  being  ca- 
pable of  laying 
hold  of  almost 
any  kind  of  food ; 
and  the  stomach 
being  intermedi- 
ate between  the 

membranous,  or  thinly- muscular  kind  peculiar  to  the  carni- 
vorous families,  and  the  gizzards,  or  strongly-muscular  organs 


Pro.  236.— HBAD  OF  CARRION  CROW. 


436  FAMILY   CORVID^E,    OR    CROW    TRIBE. 

which  are  possessed  by  those  that  feed  on  hard  vegetable  sub- 
stances. The  form  of  their  foot,  again,  adapts  them  to  traverse 
the  fields  and  pastures 
with  facility,  in  search 
of  food  ;  whilst  they  can 
also  perch  with  security 
on  trees,  as  well  as  make 
their  way  among  the 
branches ; — for  the  tarsi 
and  toes  are  moderately 
long  and  stout ;  and  the 
claws  are  arched  and 
acute.  The  wings  are 
of  that  form  which  en- 
sures a  powerful  and 

.  FIG.  237-— FOOT  or  CARRION  CROW. 

regular    flight  ;    steady 

without  being  heavy,  and  buoyant  without  wavering ;  for 
they  are  broad  and  of  moderate  length,  and  usually  rounded  at 
their  extremities.  The  tail,  which  is  chiefly  useful  as  a  rudder 
to  direct  the  course  of  the  Bird  in  rapid  flight,  is  short  in  the 
species  that  seek  their  food  entirely  on  the  ground,  and  long  in 
those  which  reside  chiefly  in  trees  and  bushes.  Their  sight  is 
keen,  and  enables  them  to  discern  objects  at  long  distances  ;  the 
smell  also,  in  some  species,  appears  to  be  very  acute.  Their  intel- 
ligence is  much  above  that  of  the  generality  of  Birds  ;  they  often 
show  a  great  deal  of  sagacity  in  their  natural  actions  ;  and  they 
possess  an  unusual  degree  of  docility.  They  are  usually  of  a 
courageous  and  active  disposition  ;  but  are  at  the  same  time 
extremely  vigilant  and  cautious. — Their  plumage  is  rather  sombre 
in  most  of  the  species  inhabiting  temperate  climates;  but  though 
dark  in  hue,  it  is  lustrous  in  its  aspect ;  and  many  species  of 
tropical  climates  exhibit  considerable  brilliancy  and  variety  in 
their  colouring.  The  Crows  and  their  allies  have,  more  than  any 
other  Birds,  the  power  of  adapting  themselves  to  a  variety  of 
circumstances ;  by  which  the  wide  extent  of  their  distribution  is 
partly  accounted  for. 

394.     The  Crows,  properly  so  called,  have  their  bills  rather 


CROW  TRIBE  ; RAVEN,  CROW,  ROOK,  ETC. 


437 


arched,  and  of  great  strength  ;  and  they  chiefly  live  upon  the 
ground,  searching  for  carrion,  worms,  slugs,  the  larvae  of  insects, 
&c.,  which  they  are  of  very  great  service  in  removing ;  but, 
when  animal  food  is  not  to  be  had,  they  will  devour  grain.  To 


FIG.  238.— HEAD  OF  RAVEN. 

this  group  belong  the  Raven,  the  Carrion  and  Hooded  Crows, 
the  Rook,  the  Jackdaw,  and  the  Magpie,  among  British  Birds  ; 
of  these  the  first  is  the  largest  and  most  powerful,  and  is  at  the 
same  time  the  most  sagacious  and  courageous,  evincing  little  dread 
of  other  animals,  and  even  of  the  larger  Birds  of  Prey.  It  not 
only  feeds  upon  carrion  and  grain,  but  will  also  attack  young 
lambs,  poultry,  &c.  In  its  general  habits  it  is  not  unlike  the 
Eagle ;  for  it  resorts  to  the  inaccessible  ledges  of  rocks,  tall  trees, 
&c.,  to  construct  its  nest,  and,  except  when  domesticated,  it 
shuns  the  proximity  of  .Man. — The  Jays  have  a  shorter  bill, 
which  terminates  rather  abruptly ;  they  usually  live  in  the  forests 
of  various  parts  of  the  world,  and  feed  upon  fruits  as  well  as 
upon  worms  and  grubs. — The  Choughs  have  a  longer  and  more 
slender  bill  than  most  of  the  family  ;  and  in  some  respects  lead 
us  towards  the  Starlings.  They  nestle  in  rocks  and  towers,  and 
are  shy  and  vigilant.  There  is  only  one  species  of  Chough  in 


438          STURNHXE    OR    STARLINGS. BIRDS    OF    PARADISE. 

Britain,  usually  known  by  the  name  of  the  Red-legged  Crow  ; 
it  is  not  a  common  Bird,  being  chiefly  confined  to  some  parts  of 
the  western  coast  of  England  and  Scotland ;  in  its  food  and 
general  habits  it  resembles  the  ordinary  Corvidse.  Other  species, 
inhabiting  the  Continent  of  Europe,  resort  to  inland  mountain 
ranges,  rather  than  to  the  shore ;  and  feed  chiefly  on  insects, 
berries,  &c. 

395.  In  the   family   STURNID^E,    or   Starlings^   the   bill  is 
usually  lengthened,  conical,  and  slender ;  many  of  the  Birds  of 
this  group  resemble  Crows  in  miniature ;  and  in  their  internal 
structure  and  general  habits,  they  differ  but  little  from  the  last 
family.    They  feed  rather  upon  worms,  larvae,  insects,  and  fruits, 
than  upon  carrion ;  and  are  very  serviceable  to  quadrupeds,  by 
relieving  them  from  the  attacks  of  insects  that  infest  them.    They 
are  for  the  most  part  very  docile,   and  may  be  taught  to  sing, 
and  even  to  speak  with  great  distinctness ;  though  they  have 
little  or  no  song  of  their  own.     To  this  family  belongs  the 
Australian  Bower  Bird,  whose  remarkable  habits  will  be  noticed 
hereafter;   and  also  the  Grakle  of  the  Indian  Archipelago,  which 
is  so  useful  in  restraining  the  multiplication  of  the  Locust  (p.  12). 

396.  In  the  family  PARADISEID^E,  or  Birds  of  Paradise,  the 
bill  is  lengthened  and  more  slender ;  hence  these  Birds  have  been 
placed  by  some  in  the  Tenuirostral  group.     They  are  believed  to 
subsist  chiefly  upon  fruits  ;  but  insects  also  form  part  of  their 
diet.     Little  is  known,  however,  of  their  habits ;  for  they  are 
confined  to  New  Guinea  and  the  neighbouring  islands,  which 
have  as  yet  been  very  little  explored  by  Naturalists.     They 
were  formerly  supposed  to  have  no  feet ;  though  their  feet  are 
in  fact  rather  strong  and  large.     This  strange  error  originated  in 
the  circumstance,  that  the  natives  collect  them  to  make  ornaments 
of  their  remarkable  plumes  ;  and  generally  cut  off  the  wings  and 
feet,   to  prevent  those   rigid   parts   from  injuring  the   delicate 
feathers.     These  plumes,  which  are  of  very  different  form  and 
aspect  in  the  different  species,  usually  consist  of  certain  feathers 
of  the  shoulder-tufts,  or  from  the  tail  ;  which  are  immensely 
prolonged   backwards,    and   are   very   thinly   barbed,    or  even 
entirely  destitute  of  barbs.     Their  use  is  entirely  unknown.     In 


BIRDS    OF    PARADISE  ;  —  1IORNBILLS 


439 


the  beautiful  species  represented  in  Fig.  239,  the  tail  filaments 
are  wanting  ;  but  three  long  filaments  proceed  from  each  side  of 


FIG.  239. — SIX-THREADED  B/RD  OF  PARADISK. 

the  neck.  In  some  species,  these  curious  appendages  are  so 
disposed,  as  to  give  to  the  Bird  the  appearance  of  having  four 
wings. 

397.  The  last  family  of  the  Conirostres  is  that  of  BTICERID^:, 
or  Hornbills  ;  which  is  remarkable  for  the  very  large  size  of  the 
beak,  and  also  for  an  extraordinary  protuberance  with  which 
this  is  generally  surmounted.  The  beak  is  arched,  and  the 
mandibles  toothed  at  their  edges  :  and  when,  as  is  sometimes  the 
case,  the  protuberance  is  wanting,  the  upper  mandible  itself 
appears  as  if  swollen  or  inflated  with  air.  The  form  of  the 
excrescence  varies  much  with  age ;  and  in  very  young  indivi- 
duals there  is  no  trace  of  it.  When  cut  across,  it  is  found  to 
consist  of  a  very  loose  bony  substance ;  its  interior  being  tra- 
versed in  every  direction  by  osseous  fibres,  the  interspaces 


440 


FAMILY    BTJCERID^E,    OR    HORNBILLS. 


between   which   are  filled   with  air.       All   the   bones  of  these 

remarkable  Birds  are  more  per- 
meated by  air  than  are  those  of 
any  other  known  species ;  even 
the  phalanges  of  the  toes  being 
penetrated  by  it.  The  Hornbills 
are  confined  to  the  warm  parts 
of  Asia  and  Africa.  In  their 
general  habits,  they  seem  to  bear 
a  considerable  resemblance  to  the 
Crows;  their  flight  is  sailing, 
like  that  of  the  Corvidae;  and 
on  the  ground  they  advance  by  a 
sort  of  leaping  action,  in  which 
they  are  assisted  by  the  wings. 
The  larger  species  are  very  shy 
and  difficult  of  approach ;  and 
they  perch  on  the  branches  of 
lofty  trees,  where  their  vision  can 
command  a  wide  range.  They 
are  omnivorous  in  their  diet ;  chasing  mice,  small  birds,  and 
reptiles  ;  not  disdaining  carrion  ;  and  resorting  to  soft  vegetable 
matter  when  no  other  is  to  be  had.  Like  the  Toucans,  which 
resemble  them  in  the  enormous  size  of  the  bill  (Fig.  265),  they 
swallow  their  food  whole,  throwing  it  up  into  the  air,  and  catch- 
ing it  as  it  falls.  They  breed  in  the  hollows  of  decayed  trees. 


FIG.  5>40.— HOUNBFLL. 


TRIBE  II.— DENTIROSTRES. 

398.  In  this  division  of  the  order,  the  upper  mandible  has  a 
notch  on  either  side  of  the  tip,  like  that  of  the  Noble  Birds  of 
Prey ;  and  the  diet  is  almost  or  completely  restricted  to  animal 
food, — these  Birds  being  chiefly  supported  upon  insects,  worms, 
&c.,  but  the  larger  of  them  feeding  also  upon  small  birds, 
reptiles,  &c.  The  notch  is  not  always  deep,  and  is  sometimes 
altogether  wanting ;  in  that  case  the  place  of  the  Bird  is  known 


DENTIRO8TRES.  —  FAMILY    SYLVJADJE. 


441 


by  the  correspondence  of  its  general  characters  with  those  of  the 
truly  toothed-billed  species.  But  there  are  many  whose  charac- 
ters are  so  intermediate  between  those  of  the  Dentirostral  and 
the  Conirostral  tribes,  that  they  may  be  placed  either  in  one  or 
the  other,  with  considerable  show  of  reason.  In  fact,  there  are 
no  such  arbitrary  divisions  in  Nature ;  and  it  is  in  the  study  of 
Birds,  more  perhaps  than  in  that  of  any  other  class,  that  the 
Zoologist  feels  a  difficulty  in  strictly  defining  his  genera  and 
families,  on  account  of  the  gradual  passage  which  is  formed 
between  one  and  another,  by  intermediate  species.  It  is  inter- 
esting to  observe,  that  several  of  the  families  contained  in  this 
tribe  are  evidently  analogous  to  the  principal  families  of  the  last. 
Thus  we  have  in  the  first  instance  the  SYLVIAD^,  or  Warblers  ; 
a  very  large  family  of  small  Birds,  which  evidently  represent 
the  Finches.  The  LANIAD^E,  Shrikes  or  Butcher  Birds,  the 
largest  and  most  powerful  of  the  order,  are  strikingly  analogous 
to  the  Crows.  And  the  TURDID^E,  or  Thrushes,  which  are  like 
Shrikes  with  their  peculiar  characters  softened  down,  may  be 
likened  to  the  Starlings.  Besides  these,  we  have  in  this  tribe 
the  MUSCICAPID^E,  or  Fly  Catchers;  and  the  AMPELID^E,  or 
Chatterers. 

399.  The  family  SYLVIAD^E,  or  Warblers,  consists  of  small 
Birds  which  have  rather  long  and  slender  bills,  with  the  tip 
slightly  curved  and 
toothed  ;  and  it  con- 
tains a  large  propor- 
tion of  the  species 
which  are  most  re- 
markable for  their 
power  of  song.  The 
Nightingale  (Fig. 
241)  will  serve  as  a 
good  example  of  the 
general  aspect  and 
characters  of  the 
group.  These  Birds 
are  solitary  in  their  habits  ;  feeding  on  insects,  worms,  and  berries  ; 


Fto.  241 — NIGHTINGALE. 


442        FAMILY   SYLVIAD^E,    OR    WARBLERS; NIGHTINGALE. 

but  preferring  the  former.  Most  of  them,  indeed,  will  not  touch 
vegetable  matter,  unless  driven  to  it  by  necessity ;  and,  when 
compelled  to  resort  to  it,  they  select  the  softer  kinds  of  vegetable 
matter,  rather  than  the  hard  seeds,  which  are  preferred  by  most 
of  the  Fringillidse.  The  two  families  may  be  generally  at  once 
distinguished  by  the  form  of  the  beak,  the  length  and  comparative 
slenderness  of  which,  together  with  the  slight  curvature  at  its 
point  (Fig.  242),  are  in  striking  contrast  with  the  short,  stout, 

and  straight  conical  bills 
of  the  typical  Fringillidae 
(Fig.  223).  But  the 
Larks  and  allied  species 
have  bills  so  intermediate 
in  form  between  these 
two,  that  they  might  be 
placed  in  one  or  the  other 
family  almost  in  differently 
(§  388).  The  various 

FIG.  242.-HEAD  OF  ACCENTOR  MODULAR,  groups     of    SylviadsB     are 

OR  HKDGK  WARBLER.  spread  over  all  quarters  of 

the  globe ;  and  are  destined  to  restrain  the  multiplication  of  the 
numerous  tribes  of  insects,  which  would  otherwise  increase  to 
such  an  extent  as  to  be  destructive  to  all  vegetation.  As  different 
localities  are  assigned  to  different  tribes  of  Insects,  so  is  a  diversity 
of  haunts  assigned  to  the  various  groups  of  these  Birds.  Some 
confine  themselves  to  the  higher  branches  of  trees,  some  frequent 
dense  humid  thickets,  some  hedgerows,  some  tall  reed-beds,  some 
grassy  lawns,  pasture  lands,  and  wide  commons : — in  each  place 
finding  the  insects  most  suitable  to  their  appetites.  A  consider- 
able number  of  those  inhabiting  temperate  climates  are  migratory ; 
arriving  at  their  summer  quarters  at  the  time  when  their  natural 
food  begins  to  abound  ;  and  retiring  southwards  when  their 
food  begins  to  diminish,  and  the  air  becomes  chilly.  This  is 
the  case, 'for  example,  with  the  Nightingale ;  which  passes  its 
summer  in  various  parts  of  Europe,  from  South  Britain  and  the 
southern  part  of  Sweden  to  the  shores  of  the  Mediterranean ; 
and  retires  to  Northern  Africa,  Egypt,  and  Syria,  for  the 


" 

1 


WARBLERS,    GOLD-CRESTS,    TAILOR- BIRDS,    STONE-CHATS.      44:J 

winter.  As  is  the  case  with  many  other  migrating  Birds,  the 
males  precede  the  females  by  several  days.  The  distribution  of 
the  Nightingale  in  Britain  is  very  limited ;  it  is  absent  from 
Devonshire,  whose  warm  humid  climate  would  seem  peculiarly 
favourable  to  it ;  and  it  has  been  observed  especially  to  frequent 
those  districts  in  which  the  cowslip  abounds, — a  flower  which  is 
seldom  or  never  met  with  in  the  county  of  Devon. 

400.     This  extensive  family  is  sub-divided  into  numerous  sub- 
ordinate groups,  of  which  little  more  than  an  enumeration  can  be 
here  given.      Thus  we  have  first  the  proper  Warblers,  including 
the  Nightingale,  Black-cap,   Wood-wren,  Kinglet,  &c. ;  which 
are  birds  of  small  size  and  delicate  conformation,  feeding  on  juicy 
fruits  as  well  as  on  insects  and  larvae  ;  and  seeking  their  food 
chiefly  among  trees  and  bushes,  seldom  betaking  themselves  to 
the  ground.     They  form  an  elaborate  nest  ;  lay  from  five  to 
eight  eggs  at  a  time  ;  and  in  some  instances  rear  two  broods  in 
ea*ch  season.  The  Kinglet,  or  Golden-crested  Wren,  is  the  smallest 
of  our  native  birds ;  its  length  from 
the  tip  of  the  beak  to  the  end  of  the 
tail  being  only  3|  inches ;  it  derives 
its  name  from  the  bright  lemon-yellow 
feathers  on  its  crown,  on  either  side 
of  which  is  a  band  of  black.     It  is  a 
very  lively  little  bird,   chiefly  inha- 
biting woods  and  plantations  of  pine, 
fir  or  larch. — Nearly  allied  to  the  War-         FlG-  2*3.— H*AD  or  r JOLD- 

;  .  CROWNED  KINGLET. 

biers  are  the  1  ailor-birds,  whose  curious 

nest  has  been  elsewhere  described  (ANIM.  PHYSIOL.,  §  705). — The 
Wheatears  and  Slonechats  have  their  bills  somewhat  depressed  (or 
horizontally  flattened)  at  the  base,  and  the  corners  of  the  mouth 
armed  with  a  few  bristles  ;  this  conformation  points  them  out  as 
insect-eaters.  Their  wings  are  lengthened  and  pointed ;  and 
their  tarsi  are  long,  enabling  them  to  leap  along  the  ground  in 
search  of  their  food.  They  inhabit  barren  places  in  various 
parts  of  the  Old  World ;  and  nestle  in  crevices  of  rocks,  among 
stones,  or  in  holes  in  the  ground. — The  Accentors,  or  Dunnocks  (of 


444    SYLVIAD.E,  OK  WARBLERS;— ACCEPTORS,  TITMICE,  &c. 

which  one  species  is  commonly  known  in  this  country  as  the 
Hedge-Sparrow,  Fig.  242),  have  their  bills  rather  straighter  and 
shorter,  and  somewhat  compressed  towards  the  edges.  This 
conformation  shows  their  relationship  to  the  Conirostral  group  ; 
which  is  further  manifested  by  their  feeding  on  small  seeds  as 
well  as  on  insects.  They  are  found  in  both  hemispheres  ;  and 
live  chiefly  on  the  ground,  seeking  their  food  near  the  shelter  of 
bushes,  to  which  they  retreat  when  disturbed,  and  moving  with 
a  gait  between  leaping  and  walking. — The  Titmice  have  short 

conical  bills,  with  the  tips 
not  dentated,  and  the  base 
covered  with  a  few  bristles. 
They  are  found  in  both  he- 
mispheres, and  are  very  active 
little  birds,  continually  flit- 
ting from  branch  to  branch, 
and  suspending  themselves 
in  all  kinds  of  strange  at- 
titudes, whilst  seeking  for 
insects  among  the  foliage. 
Though  essentially  insectivor- 
ous, many  of  them  also  feed  on  seeds  of  various  kinds ;  and 
some  of  them  do  not  disdain  carrion.  They  are  petulant, 
excitable,  and  courageous  in  their  disposition ;  defending 
themselves  with  energy,  and  not  hesitating  to  attack  birds 


FIG.  244. — GREAT  TITMOUSK. 


FIG.  245.— HEAD  AND  FOOT  OF  BLUE. HEADED  WAGTAIL. 

much  larger   than  themselves. — The    Wagtails  have  a  length- 
ened and  slender  bill ;  their  wings  are  long  and  pointed ;  and 


WAGTAILS. LANIADyE,    OR     SHRINKS.  445 

their  tail,  which  they  are  continually  shaking  up  and  down,  is 
long  and  narrow.  Their  flight  is  rapid  and  undulatory,  and 
buoyant  and  graceful  in  the  highest  degree.  Their  tarsi  are  long, 
and  they  walk  with  great  celerity  ;  the  hind  toe  is  armed  witli  a 
long  claw.  They  frequent  the  margins  of  rivers  and  lakes, 
inundated  fields,  &c. ;  and  they  feed  on  insects  and  small  seeds. 
They  nestle  on  the  ground,  among  the  herbage  or  in  stony 
places. 

401.  It  is  in  the  family  LANIAM:,  or  Shrikes,  that  we  find 
the  largest  and  most  rapacious  birds  of  the  Dentirostral  tribe ; 
and  it  is  here,  too,  that  we  find  the  dentation  of  the  bill  most 
distinct,  as  shown  in  Fig.  224.  In  their  general  habits,  many 
of  the  Laniadee  resemble  the  Raptorial  Birds  ;  for  they  sit 
motionless  upon  their  perch,  watching  for  their  prey  (which  con- 
sists of  small  birds,  quadrupeds,  and  reptiles,  and  the  larger 
insects),  and  then  suddenly  dart  upon  it.  Many  of  them  have 
the  curious  habit  of  impaling  the  animals  they  have  caught  upon 
a  large  thorn  ;  and  then  pulling  them  to  pieces,  and  devouring 
them  at  their  leisure.  They  are  said  to  lie  in  wait  near  the 
insects  which  have  been  thus  secured ;  and  to  dart  out  upon  any 
Birds  that  may  be  attracted  by  them.  Their  rapacity  causes 
them  to  be  much  dreaded  by  the  smaller  birds  of  their  own 
tribe ;  many  of  which  exhibit  as  much  alarm  at  their  presence 
as  they  would  at  that  of  a  Hawk.  They  exhibit  great  courage 
in  defending  themselves  and  their  nests  from  more  powerful 
enemies  ;  and  the  parents  show  great  attachment  to  each  other 
and  to  their  young.  It  is  said  that  when  rendered  more  than 
usually  rapacious  by  the  wants  of  their  hungry  offspring,  they 
will  even  attack  young  rabbits,  which  they  destroy  by  striking 
the  posterior  part  of  the  skull  with  their  bills.  Like  the  Rap- 
tores,  they  build  their  nests  at  a  considerable  height  from  the 
ground  ;  but  they  show  much  more  art  in  their  construction. 
This  group  is  distributed  over  both  the  Old  and  the  New  World; 
but  the  species  inhabiting  temperate  regions  are  usually  migra- 
tory. Three  are  natives  of  Britain. 

402.     The  birds  of  the  family  TURDID.E,   or  Thrushes,  have 


446  FAMILY    TURDIDJi  ; — THRUSH,    BLACKBIRD,    &C. 

arched  and  compressed  bills,  with  a  less  strongly-marked  tooth. 
Their  wings  are  usually  long  and  pointed ;  and  their  legs  and  toes 
long  and  slender.  Their  flight  is  moderately  rapid  ;  and  their 


Fro.  246. — HEAD  OF  SONG  THRUSH, 


advance  on  the  ground  is  by  leaping.  Their  food  usually  con- 
sists of  soft  animal  and  vegetable  substances,  as  fruits,  worms, 
and  snails ;  this  we  might  infer  from  the  comparative  weakness 
of  their  bills ;  but  there  are  some  divisions  of  the  family,  in 
which  the  bill  is  stronger,  and  the  food  consists  of  hard-cased 
insects  and  grains.  This  family  is  very  universally  distributed 
over  the  globe;  its  several  species  being  adapted  to  almost  every 
variety  of  climate.  They  generally  frequent  the  fields  and  pas- 
tures in  search  of  their  food ;  but  they  nestle  in  thickets  and 
woods.  Some  species  are  remarkable  for  their  power  and  variety 
of  song — as  the  common  Thrush  and  Blackbird  of  this  country, 
and  others  for  their  power  of  imitating  almost  any  sound  what- 
ever— which  is  the  case  with  the  Mocking-bird  of  America. 
This  extraordinary  songster,  which  ranges  from  New  England 
to  Brazil,  cannot  only  imitate  with  facility  the  song  of  any  other 
Bird,  with  additional  ornaments  of  its  own  ;  but  can  utter  almost 
any  other  sound  which  it  has  heard, — such  as  the  barking  of  a  dog, 
the  mewing  of  a  cat,  the  creaking  of  a  wheel,  &c.,  &c.  The 
Orioles  are  a  group  of  this  family,  chiefly  distinguished  by  the 
greater  breadth  of  the  bill  at  its  base.  They  are  mostly  tropical 


OKIOLES. MUSCICAPID^E,    OR   FLY-CATCHERS.  447 

Birds ;  but  one  species  inhabits  this  country  during  the  summer, 


. 

ral 


FIG.  247.— HEAD  AND  FOOT  OF  GOLDEN  ORIOLB. 


d  is  commonly  known  as  the  Golden  Thrush.  They  are  gene- 
rally remarkable  for  the  beauty  of  their  plumage,  and  for  their 
courageous  disposition  ;  but  they  have  no  power  of  song.  A 
large  proportion  of  their  food  consists  of  fruits. 

403.  The  family  of  MUSCICAPID^E,  or  Fly-catchers^  is  much 
more  limited  in  its  distribution  ;  comparatively  few  species  being 
found  elsewhere  than  in  the  warmer  portions  of  the  globe.  They 
belong  to  both  hemispheres  ;  but  are  most  abundant  in  the  New 
World.  They  are  characterised  by  the  breadth  and  horizontal 
flattening  of  the  beak ;  the  base  of  which  is  armed  with  stiff 
bristles,  that  serve  to  protect  the  corners  of  the  mouth  from  the 
struggles  of  the  insects  that  are  being  swallowed.  These  cha- 
racters are  best  seen  in  the  Tyrants  of  South  America ;  which 
are  very  bold  and  spirited  birds,  preying  not  merely  on  Insects, 
but  also  on  small  Birds ;  and  pursuing'  them  very  much  in 
the  manner  of  the  Shrikes.  The  smaller  species,  however,  con- 
fine their  destructive  powers  to  insects,  and  bear  a  general 


448  FLY-CATCHERS. AMPELID.E,    OR    CHATTERERS. 

resemblance   to   the  Warblers  in  their   habits.       They   seldom 

alight  on  the  ground, 
however,  being  almost 
incapacitated  from 
moving  upon  it  by  the 
shortness  of  their  legs, 
and  the  small  size  of 
their  feet.  Two  spe- 
cies, the  Grey  and  the 
Pied  Fly-catchers,  are 
annual  visitants  of 
Britain ;  arriving  in 
May,  and  departing 
at  the  beginning  of 
October ;  in  which 
interval  (as  is  the  case 
with  our  other  sum- 
mer visitants)  the  eggs 
are  hatched,  and  the 
young  reared. 

404.  The  AMPE- 
LID.E,  or  Chatterers, 
have  the  same  depressed 
beak  as  the  Fly-catchers;  but  it  is  somewhat  shorter  in  propor- 
tion, and  slightly  arched.  These,  also,  are  mostly  found  in  the 
warmer  regions  of  the  globe,  especially  in  the  New  World ;  and 
they  inhabit  the  low  grounds  or  forests,  feeding  upon  insects, 
caterpillars,  and  sometimes  upon  fruits.  Several  species  are 
remarkable  for  their  powers  of  song,  which  almost  equal  those  of 
the  Nightingale.  Only  one  species  visits  this  country ; — the 
Bohemian  Chatterer,  or  Black-throated  Waxwing,  which  derives 
its  name  from  a  series  of  curious  appendages  to  its  wing-feathers 
(Fig.  250),  resembling  red  sealing-wax  in  colour.  This  is  a  very 
handsome  Bird,  nearly  equalling  the  Song-Thrush  in  size,  and 
resembling  it  in  colour.  It  makes  its  appearance  in  Britain  at 
irregular  periods  ;  visiting  us  generally  during  the  winter  in  large 


Fiu.  248 — HEAD  AND  FOOT  OK  TYRANT  FLY-CATCHER. 


AMPELIDJ2,    OR    CHATTERERS  ; WAXWING.  449 

flocks,  and  betaking  itself  to  the  hedges  to  feed  on  their  berries. 


Fio.  249. — HEAD  OF  BOHEMIAN  CHATTERER. 


It  appears  to  be  spread  over  the  whole  continent  of  Europe 
during  the  winter,  and  to  proceed  northwards  in  the  spring; 
hence  it  has  no  right  to  the  peculiar  designation  it  has  received, 


Pio.  250.— WING  OF  WAXWING. 


as  the  Bohemian  Chatterer,  or  Waxwing.    The  use  of  the  pecu- 
liar appendages  to  its  wing- feathers  is  altogether  unknown. 


450 


TRIBE  III.— FISSIROSTRES. 

405.  In  this  tribe,  we  find  the  characters  of  the  latter  families 
of  the  preceding,  carried  to  a  much  greater  extent ;  the  bill  being 
extremely  depressed,  its  gape   enormous,  and  its  angles  being 
furnished  (in  the  typical  forms)  with  very  strong  bristles.     The 
feet,  too,  are  very  short  and  weak,  as  these  Birds  feed  chiefly  on 
the  wing ;  l>ut  their  powers  of  flight  are  very  remarkable.    They 
feed  principally  upon  insects,  which  they  pursue  and  capture  in 
the  air ;  but  some  of  the  larger  species  live  on  fish.     In  this 
tribe  are   included   the   CAPRIMULGID^,   or    Goatsuckers;    the 
HIRUNDINID.E,  or  Swallows  ;  the  TODID^E,  or  Todies ;  the  TRO- 
GONID^E,  or   Trogons ;  the  ALCEDINID.E,  or  Kingfishers;    and 
the  MEROPID.EJ,  or  'Bee-eaters. 

406.  The  Birds  of  the  family  CAPRIMULGID.E  are,  for  the 
most  part,  nocturnal  in  their  habits ;  and  they  have  the  soft 
downy  plumage,  and  the  dingy  colours,  of  the  Owls.     The  bill 
is  here  extremely  remarkable  for  the  width  of  its  gape,  which, 
in  the  true  Goatsuckers,  extends  far  beyond  the  eyes ;  but  it  is  at 


Fro.  251.— EUROPEAN  GOATSUCKER. 


the  same  time  extremely  weak,  and  is  incapable  of  seizing  any- 
thing that  requires  a  firm  grasp.     The  angles  of  the  mouth  are 


FAMILY    CAPRIMULGHXE  ; — GOATSUCKER.  451 

furnished  with  strong  lengthened  bristles ;  and  from  its  interior 
is  secreted  a  stiff  glutinous  saliva.  The  instincts  of  the  Birds 
are  in  admirable  accordance  with  these  peculiarities  of  their 
structure.  They  come  forth  in  the  evening,  when  the  Swallows 
and  Fly-catchers  have  retired  to  rest ;  and,  like  the  Bats,  range 
with  open  mouths  near  the  surface  of  the  earth,  skimming  lightly 
and  rapidly  with  almost  noiseless  flight.  But  whilst  the  Bats 
feed  especially  on  the  hard-cased  insects  (such  as  the  nocturnal 
Beetles,  &c),  the  Goatsuckers  especially  seek  the  soft-bodied 
Moths  ;  to  which,  in  the  downiness  of  their  covering,  the  sobriety 
of  their  colours,  and  their  nocturnal  habits,  they  bear  so  strong  a 
resemblance.  These  they  engulph  in  their  capacious  throats  ; 
the  viscidity  of  the  saliva,  and  the  bristles  with  which  the  cleft 
is  fenced,  being  sufficient  to  prevent  their  escape,  when  they 
have  been  once  entrapped.  Almost  the  only  sound  that  the 
Goatsucker  (often  termed  in  this  country  the  Fern-Owl)  makes 
in  flying,  is  a  peculiar  humming  noise,  caused  by  the  rushing  of 
the  air  into  the  mouth.  The  foot  of  this  Bird  is  very  curiously 
constructed.  The  hind  toe,  as  in  the  Owls,  can  be  brought 
forwards ;  and  the  middle  claw  of  the  anterior  toes  is  furnished 


FIG.  252 — FOOT  OF  EUROPEAN  GOATSUCKER. 


with  a  long  comb-like  projection.  The  use  of  this  peculiar  organ 
is  not  clearly  ascertained  ;  by  some  it  is  affirmed  that  the  Bird 
employs  it  to  clear  away  the  fragments  of  insects,  that  may  have 
clogged  up  the  fringe  of  bristles ;  by  others,  that  it  strikes  its 
prey  with  its  foot,  and  that  this  long  serrated  claw  enables  it  to 
hold  the  insect  more  securely ;  and  by  others,  again,  that  it  uses 
the  instrument  to  clean  its  plumage.  The  Goatsucker  is  a  solitary 
Bird,  and  shy  in  its  habits  ;  it  seems  to  hide  itself  during  the 
day  in  fern  brakes,  and  other  spots  where  it  can  obtain  shelter 
near  the  ground  ;  and  there  the  eggs,  which  are  usually  few  in 


452  GOATSUCKERS. FAMILY    HlRUNDINIDJi. 

number,  are  deposited  without  any  nest.' — There  is  but  one 
species  of  the  whole  family  in  Britain ;  and  this  is  a  summer 
visitant.  Several  others  are  found  in  America ;  where  one  of 
them  is  known  as  the  Whip-poor-  Will,  and  another  as  the  Night- 
Hawk.  There  is  a  species  in  Western  Africa,  which  has  a  single 
long-stemmed  feather  arising  from  the  middle  of  each  wing,  and 
extending  considerably  more  than  double  the  length  of  the  Bird  ; 
these  curious  appendages  have  no  vanes,  except  at  their  extremi- 
ties. They  strongly  remind  us  of  the  feathered  appendages  of 
the  Birds  of  Paradise ;  and,  as  with  those  organs,  their  use  is 
entirely  unknown. — This  family  includes  some  Birds  which  are 
more  or  less  diurnal  in  their  habits,  and  which  depart  in  other 
respects  from  its  peculiar  characters ;  these  are  inhabitants  of 
tropical  regions  both  in  the  Old  and  New  World. 

407.  The  HIRUNDINID.E,  or  Swallows,  differ  from  the  last 
family  in  the  closeness  of  their  plumage,  the  great  rapidity  of 
their  flight,  their  diurnal  habits,  and  the  narrower  gape  of  the 
bill,  which  wants  the  fringe  of  bristles  at  its  margin.  The  wings 

are  very  long  and  nar- 
row, consisting  almost 
entirely  of  the  pri- 
mary feathers  ;  the 
tail  is  generally  forked. 
The  feet  are  very  short 
and  slender,  and  are 
but  little  employed  by 
the  Bird,  either  for 
perching  or  walking ; 
by  far  the  largest  por- 
tion of  its  time  being 
FIG.  253.-SwAz.Low.  spent  on  the  wing.  They 

are  purely  insectivorous  in  their  diet ;  and  consequently  all  the 
species  which  breed  in  cold  or  temperate  regions,  proceed  south- 
wards at  the  approach  of  winter.  Their  migrations  are  often 
extremely  long  ;  and  are  performed  with  very  great  rapidity, — a 
large  number  usually  congregating  together  for  this  purpose.  This 
family  includes  two  groups, — the  true  Swallows,  and  the  Swifts. 


SWALLOWS    AND    MARTINS.  453 

The  latter  have  a  very  weak  triangular  depressed  bill  (Fig.  254), 
and  have  all  the  toes  directed  forwards  in  walking  ;  they  have 
obviously,  therefore,  the  nearest  alliance  to  the  Goatsuckers, 

—  The  former  have 
a  stronger  bill ;  and 
the  hind  toe  is  in- 
serted quite  at  the 
back  of  the  tarsus. 
The  Swallows  are 
remarkable  for  their 
extreme  activity,  and 
for  the  elegance  of 

FIG.  254. — HEAD  AND  FOOT  OF  WINDOW  SWALLOW,  OR  ,     . 

HOUSE  MARTIN.  their      movements  ; 

and  these  qualities, 

combined  with  the  attachment  which  they  show  to  human 
habitations,  render  them  universal  favourites.  They  nestle  in 
holes ;  or  against  the  face  of  rocks,  buildings,  or  trees,  in  which 
case  they  construct  a  nest  of  mud,  or  of  twigs  held  together  by  a 
glutinous  saliva.  Three  species  are  well  known  in  this  country 
as  summer  visitants  : — the  Common  Swallow ;  the  House,  or 
Window  Swallow,  or  Martin  ;  and  the  Bank  Swallow,  or  Sand 
Martin.  They  resemble  each  other  very  closely  in  their 
habits ;  flitting  about  during  the  whole  day  in  search  of  their 
insect  prey  ;  and  especially  frequenting  the  neighbourhood  of 
pools,  and  other  spots  where  insects  are  numerous.  The  most 
remarkable  peculiarity  of  their  flight,  is  the  facility  with  which 
they  turn  on  the  wing  ;  for  they  can  double  back,  not  merely  at  an 
angle,  but  at  a  very  acute  angle, — almost,  in  fact,  returning  upon 
their  previous  course  ;  and  this  without  the  least  appearance  of 
effort.  The  two  first  of  the  species  just  named  construct  their  nest 
against  the  walls  of  buildings,  building  them  up  of  particles  of 
earth  attached  by  their  glutinous  saliva ;  but  the  last  burrows 
into  sand-banks,  often  to  a  considerable  depth, — making  the 
entrance  slope  upwards  so  as  to  prevent  the  rain  from  beating 
into  it,  and  lining  the  interior  with  feathers  and  soft  vegetable 
fibres.  The  male  and  female  work  alternately  at  the  excavation ; 
one  feeding,  whilst  the  other  is  carrying  it  on. 


454  FAMILY  HIRUNDINID.K; — SWIFTS. 

408.  The  Swift  has  probably  the  most  imperfect  feet  of  any 
known  bird.  Owing  to  their  extreme  shortness,  it  is  unable  to 
walk,  except  with  a  most  constrained  and  hobbling  gait,  and 
with  the  assistance  of  the  wings ;  and  from  the  same  cause,  in 
combination  with  the  extreme  length  of  the  wings,  the  bird 
cannot  rise  from  a  flat  horizontal  surface,  since  its  body  is  not 
sufficiently  elevated  above  it  to  admit  of  the  first  downward 
stroke  of  these  members  (§333).  The  Swift,  consequently,  never 
settles  on' the  ground ;  but  alights  only  in  such  places  as  present 
a  brink,  or  declivity,  from  the  edge  of  which  it  can  launch  itself. 
The  toes  are  furnished  with  strong  claws ;  the  direction  of  which 
is  such,  that  the  bird  can  cling  very  securely  even  to  a  perpen- 
dicular surface.  It  lives  habitually,  and  pursues  its  prey,  at  a 
greater  height  from  the  ground  than  the  Swallows  ;  and  it  con- 


FIG.  255.— HEAD  OK  BLACK  SWIFT. 

structs  its  nest  at  a  more  lofty  elevation,  choosing  the  crevices  of 
steeples  and  towers,  and  the  crannies  of  rocks. 
The  nest  is  composed  of  twigs,  straws,  and 
feathers,  carefully  arranged,  but  cemented 
together  by  glutinous  matter.  The  height 
at  which  the  Swifts  fly,  a  good  deal  depends 
FOOT  OF  BLACK  SWIFT.  on  the  state  of  the  weather.  When  the 

atmosphere  is  pure  and  dry,  their  flight  is  most  elevated  ; 
for  it  is  then  that  their  insect  prey  rise  highest  on  the  wing. 
When  it  is  moist,  on  the  other  hand,  they  fly  much  lower ; 
and  sometimes  come  down  so  far,  as  almost  to  touch  the  sur- 
face of  the  water  over  which  they  skim.  The  amount  of  their 


SWIFTS; — ESCULENT  SWALLOW.  455 

motion  during  the  long  summer  days  is  immense  ;  for  they 
often  pass  sixteen  hours  in  vigorous  continued  flight,  chasing 
insects  not  only  for  their  own  support  but  for  that  of  their  off- 
spring ;  and  as  the  rate  of  their  movement  cannot  be  estimated 
at  less  than  100  miles  an  hour,  their  day's  performance  must  be 
at  least  1,600  miles.  When  their  flight  is  continuous  in  one 
direction,  therefore, — as  in  their  migrations, — we  see  how  im- 
mense distances  may  be  traversed,  with  little  more  than  the 
average  amount  of  exertion.  The  Swift  is  among  the  last  of  our 
Swallows  in  its  arrival,  and  the  first  to  depart.  Two  species  are 
known  in  this  country  ;  of  which  the  Black  Swift  is  by  far  the 
most  common, — the  White-bellied  or  Alpine  Swift  being  a  rare 
straggler.  The  Black  Swift  has  perhaps  the  largest  expanse  of 
feathers,  in  proportion  to  the  size  of  its  body,  of  any  Bird  ;  for  its 
length  is  nearly  eight  inches,  and  its  breadth  across  the  expanded 
wings  eighteen  inches,  whilst  the  weight  of  its  body  does  not 
exceed  an  ounce. 

409.  The  Swallows  and  Swifts  of  other  countries  bear  a  strong 
resemblance  to  our  own  in  their  general  habits ;  one  of  those 
most  worthy  of  notice  is  the  Esculent  Swallow  of  the  Javanese, 
by  which  are  constructed  the  remarkable  nests,  that  are  so  much 
valued  by  the  Chinese  as  delicacies  for  the  table.  The  material 
of  these  nests  is  not  yet  satisfactorily  ascertained ;  by  some  it  has 
been  supposed  to  be  a  kind  of  sea- weed,  which,  by  boiling  or 
steeping  in  water,  may  be  wholly  reduced  to  a  jelly ;  whilst 
others  consider  that  a  secretion  from  the  stomach  or  salivary 
glands  of  the  bird  itself  constitutes  a  large  part  of  it.  Fish 
spawn,  again,  has  been  said  to  have  been  found  in  the  substance 
of  the  nests.  Probably  various  marine  substances  of  a  gelatinous 
character  are  employed  by  these  Birds,  which  inhabit  deep 
caverns  on  the  brink  of  the  sea,  where  they  assemble  in  large 
numbers ;  and  these  are  united  by  the  viscid  secretion  formed  by 
the  Bird  itself,  as  in  our  own  Swallows.  The  collecting  these 
nests  is  a  proceeding  of  great  danger ;  but  a  large  number  of 
persons  are  employed  in  it,  as  may  be  judged  from  the  amount  of 
them  exported  to  China.  About  27,000  Ibs.  are  annually  trans- 
mitted from  Java  ;  and  these  are  of  the  best  quality.  A  still 


456 


FAMILY    TODID.£,    OR    TODIES  ; ROLLERS. 


greater  quantity  is  obtained  from  the  Suluk  Archipelago  ;  and 
much  also  from  Ceylon  and  New  Guinea.  It  is  calculated  that 
about  thirty  thousand  tons  of  Chinese  shipping  are  engaged  in 
the  traffic ;  and  that  the  value  of  their  freights  is  above  280,000/. 

410.  The  TODIDJE,  or  Todies^  have  a  remarkable  depression 
or  horizontal  flattening  of  the  beak  ;    which  is  blunt  at  the  end, 
and  has  a  gape  extending  as  far  back  as  the  eyes.      They  are 
mostly  inhabitants  of  tropical  climates  ;   some  groups  of  the 
family  being  restricted  to  South  America  and  the  West  Indies, 
and  others  to  India  and  the  Eastern  Archipelago.     They  are 
Birds  of  gaudy  plumage  and  rapid  flight ;   they  feed  on  worms, 
insects,  small  reptiles,  &c. ;  and  some  species  also  devour  berries. 
The  Rollers  are  the  only  representatives  of  this  family  in  the 
temperate  parts  of  the  Old  World  ;   and  they  depart  considerably 
from  its  general  form,  the  bill  being  much  longer  and  narrower 
than  in  the  Todies,  and  hooked  at  the  tip  ;   so  that,  except  in  its 
wide  gape  and  depression  near  the  base,  it  somewhat  resembles 
that  of  the  CorvidaB.      One  species,  the  Garrulous  Roller,  is  an 

occasional  visit- 
ant of  this  coun- 
try; it  is  about 
the  size  of  the 
blue- winged  jay, 
and  of  rather  ele- 
gant appearance. 
Its  habits  are  shy 
and  solitary;  but 
it  sometimes  as- 
sociates with 
Rooks  and  other 
Birds,  searching 
the  meadows  and 
ploughed  fields 

for  food.  This  bird  is  much  more  common  in  the  south  of  Europe, 
but  even  there  it  appears  to  be  a  summer  migrant  from  Africa. 

411.  The  TROGONIDJE,   Trogons  or  Curucuis,  have  a  short 
conical  beak,  with  the  tip,  and  generally  the  margins,   dentated 


FIG.  256. — GARRULOUS  ROLLER. 


TROGONID.E. ALCEDINID.E,    OR    KINGFISHERS.  457 

or  jagged.  They  are  covered  with  very  fine  soft  feathers  ;  and 
many  of  them  are  beautifully  coloured.  Their  habitation  is 
chiefly  in  low  damp  woods,  in  the  tropical  portions  of  America 
and  Asia ;  they  fly  early  in  the  morning,  and  in  the  evening  ; 
and  they  build  in  holes  in  trees.  Their  food  consists  partly  of 
insects,  and  partly  of  berries ;  and  whilst  watching  for  the 
former,  they  will  often  sit  for  hours  at  a  time,  perched  solitarily 
on  the  low  branches  of  trees,  in  the  most  secluded  portions  of 
dense  forests.  They  seem  to  be  stupified  by  the  glare  of  the 
sun ;  and  during  the  day  they  take  so  little  notice  of  the  pre- 
sence of  intruders,  that  they  may  be  approached  near  enough  to 
be  knocked  down  with  a  stick.  Their  flight  is  rapid  whilst  it 
lasts,  but  cannot  be  long  sustained.  The  Trogon  resplendens  of 
Mexico  is  a  most  splendid  Bird  ;  its  whole  upper  surface  being 
of  the  richest  metallic  golden  green  ;  and  the  tail  being  covered 
by  long  soft  plumes  of  the  same  hue.  These  plumes  were  made  use 
of  by  the  ancient  Mexicans  as  ornaments  for  their  head-dresses. 

412.  The  Birds  of  the  family  ALCEDINIDJE,  or  Kingfishers, 
have  a  long  quadrangular*  bill ;  which,  but  for  its  wide  gape, 
might  be  thought  to  belong  to  the  Conirostral  series.  The  wings 
are  long  ;  and  the  feet  very  small ;  the  front  toes  are  united  at 
their  base,  whence  this  group  has  been  separated  from  the  other 
Fissirostres,  by  the  title  of  Syndactyli,  which  indicates  the 
adhesion  of  the  fingers.  The  tail  is  short  ;  and  the  course  in 
flight  seems  rather  to  be  regulated  by  the  long  bill.  These  Birds 

for  the  most  part  live  on  fish,  which 
they  transfix  with  the  bill,  making 
use  of  it  as  a  fishing-spear.  The 
plumage  is  generally  of  a  brilliant 
blue  or  green  colour ;  and  very 
smooth  and  glossy,  so  as  not  to  be 
easily  wetted  by  water.  Their  nests 
are  situated  in  holes,  in  the  banks  of 
the  streams,  from  which  the  birds 

Fro.  257.— KINGFISHER.  ,  ,    .        ,,     .      f      ,         _,,  r 

obtain  their  food.     They  are  soli- 
tary Birds  in  their  habits ;  not  even  the  male  and  female  of  the 

*  Having  four  sides  and  angles. 
H  H 


458  ALCEDINID.E; — KINGFISHER,  PUFF-BIRI^S. 

same  pair  being  seen  in  each  other's  company,  except  at  breeding 
time.  Their  peculiar  forms,  bright  colours,  and  quick  motions, 
have  rendered  them  very  noted  Birds  from  an  early  period. 
The  only  species  of  this  family  that  inhabits  Britain,  is  the 
common  Kingfisher  or  Halcyon  ;  which  remains  throughout 
the  year  in  this  country,  shifting  its  station  occasionally  along  the 
margin  of  the  streams  and  lakes  which  it  frequents, — the  freezing 
of  the  shallower  waters  in  winter  driving  it  to  the  deeper.  It  is 
at  once  distinguished  from  any  other  of  our  native  Birds,  by  its 
large  body,  short  and  thick  neck,  disproportionately  long  bill, 
diminutive  feet,  and  abbreviated  tail.  When  Watching  for  its 
prey,  the  Kingfisher  perches  itself  upon  some  overhanging 
branch,  with  its  long  dagger-like  bill  pointed  downwards,  and 
its  eye  intent  upon  the  water  beneath.  Suddenly,  it  darts 
downwards,  plunges  headlong  into  the  water,  and  speedily  re- 
appears with  a  minnow  or  other  small  fish  between  its  mandibles. 
Without  loosing  its  hold,  it  passes  the  fish  through  its  bill  until 
it  has  fairly  grasped  it  by  the  tail ;  and  then  destroys  its  life,  by 
smartly  striking  its  head  three  or  four  times  against  the  branch, 
after  which  it  gulps  its  prey  at  one  mouthful,  except  when  it 
bears  it  away  to  the  nest  for  the  supply  of  the  young.  The  fish- 
bones, scales,  and  other  indigestible  parts  are  afterwards  disgorged 
by  the  mouth.  Various  other  species  of  Kingfisher  are  found 
indifferent  parts  of  the  Old  and  New  World. — This  family  also 
includes  the  Puff  Birds  of  South  America,  which  feed  on 
insects  ;  pursuing  their  prey  on  the  wing,  in  the  manner  of  the 
preceding  families.  They  have  a  moderate-sized  bill,  furnished 
with  bristles  at  its  base ;  their  plumage  is  smooth  and  dense, 
and  is  puffed  out  into  a  round  ball,  whence  their  name — The 
Jacamars,  also  inhabitants  of  South  America,  have  very  long, 
three-sided,  pointed  bills,  and  a  brilliant  metallic  plumage  ;  they, 
too,  feed  upon  insects. 

413.  The  last  family  of  the  Fissirostres  is  that  of  the  MERO- 
PID.E,  or  Bee-eaters  ;  these  have  long,  slightly-arched  beaks,  and 
long,  pointed  wings;  and  are  mostly  of  a  green  colour.  They 
associate  in  flocks,  and  fly  like  Swallows ;  pursuing  Bees  and 
Wasps,  on  which  they  prey  with  impunity.  They  are  found 


I 


MEROPIDJE,    OR    BEE-EATERS. — TENUIROSTRKS. 


459 


only  in  the  Old  World  and  in  Australia ;  and  there  is  one  species 
which  is  an  occasional  summer  visitant  of  the  British  Isles. 
This  is  a  very  beautiful  Bird,  about  eleven  inches  in  length,  and 
eighteen  inches  across  the  wings ;  its  plumage  is  mostly  of  a  clear 
sea-green,  with  a  golden-yellow  neck,  and  a  half-collar  of  black. 
It  is  tolerably  abundant  in  the  south-east  of  Europe  ;  even  there, 
however,  appearing  only  as  a  summer  visitant.  It  builds,  or 
rather  excavates,  its  nest  in  banks  remote  from  human  habita- 
tions ;  but  in  search  of  food  it  flies  in  the  close  vicinity  of  houses; 

and  the  boys  of 
Crete  are  said  to 
angle  for  it,  by 
attaching  a  small 
fish-hook  and  line 
to  a  Locust  or 
other  large  in- 
sect, and  by  let- 
ting the  insect 
fly  whilst  the 
line  is  retained 
in  the  hand. — 
A  considerable 

number  of  Bee-eaters  inhabit  Africa  ;  and  other  species  are  found 
in  Asia  and  Australia. 


TRIBE  IV.— TENUIROSTRES. 

414.  The  Tenuirostral  Birds  have  slender  compressed  bills, 
frequently  arched  ;  the  tongue  is  often  divided  at  the  tip  into 
numerous  filaments,  and  is  used  for  sucking  up  the  honey  from 
the  nectaries  of  flowers  ;  the  wings  are  usually  of  considerable 
length,  but  the  feet  are  very  slender,  with  the  exception  of  the 
hind  toe,  which  is  usually  robust,  and  serves  to  support  the 
animal  whilst  it  is  feeding.  These  Birds  are  for  the  most  part 
of  small  size  and  delicate  form,  and  of  great  variety  and  brilliancy 
of  plumage.  They  are  almost  exclusively  confined  to  the  torrid 

11  H   2 


460  FAMILY    TROCHILID.E,    OR    HUMMING-BIRDS. 

zone,  and  to  the  southern  hemisphere,  where  alone  we  meet  with 
the  typical  forms  of  the  group ;  the  few  species  that  are  found 
beyond  these  limits  do  not  exhibit  its  peculiarities  of  structure 
in  nearly  the  same  degree.  In  this  tribe  are  arranged  the 
TROCHILID.E,  or  Humming- Birds,  and  the  CINNYRIIXE,  or  Sun- 
Birds^ — the  families  in  which  the  beak  and  feet  are  most 
remarkable  for  their  length  and  slenderness  ;  and  also  the  MELI- 
PHAGID^E,  or  Honey -suckers,  the  UPUPID.E,  or  Hoopoes,  and  the 
CERTHIAD.E,  or  Creepers,  which  are  more  or  less  aberrant  in 
their  characters,  and  connect  the  group  with  others. 

415.  The  family  of  TROCHILID^,  or  Humming-Birds, 
includes  the  smallest  and  most  brilliant  of  the  whole  feathered 
race  (Fig.  225).  They  are  also  among  those  most  adapted 
for  rapid  flight  ;  the  muscles  of  their  wings  probably  exceeding 
those  of  any  other  known  Bird,  when  compared  with  the  size  of 
the  whole  body;  and  the  plumage  being  very  dense  and  compact. 
From  these  characters,  taken  in  connection  with  the  weakness  of 
the  legs,  the  Naturalist  might  at  once  infer  that  the  Humming- 
Birds  pass  the  greatest  part  of  their  time  on  the  wing  ;  and  this 
inference  would  be  found  to  correspond  exactly  with  their  real 
habits.  The  velocity  with  which  they  glance  through  the  air, 
and  the  rapidity  in  the  vibration  of  their  wings, — so  great  as  to 
elude  the  sight, — are  most  extraordinary;  and  when  hovering 
before  a  flower,  they  seem  suspended  in  the  air,  rather  than 
sustained  by  the  vigorous  movement  of  their  rigid  pinions. 
To  this  movement  is  due  the  constant  murmur  or  buzzing  sound, 
from  which  the  Birds  derive  their  name.  They  show  great 
courage,  and  even  pugnacity ;  especially  during  the  breeding 
season,  when  under  the  influence  of  jealousy.  When  attacked 
by  larger  Birds,  they  will  dart  themselves,  as  it  were,  against 
the  invaders ;  directing  their  needle-like  bills  against  the  eyes  of 
their  opponents,  so  ~as  to  become  very  formidable  adversaries. 
The  tongue  is  one  of  the  most  curious  features  in  their  organisa- 
tion ;  being  split  into  two  tubular  filaments,  which  are  capable 
of  being  darted  out  to  a  considerable  distance,  by  an  apparatus 
very  much  resembling  that  by  which  a  similar  motion  is  given  to 
the  tongue  of  the  Woodpecker  (§  343).  By  means  of  this 


HUMMING-BIRDS. CINNYRIDyE,    OR    SUN-BIRDS.  461 

instrument,  the  Humming-Bird  is  able  to  secure  both  vegetable 
juices,  and  the  insects  which  are  attracted  by  them ;  and  from 
the  large  quantity  of  the  latter,  of  which  the  remains  are  found 
in  its  stomach,  they  would  seem  to  constitute  the  principal 
portion  of  its  food.  Indeed  certain  species  of  this  family  appear 
destined  to  feed  exclusively  upon  insects ;  and  resort  to  the 
webs  of  spiders,  which  they  rob  of  the  prey  that  has  been  entrap- 
ped by  them.  This  beautiful  tribe  is  entirely  restricted  to 
America;  being  most  abundant  between  the  tropics,  and  not 
usually  extending  far  on  either  side.  Some  species,  however, 
migrate  into  the  temperate  regions  on  either  side  of  the  equator, 
during  the  warm  season  ;  and  stragglers  have  been  seen  in  very 
cold  situations.  They  are  most  numerous  in  the  dense  forests  of 
those  regions,  amongst  the  wild  blossoms  which  vie  with  them- 
selves in  splendour  ;  but  they  also  frequent  the  gardens  of  culti- 
vated districts,  and  do  not  appear  at  all  disinclined  to  the  society 
of  Man.  Their  nests  are  very  beautifully  constructed ;  being 
usually  composed  of  vegetable  down,  such  as  that  of  the  cotton- 
plant  or  silk-cotton  tree  ;  and  being  covered  on  the  outside  with 
bits  of  lichen,  leaves,  moss,  &c. 

416.  The  family  of  CYNNYRID.E,  or  Sun-Birds,  may  be 
regarded  as  representing  the  Humming-Birds  in  the  Old  World; 
almost  rivalling  them  in  brilliancy  of  plumage,  and  closely 
resembling  them  in  general  habits.  The  plumage  glitters  with 
metallic  reflections ;  but  these  do  not  vary  in  hue  in  different 
lights,  as  do  those  of  the  Humming-Birds, — the  same  points  in 
which  have  sometimes  the  lustre  of  the  emerald,  and  sometimes 
of  the  ruby,  according  to  the  direction  in  which  the  light  strikes 
them.  The  Suii-Birds  have  a  lengthened,  arched,  and  finely- 
toothed  bill ;  and  this  encloses  a  slender  tongue,  which  is  in  some 
species  forked  like  that  of  the  Humming-Birds,  and  in  others 
pencilled  at  its  extremity.  In  either  case,- it  serves  nearly  the 
same  purpose ;  the  food  of  these  Birds  consisting  chiefly  of 
vegetable  juices,  and  of  the  nectar  of  flowers,  both  of  which  are 
sought  in  the  depths  of  their  blossoms.  They  are  animated, 
rapid,  and  graceful  in  their  movements;  their  disposition  is 
lively,  and  their  song  agreeable.  In  this  last  respect  they  have 
the  superiority  over  the  Humming-Birds ;  whose  voice  is 


462  MELIPHAGID/E,    OR    HONEY-SUCKERS. UPUPIDJ2. 

nothing  more  than  a  shrill  cry.  The  Sun-Birds  range  over 
Africa,  Asia,  and  the  Pacific  Ocean ;  and  certain  species,  also 
included  in  this  family,  are  natives  of  South  America. 

417.  In   the   MELIPHAGID.E,   or   Honey-suckers, — a  family 
peculiar  to  New  Holland  and  the  neighbouring  islands, — the 
characters  exhibited  by  the  typical  groups  appear  softened  down, 
as  it  were ;  so  that  their  conformation  is  less  peculiar.     Thus 
the  bill  and  legs  are  stronger ;  and  the  powers  of  flight  are  less 
conspicuous.     The  tongue  is  still  adapted  for  suction ;   being 
furnished  with  a  pencil  of  delicate  filaments  at  its  extremity;  but 
it  is  not  nearly  so  extensible  as  in  the  Humming-IB irds  and  Sun- 
Birds  ;  and  the  branches  of  the  os  hyoides  do  not  pass  round  the 
skull.     Besides  the  juices  of  flowers,  and  the  insects  obtained 
with  them,  many  of  these  Birds  feed  on  berries,  for  which  their 
greater  strength  of  bill  adapts  them  ;  and  one  species  is  said  to 
pick  holes  in  the  bark,  and  to  draw  forth  insects  from  these,  by 
means  of  its  long  tongue,  very  much  in  the  manner  of  the  Wood- 
pecker.    The  Honeysuckers  deposit  their  eggs  in  cup-shaped 
nests,  placed  in  the  fork  of  small  branches  near  the  ground. 

418.  Of  the  more  aberrant  families  of  this  order,  we  may 
first  mention  that  of  UPUPID.E,  or  Hoopoes,  which   seems  to 
connect  it  with  the  family  CORVID^;  among  the  Conirostres ;  for 
whilst  some  of  the  species  it  includes  are  evidently  allied  closely 
to  the  suctorial  groups  we  have  just  been  considering,  others  (and 
among  these  the  Hoopoe  itself)  bear  a  close  relationship  to  certain 
forms  of  the  Crow  family.     They  have  all  a  general  agreement, 
however,  in  the  form  of  their  beak;  which  is  elongated  and 
curved,  but  stronger  than  in  the  preceding  families. — TheProm^- 
rops  and  its  allies  have  an  extensible  tongue,  divided  at  the  tip, 
as  in  the  Humming-Birds  ;  and  probably  feed  upon  the  saccha- 
rine juices   of  plants,  insects,  and  soft  fruits.     Many  of  these 
Birds  are  remarkable  for  the  beauty  of  their  plumage,  and  for  its 
singular  arrangement.     The  Superb  Promerops  of  New  Guinea 
is  four  feet  in  length,  from  the  extremity  of  the  bill  to  the  end 
of  the  tail  ;  the  tail  being  extremely  long  in  proportion  to  the 
body,  which  is  delicate  and  slender.     In  this  respect  it  is  analo- 
gous to  the  Birds  of  Paradise,  which  are  inhabitants  of  the  same 
region  ;  and  it  also  resembles  them  in  the  metallic  lustre  of  its 


FAMILY    UPUPID.E  ; PROMEHOPS,    HOOPOE. 


463 


feathery  covering.  The  head,  neck,  and  under  surface  of  the 
body  are  glittering  green  ;  and  the  feathers  which  cover  these 
parts  have  the  softness  of  velvet.  The  back  is  of  a  changeable 
violet  hue  ;  and  the  wings,  which  also  possess  a  velvety  texture, 
appear,  according  to  the  light  in  which  they  are  held,  blue,  violet, 
or  deep  black.  The  feathers  of  the  tail  and  of  the  wing-coverts 
have  the  brilliancy  of  polished  steel. — The  Hoopoes^  on  the  other 
hand,  have  much  of  the  habit  and  appearance  of  Crows.  The  bill 

is  used  in  the  same 
manner,  and  for  the 
same  purposes,  as 
in  the  Hornbills  ; 
— namely,  for  seiz- 
ing Insects,  £c., 
squeezing  them  to 
death,  and  throw- 
ing them  with  a 
jerk  into  the  throat. 
The  tongue  is  short, 
and  destitute  of  the 
power  of  extension. 

FIG.  259.-EUROPEAN  HOOPOE.  Tlle   legs    and    feet 

are  larger  than  in 

the  preceding  groups ;  and  are  better  adapted  both  for  perching 
and  walking.  The  European  Hoopoe  is  an  occasional  visitant  of 
Britain  ;  it  is  about  the  size  of  the  Missel-Thrush,  but  is  readily 
distinguished  from  it,  not  only  by  its  beautiful  crest,  but  by  the 
length  and  slenderness  of  its  bill,  and  the  shortness  of  its  feet.  It 
is  said  to  frequent  ploughed  lands  and  pasture  grounds  ;  which 
it  searches,  like  the  Crows,  for  Insect-grubs,  worms,  &c. ;  and  it 
breeds  in  hollow  trees  in  secluded  situations.  It  is  more  abun- 
dant on  the  Continent  of  Europe  than  in  Britain  ;  but  its  sojourn 
in  temperate  climates  is  but  short,  as  its  arrival  from  warmer 
regions  is  late,  and  its  departure  early.  In  Egypt  and  Northern 
Africa  it  seems  to  be  a  perpetual  resident ;  and  on  the  banks  of 
the  Nile,  where  it  is  of  great  service  in  keeping  down  the  multi- 
plication of  Insects,  it  becomes  very  familiar  with  Man,  and 
builds  its  nest  in  the  immediate  vicinity  of  his  habitations.  The 


464  FAMILY    CERTHIAD^E,    OR    CREEPERS. 

name  of  the  Bird  seems  to  be  derived  from  the  peculiar  sound, — 
resembling  hoop,  hoop,  hoop,  very  softly  and  rapidly  breathed  out, 
— which  it  is  continually  uttering. 

419.  As  the  preceding  group  conducted  us  towards  the 
Conirostral  Birds,  so  does  the  family  of  CERTHIAD^,  or  Creepers, 
lead  us  towards  the  Insectivorous  division  of  the  Perchers, — 
especially  the  Warblers,  with  which  some  of  them  have  a  very 
close  relationship ;  whilst  other  species  exhibit  an  equally  close 
relationship  to  the  Birds  of  the  next  order,  Scansores.  They  are 
for  the  most  part  adapted  to  live  upon  the  trunks  and  branches 
of  trees ;  and  to  feed  upon  the  Insects  which  infest  the  bark.  The 
form  of  the  bill  varies  in  different  species ;  being  long  and  slender 
in  some  ;  short  and  stout,  and  capable  of  penetrating  very  hard 
substances,  in  others.  Their  plumage  is  usually  of  a  dull  brown 
colour.  The  true  Creepers  have  a  long  slender  arched  bill,  enclos- 
ing a  long,  narrow,  sharp-pointed  tongue,  which  is  jagged  near 


PIG.  260. — HEAD,  FOOT,  AND  TAIL,  OF  BROWN  CREEPER. 

its  tip.  The  wings  are  long  and  rounded ;  the  feet  are  rather 
slender,  but  the  hinder  toe  is  long  and  stout ;  and  the  tips  of  the 
tail-feathers  extend  beyond  the  webs,  and  are  firm  and  pointed. 
These  Birds  cling  by  their  feet  to  the  perpendicular  surface 
of  trees,  resting  upon  the  stiff  quills  of  their  tails ;  they  creep 
from  the  base  to  the  summit  of  the  stem,  with  short  jerking 


CREEPERS; — NUTHATCH.  465 

movements ;  and  search  every  crevice  as  they  ascend.  They  will 
even  pass  round  a  horizontal  branch,  clinging  to  its  under- 
surface  with  their  backs  to  the  ground.  When  they  have 
ascended  one  tree  and  completely  searched  it,  they  fly  off  to  the 
base  of  another,  to  search  it  in  like  manner.  When  thus 
employed,  they  show  little  timorousness  ;  and  will  permit  them- 
selves to  be  approached  within  a  few  feet.  The  species  which 
inhabits  this  country  is  a  permanent  resident,  not  a  migrant ; 
for  its  food  is  to  be  obtained  at  all  seasons.  It  is  very  generally 
distributed  over  Europe,  and  seems  to  be  the  same  with  the 
Creeper  that  inhabits  North  America. — The  Nuthatches  have  a 
stronger,  straighter  and  more  conical  bill ;  they  are  for  the  most 
part  small  Birds,  and  present  a  considerable  resemblance  to  the 

Tits  (§  400)  in  their 
general  habits,  as  well 
as  in  their  form,  size, 
and  colouring.  They 
are  remarkable  for 
restless  activity,  mov- 
ing with  extreme 
quickness  up  and 
down  the  branches 
and  trunks  of  trees, 

PIG.  261.— EUROPEAN  NUTHATCH.  ,  .          ., 

searching  for   insects 

in  the  crevices  of  bark  and  among  the  leaves,  clinging  and  hang- 
ing to  the  twigs,  turning  with  astonishing  agility  in  all  direc- 
tions, and  flying  from  one  tree  to  another  in  search  of  their  food. 
Unlike  the  Creepers,  however,  they  generally  descend  trees, 
instead  of  ascending  them ;  and  they  usually  sleep  with  their 
heads  downwards.  They  feed  not  only  upon  insects,  larvae, 
&c. ;  but  also  upon  acorns,  chesnuts,  and  other  hard  fruits, 
which  they  split  or  perforate  with  their  strong  bills,  after  having 
fixed  them  in  a  crevice.  There  is  only  one  species  in  Europe  ; 
and  this  is  a  resident  in  South  Britain.  It  is  a  very  amusing 
Bird  in  confinement ;  but  must  be  kept  in  a  cage  entirely  formed 
of  wire,  as  it  speedily  chips  up  wood  with  its  bill. — Several  other 
species,  more  or  less  closely  allied  to  the  foregoing,  are  found  in 


466  FAMILY  CERTHIAD.E; — WREN,  LYRE-TAIL. 

America ;  which  country  seems  to  be  the  chief  habitation  of  this 

family. 

420.     We  are  'probably  also  to  include  in  this  family  the 

Wrens  ;  which   have  a  close  alliance  to  the  Gold-crests  among 

the  Warblers,  but  seem   on   the  whole  more  nearly  related  to 

the  Creepers.  They  have  a 
rather  long  and  slender  bill, 
short  wings,  an  elevated  tail, 
and  feet  of  moderate  size. 
Their  colouring  is  usually 
dull,  and  not  in  any  case  re- 
markable for  brilliancy.  They 
live  chiefly  on  or  near  the 

FIG.  262 — EUROPEAN  WREN.  ,  ,  .  . 

ground,   seeking   for   insects 

and  worms  among  the  low  bushes ;  and  they  construct  a  very 
bulky  nest  of  vegetable  substances,  such  as  dried  ferns,  lined  with 
moss  and  feathers.  They  inhabit  both  Continents;  and  some  of  the 
species  are  among  the  hardiest  of  all  the  smaller  Birds,  in  resist- 
ing extremes  of  cold.  There  is  only  one  species  of  true  Wren  in 
this  country,  arid  this  is  widely  diffused  over  Europe ;  all  the 
others  at  present  known  belong  to  North  America.  The  Euro- 
pean Wren  is  one  of  the  most  familiarly  known  of  all  our  small 
Birds,  on  account  of  the  liveliness  of  its  habits,  as  well  as  its 
peculiarity  of  form.  Its  flight  is  effected  by  a  rapid  and  con- 
tinuous motion  of  the  wings ;  but  it  is  not  long  sustained,  for  the 
Bird  merely  flits  from  one  bush  to  another,  or  from  stone  to  stone. 
Sometimes,  however,  it  ascends  trees,  nearly  in  the  manner  of 
the  Creepers.  The  male  has  a  very  pleasing,  rich,  and  mellow 
song ;  which  is  principally  heard  in  spring  and  summer,  but 
which  is  occasionally  put  forth  in  autumn  and  on  fine  days  in 
winter. — Allied  to  the  Wrens  is  a  very  extraordinary  Bird, 
probably  the  largest  of  the  Insessorial  order, — the  Mcenura,  or 
Lyre-tail  of  Australia.  This  is  distinguished  by  the  extraordi- 
nary plumage  of  its  tail,  the  feathers  of  which  rise  up  on  either  side, 
so  as  to  present  the  form  of  an  ancient  lyre, — whence  the  name 
given  to  the  Bird.  In  other  respects,  however,  it  bears  a  strong 
resemblance  both  to  the  Wrens  and  Thrushes ;  except  in  regard 


LYRE-TAIL. — ORDER   SCANSORES.  467 

to  its  large  size, — equalling  that  of  a  Pheasant,  which  has  caused 
some  Naturalists  to  place  it  among  the  Gallinaceous  Birds.  Its 
food  appears  to  consist  principally  of  insects,  centipedes,  snails, 
&c. ;  in  search  of  which  it  strides  with  ease  over  loose  stones, 
and  the  sides  of  rocky  gullies  and  ravines.  It  is  further  distin- 
guished for  its  vocal  powers ;  for  it  possesses  a  loud  full  note, 
which  may  be  heard  for  at  least  a  quarter  of  a  mile  ;  and  also 
an  inward  warbling  song.  It  is  an  extremely  shy  Bird,  inhabit- 
ing secluded  situations,  and  taking  alarm  at  the  slightest  unac- 
customed sound. 


ORDER  III.— SCANSORES. 

421.  THE  power  of  turning  one  of  the  front  toes  backwards, 
so  as  to  oppose  two  hind  toes  to  the  two  front  ones  (Fig.  187), 
is  that  which   particularly  distinguishes   this  order :    but   the 
group  thus  formed  scarcely  appears  to  be  a  really  natural  one ; 
since  the  families  which  possess  this  character  differ  from  each 
other  in  so  many  particulars,  that  they  do  not  seem  to  have  any 
close  connection.     Their  food,  habits,  aspect,  and  structure,  are 
so  dissimilar,  that  no  general  statement  is  applicable  to  all  of 
them;  except  that  the  form  of  their  feet,  which  gives  them 
great  power  of  prehension,  and  thus  enables  them  to  cling  with 
firmness  to  their  perch,   renders  walking  more  difficult ;  and 
that,  as  they  pass  most  of  their  time  in  trees,  their  powers  of 
flight  are  usually  moderate.     This  order  comprehends  the  fami- 
lies of  PSITTACIDJE,  or  Parrots ;  RAMPHASTID^E,  or  Toucans ; 
PICID.E,  or  Woodpeckers;  and  CUCULID^E,  or  Cuckoos. 

422.  The  general  form  and  structure  of  the  PSITTACID^E  is 
known  to  every  one,  from  domesticated  specimens.     They  are 
characterised  by  their  short  hard  beaks,  which  are  generally 
highly  arched,  and  surrounded  at  the  base  by  a  naked  skin,  in 
which  are  the  orifices  of  the  nostrils.     They  are  natives  of  tro- 
pical and  the  warmer  temperate  regions  ;  and  they  live  for  the 
most  part  upon  fruits,  seeds,  honey,  &c.,  seeking  their  food  in 
trees,  or  upon  the  ground.     This  family  is  a  very  numerous  one ; 


468    FAMILY  PSITTACID^E; — PARROTS,  COCKATOOS,  MACCAWS. 
and  is  subdivided,  chiefly  according  to  the  form  of  the  bill  and 


Fro.  263.— BILL  OF  COCKATOO. 

tail,  into  several  groups,  most  of  which  are  well  known  in  this 

country,  by  the  domesticated 
specimens  which  have  been 
introduced  into  it. — The  true 
Parrots  have  the  upper  man- 
dible toothed,  and  longer  than 
it  is  high ;  and  the  tail  is 
short,  and  even  or  rounded  at 
the  end.  They  are  found  in 
abundance  in  the  tropical 
forests  of  both  the  Old  and 
New  World. — In  the  Cockatoos, 
the  bill  is  higher  and  curved 
from  the  base ;  the  head  large 
and  generally  crested ;  the 
tail  lengthened,  broad,  and 
rounded. — The  Maccaws  have 
a  long  tail,  pointed  at  the  end  ; 
the  upper  mandible  is  very 
much  hooked,  so  that  the  tip 
descends  far  over  the  extre- 
mity of  the  lower  one ;  and  the 
lower  one  is  deeper  than  it  is 

long.     They  live  in  flocks  in  the  forests  of  the  New  World ;  and 


FIG.  264.— MACCAW. 


PSITTACID.E  J PARRAKEETS,    LOVE-BIRDS.    LORIES.          469 

feed  on  fruits,  maize,  &c. — They  are  represented  in  the  Old 
"World  by  the  ParraJceets  ;  of  which  one  group,  inhabiting  Aus- 
tralia, is  formed  to  live  on  the  ground. — The  Love- Birds  are  a 
beautiful  group,  consisting  of  very  diminutive  species ;  they  are 
found  in  both  Continents,  and  are  remarkable  for  having  no  fur- 
cula. — The  Lories  are  an  Oriental  group,  having  square  tails,  and 
dense  soft  plumage,  the  colours  of  which  are  extremely  brilliant ; 
their  beaks  are  comparatively  feeble.  Some  allied  species  are 
remarkable  for  their  extensible  tongue,  furnished  with  a  pencil 
of  filaments  at  its  extremity  ;  by  which  they  are  adapted  to  suck 
up  the  nectar  of  flowers,  in  the  manner  of  the  suctorial  birds 
last  described  :  these  are  termed  Lorikeets. — Each  species  of 
this  numerous  family  appears  to  have  its  own  peculiar  residence, 
and  a  very  limited  distribution  around  it ;  this  may  be  partly 
accounted  for  by  the  shortness  of  the  wings,  and  the  want  of 
powers  of  flight,  which  prevent  their  migrations;  but  it  is 
partly  due  also,  to  the  adaptation  of  each  to  a  peculiar  set  of 
conditions,  which  would  not  be  met  with  elsewhere.  Notwith- 
standing the  differences  in  their  plumage,  the  various  members 
of  this  family  appear  to  be  formed,  as  it  were,  upon  one  model ; 
and  this  model  differs  so  widely  from  that  of  all  other  Birds, 
that  many  Naturalists  have  proposed  to  class  the  Parrots  as 
an  order  distinct  in  itself.  They  are  remarkable  for  their  edu- 
cdbility,  and  for  the  degree  of  intelligence  they  display ;  which 
appears  to  be  superior  to  that  of  most,  if  not  all,  other  Birds. 
They  have,  too,  more  prehensile  power  than  the  other  feathered 
tribes,  and  make  more  use  of  it ;  being  often  seen,  when  in  con- 
finement, to  grasp  their  perch  with  one  foot,  and  to  convey 
their  food  to  the  mouth  with  the  other.  Further,  although 
their  voice  is  naturally  harsh  and  unmusical,  they  can  be  taught 
to  imitate  the  sound  of  the  human  voice  in  speaking  and  singing ; 
in  which  great  assistance  is  probably  given  by  their  thick 
fleshy  tongue,  as  well  as  by  the  complicated  structure  of  their 
inferior  larynx.  In  their  superior  prehensile  powers,  their  intel- 
ligence, and  their  arboreal  habits,  the  Parrot  tribe  seems  to  hold 
in  the  class  of  Birds  a  situation  analogous  to  that  of  the  Qua- 
drumana  among  Mammalia. 


470  RAMPHASTID.E,    OR    TOUCANS. PIGID^E. 

423.  The  family  of  RAMPHASTHXE,  or  Toucans,  is  distin- 
guished by  the  very  large,  light,  cellular  bill,  which  is  irregularly 
notched  at  the  edge;  and  by  tne  peculiar  long,  feather-like 
tongue.  The  beak  is  used  by  these  Birds  for  a  sort  of  masti- 


FIG.  265. — BILL  OF  TOUCAN. 


cation ;  the  food  being  crushed  between  the  mandibles  in  several 
different  directions,  before  it  is  swallowed;  and  being  then 
tossed  up  into  the  air,  and  caught  in  its  descent.  The  Toucans 
live  on  fruit,  small  birds,  and  eggs ;  they  may  be  kept  in  confine- 
ment upon  a  vegetable  diet  only ;  but  they  show  great  excite- 
ment when  a  small  bird  is  presented  to  them.  They  are  only 
found  in  tropical  America,  where  they  live  retired  in  the  deep 
forests,  mostly  in  small  companies.  Their  flight  is  straight  but 
laborious ;  among  the  branches  of  trees,  however,  their  move- 
ments are  easy  and  active.  Their  voice  is  harsh  ;  its  only  sound 
resembling  the  caw  of  a  Rook,  abruptly  terminated. 

424.  The  PICIDJE,  or  Woodpeckers,  have  a  wedge-shaped  bill, 
with  the  hard  points  and  the  sides  compressed  near  the  tip ;  the 
tail  is  usually  lengthened  and  rigid,  serving  to  support  the  Bird, 
as  in  the  Creepers ;  in  other  species,  however,  it  is  short  and 
rounded.  They  search  the  trunks  and  branches  of  trees,  especially 
those  which  are  decayed,  for  insects  and  larvae ;  to  procure  which, 
they  drive  off  chips  from  the  bark,  or  dig  into  the  wood.  "When 
thus  engaged,  they  cling  to  the  trunk  or  branch  by  their  strong, 
curved,  and  finely-pointed  cawls ;  and  support  themselves  by 
resting  on  their  stiff  tails.  When  the  aperture  has  been  made 
with  the  bill,  the  insect  or  larva  is  withdrawn  by  means  of  the 
extensible  tongue  (§  343)  ;  which  is  barbed,  towards  its  tip,  with 
small  but  strong  filaments,  that  act  like  the  teeth  of  a  rake, 


PICID^E,  OR  WOODPECKERS; — WRYNECK. 


471 


FIG.  266. — WOODPECKER. 


and  is  moistened  with  a  glutinous  saliva.  These  Birds  are 
generally  distributed  through  both  Hemi- 
spheres ;  but  are  most  abundant  in  the 
warmer  regions,  though  some  live  on 
the  borders  of  the  frigid  zone.  Their 
residence  is  in  the  forests,  where  they 
live  solitarily,  avoiding  the  society  of 
their  own  species.  They  nestle  in 
holes  dug  by  themselves  in  decayed 
trees;  and  deposit  their  eggs  at  the 
bottom,  usually  without  interposing 
anything  between  them  and  the  wood. 
Four  species  are  found  in  Britain,  of 
which  one  seems  to  be  an  occasional 
visitant.  —  The  family  contains  nume- 
rous other  genera,  more  or  less  varying  in  structure  and  habits 
from  the  true  Woodpeckers,  and  distributed  over  the  whole 
surface  of  the  globe.  Some  of  these  live  principally  on  the 
ground  ;  and  feed  on  ants,  &c. — Among  them  we  may  mention, 
as  a  native  of  Britain,  the  Wryneck,  which  has  a  broad  soft  tail, 
instead  of  a  stiff  one.  Though  its  plumage  is  not  brilliant,  it 
is  one  of  the  most  beautiful  of  British  Birds  ;  being  of  elegant 
form,  and  having  its  colours  disposed  in  a  curiously-intricate 
manner.  In  its  general  conformation,  it  bears  a  strong  resem- 
blance to  the  Cuckoo  ;  but  it  agrees  with  the  Woodpecker  in 
the  extensibility  of  the  tongue,  and  in  the  mode  in  which  it  is 
used  for  capturing  insects.  Its  name  is  derived  from  its  curious 
habit  of  twisting  its  neck,  with  a  very  odd  gesture,  when 
alarmed.  Ant-hills  are  its  favourite  resort;  for  these  supply 
it  copiously  with  the  food  of  which  it  is  most  fond. 

425.  The  [family  CucuLiD^E,  or  Cuckoo  tribe,  consists  of  a 
rather  extensive  series  of  Birds,  for  the  most  part  inhabitants 
of  the  warmer  regions  of  the  globe,  and  none  permanently 
residing  in  countries  subject  to  severe  winter  cold.  They  have 
a  slightly-arched  compressed  beak,  and  a  long  rounded  tail ; 
their  wings  are  usually  of  moderate  length,  and  they  fly  with 
rapidity  ;  their  tarsi  are  short,  and  their  feet  rather  adapted  for 


472          FAMILY  CUCULID.E; — CUCKOOS,  HONEY-QDIDES. 

grasping  a  perch,  than  for  climbing  trees.  They  feed  on  insects, 
worms,  and  soft  fruits ;  in  procuring  which  they  glide  among 
the  twigs  and  foliage,  leaping  from  branch  to  branch,  and  flitting 
from  one  tree  to  another ;  when  on  the  ground,  however,  they 
walk  awkwardly,  on  account  of  the  shortness  of  their  tarsi.  The 
remarkable  instinct  of  the  true  Cuckoos,  of  which  one  species  is 


FIG.  267- — GREY  CUCKOO. 

a  regular  summer  visitant  in  Britain,  has  been  already  noticed 
(§  351).  This  Bird  seems  to  be  more  universally  spread  over 
the  country,  than  any  other  of  the  migrating  species ;  for  it  is 
found  not  only  in  open  cultivated  districts,  but  in  the  wood  and 
thickets  of  upland  glens,  and  on  bare  rocky  hills  and  bleak 
moors. — Nearly  allied  to  the  Cuckoo,  are  the  Cowcows  of 
America,  which,  like  our  own  race,  derive  their  names  from 
their  peculiar  notes.  Their  general  habits  are  the  same  ;  but 
they  build  nests  for  themselves,  and  do  not  intrude  upon  others. 
To  this  family  also  belong  the  Indicators  or  Honey-guides 
of  Africa  ;  which  are  celebrated  for  their  curious  habit  of  guid- 
ing the  natives  to  the  nests  of  the  wild  Bees,  enticing  'them  to 
the  spot  by  flitting  before  them,  and  reiterating  a  peculiar  cry. 
They  have  short,  strong,  and  rather  conical  bills,  resembling 
those  of  the  Sparrow.  Their  skin  is  very  tough,  and  protects 
them  from  the  stings  of  Bees ;  but  these  sometimes  kill  them  by 
attacking  their  eyes. 


473 


ORDER  IV.— RASORES. 

426.  THE  Birds  of  this  order  are  for  the  most  part  adapted 
to  a  kind  of  life  entirely  different  from  the  preceding ;  being 
destined  to  obtain  their  subsistence  from  the  vegetable  world, 
and  to  pass  their  time  upon  the  ground,  rather  than  among  trees, 
or  upon  the  wing.  Their  food  chiefly  consists  of  grains  and 
seeds ;  to  obtain  this  they  are  furnished  with  short,  blunt,  and 
robust  nails,  the  use  of  which  has  obtained  for  them  the  appella- 
tion of  Rasores,  or  Scratchers.  Their  bodies  are  for  the  most  part 
bulky,  and  their  legs  strong  ;  their  powers  of  flight  are  incon- 
siderable, their  wings  not  being  of  a  size  proportionate  to  their 
bulk;  but  their  legs  are  sufficiently  long  to  enable  them  to 
walk  with  facility  upon  the  ground.  The  beak  is  usually 
arched  ;  and  surrounded  at  the  base  with  a  soft  skin,  in 


Fro.  268. — NEPAL  HORN KI>  TBAOOPAX. 

which  the  nostrils  are  pierced.  To  meet  the  difficulty  which 
attends  the  reduction  of  their  food,  they  are  provided  with 
a  large  crop  and  a  powerful  muscular  gizzard  (Fig.  201)  ; 
by  the  action  of  which  it  is  prepared  for  the  digestive  pro- 
cess. The  nests  of  these  Birds  are  rudely  constructed ;  and 
are  usually  situated  on  the  ground.  Instead  of  associating  in 


474  ORDER    RASORES  ; GENERAL    CHARACTERS. 

pairs,  they  are  polygamous, — that  is,  each  male  is  surrounded 
by  several  females.  The  male  takes  no  part  in  the  construction 
of  the  nest,  or  in  the  nurture  of  th  j  young ;  and  these  are  hatched 
with  their  eyes  open,  and  with  their  bodies  covered  with  soft 
downy  feathers,  and  are  generally  able  to  walk  about  in  search 
of  their  own  food,  as  soon  as  they  leave  the  shell.  The  Birds  of 
this  order  are  for  the  most  part  domesticable  ;  but  they  show  a 
low  degree  of  intelligence.  Of  all  the  feathered  tribes,  they  are 
the  most  useful  to  Man ;  affording  him  a  large  quantity  of 
wholesome  and  delicate  food.  In  their  domesticated  state  they 
multiply  with  great  rapidity,  if  kept  well  supplied  with  nourish- 
ment. The  plumage  of  the  males  is  generally  gay,  and  often 
possesses  a  degree  of  brilliancy  rivalling  that  of  the  most  splendid 
among  the  Perchers  ;  they  are  frequently  distinguished,  also,  by 
possessing  crests,  or  other  ornamental  appendages  to  the  head, 
The  females,  however,  are  of  much  more  sober  aspect. 

427.  There  are   many   interesting    analogies  between   the 
Rasorial  Birds,  and  the  Ruminant  tribes  among  Mammalia.     In 
the  first  place,  the  food  of  both  is  vegetable ;  and  in  both  there 
is  a  peculiar  provision  for  moistening  it  and  reducing  it,  before  it 
is  submitted  to  the  true  digestive   process.     The  crop  of  the 
Fowl  is  strictly  analogous  to  the  paunch  of  the   Sheep ;  both 
being  mere  dilatations  of  the  ossophagus,  to  receive  the  food  as  fast 
as  it  is  swallowed,  and  to  retain  it  whilst  it  is  being  thoroughly 
saturated  with  fluid.     Again,  these  tribes  correspond  in  their 
low  degree  of  intelligence,  and  in  the  facility  with  which  they 
are  brought  under  subjection  to  Man ;  we  find  in  them  by  far 
the  greater  number  of  the  domesticated  species,  in  their  respective 
classes.     Further,  they  are  alike  in  regard  to  the  bulk  of  their 
bodies,  and  the  degree  in  which  this  may  be  increased  by  an 
extra  supply  of  food.     They  resemble  each  other,  also,  in  the 
tendency  to  variation  which  they  exhibit,  under  the  influence  of 
varieties  in  external  circumstances ;  giving  origin  to  numerous 
different  breeds.     And,  lastly,  they  correspond  in  the  possession, 
by  the   males,  of  appendages  to  the  head;  which   are  rarely 
possessed  by  Birds  or  Quadrupeds  of  other  orders. 

428.  The  family  of  COLUMBIA,  or  Pigeons^  differs  in  many 


FAMILY    COLUMBIA,    OR    PIGEONS. 


475 


respects  from  the  general  type  of  the  Rasores,  and  approaches  to 
the  Perching  Birds.  The  bill  is  formed  upon  the  plan  of  that 
of  the  Gallinaceae  ;  but  the  wings,  feet,  and  tail,  more  resemble 
those  of  the  Insessores ;  and  they  live  more  among  trees  than  upon 
the  ground.  They  associate  invariably  in  pairs  ;  their  nests  are 
constructed  in  trees,  or  in  the  holes  of  rocks ;  and  both  parents  sit 
upon  the  eggs.  They  have  more  musical  voices,  too,  than  the  gene- 
rality of  the  Gallinaceous  Birds ;  although  their  vocal  powers  are 
not  great.  The  Pigeons  are  further  remarkable  for  the  peculiar 
mode  in  which  the  young  are  fed.  The  crop,  instead  of  being 
an  expansion  of  the  oesophagus  on  the  right  side  only,  as  in  other 
Birds,  is  double;  and  its  walls  are  furnished  with  numerous 
glands,  which  become  developed  in  both  sexes  during  the  period 
of  incubation.  These  glands  secrete  a  sort  of  milky  substance,  with 
which  the  food  that  passes  into  the  crop  is  moistened  ;  and  the 
food,  saturated  with  this  secretion,  is  disgorged  by  the  parents 
for  the  nourishment  of  their  young.  In  Fig.  269  is  represented 
the  double  craw  of  the  Pigeon ; 
one  side  (a)  exhibiting  its  usual 
aspect,  and  the  other  side  (b) 
showing  its  appearance  in 
Pigeons  which  have  newly- 
hatched  young.  — The  true 
Pigeons  are  found  in  most  parts 
of  the  World  ;  and  in  some  they 
multiply  to  an  enormous  extent. 
In  Britain  there  are  four  native 
species ;  the  Ring-Dove,  Cushat, 
or  Wood-Pigeon,  which  is  the 
largest  of  these;  the  Rock- 
Pigeon,  which  is  the  original  of 
all  our  domesticated  breeds; 
the  Stock-Dove,  which,  like  the 
Ring-Dove,  chiefly  frequents 
coppices  and  groves;  and  the 

Turtle-Dove,  which  is  the  smallest,  the  most  elegantly  formed, 
and  the  most  beautifully  coloured.     Among  the  Pigeons  of  other 

n2 


FIG.  269.— PIGEON'S  CRAW. 


476  FAMILY    COLUMBID^E,    OR    PIGEONS. 

countries,  there  are  none  more  remarkable  than  the  Passenger- 
Pigeons  of  North  America  ;  the  multiplication  of  which  is  so 
rapid,  and  their  destructive  power  so  great,  that  they  are  obliged 
to  migrate  from  place  to  place  in  vast  flocks,  to  obtain  their  food. 
These  flocks  are  often  so  extensive,  that  they  occupy  three  hours 
in  passing  any  given  spot ;  and  as  the  Birds  fly  with  great 
rapidity  and  steadiness,  their  rate  is  probably  not  less  than  sixty 
miles  an  hour  ;  from  which  the  length  of  a  single  flock  must  be 
180  miles.  It  has  been  calculated  by  M.  Audubon,  that  the 
number  of  individuals  in  one  of  these  enormous  flocks,  estimating 
its  breadth  at  a  mile,  and  allowing  two  Pigeons  to  each  square 
yard  (which  is  rather  within  than  beyond  the  mark),  amounts  to 
1115  millions;  and  that  as  each  Pigeon  daily  consumes  fully 
half  a  pint  of  food,  the  quantity  necessary  for  supplying  this 
multitude  must  be  8,712,000  bushels  per  day.  When  it  is  stated, 
also,  that  great  numbers  of  such  flocks  often  follow  one  another, 
darkening  the  air  for  several  days  in  succession,  the  wonder  is, 
not  that  they  should  do  great  injury  to  the  agriculturist,  and 
should  be  dreaded  by  him  as  a  pest,  but  that  they  should  any- 
where find  a  sufficient  supply  of  nutriment.  Their  breeding- 
places  are  described  as  large  forest-tracts,  fifty  miles  in  length, 
by  four  or  five  in  breadth;  in  which  every  tree  is  occupied  by 
from  fifty  to  a  hundred  nests. — Allied  to  the  true  Pigeons  on  one 
side,  but  presenting  more  points  of  resemblance  to  the  Insessores, 
are  the  Tree-Pigeons  of  Asia,  Africa,  and  Australia  ;  they  have 
long  wings,  and  live  among  trees,  feeding  on  fruits  and  berries. 
And,  on  the  other  side  are  the  Ground-Doves,  which  have 
short  rounded  wings,  and  which  are  mostly  seen  on  the  ground 
seeking  for  grains  and  seeds ;  these  are  inhabitants  of  both 
hemispheres. 

429.  The  proper   Gallinaceous  Birds  are  divided  into  six 
families;  the  CRACIDJE,  or   Curassow- Birds ;  the  PHASIANIDJE, 
or  Pheasants ;  the  TETRAONIDJE,  or  Grouse  ;  the  CHIONID^,  or 
Sheath-lills ;  the  TINAMID^E,  or  Tinamous ;  and  the  MEGAPO- 
DIDJE,  or  Megapodes. 

430.  The  family  of  CRACIDJE,  or  Curassows,  is  peculiar  to 
tropical  America,  living  in  the  woods,  building  in  trees,  and 


CRACIDJE,    OR    CURASSOW-BIRDS. PHASIANID^. 


477 


easily  tamed.  Many  of  them  approach  the  Turkey  in  magni- 
tude ;  and  their  flesh  in  delicacy  and  whiteness  surpasses  that  of 
the  Fowl  or  Pheasant.  They  feed  on  berries  and  on  various 
sorts  of  game.  In  many  parts  of  South  America,  these  Birds 
have  been  long  domesticated  ;  and  there  is  no  doubt  that  they 

might  be  profitably  intro- 
duced into  Europe,  since  it 
has  been  proved  that  they 
readily  become  habituated 
to  its  climate,  and  that  they 
thrive  as  well,  and  breed  as 
rapidly,  in  confinement,  as 
do  ordinary  Poultry.  The 
Crested  Curassow  is  one  of 
the  most  common  Birds  of 
Guiana;  living  in  the  forests, 
and  on  the  borders  of  the 
cultivated  tracts;  and  build- 
ing its  nest  on  trees.  It 
congregates  in  large  troops  ; 

and  is  extremely  unsuspicious  of  danger,  except  when  it  has  been 
frequently  molested.  This  species  has  been  bred  in  Holland  ; 
and  is  common  in  a  domestic  state  in  Berbice,  Essequibo,  and 
elsewhere  ;  it  requires  little  care,  but  needs  plenty  of  room,  a 
dry  soil  and  sheltered  situation,  and  trees  on  which  to  perch. 
It  is  found  also  in  Mexico  and  Brazil, — its  range  being  thus 
very  extensive. 

431.  In  the  family  PHASIANID.E,  or  Pheasant  tribe,  the  hind 
toe  is  placed  higher  on  the  tarsus  than  the  front  ones,  so  that 
only  the  tip  touches  the  ground ;  and  the  tarsus  of  the  male  is 
generally  furnished  with  one  or  more  spurs  (Fig.  271).  This 
group  includes,  with  the  Common  Fowls,  the  Peacocks,  Phea- 
sants, Turkeys,  Partridges,  &c.,  of  various  parts  of  the  world ; 
all  of  which  agree  in  these  characters,  and  in  their  general  mode 
of  life.  The  native  country  of  the  true  Fowls  appears  to  be 
India,  in  the  jungles  of  which  these  Birds  abound,  their  food 
consisting  of  grain,  seeds,  &c.  They  are  characterised  by  the 


FIG.  270. — CRESTED  CURASSOW. 


478  FAMILY  PHASIANHXE; — FOWLS. 

arching  of  the  tail,  and  its  lateral  compression,  and  by  the  pre- 
sence of  wattles  on  the  sides  of  the  head.     Of  all  domestic 


Fio.  271.— FOOT  OF  COMMON  FOWL. 

Birds,  the  Common  Fowl  seems  to  have  been  the  earliest  reclaimed, 
and  is  the  most  extensively  spread.  It  has  now  branched  out 
into  numerous  varieties  or  breeds,  many  of  them  differing  con- 
siderably from  each  other ;  thus  one  is  destitute  of  tail,  another 
has  the  comb  replaced  by  a  tuft  of  feathers,  another  has  five  toes 
on  each  foot,  and  the  Bantam  variety  has  the  tarsi  feathered 
down  to  the  toes.  The  Bankiva  Jungle  Fowl  is  probably  the 
species  whence  they  were  derived,  this  being  found  to  breed 
freely  with  the  domesticated  races.  The  period  at  which  it  was 
introduced  into  our  island  is  completely  uncertain ;  but  we  know 
that  it  must  have  been  very  remote.  The  ancient  Greeks  and 
Romans  valued  it  for  its  pugnacity ;  and  frequently  engraved  its 
figure  on  their  medals.  The  taste  for  Cock-fighting  has  pre- 
vailed, not  merely  among  the  ancients,  but  among  several 
modern  nations ;  the  Chinese,  the  Sumatrans,  and  the  Mussul- 
man natives  of  India,  are  devoted  to  the  sport, — if  such  it  may 
be  called ;  and  in  our  own  country,  it  has  long  ranked  amongst 
the  amusements  of  the  people.  The  diffusion  of  intellectual 
knowledge,  however,  combined  with  the  elevation  in  tue  popular 


PHASIANID^E; — PHEASANTS,  TRAGOPANS,  TURKEYS.      479 

tastes,  is  now  rapidly  putting  an  end  to  the  practice  in  this 
country. — The  Pheasants  are  nearly  allied  to  the  Fowls ;  but 
they  have  the  tail  more  lengthened,  with  narrow  and  pointed 
tail-feathers;  and  the  neck  is  usually  deficient  in  wattles.  They 
are  found  wild  in  various  parts  of  Asia,  where  many  very 
splendid  species  exist, — amongst  them  the  Argus  (Fig.  272), 
a  native  of  Sumatra,  Malacca,  and  the  south-east  of  Asia,  which 


Fio.  272.— ARGUS  PHEASANT. 

is  so  named  from  the  numerous  eye-like  spots  on  its  feathers. 
This  beautiful  Bird  is  little  inferior  to  a  Peacock  in  size,  and  the 
middle  tail-feathers  of  the  male  often  exceed  four  feet  in  length  ; 
it  is  remarkable  for  the  elongation  and  breadth  of  the  secondary 
quill-feathers,  which  spread  boldly  out  at  their  extremities, 
and  form,  when  the  wings  are  opened,  a  sweeping,  fan-like 
plume. — The  Tragopans  (Fig.  268)  seem  to  connect  the  Phea- 
sants with  the  Turkeys,  being  provided  with  large  wattles, 
which  are  characteristic  of  the  latter.  They  are  inhabitants  of 
the  countries  forming  the  northern  border  of  India,  and  are 
very  splendidly  coloured. — The  Turkeys  have  a  short  and 
rounded  tail,  and  the  head  and  neck  bare  of  feathers.  The 


480        PHASIANID^E  ; — TURKEYS,    PEACOCKS,    PARTRIDGES. 

wattles,  which  are  larger  in  them  than  in  any  other  birds  of  this 
family,  are  loose  flaps  of  skin,  copiously  supplied  with  blood- 
vessels, and  capable  of  being  contracted  or  dilated  at  pleasure  ; 
they  are  greatly  affected  by  the  emotions  of  the  animal,  becoming 
distended,  and  of  a  heightened  colour,  under  the  influence  of 
fear  or  anger, — probably  in  the  same  manner  as  the  cheeks  of 
Man  are  reddened  by  the  blush  of  shame  or  the  excitement  of 
rage.  Turkeys  are  natives  of  the  forests  of  North  and  Central 
America,  where  they  feed  on  grain  and  other  vegetable  sub- 
stances; and  their  introduction  into  Europe.,  therefore,  has 
been  of  comparatively  recent  date. — The  Peacocks  are  at  once 
distinguished  by  the  great  length  of  the  tail,  and  by  the  peculiar 
arrangement  of  the  numerous  feathers,  which  enables  the  bird  to 
spread  them  out  into  a  complete  circle  at  will.  They  are  inhabit- 
ants of  Asia,  where  they  inhabit  the  woods  and  jungles,  feeding 
on  grain,  buds,  &c. — The  Partridges  and  Quails  seem  to  be 
the  only  birds  of  this  family  that  naturally  inhabit  cold  or  tem- 
perate regions,  and  that  are  common  to  both  hemispheres ;  but 
even  these  are  more  abundant  in  warmer  climates.  Like  the 
other  birds  of  this  family,  they  prefer  the  neighbourhood  of  Man, 
resorting  for  their  food  to  cultivated  grounds,  and  finding  shelter 
in  the  enclosed  fields.  They  run  with  great  speed ;  and  have  a 
strong,  steady,  uniform  flight,  performed  by  regular  beats  of  the 
wings,  and  producing  a  whirring  sound ;  but  they  generally 
prefer  skulking,  to  avoid  danger.  They  nestle  on  the  ground, 
and  bear  a  numerous  progeny;  seldom  breeding,  however,  more 
than  once  in  the  season.  They  present,  in  several  particulars  of 
their  structure,  an  approach  to  the  succeeding  family,  with  which 
they  are  sometimes  classed. 

432,  The  family  of  TETRAONID^E,  or  Grouse,  may  be  regarded 
as  representing  the  preceding  group  in  the  northern  parts  of 
Europe,  Asia,  and  America,  to  which  it  is  nearly  restricted.  It 
has  many  characteristics  in  common  with  it ;  but  the  wings  are 
generally  long  and  acute,  and  the  legs  more  or  less  covered  with 
feathers.  The  Grouse,  of  which  only  a  single  species — the 
Black  Cock — now  exists  in  Britain,  but  of  which  there  are  several 
on  the  Continent  of  Europe,  are  generally  strong  heavy  Birds, 


PHASIANID^E; — GROUSE,  CAPERCAILZIE,  PTARMIGAN.    481 

varying  in  size  from  that  of  a  Turkey  to  that  of  a  common 
Pigeon.  They  live  upon  various  kinds  of  vegetable  substances  ; 
such  as  the  soft  shoots  and  leaves  of  trees  and  shrubs,  grasses, 
berries,  and  seeds.  Although  they  generally  gather  their  food 
on  the  ground,  some  of  them  betake  themselves  to  trees  for  that 
purpose,  and  many  occasionally  perch.  In  their  movements 
they  closely  resemble  the  Partridges  ;  but  they  frequent  different 
localities,  preferring  low,  damp,  grassy  or  ferny  places,  in  the 
neighbourhood  of  woods  or  thickets ;  and  are  more  shy  and 
wary  in  their  habits. — Besides  the  Black  Grouse,  another  species, 
known  as  the  Cock  of  the  Woods^  or  Capercailzie,  was  formerly 
abundant  in  Scotland.  Having  been  extirpated  for  the  last  half 
century  by  the  indiscriminate  zeal  of  sportsmen,  and  by  the 
destruction  of  the  forests  it  inhabited,  many  attempts  have  been 
made  to  re-naturalize  it,  by  introducing  individuals  from  Norway; 
in  the  mountainous  parts  of  which  country  it  is  still  plentiful. 
This  species  is  of  considerable  size,  being  not  much  inferior  to  the 
Turkey  in  bulk,  and  more  robust  in  proportion.  Its  food 
consists  of  the  leaves  and  buds  of  the  fir  tribe,  together  with 
juniper-berries,  cranberries,  &c. ;  the  young  are  fed  at  first  with 
insects,  and  especially  with  the  Iarva9  of  ants.  This  fine  Bird  is 
often  domesticated  in  Sweden,  and  will  breed  in  confinement. — 
The  Ptarmigans  are  nearly  allied  to  the  Grouse,  but  are  destined 
to  inhabit  still  colder  regions.  They  frequent  the  open  heaths 
and  hill-sides  of  the  northern  parts  of  the  temperate  zone  ;  and 
one  species,  the  Grey  Ptarmigan,  is  only  found  near  the  summits 
of  the  loftier  hills.  The  chief  peculiarity  in  their  structure 
consists  in  the  covering  of  their  legs  and  toes  with  thick  hair-like 
feathers,  down  to  the  very  claws  ;  and  this  covering  becomes  so 
thick  and  deep  in  winter,  as  to  give  to  the  leg  the  appearance  of 
a  Hare's  foot, — from  which  the  scientific  name  of  the  genus, 
Lagopus,  is  derived.  The  base  of  the  beak,  also,  is  covered  with 
closely-set  feathers ;  and  these  increase  in  the  colder  season,  until 
little  more  than  the^point  of  the  bill  is  visible.  Their  food  consists 
of  mountain  berries  and  heath-shoots  in  summer ;  and  of  buds 
and  leaves  in  winter  ;  and  at  the  latter  season,  the  Birds  are  often 
obliged  to  burrow  under  the  snow  for  food  and  shelter.  Two 


482  GREY    PTARMIGAN,    SAND-GROUSE. CHIONID.E. 

species  are  inhabitants  of  Britain ; — the  Brown  Ptarmigan,  or 
Moor-Fowl,  commonly  termed  the  Red  Grouse,  which  is  common 
on  the  high  moorland  districts  of  the  northern  counties  of 
England,  Wales,  Scotland,  and  Ireland  ; — and  the  Grey  Ptarmi- 
gan, sometimes  called  the  Alpine  Partridge.  It  is  in  this  last 

species,  that  the  adaptation 
to  a  residence  among  bleak 
and  snow-clad  hills,  is  best 
seen.  Its  mingled  grey  and 
brown  summer  livery  blends 
so  well  with  the  hues  of 
weather-stained  and  lichen- 
tinted  rocks,  that  a  whole 
covey  of  them  may  be  easily 
passed  without  being  no- 
ticed ;  and  towards  winter, 
the  colour  of  the  plumage 
FIG.  273.-GREY  PTARMIGAN.  gradually  disappears,  until 

it  becomes  of  a  pure  white,  not  distinguishable  from  snow. — The 
Sand-  Grouse  are  distinguished  by  their  long  pointed  wings,  and 
by  the  conical  form  of  their  tails ;  their  bills  are  short  and  highly 
arched.  They  are  natives  of  the  sandy  plains  and  rocky  deserts 
of  Africa,  Asia,  and  the  southern  districts  of  Europe.  They  are 
Birds  of  powerful  and  rapid  flight,  and  love  to  wander  from  place 
to  place,  sweeping  over  the  hot  and  arid  solitudes  in  which  they 
find  a  congenial  abode.  Though  they  repair  in  large  flocks  to 
localities  in  which  they  can  obtain  water,  they  are  not  truly 
gregarious,  but  disperse  themselves  in  pairs  over  their  feeding 
grounds.  They  are  so  abundant  in  some  districts,  that  when 
they  rise  on  the  wing,  they  seem  at  a  distance  like  large  clouds. 
433.  The  CHIONID.E,  or  Sheath-bills,  resemble  the  Grouse, 
but  have  the  nostrils  surrounded  by  a  kind  of  sheath.  They  are 
inhabitants  of  the  southern  hemisphere,  where  they  represent 
the  Tetraonidse  of  the  northern.  Some  of  them  bear  a  strong 
resemblance  to  the  Snipes,  Plovers,  and  Sand-pipers  among  the 
Waders ;  and  the  Sheath-bill  of  the  Southern  Ocean  frequents 
the  shores,  feeding  on  sea-weed  and  mollusks,  and  sometimes 


TINAMID.E,  OR  TINAMOUS. — MEGAPODID.E.  483 

venturing  far  out  to  sea, — whence  it  has  been  placed  by  some 
Naturalists  among  the  Natatores. 

434.  The  family  of  TINAMID.E,  or  Tinamous,  is  peculiar  to 
the  warmer  parts  of  the  world.     The  Birds  which  it  includes 
are   intermediate   in   form   between    the   Phasianidae   and   the 
Bustards ;  having  the  long  neck  and  legs,  and  the  small  feet,  of 
the  latter,   and  a  naked  scale  covering  the  nostrils,   as  in  the 
former.     The  tail  is  nearly  altogether  wanting,   and  the  wings 
are  short ;  the  hind  toe  is  not  at  all  developed,  or  has  the  form 
of  a  mere  claw.     These  Birds  are  mostly  found  among  the  low 
brushwood  or  tall  grass ;  and  their  food  consists  of  fruits  and 
insects. 

435.  The  family  of  MEGAPODID^;,  or  Megapodes^  is  peculiar 
to  Australia  and  the  adjacent  islands.     It  derives  its  name  from 
the  large  size  of  the  feet  of  the  Birds  included  in  it ;  which  are 
furnished  with  long  blunt  claws.  One  species  (  Talegalla  Lathami) 
is  termed  by  the  colonists  the  Brush  Turkey,  on  account  of  the 
wattles  with  which  its  neck  is  furnished ;  it  is  a  large  handsome 
bird,  inhabiting  brushwood,  and  feeding  on  seeds,  berries,  and 
insects.     Its  flesh  is  delicate  and  tender :  and  it  is  capable  of 
domestication.     Another  species  (Leipoa  ocellata)^  in  which  the 
head  is  clothed  with  feathers,  and  crested,  is  known  as  the  Native 
Pheasant ;  it  is  more  slender  and  elegantly  formed  than  the  last, 
and  inhabits  rather  the  sandy  plains,  feeding  chiefly  upon  seeds 
and  berries.     In  the  genus  Megapodius,  the  form  of  the  beak 
and  the  general  aspect  strongly  resemble  that  of  the  Fowl ; 
whence  the  name  Jungle-Fowl  is  commonly  given  to  it.     The 
head  is  crested ;  and  the  toes  and  claws  are  of  great  size  and 
strength. — These  Birds,  therefore,  may  be  regarded  as  represent- 
ing in  Australia  the  different  sections  of  the  family  Phasianidae, 
which  are  wanting  in  that  division  of  the  globe.     They  are  all 
remarkable  for  the  very  curious  mode  in  which  their  eggs  are 
hatched  ;  this  will  be  described  in  the  succeeding  volume. 


484 


ORDER  V._ CURSORES. 

436.  IN  the  Birds  of  this  order,  we  have  a  marked  excep- 
tion to  the  general  type  of  the  class.  We  are  accustomed  to 
think  of  Birds  as  denizens  of  the  air, — as  endowed  with  the 
powers  of  flight ;  but  the  Ostrich  and  its  allies,  of  which  this 
order  consists,  are  exclusively  terrestrial.  They  have  wings,  it 
is  true  ;  but  these  organs  are  but  little  developed,  and  are  totally 
incapable  by  their  most  energetic  action,  of  raising  the  Birds 
from  the  ground.  The  utmost  that  they  can  accomplish,  is  to 
assist  the  powerful  run,  which  is  effected  by  the  strong  and 
highly-developed  legs.  The  whole  locomotive  energy  is  thrown 
into  the  posterior  extremities,  the  bones  of  which  are  large  and 
stout,  and  the  muscles  acting  upon  them  exceedingly  voluminous. 
These  Birds  all  agree  in  the  flatness  of  the  sternum,  which  is 
entirely  destitute  of  projecting  keel  (Fig.  274) ;  and  the  pee- 


Fro.  274.— STERNUM  OF  EMEU. 

toral  muscles  which  arise  from  it  are  extremely  thin.  In  many 
points  of  their  conformation  they  approach  Mammalia;  thus 
we  find  in  the  Ostrich  a  partial  diaphragm,  which  is  still 
more  completely  developed  in  the  Apteryx;  and  the  ureters 
meet  in  a  sort  of  urinary  bladder,  instead  of  emptying  them- 
selves at  once  into  the  cloaca  (§  346).  It  is  not  only  in  the 


ORDER    CURSORES  ; GENERAL    CHARACTERS.  485 

absence  of  wings,  but  in  the  character  of  the  plumage,  that  the 
want  of  adaptation  of  these  Birds  to  flight  in  the  air  is  mani- 
fested. For,  as  already  stated  (§  325),  the  barbs  of  the  feathers 
have  so  little  adhesion  to  each  other,  that  the  air  can  pass  readily 
between  them  ;  and  in  some  species  they  are  at  such  a  distance 
from  each  other,  as  to  give  the  whole  feather  the  appearance  of 
a  stout  branching  hair.  All  these  Birds  construct  their  nests 
upon  the  ground  ;  and  in  several  species  it  appears  that  nume- 
rous females  lay  in  the  same  nest ;  the  eggs,  to  the  number  of 
thirty,  or  even  more,  being  chiefly  sat  on  by  the  male. 

437.  As  in  most  other  very  aberrant  groups,  the  number  of 
species  contained  in  this  order  is  small;  but  they  differ  widely  from 
each  other  in  form  and  structure ;  so  that  they  might  be  almost 
regarded  as  types  of  distinct  families.     The  beak,  in  particular, 
presents  singular  varieties  in  shape ;  and  there  is  also  a  varia- 
tion  in  the   number  of  toes.     The   Cursores,    with   the  beak 
depressed  (that  is,  flattened  horizontally)  have  the  longest  and 
strongest  legs,  and  run   with  remarkable  velocity :  this  group 
includes  the   Ostrich,   properly  so  called,  which  has  only  two 
toes;  and  the  Rhea,  or  American  Ostrich,  the  Cassowary,  and  the 
Emeu,    which  have  three  toes,  all  turned  forwards.     Of  the 
Cursores  with  a  compressed  (or  vertically-flattened)  beak,  only  a 
single  genus  is  known,  and  this  is  now  extinct, — the  Dodo  ;  this 
had  four  toes,  one  of  them  directed  backwards.     And  lastly,  we 
find  in  the  Apteryx  a  prolonged  form  of  beak,  resembling  that 
of  the  Tenuirostres,  with  four  toes,  of  which  the  posterior  one 
is  scarcely  developed.     Each  of  these   species  will   be   briefly 
noticed. 

438.  In  the  Ostrich  the  wings  are  sufficiently  developed  to 
accelerate  the  speed  of  the  Bird,  when  running  along  the  plains 
it  frequents  ;  although  the  plumage  is  lax  and  flexible.     The 
African  Ostrich,  which  has  been  known  from  remote  antiquity, 
is  the  tallest  of  all  Birds  at  present  known  to  exist ;  it  attains 
the  height  of  six  feet  and  a  half,   or  even  eight  feet ;  and  is 
chiefly  distinguished  by  the  presence  of  only  two  toes  upon  each 
foot,  one  of  them  being  much  larger  than  the  other  (Fig.  185). 
It  inhabits  the  sandy  deserts  of  Arabia  and  Africa,  everywhere 


486 


ORDER    CURSORES; — OSTRICH,    RHEA. 


FIG,  275.— AFRICAN  OSTRICH. 


avoiding  the  presence  of  Man,  but  not  disliking  the  society  of 

other  animals.  Flocks  of 
Ostriches  are  not  unfre- 
quently  seen  on  the  Great 
Karroo  of  South  Africa, 
in  company  with  troops 
of  Quaggas,  all  amicably 
feeding  together,  and  when 
alarmed  scouring  the  de- 
sert with  extraordinary 
rapidity.  The  Ostrich  is, 
indeed,  one  of  the  swift- 
est, if  not  the  most  rapid, 
of  all  running  animals. 
When  darting  along  in  a 
straight  line,  it  leaves  the 
swiftest  Horse  far  behind ; 
and  can  maintain  its  speed 
for  several  hours.  Hence 

it  can  only  be  captured  by  a  number  of  horsemen,  taking  different 
sides  of  the -plain,  or  by  darting  across  the  path  of  the  bird. 
When  driven  to  extremities,  it  will  occasionally  turn  with  fury 
on  its  pursuers,  and  will  inflict  dreadful  wounds  with  its  claw. 
The  Ostrich  has  been  domesticated,  and  behaves  in  this  state  with 
much  gentleness  to  those  with  whom  it  is  familiar,  though  fierce 
and  violent  towards  strangers.  It  will  permit  itself  to  be 
mounted,  even  by  two  full-grown  men,  and  carries  them  with 
great  ease.  Its  food  consists  of  the  tops  of  shrubby  plants, 
seeds,  and  grain ;  but  it  will  swallow  many  other  substances  with 
indiscriminating  voracity,  such  as  stones,  sticks,  pieces  of 
metal,  cord,  leather,  &c.  It  is  probably  guided  by  the  same 
instinct  in  swallowing  hard  substances,  that  leads  the  Fowl  to 
swallow  gravel ;  for  they  are  probably  of  use  in  assisting  the 
action  of  the  gizzard  in  the  reduction  of  the  food.  The  curious 
habits  of  this  Bird  in  regard  to  the  incubation  of  its  eggs  will 
be  hereafter  detailed. — The  Rheay  or  American  Ostrich,  is  a 
smaller  Bird,  more  completely  feathered  on  the  head  and  neck ; 


ORDER    CURSORES  ; RIIEA,    CASSOWARY.  487 

the  wings  are  rather  more  developed  than  in  the  African  species, 
and  are  terminated  by  a  hooked  spur  ;  and  the  feet  possess  three 
toes,  armed  with  stout  claws,  the  central  one  being  much  the 
largest.  Two  species  are  now  known ;  the  Nandu,  which 
stands  about  five  feet  high  ;  and  Darwin  s  Rhea,  which  is  much 
smaller.  Both  these  species  are  partly  aquatic  in  their  habits  ; 
the  former  is  chiefly  found  upon  the  plains  bordering  the  river 
La  Plata,  extending  through  the  South  of  Brazil  to  the  North 
of  Patagonia;  whilst  the  latter  takes  its  place  in  Southern 
Patagonia. 

439.  The  Cassowary  is  a  native  of  Java  and  the  adjacent 
islands  of  the  Indian  Archipelago  ;  it  is  much  inferior  in  size  to 
the  Ostrich,  its  height  when 
erect  being  about  five  feet ; 
but  it  is  robustly  built,  and 
very  strong.  In  many  im- 
portant points  of  internal 
structure,  it  differs  from  the 
Ostrich  ;  particularly  in  the 
conformation  of  its  digestive 
organs,  which  are  not  adapt- 
ed for  hard  coarse  diet,  but 
for  eggs,  fruits,  and  tender 
succulent  herbage.  It  is 
not  common  even  in  its  na- 
tive islands  ;  but  is  some- 
times kept  tame  there.  The 
head  is  surmounted  by  a 
sort  of  crest  or  helmet,  which 
is  supported  by  a  bony 

growth,  resembling  that  of  the  Hornbills  (§  397)  ;  and,  as  in  that 
group,  the  appendage  is  not  developed  in  the  young  Bird.  The 
exterior  of  the  helmet  is  of  the  most  intense  blue,  purple,  and 
scarlet,  blended  together  ;  and  the  lower  part  of  the  neck  is  fur- 
nished with  a  pair  of  wattles.  The  pinions  are  very  small,  and  are 
concealed  between  the  plumage  ;  they  do  not  seem  to  be  of  any 
service  in  assisting  the  motions  of  the  bird. — The  Emeu,  a  native 


488 


ORDER    CUJRSORK3  ; EMEU. 


of  New  Holland,  and  of  the   neighbouring   islands,    is   nearly 
allied  to  the  Cassowary ;    but  differs  from  it  in  the  form  of  the 


Fro.  277- — EMEU. 

bill,  and  has  no  helmet.  It  nearly  equals  the  Ostrich  in  bulk  ; 
but  is  lower  on  the  legs,  shorter  in  the  neck,  and  more  thick-set 
in  the  body.  In  its  native  regions,  it  is  said  to  stand  six  or 
seven  feet  high,  when  its  head  is  fully  elevated.  The  wings  are 
mere  rudiments,  destitute  of  plumes,  and  hidden  beneath  the 
feathers  of  the  body ;  the  cheeks  and  throat  are  nearly  naked. 
The  feathers  bear  a  strong  resemblance  to  branching  hairs ;  the 
laminae  of  the  vanes  being  placed  at  a  distance  from  each  other. 
Two  stems  arise  from  each  root  ;  one  of  these  may  be  regarded 
as  an  increased  development  of  the  accessory  plume,  a  sort  of 
little  tuft  which  grows  at  the  base  of  ordinary  feathers.  The 
Emeu  feeds  upon  leaves,  fruits,  and  herbage  ;  for  the  plucking  of 
which,  its  strong  straight  beak,  rounded  at  the  point,  is  well 
adapted.  It  is  a  timid  and  peaceful  bird,  trusting  to  its  speed 
for  safety,  except  when  hard-pressed  ;  it  then  strikes  violently 
with  its  legs.  The  flesh  of  the  young  is  extremely  delicate  ;  bi 


EMEU  ;    APTERYX.  489 

that  of  the  full-grown  Bird  is  coarse.  It  is  pursued,  however, 
for  the  oil  that  is  obtained  from  it ;  of  which  the  skin  produces 
six  or  seven  quarts.  The  eggs  are  highly  esteemed  as  food. 
Though  not  an  aquatic  bird,  the  Emeu  swims  well,  and  has  been 
seen  to  cross  rivers.  There  is  good  reason  to  believe  that  it 
might  be  easily  naturalized  in  Europe ;  as  it  not  only  thrives, 
but  breeds,  in  captivity;  and  seems  to  be  quite  capable  of 
adapting  itself  to  the  climate  of  England. 

440.     Of  all   the   Cursores,  the  Apteryx  of   New   Zealand 
appears  to  be  the   one  which  is  most  completely   destitute  of 


FIG.  27.'].— AITKRYX. 

wings,  and  which  departs  most  widely  from  the  general  type  of 
the  class  of  Birds.  Its  wings  are  trifling  rudiments,  buried 
beneath  the  general  plumage  of  the  body,  and  not  to  be  dis- 
covered without  difficulty  ;  they  are  each  terminated  by  a 
hooked  claw.  The  beak  is  long,  slender,  and  slightly  arched, 
resembling  that  of  the  Curlew.  The  nostrils  are  not  situated 
near  the  base  of  the  bill,  as  in  most  other  Birds  ;  but  are  minute 
narrow  fissures,  one  on  either  side  of  its  tip.  The  legs  are 
extremely  powerful,  and  the  tarsi  thick  and  short ;  the  toes  are 
three  anteriorly  and  one  posteriorly, — the  former  robust  and 
armed  with  strong  claws,  well  adapted  for  digging, — the  latter 
a  thick  sharp  horny  spur,  which  is  used  as  a  weapon  of  offence 
and  defence.  There  is  no  vestige  of  a  tail.  This  extraordinary 
Bird  is  principally  found  in  the  southern  parts  of  the  middle 
island  of  New  Zealand  ;  especially  frequenting  fern-brakes  ;  and 
seeking  shelter  in  clefts  of  rocks,  hollow  trees,  or  in  deep  holes 


490  ORDFR  CURSORES. APTERYX  ;  DODO. 

which  it  excavates  in  the  ground.  These  holes  are  its  breeding 
places,  and  conduct  to  a  deep  chamber  in  which  the  Bird  deposits 
its  eggs  upon  a  bed  of  fern.  The  food  of  the  Apteryx  consists  of 
insects  and  particularly  of  worms ;  the  latter  it  procures  by  thrust- 
ing its  bill  into  the  soil,  when  soft,  and  drawing  them  forth  ;  or 
by  striking  with  its  bill  and  feet  on  the  ground,  when  it  is  hard, 
so  as  to  disturb  the  worms,  which  it  seizes  as  soon  as  they  make 
their  appearance.  Its  habits  are  nocturnal;  and  the  natives 
hunt  it  by  torchlight  for  the  sake  of  its  skin,  which  is  much 
valued  by  them,  as  a  material  for  the  chiefs'  dresses.  "When  it 
is  pursued,  it  elevates  its  head  like  an  Ostrich,  and  runs  with 
great  swiftness ;  and  if  overtaken,  it  defends  itself  with  great 
spirit  and  vigour,  and  inflicts  dangerous  blows  with  its  spur- 
armed  feet.  This  remarkable  Bird  seems  likely  to  be  soon  exter- 
minated from  the  very  limited  portion  of  the  globe  which  it 
inhabits  at  present ;  and  must  then  be  numbered  among  the 
races  that  have  been. 

441.      It  is  a  fact  of  no  little  interest,  that  this  family  should 


FIG.  279.— DODO. 


include  two  other  very  remarkable  Birds,  whose  existence  we 
learn  only  from  tradition,  and  from  some  very  imperfect  remaii 


EXTINCT  CDRSORES;  — DODO,  DINORN1S.  491 

that  have  been  preserved.  One  of  these  is  the  Dodo ;  which 
appears,  from  the  records  of  history,  to  have  once  abounded  in  the 
Mauritius,  Bourbon,  and  some  neighbouring  islands;  but  of  which 
the  only  relics  we  at  present  have,  are  a  head  and  foot  in  the 
Ashmolean  Museum  at  Oxford,  a  foot  in  the  British  Museum, 
a  head  in  the  Museum  at  Copenhagen,  and  a  breast-bone  in  the 
Museum  at  Paris ;  together  with  various  representations,  of 
which  a  painting  in  the  British  Museum  is  probably  to  be  re- 
garded as  an  accurate  one.  The  absence  of  wings  seems  to 
determine  the  place  of  the  Dodo  to  be  in  this  family  ;  notwith- 
standing the  conformation  of  its  bill,  which  is  extremely  vulture- 
like.  The  body  and  feet  bear  a  strong  resemblance  to  that  of 
the  Gallinaceous  Birds  ;  in  size  it  surpassed  the  largest  among 
them,  its  weight  being  between  forty-five  and  fifty  pounds.  Its 
flesh  is  described  by  the  early  voyagers  as  palatable ;  and  it 
seems  to  be  to  the  destruction  of  large  numbers,  for  .the  supply  of 
the  crews  of  India  ships  touching  at  the  islands  just  mentioned, 
that  we  are  to  attribute  the  extirpation  of  the  race.  If  it  should 
still  survive,  it  would  probably  be  found  in  Madagascar ;  which 
has  been,  as  yet,  but  very  insufficiently  explored  by  Naturalists. 
442.  The  former  existence,  in  New  Zealand,  of  a  gigantic 
race  of  Birds  of  the  wingless  order,  of  which  some  traditionary 
accounts  remained  among  the  natives,  has  been  recently  proved 
by  the  discovery  in  that  country  of  a  considerable  number  of 
bones,  presenting  a  very  strong  resemblance  to  those  of  the 
Ostrich,  but  for  the  most  part  belonging  to  Birds  of  much  larger 
size.  These  all  agree  so  well  in  their  general  characters,  as  to 
be  placed  in  one  genus,  to  which  the  name  of  Dinornis  has  been 
given  by  Professor  Owen ;  but  their  differences  in  size  and  in 
other  particulars  appear  sufficient  to  prove,  thatjive  distinct  species 
must  have  formerly  inhabited  New  Zealand.  The  largest  of 
these  must  have  stood  at  least  ten  feet  and  a  half  in  height,  and 
probably  more ;  several  of  its  bones  are  at  least  twice  the  size  of 
those  of  the  Ostrich ;  but  the  body  seems  to  have  been  more 
bulky  in  proportion,  and  the  tarsus  was  shorter  and  stouter,  in 
order  to  sustain  its  weight.  The  bones  cannot  be  regarded  as 
fossils ;  but  as  the  remains  of  animals  that  have  existed  at  no 

K    K    2 


492  DINORNIS. ORDER    GRALLATORES. 

very  remote  period.  It  has  been  suggested  by  Professor  Owen, 
that,  when  the  islands  were  first  colonised  by  a  party  of  Malays 
driven  thither  in  a  storm  (which  was  probably  the  mode  in  which 
human  beings  first  found  their  way  thither),  these  birds  were 
eagerly  sought,  as  being  the  only  large  animals  that  could  serve 
as  food ;  and  that,  by  being  improvidently  destroyed,  the  whole 
race  was  speedily  extirpated.  The  preservation  of  its  relative, 
the  Apteryx,  might  be  due,  he  remarks,  to  its  comparatively 
small  size,  and  to  its  nocturnal  and  burrowing  habits.  The 
failure  of  food,  resulting  from  the  destruction  of  this  race,  may 
have  led,  he  also  suggests,  to  the  practice  of  cannibalism,  for 
which  in  spite  of  their  many  elevated  qualities,  the  inhabitants 
of  New  Zealand  have  been  notorious. 


ORDER  VI.— GRALLATORES. 

443.  THE  scientific  name  of  this  order,  which  literally  means 
stilt-walkers,  is,  on  the  whole,  more  appropriate  than  the  term 
Waders,  which  is  commonly  applied  to  it.  For  all  the  Birds 
which  it  includes  are  remarkable  for  the  length  of  their  legs,  and 
especially  of  the  shank  ;  whilst  many  can  scarcely  be  said  to  be 
aquatic  in  their  habits.  The  length  of  the  lower  part  of  the  leg, 
and  the  absence  of  feathers  at  the  lower  end  of  the  tibia,  enable 
them  to  wade  into  water  of  a  certain  depth,  without  wetting 
their  plumage ;  and  thus  to  procure  fish,  mollusks,  aquatic 
worms  and  insects,  &c.,  by  means  of  their  bills,  which  are  usually 
supported  upon  necks  of  a  length  proportional  to  that  of  their 
legs.  They  are  for  the  most  part  slender  in  form ;  and  thus  pre- 
sent a  marked  contrast  with  the  robust  bodies  of  the  two  preced- 
ing orders.  The  wings  of  these  Birds  are  usually  long,  and 
adapted  for  rapid  flight.  The  tail,  however,  is  short ;  and  when 
flying,  the  Birds  stretch  out  their  long  legs  behind,  to  counter- 
balance their  long  necks,  and  to  serve  as  a  rudder.  They  are 
very  generally  diffused  over  the  globe ;  and  many  of  them  make 
periodical  migrations  of  considerable  length.  They  generally 
construct  their  nests  upon  the  ground,  concealing  them  among 


ORDER    GRALLATORES. OTIDJS,    OR    BUSTARDS.  493 

the  herbage ;  and  the  young  are  usually  able  to  run  about  as 
soon  as  they  are  hatched.  Considerable  varieties  of  structure 
present  themselves  in  this  order ;  some  of  the  birds  which  it  con- 
tains having  a  strong  resemblance  to  the  Gallinaceous  and  Ostrich 
tribes ;  whilst  others  have  a  close  relationship  with  the  strictly 
aquatic  Birds  of  the  next  order.  They  may  be  arranged  under 
the  following  families : — OTIDJE,  or  Bustards;  CHARADRIAD^E,  or 
Plovers;  GRUID^E,  or  Cranes ;  ARDEID^E,  or  Herons;  SCOLOPA- 
CID^E,  or  Snipes ;  and  RALLID^E,  or  Rails.  Of  these,  the  Bus- 
tards and  Cranes  are  the  least  aquatic  in  their  habits ;  and  the 
Rails  the  most  so. 

444.  The  OTIOSE,  or  Bustards,  which  are  peculiar  to  the 
Eastern  Hemisphere  and  to  Australia,  have  the  stout  body, 
strong  limbs,  long  neck  and  legs,  and  small  feet,  of  the  Ostrich  ; 
but  the  wings  are  longer.  The  beak  is  short,  conical,  and  com- 
pressed. They  have  three  short  toes  united  at  the  base,  but  no 
hind  toe.  They  frequent  wide  plains,  extensive  downs,  and 
open  lands  dotted  with  patches  of  shrubby  vegetation ;  and  their 
food  consists  of  tender  herbage,  grain,  and  insects.  They  run 
with  extreme  rapidity  ;  and,  unless  closely  pursued,  they  seldom 
take  wing ;  when  obliged  to  rise,  however,  their  flight  is  direct 
and  rapid.  They  are  shy  and  watchful ;  and  not  to  be  approached 
without  difficulty.  Like  the  Gallinacese,  they  are  polygamous 
in  their  habits ;  and  the  eggs  are  deposited  on  the  ground,  with- 
out any  proper  nest.  There  is  a  remarkable  difference  in  the 
size  of  the  male  and  female  Bustards ;  the  latter  being,  in  some 
species,  not  above  a  third  of  the  bulk  of  the  former.  The  males 
are  further  distinguished  by  a  gayer  plumage ;  but  this  is  lost 
in  winter.  The  Great  Bustard  is  the  largest  of  all  the  native 
Birds,  not  only  of  Great  Britain,  but  of  Europe.  The  male, 
when  full  grown,  is  four  feet  in  length,  and  not  less  than  nine  in 
the  expanse  of  its  wings ;  its  weight  is  from  thirty  to  forty 
pounds.  This  noble  Bird  was  once  common  in  our  island  ;  but 
it  is  now  rarely  to  be  seen,  except  in  the  western  part  of  Norfolk. 
It  is  still  common,  however,  in  Spain,  on  the  plains  of  Greece, 
in  some  parts  of  Russia,  and  on  the  wilds  of  Tartary.  In  the 
adult  male,  there  is  a  remarkable  membranous  pouch  beneath 


494  BUSTARDS. — CHARADRIAD^E,    OR    PLOVERS. 

the  skin  on  the  fore-part  of  the  neck  ;  having  an  entrance  to  it 
under  the  tongue ;  this  pouch  is  of  considerable  dimensions, 
being  capable  of  holding  seven  or  eight  pints  of  water ;  its  use 
is  unknown.  The  Little  Bustard,  which  also  is  a  native  of 
Britain  (though  now,  like  the  preceding,  a  rare  Bird),  is  not 
above  one-third  of  the  dimensions  of  the  preceding;  and  its 
wings  are  shorter  in  proportion.  Other  species  of  Bustards  are 
found  in  Africa  and  India ;  some  of  them  closely  allied  to  those 
just  described;  whilst  others  partake  of  the  characters  of  the 
next  family. 

445.  In  the  comprehensive  family  of  CHARADRIADJS,  or 
Plovers,  the  legs  are  long,  the  toes  short,  the  hinder  one  small  or 
altogether  wanting  (Fig.  207),  and  the  wings  long  and  powerful. 
The  bill  is  short,  and  arched  towards  the  tip ;  its  covering  is  soft 
at  the  base,  but  hard  at  the  extremity.  These  Birds  chiefly 
frequent  sandy  unsheltered  shores,  and  exposed  commons  or 
moors.  They  congregate  in  flocks,  and  run  with  great  swiftness ; 
many  of  them  are  nocturnal  in  their  habits.  They  belong,  for 
the  most  part,  to  the  Old  "World ;  and  are  abundant  in  temperate 
climates.  Of  the  true  Plovers,  we  have  a  good  example  in  the 
Golden  Plover,  which  is  a  Bird  of  Passage,  spread  over  Europe, 
Western  Asia,  and  portions  of  North  Africa.  It  breeds  in  various 
parts  of  the  British  Isles  ;  but  it  is  only  found  in  the  southern 
districts  during  the  winter,  at  which  time  its  numbers  are  much 
increased  by  arrivals  from  northern  latitudes.  As  in  the  Bustards, 
the  winter  livery  differs  considerably  from  the  summer ;  being 
lighter  in  tint,  and  less  varied.  The  flight  of  this  species  is  rapid 
and  vigorous,  and,  during  the  spring  and  summer,  is  usually  at 
a  greater  elevation ;  and  the  Bird  is  frequently  seen  in  the  air 
performing  the  most  graceful  evolutions  as  it  sails  round  and 
round.  It  takes  its  repose  during  the  day ;  and  goes  forth  at 
night  in  search  of  its  food,  which  consists  of  insects,  larvas,  slugs, 
worms,  &c.  For  these  it  frequents  fallow  lands  in  the  autumn, 
and  then  becomes  very  fat ;  in  which  state  it  is  much  esteemed 
as  a  luxury  for  the  table.  The  Plover  associates  in  pairs  during 
the  breeding  season ;  but  at  other  times  indiscriminately  in  large 
flocks.  The  eggs  are  usually  deposited  in  the  neighbourhood  of 


PLOVERS,    DOTTEREL,    LAPWINGS.  495 

marshes  or  streams,  under  cover  of  the  herbage.  The  common 
English  name  plover^  seems  to  be  a  corruption  of  the  French 
pluvier,  or  Rain-Bird ;  its  activity  being  the  greatest  when  the 
weather  is  damp. — The  Dotterel  is  a  smaller  species,  which 
breeds  in  colder  latitudes  than  ours,  and  winters  in  warmer, — 
passing  over  Britain  in  large  flocks,  in  its  spring  and  autumn 
migrations.  It  occasionally  breeds  on  the  mountains  of  the 
northern  parts  of  our  island.  The  Dotterel  has  been  accused  of 
excessive  stupidity,  and  its  name  has  even  become  proverbial  on 
this  account,  in  the  parts  of  Britain  where  it  is  best  known ; 
there  appears  no  other  reason  for  this,  however,  than,  that  being 
fresh  from  wilds  untrodden  by  Man,  and  not  having  experienced 
persecution,  it  does  not  so  readily  take  alarm,  as  do  Birds  that 
have  lived  in  nearer  neighbourhoods  to  their  great  enemy. — The 
Grey  Plover  is  another  species  which  visits  our  island  in  its 
migrations.  Its  summer  residence  and  breeding  place  is  within 
the  arctic  regions  ;  but  it  retires  to  the  countries  of  Central  and 
Southern  Europe,  to  pass  the  winter.  Another  species  of  Plover 
is  found  in  the  northern  and  temperate  parts  of  Asia  and  North 
America. 

446.  The  Lapwings  are  nearly  allied  to  the  Plover ;  but 
they  have  the  hind-toe  more  developed  ;  and  the  head  is  orna- 
mented either  with  a  crest,  or  with  fleshy  wattles  and  protube- 
rances about  the  base  of  the  beak.  They  frequent  open  grounds 
and  plains,  especially  where  the  soil  is  moist ;  and  they  feed  on 
insects,  worms,  larvae,  &c.  The  name  is  derived  from  the  arti- 
fices employed  by  the  Parent-Birds  to  decoy  away  intruders 
from  their  nests ;  for  they  will  place  themselves  almost  within 
reach  of  their  enemies,  feigning  lameness,  and  fluttering  and 
tumbling  in  the  path  before  them,  until  they  have  drawn  them 
to  a  sufficient  distance ;  after  which  they  will  take  wing  and 
escape.  The  Lapwing,  or  Peewit  (so  called  from  its  note),  of 
this  country  is  a  very  beautiful  Bird  /  and  has  an  elegant  crest 
of  long  slender  black  feathers  arising  from  its  head.  Between 
the  spring  and  autumn,  it  frequents  moorland  tracts  in  various 
parts  of  Britain  ;  but  as  winter  approaches,  it  assembles  in  vast 
flocks,  which  betake  themselves  to  the  districts  near  the  sea  and 


496       TURNSTONE,     OYSTER-CATCHER. GRUID.E,    OR  CRANES. 

the  mouths  of  rivers,  especially  in  the  southern  part  of  our  island. — 
The  Turnstones  have  a  short  bill,  thick  at  the  base,  and  narrowing 
gradually  to  the  point ;  and  with  .his  they  turn  over  the  stones 
on  the  sea-shore,  in  quest  of  the  small  molluscous  and  crustaceous 
animals  on  which  they  feed.  The  species  which  visits  our  shores 
is  very  universally  diffused ;  being  met  with  in  almost  every  part 
both  of  the  northern  and  southern  hemispheres.  It  breeds  in 
high  latitudes,  and  migrates  towards  the  tropics  for  the  winter 
season. — Another  curious  Bird  of  this  group  is  the  Oyster-Catcher; 
the  bill  of  which  is  long,  hard,  and  compressed  towards  its  point, 
which  is  abrupt  and  chisel -like.  With  this  instrument  it  opens 
the  shells  of  bivalve  mollusks,  such  as  mussels,  oysters,  &c. ;  and 
detaches  limpets  from  the  rock.  It  wades  in  quest  of  its  food 
amongst  the  shallows ;  and  swims  where  the  depth  forbids 
wading.  This  Bird  is  distributed  over  the  whole  of  the  European 
Continent,  and  a  great  part  of  Asia  and  Africa,  frequenting  chiefly 
the  low  flat  coasts,  and  laying  its  eggs  on  the  bare  ground  amidst 
the  shingle,  or  such  herbage  as  grows  above  high- water  mark. 

447.  In  the  family  GRUHXE, 
or  Cranes,  the  hind  toe  is  rather 
short ;  and  is  much  higher  on  the 
legs  than  the  front  ones.  The 
beak  is  strong,  hard,  and  rather  long. 
The  wings  are  rounded  ;  and  the 
secondary  feathers  elongated  into 
drooping  plumes.  Instead  of  deriv- 
ing their  sole  subsistence  from  the 
worms,  insects,  &c.,  of  lakes  and 
morasses,  the  members  of  this  family 
live  in  great  measure  on  vegetable 
food ;  and  frequent  plains  and  newly- 
sown  lands,  and  cultivated  districts. 
— The  Common  Crane  (Fig.  280) 
is  an  inhabitant  of  a  large  portion  ot 
Europe,  Asia,  and  Africa:  it  was 

P  .   .,  FJG.  280.— CRANE. 

tormerly  a   regular  visitor   to  our 

island,  but  seems  to  have  been  driven  away  by  the  advance  of  cul- 


DEMOISELLE,  TRUMPETER. ARDEID^E,  OR  HERONS.  497 

tivation,  which  has  deprived  it  of  many  of  its  most  congenial  loca- 
lities. Its  breeding  places  are  in  the  north  of  Europe  and  Asia  ; 
but  in  its  winter  migrations  it  visits  India,  Egypt,  and  other  parts 
of  Africa.  Its  aerial  voyages  are  performed  at  a  great  height  in 
the  air  ;  and  its  cries  may  be  heard,  when  it  is  itself  beyond  the 
limits  of  the  sight. — The  Demoiselfa,  or  Numidian  Crane,  is 
remarkable  for  the  grace  and  symmetry  of  its  form,  and  the  ele- 
gance of  its  deportment.  It  has  a  beautiful  drooping  head-crest 
of  soft  loose  plumes,  which  undulate  with  every  movement. — In 
America  we  find  a  curious  species,  the  Trumpeter,  which  is 
remarkable  for  its  loud  harsh  voice,  and  for  the  attachment  it 
displays  to  Man,  in  a  domesticated  state.  It  equals  a  large  fowl 
in  bulk,  but  has  much  longer  legs  and  neck  ;  it  is  a  native  of  the 
forests  of  tropical  America  and  the  wild  uplands,  never  visiting 
fens  or  the  borders  of  lakes  or  rivers.  It  walks  and  runs  with 
great  celerity,  but  seldom  takes  wing,  and  rises  in  flight  but  a 
few  feet  from  the  ground.  The  name  of  this  Bird  is  derived  from 
the  hollow  internal  sound,  which  it  makes  without  opening  the 
bill ;  this  seems  to  be  produced  by  the  passage  of  the  air  from 
the  lungs,  into  two  large  membranous  bags,  which  are  given  off 
from  the  windpipe  just  as  it  enters  the  chest. 

448.  The  family  ARDEIDJE,  or  Heron  tribe,  may  probably  be 
regarded  as  the  typical  group  of  the  order ;  the  Birds  which  it 
contains  being  pre-eminently  formed  for  wading.  They  frequent, 
as  a  rule,  the  margins  of  rivers,  lakes,  or  marshes ;  and  feed  on 
Fish,  Reptiles,  and  even  small  Mammalia.  The  beak  is  usually 
long,  of  considerable  strength,  and  sharp-pointed.  The  toes  are 
generally  elongated,  and  the  hind  toe  upon  the  level  of  the  rest, 
so  as  to  form  a  more  extensive  bearing  to  the  foot.  The  wings 
are  large,  and  their  flight  easy;  and  many  of  the  species  are 
adorned  with  elegant  plumes  and  crests  (Fig.  281).  They  usually 
build  and  breed  in  society  ;  but  wander  alone  in  search  of  food, 
and  separate  when  the  breeding  season  is  over.  Many  subordi- 
nate groups,  differing  considerably  from  one  another,  are  con- 
tained in  this  family  ;  of  these  we  shall  briefly  notice  the  chief* 
— The  Common  Heron  is  spread  over  the  greater  part  of  the 
Old  World ;  and  is  represented  by  an  allied  species  in  America. 


498 


ARDEID^E  ; HERON,    BITTERN,    SPOONBILL. 


In  our  island,  and  in  temperate  climates,  it  is  stationary  during 

the  whole  year  ;  but  it  is  migratory 
in  colder  latitudes.  It  feeds  chiefly 
upon  fish ;  which  it  catches  by 
means  of  a  sudden  dart  of  its  long 
beak.  Contrary  to  the  usual  habit 
of  this  order,  the  Heron  builds  its 
nest  in  the  highest  trees  of  the 
neighbourhood  it  frequents.  The 
young  remain  in  the  nest  for  five 
or  six  weeks,  and  are  supplied  with 
fish  by  the  parents. — The  Bittern 
is  nearly  allied  to  the  Heron,  but 
it  is  of  smaller  size.  It  frequents 
wild  morasses  and  the  oozy  banks 
of  large  rivers,  where  it  crouches 
among  flags,  reeds,  and  bulrushes. 
Here,  too,  the  nest  is  placed,  on 
some  slight  elevation ;  but  never 
in  trees. 

This   Bird    is   remarkable   for   the 

"  booming f '  sound  which  it  utters 

during  the  breeding  season ;  at  other 

times  its  cry  is  different.      When 

attacked,    it    defends    itself    with 

great    resolution   by   means   of  its 

formidable    beak;    throwing   itself 

upon  its  back  like  a  Bird  of  Prey. 

— Notwithstanding     the     unusual 

form  of  their  beak,  the  Spoonbills 

also  belong  to  this  division  of  the 

family.     They  live  by  the  edges  of 

marshes,  or  near  the  sea  where  the 

ground  is  shaded  with  thick  bushes ; 

and  sally  forth  from  their  cover  to  seize  the  small  fishes  that 

may  approach  the  shore,  and  to  pick  up  small  mollusca,  crus- 

tacea,  and  aquatic  insects.     They  nestle  sometimes  in  lofty  trees, 


FIG.  281 — CRESTED  HERON. 


FIG.  282. — BITTERN. 


SPOONBILL,    BOATB1LL,    STORKS. 


499 


sometimes  in  close  bushes,  and  sometimes  in  tall  annual  herbage. 
Like  most  other  Birds  of 
the  banks  andshores,  they 
are  migratory ;  moving 
in  the  direction  of  the 
poles  during  the  breeding 
season ;  and  back  again 
towards  the  equator  in 
autumn.  The  White 
Spoonbill  is  an  inhabit- 
ant of  most  parts  of  the  f 
Eastern  Hemisphere, 
and  occasionally  visits 
Britain.  The  Boatlill 
is  a  Bird  of  the  shores 
and  marshes  of  Guiana, 
Brazil,  and  other  parts 
of  South  America.  In 
the  form  of  its  bill,  and 
in  its  general  habits,  it  closely  resembles  the  Spoonbill ;  but  its 
diet  seems  more  restricted  to  fish. 

449.  The  Storks  have  long,  straight,  robust,  and  rather 
conical  bills ;  their  legs  are  long,  and  naked  high  above  the 
tarsal  joint ;  the  fore  toes  are  connected  at  the  base  by  webs, 
but  the  hind  toe  is  placed  higher.  They  frequent  retired  marshes 
and  borders  of  pools ;  and  feed  upon  frogs  and  other  reptiles, 
mice,  worms,  insects,  and  eels,  with  a  voracious  appetite.  Their 
habits  are  migratory ;  and  the  range  of  countries  through  which 
the  same  species,  and  even  the  same  individual,  is  seen,  is  con- 
sequently very  great.  Though  rare  in  this  country  (probably  on 
account  of  the  want  of  a  congenial  habitation),  the  Stork  is  very 
common  in  Holland  and  Germany,  where  it  approaches  the 
dwellings  of  Man  without  fear,  and  is  treated  as  a  welcome  guest. 
In  many  countries  it  is  held  sacred,  on  account  of  the  benefit 
it  confers  in  the  destruction  of  vermin  ;  and  it  even,  like  the 
Vultures,  cleanses  the  eastern  cities  of  carrion  and  offal.  It  has 
been  well  ascertained  that,  after  a  migration  of  many  thousands 


Fio.  283. — SPOONBILL. 


500 


; — STORK,    ADJUTANT,    IBIS. 


of  miles,  the  same  pairs  of  Storks  will  regularly  return  to  the 
habitations  they  had  previously  tenanted. — The  Adjutant- Stork, 
or  Aryala,  of  India,  is  remarkable  on  several  accounts.  Its  size 
is  very  great ;  its  ordinary  height  in 
the  erect  attitude  being  five  feet;  its 
length  from  the  tip  of  the  bill  to  the 
claws  being  seven  feet  and  a  half ; 
and  the  spread  of  its  wings  being 
fourteen  or  fifteen  feet.  The  beak  is 
of  enormous  size  and  strength ;  the 
head  is  large  ;  and  the  neck  propor- 
tionally muscular.  The  head  and 
neck  are  nearly  bare  of  skin ;  and 
from  the  under  part  of  the  neck 
there  hangs  a  large  pouch  of  skin, 
like  a  dewlap,  which  is  capable  of 
being  inflated,  and  which  gives  to 
the  Bird  a  very  strange  appearance. 
The  Adjutant  is  a  native  of  the 
warmer  parts  of  India  ;  and  is  very 
useful  in  removing  noxious  animals 
and  carrion,  which  it  devours  with 
great  voracity.  It  swallows  snakes,  lizards,  frogs,  &c. ;  as  well 
as  offal  of  all  kinds ;  and  in  the  craw  of  one  of  these  birds  has 
been  found  a  land  tortoise  ten  inches  long,  together  with  the 
entire  body  of  a  large  black  cat.  In  its  wild  state,  it  usually 
lives  in  companies ;  and  chiefly  frequents  the  mouths  of  rivers  ; 
it  may  be  readily  domesticated,  but  is  very  apt  to  display  its 
voracity  by  purloining  articles  of  food,  and  makes  no  difficulty 
in  swallowing  a  leg  of  mutton,  a  fowl,  or  a  hare,  at  one  mouthful. 
From  this  Bird,  and  from  an  allied  species  in  Senegal,  the 
beautiful  Marabou  feathers  are  obtained. — The  Ibises  have  long 
arched  bills,  with  a  blunt  point ;  in  their  general  conformation 
and  habits,  they  closely  approach  the  Storks  (Fig.  188).  One 
species,  which  inhabits  Egypt,  is  celebrated  as  the  Sacred  His  of 
the  ancient  Egyptians,  who  entertained  it  in  their  temples  with 
the  observances  of  religious  worship,  embalmed  it  after  death, 


FIG.  284. — POUCHED  ADJUTANT. 


FAMILY   SCOLOPACIDJE  ; SNIPES,     WOODCOCK.  501 

and  sculptured  it  upon  their  monuments.  Various  reasons  have 
been  assigned  for  these  honours  ;  according  to  some,  it  was  on 
account  of  its  utility  in  destroying  serpents, — which  seems 
doubtful ;  the  more  probable  opinion  is,  that  its  appearance 
announced  the  rise  of  the  Nile,  on  which  (as  is  well  known)  the 
fertility  of  the  country  entirely  depends. 

450.  The  members  of  the  family  SCOLOPACID^,  or  Snipe 
tribe,  are  all  inhabitants  of  marshy  lands,  the  borders  of  swamps, 
lakes,  and  rivers,  and  the  sea  shore.  Their  food  consists  of 
insects,  worms,  slugs,  aquatic  mollusks,  &c. ;  and  they  usually 
obtain  it  by  thrusting  their  long  bills  into  the  mud  or  moist 
earth.  For  this  purpose  they  are  provided  with  a  very  peculiar 
distribution  of  nerves  upon  the  bill,  which  render  its  exterior 
sensible,  especially  towards  its  tip,  the  membrane  of  which  is 
almost  pulpy  ;  and  in  many  species  there  is  a  peculiar  muscle, 
that  enables  the  Bird  to  separate  the  flexible  points  of  the  man- 
dibles, so  as  to  seize  its  prey  the  moment  it  is  felt,  whilst  the  bill 
is  still  buried  in  the  ground.  The  distribution  of  this  family  is 
very  general ;  all  the  Birds  which  it  contains  being  more  or  less 
migratory  in  their  habits  ;  and  their  powers  of  flight  considerable. 
These  Birds  so  much  resemble  each  other  in  their  general  con- 
formation and  habits,  that  it  will  not  be  necessary  to  do  much 
more  than  mention  the  principal  species  included  in  this  family. 
The  Snipes  have  a  long,  straight,  compressed,  and  slender  beak ; 
the  legs  slender  and  short ;  the  toes  rather  long,  and  not  united 
at  their  base.  They  mostly  breed  in 
high  latitudes,  and  pass  southwards  at 
the  approach  of  winter.  The  British 
islands  are  thus  visited  by  four  species ; 
the  Common  Snipe,  which  sometimes 
breeds  in  our  own  country ;  the  Solitary 
or  Great  Snipe,  which  is  comparatively 
rare ;  the  Jack  Snipe,  a  much  smaller 

species ;  and  the  Woodcock,  which  also  breeds  in  our  islands. 
This  last  Bird  conceals  itself  in  woods,  thickets,  or  brakes, 
during  the  day ;  but  proceeds  at  night  to  damp  meadows  or 


502  SCOLOPACIDJE  ; — SANDPIPER,    RUFF,      CURLEW. 

swampy  open  ground  in  search  of  its  food,  of  which  earth-worms 
constitute  a  very  large  proportion.  Its  voracity  is  very  great ; 
a  single  individual  having  been  known  to  consume  within 
one  night  more  earth-worms  than  half  filled  a  garden-pot  of 
moderate  size. — The  Sandpipers  and  their  allies  constitute  a 
numerous  group,  which  chiefly  frequent  saline  marshes  and  the 
sea-shore ;  though  some  prefer  the  margin  of  inland  lakes  and 
rivers.  They  associate  in  flocks,  and  perform  periodical  migra- 
tions in  large  bodies.  Their  food  consists  of  worms,  Crustacea, 
and  small  mollusks ;  this  is  obtained  rather  from  the  surface  than 
beneath  it, — the  bill  not  being  so  sensitive  as  in  the  Snipes.  They 
undergo  a  double  annual  moult,  the  summer  livery  differing 
remarkably  from  that  of  the  winter.  Many  of  the  species  are 
very  widely  diffused ;  the  Marsh  Sandpiper,  for  instance,  being 
found  in  the  north  of  Europe  and  in  the  Indian  Archipelago  ;  and 
the  Willet  being  common  to  Europe  and  America.  One  of  the 
most  remarkable  species  of  this  group  is  the  Ruff,  of  which  the 
female  is  known  as  the  Reeve.  It  breeds  in  the  fenny  parts  of 
Britain,  but  departs  southwards  for  the  winter.  Soon  after  its 
spring  arrival  in  the  breeding-places,  a  ruff  of  beautiful  long 
plumes  is  developed  round  the  neck  of  the  male ;  this  disappears 
at  the  end  of  June.  It  is  remarkable  for  the  diversity  of  its 
colouring ;  the  hues  not  being  alike  in  any  two  instances.  A 
very  extraordinary  degree  of  pugnacity  is  displayed  by  the 
males  at  the  commencement  of  the  breeding  season ;  this  does 
not  abate  in  confinement ;  and  such  fierce  conflicts  are  excited 
by  merely  setting  a  bowl  of  food  before  them,  that  the  results 
are  sometimes  fatal  to  the  weaker.  The  Curlew,  Whimbrel,  and 
Godwit,  also  belong  to  this  family  ;  their  bills  are  long,  slender, 
and  slightly  curved  ;  and  are  used  to  obtain  food  from  the  mud 
and  oozy  ground,  in  the  same  manner  as  those  of  the  Snipes.  They 
mostly  breed  in  the  high  northern  latitudes,  and  visit  us  only  for 
the  winter  ;  but  they  are  known  to  breed  occasionally  in  Britain. 
45 1 .  Nearly  allied  to  the  preceding,  but  classed  as  a  distinct 
family  by  some  Ornithologists,  are  the  Stilts,  or  Stilt-Plovers, 
and  the  Avocet ;  which  are  remarkable  for  the  extreme  length  and 


STILT,    AVOCET. 


503 


Fio.  286.— STILT. 


slenderness  of  their  legs,  and  for  the  peculiar  form  of  their  bills. 
Although  not  numerous,  the  Stilts 
are  found  in  every  quarter  of  the 
globe ;  the  species  which  occasion- 
ally visits  England  and  western 
Europe,  being  spread  throughout 
Asia  and  Africa, — another  being 
met  with  in  Australia, — and  two 
others  in  America.  They  fre- 
quent marshes,  shallow-lakes,  salt 
pools,  &c. ;  and  feed  upon  minute 
shell-fish,  insects,  Crustacea,  &c. 
They  construct  their  nests  in  the 
vicinity  of  these  ;  six  or  eight 
pairs  uniting  to  build  a  sort  of 
platform,  by  which  the  nests  may 
be  raised  above  the  level  of  the  water.  The  immense  length  of 
their  legs,  and  the  wide  spread  of  their  toes,  adapts  them  admi- 
rably for  wading  ;  and  when  they  get  beyond  their  depth,  they 
can  swim  with  facility  ;  but  they  cannot  walk  with  steadiness 
upon  hard  ground.  Their  wings  are  long,  however,  and  they  fly 
with  great  swiftness.  In  the  Avocet,  the  bill  is  of  extraordinary 

length,   and  slenderness  ; 

and  curves  upwards    to- 

V  ""iM^  W/MiYfJVV      ward9thetiP-   Although 

I)  .Iffl^W™* AV  \          this  conformation  renders 

it  unfit  for  being  plunged 
in  the  mud  in  search  of 
food,  it  adapts  it  most 
admirably  to  skim  its 
surface  in  the  manner  of 
a  light  scoop ;  and  thus 
FIG.  287.-Avoc«T.  to  take  up  the  minute 

insects  and  worms  on  which  the  Bird  feeds.  The  way  in  which 
it  avails  itself  of  the  harvest  of  worms  and  larvas,  small  crusta- 
ceous  and  molluscous  animals,  the  spawn  of  fishes,  &c.,  which 
are  half  imbedded  in  the  mud  at  the  bottom  of  the  fens  and 


504  AVOCET. —  RALLID.E,    OR    RAILS. 

water-courses  it  frequents,  has  some  resemblance  to  mowing.  It 
moves  forwards  with  slow  but  rather  lengthy  steps  ;  and  scoops 
the  ooze  or  mud  in  curves,  right  and  left,  as  it  proceeds.  The 
traces  of  its  scoopings  may  be  seen  in  the  places  where  the  Bird 
has  been  feeding ;  until  they  are  effaced  by  the  tide.  In  this 
action  it  does  not  move  the  bill  alone,  but  the  whole  body ; 
stretching  it  on  either  side  from  the  fixed  point  in  the  feet,  so 
that  the  bill  has  a  very  wide  range,  considering  its  length,  which 
is  about  34  inches.  The  Avocet  was  formerly  not  uncommon  in 
England ;  but  it  is  now  rare,  even  in  the  fenny  districts.  It 
abounds,  however,  in  Holland;  and  is  diffused  over  Europe, 
Asia,  and  Africa.  It  is  not  properly  a  migrating  Bird ;  but 
frequents  the  inland  fens  and  saline  marshes  during  the  breeding 
season  ;  and  resorts  to  the  neighbourhood  of  the  shore  in  winter, 
for  a  better  supply  of  food. 

452.     We  have  lastly  to  notice  the  family  of  RALLID.E,  or 
Rails;  in  which  we  find   many  of  the  characters  of  the  next 

order.  The  toes 
are  long  and  slen- 
der ;  the  hind  one 
is  placed  on  a  level 
with  the  others ; 
and  they  often 
have  a  membra- 
nous margin  along 
their  sides,  by 
which  their  surface 
is  extended  for 
swimming,  or  for 
treading  on  oozy 
ground  (Fig.  288). 
Their  bodies,  too, 
are  generally  com- 
pressed ;  so  as  to  move  with  greater  facility  through  the  water, 
or  to  make  their  way  through  closely-set  herbage.  The  family 
includes,  however,  Birds  of  considerable  variety  of  structure  and 
habit ;  from  the  diving  and  swimming  Coot  to  the  terrestrial 


RAILS,    GALLINULES,    COOTS,    JACANA8,    ETC.  505 

Land-Rail.  "  The  Rallidse  have  to  thread  their  way  through 
beds  of  thick-set  stems  of  reeds,  bulrushes,  and  other  aquatic 
plants,  among  which  they  seek  shelter  and  concealment ;  or,  as 
in  the  case  of  the  Land-Rail,  through  the  tall  grass  of  the 
meadow ; — and  that  so  rapidly  and  noiselessly,  that  the  field 
seems  traversed  by  magic.  Hence  they  elude  pursuit  with 
great  ease,  and  can  seldom  be  forced  to  take  wing." — The  Rails 
have  a  lengthened,  slender,  and  slightly-arched  bill.  They 
mostly  seek  the  shelter  of  tall  herbage;  the  Water-Rails  tenanting 
thick  reed-beds,  on  the  borders  of  the  marshes  and  ponds  in  which 
they  seek  their  food  ;  whilst  the  Land-Rails^  or  Crakes  frequent 
the  fertile  meadows,  and  feed  on  vegetables  and  seeds  as  well 
as  on  worms  and  insects. — The  Gallinules,  or  Moor-Hens,  are 
more  exclusively  aquatic  in  their  habits ;  and  are  able  not  only 
to  swim  with  facility,  but  even  to  dive.  They  have  a  short  and 
straight  bill,  the  cutting  edges  of  the  upper  mandible  falling  over 
those  of  the  lower ;  and  their  food  consists  of  aquatic  weeds  and 
corn-grains,  in  addition  to  aquatic  larvaB,  worms,  &c. — The  Coots 
have  a  strong,  straight,  somewhat  conical  bill;  and  a  membranous 
border  to  the  toes.  They  swim  and  dive  with  great  address, 
and  are  not  inactive  on  land.  The  British  species  is  very  gene- 
rally spread  over  temperate  Europe  ;  and  is  particularly  abundant 
in  Holland.  It  frequents  large  sheets  of  water,  on  the  very 
edge  of  which  it  builds  its  nest ;  and  migrates  in  the  winter, 
when  the  inland  waters  are  frozen,  to  the  saline  marshes,  estua- 
aries,  See.,  of  our  southern  coasts. — The  Jacanas  and  Screamers 
of  tropical  climates,  are  usually  placed  in  this  family ;  though 
sometimes  separated  into  a  distinct  group.  They  are  remark-- 
able for  the  great  length  of  their  toes,  and  of  their  spine-like 
claws,  especially  that  of  the  hinder  toe.  Various  species  of  the 
Jacana,  which  in  contour  and  habit  resemble  our  Moor-Hen, 
are  spread  over  the  tropical  regions  both  of  the  Old  and  New 
World.  They  are  very  light  birds  ;  and  the  wide  surface  over 
which  their  toes  extend,  enables  them  to  walk  over  the 
floating  leaves  of  plants  with  great  facility,  so  that  they  really 
seem  as  if  they  were  treading  upon  water. — The  Screamers, 
which  are  confined  to  South  America,  are  remarkable  not  merely 


506  ORDER    NATATORES  ; — GENERAL   CHARACTERS. 

for  their  harsh  and  discordant  voices,  but  for  the  sharp  hard 
spurs  with  which  the  wings  are  armed  at  the  shoulder  joint. 
These  are  very  efficient  weapons  of  defence;  and  enable  the 
birds  to  resist  the  attacks  of  the  Snakes,  which  infest  the  places 
they  inhabit.  One  species  is  also  remarkable  for  the  possession 
of  a  slender  pointed  horn,  three  or  four  inches  in  length,  which 
arises  from  the  top  of  the  head,  and  curves  gently  forwards. 
The  use  of  this  singular  appendage  is  unknown. 


ORDER  VII.— NATATORES. 

453.  The  Swimmers  or  Web-footed  Birds  are,  of  all  the 
orders  of  the  feathered  race,  the  most  easily  distinguishable,  on 
account  of  the  peculiar  structure  and  position  of  their  oar-like 
feet.  These  members  are  placed  very  far  back,  so  as  to  be  more 
efficient  instruments  for  the  propulsion  of  the  body  in  water ; 
but  this  arrangement  gives  to  the  Birds  an  awkward  waddling 
gait  on  land.  The  feet  are  always  webbed ; — that  is,  the  toes 
are  connected  together  by  a  membrane ;  but  this  in  a  different 
manner  in  the  different  families.  In  making  the  swimming- 
stroke,  the  foot  is  first  drawn  forwards  ;  and  the  toes  then  close 
together,  and  the  webs  fold,  so  as  to  offer  to  the  water  the  least 
possible  resistance  :  but  when  the  back-stroke  is  made,  the  toes 
spread  out,  so  as  to  present  a  large  surface  to  the  water.  The  form 
of  the  body  is  boat-shaped,  so  as  to  move  through  the  water  with 
little  resistance  ;  and  the  neck  is  usually  long,  so  as  to  enable  the 
Bird  to  plunge  the  head  far  down  in  search  of  its  food.  The  tail  is 
generally  short ;  in  some  instances  it  is  composed  of  rigid  feathers, 
and  serves  as  a  rudder  to  direct  the  Bird  in  the  act  of  diving  ; 
but  in  some  of  the  aquatic  Birds  it  is  very  long,  and  guides  them  in 
their  rapid  flight.  The  form  and  size  of  the  wings,  and  the  powers 
of  flight,  vary  greatly  in  the  different  tribes  of  this  order ;  some  of 
them  are  almost  unsurpassed  in  the  extent  of  their  wings ;  whilst 
in  others,  these  organs  are  so  short  as  to  be  utterly  useless  in 
flight,  and  can  be  only  used  as  paddles  for  urging  them  througl 
the  water.  The  plumage  is  dense,  and  is  oiled  by  a  secretic 


AQUATIC    BIRDS. ANATID^E,    OR    DUCK    TRIBE.  507 

from  certain  glands  near  the  tail,  so  as  to  throw  off  the  water 
without  being  wetted  by  it ;  and  there  is  generally  an  under- 
garment of  down,  which  is  especially  thick  beneath  the  body. 
The  food  of  these  Birds  usually  consists  of  fish,  mollusks,  and 
insects.  They  live  much  more  upon  or  in  the  water,  than  on 
land  ;  and  resort  to  the  shore  chiefly  for  the  purpose  of  building 
their  nests  and  rearing  their  young.  One  male  usually  asso- 
ciates with  several  females,  and  leaves  to  them  the  cares  of 
incubation.  The  nest  is  rudely  constructed,  and  is  placed  either 
upon  the  ground,  or  upon  the  low  vegetation  in  the  neighbour- 
hood of  water ;  and  the  young  are  hatched  in  a  condition  that 
enables  them  immediately  to  run  about  and  seek  their  own  food. 
— This  Order  includes  five  families  ; — the  ANATIDJE,  or  Ducks  ; 
the  COLYMBID^:,  or  Divers;  the  ALCID^I,  or  Auks;  the  LARID.E, 
or  Gulls;  and  the  PELICANID.E,  or  Pelicans. 

454.  The  ANATID./E,  or  Duck  tribe,  are  distinguished  by  the 
breadth  and  depression  of  the  bill,  which  is  covered  with  a  soft 
sensitive  skin ;  and  by  the  separation  of  the  hind  toe,  which  is 
not  included  in  the  web.  The  bill  is  furnished  with  a  set  of 
laminae  or  horny  plates  at  the  edge  of  each  mandible  ;  the  use 
of  which  appears  to  be,  to  filter  the  fluid  taken  up  by  the  bill, 
allowing  the  water  to  escape,  and  retaining  the  solid  substances 
included  in  it, — thus  serving  very  much  the  same  purpose  as 
the  sieve  of  Whalebone  in  the  mouth  of  the  Whale  (§  214). 
The  selection  and  appropriation  of  the  food  is  further  aided  by 
the  tongue ;  which,  instead  of  being  slender  and  horny,  is  large 
and  fleshy.  The  gizzard  is  strong  and  muscular,  and  is  lined 
in  many  species  by  a  very  thick,  tough,  and  almost  horny  coat, 
so  as  to  be  capable  of  grinding  down  the  shells  of  mussels  and 
other  mollusks  on  which  they  feed.  The  Anatidae  are  dispersed 
over  every  part  of  the  globe,  and  are  usually  more  or  less  migra- 
tory in  their  habits.  Their  flight  is  vigorous  and  rapid  ;  and  it 
is  generally  at  a  high  elevation. — As  connecting  this  family 
with  the  preceding  order,  we  must  notice  the  extraordinary 
Flamingo;  which,  from  the  length  of  its  legs  and  neck,  would 
seem  to  be  a  Wading  Bird  ;  but  which,  in  the  complete  palma- 
tion  (webbing)  of  its  feet,  and  in  the  form  and  structure 

L  L2 


508 


ANATID^E  ;  —  FLAMINGO  ;   GEESE. 


of  its  bill,  would  rather  seem  to  belong  to  the  Duck  tribe. 
The  beak  would  closely  resemble  that  of  a  Swan,  were  it 
not  bent  down  abruptly 
in  the  middle ;  and  by 
this  change  of  form,  it  is 
adapted  to  be  used  in  a 
position  contrary  to  the 
usual  one,  —  the  head 
being  so  bent  down,  that 
the  upper  mandible,  not 
the  lower,  is  applied 
to  the  mud  and  ooze  in 
which  the  Bird  is  seeking 
its  food.  The  edges  of 
the  mandibles  are  lami- 
nated, as  in  the  Ducks ; 
and  the  tongue  is  fleshy, 
and  beset  with  rows  of 
curved  spines.  The  Fla- 
mingoes are  waders  in 
their  habits,  chiefly  fre-  FIG.  289— FLAMINGO. 

quenting  low  muddy  coasts,  the  mouths  of  large  rivers,  creeks, 
lagoons,  and  inland  lakes.  The  European  species  is  seen  on  the 
shores  of  the  Mediterranean ;  but  it  is  more  abundant  in 
Southern  Africa,  and  on  the  shores  of  the  Caspian. 

455.  Of  the  true  ANATID^,  the  Geese  seem  best  adapted  for 
an  inland  residence ;  their  food  consists  chiefly  of  grain  or  grass; 
and  their  legs  are  placed  further  forwards  than  in  the  Ducks. 
The  parent-stock  of  our  domesticated  breeds — the  common  Wild 
Goose  or  Grey  Lag  Goose,  is  still  extant  in  some  parts  of  England, 
though  its  numbers  are  diminishing  in  consequence  of  the  exten- 
sion of  cultivation.  It  ranges  over  the  greater  part  of  the 
temperate  regions  of  the  Old  World ;  and  is  replaced  in  the 
New  by  a  species  very  closely  allied  to  it,  and  equally  domes- 
ticable,— the  Canada  Goose.  Still  further  north  is  found  the 
Snow  Goose,  which  seems  altogether  confined  to  the  Arctic 
regions. — The  Brent  Goose  is  a  much  smaller  Bird  than  the 


GEESE  ;      SWANS ;     DUCKS. 


509 


Common  Goose,  but  has  much  longer  wings ;  and  it  traverses 
greater  distances  in  its  migrations.     Its  breeding-places  are  in 


FIG.  290.— BRENT  GOOSE. 


the  far  north ;  but  it  migrates  for  the  winter  as  low  down  as 
the  middle  of  France,  and  has  been  known  (when  the  season 
has  been  very  severe)  to  attack  the  corn-fields  in  such  numbers, 
as  to  produce  the  most  serious  injury.  Nearly  allied  to  this  is 
the  Barnacle  Goose;  of  whose  origin  from  the  Barnacles 
attached  to  floating  timber,  &c.,  such  strange  stories  are  told  by 
the  older  naturalists. — The  Swans  are  more  purely  aquatic  in 
their  habits;  but  their  diet  consists  chiefly  of  the  roots  of 
aquatic  plants,  and  other  vegetable  matter,  which  they  obtain 
by  means  of  their  long  necks.  They  are  distributed  through  all 
parts  of  the  world ;  and  are  remarkable  for  their  graceful  appear- 
ance upon  the  water,  which  is  familiar  to  every  one. — The  Ducks 
are  destined  to  feed  in  great  part  upon  animal  matter,  such  as 
insects  and  mollusks ;  as  well  as  upon  vegetables  and  grains. 
They  are  inhabitants  of  various  parts  of  the  world,  and  are 
generally  seen  upon  the  lakes  and  rivers  of  the  interior,  though 
they  occasionally  resort  to  the  sea-shore.  Ducks  can  all  swim 
and  dive  with  facility ;  they  can  all  fly  well ;  and  they  can  all 
walk,  though  frequently  with  difficulty.  The  number  of  species 
is  very  numerous ;  and  they  may  be  arranged  under  two  sub- 
divisions, according  to  their  habits,  and  the  peculiarities  of 
structure  which  correspond  to  them. — The  Ducks  of  the  first 
section  live  for  the  most  part  inland,  and  frequent  shallow 


510  DUCKS; — MALLARD;  SCOTERS,  ETC. 

waters,  very  seldom  immersing  the  whole  body ;  the  feet  are 
placed  farther  forwards  than  in  the  other  section,  so  that  walk- 
ing is  easier ;  the  wings  are  longer ;  the  swimming- web  is  less 
extensive,  and  the  hind-toe  is  free.  They  employ  their  wings 
and  legs  considerably  in  flying  or  walking  from  one  part  of  the 
shallow  to  another  ;  and  their  food  consists  of  vegetable  matter, 
as  well  as  of  small  animals.  To  this  section  belong  the  common 
Mallard  or  Wild  Duck  (the  origin  of  our  domesticated  breeds), 


FIG.  291.— MALLARD. 

the  Sheldrake,  Teal,  Widgeon,  Muscovy  Duck,  and  many  other 
species. — The  Ducks  of  the  second  section  are  inhabitants  of 
deeper  waters  and  of  the  sea.  The  hind-toe  is  included  in  the 
membranous  web;  and  the  expanse  of  this  is  considerably 
greater;  so  that  the  swimming  powers  are  much  increased. 
Most  of  them,  too,  are  good  divers;  and  obtain  their  food, 
which  consists  of  small  crabs,  shell-fish,  and  aquatic  plants,  by 
immersing  the  whole  body  in  water.  The  neck  is  shorter,  and 
not  so  much  adapted  for  dabbling  in  water;  the  wings  are 
smaller  and  less  powerful ;  and  the  legs  are  placed  far  back. 
This  group  includes  the  Scoters,  Eiders,  Pochard,  Scaup,  Gol- 
den-Eye, and  many  other  species  more  or  less  known  upon  our 
coasts.  The  Scoters  are  altogether  marine  in  their  habits,  and 
obtain  their  food  by  diving.  They  chiefly  live  upon  fish  and 
mollusks;  and  their  flesh  has  a  rank  fishy  taste.  They  are 


SCOTERS  :     EIDER    DUCK. 


511 


common  on  the  northern  shores  of  both  continents  during  the 
winter ;  and  retire  to  the  extreme  north  to  breed  during  the 


FIG.  292.— BLACK  SCOTBR. 


summer  months. 


Their  plumage  is  for  the  most  part  dark,  or 
even  quite  black  ;  but  it  is  very 
close  and  stiff,  so  that  it  receives 
no  injury  from  immersion  in 
water.  The  Eiders  are  the 
largest  of  all  the  Ducks,  being 
as  weighty  as  the  average  of 
Geese.  They  are  remarkable 
for  the  extraordinary  coating 
of  down,  with  which  their 
bodies  are  covered  ;  and  for  this 
their  nests  are  sought  with 
eagerness  by  the  Fowler,  a  con- 
siderable quantity  of  it  being 
plucked  off  by  the  female  for  their  lining.  When  the  eggs  and 


FIG.  293 — EIDER  DUCK. 


512 


EIDER    DUCK; — MERGANSER.  —  DIVERS. 


their  covering  of  down  have  been  taken  away,  the  female 
will  again  lay;  and  when  she  has  nearly  stripped  herself  of 
down,  the  male  affords  some  of  his.  The  breeding-places  of 
this  Bird  are  situated  for  the  most  part  in  the  arctic  regions ; 
and  it  is  only  an  accidental  visitor  to  our  southern  coasts.  The 
shores  of  Iceland,  Greenland,  Lapland,  Spitzbergen,  and  those  of 
Labrador,  Hudson's,  and  Baffin's  Bays  are  its  chief  resorts. 
During  the  summer  months,  these  Birds  are  often  met  with 
floating  in  pairs,  or  solitary,  at  a  considerable  distance  from  land, 
though  usually  in  the  neighbourhood  of  ice. — The  last  division 
of  this  family  consists  of  the  Mergansers  or  Gooseanders;  which 


FIG.  294. — MERGANSER. 

have  narrow  cylindrical  bills,  with  the  margin  jagged  like  a  saw, 
and  the  tip  armed  with  a  hooked  nail.  They  are  inhabitants 
of  the  arctic  regions,  breeding  very  far  north  in  summer,  and 
migrating  southwards  in  winter,  —  though  few,  even  then, 
advance  far  into  the  temperate  zone.  Their  food  consists  prin- 
cipally of  fish,  which  they  take  by  rapid  diving ;  also  of  small 
crabs  and  insects.  They  seem  never  to  feed  upon  land ;  and  to 
be  incapable  of  digesting  vegetable  matter  of  any  kind. 

456.     The  family  of  COLYMBID^:,  or  Divers,  have  short  wings; 
and  the  legs  are  placed  so  far  back  on  the  body,  that  they  always 


COLYMBID^  ; DIVERS,    GREBES. 


513 


assume  an  erect  position  when  standing.  The  bill  is  compressed 
at  the  tip,  and  pointed.  Some  of  them  even  suspend  their  nests 
on  rushes  at  the  surface  of  the  water.  The  true  Divers  have 


FIG.  295. — GREAT  NORTHERN  DIVER. 

the  feet  large,  all  the  front  toes  entirely  webbed,  and  the  hind 
toe  connected  to  the  outer  membrane  of  the  inner  one. — They 
are  found  in  the  northern  regions;  visiting  the  lakes  of  the 
interior  during  the  breeding  season.  They  are  rapid  and  power- 
ful divers ;  feeding  on  fish,  and  sometimes  on  vegetables. — The 
Grebes  have  their  toes  flattened,  separate,  but  broadly  fringed  at 
their  edges  by  a  firm  membrane ;  this  division  of  the  webbed 
foot  probably  assists  its  action,  in  waters  where  there  is  a 
good  deal  of  vegetation.  The  quickness  with  which  they  dive 
extremely  remarkable ;  they  have  been  seen  to  plunge  with 
ifficient  rapidity  to  avoid  the  shot  of  a  fowling-piece,  by  whose 


514 


GREBES. — ALCID^E,    OR    AUKS. 


FIG.  296.— LITTLE  GREBE. 


discharge  they  were  alarmed;  and  then  to  come  up  at  two  hun- 
dred yards'  distance.  Their  pro- 
gression on  land,  however,  is  ex- 
tremely awkward ;  for  they  are 
obliged  to  lie  upon  the  whole  length 
of  the  body,  and  then  to  shuffle 
along  like  Seals,  by  the  action  of 
their  feet  against  the  ground.  Their 
flight  is  feeble,  but  their  wings  give 
much  assistance  in  the  act  of 
diving. 

457.  The  family  ALCID^E,  or 
Auks,  have,  like  the  Divers,  very 
short  wings,  and  the  legs  placed 
far  behind  the  centre  of  the  body, 
so  that  they  stand  nearly  erect; 
but  they  have  the  toes  all  united 
with  a  web.  They  pass  a  large 
part  of  their  time  in  the  waters 
of  the  ocean ;  and  nestle  upon  its  borders.  The  power  of  the 
wings  is  extremely  limited;  and  in 
one  tribe  they  are  only  capable  of 
acting  as  paddles,  to  assist  the  mo- 
tion of  the  Bird  in  the  water.  The 
form  of  the  bill  varies  in  the  dif- 
ferent genera ;  but  it  is  usually 
compressed,  and  the  tip  is  very  com- 
monly hooked.  In  the  Auks, 
or  Razor-bills,  the  wings  are  per- 
fectly formed,  though  short;  and 
the  hind  toe  is  wanting.  These  Birds 
are  found  in  the  Northern  Ocean, 
and  appear  in  more  temperate  cli- 
mates during  the  winter.  They  feed 
on  fish,  small  crabs,  &c.  They 
never  leave  the  water,  except  for  the 
purposes  of  incubation ;  and  they  breed  on  the  ledges  of 


FIG.  297.— GREAT  AUK. 


AUKS;  PUFFINS;   GUILLEMOTS.  515 

precipices,  in  caverns,  and  in  deep  fissures  of  the  rocks.  When 
on  land,  they  shuffle  along  in  a  very  awkward  manner ;  and 
sometimes  use  the  bill  to  draw  themselves  upwards  on  the  shore ; 
but  in  water,  they  dash  along  with  the  ease  and  velocity  of 
fishes. — Nearly  allied  to  the  Auks  are  the  Puffins,  which  are 


Fio.  298. — COMMON  PUFFIN. 

abundant  on  the  shores  of  all  the  northern  seas,  breeding  in  holes 
and  crevices  of  rocks,  but  not  resorting  to  the  land  at  any  other 
time.  They  breed  on  many  parts  of  our  own  coasts ;  such  as 
Dover  Cliffs,  the  Needles,  and  the  Farn  islands  of  Northumber- 
land. Their  nests  are  much  sought  by  fowlers,  both  for  the 
eeres,  and  for  the  parent  birds,  the  bodies  of  which  are  much 

oo  '  »• 

relished  by  many  as  food. — The  Guillemots  strongly  resemble 
the  Auks  and  Puffins  in  their  general  habits ;  but  differ  in  the 
form  of  the  bill,  which  is  straight  and  compressed.  They  are 
thick  and  clumsy  Birds,  and  are  almost  completely  destitute  of 
the  powers  of  walking  and  of  flight ;  but  they  dive  with  great 
address,  and  catch  their  prey  with  much  adroitness.  The  most 
common  species  is  known  as  the  Foolish  Guillemot,  on  account 
of  its  habit  of  allowing  itself  to  be  taken,  rather  than  quit  its 
single  egg.  This  Bird  is  widely  spread  through  the  northern 
shores,  and  performs  a  southern  migration  for  the  winter ;  the 
extent  of  which  depends  in  part  upon  the  place  it  has  left.  Thus, 
the  Guillemots  which  breed  on  the  small  rocky  islands  near  the 


516  PENGUINS. — LARIDJE,    OR   GULLS;    PETRELS. 

coast  of  Britain,  associating  with  the  Puffins  and  other  Birds  of 
the  same  family,  pass  the  winter  in  the  Mediterranean  ;  whilst 
those  that  breed  in  more  northern  spots  find  a  sufficient  change 
of  temperature,  by  passing  the  winter  on  the  British  shores. 

458.  These  Birds  are  represented  in  the  southern  Hemisphere 
by  the  Penguins,  an  extremely  remarkable  group ;  in  which  the 
legs  are  placed  so  far  back,  that  the  body  is  quite  upright  when 
the  Bird  is  standing  on  the  ground  ;  and  the  wings  lose  alto- 
gether the  power  of  raising  the  body  in  the  air,  being  covered 
with  short  rigid  scale-like  feathers,  disposed  in  regular  order, 
instead  of  having  their  surface  extended  by  prolonged  feathers 
(Fig.  189).     The  bones,  unlike  those  of  Birds  in  general,  are 
hard,  compact  and  heavy,  and  have  no  apertures  for  the  admis- 
sion of  air ;  those  of  the  extremities  contain  an  oily  marrow. 
The  Penguin  is  exclusively  a  Water-Bird,  except  in  the  breeding 
season ;  and,  aided  by  its  paddle-like  wings,  it  swims  and  dives 
with  great  facility.     It  is  a  courageous  bird,   although  by  no 
means  disposed  to  fight.     From  the  presence  of  a  large  number 
of  the  horny  parrot-like  beaks  of  Cuttle-fish  in  the  specimens 
dissected,  it  may  be  inferred  that  these  animals  constitute  a  large 
part  of  their  food. 

459.  The  Birds  of  the  family  LARID^E,  or  Gulls,  are  entirely 
oceanic  in  their  habits ;  being  seldom  found  at  any  distance  from 
the  sea,  and  for  the  most  part  living  upon  its  surface,  even  at 
vast  distances  from  land.     They  are  generally  distinguished  for 
great  powers  of  flight ;  in  which  respect  they  present  a  remark- 
able contrast  to  the  Birds  of  the  preceding  family.      But,  on  the 
other  hand,  they  are  not  good  divers ;  their  food  being  such  as 
they  may  obtain  at  or  near  the  surface  of  the  water,  rather  than 
in   its   depths.     They   are   distinguished  by  the    shortness   or 
absence  of  the  hind  toe,  which  is  not  included  in  the  web ;  and 
by  the  compressed  form  of  the  bill.      These   characters  are, 
perhaps,  best  seen,  not  in  the  Gulls,  but  in  the  Petrels  ;  in  which 
the  hind  claw  originates  at  once  from  the  tarsus  (like  a  spur), 
without  any  toe ;  and  each  mandible  of  the  bill  (which  is  longer 
than  the  head)  terminates  in  a  sort  of  hard  nail,  of  which  the 
upper  one  is  abruptly  hooked.     The  Petrels  are  inhabitants  of 


STORMY    PETREL;    ALBATROSS.  517 

the  higher  latitudes  of  both  hemispheres,  and  are  almost  con- 
stantly seen  on  the  wing,  only  alighting  on  the  ocean  to  take  a 
short  repose,  and  rarely  coming  to  land  except  during  the  breed- 
season.  They  feed  upon  fish,  mollusks,  and  floating  garbage ; 
and  many  species  are  in  the  habit  of  following  ships  in  their 
course,  to  partake  of  the  refuse  which  is  thrown  overboard.  The 
larger  ones  will  attack  other  Marine  Birds,  compelling  them  to 
give  up  their  prey,  or  even  destroying  and  devouring  them. 
The  Stormy  Petrels*  commonly  known  by  sailors  as  Mother 
Careys  Chickens -,  are  the  smallest  of  all  the  web-footed  Birds, 
and  are  distributed  over  every  part  of  the  ocean.  They  seem 
quite  at  their  ease  amidst  the  most  violent  storms,  coursing  over 
the  roughest  waves,  and  mounting  through  the  breaking  surge 
that  threatens  to  overwhelm  them.  Hence  they  are  so  associated 
in  the  minds  of  seamen  with  the  idea  of  tempest,  that  their 
appearance  is  regarded  as  the  sure  forerunner  of  a  storm. — To 
this  group  also  belongs  the  gigantic  Albatross  ;  which  is  one  of 
the  largest  of  all  aquatic  Birds, — its  spread  of  wing  being  some- 


FIG.  299.— ALBATROSS. 


times  fourteen  feet,  and  its  weight  twenty  pounds.  This  Bird 
is  an  inhabitant  of  the  southern  seas,  where  it  is  often  seen  by 
the  voyager  sailing  with  outspread  wings  around  his  vessel,  or 


518 


LARID^S  ; ALBATROSS;     GULLS. 


sweeping  over  the  surface  in  chase  of  flying-fish.  It  is  extremely 
voracious,  being  often  seen  to  swallow  at  one  mouthful  a  fish  of 
four  or  five  pounds  weight.  Albatrosses  are  occasionally  seen 
in  the  northern  seas ;  being  probably  attracted  thither  by  the 
migrations  of  fish,  whose  shoals  they  follow.  Notwithstanding 
their  large  size,  they  are  not  courageous  Birds ;  being  often 
obliged  to  yield  their  prey  to  the  Sea-Eagles,  and  even  to  the 
larger  Gulls.  When  they  meet  with  abundance  of  food,  they 
gorge  themselves  until  they  are  almost  stupified,  and  seem  to 
doze  upon  the  water ;  and  when  alarmed  in  this  state,  they 
discharge  the  contents  of  their  stomachs,  which  are  rendered 
peculiarly  offensive  by  the  secretion  of  a  quantity  of  acrid  oil. 
In  these  habits  they  strongly  remind  us  of  the  Vultures. 

460.     The  true  Gulls  have  the  bill  of  moderate  size,  with  the 
tip  hooked  and  acute.     They  have  a  small  hind-toe,  elevated 

from  the  ground.  They 
are  found  in  every 
part  of  the  world,  and 
are  omnivorous  in 
their  habits;  and  in 
these  and  other  par- 
ticulars, they  may  be 
regarded  as  represent- 
ing the  Crows.  Some 
are  found  at  a  dis- 
tance from  the  sea, 
feeding  on  slugs, 
worms,  grubs ;  but 
the  sea-shore  is  their  usual  haunt,  and  there  they  devour  all 
kinds  of  garbage  that  the  tide  brings  up,  together  with  such 
living  animals  as  they  may  obtain.  They  are  extremely  useful, 
therefore,  in  removing  a  great  deal  of  matter,  that  would  other- 
wise taint  the  air  by  its  putrescence.  Thus  if  a  Whale  is 
thrown  ashore  in  the  Orkney  Islands,  its  carcase  is  speedily 
devoured  by  innumerable  Gulls,  which  flock,  in  a  wonderfully 
short  space  of  time,  to  any  spot  where  food  is  to  be  had.  They 
frequent  the  neighbourhood  of  fishing  villages ;  and  are  very 


FIG.  300.— COMMON  GULL. 


LARHXE  ; SKUAS,  TERNS.  519 

serviceable  in  carrying  off  the  refuse  that  is  left  by  Man. — The 
Skuas  are  a  tribe  of  Gulls  which  are  larger  than  the  rest,  and 
which  obtain  their  chief  subsistence  by  robbing  other  marine 
birds  of  their  prey.  The  Common  Skua,  which  is  abundant  on 
many  parts  of  the  British  shores,  is  not  much  inferior  to  the 
Eagles  in  size  and  strength  ;  and  as  it  is  a  courageous  Bird,  it 
has  no  difficulty  in  keeping  the  smaller  Gulls  in  subjection, 
though  it  is  not  known  to  attack  them  for  the  sake  of  devour- 
ing their  bodies.  It  is  accused,  in  the  Orkney  and  Shetland 
Islands,  of  attacking  lambs ;  but  this  is  unlikely, — though  it 
may  very  probably  feed  on  the  bodies  of  such,  as  it  finds  dead 
in  the  pastures.  Although  the  claws  are  strong  and  crooked, 
these  birds  cannot  carry  off  anything  in  them,  from  the  want  of 
an  efficient  hind-toe,  against  which  to  act. — The  Terns,  or  Sea- 
Swallows,  have  a  lengthened,  straight,  and  slender  bill,  rather 


FIG.  301. — TBRN,  OR  SEA-SWALLOW. 

curved  at  the  tip  ;  their  wings  are  long  and  pointed  ;  and  their 
tails  forked.  These  birds  are  met  with  on  almost  every 
sea-coast  in  the  world,  and  occasionally  proceed  inland  to  the 
lakes,  &c.  They  are  continually  seen  on  the  wing,  and  are  some- 
times found  at  very  great  distances  from  land.  Their  food  con- 
sists principally  of  fish  ;  some  also  attack  the  eggs  and  young 
of  water-birds;  and  others  feed  only  on  insects,  like  the  Swallows, 
which  they  so  much  resemble.  They  are  migratory  in  their 
habits,  passing  southwards  in  the  winter,  in  large  flocks.  Some 


520 


PELICANID.E  ; DARTERS  ; TROPIC    BIRDS. 


of  the  Gulls,  also,  change  their  abodes  periodically ;  but  rather, 
it  would  seem,  for  the  purposes  of  breeding,  or  for  seeking  their 
food,  than  for  a  change  of  temperature. 

461.  The  last  family  of  Natatores  is  that  of  PELICANHXE,  or 
the  Pelican  tribe,  the  birds  of  which  are  at  once  distinguished 
from  the  preceding  by  the  length  of  the  hind  toe,  and  its  union  with 
the  rest  in  the  web  (Fig.  190)  ;  they  are  consequently  excellent 
swimmers,  and  they  often  perch  upon  trees.  The  edge  of  the 
beak  is  generally  toothed  ;  and  their  throat  is  dilated  into  a  bag, 
in  which  they  keep  the  fish  as  they  catch  them,  to  feed  their 
young. — The  Darters  have  a  long  slender  bill,  broad  at  the 

base,  but  much  compressed  and 
acute  at  the  tips.  They  live  in 
small  flocks ;  perching  on  trees  by  the 
sides  of  rivers,  lakes,  and  lagoons, 
at  no  great  distance  from  the  shore  ; 
and  darting  at  fish  with  their  long 
slender  bills  and  flexible  necks. 
They  thus  bear  a  strong  resem- 
blance to  the  Kingfishers.  If  alarmed 
on  their  perch,  they  plunge  directly 
into  the  water  almost  as  if  shot, 
swim  for  some  distance  beneath  the 
surface,  and  then  re-appear  and 
dart  into  the  air  like  an  arrow. 
Their  nests  are  rudely  formed  of 
sticks,  in  the  tops  of  trees.  The 

Darters  are  found  near  the  eastern  coasts  of  the  tropical  parts 
of  America ;  and  on  the  western  coast  of  tropical  Africa. — The 
Tropic-birds  have  a  long  bill,  broad  at  the  base,  with  the  edges 
of  the  mandibles  finely  serrated.  The  general  form  of  the  body 
is  like  that  of  the  Gulls ;  but  there  are  two  narrow  middle 
feathers,  which  are  prolonged  far  backwards.  They  are  found 
in  tropical  climates,  where  they  catch  the  Flying-fish,  &c.,  on 
which  they  prey, — hovering  over  the  water,  and  then  suddenly 
darting  down  upon  any  fish  within  their  reach.  They  rarely,  if 
ever,  settle  upon  the  water ;  but  return  every  evening  to  their 


FIG.  302 — DARTER. 


PELECANID^i; — PELICANS,    GANNET8.  521 

roosting-places  on  the  shore.  If  far  out  at  sea,  however,  they 
will  fly  all  night.  Their  movements  are  remarkably  graceful. 
It  is  in  the  Pelicans  and  their  allies,  that  we  find  the  pouch 
beneath  the  mouth  most  developed.  Their  bill  is  long  and 
straight,  and  the  tip  hooked ;  the  lower  mandible  is  composed 
of  two  flexible  branches  united  only  at  the  point ;  and  the 
cheeks  and  throat  are  bare  of  feathers.  Their  powers  of  flight 
are  very  great ;  and  this  seems  due  not  only  to  the  great  extent 
of  their  wings,  but  also  to  the  large  size  of  the  air-cells,  which 
are  more  extensive  than  in  any  other  Birds.  The  Pelican  is  an 


FIG.  303.— PELICAN. 

inhabitant  of  tropical  climates,  usually  keeping  near  the  shore, 
but  sometimes  going  inland  for  the  purposes  of  incubation.  It 
hovers  over  the  surface  of  the  water,  watching  the  shoals  of 
fish  beneath ;  then  suddenly  descends,  sinking  deep  into  the 
water,  and  using  its  bill  as  a  scoop,  by  which  it  entraps  its 
finny  prey ;  and  rising  to  the  surface  by  its  own  buoyancy, 
immediately  ascends  again  on  expanded  wings.  Its  pouch  is  so 
capacious,  that  it  will  hold,  when  distended,  two  gallons  of  water. 
The  Gannet,  or  Solan  Goose,  of  our  own  coasts, — the  Brown 
Gannet,  or  Booby  of  the  South  Seas  (so  called  from  its  apathy 
in  allowing  itself  to  be  taken  or  knocked  on  the  head), — the 


522  PELEC AN IDJE  ;— CORMORANT,    FRIGATE    BIRD. 

Cormorant,  which  ranges  from  Britain  to  America  and  India, — 
and  the  Frigate,  or  Man-of-War  Bird,  of  the  tropics,  are  all 


FIG.  304 — FRIGATE  BIRD. 


closely  allied  to  the  Pelican  in  structure,  and  resemble  it  in 
habits.  The  last-named  Bird  is  remarkable  for  its  extent  of 
wing,  and  for  its  habit  of  tyrannising  over  the  Gulls  and 
Boobies,  from  which  it  forces  the  prey  they  have  captured. 


CHAPTER  V. 

CLASS  OF  REPTILES. 

462.  THE  class  of  Reptiles  comprises  all  the  cold-blooded 
Vertebrated  animals,  whose  respiration  (in  the  perfect  state,  at 
least)  is  aerial  and  incomplete.     They  have  lungs,  as  Mammalia 
and  Birds ;  but  their  circulating  apparatus  is  always  arranged 
in  such  a  manner,  that  a  part  of  the  venous  blood  is  mixed  with 
arterial  blood  without  having  traversed  the  respiratory  organ. 
This  mixture  usually  takes  place  in  the  heart;  which   only 
possesses  a  single  ventricle,  into  which  open  the  two  auricles. 
In  their  general  form,  Reptiles  approach  Mammalia  nearer  than 
Birds ;  but  they  offer  in  this  respect  many  variations,  as  may 
be  seen  by  comparing  together,  a  Tortoise  (Fig.  326),  a  Croco- 
dile (Fig.  329),   a  Serpent  (Fig.  339),  and  a  Frog  (Fig.  342). 
Their  head  is  almost  always  small,  and  their  body  very  much 
lengthened  out;  some,   as  Serpents,   are   entirely  destitute   of 
members,  or  have  only  traces  of  them  ;  but  the  greater  number 
of  these  animals,  the  Lizard  and  Frog  for  instance,  have  four 
limbs,  formed  so  as  to  serve  for  walking  or  swimming.  Further, 
these  members  are  generally  too  short  to  prevent  the  trunk  from 
dragging  on  the  earth ;  hence,  most  Reptiles  are  accustomed  to 
crawl  rather  than  walk ;  from  which  circumstance  it  is,  that 
their  name  is  derived.* 

463.  The  skeleton  in  this  class  presents  much  greater  varia- 
tions in  its  structure,  than  in  warm-blooded  Vertebrata.     All 
the  parts  of  which  it  is  composed  are  wanting  in  one  or  another 
group,  excepting  the  head,  and  the  vertebral  column;  but  the 
bones  of  which  these  are  composed,  always  preserve  a  great 
resemblance  to  those  of  Mammalia  and  Birds,  and  are  easily 

•  The  Latin  repto  means,  to  crawl  or  creep. 
M  M  2 


524  GENERAL    CHARACTERS    OF    REPTILES. 

recognised  as  being  analogous  to  them.  The  skull  is  always 
small,  and  the  face  lengthened ;  the  lower  jaw  is  composed  of 
several  pieces,  as  in  Birds ;  and  is  articulated  to  a  bone  distinct 
from  the  temporal  (the  os  quadratum,  or  tympanic  bone,  §  326). 
Sometimes  even  this  bone  is,  in  its  turn,  suspended  to  a  mov- 
able lever ;  an  arrangement  which  greatly  increases  the  dilata- 
bility  of  the  mouth,  as  we  shall  presently  see  when  speaking  of 
the  deglutition  of  Serpents.  The  upper  jaw  is  generally  im- 
movable ;  but  in  Serpents  it  is  articulated  so  as  to  execute  cer- 
tain movements.  Amongst  several  reptiles,  Lizards  and  Tor- 
toises for  example,  the  bones  of  the  cranium  are  prolonged 
laterally  over  the  temples,  in  the  manner  of  a  shield,  and  thus  give 
to  the  head  a  considerable  length.  Lastly,  the  head  is  in  gene- 
ral but  slightly  movable  ;  and  is  articulated  upon  the  vertebral 
column  by  means  of  a  single  condyle.  The  bones  of  the  trunk 
present,  in  their  arrangement  and  number,  more  considerable 
variations.  In  Lizards,  Crocodiles,  and  other  Reptiles  formed 
on  nearly  the  same  plan,  there  are  generally  but  few  anomalies 
to  be  remarked  ;  and  we  shall  only  notice,  that  the  ribs  are  more 
numerous  than  in  Mammalia  or  Birds ;  and  that  they  protect 
the  abdomen,  as  well  as  the  thoracic  portion  of  the  body. 
Amongst  Serpents,  the  sternum  is  wanting,  as  well  as  the  bones 
of  the  members  ;  and  the  ribs,  whose  number  is  very  great,  are 
free  at  their  lower  extremity  :  we  sometimes  count  more  than 
300  pairs  of  them,  in  the  Colubers  for  example  ;  and  they  are  so 
movable,  that  the  animal  employs  them  as  supports  in  its 
crawling  motion.  The  vertebrae  also  possess  great  mobility ; 
and  are  articulated  together  by  means  of  a  rounded  eminence  on 
each,  received  into  a  corresponding  cavity  in  the  next,  and  held 
by  the  aid  of  ligaments ;  so  as  to  form  a  series  of  ball-and- 
socket  joints  (ANIM.  PHYSIOL.  §  629.)  Among  Frogs,  the 
skeleton  presents  a  contrary  arrangement;  for  the  ribs  are 
entirely  wanting,  whilst  the  sternum,  on  the  contrary,  is  very  much 
developed,  and  is  united  with  the  bones  of  the  shoulder,  so  as  to 
form  a  kind  of  girdle  around  the  chest.  But  it  is  in  the  Tor- 
toise tribe,  that  the  conformation  of  these  bones  is  the  most 
remarkable ;  for  they  form  two  great  shields,  between  which  the 


GENERAL    CHARACTERS    OF    REPTILES.  525 

animal  can  generally  withdraw  itself  completely.  One  of  these 
shields  occupies  the  back,  and  is  named  the  carapace  ;  the  other, 
situated  under  the  body,  is  called  the  plastron.  (Fig.  327.) 
They  are  united  together  on  each  side,  in  such  a  manner  as  to 
leave,  in  front  and  behind,  an  opening  that  serves  for  the  pas- 
sage of  the  head,  feet,  and  tail.  This  kind  of  cuirass  is  only 
covered  by  the  skin,  which,  in  its  turn,  is  generally  furnished 
with  large  scaly  plates ;  and  all  the  muscles  and  other  soft  parts 
are  enclosed  in  the  great  cavity  thus  formed. 

464.  The  osseous  framework  of  Tortoises,  in  order  to  present 
this  unusual  arrangement,  must  necessarily,  it  is  evident,  be 
greatly  modified :  we  nevertheless  find  the  same  constituent  parts 
as  in  ordinary  Vertebrata ;  but  several  of  these  pieces  have 
changed  their  form  and  size.  When  we  examine  the  carapace  on 
its  upper  surface,  we  see  that  it  is  formed  by  a  great  number  of 
bony  plates,  united  together  by  sutures ;  of  these  plates,  eight 
occupy  the  median  line,  sixteen  constitute  a  longitudinal  range  on 
each  side  of  these,  and  twenty-five  or  twenty-six  surround  the 
whole  like  an  oval  frame.  It  is  difficult  then  to  recognise  the 
nature  of  these  bones ;  but  if  we  examine  the  carapace  by  its 
lower  surface  (Fig.  305),  we  immediately  see  that  the  central 
pieces,  of  which  we  have  just  spoken,  are  nothing  else  than  appen- 
dages of  the  dorsal  vertebrae.  On  the  under  side,  the  body  of  each 
of  these  bones  is  found,  in  fact,  to  present  its  ordinary  form  ;  as 
is  also  the  vertebral  canal,  which  serves  to  lodge  the  spinal  cord ; 
but  the  upper  portion  of  the  walls  of  the  ring  which  constitute 
this  canal, — instead  of  having  its  usual  form  of  a  simple  trans- 
verse arch  of  bone  separated  by  a  void  space  from  those  above 
and  below,  and  instead  of  being  surmounted  by  a  spinous  process, 
— is  here  spread  out  sideways  as  a  disk,  and  is  continuous  without 
interruption  with  the  corresponding  plates,  belonging  to  the  ver- 
tebra which  precedes,  and  to  that  which  follows.  These  dorsal 
vertebrae,  thus  become  immovable,  have  attached  to  each  a  pair 
of  ribs,  as  in  Man  and  most  other  Vertebrata ;  but  these  ribs  (c) 
are  so  much  widened,  as  to  touch  each  other  along  the  whole,  or 
nearly  the  whole,  of  their  length,  and  are  connected  together  by 
sutures.  Finally,  the  marginal  pieces,  which  are  articulated  with 


526 


GENERAL    CHARACTERS    OF    REPTILES. 


the  extremities  of  the  ribs,  and  which  form  a  kind  of  border  to 
the  carapace,  evidently  represent  the  sternal  portions  of  these 


FIG.  305.— SKELETON  OF  LAND  TORTOISE,  WITH  THE  PLASTRON  REMOVED. 

ve,  cervical  vertebrae  ;  vd,  dorsal  vertebrae;  c,  ribs ;  cs,  sternal  ribs,  or  marginal  pieces 
of  the  carapace;  o,  scapula;  cl,  clavicle;  co,  coracoid  bone;  b,  pelvis;  /,  femur; 
t,  tibia  ;  p,  fibula. 

bones ;  which,  in  Mammalia,  remain  in  a  cartilaginous  state,  but 
which  amongst  Birds  are  completely  ossified.  In  some  Tortoises, 
even,  they  remain  cartilaginous ;  and  in  almost  all  these  animals 
several  of  them  are  supported  at  their  edges  upon  the  borders 
of  the  Plastron. 

465.  The  plastron  is  formed  by  the  sternum,  which  presents 
an  extraordinary  development,  and  is  extended  from  the  base  of 
the  neck  to  the  commencement  of  the  tail,  (Fig.  327).  The 


GENERAL    CHARACTERS    OF   REPTILES.  527 

pieces  which  enter  into  its  formation  are  nine  in  number ;  and, 
instead  of  being  placed  all  in  a  row,  the  one  after  the  other  as 
in  Mammalia,  they  are,  with  the  exception  of  a  single  one, 
ranged  in  pairs,  and  soldered  or  articulated  together,  so  as  to 
form  a  large  oval  plate.  Sometimes  this  shield  is  entire  and 
solid  through  all  its  length  ;  sometimes  it  is  divided  into  three 
parts,  of  which  the  anterior  and  the  posterior  are  slightly  mov- 
able ;  and  in  other  cases,  again,  it  is  hollowed  out  in  the  centre 
like  a  frame.  It  is  fixed  on  each  side  to  the  carapace,  either  by  a 
large  bony  prolongation,  or  by  cartilages ;  and,  in  front  as  well 
as  behind,  an  interval  is  left  between  the  two,  in  order  to  allow 
the  head,  the  members,  and  the  tail  to  pass  out.  The  carapace 
and  plastron,  as  we  have  already  said,  are  only  covered  by  the 
skin  ;  there  is  no  muscle  inserted  on  the  external  surface ;  and 
it  is  consequently  in  the  interior  of  the  trunk,  that  those  of  the 
neck  and  members  are  fixed.  The  shoulder,  instead  of  being 
supported  upon  the  external  surface  of  the  walls  of  the  thorax, 
is  lodged  in  the  interior  of  this  cavity ;  and  the  pelvis  is,  so  to 
speak,  drawn  up  within  the  abdomen. 

466.  The  bones  of  the  shoulder  (0,  cl>  co)  are  articulated  with 
the  vertebral  column,  at  one  end,  and  with  the  sternum,  at  the 
other ;  so  as  to  form  a  kind  of  ring  between  the  carapace  and 
plastron.      We  there   distinguish    three  branches,    frequently 
united  together  at  an  early  period,  and  converging  towards  the 
articular  cavity  of  the  humerus,  which  is  formed  by  their  meeting. 
One  of  these  bones  (0),  suspended  to  the  vertebral  column,  is 
evidently  the  scapula  ;  the  second  (co\  which  is  directed  back- 
wards, is  analogous  to  the  coracoid  lone  of  Birds ;  and  the  third 
(cl),  which  descends  to  unite  with  the  plastron,  is  the  represent- 
ative of  the  clavicle. — The  pelvis  bears  a  great  resemblance  to 
the  ring  formed  by  the  bones  of  the  shoulder.     It  is  composed  of 
three  pairs  of  distinct  pieces ; — an  iliac  bone,  which  is  attached 
to  the  transverse  processes  of  the  posterior  vertebrae  of  the  cara- 
pace ;  a  pulls,  and  an  ischium,  which  are  both  directed  towards 
the  plastron,  and  are  united  to  their  fellows. 

467.  In  other  Reptiles,  the  form  of  the  bones  of  the  shoulder 
bears  a  greater  resemblance  to  that  which  we  have  already  seen 


528  GENERAL    CHARACTERS    OF    REPTILES. 

in  Birds.  The  members  do  not  in  general  present  anything  very 
remarkable.  Sometimes  they  are  abruptly  terminated  at  the 
end,  and  can  only  serve  to  push  the  animal  forward,  as  in  Land 
Tortoises  for  example ;  sometimes  they  are  terminated  by  slender 
fingers,  and  furnished  with  claws,  which  allow  the  animal  to 
hook  itself  on  by  inequalities  of  the  surface,  and  to  climb  with 
facility  ;  the  feet  of  the  Lizard  are  formed  in  this  way.  In  other 
instances  there  is  at  the  extremity  of  the  fingers  a  particular 
arrangement,  which  is  singularly  favourable  to  this  kind  of  move- 
ment; thus,  among  the  Hylcs^  or  Tree-Troys  (Fig.  343),  we  see 
at  the  extremity  of  each  of  these  organs  a  kind  of  rounded  and 
adhesive  cushion,  which  allows  the  animal  to  fasten  itself  against 
the  substances  upon  which  it  climbs,  even  when  their  surfaces 
are  very  smooth  ;  and  among  the  Geckos  (Fig.  331)  the  fingers 
are  very  much  expanded  towards  the  end,  and  furnished  under- 
neath with  little  folds  of  skin,  which  appear  to  perform  the 
function  of  suckers,  and  which  permit  these  hideous  Reptiles  to 
ascend  along  the  smoothest  walls,  and  even  to  walk  in  an  inverted 
position  upon  ceilings.  There  are  also  some  Reptiles  whose 
fingers  are  opposible,  almost  as  in  the  hand  of  Man;  in  fact, 
among  Chameleons  (Fig.  330)  they  are  united  in  two  sets,  which 
spread  out  and  approach  each  other,  like  the  arms  of  a  pair  of 
pincers,  and  which  enable  these  animals  to  take  a  firm  hold  of 
the  branches  on  which  they  rest ;  Chameleons  have  also  a  pre- 
hensile tail,  which  makes  them  essentially  climbing  animals. 
Finally,  in  other  Reptiles  adapted  to  a  life  more  or  less  aquatic, 
the  fingers  are  sometimes  webbed,  as  is  seen  in  the  posterior  feet 
of  the  Frog ;  or  are  even  transformed  to  a  kind  of  flattened 
paddle,  unfit  for  walking,  but  very  favourable  for  swimming. 
The  Turtles  (Fig.  328)  are  the  only  Reptiles,  which  at  the 
present  time  possess  this  last  form  of  structure ;  but  at  more 
remote  periods  of  the  geological  history  of  the  globe,  our  seas 
were  peopled  with  large  animals  provided  with  similar  paddles, 
and  presenting  as  to  the  rest  of  the  body  great  resemblance  to 
Lizards  and  Serpents ;  some  of  these  skeletons  have  been  dis- 
covered in  the  fossil  state,  and  they  have  been  designated  by  the 
names  of  Icthyosaurus  (Fig.  337)  and  Plesiosaurus  (Fig.  338). 


GENERAL    CHARACTERS   OF    REPTILES. 


529 


468.     We  are  also  acquainted  with  Reptiles  possessing  wings. 
The  Drayons  (Fig.  306), 'animals  nearly  allied  to  Lizards,  are  of 


FIG.  306.— DRACO  VOLANS. 

this  number.  They  are  distinguished  from  all  other  animals  of 
the  same  class,  by  the  existence  of  a  broad  fold  of  skin,  situated 
along  each  flank,  and  much  resembling  the  wings  of  Bats  ;  but 
this,  instead  of  being  sustained  and  put  in  motion  by  the  anterior 
members,  is  altogether  independent  of  them,  and  is  supported  by 
the  six  first  false  ribs,  extended  horizontally  in  a  straight  line. 
The  animal  makes  use  of  them  as  a  parachute  to  sustain  itself  in 
the  air,  whilst  it  leaps  from  branch  to  branch ;  but  it  cannot 
move  them  with  sufficient  force  to  fly  like  a  Bat  or  Bird.  These 


FlO.  307- — PTBRODACTYLW8. 


singular  Reptiles,  which  inhabit  India,  realise  therefore,  up  to  a 


530  GENERAL   CHARACTERS    OF   REPTILES. 

certain  point,  the  fabulous  Flying  Lizards  and  Serpents  of  an- 
tiquity ;  but  the  Dragons  of  zoologists,  instead  of  being  formi- 
dable animals,  like  those  of  poets,  are  of  very  small  size,  and 
only  attack  insects.— At  the  epoch  in  which  lived  the  Icthyosauri 
and  Plesiosauri,  of  which  we  have  just  spoken,  there  also  existed 
a  flying  Reptile  still  more  singular  than  the  Dragon.  From  the 
structure  of  its  bony  framework,  we  see  that,  like  our  Bats,  it 
had  the  power  both  of  walking  on  the  ground  and  of  flying ;  for 
its  posterior  feet  and  all  the  fingers  of  its  anterior  feet,  one  alone 
excepted,  are  formed  in  the  ordinary  manner ;  but  the  second 
finger  of  the  anterior  members,  is  more  than  twice  the  length  of 
the  trunk,  and  probably  served  to  sustain  a  fold  of  the  skin 
adapted  to  fulfil  the  functions  of  wings.  In  order  to  designate 
this  singular  conformation,  the  generic  name  of  Pterodactylus  (or 
finger- winged)  has  been  given  to  these  Saurian  fossils. 

469.  The  movements  of  Reptiles  are  generally  less  lively  and 
prolonged,  than  those  of  Mammalia  and  Birds ;  as,  indeed,  might 
have  been  anticipated  from   the  more  limited  extent  of  their 
respiration  ;  for  there  always  exists,  as  we  have  already  seen,  an 
intimate  relation  between  the  energy  of  the  two  functions.  Their 
muscles  receive  less  blood,  and  present  a  pale  hue.     But  it  is 
likewise  to  be  remarked,  that  these  organs  preserve  their  irrita- 
bility for  a  longer  time,   after  they  have  been  removed  from  the 
influence  of  the  nervous  system.    Among  warm-blooded  animals, 
the  destruction  of  the  brain  and  spinal  cord,  or  the  section  of  a 
nerve,  immediately  causes  a  complete  paralysis,  either  general  or 
local ;  and  in  a  short  time  after  this  has  taken  place,  it  becomes 
impossible  to  excite  muscular  contractions,  by  pricking  or  other- 
wise stimulating  the  affected  parts.     Among  Reptiles,  on  the 
contrary,  the  power  of  executing  movements  under  the  influence 
of  these  stimulants,  is  preserved,  in  similar  circumstances,  for  a 
long  time ;  thus  the  tail  of  the  Lizard,  detached  from  the  body, 
continues  to  move  for  several  hours  ;    and  it  often  happens,  that 
the  limbs  of  a  Tortoise  which  has  been  dead  for  several  days  are 
seen  to  move  convulsively,  when  the  muscles  are  stimulated  by 
being  pricked. 

470.  The  brain  of  Reptiles  is  very  little  developed  ;  the  sur- 


GENERAL   CHARACTERS   OF   REPTILES.  531 

face  of  the  cerebrum  is  smooth,  and  without  convolutions  (Fig. 
308).     The  two  hemispheres  (a)  are  oval,  more  or  less 
a  elongated,  and  hollowed  out  in  the  interior  into  a  ven- 
tricle,  as  in  Birds ;    there  is  no  corpus  striatum ;    and 
at  their  anterior  part  there  are  often  observed  olfactory- 
lobes  of  moderate  size,  situated  at  the  origin  of  the  first 
pair  of  nerves.     The  optic  lobes   (b)  are  generally  of 
moderate  size ;  and  are  placed  behind  the  hemispheres 
on  the  same  level.     The  Cerebellum  (c)  is,  on  the  con- 
trary, very  small ;  and  (as  in  other  oviparous  Vertebrata)  it  does 
not  send  beneath  the  Medulla  Oblongata,  that  transverse  pro- 
longation or  commissure,  which  aids  in  forming  that  ring  around 
it,  which  is   possessed  by  Mammalia.      The  Spinal   Cord  (e?), 
compared  with  the  brain,  is  very  much  developed ;  and  it  may 
also  be  remarked,  that  the  nerves  are  larger  in  proportion  to  the 
size  of  the  central  parts  of  the  nervous  system,  than  in  the  higher 
animals. 

471.  Most  Reptiles  have  no  special  organ  of  touch;  and  in 
general  this  sense  cannot  be  very  much  developed,  on  account 
of  the  nature  of  their  integuments.      Some  have,  it  is  true,  the 
skin  completely  naked,  and  the  epidermis  scarcely  distinct ;  but, 
in  the  greater  number,  it  is  covered  by  a  thick  epidermic  layer 
formed  of  plates  more  or  less  dense,  consisting  of  horny  or  even 
bony  matter.   The  substance  known  under  the  name  of  Tortoise- 
shell,  and  employed  for  such  various  uses,  consists  of  the  horny 
plates  which  cover  the  carapace  of  a  particular  species  of  Turtle 
(Fig.  328).     Among  Reptiles  with  a  naked  skin,  the  epider- 
mis, being  of  slight  consistency,  is  detached  and  renovated  very 
often ;  and,  among  the  animals  of  that  class,  in  which  it  possesses 
more  consistency,  it  is  also  detached  at  different  periods  of  the 
year,  to  make    room  for  a  new  epidermis.       Sometimes  this 
species  of  moulting  is  partial,  or,  at  least,  the  epidermis  only  falls 
off  by  shreds ;    but  in  other  instances  it  is  detached  entire,  and 
preserves  the  form  of  the   animal  by  which  it  is  thrown  off. 
Serpents  thus  cast  their  skins  several  times  a  year. 

472.  The  eyes  of  Reptiles  do  not  present  anything  very  re- 
markable ;  their  position  is,  in  general,  almost  the  same  as  in 


532  GENERAL   CHARACTERS   OP    REPTILES. 

Birds  ;  but  we  only  rarely  find  a  prolongation  having  an  analogy 
with  the  marsupium  (§.  340).  The  eyelids  are  generally  to  the 
number  of  three,  but  are  sometimes  entirely  wanting;  in 
Serpents,  for  example,  the  skin  is  continuous  without  inter- 
ruption in  front  of  the  eyes ;  and  only  presents  in  this  point 
sufficient  transparency,  not  to  oppose  any  obstacle  to  the  passage 
of  light, — an  arrangement  which  gives  to  these  animals  a  re- 
markable fixity  of  look. — The  auditory  apparatus  is  much  less 
complete  than  in  Mammalia,  or  even  than  in  Birds.  The  external 
ear  is  almost  always  entirely  wanting ;  and  the  tympanum  is  at 
the  surface  of  the  head,  either  uncovered,  or  concealed  beneath 
the  skin  ;  sometimes  there  does  not  exist  even  a  trace  of  it.  The 
cavity  of  the  tympanum  is  usually  but  very  imperfectly  closed 
in  by  the  bones  of  the  cranium,  and  communicates  by  a  large  slit 
with  the  pharynx,  of  which  it  sometimes  seems  to  be  only  an 
appendage  ;  the  small  bones  of  the  ear  are  generally  wanting  ; 
and  the  cochlea  is  often  rudimentary. — The  nasal  fossae  are  but 
little  developed ;  and  the  sense  of  taste  seems  to  be  very  obtuse 
in  all  these  animals.  The  tongue  is  sometimes  thickened  and 
fleshy ;  but  in  general  it  is  thin,  dry,  very  protractile,  and  cleft 
towards  the  end;  Serpents  and  Lizards  (Fig.  309)  afford  us 
examples  of  this.  The  tongue  of  Frogs 
presents  a  singular  peculiarity ;  it  is  fleshy, 
an(j  gxe(j  to  the  jaw  by  -tg  anterior  ex- 

Fio.309.  tremity,  whilst  its  tip,  usually  directed 

backwards,  is  free  and  can  be  turned  forwards.  Lastly,  in  the 
Chameleon,  this  organ  becomes  a  very  remarkable  instrument 
of  prehension  ;  for  the  animal  can  dart  it  out  to  a  distance  which 
exceeds  the  length  of  its  body  ;  and  it  is  terminated  by  a  kind 
of  adhesive  cushion,  to  which  the  flies  and  other  insects,  on 
which  this  slow  and  awkwardly-moving  reptile  feeds,  are  easily 
attached. 

473.  There  are  few  Reptiles  which  live  on  vegetable  matter 
alone.  Almost  all  are  carnivorous,  and,  with  some  exceptions, 
only  seek  a  living  prey,  which  they  swallow  generally  without 
dividing  it ;  hence  the  choice  of  the  animals  on  which  they  are 
nourished  is  regulated,  so  to  speak,  by  the  size  of  their  mouth. 


GENERAL    CHARACTERS   OP    REPTILES.  533 

It  is  always  widely  dilated ;  but  it  is  among  Serpents,  that  it  is 
susceptible  of  being  extended  in  the  most  remarkable  manner  ; 
hence,  these  Reptiles  can  swallow  animals  larger  than  themselves. 
The  two  branches  of  the  lower  jaw  are  not  united  ;  and  the  sort 
of  peduncle  or  stalk  which  supports  them  (the  tympanic  bone,  t, 

Fig.  310,)  is  not  only  movable 
itself,  but  is  also  suspended  to 
another  portion  of  the  tem- 
~t  poral  bone,  called  the  mastoid 
bone  (ma),  which  is  likewise 
distinct  from  the  cranium  (c), 
and  is  attached  to  it  only  by 
ligaments  and  muscles.  The 

p    pi  mi 

FIR.  3io_SKULL  OF  RATTLK-SNAKE.      branches  of  the  upper  jaw  (m), 

c,  cranium  ;  ma,  mastoid  bone  ;t,  tympanic    are     Only     fixed    to     the     inter- 

Sr/SJjTSSriS^  ***&*  bone  by  ligaments, 
1)01168  which  permit  them  to  be  more 

or  less  separated ;  and  the  palatine  arches  (p)  also  participate 
in  this  mobility.  This  peculiarity  of  structure  corresponds 
with  the  habits  of  these  essentially  carnivorous  Reptiles. 
They  can  support  abstinence  for  a  long  time ;  but  generally, 
when  an  occasion  presents  itself,  they  take  into  their  stomach 
such  a  great  mass  of  nutriment,  that,  during  their  digestion 
of  it,  they  remain  in  a  state  of  torpidity  more  or  less  pro- 
found. They  do  not  masticate  their  food,  but  their  mouth 
is  armed  with  hooked  teeth,  adapted  to  retain  their  prey 
within  it. 

474.  Several  Serpents,  such  as  the  Viper,  the  Asp,  (Fig.  340), 
the  Crotalus  or  Rattle  Snake  (Fig.  341),  and  the  Trigonocepha- 
lus,  present  still  more  remarkable  peculiarities  of  structure  ;  for 
nature  has  endowed  them  with  a  venomous  apparatus,  by  the 
aid  of  which  they  can  immediately  kill,  as  soon  as  they  bite 
them,  the  animals  upon  which  they  intend  to  feed.  Their  poison 
is  secreted  by  glands,  which  greatly  resemble  the  salivary ;  and 
which  pour  this  liquid  out  by  an  excretory  duct,  in  the  neigh^ 
bourhood  of  one  of  the  maxillary  teeth  of  the  upper  jaw,  whose 
form  is  modified,  in  order  to  adapt  it  to  the  uses  for  which  it  is 


534  GENERAL    CHARACTERS   OF   REPTILES. 

destined.      These  glands  (v,  Fig.  311)  are  placed  under  the 
temporal  muscles,   so   as  to  be    compressed   by  their  contrac- 
tion ;  and  this  tooth,  which  is 
larger  than  the  others,  is  some- 
times pierced  by  a  canal,  and 
sometimes  only  channelled  by 
a  furrow ;  but  in  both  cases, 
the  canal  which  it  presents  is 
in    communication   with    the 
s  excretory  duct  of  the  poison- 

FIG,  3ii.— POISON  APPARATUS  OF  RATTLB-     gland,  and  serves  to  convey  the 

SNAKE.  . 

.,  poison  gland,  whose  duct  terminates  in  Ve*°m    to   the  ^  bottom    of  the 

the  large  movable  tooth,  c ;  m,  muscles  WOUnd  which  is  made  by  the 
which  elevate  the  lower  jaw,  and  serve  also  ,  .  lf  ,_,,  . 

to  compress  the  gland ;  *,  salivary  glands  ;  tooth  itself.     IhlS  Venom  IS  One 

n,  nostrils.  Of  the  most  violent  of  poisons. 

It  is  neither  acrid  nor  burning ;  it  only  produces  on  the  tongue 
a  sensation  analogous  to  that  occasioned  by  a  fatty  matter,  and 
may  be  swallowed  with  impunity ;  but,  introduced  in  sufficient 
quantity  into  a  wound,  it  produces  death  with  frightful  rapidity. 
Its  power  varies  with  the  species,  and  according  to  the  circum- 
stances in  which  the  Serpent  is  found.  The  same  species  appears 
to  be  more  dangerous  in  warm,  than  in  cold  or  temperate  coun- 
tries ;  and  the  results  produced  by  its  bite  are  much  more  severe, 
in  proportion  as  the  poison  flows  more  abundantly  into  the 
wound.  Further,  these  animals  are  much  more  formidable, 
when  they  have  fasted  some  time,  and  when  their  venom  is 
collected  in  a  considerable  quantity  in  the  glands  in  which  it  is 
secreted  ;  than  when  they  have  bitten  several  times,  and  there 
can  only  remain  a  small  quantity  of  this  liquid.  It  has  also 
been  remarked,  that  their  bite  does  not  act  in  the  same  manner 
upon  all  animals.  It  appears  that  to  Leeches,  Slugs,  the  Asp, 
the  Common  Snake,  the  Slow-worm,  &c.,  the  venom  of  the 
Viper  is  not  a  poison  ;  whilst  it  produces  death  with  great  rapi- 
dity in  all  warm-blooded  animals,  Lizards,  and  the  Viper  itself. 
In  general  the  quantity  of  venom  necessary  to  produce  death  is, 
other  things  being  equal,  in  proportion  to  the  size  of  the  animal 
wounded ;  thus  whilst  a  hundredth  of  a  grain  of  the  venom  of 


GENERAL   CHARACTERS    OP    REPTILES.  535 

the  Viper  is  sufficient  to  kill  a  Sparrow,  six  times  as  much  would 
be  required  to  destroy  a  pigeon. 

475.  Before  this  poison  can  act  upon  the  animal  body,  it  must 
be  absorbed  and  carried  into  the  current  of  the  circulation  ;  hence, 
when  a  bite  has  been  received  from  a  venomous  reptile,  the  most 
proper  means  to  retard  this  absorption  should  be  at  once  em- 
ployed, in  order  to  have  time  to  draw  out,  or  to  destroy,  the 
venom  deposited  in  the  bottom  of  the  bite.      Compression  exer- 
cised upon  the  veins  above  the  bitten  part,  and  the  application 
of  a  cupping-glass  upon  the  wound  itself,   are  the  most  proper 
means  to  retard  the  absorption  of  the  poison  ;    but  in  order  to 
deliver  the  sufferer  completely  from  the  danger  which  menaces 
him,  it  is  necessary  in  general  to  enlarge  the  wound,  and  to 
cauterise  the  bottom  of  it,  either  with  a  red- hot  iron,  or  with 
powerful  caustics.       Some   internal    remedies  have   also   been 
praised,  such   as  ammonia,  arsenic,  &c. ;  but  on  these  means, 
even  if  they  are  sometimes  useful,  no  great  dependence  should 
be  placed.      The  South  American  Indians  attribute  still  greater 
virtues  to   a  plant  of  their   country,   known  by  the  name  of 
Guaco,  or  Micania  guaco ;  they  assert  that  not  only  does  the 
application  of  the  leaves  of  the  guaco  upon  the  bite  of  the  most 
dangerous  Serpents,  prevent  all  deleterious  effect,  but  that  the 
inoculation  of  the  juice   of  this   plant   prevents  these  animals 
from  biting   the  person  thus   prepared.      The   celebrated  and 
learned  traveller,  M.  de  Humboldt,  thinks,  after  some  experi- 
ments, that  the  guaco  may  give  to  the  skin  an  odour  which  is 
repugnant  to  the  Serpent,  and  which  hinders  it  from  biting.    The 
symptoms   which  accompany  the   action   of  the   poison  differ 
according  to  the  species  and  circumstances.      Generally,    the 
circulation  is  extremely  enfeebled,  the  blood  loses  the  power  of 
coagulating,  and  the  parts  surrounding  the  wound  become  gan- 
grenous. 

476.  The  arrangement  of  the  poison-apparatus  varies  amongst 
these  Reptiles.     Sometimes  the  tooth  which  is  placed  at  the  end 
of  the  canal  that  excretes  the  poison,  is  a  movable  hook  ;  some- 
times  an  immovable    tooth,  simply   furrowed. — Serpents  with 
movable  poison  fangs,  are  the  most  dangerous.      These  fangs 


536  GENERAL   CHARACTERS   OF    REPTILES. 

(Fig.  311,  c)  situated  in  the  front  of  the  mouth,  are  separate  from 
the  rest,  very  sharp  and  pierced  by  a  small  canal,  which  termi- 
nates near  their  extremity;  they  are  fixed  upon  very  small 
maxillary  bones  (Fig.  310),  and  these  bones,  supported  upon  a 
long  pedicle,  are  very  movable ;  so  that  when  the  animal  does 
not  intend  to  use  these  poison-fangs,  it  turns  them  backwards, 
and  conceals  them  in  a  fold  of  its  gum,  from  which  it  can  erect 
them  at  any  moment.  One  of  these  long  teeth  is  seen  on  each 
side;  and  there  are,  behind  each  of  them,  several  germs,  destined 
to  replace  it,  if  it  should  break  in  the  act  of  biting ;  but  the 
maxillary  bones  do  not  bear  any  other  teeth  ;  and  there  are  only 
seen  in  the  roof  of  the  mouth,  two  rows  of  palatine  teeth,  instead 
of  four  ranges,  as  in  the  common  Snakes.  These  last  animals, 
like  several  other  Reptiles  have  the  palate  furnished  with  teeth, 
as  well  as  the  jaws. — Some  Reptiles  are,  on  the  contrary,  com- 
pletely destitute  of  teeth  (Frogs,  for  example) ;  and  among 
Tortoises,  which  are  likewise  destitute  of  these  organs,  the  jaws 
are  covered  with  a  horny  plate,  like  the  beak  of  Birds,  having 
cutting  edges ;  but  there  are  never  fleshy  and  moveable  lips  as 
in  Mammalia. 

477.  As  the  aliment  does  not  require  to  remain  in  the  mouth, 
in  order  to  be  ground  down  there,  the  veil  of  the  palate  would 
have  been  in  general  useless ;  and  in  fact,  it  very  seldom  exists. 
In  the  greater  number  of  these  animals,  the  pharynx  is  not  dis- 
tinct from  the  mouth,  and  frequently  there  is  not  even  any  well- 
drawn   line   of    separation   between   the    oesophagus   and   the 
stomach,  which  is  simple  and  of  varied  form.    The  intestines  are 
short  and  deprived  of  the  coecal  appendage  ;  the  large  intestine 
differs  little  from  the  small  intestine,  and  terminates  in  a  cloaca? 
into  which  open  also  the  urinary  canals  and  organs  of  reproduc- 
tion.— Reptiles  have,  like  the  higher  animals,  lymphatic  vessels, 
destined  to  absorb  the  products  of  digestion,  and  to  pour  them 
into  the  current  of  the  circulation. 

478.  Their  blood  is  not  rich  in  solid  matter;  and  the  oval 
corpuscles,  which  swim  about  in  it,  are  of  a  greater  size  than  in 
any  other  class.     The  arrangement   of  the  circulating  system 
varies  ;  but  there  is  always  a  direct  communication  between  the 


GENERAL    CHARACTERS   OF    REPTILES.  537 

system  conveying  arterial  blood,  and  that  conveying  venous  blood ; 
so  that  these  two  liquids  mingle,  and  the  body  only  receives 
blood  which  has  been  imperfectly  arterialised  by  the  act  of  respi- 
ration. The  heart  is  almost  always  composed  of  two  auricles 
(Fig.  312),  opening  into  a  single  ventricle.  It  follows  from  this 


Pulmonary  artery  ^.^^fe^^^^  Pulmonary  artery. 
"8  ""VfejJx^dl^     1  .-^.Pulmonary  vein. 

Pulmonary  vein  a 

Right  auricle Y^M^^-  Left  auricle. 

Venacava -^*F*Xr          '"  Single  ventricle. 

Left  aortic  trunk 


Right  aorta 

• 

Abdominal  aorta. 

FIG.  312.— HEART  OF  TORTOISE. 

that  the  arterial  blood  coming  from  the  lungs,  received  into  the 
left  auricle,  and  the  venous  blood  flowing  from  the  different  parts 
of  the  body  into  the  right  auricle,  are  mixed  in  this  common 
ventricle.  One  portion  of  this  mixture  returns  by  the  aorta  to 
the  different  organs,  which  it  is  destined  to  nourish  ;  whilst  the 
other  part  is  carried  to  the  lungs  by  vessels  which  arise  directly 
from  the  common  ventricle,  or  even  from  the  aorta.  In  Croco- 
diles, however,  the  heart  is  formed  (Fig.  313)  almost  in  the  same 
manner  as  in  Birds  and  Mammalia,  and  presents  a  partition 
which  separates  the  right  from  the  left  ventricle  ;  it  follows, 
therefore,  that  this  organ  presents  two  distinct  ventricles  and 
two  auricles,  and  that  the  arterial  blood  is  not  mixed  there  with 
the  venous  blood ;  but  a  particular  arrangement  of  the  arteries 
effects  this  mixture  at  some  distance  from  the  heart,  and  the 
vessels  of  all  the  posterior  half  of  the  body  only  receive  im- 
perfectly-arterialised  blood.  In  fact,  the  venous  blood  received 
into  the  right  ventricle  does  not  go  entirely  to  the  lungs,  as  in 
warm-blooded  Vertebrata ;  for,  at  the  side  of  the  opening  of  the 
pulmonary  arteries  (op),  is  found  another  vessel  (a)  which  like- 
wise arises  from  the  right  ventricle,  and  which,  after  bending  back 


5,38 


GENERAL   CHARACTERS    OF    REPTILES. 


ap 

vp 


od 


behind  the  heart,  goes  to  empty  itself  into  the  descending  aorta  (ao). 
It  follows  from  this,  that  at  each  contrac- 
tion of  the  heart,  one  portion  of  the 
venous  hlood  is  carried  to  the  lungs,  and 
another  portion  goes  to  be  mixed  with 
arterial  blood  ;  but  this  mixture  is  not 
carried  on  in  the  first  part  of  the  interior 
of  the  aorta,  but  below  the  origin  of  the 
branches  (c  c)  which  this  vessel  sends  to 
the  head  and  anterior  part  of  the  body, 
so  that  these  parts  receive  pure  arterial 
blood ;  whilst  all  those  parts,  whose 
arteries  arise  below  the  point  of  junc- 
tion of  the  aorta,  with  the  vessel  arising 
from  the  right  ventricle,  only  receive 

a  mixture   of  red   and   dark  blood 

It  was  believed  until  recently,  that 
among  other  animals  of  this  class  (the 
Batrachians,  or  Frog  tribe),  there  only 
existed  a  single  auricle;  but  this  has 
been  shown  to  be  otherwise.  With 
respect  to  the  mode  of  distribution  of 
the  arteries  among  Reptiles,  we  shall 
only  add,  that  there  exist  two  or  more 

aortic  arches  curving  to  the  right  and  to  the  left,  and  shortly 
uniting  to  constitute  one  trunk  (Fig.  314). 

479.  The  respiration  of  Reptiles  is  not  active  ;  the  greater 
number  of  these  animals  consume  but  little  oxygen,  and  can  be 
deprived  of  it  for  a  long  time  without  being  suffocated.  More- 
over, temperature  has  very  great  influence  upon  this  phenomenon; 
and  in  warm  weather,  the  necessity  of  respiration  is  felt  much 
more  than  in  winter.  A  Frog,  for  example,  which  has  been 
deprived  of  air,  perishes  in  summer  in  less  than  two  hours,  whilst 
in  winter  it  may  continue  to  live  for  several  days.  In  some 
Reptiles,  as  we  shall  shortly  see,  gills  exist  in  the  early  period 
of  life ;  but  the  lungs  are  soon  developed,  and  the  gills  usually 
then  wither  and  disappear  ;  so  that  the  same  animal  h  as  at  first 


FIG.  313  —HEART  AND  LARGE 
VESSELS  OF  CROCODILE. 

vv,  systemic  veins,  termi- 
nating in  the  right  auricle, 
odf  vt,  the  two  ventricles, 
separated  by  an  internal  par- 
tition ;  ap,  the  two  pulmo- 
nary arteries,  conveying  blood 
from  the  right  ventricle  to 
the  lungs  ;  a,  trunk  from  the 
same  ventricle,  going  to  join 
the  descending  aorta ;  vp, 
pulmonary  veins,  emptying 
into  left  auricle,  og;  ao,  aorta, 
arising  from  left  ventricle  ; 
c,  c,  vessels  proceeding  to 
the  head. 


GENERAL   CHARACTERS   OP    REPTILES.  539 

an  aquatic,  afterwards  an   aerial  respiration.     There  are  even 


Arches  of  A< 


Super,  vena  cava 


/arotid  artery 


y  xArches  of  aorta 

,.<•'*  ^Right  auricle 


Ventricle 

„ •*•"" -Pulmonary  vein 

, Brachial  artery 

Pulmonary  artery 


Pulmonary  artery- — f^ 
Inferior  vena  cava 


Venaporta? 

—Intestines 


FIG.  314. — CIRCULATING  APPARATUS  OF  LIZARD. 


some  which  retain  their  organs   during  the  whole  of  life,  and 
which,  having  at  the  same  time  lungs,  are  completely  amphibious ; 


N  N  2 


540 


GENERAL    CHARACTERS    OF    REPTILES. 


the  Proteus,  Siren,   and  Axolotl  (Fig.  345)  are  of  this  number; 
but  most  Reptiles  have  only  lungs.     It  does  not  follow  from 


FIG.  315  — ANATOMY  OF  COLUBER. 

I,  tongue  and  glottis  ;  <z,  aesophagus,  divided  at  ce'  to  show  the  heart,  &c.  ;  i,  stomach  ; 
i',  intestine  ;  cl,  cloaca ;  an,  anus  ;  f,  liver ;  o,  ovary ;  6,  eggs  ;  t,  trachea  ;  p,  principal 
lung  ;  p',  undeveloped  lung ;  vt,  ventricle ;  c,  left  auricle  ;  c',  right  auricle  ;  ag,  left 
aortic  arch  ;  ad,  right  aortic  arch  ;  d.  d,  ventral  aorta ;  ac,  carotid  arteries ;  v,  vena 
cava  superior ;  vc,  vena  cava  inferior ;  vp,  pulmonary  vein. 

this,  however,  that  their  respiration  is  always  exclusively  aerial ; 
for  in  several  of  these  animals,  the  skin  is  also  an  organ  of  respi- 
ration, and  can  act  upon  the  air  contained  in  the  water,  as  well 


GENERAL   CHARACTERS   OF   REPTILES.  541 

as  upon  the  oxygen  in  a  gaseous  state.  In  some  Reptiles,  the 
cutaneous  respiration  is  even  so  active,  that  in  certain  circum- 
stances it  is  sufficient  for  the  maintenance  of  life.  The  lungs 
are  organised  in  a  manner  which  is  not  favourable  to  a  great 
activity  of  their  functions  ;  for  their  air-cells  are  very  large,  and 
consequently  the  vascular  surface  destined  to  receive  the  contact 
of  the  air  is  of  small  extent  (ANIM.  PHYSIOL.,  §  312).  They 
are  not  lodged  in  a  distinct  cavity ;  the  thorax  not  being  separated 
from  the  abdomen  by  a  diaphragm  ;  and  the  air  is  renewed  in 
their  interior  with  less  facility  and  regularity  than  in  the  higher 
animals.  Sometimes  even,  as  in  Frogs,  and  Tortoises,  the 
absence  of  the  ribs,  or  the  immobility  of  these  bones,  renders 
the  ordinary  respiratory  movements  impossible ;  and  then  it  is 
by  an  act  of  deglutition,  that  the  air  is  forced  into  the  lungs. 
It  is  likewise  to  be  noticed,  that  Serpents  possess,  in  the  arrange- 
ment of  the  respiratory  apparatus,  a  remarkable  anomaly ;  one 
of  their  lungs  being  so  little  developed,  that  we  can  often  scarcely 
perceive  it ;  whilst  the  other  acquires  very  considerable  dimen- 
sions (Fig.  315). 

480.  Reptiles  are  all  cold-blooded  animals ;  that  is  to  say, 
they  do  not  produce  enough  heat,  to  have  a  temperature  sensibly 
higher  than  that  of  the  surrounding  air.  The  whole  of  their 
body  is  heated  or  cooled  at  the  same  time  as  the  surrounding 
medium;  and  the  changes  of  temperature  which  they  thus 
experience,  have  great  influence  upon  all  their  functions.  A 
warmth  of  from  105°  to  120°  is  soon  fatal  to  most  of  these 
animals;  and  cold  tends  to  depress  all  their  vital  operations. 
In  winter,  most  of  them  could  no  longer  digest  the  food  intro- 
duced into  their  stomach,  and  do  not  take  nourishment.  Their 
respiration  also  diminishes  in  a  most  remarkable  manner.  Thus 
during  the  cold  season,  the  action  of  the  air  on  the  skin  is  suffi- 
cient for  the  maintenance  of  the  life  of  a  Frog  ;  and  the  lungs  of 
one  of  these  animals  may  be  removed  without  producing  asphyxia; 
whilst  in  summer  they  have  need  not  only  of  the  pulmonary 
respiration,  but  also  of  their  cutaneous ;  and  death  soon  occurs 
when  the  air  does  not  act  on  the  skin,  or  is  excluded  from  the 
lungs.  Limitation  of  the  supply  of  air  often  produces  in  these 


542 


GENERAL    CHARACTERS    OP    REPTILES. 


animals  a  lethargic  dulness,  analogous  to  that  of  hybernating 
animals. 

481.  Like  Birds,  Reptiles  are  destitute  of  mammae  for  the 
suckling  of  their  young,  and  are  reproduced  by  eggs ;  but  these 
eggs  are  sometimes  hatched  before  they  come  out  of  the  body 
(in  the  Viper,  for  example)  ;  and  the  name  of  ovo-viviparous 
is  given  to  the  animals  in  which  this  phenomenon  is  observed. 
The  mode  of  development  of  most  Reptiles  presents  nothing 
irregular;  but  Frogs,  Toads,  Salamanders,  and  other  species 
known  to  zoologists  under  the  general  term  of  Batrachians^  are 
not  born  in  the  form  which  they  ultimately  preserve,  and 
undergo  in  the  early  state  some  remarkable  metamorphoses. 
They  at  first  resemble  Fishes  in  their  external  form,  as  well  as 
in  their  internal  structure ;  and  it  is  by  degrees,  that  they 
acquire  the  characters  peculiar  to  the  class  of  Reptiles.  Whilst 


FIG.  316. 


FIG.  320.  FJG.  321. 

FIGS.  316— 321.— METAMORPHOSKS  OF  BATRACHIA. 

they  are  in  this  transitory  state,  the  name  of  tadpoles  is  given 
to  them,  and  the  metamorphoses  which  they  undergo  are  greater 


GENERAL   CHARACTERS   OP    REPTILES.  543 

or  less,  according  to  the  species.  Frogs,  Toads,  and  other 
species  formed  almost  on  the  same  plan,  are,  of  all  the  Batra- 
chians,  those  whose  metamorphoses  are  the  most  complete.  At  the 
time  when  the  young  tadpole  of  the  Frog  comes  from  the  egg, 
it  is  very  like  a  little  fish,  and  can  only  live  in  water.  Its 
head  is  very  large,  its  abdomen  protuberant,  and  its  body, 
deprived  of  members,  is  terminated  by  a  long  and  compressed 
tail ;  its  mouth  is  as  yet  but  a  small  aperture,  hardly  percep- 
tible; and  its  gills  only  consist  of  a  tubercle  placed  at  each  side 
of  the  posterior  part  of  the  head.  These  appendages  are  soon 
elongated  and  divided  into  laminae ;  the  eyes  are  distinguishable 
through  the  skin,  and  a  transverse  slit  is  seen  under  the  neck, 
so  as  to  form  there  a  kind  of  membranous  operculum,  analogous 
to  the  gill-covers  of  Fishes.  By  degrees,  the  gills  (Fig.  316) 
ramify  ;  and  the  lips  are  covered  with  a  kind  of  horny  beak  ; 
by  the  aid  of  which  the  animal  fixes  itself  to  the  vegetables,  on 
which  it  is  chiefly  nourished.  This  state,  however,  only  endures 
for  a  short  time.  At  the  end  of  some  days,  the  gill-fringes, 
which  float  on  each  side  of  the  neck,  disappear  (Fig.  317) ;  and 
respiration  is  performed  by  the  aid  of  small  vascular  tufts,  fixed 
along  four  cartilaginous  arches,  situated  under  the  throat,  and 
fastened  to  the  hyoid  bone.  A  membranous  tunic,  covered  by 
the  skin,  envelops  these  internal  gills ;  to  which  the  water  comes 
through  the  mouth,  by  passing  through  the  intervals  of  the 
arches  of  the  hyoid ;  after  having  bathed  these  organs,  the 
liquid  escapes  by  one  or  two  external  slits,  whose  position  varies 
a  little  according  to  the  species.  The  respiratory  apparatus 
then  presents,  as  we  see  (ANIM.  PHYSIOL.  §  317)5  a  most  exact 
resemblance  to  that  of  Fishes.  A  little  time  afterwards,  the 
posterior  feet  of  the  tadpole  present  themselves,  and  are  deve- 
loped little  by  little  (Fig.  318)  ;  and  they  attain  considerable 
length,  before  the  anterior  feet  can  be  seen. — These  last  are 
developed  beneath  the  skin,  which  they  pierce  more  slowly 
(Fig.  319).  About  the  same  time,  the  horny  beak  falls  off,  and 
leaves  the  jaws  bare;  the  tail  begins  to  be  atrophied  (Fig.  320); 
the  lungs  are  developed;  and  in  proportion  as  these  organs 
become  more  exclusively  the  seat  of  respiration,  the  gills  shrivel 


544  GENERAL   CHARACTERS    OF   REPTILES. 

up  and  disappear, — the  cartilaginous  arches  which  supported 
them  being  also  in  part  absorbed :  finally  the  tail  entirely  dis- 
appears, the  little  animal  takes  the  form  which  it  must  ulti- 
mately preserve  (Fig.  321),  and  completely  changes  its  regimen. 
Herbivorous  at  first,  it  becomes  by  degrees  exclusively  carnivo- 
rous; and  whilst  these  metamorphoses  are  taking  place,  its 
intestinal  canal,  at  first  long  and  twisted  in  a  spiral  form, 
becomes  short,  almost  straight,  and  enlarged  in  parts  correspond- 
ing with  the  stomach  and  colon. 

482.  The  apparatus  of  circulation  undergoes  changes  cor- 
responding to  those,  which  the  organs  of  respiration  experience. 
The  heart  of  the  adult  Batrachian  is  composed,  like  that  of  most 

1      t   o    t         o  ab 


6r3  ; 

3      a      fip  (tv  c   ab  2 

FIG.  322 — BLOOD-VBSSELS  OF  THE  TADPOLB  IN  ITS  FIRST  STATE. 

a,  artery  originating  from  the  single  ventricle,  and  dividing  into  six  branchial  arteries, 
ab  ;  brl,  br2,  br3,  the  three  pairs  of  gills,  from  which  return  the  branchial  veins  vb. 
The  second  and  third  branchial  veins  on  each  side  form  a  trunk,  c,  which  unites  with 
the  opposite  one  to  form  the  great  dorsal  artery,  av  ;  the  first  pair  of  branchial  veins 
send  off  the  trunks,  t,  t,  to  the  head — 1,  2, 3,  communicating  branches,  connecting  the 
branchial  arteries  with  the  branchial  veins,  in  this  stage  very  small ;  ap,  pulmonary 
arteries,  as  yet  but  little  developed. 

Reptiles,  of  two  auricles  and  a  single  ventricle ;  whence  arises 
a  large  artery,  which  swells  at  its  base  into  a  contractile  bulb, 
and  which  is  sometimes  bifurcated  to  form  the  two  arches  of  the 
aorta.  But  when  the  young  animal  respires  by  the  gills  only, 
the  blood  forced  out  of  the  ventricle  is  distributed  to  these  organs  ; 
and  thence  the  greater  part  is  returned  into  a  dorsal  artery, 
whose  branches  convey  it  to  the  rest  of  the  body  (Fig.  322). 


GENERAL    CHARACTERS    OP    REPTILES.  545 

We  have  elsewhere  seen  (ANIM.  PHYSIOL.  §  289),  that  among 


brl 


Pio.  323. — The  same,  in  a  more  advanced  state ;  the  communicating  branches  are 
now  enlarged,  so  that  much  of  the  hlood  transmitted  to  the  branchial  arteries  finds  its 
way  at  once  into  the  branchial  veins,  without  passing  through  the  gills ;  the  pulmonary 
arteries,  ap,  are  also  much  increased  in  size. 

Fishes,  the  blood  follows  the  same  course ;  but  when  the  lungg 
0  are  developed,  the  arrange- 

ment of  the  vascular  appa- 
ratus changes;  there  is  esta- 
blished a  direct  communi- 
cation between  the  arteries 
which  carry  the  blood  to 
the  gills,  and  those  which 
return  it  from  these  organs ; 
so  that  the  nutritious  fluid 
is  no  longer  compelled  to 
traverse  this  apparatus  of 
aquatic  respiration,  in  order 
to  arrive  at  the  dorsal  artery, 


6K1 


ap 


FIG.  324.— The  same,  in  the  perfect  animal ; 
the  gills  have  now  disappeared,  and  the  course 
of  the  blood  is  entirely  through  the  communi- 
cating branches ;  that  of  the  first  pair  conveys 
it  direct  to  the  trunks,  t,  t,  supplying  the  head ; 
and  those(of  the  second  and  third  to  the  aorta, 
av.  The  respiratory  circulation  is  now  entirely  and  which  might  be  at  first 

compared   to     a    branchial 
artery,  then  becomes  the  origin  of  the  dorsal  trunk,  and  forms 


and  thence  into  the  different 
parts  of  the  body  (Fig. 
323).  The  artery  (a)  which 
arises  from  the  ventricle, 


546  GENERAL    CHARACTERS  OF    REPTILES. 

with  it  a  true  aorta  ;  of  which  certain  branches,  that  are  sent 
to  the  lungs,  are  developed  at  the  same  time,  and  establish  the 
pulmonary  circulation.  Finally,  the  branchial  vessels  are  oblite- 
rated, and  then  the  circulation  becomes  almost  the  same  as  in 
other  Reptiles  (Fig.  324).  The  venous  blood  returning  from 
every  part  of  the  body,  is  poured  into  the  ventricle  by  one  of 
the  auricles,  and  is  there  mixed  with  the  arterial  blood  coming 
from  the  lungs,  and  forced  into  the  same  ventricle  by  the 
other  auricle.  This  mixture  then  passes  into  the  aorta ;  a 
small  part  of  it  being  distributed  to  the  lungs,  and  a  larger  part 
to  the  different  organs  of  the  animal. 

483.  Certain  Batrachians  undergo  less  complete  metamor- 
phoses.    Thus  Salamanders,  like  Frogs,  acquire  members  in  the 
progress  of  time  and  lose  their  gills ;  but  they  also  preserve 
their  long  tail  (Fig.  344)  :   and,  as  we  have    already  stated, 
there  are  also  some  of  these  Reptiles  which,  as  regards  their 
mode  of  respiration,  always  remain  in  the  tadpole  state ;  for 
their  gills  are  preserved  during  the  whole  of  life,  and  the  deve- 
lopment of  the  lungs  is  stopped  at  an  early  stage. — It  is  one  of 
the  most  curious  proofs  of  the  influence  of  external  conditions 
upon  the  development  of  animals,  that,  by  seclusion  from  light, 
and  by  being  kept  at  a  low  temperature,  the  common  Tadpole 
may  be  prevented  from  changing  into  a  Frog,  and  may  be  made 
to  continue  to  grow  as  a  Tadpole. 

484.  In  general,  Reptiles  abandon  their  eggs  as  soon  as  they 
have  laid  them ;  and  they  are  hatched  by  the  aid  of  atmospheric 
warmth  only ;  but  there  is  in  this  respect  a  remarkable  excep- 
tion ;  a  large  Serpent  of  India,  nearly  allied  to  the  Boas  and 
Colubers,  known  by  the  name  of  Python^  twines  itself  round  its 
eggs ;  and  whilst  it  remains  rolled  round  its  offspring,  it  gives 
out  such  a  considerable  amount  of  heat,  that  the  temperature  of 
its  body  is  sometimes  raised  to  more  than  104°  Fahr.     Another 
Reptile,  nearly  allied  to  the  Toad,  the  Pipa  (Fig.  325),  also  pre- 
sents a  peculiarity  of  habit,  which  deserves  to  be  noticed  here. 
This  animal,  in  its  adult  state,  lives  on  the  earth ;  but  it  is  born 
in  the  form  of  a  Tadpole,  and  requires  to  be  then  immersed  in 
water.     When  the  eggs  are  laid,  the  male  places  them  upon  the 


GENERAL   CHARACTERS    OP    REPTILES.  547 

back  of  the  female ;  and  her  skin,  irritated  by  the  contact  of 


FIG.  325.— PIPA. 

these  bodies,  swells  and  forms  cells,  in  which  the  young  are 
enclosed  ;  the  mother,  thus  loaded,  betakes  herself  to  the  water, 
remains  there  until  the  young  have  completed  their  meta- 
morphoses ;  and  the  young  Pipas  then  quit  these  chambers,  and 
the  mother  returns  to  the  earth. 

485.  The  class  of  Reptiles  may  be  most  naturally  divided 
into  the  four  following  orders,  the  differences  between  which  are 
very  obvious  and  important. 

I.  CHELONIA,  or  Tortoises ;  in  which  the  trunk  is  enclosed 
between  a  carapace  and  plastron  (§  475)  formed  by  the  dorsal 
vertebrae,  ribs,  and  sternum ;  the  mouth  destitute  of  teeth,  but 
furnished  with  a  horny  beak ;  the  skin  covered  with  large  horny 
plates  ;  and  the  members,  four  in  number,  all  formed  upon  the 
same  plan. 

II.  SAURIA,  or  Lizards  ;  in  which  the  dorsal  vertebrae  and 
ribs  are  moveable,  so  that  there  is  neither  carapace  nor  plastron ; 
the  horny  beak  absent,  but  the  mouth  armed  with  teeth ;  the 
skin  covered  with  scales;   and  the  members  usually  four  in 
number. 

III.  OPHIDIA,  or  Serpents  ;  which  are  formed  upon  the  same 
general  plan  with  the  Lizards,  but  are  destitute  of  sternum  and 
of  members. 


548  ORDER    CHELONIA. 

IV.  BATRACHIA,  or  Frogs ;  which  have  neither  ribs  nor 
sternum,  but  which  possess  four  members  ;  the  skin  is  soft  and 
naked  (or  uncovered  with  scales)  ;  and  in  their  early  state  they 
respire  by  means  of  gills,  which  are  sometimes  retained  through 
the  whole  of  life. 

As  the  chief  peculiarities  of  these  several  orders  have  been 
already  noticed,  a  very  short  account  of  the  principal  families 
included  in  them  will  suffice. 


ORDER  I.— CHELONIA. 

486.  The  animals  composing  this  order  vary  considerably  in 
those  details  of  their  structure,  which  adapt  them  to  different 
habits  of  life  ;  some  of  them  being  destined  to  reside  exclusively 
upon  the  solid  ground,  others  to  pass  nearly  their  whole  time  in 
water,  and  others  to  dwell  amidst  marshes,  the  muddy  banks 
of  rivers,  &c.  The  most  obvious  variations  are  in  the  structure 
of  the  feet,  and  in  the  form  of  the  shell.  Thus  in  the  proper 
Land-Tortoises,  we  meet  with  a  short  stumpy  foot,  not  unlike 
that  of  an  Elephant, — the  toes  not  being  separated,  and  only  the 
claws  apparent  (Fig.  326.)  In  the  Marsh  and  River-Tortoises, 
the  toes  are  divided  and  webbed,  so  as  to  increase  the  extent  of 
surface ;  and  in  the  Marine-  Tortoises,  or  Turtles,  we  find  them 
extended  into  large  undivided  paddles,  by  which  the  animals 
can  propel  themselves  rapidly  through  the  water  (Fig.  328). — 
The  carapace  is  highly  arched  and  very  strong  in  the  Land- Tor- 
toises (Fig.  326) ;  but  more  flattened  in  the  aquatic  families,  for 
the  better  adaptation  of  their  form  to  motion  in  a  liquid.  The 
plastron  differs  considerably  in  degree  of  development,  and  in  the 
relative  consolidation  of  its  different  parts.  It  is  most  complete 
in  the  Land-Tortoises ;  in  many  of  which,  the  anterior  and 
posterior  portions  of  it  are  so  jointed  to  the  centre-piece,  as  to 
be  able  to  close  the  orifices  before  and  behind,  after  the  head, 
tail,  and  legs  have  been  drawn  in, — thus  affording  to  the  animal 
the  most  excellent  means  of  passive  defence.  The  natural  food 
of  many  of  the  Chelonia  is  vegetable,  and  they  can  endure  long 


ORDER    CHELONIA. TESTUDINID^. 


549 


fasting  with  impunity ;  there  are  some  species,  however,  which 
are  carnivorous,  and  which  show  much  ferocity  of  disposition. 
They  are  extremely  tenacious  of  life ;  surviving  the  severest 
mutilations  for  days  or  even  weeks.  Their  movements  are 
usually  slow  and  awkward  ;  but  they  continue  them  with  great 
perseverance,  and  for  a  long  time,  apparently  without  fatigue,  so 
as  to  produce  effects  which  would  not  have  been  anticipated. 
Their  sensations  appear  to  be  very  obtuse  ;  and  altogether  they 
may  be  said  to  live  very  slowly.  Connected  with  this  slowness 
appears  to  be  the  remarkable  length  of  their  lives  ;  which  has 
been  known  to  exceed  (in  the  case  of  a  Garden  Tortoise)  two 
hundred  and  twenty  years,  and  may  have  been  much  more. — 
The  Chelonia  are  divided,  according  to  the  form  of  their  shell 
and  extremities,  into  four  families: — 1.  TESTUDINID^E,  or  Land- 
Tortoises  ;— 2.  EMYD^E,  or  Marsh-  Tortoises  ; — 3.  TRIONYCID^E, 
or  River-Tortoises; — and  4.  CHELONID^E,  or  Turtles  (Marine 
Tortoises). 

487.     The  TESTUDINID^  are  slow,  quiet,  inoffensive  animals  ; 
feeding  upon  vegetable  substances,  and  seldom  wandering  far 


FIG.  326. 


FIG.  327. 


from  their  usual  haunts.  They  are  for  the  most  part  inhabit- 
ants of  the  warmer  regions  of  the  globe ;  though  many  species 
will  bear  removal  to  colder  climates, — passing  the  winter,  how- 
ever, in  a  torpid  state.  The  Testudo  Grceca,  of  which  the 
upper  and  under  surfaces  are  shown  in  Figs.  326  and  327,  is 


550  TESTUDINID.E  ; — EMYDJ5. 

the  species  best  known  in  this  country ;  it  is  a  native  of  the 
South  of  Europe ;  but  it  will  live  in  our  gardens  for  many  years 
without  any  particular  care.  It  digs  a  pit  in  the  ground,  in 
which  to  hybernate ;  and  it  also  buries  its  eggs  in  the  soil, 
lightly  covering  them  with  earth.  Some  very  large  species  of 
this  group  are  found  between  or  near  the  tropics.  Thus  the 
Gallipagos  Islands  are  inhabited  by  great  numbers  of  gigantic 
Tortoises,  weighing  above  two  hundred  pounds  each ;  which  are 
described  as  wholesome  and  palatable  articles  of  food.  And  in 
the  Zoological  Gardens  of  London,  at  the  present  time,  is  an 
immense  Tortoise,  originally  brought  to  the  Mauritius  from  the 
Seychelles  Islands,  in  1766 ;  the  length  of  which,  taken  along 
the  curve  of  its  back,  is  four  feet  four  inches ;  its  breadth,  four 
feet  niae  inches ;  and  its  weight,  two  hundred  and  eighty-five 
pounds. — The  EMYD^E,  or  Marsh  Tortoises,  form  an  extensive 
family,  diffused  through  the  warmer  latitudes  of  both  the  Old 
and  the  New  "World,  and  occurring  in  Australia,  where  hitherto 
no  Land  Tortoise  has  been  detected.  They  have  a  more  flattened 
shell;  and  their  feet  are  expanded  and  webbed  between  the 
toes,  which  are  armed  with  sharp  claws.  These  animals  tenant 
swamps,  lakes,  ponds,  and  small  rivers ;  and  swim  with  con- 
siderable facility.  On  land  they  are  more  active  and  alert  than 
the  species  of  the  previous  family ;  but  they  never  venture  far 
from  the  water,  and  invariably  seek  it  as  a  refuge  from  danger. 
The  plastron  is  generally  less  developed  than  in  the  Testudinidse, 
and  is  frequently  united  to  the  carapace  by  cartilage  only :  in 
some  species,  as  the  Emysaurus  serpentinus9  the  carapace  and 
plastron  are  so  small,  that  the  head  and  limbs  cannot  be 
drawn  within  the  shell.  The  Emydae  are  carnivorous  in  their 
habits ;  pursuing  fishes,  newts,  frogs,  and  insects  with  eagerness. 
Some  of  them  are  formidable  from  their  size  and  ferocity ;  this 
is  the  case  with  the  species  just  named,  which  is  commonly 
known  under  the  name  of  the  Alligator  Tortoise.  It  is  a  native 
of  the  lakes,  rivers,  and  morasses  of  Carolina ;  and  is  remark- 
able for  its  activity,  and  for  the  strength  of  its  jaws, — darting 
suddenly  upon  aquatic  Birds,  Fishes,  or  other  animals  that 
come  within  its  reach,  and  snapping  them  up  between  its 


TRIONYCID^E  ; — CHELONID^E.  551 

mandibles,  from  which  habit  it  is  sometimes  designated  as  the 
'*  Snapping  Turtle."  It  cannot  be  safely  approached  even  by 
Man. 

488.  The  two  other  families  of  this  order  are  exclusively 
aquatic ;  coming  on  shore  only  to  deposit  their  eggs,  and  doing 
this  stealthily  by  night.  In  the  TRIONYCID^E,  or  River  Tortoises, 
however,  the  structure  of  the  feet  does  not  depart  so  widely  from 
the  forms  of  the  preceding  families,  as  it  does  in  the  Turtles ; 
for  although  the  toes  are  connected  by  a  web,  and  only  three  of 
them  are  furnished  with  claws,  they  are  still  distinguishable. 
Like  the  Emydse,  these  Tortoises  are  exclusively  carnivorous  ; 
and  they  eat  their  food  in  the  water.  They  subsist  upon  Fishes, 
Reptiles,  Birds,  &c.,  at  which  they  dart  out  from  their  hiding- 
places,  launching  out  their  long  necks  and  snapping  at  their 
prey  with  great  energy  and  rapidity.  The  edges  of  their  man- 
dibles are  so  sharp  and  firm,  that  they  can  readily  bite  off  a 
man's  finger.  The  carapace  has  only  a  centre  of  bone,  the  cir- 
cumference being  cartilaginous  ;  and  the  plastron  is  not  osseous 
throughout.  The  skin,  too,  is  destitute  of  scales.  Hence  these 
animals  are  sometimes  called  Soft  Tortoises.  No  species  of  this 
family  is  European ;  but  almost  every  large  river  and  lake,  in 
the  warmer  regions  of  the  Old  and  New  World,  is  inhabited  by 
them.  They  are  particularly  numerous  in  the  Ganges ;  where 
they  prey,  with  the  Gavials,  on  the  human  bodies  which  are 
always  floating  in  that  stream. — The  Marine  Tortoises,  CHELO- 
NID^E,  OT  Turtles,  are  at  once  distinguished  by  the  compressed  and 
paddle-like  form  of  the  feet ;  of  these,  the  anterior  pair  is  most 
developed ;  and  they  are  used  as  oars,  or  rather  as  aquatic 
wings ;  by  means  of  which  these  animals  can  move  through  the 
water  in  any  direction,  with  considerable  rapidity  and  address. 
This  conformation,  however,  renders  their  progression  on  land  so 
much  the  more  difficult ;  they  can  only  shuffle  along  at  a  slow 
rate  and  with  laborious  efforts ;  and,  from  the  flattened  form  of 
their  carapace,  they  are  unable  to  recover  their  natural  position, 
when  turned  upon  their  backs  upon  a  flat  surface.  The  jaws  of 
the  Turtles  are  robust ;  and  the  upper  mandible  is  received  into 
a  groove  in  the  lower,  so  that  their  grasp  is  very  firm.  Most 


552 


CHELONIDvE,    OR   TURTLES. 


of  the  species  feed  upon  marine  plants ;  but  the  Hawksbill 
(Fig.  328),  so  named  from  the  peculiar  hooked  form  of  the  end  of 
the  upper  mandible,  also  eats  Crustacea,  Shell-fish,  Echini,  &c. 
These  animals  are  found  in  all  the  seas  of  warm  climates,  but 
principally  in  the  tropical  ocean ;  though  stragglers  occasionally 
arrive  at  our  own  shores.  They  have  their  favourite  breeding- 
places,  to  which  thousands  periodically  resort,  often  travelling 
thither  from  immense  distances ;  these  are  usually  islands  situated 
in  the  midst  of  the  open  ocean, — such  as  the  island  of  Ascension, 
which  is  one  of  those  most  frequented  by  them.  At  other  times 
they  are  found  at  the  distance  of  many  hundred  leagues  from 
any  land. — The  species  most  valued  as  food  is  the  Chelone  midas, 
or  Green  Turtle;  this  occasionally  attains  an  enormous  size, 

measuring  six  or  seven  feet  in 
length,  and  weighing  from  five  to 
eight  hundred  pounds;  its  ordi- 
nary bulk,  however,  is  much  less. — 
The  Chelone  imbricata,  or  Hawks- 
bill  Turtle,  is  the  one  most  in  re- 
quest for  its  covering  of  horny 
plates,  which  are  known  as  tor- 
toise-shell; these  plates  are  of  large 
size,  and  lie  over  one  another  like 
the  tiles  of  a  house,  so  that  each 
is  overlapped  by  the  one  in  front 
of  it,  to  one-third  of  its  extent. 

Fro.  328.— HAWKSBILL  TURTLE.  Hence,  although  this  Species  is  not 

nearly  so  large  as  the  Green  Turtle,  the  plates  are  of  greater  dimen- 
sions, as  well  as  of  finer  quality.  Its  flesh,  however,  is  neither 
so  palatable,  nor  so  wholesome. — One  other  species  maybe  noticed, 
the  Sphargis,  or  Leathery  Turtle ;  which  differs  from  all  other 
Turtles,  in  having  the  bones  covered  with  a  leathery  skin,  instead 
of  with  plates.  When  attacked  and  wounded,  it  utters  loud, 
piercing  cries,  which  have  been  heard  nearly  a  mile  off.  It 
sometimes  attains  dimensions  as  great  as  those  of  the  Green 
Turtle.  Its  flesh  appears  to  be  very  unwholesome. 

489.     Little  is  as  yet  known  of  the  fossil  forms  of  this  order ; 


ORDER  SAURIA; — GENERAL  CHARACTERS.      553 

but,  from  discoveries  recently  made  among  the  Himalaya  moun- 
tains, it  appears  that  Tortoises  must  have  formerly  existed,  far 
surpassing  in  dimensions  the  most  bulky  of  the  Chelonidse  now 
living. 


ORDER  II.— SAURIA. 

490.  THE  number  of  species  included  in  this  order  is  very 
considerable  :  and  their  variation  in  form,  dimensions,  and  cha- 
racter, is  far  greater  than  is  to  be  met  with  in  the  preceding 
group.      The  contrast   is   still   stronger,  when   we   include   in 
our  survey  those  fossil  remains  of  the  Saurian  Reptiles,  which 
abound  in  many  parts  of  the  world  ;  for  not  even  the  gigantic 
and  ferocious  Crocodile  is  nearly  so  striking  in  comparison  with 
the  harmless  little  Lizard  of  our  walls  and  copses,  as  were  the 
monstrous  Saurians  of  the  ancient  streams  and  marshes,  or  the 
Pterodactylus,  which  winged  its  Bat-like  flight  through  the  air. 
The  diversity  in  the  habits  of  the  existing  Saurians  is  very  con- 
siderable ;    some   being  more   or   less  aquatic ;    others   strictly 
terrestrial,  living  on  the  ground  and  retreating  for  shelter  to 
holes  burrowed  beneath  the  surface  ;  and  others  entirely  arboreal, 
passing  their  whole  lives  in  the  midst  of  trees.  They  mostly  feed 
on  animal  substances  ;  some  of  them  preferring  flesh,   others 
attacking  small  animals,  and  others  pursuing  insects;  one  family, 
however,  is  for  the  most  part  herbivorous.     They  are  all  fur- 
nished with  teeth ;  which  are  of  a  simple  conical  form,   and 
adapted  rather  for  securing  and  tearing  their   prey,   than   for 
masticating  it. — The  chief  families  included  in  this  order  are  the 
following: — 1.  CROCODILID^E,  or  Crocodiles ; — 2.  CHAMELEONID^, 
or  Chameleons  ; — 3.    GECKOTID.E,  or  Geckos  ; — 4.    IGUANID^I, 
or  Iguanas  ; — 5.    AGAMIDJE,   or  Agamas  ; — 6.  VARANIDJE.  or 
Varans  ; — 7-  TEID.E,  or  Teguixins  ; — 8.  LACERTHXE,  or  True 
Lizards; — 9.  CHALCID^:,   or  Snake  Lizards; — 10.  SCINCID.E, 
or  Scinks  ; — besides  certain  fossil  forms,  which  cannot  be  referred 
to  any  of  these. 

491.  Some    writers   consider   the   family    CROCODILIDJS   as 
forming  a  distinct  order,  intermediate  between  the  Turtles  and 


554        FAMILY    CROCODILIDJE  ; CROCODILES,    ALLIGATORS. 

the  Lizards ;  their  bodies  being  covered  with  square  bony  plates, 
instead   of  with  scales ;    and   the  skull   having  a  remarkable 
solidity.     Their  general  plan  of  structure,  however,  is  the  same 
as  that  of  the  Lizards ;  but  they  are  in  some  respects  superior  to 
other   Reptiles, — their  heart  possessing  four  cavities   (§  478), 
and  their  lungs  being  more  subdivided  than  those  of  Reptiles  in 
general.     These  animals,  as  is  well  known,  are  very  ferocious  in 
their  disposition ;  they  seize  their  prey  for  the  most  part  in  the 
water,  but  retire  to  some  retreat  on  land  to  devour  it ;  and  they 
relish  it  in  a  state  of  putrescence.     Their  aquatic  habits  are  indi- 
cated by  the  vertical  flattening  and  expansion  of  the  tail,  and  by 
the  webbing  of  the  posterior  feet ;  in  this  respect,  however,  there 
is  a  difference  between  the  several  groups  of  this  family.     These 
animals  are  only  found  in  warm  climates ;  and  inhabit  the  rivers, 
lakes,  and  marshy  places,  sometimes  swimming  out  to  sea,  even 
to  a  considerable  distance  from  land. — This  family  is  divided 
into  three  genera,  the  Crocodiles,  Alligators  and  Gamals  ;  which 
differ  in  their  structure  and  in  their  geographical  distribution. — 
The  true  Crocodiles  are  inhabitants  of  Africa,  India,  and  the 
hotter  parts  of  America.     Their  muzzle  is  more  pointed  than 
that  of  the  Alligators,  but  much  less  so  than  in  the  Gavials ; 
the  longest  teeth  in  the  lower  jaw  are  received  into  notches  on 
each  side  of  the  upper ;  the  hinder  limbs  have  a  ridge  of  scales 
along  their  external  border,  resembling  that  which  runs  along 


FIG.  329. — CROCODILE. 


the  upper  edge  of  the  tail ;  and  the  three  outer  toes  of  the  hind- 
feet  are  entirely  webbed.  The  movements  of  these  animals  on 
land  are  awkward,  the  legs  being  ill  formed  for  running,  and 
the  head  possessing  but  little  power  of  motion  from  side  to  side ; 
but  in  water  they  dart  along  with  great  rapidity,  by  the  lateral 
movements  of  the  tail,  aided  by  the  action  of  their  swimming- 
feet. — The  Alligators,  or  Caymans,  are  confined  to  America,  and 


ALLIGATORS,    GAVIALS,    FOSSIL    CROCODILES.  555 

are  less  aquatic  in  their  habits  than  the  Crocodiles.  They  are 
distinguished  by  the  shortness  and  roundness  of  the  muzzle  ;  by 
the  reception  of  the  longest  teeth  of  the  lower  jaw  into  cavities 
in  the  upper  ;  by  the  absence  of  the  ridge  of  scales  on  the  hind- 
legs  ;  and  by  the  much  inferior  development  of  the  webs  between 
the  toes.  They  frequent  swamps  and  marshes,  rather  than  rivers ; 
and  are  occasionally  seen  basking  on  dry  ground,  during  the  day, 
luxuriating  in  the  heat  of  the  sun.  It  is  during  the  night  that 
they  are  most  active  ;  and  they  then  set  up  a  loud  bellowing,  not 
unlike  that  of  a  bull.  Several  species  of  Alligator  are  known  ; 
vary  ing  in  length  from  twoto  morethan  twentyfeet. — The  Gavial, 
or  Crocodile  of  the  Ganges,  of  which  only  one  species  is  known, 
is  the  largest  of  the  living  Saurian  Reptiles ;  and  differs  remark- 
ably from  the  preceding,  in  several  particulars.  The  muzzle  is 
extremely  prolonged  and  narrow,  forming  a  sort  of  beak ;  and 
this  is  swollen  at  its  extremity,  around  the  aperture  of  the 
nostrils.  The  teeth  are  large  and  numerous,  118  or  120  being 
usually  present ;  and  the  longest  of  the  lower  jaw  are  received 
into  notches  in  the  upper,  as  in  the  Crocodile.  The  Gavial  is 
quite  as  aquatic  in  its  habits,  as  is  the  Crocodile  of  the  Nile  ;  its 
hind-feet  are  fully  webbed  ;  and  the  crest  on  the  tail,  increasing 
the  surface  by  which  it  strikes  the  water,  is  much  elevated.  This 
powerful  animal  frequently  attains  the  length  of  twenty-five 
feet ;  and  is  very  formidable  from  its  strength  and  ferocity.  It 
is  very  serviceable  in  devouring  the  numerous  dead  bodies  of 
men  and  animals,  which  are  committed  to  the  sacred  river ;  and 
which  would  otherwise  taint  the  air  by  their  decay. — Several 
species  of  Crocodiles  are  found  in  a  fossil  state  ;  some  of  them 
having  been  much  larger  than  any  now  existing.  It  is  interest- 
ing to  remark,  that  remains  of  forms  allied  to  the  Gavials  are 
found  in  the  same  strata  with  those  of  the  Icthyosaurus  and 
Plesiosaurus ;  which  strata  are,  geologically  speaking,  much 
older  than  those  in  which  the  remains  of  Mammals  occur.  It  is 
in  these  last,  that  we  find  relics  of  Sauria  resembling  the  Cay- 
mans of  the  present  time ;  and  this  is  in  accordance  with  the 
general  rule,  that  the  terrestrial  animals  were  the  last  to  make 
their  appearance  on  the  surface  of  the  globe. 

o  o  2 


556  FAMILY   CHAMELEONIC,    OR    CHAMELEONS. 

492.  The  family  CHAMELEONIDJE,  or  Chameleons,  is  dis- 
tributed through  the  warmer  parts  of  the  Old  "World,  but  not  in 
America.  The  species  it  includes  are  distinguished  from  all 
others,  by  several  very  remarkable  peculiarities.  Their  bodies 
are  much  compressed,  or  flattened  sideways ;  and  the  back  is 
surmounted  by  a  sharp  ridge.  Two  of  the  toes  are  directed 
backwards,  opposing  the  three  anterior  ones,  and  thus  forming 
very  efficient  instruments  of  prehension.  The  tail  also,  which 
is  of  a  tapering  form,  is  prehensile.  The  tongue  is  a  hollow 


FIG.  330  — CHAMELEON. 

tube,  with  a  swollen  fleshy  extremity  ;  and  it  is  capable  of  being 
darted  out  instantaneously  to  a  great  distance,  and  of  being  as 
rapidly  drawn  in.  This  organ  is  furnished  with  a  glutinous 
saliva;  by  which  the  insect  prey,  that  serve  for  the  support  of 
these  extraordinary  Reptiles,  are  attached  to  it.  The  eyes  of 
the  Chameleon  are  capable  of  being  moved  independently  of  each 
other ;  and  they  are  constantly  covered  with  a  sort  of  eyelid, 
in  which  there  is  a  small  aperture  corresponding  with  the  pupil. 
Its  skin  is  not  furnished  with  scales,  but  is  beset  with  horny 
granules.  It  undergoes,  as  is  well  known,  remarkable  changes 
of  colour;  varying  through  different  shades  of  yellow,  red, 
gray,  brown,  violet,  and  dull  inky  blue.  The  cause  of  these 
changes  is  not  well  understood  ;  by  M.  Milne  Edwards,  they  are 
referred  to  two  differently  coloured  layers  of  pigment,  which  are 
stated  by  him  to  be  so  arranged,  that  either  of  them  may  be 
made  to  appear  alone  under  the  cuticle,  or  the  two  may  be 
presented  in  different  degrees  of  combination.  It  is  not  easy 


CHAiMELEON. FAMILY    GECKOTID2E.  557 

to  understand,  however,  by  what  arrangement  this  can  be 
effected  ;  or  how  all  the  shades  of  colour,  which  the  Chameleon 
presents,  can  be  given  by  the  mixture  of  two  only.  These 
curious  animals  are  arboreal  in  their  habits ;  traversing  the 
twigs  and  branches  in  a  slow  and  cautious  manner,  with  the  aid 
of  the  grasping  powers  of  the  feet  and  tail ;  and  occasionally 
darting  out  their  tongues  at  insects  that  come  within  their  reach, 
with  such  rapidity  that  the  movement  is  scarcely  perceptible. 
They  are  very  inanimate  in  their  appearance,  often  remaining  in 
precisely  the  same  position  for  many  hours  together  ;  and  they 
can  exist  for  several  months  without  food.  The  lungs  are  large, 
and  are  connected  (as  in  Birds)  with  air-cells  that  lie  among  the 
muscles  and  beneath  the  skin ;  hence  the  appearance  of  the 
animal  varies  greatly,  according  as  these  cavities  are  full  or 
empty, — being  sometimes  full  and  bloated,  and  the  next  minute 
lean  and  shrunken. 

493.     The  GECKOTID.E,  or  Geckos,  are  Lizards  of  small  size, 
but  of  repulsive  aspect ;  their  bodies  being  flattened,  and  their 


'Fin.  331 — GECKO. 


colour  lurid.  Many  of  the  species  are  considered  as  poisonous 
by  the  inhabitants  of  the  countries  in  which  they  are  found ; 
and  some  even  assert  that  they  infect  every  substance  over  which 
they  Avalk ;  but  both  these  opinions  are,  to  say  the  least,  very 
doubtful.  From  the  peculiar  structure  of  their  toes  (§  467), 
they  are  capable  of  running  along  the  smoothest  surfaces,  of 
creeping  up  walls,  and  even  of  traversing  ceilings, — like  a  fly,— 


558  GECKOS. FAMILY    IGUANIDJE. 

with  the  back  downwards  :  they  lurk  in  the  chinks  and  fissures 
of  walls  and  trees,  and  in  holes  and  crannies  of  buildings.  From 
the  flatness  and  flexibility  of  their  bodies,  they  are  capable  of 
insinuating  themselves  into  the  smallest  crevices ;  and  there  they 
lurk  during  the  day,  coming  forth  at  night  in  quest  of  their 
insect  prey,  and  pursuing  it  with  much  activity, —  occasionally 
uttering  a  kind  of  chuckling  cry,  from  which  their  name  is 
derived.  The  Geckos  are  diffused  through  the  warmer  regions 
of  all  quarters  of  the  globe ;  being  most  numerous  in  the 
tropical  portions  of  Africa. 

494.  The  family  IGUANHXE,  or  Iguanas^  is  a  very  extensive 
one ;  numbering  upwards  of  150  species,  many  of  which  are 
among  the  largest  Saurians  at  present  existing,  with  the  excep- 
tion of  the  Crocodiles.  Of  the  true  Iguanas^  which  are  re- 
stricted to  America,  the  general  aspect  will  be  seen  from  the 


FIG.  332 — IGUANA. 

accompanying  figure.  They  have  a  crested  ridge  along  the 
back ;  and  a  curious  dewlap,  formed  by  a  fold  of  the  skin, 
under  the  throat,  which  is  capable  of  being  distended  with  air. 
The  tail  is  long  and  flexible,  and  is  laterally  compressed,  as  in 
the  Crocodiles.  The  Iguanas  are  chiefly  distinguished  by  the 
form  and  insertion  of  the  teeth  ;  these  are  not  lodged  in  distinct 
sockets,  but  are  fixed  along  the  internal  face  of  the  jaw-bone  in 
a  sort  of  furrow,  and  adhere  by  one  side  of  the  bony  substance 
of  the  root;  the  surface  of  the  teeth  is  irregular,  adapting  them 
to  grind  down  the  vegetable  substances  on  which  these  animals 
feed.  They  are  arboreal  in  their  habits,  and  feed  principally 
upon  vegetable  aliment;  it  appears,  however,  that  they  will 


FAMILY  IGUANIDJE; — IGUANODON  ;  ANOLIS.  559 

sometimes  eat  eggs,  or  other  animal  substances.  Their  disposi- 
tion is  rather  fierce,  and  they  will  defend  themselves  with  vigour ; 
when  water  is  near,  they  betake  themselves  to  it,  and  swim  with 
considerable  rapidity,  by  the  lateral  strokes  of  the  tail.  The 
colour  of  the  Iguanas  is  usually  a  mixture  of  green  and  brown, 
— adapted  to  conceal  them  during  their  residence  in  trees ;  and 
their  hues  seem  to  have  some  of  that  power  of  change,  which  is 
so  remarkable  in  the  Chameleons.  Their  usual  length  is  from 
four  to  six  feet,  including  the  tail.  The  flesh  is  very  palatable, 
and  is  much  esteemed  in  the  West  Indies  as  an  article  of  food  ; 
the  animals,  however,  are  now  becoming  scarce  in  most  of  the 
islands. — Remains  of  a  gigantic  Saurian  have  been  discovered  in 
the  South  East  of  England;  which  appears,  from  the  structure  of 
the  teeth,  to  have  been  undoubtedly  allied  to  the  Iguanas  of  the 
present  day ;  and  which  has  received  the  name  of  Iguanodon. 
This  animal  could  not  have  been  less  than  70  feet  in  length,  and 
was  perhaps  more.  Its  teeth  were  evidently  fitted, — by  the 
roughness  of  their  surface, — and  by  the  provision  made  in  the 
arrangement  of  the  enamel,  for  the  continued  maintenance  of  that 
roughness,  notwithstanding  the  wear  of  the  tooth, — to  grind 
down  hard  vegetable  substances  to  a  pulp ;  and  remains  of  terres- 
trial plants  have  been  found  associated  with  it,  showing  that  its 
habits  were  nearly  the  same  as  those  of  the  existing  Iguanas. 

495.     In  this  family  are  also  included  several  other  genera ; 
of  which  those  that  have  the  teeth  arranged  on  the  same  plan 


FIG.  333.— ANOLIS. 


as  the  Iguanas,   are,  like  them  restricted  to  the  New  World. 
The  Anolis  is  a  small,  slender,  active  little  animal  ;  frequenting 


560  FAMILY  IGUANLIXE; — ANOLIS  ;  BASILISK. 

woods  and  rocky  places ;  and  running,  leaping,  and  climbing 
with  singular  address  and  rapidity.  It  is  very  timid  and  harm- 
less ;  and  when  under  the  influence  of  fear  or  other  excitement, 
the  dewlap  beneath  its  throat  becomes  inflated,  and  the  tints  of 
its  skin  change  with  great  celerity.  In  the  structure  of  its  feet, 
it  bears  some  resemblance  to  the  Geckos ;  and  like  them,  it 
feeds  chiefly  on  insects,  although  it  also  subsists  in  part  upon 
vegetable  substances.  The  largest  species  of  this  genus  (of 
which  several  abound  in  the  West  India  Islands)  is  not  above  a 
foot  in  length. — Another  genus  of  this  family  has  received  the 
name  of  Basilisk ;  a  term  that  was  applied  by  the  ancients  to 
a  monster,  which  existed  only  in  their  own  imaginations,  yet  of 
which  the  most  detailed  accounts  have  been  transmitted  to  us. 
The  name  was  derived  from  a  Greek  word,  signifying  royalty ; 
and  the  animal  was  represented  as  the  king  of  the  Serpents, 
with  a  regal  crown  upon  its  head,  blighting  the  herbage  with  its 
breath,  and  striking  dead  with  a  glance  of  its  eye.  It  was 
described  as  being  eight  feet  long,  and  as  having  two  large  scales 
for  wings.  The  idea  of  such  an  animal  could  not  have  originated 
in  the  harmless  little  creatures  to  which  the  name  is  now  applied  ; 
since  these  were  not  known  to  the  ancients.  But  the  term 
has  been  retained,  on  account  of  the  crest  or  projection  on  the 


FIG.  334.— MITRED  BASILISK. 


head  by  which  they  are  characterised.  The  Mitred  Basilisk  is 
an  inhabitant  of  Guiana,  Martinique,  and  the  tropical  portions 
of  South  America.  In  its  general  form  and  habits,  it  is  not 
unlike  the  Iguanas;  but  it  is  more  aquatic,  and  swims  with 
great  address  by  means  of  the  lateral  motions  of  its  finny  tail. 


DRACO  VOLANS;    STELLIS. FAMILY    AGAMID^E.  561 

496.  Besides  the  foregoing,  some  other  genera,  having  the 
teeth  arranged  on  the  upper  edge  of  the  jaw,  belong  to  this 
family ;  and  these  are  for  the  most  part  inhabitants  of  the  Old 
World.     Here  we  place  the  curious  little  Draco  volans  (Fig. 
306),  whose  structure  and  habits  have  been  already  described 
(§  468) ;    this   interesting  animal  is   a   native   of  the   Asiatic 
Archipelago.     To  this  group   also  belongs  the  Stellio,  the  dif- 
ferent species  of  which  are  the  most  common  Lizards  of  the 
Levant, — tenanting  old  walls,  piles  of  stones,  crevices  of  rocks, 
&c.,  and  feeding  upon  insects. 

497.  The  AGAMID.E,  or  Agamas,  are  in  general  short,  thick- 
bodied  lizards,  covered  with  a  lax  skin,  which  is  capable  of  being 

inflated  with  air  at  the 
will  of  the  animals ;  they 
are  frequently  beset  with 
spines,  which  are  raised 
up  when  the  skin  is  in- 
FIO.  m-AGAMA.  flate(j5  presenting  a  formi- 

dable array.  In  many  of  them,  the  general  form  and  aspect  are 
so  Toad-like,  that,  were  it  not  for  the  presence  of  a  tail,  they 
might  be  mistaken  for  that  Reptile  on  a  first  glance.  These  lurk 
among  rocks,  heaps  of  stones,  and  mouldering  ruins ;  where 
their  dull  and  sombre  colours  protect  them  from  observation. 
Others,  however,  have  a  more  slender  contour,  longer  limbs, 
and  more  flexible  toes ;  and  ascend  trees  with  facility.  Many 
of  them  are  capable  of  changing  the  colours  of  the  skin.  A 
very  remarkable  species  of  this  group,  found  in  Australia,  is 
distinguished  by  the  presence  of  a  sort  of  frill  or  ruff  attached 
to  the  neck ;  this  lies  back  in  plaits,  when  the  animal  is  undis- 
turbed ;  but  is  raised,  to  the  extent  of  five  inches  on  either  side, 
when  the  animal  is  alarmed.  This  Frilled  Lizard  has  received 
the  scientific  name  of  Chlamydosaurus. 

498.  The  family  VARANIDJE,  or  Varans,  includes  the  largest 
of  the  Saurian  Reptiles,  with  the  exception  of  the  Crocodiles. 
It  is  chiefly  characterised  by  the  form  of  the  tongue,  which  is 
fleshy  and  very  extensible,  and  forked  at  the  tip  like  that  of  Ser- 
pents ;  and  by  the  peculiar  mode  in  which  the  skin  is  covered 


562  FAMILY    VARANID^E. TEIDJE. LACERTIDjE. 

with  small  scales,  these  not  being  imbricated  (that  is,  overlap- 
ping one  another  like  the  tiles  of  a  house),  but  being  arranged 
side  by  side,  so  as  to  form  circular  rings,  inclosing  the  head, 
body,  and  limbs.  The  figure  of  these  animals  is  elongated  and 
graceful,  and  their  actions  are  quick  and  alert.  Some  of  them 
have  a  conical,  nearly  rounded,  tail,  which  assists  the  animals 
in  their  rapid  serpentine  movements  on  land ;  whilst  in  others 
the  tail  is  compressed  laterally,  and  is  a  very  efficient  instru- 
ment for  motion  in  water.  The  Varans  are  only  found  in 
the  warmer  parts  of  the  Old  "World,  tenanting  desert  and  rocky 
places,  and  the  borders  of  rivers ;  their  food  consists  of  the 
larger  kinds  of  insects,  as  locusts,  &c.,  eggs,  birds,  and  small 
mammalia,  reptiles,  and  fish.  It  is  said  that  they  unite  toge- 
ther in  packs  on  the  banks  of  rivers,  and  seize  such  quadrupeds 
as  approach  unsuspectingly  to  drink.  The  Varan  of  the  Nile, 
which  is  about  six  feet  in  length,  is  very  destructive  to  the  eggs 
and  young  of  the  Crocodile.  Remains  of  much  larger  Reptiles 
belonging  to  this  family,  however,  are  found  in  the  chalk  and 
neighbouring  deposits ;  the  Mososaurus,  for  example,  which 
seems  more  allied  to  the  Varans  than  to  any  other  group,  must 
have  been  more  than  twenty-five  feet  in  length.  Its  residence 
was  in  the  sea ;  and  its  habits  seem  to  have  been  exclusively 
aquatic. — Even  this  was  but  a  pigmy,  however,  in  comparison 
with  the  Megalosaurus ;  which,  from  the  scanty  remains  of  it 
yet  discovered,  may  be  proved  to  have  been  at  least  seventy  feet 
in  length, — equalling  the  Elephant  in  height,  and  approaching 
the  largest  "Whales  in  bulk. 

499.  The  family  of  TEIDJE,  or  Tegmxins,  which  is  exclu- 
sively American,  is  closely  allied  to  the  preceding ;  it  contains 
some  large  Lizards,  which  have  been  termed  Safeguards  and 
Monitors,  from  the  idea  that  they  give  warning  by  a  hiss  of  the 
proximity  of  the  Alligator, — which  has  also  been   supposed, 
though  erroneously,  respecting  the  Varans  and  Crocodiles.     In 
their  general  habits,  they  much  resemble  the  Varans. 

500.  The  LACERTID.E,  or  True  Lizards,  are  bright-eyed, 
active,  slender  little  animals,  adorned  with  brilliant  colours,  and 
having  nothing  repulsive  in  their  aspect  or  manners.     They  are 


VIVIPAROUS    LIZARD  ;    SAND    LIZARD.  563 

covered  above  with  small  imbricated  scales ;  and  below  with 
larger  plates.  The  tongue  is  long  and  forked ;  and  there  are 
generally  small  teeth  on  the  palate.  To  this  group, — which  is 
peculiar  to  the  Old  World,  and  most  abundant  in  Southern 
Europe  and  Western  Asia, — belong  the  only  two  species  of 
Saurians  that  inhabit  our  own  country,  the  Viviparous  Lizard, 
and  the  Sand  Lizard.  The  former  derives  its  name  from  the 
circumstance,  that  the  eggs  are  hatched  before  leaving  the 
oviduct  of  the  female ;  so  that  the  young  are  produced  alive. 
It  frequents  thickets,  heaths,  and  sunny  banks ;  and  several  are 
often  seen  in  such  situations  basking  in  the  summer's  sun,  and 
watching  for  their  insect  prey.  The  females  in  particular 
expose  themselves  to  as  much  external  warmth  as  possible, 
during  the  time  that  the  incubation  of  the  eggs  is  going  on  within 
them ;  and  this  is  not  improbably  connected  with  the  unusual 
development  which  these  animals  subsequently  attain,  in  regard 
to  the  acuteness  of  their  senses,  and  the  activity  of  their  muscular 
movements.  They  burrow  in  the  ground,  and  retreat  to  their 
hiding-places  on  the  slightest  alarm.  The  average  length  of  this 
species  is  about  six  inches.  The  Sand  Lizard  is  larger  than 
the  preceding,  its  length  varying  from  seven  to  twelve  inches ; 
two  varieties  of  it  appear  to  exist, — one  being  of  a  sandy-brown 
colour, — and  the  other  having  a  mixture  of  green,  more  or  less 
decided.  The  ordinary  residence  of  this  species  is  on  sandy 
heaths ;  and  though  less  quick  and  active  than  the  Viviparous 
Lizard,  it  runs  with  considerable  alertness.  The  greener  variety, 
however,  seems  to  frequent  more  verdant  localities. — There  is  a 
beautiful  green  species,  nearly  allied  to  the  preceding,  which  is 
common  in  the  south  of  Europe,  and  which  is  frequently  brought 
over  to  this  country  in  cages.  It  soon  becomes  very  tame  in 
captivity,  and  will  take  flies  from  those  to  whom  it  is  familiar. 
In  all  these  Lizards,  the  tail  is  extremely  brittle ;  so  that  it 
snaps  off  at  the  slightest  touch,  when  the  attempt  is  made  to 
seize  them  by  it.  Nature  has  provided  a  remedy  for  this  acci- 
dent, by  giving  to  the  animals  the  power  of  forming  a  new  tail ; 
this  organ  has  only  a  central  cartilage,  however,  in  place  of  the 
bones,  and  is  often  covered  with  scales  different  from  those  of  the 


564  FAMILY   CHALCIDJ5  ; — SNAKE-LIZARDS. 

rest  of  the  tail.  If  the  tail  be  cracked  only  on  one  side,  and  not 
thrown  off,  a  new  tail  often  springs  out  of  the  crack,  so  that  the 
member  becomes  forked.  Other  Lizards  have  a  similar  power 
of  reparation. 

501.  In  the  family  CHALCHXE,  we  meet  with  a  series  of 
forms,  which  presents  us  with  a  gradual  transition  from  the  order 
of  Lizards  to  that  of  Serpents, — some  of  them,  indeed,  having 
been  placed  by  many  Naturalists  in  the  latter.  The  body  is 
usually  cylindrical,  and  extremely  elongated  or  snake-like ; 
sometimes  destitute  of  limbs,  and  mostly  with  the  limbs  only  a 
little  developed  :  there  is  usually  no  distinct  neck  between  the 
head  and  trunk ;  and  the  latter  merges  imperceptibly  into  the 
tail.  The  accompanying  figure  represents  the  Four-toed  Sau- 
rophis,  or  Snake-Lizard,  which  is  a  native  of  the  southern  part 


FIG.  336. — SNAKE-LIZARD. 


of  Africa ;  it  possesses  four  minute  limbs,  each  provided  with 
four  toes.  In  the  Anguine  Lizard,  also  a  native  of  South  Africa, 
the  limbs  are  still  more  reduced,  and  have  each  but  a  single  toe. 
The  Scheltopusic,  a  native  of  Northern  Africa  and  South- Western 
Asia,  and  common  also  in  the  Morea,  has  no  fore-limbs,  and  the 
hind-legs  are  mere  scaly  appendages. — In  the  Ophisaurus,  or 
Glass-Snake,  of  Carolina,  there  is  an  entire  absence  of  limbs;  yet 
there  are  certain  anatomical  peculiarities,  which  indicate  that  it 
belongs  rather  to  the  Saurian  than  to  the  Ophidian  group. — 
The  same  may  be  said  of  the  Amphisbcena,  an  animal  of  very 
remarkable  appearance  and  habits.  Its  head  and  body  are  of 
uniform  thickness  ;  and  its  tail  terminates  bluntly  ;  so  that  at  a 
first  glance  it  is  not  easy  to  distinguish  between  the  head  and 
tail,  more  especially  as  the  minute  eyes  are  so  covered  by  horny 
plates,  as  only  to  be  distinguished  as  little  black  dots.  The 
name  of  the  animal,  derived  from  two  Greek  words,  has  reference 
to  its  power  of  crawling  head  or  tail  foremost  with  equal  facility; 


AMPHlSBJiNA. FAMILY    SCINCID^E.  5G5 

from  which  circumstance,  joined  to  the  similarity  in  the  appear- 
ance of  the  two  extremities,  the  idea  lias  arisen  among  the 
natives  of  some  of  the  countries  inhabited  by  it,  that  it  has  a 
head  at  each  end  of  the  body.  The  Amphisbaena  bores  in  the 
soft  earth  like  a  worm,  working  its  way  with  considerable 
dispatch ;  and  it  lives  principally  on  Ants  and  Termites  (com- 
monly termed  White  Ants)  and  their  larvce.  One  species  inha- 
bits Spain,  Portugal,  and  Northern  Africa ;  but  many  more  are 
found  in  America. 

502.'  In  the  family  SCINCID/E,  or  Scinks,  we  meet  with  a 
similar  gradual  transition  from  the  form  of  the  Lizards  to  that  of 
the  Serpents ;  but  the  animals  composing  it  differ  from  those  of 
the  last  family  in  the  arrangement  of  the  scales,  and  in  certain 
other  peculiarities.  The  head  is  covered  with  large  plates  of 
an  angular  figure,  as  in  the  true  Lizards ;  but  the  body,  tail,  and 
limbs,  are  covered  with  uniform  overlapping  scales,  having  a 
glossy  and  polished  aspect,  and  presenting  almost  the  appearance 
of  a  coat  of  mail.  The  true  Scinhs  have  four  legs,  and  a  sharp- 
edged  muzzle,  by  which  they  bury  themselves  in  the  sand  of  the 
deserts  they  inhabit.  One  species,  a  native  of  Arabia,  Northern 
Africa,  &c.,  was  long  held  in  repute,  on  account  of  its  supposed 
medicinal  virtues. — From  these  we  pass,  through  genera  in  which 
the  limbs  are  reduced  to  mere  footless  appendages,  and  others  in 
which  either  the  anterior  or  posterior  pair  is  deficient,  to  the 
genus  Anguis;  of  which  one  species,  inhabiting  our  own  country, 
is  known  as  the  Slow-worm,  or  Blind-worm.  In  this  animal, 
which  is  from  twelve  to  fifteen  inches  in  length,  the  legs  are 
reduced  to  mere  rudiments,  which  do  not  manifest  themselves 
externally,  but  may  be  traced  by  careful  dissection  beneath  the 
skin.  The  Slow-worm  frequents  copses,  orchards,  old  moulder- 
ing walls,  and  banks,  where  it  delights  to  bask  in  the  sun  ;  it  is 
a  sluggish,  timid  creature  ;  and  its  food  consists  chiefly  of  worms 
and  slugs.  Its  whole  body  is  as  brittle  as  the  tail  of  the  Vivi- 
parous Lizard  ;  breaking  asunder  on  the  slightest  attempt  to 
bend  it,  or  on  a  trifling  blow,  in  consequence  (as  it  would  seem) 
of  the  violent  contraction  of  the  muscles  induced  by  alarm. — 


566      FOSSIL   SAURIANS; PTERODACTYLUS;    ICTHYOSAURUS. 

The  Acontias,  or  Javelin  Snake,  of  Southern  Africa,  is  nearly 
allied  to  our  Slow-worm. 

503.  We  have  now  to  advert  to  some  extraordinary  Reptiles 
of  a  past  age ;  which  establish,  in  a  remarkable  manner,  the 
connection  between  this  class  and  the  other  Vertebrata.     The 
remains  of  the  Pterodactylus  (Fig.  307),  the  chief  peculiarity  in 
whose  structure  has  been  already  noticed  (§  468),  are  found  in 
the  lias  and  oolite  formations  ;  mingled  with  the  remains  of  large 
insects,   such   as   Dragon-flies   and  Beetles.     There  can  be  no 
doubt  that  they  were  adapted  to  lead  the  life  of  the  Bats  and 
Swallows  of  the  present  day ;  restraining  the  multiplication  of  the 
Insect  tribes,  at  a  period  when  neither  Birds  nor  Bats  existed. 
Some  of  the  larger  species  may  not  improbably  have  been  partly 
aquatic  in  their  habits,  and  may  have  fed  on  fish.     From  the 
size  and  form  of  the  posterior  extremities,  the  Pterodactylus 
seems  to  have  been  able  to  walk  arid  perch  upon  them,  after  the 
manner  of  Birds  ;  and  with  the  anterior  and  posterior  combined, 
it  could  probably  walk  and  climb  on  rocks  and  cliffs,  like  Bats 
and  Lizards.    Several  species  have  been  already  found,  and  more 
probably  remain  to  be  discovered ;  their  size  varied  from  that  of 
a  Snipe  to  that  of  a  Cormorant.     One  of  these  was  remarkable 
for  the  enormous  length  of  its  head ;  in  all  of  them  the  neck  was 
very  long,  and  thus  enabled  the  head  to  make  a  sudden  dart 
upon  the  prey. 

504.  In  the  same  deposits,  we  find  the  remains  of  numerous 
species  of  Icthyosaurus,  or  Fish-Lizard  ;  the  whole  organisation 
of  which  shows  its  intermediate  position  between  the  Reptiles, 
Fishes,  and  Cetaceous  Mammalia.     The  spinal  column  is  formed 
upon  the  plan  of  that  of  the  Fish  ;  the  vertebrae  being  concave 
on  both   surfaces,   and  having  had  a  bag  of  fluid  interposed 
between  each  pair  (§  66)  ;  and  the  arches  which  enclosed  the 
spinal  chord  always  remained  distinct  from  the  bodies.     Hence 
the  body  must  have  had  great  flexibility,  and  must  have  been 
able  to  move  rapidly  through  the  water  by  its  undulations  from 
side  to   side ;  whilst  the  spinal  column  could  not  have  been 
sufficiently  strong  to  support  the  weight  of  the  trunk  upon  land. 


ICTHYOSAURUS.  567 

But  the  progression  of  these   animals  through  the  water  was 
accomplished  in  part  by  means  of  the  anterior  and  posterior 


F/o.  337 — ICTHYOSAURUS. 

extremities,  which  are  very  efficient  instruments  of  propulsion, 
being  formed  very  much  upon  the  plan  of  the  paddles  of  the 
Whale ;  but  their  number  of  fingers  and  phalanges  was 
much  greater;  and  the  bones  themselves,  being  shorter,  were 
arranged  in  a  tessellated  manner.  The  muzzle  is  elongated  and 
pointed  ;  and  the  teeth  very  numerous.  The  general  form  of 
the  head  is  not  unlike  that  of  the  Porpoise  ;  but  it  must  have 
had  far  greater  strength,  and  the  surface  for  the  attachment  of 
muscles  is  very  extensive.  The  form  and  solidity  of  the  sternal 
arch,  to  which  the  anterior  paddles  are  attached,  show  that 
provision  was  made  for  imparting  enormous  power  and  firm- 
ness to  these ;  and  certain  peculiarities  in  the  structure  of  the 
tail  seem  to  prove,  that  the  Icthyosaurus  must  have  had  a  ver- 
tical cartilaginous  tail-fin,  like  that  which  is  seen  on  the  back  of 
many  Cetacea.  From  the  absence  of  any  remains  of  scales  or 
plates,  it  may  be  concluded  that  the  skin  was  naked,  like  that 
of  the  Whales  and  their  allies.  There  is  no  question  that  the 
Icthyosaurus  was  exclusively  an  air-breathing  animal ;  no  trace 
of  any  adaptation  to  branchial  respiration  being  perceptible. 
From  the  remains  of  partially-digested  food,  which  are  found 
with  their  bones,  it  appears  that  they  fed  (as  might  have  been 
anticipated)  exclusively  upon  Fishes ;  and  especially  upon  one 
species,  which  is  known  only  in  a  fossil  state.  Some  of  the 
largest  of  these  aquatic  Reptiles  must  have  exceeded  thirty  feet 
in  length;  and  it  is  easily  to  be  conceived  that 'they  were  very 
formidable  enemies  to  the  other  inhabitants  of  the  deep.  They 
seem  to  have  taken  the  place  of  the  Grampus,  and  other  vora- 
cious Cetacea,  at  a  time  when  no  Mammals  had  been  called  into 
existence. 


568  PLESIOSAURUS. 

505.  Still  more  extraordinary  in  its  conformation,  was  the 
animal  known  under  the  name  of  the  Plesiosaurus  ;  which  has 
been  designated  by  Cuvier  as  the  most  heteroclife, — that  is, 
made  up  of  the  most  unexpected  combination  of  parts, — of  any 
that  had  come  under  his  knowledge.  To  the  head  of  a  Lizard, 


FIG.  338.— Pi-EsrosAURUs. 


it  united  the  teeth  of  a  Crocodile  ;  a  neck  of  enormous  length, 
resembling  the  body  of  a  Serpent ;  the  trunk  and  tail  having 
the  proportions  of  an  ordinary  Quadruped  ;  the  ribs  resembling 
those  of  the  Chameleon  ;  and  the  paddles  being  like  those  of  the 
Whale.  "  Such,"  says  Dr.  Buckland,  "  are  the  strange  com- 
binations of  form  and  structure  in  the  Plesiosaurus ;  a  genus, 
the  remains  of  which,  after  interment  for  thousands  of  years, 
amidst  the  wreck  of  millions  of  the  inhabitants  of  the  ancient 
earth,  are  at  length  recalled  to  light  by  the  researches  of  the 
geologist,  and  submitted  to  our  examination  in  nearly  as  perfect 
a  state  as  the  species  that  are  now  existing  upon  the  earth." 
The  Plesiosaurus  was  evidently  a  marine  animal ;  and,  if  ever 
it  visited  the  land,  its  motions  must  have  been  very  awkward. 
The  probability  is,  that  it  swam  habitually  on  or  near  the  sur- 
face of  the  water,  arching  back  its  long  neck  like  the  Swan,  and 
occasionally  darting  it  down  at  the  fish  which  happened  to  float 
within  its  reach.  Or  it  may  have  lurked  in  shoal  water  along 
the  coast,  like  the  long-necked  Emydae  of  the  present  time 
(§  487)  ;  suddenly  darting  at  such  fish  or  reptiles  as  approached 
its  place  of  concealment.  The  neck  had  no  less  than  forty 
vertebrae  in  some  species ; — a  greater  number  than  exists  in  any 
other  known  animal,  the  Swan  having  but  twenty-three. 


5G9 


ORDER  III.— OPHIDIA. 

506.  THE  division  of  the  class  of  Reptiles,  which  includes 
the  Serpent  tribes,  is  one  which  is  almost  universally  regarded 
with  feelings  of  horror  and  aversion.     These  doubtless  originate 
in  the  venomous  qualities  of  certain  families  of  the  order,  and  in 
the  terrific  strength  that  characterises  others ;  and  also  in  the 
insidious  manner  in  which  they  usually  approach  their  victims. 
The   prejudice   is   unjust,   however,  as  regards  a  considerable 
number  of  the  order,  which  are  neither  furnished  with  poison- 
fangs,  nor  of  a  strength  or  size  to  render  them  dangerous  to 
Man  ;  and  when  it  can  be  overcome,  there  is  much  in  the  beauty 
of  their  markings,  and  the  grace  of  their  movements,  to  excite 
our   interest.      The   species   belonging   to  this   order   may  be 
naturally   grouped   in   three   sections: — 1.   Harmless   Snakes; 
— 2.  Venomous  Snakes ; — 3.  Water  Snakes. 

507.  The  Harmless  Snakes  are  divided  into  two  families, — 
the  COLUBRID^,  or  Colubers, — and  the  BOID.E,  or  Boas.    Of  the 
former  of  these,  which  contains  more  than  half  the  entire  number 
of  species  of  Snakes,  we  have  an  example  in  our  own  country, 
the  common  Ringed  Snake;  which  is  abundant  in  low  moist 
woods,  damp  meadows,  and  hedgerows  in  the  vicinity  of  water, 
these  being  the  situations  in  which  its  favourite  food,  the  Frog, 
is  always  to  be  procured.     In  this  fondness  for  water,  and  in 
its  power  of  swimming  with  facility,  the  Ringed  Snake  differs 
from  the  Viper,  which  prefers  dry  localities.     It  is  a  voracious 
animal,  and  pursues  its  prey  with  great  determination ;  besides 
frogs,  it  feeds  on  mice,  shrews,  and  nestling  birds ;  these  are 
swallowed  whole,  whilst  yet  alive,  by  the  peculiar  mechanism  of 
the  jaws  (§  473).     This  Snake  may   be   readily  tamed,    and 
exhibits  feelings  of  attachment  to  its  protector.     It  passes  the 
winter  in  a  state  of  torpidity,  retreating  to  some  sheltered  situ- 
ation, in  which  numbers  often  collect,  for  the  sake  of  preserving 
their   warmth ;    in   an   instance   which   has   come   within   the 
Author's  knowledge,  as  many  as   1300  were  found  in  an  old 


570  COLUBRID^. BOID^E. 

limekiln.  The  length  of  this  species  is  usually  between  three 
and  four  feet ;  in  tropical  countries,  however,  the  Colubers 
attain  a  much  greater  size. — The  family  Colubridte  includes 
many  species  which  habitually  reside  among  trees ;  and  these 
are,  for  the  most  part,  distinguished  by  the  brilliancy  of  their 
colours,  and  the  gracefulness  of  their  forms  and  movements. 
They  are  harmless  and  very  tameable.  One  species  belonging 
to  this  family,  the  Acrochordus,  or  Oular  Carron  of  the  Java- 
nese, is  remarkable  on  account  of  its  diet ;  which  (contrary  to 
the  general  habit  of  the  order)  seems  to  consist  chiefly  or 
entirely  of  fruits. 

508.  Whilst  the  ColubridsB  are  very  widely  distributed, 
some  species  being  found  in  almost  every  part  of  the  world,  the 
BOID^E  are  restricted  to  tropical  climates.  They  are  Serpents  of 
very  large  size  and  enormous  muscular  strength ;  and  from  their 
power  of  coiling  round  and  firmly  compressing  the  bodies  of 
their  victims,  they  are  able  to  overcome  animals  of  the  largest 
dimensions.  The  tail  has  great  prehensile  power  ;  and  is  much 


IMG  239, — BOA  CONSTRICTOR. 


aided  in  its  grasp,  by  two  hook-like  claws  sheathed  with  horn, 
which  are  supported  upon  bones  that  obviously  represent  those 


BOAS;  PYTHONS. — CROTALID*.  571 

of  the  hinder  limbs,  in  their  position  and  attachments  ;  these 
claws  are  put  in  action  by  powerful  muscles,  and  serve  as  a  kind 
of  antagonist  to  the  tail  in  grasping  any  object.  The  true  Boas 
are  restricted  to  America ;  the  name  of  Python  being  given  to 
the  large  Serpents  of  Africa  and  India.  There  is  no  doubt  that 
individuals  of  both  genera  occasionally  attain  a  size  that  enables 
them  to  overpower  and  gorge  animals  of  large  size,  such  as  Men 
or  Cattle  ;  but  these  are  rarely  met  with, — the  usual  length  of 
these  Serpents  being  from  15  to  30  feet.  It  is  related  by  Pliny, 
that  the  army  of  Regulus  was  alarmed  by  a  huge  Serpent,  whose 
length  was  123  feet ;  but  it  is  doubtful  how  far  this  account  is 
to  be  relied  on.  A  well-authenticated  instance  has  occurred  in 
recent  times,  however,  of  the  destruction  of  a  Snake  above  62 
feet  long,  whilst  in  the  act  of  coiling  itself  round  the  body  of  a 
man.  After  having  destroyed  the  life  of  their  victims  by  the 
compression  of  the  body,  these  huge  Snakes  proceed  to  envelope 
them  whole  in  their  capacious  swallow;  and  owing  to  the  re- 
markable power  of  distention,  which  the  jaws  and  oesophagus 
possess,  even  the  bodies  of  men  and  cattle  can  be  thus  engulfed. 
After  gorging  themselves  to  a  degree  which  causes  the  skin  of 
the  neck  to  appear  as  if  it  would  burst,  they  retire  to  their  hiding 
places,  and  there  continue  in  an  almost  torpid  state,  until  the 
process  of  digestion  has  been  completed  ;  after  this  period  (which 
sometimes  lasts  a  month)  is  over,  the  Snake  again  issues  forth  in 
search  of  its  prey.  The  Boas  of  America  seem  to  have  been 
tamed  by  the  ancient  Mexicans ;  and  to  have  been  especially 
used  by  the  priests,  as  instruments  for  impressing  the  people  with 
awe  and  reverence  for  their  power. 

509.  The  section  of  Poisonous  Snakes  also  contains  two 
families, — the  CROTALID.E,  or  Rattle- Snakes, — and  the  VIPERID^E, 
or  Vipers. — The  true  Rattle- Snakes,  distinguished  by  the  peculiar 
appendage  to  their  tails  from  which  their  name  is  derived,  are 
confined  to  America  ;  but  there  are  other  species,  included  in  the 
family  CROTALID^E,  which  are  found  in  the  Old  World  also. 
The  rattle  consists  of  a  number  of  thin  horny  cells,  which  are 
articulated  loosely  to  each  other,  and  which  produce  a  rustling 
noise  when  shaken.  The  number  of  joints  increases,  up  to  a 


572  RATTLE-SNAKES. VIPERIDJ3,    OR    VIPERS. 

certain  amount  at  least,  with  each  casting  of  the  skin.  The  Rattle- 
snake vibrates  this  appendage  when  irritated   or  alarmed,  and 

gives  timely  warning  of  its  ap- 
proach; it  would  seem,  however, 
that  most  of  the  small  animals 
on  which  it  usually  preys,  are  so 
bewildered  by  the  neighbourhood 
of  their  dreaded  enemy,  as  to 
make  but  little  attempt  at  escape. 
There  is  no  reason  to  believe  that 
it  ever  attacks  Man,  unless  it 
be  trodden  on,  or  otherwise 
molested.  Its  bite,  however, 
when  severe,  is  almost  certainly 
fatal;  unless  immediate  mea- 
sures be  taken  to  prevent  the 
absorption  of  the  poison  (§  475)  : 
small  animals,  such  as  dogs,  are 
very  rapidly  affected  by  the  poi- 
son ;  death  taking  place  in  a  few  minutes.  The  usual  length 
of  these  Snakes  is  about  four  feet ;  but  they  have  been  occa- 
sionally met  with  double  that  size. 

510.  The  family  VIPERID^E  is  a  very  numerous  one,  and 
widely  distributed.  One  species,  and  this  among  the  smallest, 
is  an  inhabitant  of  our  own  country ;  giving  preference  to  dry 
woods,  sandy  heaths,  sunny  banks,  and  similar  places.  The 
Fiper,  or  Adder  (as  it  is  commonly  termed),  is  subject  to  great 
differences  in  colour  ;  thus  we  have  black,  red,  and  blue-bellied 
varieties,  which  have  been  described  (though  erroneously)  as 
distinct  species.  The  Viper  feeds  upon  small  animals,  such  as 
mice,  rats,  birds,  &c.,  which  are  very  speedily  killed  by  its  bite ; 
it  never  attacks  Man  unless  provoked  to  do  so ;  and  although 
very  unpleasant  consequences  follow  the  insertion  of  the  poison- 
fangs  into  his  body,  it  is  very  seldom  (if  ever)  that  fatal  results 
occur  to  persons  previously  healthy.  The  Viper  is  ovo-vivipa- 
rous,  the  eggs  being  hatched  within  the  body;  and  the  female, 
when  loaded  with  them,  may  often  be  seen  basking  in  the  sun, 


VIPERS. HYDRIDE,    OR    WATER    SERPENTS.  573 

and  thus  taking  advantage  of  its  warmth  for  the  development  of 
her  offspring. — The  Viperidae  of  tropical  regions  are  much  more 
venomous ;  their  bite  being  fatal  to  Man.  Among  these  we 
may  mention  the  Cerastes,  or  Horned  Viper,  so  named  from  a 

little  pointed  horn  which  rises 
from  the  upper  edge  of  each 
eye ;  the  Indian  Naja,  Cobra 
di  Capellc,  or  Spectacle- 
Snake,  which  has  a  curious 
mark  resembling  a  pair  of 
spectacles,  on  the  loose  skin  of 
its  neck  ;  the  Egyptian  Naja, 
or  Asp,  which  (in  common 
with  the  preceding)  has  a  sort 
of  hood,  formed  by  the  loose 
skin  of  the  neck,  that  rises 
when  the  animal  is  excited ; 
the  Hamadryas,  another  In- 
dian Serpent,  which  some- 

FJO.  241.— EGYPTIAN  NAJA. 

times    attains     the   length   of 

twelve  feet ;  and  the  Trigonocephalus,  or  Lance-headed  Viper, 
of  Martinique,  which  also  is  extremely  dangerous  from  its  size 
and  venomous  power. 

511.  The  Marine  Snakes,  belonging  to  the  family  HYDRIDE, 
are  characterised  by  the  compressed  form  of  their  bodies,  and  by 
the  vertical  flattening  of  the  tail,  which  adapts  them  to  move 
through  the  water  with  facility.  In  their  general  aspect  and 
movements  they  strongly  resemble  Eels ;  but  they  are  altogether 
destitute  of  fins,  and  are  covered  with  scales.  They  appear 
seldom  or  never  to  quit  the  land  ;  and  they  can  only  live  for  a 
short  time  out  of  salt  water.  Little  is  known  of  their  habits  ; 
but  it  has  been  proved  (contrary  to  the  general  opinion),  that 
all  the  species  are  venomous,  some  of  them  extremely  so.  These 
Serpents,  of  which  more  than  fifty  species  are  known,  are  peculiar 
to  the  seas  of  tropical  Asia  and  New  Holland. 


574 


ORDER  IV.—BATRACHIA. 

512.  The  peculiarities  of  this  curious  order  have  already 
been  dwelt  upon  in  so  much  detail,  that  we  need  not  do  more 
than  notice  the  principal  varieties  of  form  which  it  includes. 
These,  like  the  varieties  of  the  Marsupialia,  which  occupy  a 
somewhat  corresponding  position  among  the  Mammals,  are  very 
numerous  and  remarkable  ;  the  other  orders  of  the  Reptile  class 
finding  their  representatives,  so  to  speak,  in  this  one;  whilst  many 
of  its  forms  present  us  with  a  very  close  resemblance  to  the  Fishes. 
— The  family  RANID^E,  including  the  Frogs,  Toads,  &c.,  is  the 
one  in  which  the  metamorphoses  is  most  complete, — the  perfect 
form  being  most  unlike  the  Tadpole  state.  The  different  species 
vary  in  size  and  in  the  adaptation  of  their  structure  to  aquatic 
habits ;  but  in  other  respects  they  have  a  close  correspondence. 

They  have  a  broad,  short,  de- 
pressed body,  quite  destitute  of 
any  tail.  Their  hind-legs  are 
much  larger  than  the  anterior 
pair;  and  they  are  the  chief 
instruments  in  the  progression  of 
the  animal,  which  is  accom- 
plished on  land  by  leaping,  and 
in  water  by  swimming.  The 
family  is  divided  into  three 
groups; — the  Frogs,  which  have 
teeth  in  their  upper  jaw,  and 

FIG.  242. — TOAD.  , .     .      -  ,  ,  ,•,       rr<      j 

their  feet  webbed ;— the  Toads, 

which  have  no  teeth  in  either  jaw,  and  the  toes  but  little 
connected  with  webs  ; — and  the  Hylm  or  Tree  Frogs,  which 
have  the  ends  of  their  toes  dilated  into  small  pads,  that  enable 
them  to  walk  on  the  under  sides  of  smooth  surfaces,  in  the 
manner  of  the  Geckos  (§  467).  The  food  of  all  these  is  nearly 
the  same,  consisting  of  insects,  slugs,  &c.,  in  the  capture  of 
which  the  tongue  performs  an  important  part.  The  Tree 


TREE    FROGS. — C^EClLTADjE. SALAMANDRID^5.  575 

Frogs,    which    are   common   in    most    temperate    and   tropical 

regions,  although  none  occur 
in  Britain,  are  very  beautiful 
and  active  little  animals, 
dwelling  amidst  the  foliage 
of  the  woods,  and  changing 
their  hues  in  accordance  with 
the  colour  of  the  surrounding 
objects. — There  is  distinct 
evidence,  derived  from  im- 
pressions of  footsteps,  and 
from  remains  of  teeth  and 

FJO.  243.— HYLA  OR  TRBE-FROG.  ,  ...          .         ,.  . 

bones,  that  a  gigantic  animal 

of  the  Frog  tribe,  measuring  at  least  three  or  four  feet  in  length, 
inhabited  Britain,  at  the  time  when  the  New  Red  Sandstone 
was  in  process  of  formation  ;  this  has  received  the  name  of  Ldby- 
rinthodon,  from  peculiarities  in  the  structure  of  the  teeth. 

513.  The  Tortoises  seem  to  be  represented  in  this  group,  by 
a  species  of  Frog  that  inhabits  Brazil ;  in  which  a  sort  of 
carapace  and  plastron  are  formed  by  the  thickening  of  the  skin 
above  and  below. — The  Serpents  are  represented  by  the  very 
curious  family  of  C^CILIAD^G,  which  are  intermediate  in  their 
characters  between  the  two  groups,  having  the  form  of  Serpents, 
but  the  naked  skin  and  imperfectly-developed  ribs  of  the  Frogs. 
That  their  real  position  is  in  this  order,  has  been  recently  proved 
by  the  discovery,  that  they  undergo  a  metamorphosis  like  the 
Batrachia  in  general. — The  Lizards,  too,  find  their  represent- 
atives in  the  family  SALAMANDRID^E,  or  Salamanders;  of  which 
we  have  examples  in  this  country,  the  Water  and  Land-Newts, 
or  Efts,  bearing  much  ^j/vV^i, 

the  same  relation  to 
each  other,  as  do  the 
Frogs  and  Toads. 
These  are  extremely 
harmless  animals,  not  FIG.  244.— WATER-NEWT. 

at  all  deserving  the  aversion  with  which  they  are  commonly 
regarded.  The  Menopoma  of  the  Ohio  and  Alleghany  rivers 


576  PROTEID^E  ; PROTEUS,    SIREN,    AXOLOTL,    LEPIDOSIREN. 

belongs  to  this  family ;  it  is  about  two  feet  in  length,  and  is 
described  as  very  voracious.  It  is  interesting  as  exhibiting  the 
first  stage  of  the  incomplete  metamorphosis  of  the  respiratory 
organs, — the  branchial  aperture  remaining  open  in  the  neck 
during  the  whole  of  life.  Remains  of  a  gigantic  Salamander, 
nearly  six  feet  long,  have  been  found  near  ^ningen. 

514.  In  the  PROTEUXE,  or  perennibranchiate  Batrachia,  the 
gills  remain  during  the  whole  of  life,  and  the  lungs  are  not 
developed  sufficiently  to  maintain  the  respiration  by  themselves. 
The  body,  too,  retains  much  of  the  Tadpole  form  and  aspect. 
Of  these  very  curious  animals,  several  distinct  genera  are  known. 
The  Proteus  inhabits  the  underground  lakes  of  the  Tyrol, 
retreating  from  the  light  of  day,  and  burying  itself  in  the  mud 
when  the  waters  in  which  it  dwells  (as  sometimes  happens)  are 
dried  up.  It  is  very  Eel-like  in  its  appearance  and  movements, 
but  has  four  short  limbs. — The  Sirens  have  no  hind  limbs  ; 
and  the  anterior  pair  are  short  feeble  rudiments ;  these  animals 
inhabit  the  marshy  grounds  of  Carolina.— The  Axolotl  (Fig.  19) 
is  common  in  the  Lake  of  Mexico,  and  is  considered  as  an  article 
of  luxury  by  the  inhabitants  of  that  city.  Its  general  form  is 
very  Fish-like  ;  though  its  extremities  are  more  developed  than 
those  of  the  preceding.  Finally,  the  curious  Lepidosiren  (Fig.  20) 
— of  which  one  species  (about  a  foot  long)  inhabits  the  upper 
part  of  the  river  Gambia,  and  another  (from  two  to  three  feet 
in  length)  is  a  native  of  the  large  rivers  of  South  America, 
— approaches  the  most  nearly  of  any  of  this  group  to  the 
class  of  Fishes ;  with  which,  indeed,  it  is  ranked  by  some 
eminent  Naturalists.  In  its  respiratory  apparatus,  it  bears  the 
closest  correspondence  with  the  Perennibranchiate  Batrachia  ; 
but  in  many  other  points  of  its  internal  structure,  it  more 
resembles  certain  species  of  the  class  of  Fishes.  The  African 
species  is  said  to  pass  nine  months  out  of  the  twelve  in  a 
state  of  torpidity ;  burying  itself  in  the  mud  during  the  dry 
season,  and  again  reviving  when  the  sources  of  the  river  are 
swollen  by  the  rains. 


BRADBURY    AMD     FVANS,     PRINTERS,    WHITEFKIARS. 


UNIVERSITY  OF  CALIFORNIA  LIBRARY 


8      THIS  BOOK  IS  DUE  ON  THE  LAST  DATE 
Kp                               STAMPED  BELOW 

fi      SEP  I5  191& 

s 

g     JUL151918 

i 

m         SfP  101920 

a^ 

K3 
•9 

. 

30m-l,'15 


"Ml 


£/*^K 


OSS 


r3r*^ 


OGX 


UB** 

fi. 


UNIVE.T 


<         •   <      f  ' 
< 

'     < 


^..''.' 

v      v